This is a modern-English version of An Outline of Occult Science, originally written by Steiner, Rudolf.
It has been thoroughly updated, including changes to sentence structure, words, spelling,
and grammar—to ensure clarity for contemporary readers, while preserving the original spirit and nuance. If
you click on a paragraph, you will see the original text that we modified, and you can toggle between the two versions.
Scroll to the bottom of this page and you will find a free ePUB download link for this book.
An Outline of Occult Science
A Guide to Occult Science
By
By
Rudolf Steiner, Ph.D.
Rudolf Steiner, PhD
Authorized Translation from the Fourth Edition
Authorized Translation from the Fourth Edition
(Newly Revised)
(Newly Revised)
AnthropoSophic Press
Anthroposophic Press
New York
NYC
1922
1922
Contents
- Preface to the Fourth Edition.
- Author's Remarks To First Edition
- Chapter I. The Character of Occult Science
- Chapter II. The Nature of Man
- Chapter III. Sleep and Death
- Chapter IV. The Evolution of the World and Man
- Chapter V. Knowledge of the Higher Worlds
- Chapter VI. The Present and Future Evolution of the World and of Humanity
- Chapter VII. Details from the Domain of Occult Science Man's Etheric Body
- Footnotes
Preface to the 4th Edition.
One who undertakes to represent certain results of scientific spiritual research of the kind recorded in this book, must above all things be prepared to find that this kind of investigation is at the present time almost universally regarded as impossible. For things are related in the following pages about which those who are today esteemed exact thinkers, assert that they will probably remain altogether indeterminable by human intelligence. One who knows and can respect the reasons which prompt many a serious person to assert this impossibility, would fain make the attempt again and again to show what misunderstandings are really at the bottom of the belief that it is not given to human knowledge to penetrate into the superphysical worlds.
Anyone who sets out to explain certain results of scientific spiritual research like those documented in this book must, above all, be ready to encounter the fact that this type of inquiry is currently seen as nearly impossible by most people. The following pages discuss topics that those considered precise thinkers today claim will likely remain completely beyond human understanding. Anyone who understands and can appreciate the reasons why many serious individuals assert this impossibility would want to try time and again to clarify the misunderstandings that actually lie behind the belief that human knowledge cannot access the spiritual realms.
For two things present themselves for consideration. First, no human being will, on deeper reflection, be able in the long run to shut his eyes to the fact that his most important questions as to the meaning and significance of life must remain unanswered, if there be no access to higher worlds. Theoretically we may delude ourselves concerning this fact and so get away from it; the depths of our soul-life, however, will not tolerate such self-delusion. The person who will not listen to what comes from [pg xii] these depths of the soul will naturally reject any account of supersensible worlds. There are however people—and their number is not small—who find it impossible to remain deaf to the demands coming from the depths of the soul. They must always be knocking at the gates which, in the opinion of others, bar the way to what is “incomprehensible.”
For two things need to be considered. First, no one can ultimately ignore the fact that their most important questions about the meaning and significance of life will remain unanswered if there is no access to higher realms. We might fool ourselves about this fact theoretically and try to avoid it, but the depths of our soul won't allow such self-deception. Those who refuse to listen to what comes from these deep parts of the soul will naturally dismiss any accounts of unseen worlds. However, there are people—and they are not few—who find it impossible to ignore the calls from their inner depths. They feel compelled to keep knocking at the gates that, to others, seem to block what is “incomprehensible.”
Secondly, the statements of “exact thinkers” are on no account to be despised. Where they have to be taken seriously, one who occupies himself with them will thoroughly feel and appreciate this seriousness. The writer of this book would not like to be taken for one who lightly disregards the enormous thought-labour which has been expended in determining the limits of the human intellect. This thought-labour cannot be put aside with a few phrases about “academic wisdom” and the like. In many cases it has its source in true striving after knowledge and in genuine discernment. Indeed, even more than this must be admitted; reasons have been brought forward to show that that knowledge which is to-day regarded as scientific cannot penetrate into supersensible worlds, and these reasons are in a certain sense irrefutable.
Secondly, the views of "precision thinkers" shouldn’t be underestimated. When they are to be taken seriously, anyone who engages with them will truly feel and recognize this seriousness. The author of this book does not want to be seen as someone who casually dismisses the vast amount of intellectual effort that has gone into defining the limits of human understanding. This intellectual effort can’t be brushed aside with a few comments about “scholarly knowledge” or similar terms. In many instances, it stems from a genuine pursuit of knowledge and real insight. In fact, it must be acknowledged even more than this; there are arguments presented that show that the knowledge we consider scientific today cannot access higher realms, and these arguments are, in a way, undeniable.
Now it may appear strange to many people that the writer of this book admits this freely, and yet undertakes to make statements about supersensible worlds. It seems indeed almost impossible that a person should admit in a certain sense the reasons [pg xiii] why knowledge of superphysical worlds is unattainable, and should yet speak about those worlds.
Now, it might seem odd to many that the author of this book openly acknowledges this, yet still makes claims about non-physical realities. It truly seems almost impossible for someone to recognize the reasons why understanding these superphysical worlds is beyond reach, and still talk about them.
Yet it is possible to take this attitude, and at the same time to understand that it impresses others as being inconsistent. It is not given to every one to enter into the experiences we pass through when we approach supersensible realms with the human intellect. Then it turns out that intellectual proofs may certainly be irrefutable, and that notwithstanding this, they need not be decisive with regard to reality. Instead of all sorts of theoretical explanations, let us now try to make this comprehensible by a comparison. That comparisons are not in themselves proofs is readily admitted, but this does not prevent their often making intelligible what has to be expressed.
Yet it’s possible to have this mindset and still recognize that others might see it as inconsistent. Not everyone can grasp the experiences we go through when we explore higher realms with the human intellect. It becomes clear that intellectual arguments can be absolutely valid, and yet in spite of this, they don’t have to be definitive when it comes to reality. Rather than getting into various theoretical explanations, let’s try to clarify this through a comparison. It’s generally acknowledged that comparisons aren’t proofs in themselves, but that doesn’t stop them from often helping to clarify what needs to be expressed.
Human understanding, as it works in everyday life and in ordinary science, is actually so constituted that it cannot penetrate into superphysical worlds. This may be proven beyond the possibility of denial. But this proof can have no more value for a certain kind of soul-life than the proof one would use in showing that man's natural eye cannot, with its visual faculty, penetrate to the smallest cells of a living being, or to the constitution of far-off celestial bodies.
Human understanding, as it operates in daily life and in regular science, is structured in a way that it can't access superphysical realms. This can be proven beyond a doubt. However, this proof holds little value for a certain type of inner life, just like demonstrating that the human eye, with its visual ability, cannot see the smallest cells of a living organism or understand the makeup of distant celestial bodies.
Just as the assertion is true and demonstrable that the ordinary power of seeing does not penetrate as far as the cells, so also is the other assertion which maintains that ordinary knowledge cannot penetrate into supersensible worlds. And yet the [pg xiv] proof that the ordinary power of vision has to stop short of the cells in no way excludes the investigation of cells. Why should the proof that the ordinary power of cognition has to stop short of supersensible worlds, decide anything against the possibility of investigating those worlds?
Just as it's true and can be proven that normal eyesight doesn't reach as deep as the cells, it's also true that regular knowledge can't reach into non-physical realms. Yet the proof that normal vision can’t go beyond the cells doesn’t rule out the study of those cells. Why should the fact that regular understanding can’t access non-physical worlds mean we can’t explore those worlds?
One can well sense the feeling which this comparison may evoke in many people. One can even understand that he who doubts and holds the above comparison against this labor of thought, does not even faintly sense the whole seriousness of that mental effort. And yet the present writer is not only fully convinced of that seriousness, but is of opinion that that work of thought may be numbered among the noblest achievements of humanity. To show that the human power of vision cannot perceive the cellular structure without the help of instruments, would surely be a useless undertaking; but in exact thinking, to become conscious of the nature of that thought is a necessary work of the mind. It is only natural that one who devotes himself to such work, should not notice that reality may refute him. The preface to this book can be no place for entering into many “refutations” of former editions, put forth by those who are entirely devoid of appreciation of that for which it strives, or who direct their unfounded attacks against the personality of the author; but it must, none the less, be emphasized that belittling of serious scientific thought in this book can only be imputed to the author by one who [pg xv] wishes to shut himself off from the spirit of what is expressed in it.
One can definitely feel the emotions this comparison might stir in many people. It's also understandable that someone who doubts and compares this line of thought to other efforts doesn’t fully grasp the seriousness of that mental work. Still, the author is not only completely convinced of that seriousness but believes this intellectual endeavor ranks among humanity's greatest achievements. Demonstrating that human vision can't perceive cellular structures without instruments would certainly be a pointless task; however, in precise thinking, recognizing the nature of that thought is an essential mental exercise. It's only natural that someone dedicated to such work might overlook the fact that reality could contradict them. The preface of this book isn’t the right place to delve into numerous "counterarguments" from previous editions made by those who have no appreciation for its goals or who aim their unfounded criticisms at the author personally; however, it should still be highlighted that any dismissal of the serious scientific thinking in this book can only come from someone [pg xv] wishing to distance themselves from the vibe of what it conveys.
Man's power of cognition may be augmented and made more powerful, just as the eye's power of vision may be augmented. Only the means for strengthening the capacity of cognition are entirely of a spiritual nature; they are inner processes, belonging purely to the soul. They consist of what is described in this book as meditation and concentration (contemplation). Ordinary soul-life is bound up with the bodily instrument; the strengthened soul-life liberates itself from it. There are schools of thought at the present time to which this assertion must appear quite senseless, to which it must seem based only upon self-delusion. Those who think in this way will find it easy, from their point of view, to prove that “all soul-life” is bound up with the nervous system. One who holds the standpoint from which this book has been written, can thoroughly understand such proofs. He understands people who say that only superficiality can assert that there may be some kind of soul-life independent of the body, and who are quite convinced that in such experiences of the soul there exists a connection with the life of the nervous system, which the “dilettantism of occult science” merely fails to detect.
A person's ability to think can be enhanced and made stronger, just like the eye's ability to see can be improved. However, the ways to boost thinking are entirely spiritual; they are inner processes that belong purely to the soul. These methods include what this book describes as meditation and concentration (contemplation). Ordinary life of the soul is tied to the physical body, but an enhanced life of the soul frees itself from that connection. Currently, there are schools of thought that would find this claim completely nonsensical and view it as mere self-deception. Those who think this way can easily argue that “all soul-life” is connected to the nervous system. Someone who adopts the perspective from which this book has been written can fully understand such arguments. They recognize that people who claim only a superficial understanding would assert the possibility of soul-life existing independently from the body and are convinced that in these experiences of the soul, there is a link to the nervous system, which the “dilettantism of occult science” simply overlooks.
Here certain quite comprehensible habits of thought are in such sharp contradiction to what has been described in this book, that there is as yet no prospect of coming to an understanding with many [pg xvi] people. It is here that we come to the point where the desire must arise that it should no longer be a characteristic of our present day culture to at once decry as fanciful or visionary a method of research which differs from its own. But on the other hand it is also a fact at the present time that a number of people can appreciate the supersensible method of research, as it is presented in this book, people who understand that the meaning of life is not revealed in general phrases about the soul, self, and so on, but can only result from really entering into the facts of superphysical research.
Here, certain understandable ways of thinking are in such stark contrast to what has been discussed in this book that there’s currently no chance of reaching an agreement with many people. This is where we reach the point where the desire should emerge that it should no longer be typical of our modern culture to immediately dismiss as fanciful or unrealistic a method of research that differs from its own. However, it is also true that right now, there are people who can appreciate the supersensible method of research presented in this book—individuals who understand that the meaning of life isn’t revealed through vague statements about the soul, self, and so forth, but can only come from genuinely engaging with the facts of superphysical research.
Not from lack of modesty, but with a sense of joyful satisfaction, does the author of this book feel profoundly the necessity for this fourth edition after a comparatively short time. The author is not prompted to this statement by lack of modesty, for he is entirely too conscious of how little even this new edition approaches that “outline of a supersensuous world concept” which it is meant to be. The whole book has once more been revised for the new edition, much supplementary matter has been inserted at important points, and elucidations have been attempted. But in numerous passages the author has realized how poor the means of presentation accessible to him prove to be in comparison with what superphysical research discovers. Thus it was scarcely possible to do more than point out the way in which to reach conceptions of the events described in this book as the Saturn, Sun, and Moon evolutions. An important aspect of this subject has been briefly [pg xvii] remodelled in this edition. But experiences in relation to such things diverge so widely from all experiences in the realm of the senses, that their presentation necessitates a continual striving after expressions which may be, at least in some measure, adequate. One who is willing to enter into the attempted presentation which has here been made, will perhaps notice that in the case of many things which cannot possibly be expressed by mere words, the endeavour has been made to convey them by the manner of the description. This manner is, for instance, different in the account of the Saturn evolution from that used for the Sun evolution, and so on.
Not out of a lack of modesty, but with a sense of joyful satisfaction, the author of this book feels a deep need for this fourth edition after a relatively short period. This isn't a statement made from modesty, as the author is fully aware of how little even this new edition reflects that "overview of a transcendent world concept" that it aims to represent. The entire book has been revised again for this new edition, with much supplementary material added at crucial points, and attempts have been made to clarify certain aspects. However, in many areas, the author has realized how limited the means of expression available are compared to what superphysical research uncovers. Therefore, it was hardly possible to do more than suggest how to understand the concepts related to the events described in this book, such as the Saturn, Sun, and Moon evolutions. A significant part of this topic has been briefly [pg xvii] remodeled in this edition. However, experiences related to these matters differ so greatly from all sensory experiences that their presentation requires a constant effort to find expressions that may be somewhat adequate. Anyone willing to engage with the attempted presentation made here may notice that in many cases where things cannot be expressed in mere words, an effort has been made to convey them through the way of the description. This manner, for example, differs in the discussion of the Saturn evolution from that used for the Sun evolution, and so on.
Much complementary and additional matter has been inserted in this edition in the part dealing with “Perception of the Higher Worlds.” The endeavour has been made to represent in a graphic way the kind of inner soul-processes by which the power of cognition liberates itself from the limits which confine it in the world of sense and thereby becomes qualified for experiencing the supersensible world. The attempt has been made to show that these experiences, even though gained by entirely inner ways and methods, still do not have a merely subjective significance for the particular individual who gains them. The description attempts to show that within the soul stripped of its individuality and personal peculiarities, an experience takes place which every human being may have in the same way, if he will only work at his development from out his subjective experiences. It is only when “knowledge of supersensible [pg xviii] worlds” is thought of as bearing this character that it may be differentiated from old experiences of merely subjective mysticism. Of this mysticism it may be said that it is after all more or less a subjective concern of the mystic. The scientific spiritual training of the soul, however, as it is described here, strives for objective experiences, the truth of which, although recognized in an entirely inner way, may yet, for that very reason, be found to be universally valid. This again is a point on which it is very difficult to come to an understanding concerning many of the habits of thought of our time.
Much additional and complementary material has been added to this edition in the section about "Understanding the Higher Realms." The goal has been to visually illustrate the inner processes of the soul that allow our ability to understand to break free from the limitations of the physical world, thus becoming capable of experiencing the non-physical realm. This effort aims to demonstrate that these experiences, even though they are achieved through entirely internal methods, still hold significant meaning beyond just the individual who experiences them. The description strives to convey that within the soul, when stripped of its individual traits and personal quirks, there is an experience that every person can access in the same way if they work on their growth based on their personal experiences. It is only when “knowledge of non-physical worlds” is understood in this way that it can be distinguished from past experiences of purely subjective mysticism. This form of mysticism is, after all, largely a personal issue for the mystic. However, the scientific spiritual development of the soul, as described here, seeks objective experiences, whose truth, although recognized in a wholly internal manner, can still be found to be universally applicable. This is also a point on which it is very challenging to reach a common understanding given many prevalent thought patterns of our time.
In conclusion, the author would like to observe that it would be well if even the sympathetic reader of the book would take its statements exactly as they stand. At the present time there is a very prevalent tendency to give this or that spiritual movement an historical name, and to many it is only such a name that seems to make it valuable. But, it may be asked, what would the statements in this book gain by being designated “Rosicrucian,” or anything else of the kind? What is of importance is that in this book a glimpse into supersensible worlds is attempted with the means which in our present period of evolution are possible and suitable for the human soul; and that from this point of view the problems of human destiny and human existence are considered beyond the limits of birth and death. It is not a question of an endeavor which shall bear this or that old name, but of a striving after truth.
In conclusion, the author wants to point out that it would be best if even the sympathetic reader of the book took its statements at face value. Right now, there's a common trend to label various spiritual movements with historical names, and for many, it's just the name that seems to give it value. But, one might ask, what do the statements in this book gain by being called “Rosicrucian” or something similar? What matters is that this book attempts to offer a glimpse into non-physical worlds using the methods that are currently possible and suitable for the human soul; and that from this perspective, it addresses the issues of human destiny and existence beyond the confines of birth and death. It's not about pursuing some old label, but rather about striving for truth.
On the other hand, expressions have also been [pg xix] used, with hostile intention, for the conception of the universe presented in this book. Leaving out of account that those which were intended to strike and discredit the author most heavily are absurd and objectively untrue, these expressions are stamped as unworthy by the fact that they disparage a fully independent search for truth; because the aggressors do not judge it on its own merits, but try to impose on others, as a judgment of these investigations, erroneous ideas about their dependence upon this or that tradition,—ideas which they have invented, or adopted from others without reason. However necessary these words are in face of the many attacks on the author, it is yet repugnant to him in this place to enter further into the matter.
On the other hand, there have also been [pg xix] expressions used with malicious intent against the view of the universe presented in this book. Setting aside the fact that those aimed at damaging the author most severely are ridiculous and factually incorrect, these expressions are seen as unworthy because they undermine a genuinely autonomous quest for truth. The attackers don’t evaluate it based on its own merits, but instead try to impose false ideas about its dependence on certain traditions—ideas they have either created or adopted from others without justification. Although these comments are necessary given the many attacks against the author, he finds it distasteful to delve deeper into this issue at this moment.
Rudolf Steiner
June, 1913.
Rudolf Steiner
June 1913.
Author's Notes on First Edition
In placing a book such as this in the hands of the public, the writer must calmly anticipate every kind of criticism regarding his work which is likely to arise in the present day. A reader, for instance, whose opinions are based upon the results of scientific research, after noting certain statements made here touching these things, may pronounce the following judgment: “It is astounding that such statements should be possible in our time. The most elementary conceptions of natural science are distorted in such a manner as to denote positively inconceivable ignorance of even the rudiments of science. The author uses such terms, for instance, as ‘heat’ in a way that would lead one to infer that he had let the entire wave of modern thought on the subject of physics sweep past him unperceived. Any one familiar with the mere elements of this science would show him that not even the merest dilettante could have made these statements, and they can only be dismissed as the outcome of rank ignorance.”
In sharing a book like this with the public, the author has to prepare for all sorts of criticism about their work that might come up today. For example, a reader whose views are influenced by scientific research, after seeing some statements made here about these topics, might make the following comment: "It’s amazing that such statements can still happen today. The fundamental concepts of natural science are so misunderstood that they reveal a total lack of knowledge about even the basics of science. The author uses terms like ‘heat’ in a way that implies he’s completely out of touch with modern advancements in physics. Anyone with even a bit of knowledge in this field would see that only someone entirely uninformed could make these claims, and they come off as a clear sign of ignorance."
This and many a similar verdict might be pronounced, and we can picture our reader, after the perusal of a page or two, laying the book aside,—smiling or indignant, according to his temperament,—and [pg xxi] reflecting on the singular growths which a perverse tendency of thought may put forth in our time. So thinking, he will lay this volume aside, with his collection of similar freaks of the brain. What, however, would the author say should such opinions come to his knowledge? Would he not, from his point of view, also set the critic down as incapable of judgment or, at least, as one who has not chosen to bring his good will to bear in forming an intelligent opinion? To this the answer is most emphatically—No! In no sense whatever does the author feel this, for he can easily conceive of his critic as being not only a highly intelligent man, but also a trained scientist, and one whose opinions are the result of conscientious thought. The author of this book is able to enter into the feelings of such a person and to understand the reasons which have led him to form these conclusions.
This and many similar judgments could be made, and we can imagine our reader, after reading a page or two, putting the book down—smiling or feeling upset, depending on their personality—and reflecting on the strange ideas that a twisted way of thinking can produce in our time. While thinking this, they will set this book aside with their collection of other oddities of thought. However, what would the author think if they heard such opinions? Wouldn't he consider the critic as someone lacking judgment, or at least someone who hasn’t put in the effort to form an informed opinion? The answer to that is a resounding—No! The author doesn’t feel this way at all; he can easily picture his critic as not only a highly intelligent person but also a trained scientist, whose views come from careful consideration. The author of this book is able to empathize with such a person and understand the reasons that led them to form these conclusions.
Now, in order to comprehend what the author really means, it is necessary to do here what generally seems to him to be out of place, but for which there is urgent cause in the case of this book, namely, to introduce certain personal data. Of course, nothing will be said in this connection but what bears upon the author's decision to write this book. What is said in it could not be justified if it bore merely a personal character. A book of this kind is bound to proffer views to which any person may attain, and these views must be presented in such a way [pg xxii] as to suggest no shade of the personal element, that is, as far as such a thing is possible.
Now, to truly understand what the author means, it's necessary to do something that usually seems out of place for him, but is important in the context of this book: to share some personal background. Of course, only relevant information will be included that pertains to the author's decision to write this book. What is expressed here couldn't stand on its own if it was just about personal experiences. A book like this should offer insights that anyone can reach, and those insights must be presented in a way [pg xxii] that doesn't imply any personal bias, as much as that is possible.
It is therefore not in this sense that the personal note is sounded. It is only intended to explain how it was possible for the author to understand the above characterized opinions concerning his presentations, and yet was able to write this book.
It’s not in this way that the personal note is expressed. It’s just meant to explain how the author could grasp the opinions described above about his presentations, yet still write this book.
It is true there is one method which would have made the introduction of the personal element unnecessary—this would have been to specify in detail all those particulars which would show that the statements here made are in agreement with the progress of modern science. This course would, however, have necessitated the writing of many volumes, and as such a task is at present out of the question, the writer feels it necessary to state the personal reasons which he believes justify him in thinking such an agreement thoroughly possible and satisfactory. Were he not in a position to make the following explanations, he would most certainly never have gone so far as to publish such statements as those referring to heat processes.
It's true there’s a way to make the personal element unnecessary—by detailing all the specifics that would demonstrate how the statements made here align with the advancements of modern science. However, doing that would require writing many volumes, and since that’s not feasible at the moment, the author feels it’s important to share the personal reasons that justify his belief that such an alignment is entirely possible and acceptable. If he weren’t able to offer the following explanations, he certainly wouldn’t have gone as far as to publish statements regarding heat processes.
Some thirty years ago the author had the opportunity of studying physics in its various branches. At that time the central point of interest in the sphere of heat phenomena was the promulgation of the so-called “Mechanical Theory of Heat,” and it happened that this theory so particularly engrossed his attention that the historical development of the various interpretations associated with the names of Julius Robert Mayer, Helmholtz, Joule, Clausius, [pg xxiii] and others, formed the subject of his continuous study. During that period of concentrated work he laid those foundations which have enabled him to follow all the actual advances since made with regard to the theory of physical heat, without experiencing any difficulty in penetrating into what science is achieving in this department. Had he been obliged to confess himself unable to do this, the writer would have had good reason for leaving unsaid and unwritten much that has been brought forward in this book.
About thirty years ago, the author had the chance to study physics in its various aspects. At that time, the main focus in thermal phenomena was the introduction of the so-called "Mechanics of Heat," which fascinated him so much that he continuously studied the historical development of the different interpretations linked to the names of Julius Robert Mayer, Helmholtz, Joule, Clausius, [pg xxiii] and others. During that intense period of work, he built a foundation that allowed him to keep up with all the recent advancements in the theory of physical heat without struggling to understand what science is achieving in this field. If he had had to admit he couldn't do this, the author would have had good reason to leave out a lot of what has been presented in this book.
He has made it a matter of conscience, when writing or speaking on occult science, to deal only with matters on which he could also report, in what seemed an adequate manner, the views held by modern science. With this, however, he does not wish in the least to give the impression that this is always a necessary prerequisite. Any one may feel a call to communicate or to publish whatever his judgment, his sense of truth, and his feelings may prompt him to, even if he is ignorant of the attitude taken by contemporary science in the matter. The writer wishes to indicate merely that he holds to the pronouncements he has made. For instance, he would never have written those few sentences on the human glandular system, nor those regarding man's nervous system, contained in this volume, were he not in a position to discuss both subjects in the terms used by the modern scientist, when speaking of the glandular and nervous systems from the standpoint of science.
He has made it a point of conscience to only write or speak about occult science in relation to topics where he can also adequately present the views of modern science. However, he doesn’t intend to suggest that this is always a must. Anyone can feel inspired to share or publish whatever their judgment, sense of truth, and feelings may lead them to, even if they aren’t aware of what contemporary science thinks about the subject. The writer just wants to clarify that he stands by the statements he has made. For example, he would never have included those brief comments on the human glandular system or those about the nervous system in this book if he weren't able to discuss both topics using the terminology of modern scientists when addressing the glandular and nervous systems from a scientific perspective.
In spite of the fact that it may be said that he who speaks concerning “heat,” as is done here, knows nothing of the elements of modern physics, yet the author feels himself quite justified, because he believes that he knows present day research along those lines, and because if it were unknown to him, he would have left the subject alone. He knows that such utterances may be ascribed to lack of modesty, but it is necessary to declare his true motives, lest they should be confounded with others of a very different nature, a result infinitely worse than a verdict of mere vanity.
Even though one might say that someone discussing "heat," as is done here, doesn’t understand modern physics, the author feels fully justified because he believes he is up-to-date with current research in this area, and if he weren't, he would have avoided the topic altogether. He realizes that such statements might be seen as lacking humility, but he feels it’s important to clarify his true intentions to avoid them being mistaken for motives of a completely different kind, which is far worse than just being seen as vain.
He who reads this book as a philosopher, may well ask himself, “Has this author been asleep to present day research in the field of the theory of cognition? Had he never heard of the existence of a man called Kant?” this philosopher might ask, “and did he not know that according to this man it was simply inadmissible, from a philosophic point of view, to put forward such statements?” and so on, while in conclusion he might remark that stuff of so uncritical, childish, and unprofessional a nature should not be tolerated among philosophers, and that any further investigation would be waste of time. However, here again, for reasons already advanced and at the risk of being again misinterpreted, the writer would fain introduce certain personal experiences.
Anyone reading this book as a philosopher might wonder, "Has this author been unaware of recent research in cognitive theory? Has he never heard of a philosopher named Kant?" This philosopher might also question, "Didn't he understand that, from a philosophical perspective, making those kinds of claims is just not okay?" They might conclude that such uncritical, naive, and unprofessional content shouldn't be accepted in philosophical discussions, and that any further exploration would be pointless. However, as mentioned before and despite the risk of being misunderstood again, the author would like to share some personal experiences.
His studies of Kant date from his sixteenth year, and he really believes he is now capable of criticizing quite objectively, from the Kantian point of view, everything that has been put forward in this [pg xxv] book. On this account, too, he might have left this book unwritten were he not fully aware of what moves a philosopher to pass the verdict of “childishness” whenever the critical standard of the day is applied. Yet one may actually know that in the Kantian sense the limits of possible knowledge are here exceeded: one may know in what way Herbart (who never arrived at an “arrangement of ideas”) would discover his “naive realism.” One may even know the degree to which the modern pragmatism of James and Schiller and others would find the bounds of “true presentments” transgressed—those presentments which we are able to make our own, to vindicate, enforce, and to verify.
His studies of Kant began when he was sixteen, and he truly believes he can now criticize, quite objectively and from a Kantian perspective, everything that’s been presented in this [pg xxv] book. Because of this, he might have chosen not to write this book if he weren’t fully aware of what drives a philosopher to label something as “childish” whenever the prevailing critical standards are applied. Yet it’s possible to recognize that, in the Kantian sense, the limits of possible knowledge are being exceeded here: one can understand how Herbart (who never achieved an “arrangement of ideas”) would identify his “naive realism.” One can even grasp the extent to which modern pragmatists like James and Schiller would find the limits of “true presentments” breached—those presentments that we can make our own, validate, enforce, and verify.
We may know all these things and yet, for this very reason, feel justified in holding the views here presented. The writer has dealt with the tendencies of philosophic thought in his works: “The Theory of Cognition of Goethe's World-Concept”; “Truth and Science”; “Philosophy of Freedom”; “Goethe's World Concept” and “Views of the World and Life in the Nineteenth Century.”
We might understand all these things and yet, for that very reason, feel justified in holding the views presented here. The author has explored the trends in philosophical thought in his works: “The Theory of Cognition in Goethe's Worldview”; "Truth and Science"; "Philosophy of Freedom"; "Goethe's Concept of the World" and "Perspectives on the World and Life in the Nineteenth Century."
Many other criticisms might be suggested. Any one who had read some of the writer's earlier works: “Views of the World and Life in the Nineteenth Century,” for instance, or a smaller work on Haeckel and his Opponents, might think it incredible that one and the same man could have written those books as well as the present work and also his already published “Theosophy.” “How,” he might ask, “can a man throw himself into the breach [pg xxvi] for Haeckel, and then, turn around and discredit every sound theory concerning monism that is the outcome of Haeckel's researches?” He might understand the author of this book attacking Haeckel “with fire and sword”; but it passes the limits of comprehension that, besides defending him, he should actually have dedicated “Views of the World and Life in the Nineteenth Century” to him. Haeckel, it might be thought, would have emphatically declined the dedication had he known that the author was shortly to produce such stuff as An Outline of Occult Science, with all its unwieldy dualism.
Many other criticisms could be made. Anyone who has read some of the writer's earlier works, like “Perspectives on the World and Life in the Nineteenth Century,” or a smaller piece on Haeckel and His Critics, might find it hard to believe that the same person could have written those books as well as the current work and also his previously published "Theosophy." “How,” he might ask, "Can a man join the battle for Haeckel and then, turn around and reject every reliable theory about monism that comes from Haeckel's research?" He might get the idea of the author attacking Haeckel "with fire and sword"; but it’s hard to understand that, in addition to defending him, the author actually dedicated "Perspectives on the World and Life in the Nineteenth Century" to him. Haeckel might have strongly refused the dedication if he knew the author was soon to produce something like A Guide to Occult Science, with all its complicated dualism.
The writer of this book is of the opinion that one may very well understand Haeckel without being bound to consider everything else as nonsense which does not flow directly from Haeckel's own presentments and premises. The author is further of the opinion that Haeckel cannot be understood by attacking him with “fire and sword,” but by trying to grasp what he has done for science. Least of all does he hold those opponents of Haeckel to be in the right, against whom he has in his book, Haeckel and his Opponents, sought to defend the great naturalist; for surely, the fact of his having gone beyond Haeckel's premises by placing the spiritual conception of the world side by side with the merely natural one conceived by Haeckel, need be no reason for assuming that he was of one mind with the latter's opponents. Any one taking the trouble to look at the matter in the right light must see that the [pg xxvii] writer's recent books are in perfect accord with those of an earlier date.
The author of this book believes that you can understand Haeckel without dismissing everything that doesn't stem directly from Haeckel's ideas. The writer also thinks that the best way to comprehend Haeckel isn't by attacking him aggressively but by appreciating his contributions to science. He certainly doesn't agree with Haeckel's critics, whom he defends in his book, Haeckel and His Critics; just because he goes beyond Haeckel's ideas by including a spiritual view of the world alongside Haeckel's natural perspective, doesn’t mean he aligns with Haeckel's adversaries. Anyone willing to look at the issue fairly will see that the [pg xxvii] author's recent works align perfectly with his earlier ones.
But the author can also conceive of a critic who in general and offhand looks upon the presentations of this book as the out-pourings of a fantasy run wild or as dreamy thought-pictures. Yet all that can be said in this respect is contained in the book itself, and it is explicitly shown that sane and earnest thought not only can but must be the touch-stone of all the facts presented. Only one who submits what is here advanced to logical and adequate examination, such as is applied to the facts of natural science, will be in a position to decide for himself how much reason has to say in the matter.
But the author can also imagine a critic who generally and casually views the contents of this book as the ramblings of an unchecked imagination or as whimsical thought images. However, everything that can be said about this is already included in the book itself, and it is clearly demonstrated that rational and serious thinking not only can but gotta be the standard for all the information presented. Only someone who subjects the arguments made here to logical and thorough scrutiny, similar to what is done with natural science facts, will be able to determine for themselves how much logic supports the issue.
After saying this much about those who may at first be inclined to take exception to this work, we may perhaps be permitted to address a few words to those on whose sympathetic attention we can rely. These will find all broad essentials contained in the first chapter, “Concerning the Nature of Occult Science.” A word, however, must here be added. Although this book deals with investigations carried beyond the confines of intellect limited to the world of the senses, yet nothing has been asserted except what can be grasped by any person possessed of unprejudiced reasoning powers backed by a healthy sense of truth, and who is at the same time willing to turn these gifts to the best account; and the writer emphatically wishes it to be understood that he hopes to appeal to readers who will not be content with merely accepting on “blind faith” the [pg xxviii] matters presented, but who will take the trouble to test them by the light of their own understanding and by the experiences of their own lives. Above all, he desires cautious readers, who will allow themselves to be convinced only by what can be logically justified. The writer is well aware that his work would be worth nothing were its value to rest on blind belief; it is valuable only in the degree to which it can be justified by unbiased reason. It is an easy thing for “blind faith” to confound folly and superstition with truth, and doubtless many, who have been content to accept the supersensible on mere faith, will be inclined to think that this book makes too great demands upon their powers of thought. It is not a question of merely making certain communications, but rather of presenting them in a manner consistent with a conscientious view of the corresponding plane of life; for this is the plane upon which the loftiest matters are often handled with unscrupulous charlatanism, and where knowledge and superstition come into such close contact as to be liable to be confused one with the other.
After saying this much about those who might initially disagree with this work, we can perhaps say a few words to those whose sympathetic attention we can count on. They will find all the key points in the first chapter, "About the Nature of Occult Science." However, I must add a note here. Although this book discusses topics beyond the limits of intellect defined by the physical world, nothing has been claimed that isn't understandable to anyone who has an open mind, good reasoning skills, and a healthy sense of truth, and who is willing to use those qualities effectively. The author strongly hopes to reach readers who will not settle for simply accepting the information on unquestioning belief but will take the time to evaluate it through their own understanding and life experiences. Above all, he seeks careful readers who will only be convinced by what can be logically justified. The writer knows that his work would mean nothing if its value relied on blind belief; it is only valuable to the extent that it can be supported by unbiased reasoning. It's easy for "blind faith" to confuse foolishness and superstition with truth, and undoubtedly those who have accepted the unseen based solely on faith may feel that this book asks too much of their thinking abilities. This is not just about conveying certain ideas, but about presenting them in a way that aligns with a sincere understanding of the related aspects of life; for this is where the most profound topics are often mismanaged by unscrupulous charlatans, and where knowledge and superstition can become so intertwined that they are often mistaken for one another.
Any one acquainted with supersensual research will, on reading this book, be able to see that the author has sought to define the boundary line sharply between what can be communicated now from the sphere of supersensible cognition, and that which will be given out, at a later time, or at least, in a different form.
Anyone familiar with spiritual research will, upon reading this book, recognize that the author has aimed to clearly distinguish between what can currently be communicated from the realm of spiritual knowledge and what will be revealed later, or at least, in a different form.
Rudolf Steiner
December, 1909.
Rudolf Steiner
December 1909.
Chapter I. The Nature of Occult Science
At the present time the words “occult science” are apt to arouse the most varied feelings. Upon some people they work like a magic charm, like the announcement of something to which they feel attracted by the innermost powers of their soul; to others there is in the words something repellent, calling forth contempt, derision, or a compassionate smile. By many, occult science is looked upon as a lofty goal of human effort, the crown of all other knowledge and cognition; others, who are devoting themselves with the greatest earnestness and noble love of truth to that which appears to them true science, deem occult science mere idle dreaming and fantasy, in the same category with what is called superstition. To some, occult science is like a light without which life would be valueless; to others, it represents a spiritual danger, calculated to lead astray immature minds and weak souls, while between these two extremes is to be found every possible intermediate shade of opinion.
Right now, the term "esoteric knowledge" tends to evoke a wide range of feelings. For some, it acts like a magical charm, announcing something they feel deeply drawn to; for others, the term has a repellent quality that inspires contempt, mockery, or a pitying smile. Many view occult science as a noble pursuit, the pinnacle of all knowledge and understanding; meanwhile, others, who passionately and earnestly seek what they consider true science, see occult science as nothing more than idle fantasy, grouped with what is termed superstition. To some, occult science is like an essential light that makes life meaningful; to others, it poses a spiritual threat that might mislead inexperienced minds and vulnerable souls. Between these two extremes, there exists every possible shade of opinion.
Strange feelings are awakened in one who has attained a certain impartiality of judgment in regard [pg 002] to occult science, its adherents and its opponents, when one sees how people, undoubtedly possessed of a genuine feeling for freedom in many matters, become intolerant when they meet with this particular line of thought. And an unprejudiced observer will scarcely fail in this case to admit that what attracts many adherents of occult science—or occultism—is nothing but the fatal craving for what is unknown and mysterious, or even vague. And he will also be ready to own that there is much cogency in the reasons put forward against what is fantastic and visionary by serious opponents of the cause in question. In fact, one who studies occult science will do well not to lose sight of the fact that the impulse toward the mysterious leads many people on a vain chase after worthless and dangerous will-o'-the-wisps.
Strange feelings arise in those who have developed a certain impartiality in judging occult science, its supporters, and its critics when they notice how people, who genuinely value freedom in many areas, become intolerant when faced with this specific line of thought. An unbiased observer will likely agree that what draws many to occult science—or occultism—is a deep craving for the unknown and mysterious, or even just vague ideas. They will also acknowledge that there are strong arguments against the fantastic and visionary ideas presented by serious critics of the topic. In fact, anyone studying occult science should remember that the desire for mystery can lead many people on a futile and risky pursuit of worthless and dangerous illusions.
Even though the occult scientist keeps a watchful eye on all errors and vagaries on the part of adherents of his views, and on all justifiable antagonism, yet there are reasons which hold him back from the immediate defence of his own efforts and aspirations. These reasons will become apparent to any one entering more deeply into occult science. It would therefore be superfluous to discuss them here. If they were cited before the threshold of this science had been crossed, they would not suffice to convince one who, held back by irresistible repugnance, refuses to cross that threshold. But to one who effects an entry, the reasons will soon manifest themselves, with unmistakable clearness from within.
Even though the occult scientist keeps a close eye on all the mistakes and inconsistencies made by supporters of his views, as well as on all valid opposition, there are still reasons that prevent him from immediately defending his own work and ambitions. These reasons will become clear to anyone who delves deeper into occult science. So, it would be unnecessary to discuss them here. If they were mentioned before someone crossed the threshold of this science, they wouldn't be enough to convince someone who, held back by strong aversion, refuses to take that step. But for those who do enter, the reasons will soon reveal themselves clearly from within.
This much, however, implies that the reasons in question point to a certain attitude as the only right one for an occult scientist. He avoids, as much as he possibly can, any kind of outer defence or conflict, and lets the cause speak for itself. He simply puts forward occult science; and in what it has to say about various matters, he shows how his knowledge is related to other departments of life and science, what antagonism it may encounter, and in what way reality stands witness to the truth of his cognitions. He knows that an attempted vindication would,—not merely on account of current defective thinking but by virtue of a certain inner necessity,—lead into the domain of artful persuasion; and he desires nothing else than to let occult science work its own way quite independently.
This implies that the reasons mentioned point to a specific attitude as the only right one for someone studying the occult. They do their best to avoid any kind of outer defense or conflict, letting the subject speak for itself. They simply present occult science and, in what it discusses regarding various topics, demonstrate how their knowledge connects to other areas of life and science, what opposition they might face, and how reality supports the validity of their insights. They understand that trying to justify their views would—due not just to flawed contemporary thinking but also due to an inner necessity—lead to manipulative persuasion; and they wish for nothing more than to let occult science operate on its own terms.
The first point in occult science is by no means the advancing of assertions or opinions which are to be proven, but the communication, in a purely narrative form, of experiences which are to be met with in a world other than the one that is to be seen with physical eyes and touched with physical hands. And further, it is an important point that through this science the methods are described by which man may verify for himself the truth of such communications. For one who makes a serious study of genuine occult science will soon find that thereby much becomes changed in the conceptions and ideas which are formed—and rightly formed—in other spheres of life. A wholly new conception necessarily arises also about what has hitherto been called a “proof.” [pg 004] We come to see that in certain domains such a word loses its usual meaning, and that there are other grounds for insight and understanding than “proofs” of this kind.
The first point in occult science is definitely not about putting forward statements or opinions that need to be proven, but rather sharing experiences in a straightforward narrative way that are found in a world beyond what we can see with our eyes and touch with our hands. Additionally, it's crucial to note that this science outlines the methods by which individuals can personally verify the truth of these experiences. Anyone who seriously studies authentic occult science will quickly realize that their perspectives and ideas about various aspects of life will change significantly. A completely new understanding also emerges about what has previously been referred to as a "proof." [pg 004] We begin to understand that in certain areas, the term loses its standard meaning, and there are other bases for gaining insight and understanding beyond "proofs" of this nature.
All occult science is born from two thoughts, which may take root in any human being. To the occult scientist these thoughts express facts which may be experienced if the right methods for the purpose are used. But to many people these same thoughts represent highly disputable assertions, which may arouse fierce contention, even if they are not regarded as something which may be “proven” impossible.
All occult science comes from two ideas that can grow in anyone. For the occult scientist, these ideas represent facts that can be experienced if the proper methods are applied. However, many people see these same ideas as highly debatable claims that can lead to intense arguments, even if they aren't seen as something that can be "validated" impossible.
These two thoughts are, first, that behind the visible world there is another, the world invisible, which is hidden from the senses and also from thought that is fettered by these senses; and secondly, that it is possible for man to penetrate into that unseen world by developing certain faculties dormant within him.
These two ideas are, first, that behind the observable world there is another, the unseen world, which is hidden from our senses and also from a mind restricted by these senses; and second, that it's possible for humans to access that invisible world by developing certain abilities that are currently dormant within them.
Some will say that there is no such hidden world. The world perceived by man through his senses is the only one. Its enigmas can be solved out of itself. Even if man is still very far from being able to answer all the questions of existence, the time will certainly come when sense-experience and the science based upon it will be able to give the answers to all such questions.
Some will argue that there isn’t any hidden world. The world that people experience through their senses is the only one. Its mysteries can be figured out from within it. Even though we are still quite far from having all the answers to life's questions, there will definitely come a time when sensory experience and the science built on it will be able to provide answers to all those questions.
Others say that it cannot be asserted that there is no unseen world behind the visible one, but that human powers of perception are not able to penetrate into that world. Those powers have bounds [pg 005] which they cannot pass. Faith, with its urgent cravings, may take refuge in such a world; but true science, based on ascertained facts, can have nothing to do with it.
Others argue that we can't definitively say there isn't an unseen world beyond what we can see, but rather that human perception isn't capable of reaching that world. Our powers of perception have limits that they cannot go beyond. Faith, with its strong desires, might find solace in that world; however, true science, which is based on established facts, cannot engage with it.
A third class looks upon it as a kind of presumption for man to attempt to penetrate, by his own efforts of cognition, into a domain with regard to which he should give up all claim to knowledge and be content with faith. The adherents of this view feel it to be wrong for weak human beings to wish to force their way into a world which should belong to religious life.
A third group sees it as arrogance for people to try to understand a realm that they should simply accept on faith, rather than claim to know. Those who hold this belief think it's inappropriate for fragile humans to try to invade a world that should be reserved for spiritual life.
It is also alleged that a common knowledge of the facts of the sense-world is possible for mankind, but that in regard to supersensible things it can be merely a question of the individual's personal opinion, and that in these matters there can be no possibility of a certainty universally recognized. And many other assertions are made on the subject.
It is also claimed that people can have a shared understanding of the facts in the physical world, but when it comes to things beyond our senses, it’s mostly a matter of personal belief, and there can be no universally accepted certainty about these issues. Many other statements are also made on the topic.
The occult scientist has convinced himself that a consideration of the visible world propounds enigmas to man which can never be solved out of the facts of that world itself. Their solution in this way will never be possible, however far advanced a knowledge of those facts may be. For visible facts plainly point, through their own inner nature, to the existence of a hidden world. One who does not see this closes his eyes to the problems which obviously spring up everywhere out of the facts of the sense-world. He refuses to recognize certain questions and problems, and therefore thinks that all questions [pg 006] can be answered through facts within reach of sense perception. The questions which he is willing to ask are all capable of being answered by the facts which he is convinced will be discovered in the course of time. Every genuine occultist admits this. But why should one, when he asks no questions, expect answers on certain subjects? The occult scientist says that to him such questioning is natural, and must be regarded as a wholly justifiable expression of the human soul. Science is surely not to be confined within limits which prohibit impartial inquiry.
The occult scientist has convinced himself that looking at the visible world presents puzzles to humanity that can never be solved just by examining that world’s facts. No matter how advanced our understanding of those facts becomes, we will never find solutions this way. Visible facts clearly indicate, through their own nature, that there is a hidden world. Anyone who doesn’t see this is ignoring the problems that clearly arise from the facts of the sensory world. They refuse to acknowledge certain questions and issues and thus believe that all questions can be answered with facts that can be perceived through the senses. The questions they are willing to ask can all be answered by the facts they are sure will be uncovered over time. Every true occultist agrees with this. But why should someone expect answers on certain topics if they aren't asking any questions? The occult scientist argues that for him, asking such questions is natural and should be seen as a completely valid expression of the human soul. Science surely cannot be limited by boundaries that prevent unbiased investigation.
The opinion that there are bounds to human knowledge which it is impossible to pass, compelling man to stop short of the invisible world, is thus met by the occult scientist: he says that there can exist no doubt concerning the impossibility of penetrating into the unseen world by means of the kind of cognition here meant. One who considers it the only kind can come to no other opinion than that man is not permitted to penetrate into a possibly existing higher world. But the occult scientist goes on to say that it is possible to develop a different sort of cognition, and that this leads into the unseen world. If this kind of cognition is held to be impossible, we arrive at a point of view from which any mention of an invisible world appears as sheer nonsense. But to an unbiased judgment there can be no basis for such an opinion as this, except that its adherent is a stranger to that other kind of cognition. But how can a person form an opinion about a subject of which he declares himself ignorant? Occult science [pg 007] must in this case maintain the principle that people should speak only of what they know, and should not make assertions about anything of which they are ignorant. It can only recognize every man's right to communicate his own experiences, not every man's right to declare the impossibility of what he does not, or will not, know. The occult scientist disputes no one's right to ignore the invisible world; but there can be no real reason why a person should declare himself an authority, not only on what he may know, but also on things considered unknowable.
The belief that there are limits to human knowledge that make it impossible to access the invisible world is challenged by the occult scientist. He argues that there’s no doubt about the impossibility of exploring the unseen world through the type of understanding that has been mentioned. Someone who believes this is the only type of understanding available might conclude that humans aren’t allowed to access a potentially existing higher realm. However, the occult scientist claims that it is possible to cultivate a different kind of understanding, which can lead to the unseen world. If this alternative understanding is deemed impossible, then any reference to an invisible world seems completely absurd. Yet, a fair judgment cannot support such a viewpoint unless the person has never encountered that alternative form of understanding. How can someone form an opinion about something they admit they know nothing about? Occult science must uphold the principle that individuals should only speak about what they truly know and should refrain from making claims about anything they are uninformed about. It can only recognize each person's right to share their own experiences, not their right to claim the impossibility of what they don't know or refuse to learn. The occult scientist doesn’t challenge anyone’s right to ignore the invisible world; however, there’s no genuine justification for someone to declare themselves an authority not just on what they know, but also on matters considered unknowable.
To those who say that it is presumption to penetrate into unseen regions, the occult scientist would merely point out that this can be done, and that it is sinning against the faculties with which man has been endowed if he allows them to waste instead of developing and using them.
To those who claim that it’s arrogant to explore the unknown, the occult scientist would simply say that this can be done, and that it’s a waste of the abilities humans have if they let them go unused instead of developing and applying them.
But he who thinks that views about the unseen world are necessarily wholly dependent on personal opinion and feeling is denying the common essence of all human beings. Even though it is true that every one must find light on these things within himself, it is also a fact that all those, who go far enough, arrive at the same, not at different conclusions regarding them. Differences exist only as long as people will not approach the highest truths by the well-tested path of occult science, but attempt ways of their own choosing. Genuine occult science will certainly fully admit that only one who has followed, or at any rate has begun to follow the path of occult [pg 008] science, is in a position to recognize it as the right one. But all those who follow that path will recognize its genuineness, and have always done so.
But anyone who believes that views about the unseen world are solely based on personal opinion and feelings is ignoring the shared essence of all humans. While it’s certainly true that everyone must seek understanding within themselves, it’s also a fact that those who delve deeply enough arrive at the same conclusions, not different ones. Differences only persist as long as people avoid approaching the highest truths through the well-established path of occult science and instead try methods of their own choosing. Genuine occult science will absolutely acknowledge that only someone who has followed, or at least started to follow, the path of occult science can recognize it as the correct one. However, everyone who takes that path will recognize its authenticity, and they always have.
The path to occult knowledge will be found, at the fitting moment, by every human being who discerns in what is visible the presence of something invisible, or who even but dimly surmises or divines it, and who, from his consciousness that powers of cognition are capable of development, is driven to the feeling that what is hidden may be unveiled to him. One who is drawn to occult science by such experiences of the soul will find opening up before him, not only the prospect of finding the answers to certain questions which press upon him, but the further prospect of overcoming everything which hampers and enfeebles his life. And in a certain higher sense it implies a weakening of life, in fact a death of the soul, when a person is compelled to turn away from, or to deny, the unseen. Indeed, under certain circumstances despair is the result of a man's losing all hope of having the invisible revealed to him. This death and despair, in their manifold forms, are at the same time inner spiritual foes of occult science. They make their appearance when a person's inner force is dwindling away. In that case, if he is to possess any vital force it must be supplied to him from without. He perceives the things, beings, and events which approach his organs of sense, and analyzes them with his intellect. They afford him pleasure and pain, and impel him to the actions of which he is capable. For a while he may go on in this way: [pg 009] but at length he must reach a point at which he inwardly dies. For that which may thus be extracted for man from the outer world, becomes exhausted. This is not a statement arising from the personal experience of one individual, but something resulting from an impartial survey of the whole of human life. That which secures life from exhaustion lies in the unseen world, deep at the roots of things. If a person loses the power of descending into those depths so that he cannot be perpetually drawing fresh vitality from them, then in the end the outer world of things also ceases to yield him anything of a vivifying nature.
The journey to discovering hidden knowledge will be found, at the right moment, by anyone who recognizes something invisible in what is visible, or even just vaguely senses it, and who feels driven by the awareness that cognitive abilities can grow. This person will feel that what is hidden can be revealed to them. Those drawn to occult science by such inner experiences will find not just a chance to answer pressing questions, but also a way to overcome everything that weakens and hinders their life. In a deeper sense, it implies a decline in life, even a death of the soul, when someone has to turn away from or deny the unseen. Indeed, sometimes despair follows when a person loses all hope of having the invisible shown to them. This death and despair, in their various forms, are internal spiritual enemies of occult science. They appear when someone's inner strength is fading. In that case, if they are to maintain any life force, it must come from outside themselves. They see the things, beings, and events that reach their senses and analyze them with their intellect. They bring pleasure and pain and drive them to action. For a time, they can continue this way: [pg 009] but eventually, they will reach a point where they spiritually die inside. What they can extract from the outside world will eventually run dry. This isn't just a personal observation, but a conclusion I’ve drawn from an unbiased look at all human life. What protects life from running out lies in the unseen world, deep in the roots of existence. If someone loses the ability to dive into those depths and can't keep drawing fresh energy from them, ultimately, the outside world will stop giving them anything life-giving.
It is by no means the case that only the individual and his personal weal and woe are concerned. Through occult science man gains the conviction that from a higher standpoint the weal and woe of the individual are intimately bound up with the weal and woe of the whole world. This is a means by which man comes to see that he is inflicting an injury on the entire world and every being within it, if he does not develop his own powers in the right way. If a man makes his life desolate by losing touch with the unseen, he not only destroys in his inner self something, the decay of which may eventually drive him to despair, but through his weakness he constitutes a hindrance to the evolution of the whole world in which he lives.
It’s not just about the individual and their personal struggles. Through mystical knowledge, a person realizes that their own well-being is closely connected to the well-being of the entire world. This understanding helps them see that by failing to develop their own potential, they are harming not only themselves but also everyone and everything around them. If someone neglects their connection to the invisible forces, they not only harm their own inner self, which can lead to feelings of despair, but they also become an obstacle to the progress of the world they inhabit.
Now man may delude himself. He may yield to the belief that there is nothing invisible, and that that which is manifest to his senses and intellect [pg 010] contains everything which can possibly exist. But such an illusion is only possible on the surface of consciousness and not in its depths. Feeling and desire do not yield to this delusive belief. They will be perpetually craving, in one way or another, for that which is invisible. And if this is withheld, they drive man to doubt, to uncertainty about life, or even to despair. Occult science, by making manifest what is unseen, is calculated to overcome all hopelessness, uncertainty, and despair,—everything, in short, which weakens life and makes it unfit for its necessary service in the universe.
Now a person can trick themselves. They might convince themselves that nothing is invisible and that everything that’s obvious to their senses and intellect [pg 010] contains all that could possibly exist. But this kind of illusion only happens on the surface of consciousness and not in its depths. Feelings and desires don’t give in to this deceptive belief. They will always be longing, in one way or another, for what is unseen. And if this is denied, it leads a person to doubt, to uncertainty about life, or even to despair. Occult science, by revealing what is hidden, aims to eliminate all hopelessness, uncertainty, and despair—everything, in short, that weakens life and makes it unsuitable for its essential role in the universe.
The beneficent effect of occult science is that it not only satisfies thirst for knowledge but gives strength and stability to life. The source whence the occult scientist draws his power for work and his confidence in life is inexhaustible. Any one who has once had recourse to that fount will always, on revisiting it, go forth with renewed vigour.
The positive impact of occult science is that it not only quenches our thirst for knowledge but also brings strength and stability to life. The source from which the occult scientist draws their power for work and confidence in life is limitless. Anyone who has ever turned to that wellspring will always leave it feeling revitalized.
There are people who will not hear anything about occult science, because they think they discern something unhealthy in what has just been said. These people are quite right as regards the surface and outer aspect of life. They do not desire that to be stunted, which life, in its so-called reality, offers. They see weakness in man's turning away from reality and seeking his welfare in an unseen world which to them is synonymous with what is chimerical and visionary. If as occult scientists we do not desire to fall into morbid dreaming and weakness, we must admit that such objections are partially justified. For [pg 011] they are founded upon sound judgment, which leads to a half truth instead of a whole truth merely because it does not penetrate to the roots of things, but remains on the surface. If occult science were calculated to weaken life and estrange man from true reality, such objections would certainly be strong enough to cut the ground from under the feet of those who follow this spiritual line of life. But even in regard to such opinions as these, occult science would not be taking the right course in defending itself in the ordinary sense of the word. Even in this case it can only speak by means of what it gives to those who really penetrate into its meaning, that is, by the real force and vitality which it bestows. It does not weaken life, but strengthens it, because it equips man not only with the forces of the manifest world but with those of the invisible world of which the manifest is the effect. Thus it does not imply an impoverishment, but an enrichment, of life. The true occult scientist does not stand aloof from the world, but is a lover of reality, because he does not desire to enjoy the unseen in a remote dream-world, but finds his happiness in bringing to the world ever fresh supplies of force from the invisible sources from whence this very world is derived, and from which it must be continually fructified.
There are people who won’t listen to anything about occult science because they sense something unhealthy in what’s being discussed. These individuals are correct regarding the surface and outward aspects of life. They don’t want to diminish what life, in its so-called reality, offers. They see a weakness in mankind’s turn away from reality to seek fulfillment in an unseen world, which to them seems fantastical and unrealistic. If we, as occult scientists, don’t want to fall into morbid dreaming and weakness, we must acknowledge that such objections have some validity. They are based on sound reasoning, which leads to a half-truth instead of a whole truth simply because it doesn't dig deep into the roots of reality and stays on the surface. If occult science were meant to weaken life and distance humans from true reality, those objections would certainly be strong enough to undermine the foundation of those who pursue this spiritual path. However, when it comes to such views, occult science would not be right in defending itself in the usual way. In this case, it can only communicate through what it offers to those who genuinely grasp its meaning, which is the real power and vitality it provides. It doesn’t weaken life; it strengthens it by equipping individuals with the forces of both the visible world and the invisible one, of which the visible is just an effect. Therefore, it doesn’t lead to a decrease, but rather an enhancement of life. The true occult scientist doesn’t distance themselves from the world; they are an advocate for reality. They don’t seek enjoyment in a distant dream world but find happiness in bringing fresh sources of energy from the invisible realms, from which this world originates and must continually be nourished.
Some people find many obstacles when they enter upon the path of occult science. One of these is expressed in the fact, that a person, attempting to take the first steps, is sometimes discouraged because [pg 012] at the outset he is introduced to the details of the supersensible world, in order that he may, with entire patience and devotion, become acquainted with them. A series of communications is made to him concerning the invisible nature of man, about certain definite occurrences in the kingdom of which death opens the portals, and regarding the evolutions of man, the earth, and the entire solar system. What he expected was to enter the supersensible world easily, at a bound. Now he is heard to say: “Everything which I am told to study is food for my mind, but leaves my soul cold. I am seeking the deepening of my soul-life. I want to find myself within. I am seeking something that will lift my soul into the sphere of the divine, leading it to its true home; I do not want information about the human being and world-processes.” People who talk in this way have no idea that by such feelings they are barring the door to what they are really seeking. For it is just when, and only when, with a free and open mind, in self-surrender and patience, they assimilate what they call “merely” food for the intellect, that they will find that for which their souls are athirst. That road leads the soul to union with the divine, which brings to the soul knowledge of the works of the divine. The uplifting of the heart is the result of learning to know about the creations of the spirit.
Some people face many obstacles when they start on the path of occult science. One of these obstacles is that a person trying to take the first steps often feels discouraged because, right from the beginning, they are faced with the details of the supersensible world so that they can, with complete patience and dedication, get to know them. A series of messages is shared with them about the invisible nature of humanity, certain specific events in the realm that death opens, and about the evolution of humans, the earth, and the entire solar system. What they expected was to easily jump into the supersensible world. Now they might say: "Everything I’m asked to learn is like food for my brain, but it doesn’t nourish my soul. I’m seeking a deeper spiritual life. I want to find my true self inside. I’m looking for something that will lift my soul to a higher level, guiding it to its true home; I don’t just want facts about people and how the world works." People who say this have no idea that their feelings are blocking the door to what they truly seek. Because it's only when they approach what they consider "just" intellectual food with an open mind, in self-surrender and patience, that they will find what their souls are craving. That path leads the soul to unite with the divine, which grants it knowledge of divine works. The uplifting of the heart comes from learning about the creations of the spirit.
On this account occult science must begin by imparting the information which throws light on the realms of the spiritual world. So too, in this book, we shall begin with what can be unveiled concerning [pg 013] unseen worlds through the methods of occult research. That which is mortal in man, and that which is immortal, will be described in their connection with the world, of which he is a member.
For this reason, occult science must start by providing insights that clarify the spiritual world. Similarly, in this book, we will begin with what can be revealed about the unseen worlds through methods of occult research. We will describe what is mortal in humans and what is immortal, highlighting their connection to the world of which they are a part.
Then will follow a description of the methods by which man is able to develop those powers of cognition latent within him, which will lead him into that world. As much will be said about the methods as is at present possible in a work of this kind. It seems natural to think that these methods should be dealt with first. For it seems as though the main point would be to acquaint man with what may bring him, by means of his own powers, to the desired view of the higher world. Many may say, “Of what use is it for me that others tell me what they know about higher worlds? I wish to see them for myself.”
Then there will be a description of the methods through which people can develop the cognitive abilities they have inside them, leading them into that world. As much as possible will be shared about these methods in this type of work. It makes sense to address these methods first. The main goal seems to be to help people understand how they can use their own abilities to gain insight into the higher world. Many might say, “What good does it do me if others share their knowledge about higher worlds? I want to experience them myself.”
The fact of the matter is that for really fruitful experience of the mysteries of the unseen world, previous knowledge of certain facts belonging to that world is absolutely necessary. Why this is so, will be sufficiently brought out from what follows.
The truth is that to truly experience the mysteries of the unseen world, prior knowledge of certain facts about that world is essential. The reasons for this will become clear in what comes next.
It is a mistake to think that the truths of occult science which are imparted by those qualified to communicate them, before mention is made of the means of penetrating into the spiritual world itself, can be understood and grasped only by means of the higher vision which results from developing certain powers latent in man. This is not the case. For investigating and discovering the mysteries of a supersensible world, that higher sight is essential. No one is able to discover the facts of the unseen world [pg 014] without the clairvoyance which is synonymous with that higher vision. When however, the facts have been discovered and imparted, every one who applies to them the full range of his ordinary intellect and unprejudiced powers of judgment, will be able to understand them and to rise to a high degree of conviction concerning them. One who maintains that the mysteries are incomprehensible to him, does not do so because he is not yet clairvoyant, but because he has not yet succeeded in bringing into activity those powers of cognition which may be possessed by every one, even without clairvoyance.
It's a mistake to think that the truths of occult science shared by qualified individuals can only be understood through higher vision that comes from developing certain latent powers in people. That's not true. To investigate and uncover the mysteries of a spiritual world, that higher sight is essential. No one can discover facts about the unseen world without the clairvoyance linked to that higher vision. However, once the facts have been discovered and shared, anyone who applies their full intellect and unbiased judgment will be able to understand them and reach a strong conviction about them. If someone claims that the mysteries are incomprehensible to them, it's not because they aren't clairvoyant yet, but rather because they haven't activated the cognitive abilities that everyone can have, even without clairvoyance.
A new method of putting forward these matters consists in so describing them, after they have been clairvoyantly investigated, that they are quite accessible to the faculty of judgment. If only people do not shut themselves off by prejudice, there is no obstacle to arriving at a conviction, even without higher vision. It is true that many will find that the new method of presentment, as given in this book, is far from corresponding to their customary ways of forming an opinion. But any objection due to this will soon disappear if one takes the trouble to follow out these customary methods to their final consequences.
A new way of presenting these issues involves describing them in a way that makes them easy for people to understand after being thoroughly examined. As long as individuals don’t let their biases get in the way, it’s possible to reach a conclusion without needing an elevated perspective. It’s true that many will find the way these topics are presented in this book quite different from their usual methods of forming opinions. However, any resistance they have to this approach will fade once they take the time to explore the usual methods to their logical conclusions.
When, by an extended application of ordinary thought, a certain number of the higher mysteries have been assimilated and found intelligible by any one, then the right moment has come for the methods of occult research to be applied to his individual [pg 015] personality:—these will give him access to the unseen world.
When someone has thoroughly understood a certain number of the deeper mysteries through regular thinking, the right time has come to apply the methods of occult research to their personal experience—this will allow them to access the unseen world.
Nor will any genuine scientist be able to find contradiction, in spirit and in truth, between his science, which is built upon the facts of the sense-world, and the way in which occult science carries on its researches. The scientist uses certain instruments and methods. He constructs his instruments by working upon what “nature” gives him. Occult science also uses an instrument, but in this case the instrument is man himself. And that instrument too must first be prepared for that higher research. The faculties and powers given to man by nature at the outset without his co-operation, must be transformed into higher ones. In this way man is able to make himself into an instrument for the investigation of the unseen world.
Nor will any genuine scientist be able to find a contradiction, in spirit and in truth, between his science, which is based on the observable world, and the approach that occult science takes in its research. The scientist uses specific tools and methods. He creates his instruments by working with what "nature" provides. Occult science also uses a tool, but in this case, the tool is the individual themselves. And that tool must also be prepared for higher research. The abilities and powers given to a person by nature initially, without their involvement, must be transformed into advanced ones. In this way, a person can become a tool for exploring the unseen world.
Chapter II. The Nature of Man
With the consideration of man in the light of occult science, what this signifies in general, immediately becomes evident. It rests upon the recognition of something hidden behind that which is revealed to the outer senses and to the intellect acquired through perception. These senses and this intellect can apprehend only a part of all that which occult science unveils as the total human entity, and this part is the physical body. In order to throw light upon its conception of this physical body, occult science at first directs attention to a phenomenon which confronts all observers of life like a great riddle,—the phenomenon of death,—and in connection with it, points to so-called inanimate nature, the mineral kingdom. We are thus referred to facts, which it devolves on occult science to explain, and to which an important part of this work must be devoted. But to begin with, only a few points will be touched upon, by way of orientation.
When we look at humanity through the lens of occult science, its meaning becomes clear. It relies on recognizing something hidden behind what our outer senses and learned intellect can perceive. These senses and intellect can only grasp a portion of what occult science reveals about the complete human being, which is the body. To clarify its understanding of the physical body, occult science first focuses on a phenomenon that presents itself to everyone observing life as a significant mystery—the phenomenon of death—and in relation to this, it highlights inanimate nature, specifically the mineral kingdom. This leads us to facts that occult science needs to explain, and a significant part of this work will be dedicated to these discussions. However, to start, only a few key points will be briefly addressed for orientation.
Within manifested nature the physical body, according to occult science, is that part of man which is of the same nature as the mineral kingdom. On the other hand, that which distinguishes man from minerals is considered as not being part of the physical [pg 017] body. From the occult point of view, what is of supreme importance is the fact that death separates the human being from that which, during life, is of like nature with the mineral world. Occult science points to the dead body as that part of man which is to be found existing in the same way in the mineral kingdom. It lays strong emphasis upon the fact that in this principle of the human being, which it looks upon as the physical body, and which death reduces to a corpse, the same materials and forces are at work as in the mineral realm; but no less emphasis is laid upon the fact that at death disintegration of the physical body sets in. Occult science therefore says: “It is true that the same materials and forces are at work in the physical body as in the mineral, but during life their activity is placed at the disposal of something higher. They are left to themselves only when death occurs. Then they act, as they must in conformity with their own nature, as decomposers of the physical body.”
Within the natural world, the physical body, according to occult science, is the part of a person that is similar to the mineral kingdom. In contrast, what sets humans apart from minerals is seen as not being part of the physical body. From an occult perspective, what is most important is the fact that death separates a person from what, during their life, is made of the same essence as the mineral world. Occult science identifies the dead body as that part of a person that exists in the same way in the mineral kingdom. It underscores that in this aspect of the human being, which it refers to as the physical body, and which death turns into a corpse, the same materials and forces are present as in the mineral realm; but it also emphasizes that with death, the physical body starts to break down. Therefore, occult science states: “It's true that the same materials and forces are present in the physical body as in minerals, but during life, their activity is directed toward something greater. They are only allowed to operate on their own when death happens. At that point, they function, as they naturally do, as decomposers of the physical body.”
Thus a sharp distinction must be drawn between the manifested and the hidden elements in man. For during life, that which is hidden from view has to wage perpetual war on the materials and forces of the mineral world. This indicates the point at which occult science steps in. It has to characterize that which wages the war alluded to, as a principle which is hidden from sense-observation. Clairvoyant sight alone can reveal its workings. How man arrives at awareness of this hidden element, as plainly [pg 018] as his ordinary eyes see the phenomena of sense, will be described in a later part of this book. Results of clairvoyant observation will be given now for the reason already pointed out in the preceding pages, that is, that communications about the way in which the higher sight is obtained can only be of value to the student when he has first become acquainted, in the form of a narrative, with the results of clairvoyant research. For in this sphere it is quite possible to understand things which one is not yet able to observe. Indeed, the right path to higher vision starts with understanding.
A clear distinction must be made between the visible and the hidden aspects of a person. During life, the hidden elements must constantly struggle against the forces and materials of the physical world. This is where occult science comes into play. It aims to define what is engaged in this struggle as a principle that can't be perceived through the senses. Only clairvoyant vision can unveil its workings. How a person comes to recognize this hidden element, just as clearly as their ordinary eyes see sensory phenomena, will be explained later in this book. The findings from clairvoyant observation will be shared now because, as mentioned in earlier pages, information about how to achieve higher sight is only valuable to a student after they've become familiar, through storytelling, with the results of clairvoyant exploration. In this field, it's entirely possible to grasp concepts that one isn't yet able to perceive. In fact, the right path to higher vision begins with understanding.
Now, although the hidden something which wages war on the disintegration of the physical body can be observed only by the higher sight, it is plainly visible in its effects to the human faculty of judgment which is limited to the manifested world; and these effects are expressed in the form or shape in which mineral materials and forces are combined during life. When death has intervened, the form disappears little by little, and the physical body becomes part of the rest of the mineral world. But the clairvoyant is able to observe this hidden something as an independent member of the human organism, which during life prevents the physical materials and forces from taking their natural course, which would lead to the dissolution of the physical body. This independent principle is called the etheric or vital body.
Now, even though the hidden force that battles the breakdown of the physical body can only be seen by those with a heightened perception, its effects are clearly observable by our ordinary judgment, which is limited to the physical world. These effects are reflected in how mineral materials and forces combine during life. After death, the form gradually disappears, and the physical body becomes part of the surrounding mineral world. However, a clairvoyant can see this hidden force as a separate part of the human organism that, during life, keeps the physical materials and forces from following their natural path, which would lead to the body's decay. This independent principle is known as the etheric or vital body.
If misunderstandings are not to arise at the outset, two things must be borne in mind in connection with this account of a second principle of human [pg 019] nature. The word “etheric” is used here in a different sense from that of modern physics, which designates as “ether” the medium by which light is transmitted. In occult science the use of the word is limited to the sense given above. It denotes that which is accessible to higher sight, and can be known to physical observation only by its effects, that is, by its power of giving a definite form or shape to the mineral materials and forces present in the physical body. Again, the use of the word “body” must not be misunderstood. It is necessary to use the words of every day language in describing things on a higher plane of existence, and these terms, when applied to sense-observation, express only what is physical. The etheric body has, of course, nothing of a bodily nature in the physical sense, however ethereal we might imagine such a body to be. As soon as the occultist mentions this etheric or vital body, he reaches the point at which he is bound to encounter the opposition of many contemporary opinions. The development of the human mind has been such that the mention of such a principle of human nature is necessarily looked upon as unscientific. The materialistic way of thinking has arrived at the conclusion that there is nothing to be seen in a living body but a combination of physical substances and forces such as are also found in the so-called inanimate body of the mineral, the only difference being that they are more complicated in the living than in the lifeless body. Yet it is not [pg 020] very long since other views were held, even by official science.
If we want to avoid misunderstandings from the start, we need to keep two things in mind concerning this explanation of a second principle of human nature. The term “etheric” is used here differently than in modern physics, where “ether” refers to the medium that transmits light. In occult science, this term is restricted to the meaning mentioned above. It refers to what can be perceived through higher awareness and can only be observed physically through its effects, meaning its ability to shape the mineral materials and forces present in the physical body. Additionally, the term “body” should not be misinterpreted. It’s essential to use everyday language when describing things on a higher level of existence, and these terms, when related to physical observation, only indicate what is tangible. The etheric body, of course, doesn’t have a physical nature in the traditional sense, no matter how ethereal we might envision it. When an occultist brings up this etheric or vital body, they reach a point where they will likely face opposition from many contemporary perspectives. The evolution of the human mind has led to the idea that mentioning such a principle of human nature is considered unscientific. Materialistic thinking has concluded that all we see in a living body is just a combination of physical substances and forces, similar to those found in so-called lifeless matter, with the only difference being that they are more complex in the living than in the inanimate body. However, it wasn’t that long ago that different views were accepted, even by mainstream science.
It is evident to any one who studies the works of many earnest men of science, produced during the first half of the nineteenth century, that at that time many a genuine investigator of nature was conscious of some factor acting within the living body other than in the lifeless mineral. It was termed “vital force.” It is true this vital force is not represented as being what has been above characterized as the vital body, but underlying the conception was a dim idea of the existence of such a body. Vital force was generally regarded as something which in a living body was united with physical matter and forces in the same way that the force of a magnet unites itself with iron. Then came the time when vital force was banished from the domain of science. Mere physical and chemical causes were accounted all sufficient.
It’s clear to anyone who studies the works of many dedicated scientists from the first half of the nineteenth century that many true investigators of nature at that time were aware of some factor at work within living beings that wasn’t present in inanimate minerals. This factor was called "life force." While this vital force isn’t described as the vital body mentioned earlier, there was a vague understanding that such a body might exist. Vital force was generally seen as something that was integrated with physical matter and forces in the same way that a magnet connects with iron. Eventually, the concept of vital force was pushed out of scientific thought. Only physical and chemical causes were considered adequate.
At the present moment, however, there is a reaction in this respect in some scientific quarters. It is sometimes conceded that the hypothesis of something of the nature of “vital force” is not pure nonsense. Yet even the scientist who concedes this much is not willing to make common cause with the occultist with regard to the vital body. As a rule, it serves no useful purpose to enter upon a discussion of such views from the standpoint of occult science. It should be much more the concern of the occultist to recognize that the materialistic way of thinking is a necessary concomitant phenomenon [pg 021] of the great advance of natural science in our day. This advance is due to the vast improvements in the instruments used in sense-observation. And it is in the very nature of man to bring some of his faculties to a certain degree of perfection at the expense of others. Exact sense-observation, which has been evolved to such an important extent by natural science, was bound to leave in the background the cultivation of those human faculties which lead into the hidden worlds. But the time has come when this cultivation is once more necessary; and recognition of the invisible will not be won by combating opinions which are the logical outcome of a denial of its existence, but rather by setting the invisible in the right light. Then it will be recognized by those for whom the “time has come.”
At this moment, however, there’s a shift happening in some scientific circles. It's sometimes acknowledged that the idea of something like "life force" isn’t just absolute nonsense. Yet even scientists who accept this much are still not willing to align themselves with occultists regarding the concept of the vital body. Generally, discussing these views from the perspective of occult science isn’t particularly useful. It’s more important for the occultist to understand that materialistic thinking is a natural side effect of the significant progress in natural science today. This progress is a result of the major advancements in the tools used for sensory observation. And it’s human nature to develop some abilities at the expense of others. The precise sensory observation that has advanced so much in natural science inevitably pushed the development of those human faculties that connect to the hidden realms into the background. But the time has come when this development is needed again; recognition of the invisible won’t be achieved by fighting against opinions that logically arise from denying its existence, but rather by presenting the invisible in a clearer way. Then it will be recognized by those for whom the “the time has come.”
It was necessary to say this much, in order that it may not be imagined that occult science is ignorant of the standpoint of natural science when mention is made of an “etheric body,” which, in many circles must necessarily be considered as purely imaginary.
It was important to say this much to prevent the assumption that occult science is unaware of the perspective of natural science when referring to an “energetic body,” which, in many circles, must be viewed as merely imaginary.
Thus the etheric body is the second principle of the human being. For the clairvoyant, it possesses a higher degree of reality than the physical body. A description of how it is seen by the clairvoyant can be given only in later parts of this book, when the sense in which such descriptions are to be taken will become manifest. For the present it will be enough to say that the etheric body penetrates the [pg 022] physical body in all its parts, and is to be regarded as a kind of architect of the latter. All the physical organs are maintained in their form and shape by the currents and movements of the etheric body. The physical heart is based upon an etheric heart, the physical brain, upon an etheric brain, and the physical, with this difference, that in the etheric body the parts flow into one another in active motion, whereas in the physical body they are separated from each other.
The etheric body is the second aspect of a human being. To a clairvoyant, it has a greater degree of reality than the physical body. A description of how it appears to a clairvoyant will be provided later in this book, when the meaning of such descriptions will become clear. For now, it's enough to say that the etheric body permeates every part of the physical body and should be seen as a sort of architect for it. All physical organs retain their form and shape through the currents and movements of the etheric body. The physical heart is based on an etheric heart, the physical brain on an etheric brain, with the difference being that in the etheric body, the parts flow into one another in active motion, while in the physical body, they are separate from one another.
Man has this etheric body in common with all plants, just as he has the physical body in common with minerals. Everything living has its etheric body.
Man shares this etheric body with all plants, just as he shares the physical body with minerals. Everything that is alive has its etheric body.
The study of occult science proceeds upwards from the etheric body to another principle of the human being. To aid in the formation of an idea of this principle, it draws attention to the phenomenon of sleep, just as in connection with the etheric body attention was drawn to death. All human work, so far as the manifested world is concerned, is dependent upon activity during waking life. But that activity is possible only as long as man is able to recuperate his exhausted forces by sleep. Action and thought disappear, pain and pleasure fade away during sleep, and on re-awaking, man's conscious powers ascend from the unconsciousness of sleep as though from hidden mysterious sources of energy. It is the same consciousness which sinks down into [pg 023] dim depths on falling asleep and ascends from them again on re-awaking.
The study of occult science moves from the etheric body to another principle of the human being. To help clarify this principle, it highlights the phenomenon of sleep, similar to how the etheric body was linked to death. All human work, in terms of the visible world, relies on activity during waking life. However, that activity is only possible as long as a person can restore their depleted energy through sleep. During sleep, action and thought vanish, and pain and pleasure fade away; upon waking, a person’s conscious abilities rise from the unconsciousness of sleep as if drawn from hidden, mysterious energy sources. It is the same consciousness that sinks into deep darkness upon falling asleep and rises from it again upon waking.
That which awakens life again out of this state of unconsciousness is, according to occult science, the third principle of the human being. It is called the astral body. Just as the physical body cannot keep its form by means of the mineral substances and forces it contains, but must, in order to be kept together, be interpenetrated by the etheric body, so is it impossible for the forces of the etheric body to illuminate themselves with the light of consciousness. An etheric body left to its own resources would be in a permanent state of sleep.1 An etheric body awake, is illuminated by an astral body. This astral body seems to sense-observation to disappear when man falls asleep; to clairvoyant observation it is still present, with the difference that it appears separated from or drawn out of the etheric body. Sense-observation has nothing to do with the astral body itself, but only with its effects in the manifested world, and these cease during sleep. In the same sense in which man possesses his physical body in common with plants, he resembles animals as regards his astral body.
What brings life back from this state of unconsciousness is, according to occult science, the third principle of a human being. It’s called the astral body. Just as the physical body can’t maintain its structure solely through the mineral substances and forces it contains, but needs to be supported by the etheric body to hold itself together, the forces of the etheric body can’t shine with consciousness. An etheric body left on its own would be in a constant state of sleep. An awake etheric body is illuminated by an astral body. The astral body seems to disappear to normal observation when a person falls asleep; however, to clairvoyant observation, it is still visible, but it appears to be separated or drawn out from the etheric body. Regular observation has nothing to do with the astral body itself, only with its effects in the material world, and these effects stop during sleep. In the same way that humans share their physical body with plants, they share their astral body with animals.
Plants are in a permanent state of sleep. One who does not judge accurately in these matters may easily make the mistake of attributing to plants the same kind of consciousness as that of animals and human beings in the waking state; but this assumption [pg 024] can only be due to an inaccurate conception of consciousness. In that case it is said that, if an external stimulus is applied to a plant, it responds by certain movements, as would an animal. The sensitiveness of some plants is spoken of,—for example, of those which contract their leaves when certain external things act upon them. But the characteristic mark of consciousness is not that a being reacts in a certain way to an impression, but that it experiences something in its inner nature which adds a new element to mere reaction. Otherwise we should be able to speak of the consciousness of a piece of iron when it expands under the influence of heat. Consciousness is present only when, through the effect of heat, the being feels pain or pleasure inwardly.
Plants are always in a state of rest. If someone doesn’t understand this well, they might mistakenly think that plants have the same kind of awareness as animals and humans when they are awake. But this belief shows a misunderstanding of what consciousness really is. It’s said that when a plant is exposed to a stimulus, it moves in response, just like an animal would. Some plants are noted for their sensitivity, like those that fold their leaves when certain things happen to them. However, the true sign of consciousness isn’t just reacting to stimuli; it’s about experiencing something internally that adds depth to simple reactions. Otherwise, we could claim that a piece of iron has consciousness when it expands because of heat. Consciousness is present only when a being feels pain or pleasure internally due to the heat.
The fourth principle of being which occult science attributes to man is one which he does not share in common with the rest of the manifested world. It is that which differentiates him from his fellow creatures and makes him the crown of creation. Occult science helps in forming a conception of this further principle of human nature by pointing out the existence of an essential difference between the kinds of experience in waking life. On the one hand, man is constantly subjected to experiences which must of necessity come and go; on the other, he has experiences with which this is not the case. This fact comes out with special force if human experiences are compared with those of animals. An animal experiences the influences of the outer world [pg 025] with great regularity; under the influence of heat and cold it becomes conscious of pain or pleasure, and during certain regularly recurring bodily processes it feels hunger and thirst. The sum total of man's life is not exhausted by such experiences; he is able to develop desires and wishes which go beyond these things. In the case of an animal it would always be possible, on going far enough into the matter, to ascertain the cause—either within or without its body—which impelled it to any given act or feeling. This is by no means the case with man. He may engender wishes and desires for which no adequate cause exists either inside or outside of his body. A particular source must be found for everything in this domain; and according to occult science this source is to be found in the human “I” or “ego.” Therefore the ego will be spoken of as the fourth principle of the human being.
The fourth principle of being that occult science assigns to humans is something they don't share with the rest of the manifested world. It's what sets them apart from other creatures and positions them as the pinnacle of creation. Occult science aids in understanding this additional principle of human nature by highlighting a fundamental difference between the types of experiences in waking life. On one hand, humans constantly go through experiences that inevitably come and go; on the other, they have experiences that don't fit that pattern. This becomes especially clear when comparing human experiences to those of animals. An animal reacts to the influences of the outside world with considerable consistency; it becomes aware of pain or pleasure from heat and cold, and it experiences hunger and thirst during specific, recurring bodily processes. However, the totality of human life is not limited to such experiences; humans can develop desires and wishes that extend beyond these basic needs. In the case of an animal, it's always possible to trace back the cause—either within or outside its body—that drives it to a specific action or feeling. This is not the case for humans. They can create wishes and desires that have no sufficient cause inside or outside their bodies. A specific source must be identified for everything in this realm, and according to occult science, this source is found in the human "I" or “ego.” Thus, the ego is referred to as the fourth principle of the human being.
Were the astral body left to its own resources, feelings of pleasure and pain, and sensations of hunger and thirst, would take place within it, but there would be lacking the consciousness of something lasting in all these feelings. It is not the permanent as such, which is here designated the “ego,” but rather that which experiences this permanent element. In this domain, conceptions must be very exactly expressed if misunderstandings are not to arise. With the becoming aware of something permanent, lasting, within the changing inner experiences, begins the dawn of “ego consciousness.”
If the astral body were left on its own, feelings of pleasure and pain, as well as sensations of hunger and thirst, would occur within it, but there would be no awareness of something enduring in all these feelings. It’s not the permanent aspect itself that is referred to as the "ego," but rather what perceives this permanent element. In this area, ideas must be expressed very clearly to avoid misunderstandings. With the recognition of something lasting and permanent amid the changing inner experiences, the emergence of "self-awareness."
The sensation of hunger, for instance, cannot give [pg 026] a creature the feeling of having an ego. Hunger sets in when the recurring causes make themselves felt in the being concerned, which then devours its food just because these recurring conditions are present. For the ego-consciousness to arise, there must not only be these recurring conditions, urging the being to take food, but there must have been pleasure derived from previous satisfaction of hunger, and the consciousness of the pleasure must have remained, so that not only the present experience of hunger but the past experience of pleasure urges the being to take nourishment.
The feeling of hunger, for example, doesn't give an animal a sense of self. Hunger happens when the causes keep showing up for the creature, which then eats just because these constant conditions are there. For self-awareness to develop, it’s not enough to just have these recurring needs pushing the being to eat; there also needs to be pleasure from having satisfied hunger before, and the being must remember that pleasure so that both the current feeling of hunger and the memory of past pleasure motivate it to eat.
Just as the physical body falls into decay if the etheric body does not keep it together, and as the etheric body sinks into unconsciousness if not illuminated by the astral body, so the astral body would necessarily allow the past to be lost in oblivion unless the ego rescued the past by carrying it over into the present. What death is to the physical body and sleep to the etheric, the power of forgetting is to the astral body. We may put this in another way, and say that life is the special characteristic of the etheric body, consciousness that of the astral body, and memory that of the ego.
Just like the physical body deteriorates if the etheric body doesn't hold it together, and the etheric body falls into unconsciousness without being energized by the astral body, the astral body would inevitably let the past fade away unless the ego brings the past into the present. Just as death affects the physical body and sleep impacts the etheric body, the ability to forget affects the astral body. We can also say that life defines the etheric body, consciousness defines the astral body, and memory defines the ego.
It is still easier to make the mistake of attributing memory2 to an animal than that of attributing [pg 027] consciousness to a plant. It is so natural to think of memory when a dog recognizes its master, whom perhaps it has not seen for some time; yet in reality the recognition is not due to memory at all, but to something quite different. The dog feels a certain attraction toward its master which proceeds from the personality of the latter. This gives the dog a sense of pleasure whenever its master is present, and every time this happens it is a cause of the repetition of the pleasure. But memory only exists in a being when he not only feels his present experiences, but retains those of the past. A person might admit this, and yet fall into the error of thinking the dog has memory. For it might be said that the dog pines when its master leaves it, and therefore it retains a remembrance of him. This too is an inaccurate opinion. Living with its master has made his presence a condition of well-being to the dog, and it feels his absence much in the same way in which it feels hunger. One who does not make these distinctions will not arrive at a clear understanding of the true conditions of life.
It's still easier to mistakenly attribute memory to an animal than to attribute consciousness to a plant. It feels natural to think of memory when a dog recognizes its owner, whom it might not have seen in a while; however, the recognition isn't actually due to memory but something else entirely. The dog feels a certain attraction to its owner, which comes from the owner's personality. This creates a feeling of pleasure whenever the owner is around, and each time that happens, it leads to a repeat of that pleasure. But memory only exists in a being when it not only experiences the present but also retains experiences from the past. A person might acknowledge this and still mistakenly think that the dog has memory. Someone might argue that the dog pines for its owner when they leave, suggesting it remembers them. But that's also an inaccurate viewpoint. Living with its owner has made their presence essential to the dog's well-being, and it feels the absence like it feels hunger. Anyone who doesn't make these distinctions will struggle to truly understand the real conditions of life.
Memory and forgetfulness have for the ego much the same significance that waking and sleeping have for the astral body. Just as sleep banishes into nothingness the cares and troubles of the day, so does forgetfulness draw a veil over the sad experiences of life and efface part of the past. And just as sleep is necessary for the recuperation of the exhausted vital forces, so must a man blot out from his memory certain portions of his past life if he is to face his new experiences freely and without prejudice. It is out of this very forgetfulness that strength arises for the perception of new facts. Let us take the case of learning to write. All the details which a child has to go through in this process are forgotten. What remains is the ability to write. How would a person ever be able to write if each time he took up his pen all his experiences in learning to write rose up before his mind?
Memory and forgetfulness are to the ego what waking and sleeping are to the astral body. Just like sleep pushes aside the worries and troubles of the day, forgetfulness masks the sad experiences of life and erases parts of the past. And just as sleep is essential for recovering tired energy, a person must forget certain aspects of their past to face new experiences openly and without bias. This very forgetfulness provides the strength needed to perceive new facts. Consider learning to write: all the steps a child goes through during this process are eventually forgotten. What stays is the ability to write. How could anyone write if every time they picked up a pen, all their memories of learning to write flooded back into their mind?
Now there are many different degrees of memory. Its simplest form is manifest when a person perceives an object and, after turning away from it, retains [pg 029] its image in his mind. He formed the image while looking at the object, A process was then carried out between his astral body and his ego. The astral body lifted into consciousness the outward impression of the object, but knowledge of the object would last only as long as the thing itself was present, unless the ego absorbed the knowledge into itself and made it its own.
Now there are many different levels of memory. The simplest form happens when a person sees an object and, after looking away, keeps its image in their mind. They created the image while observing the object. A process took place between their astral body and their ego. The astral body brought the external impression of the object into awareness, but knowledge of the object would only last as long as the object was present, unless the ego took in the knowledge and made it a part of itself.
It is at this point that occult science draws the dividing line between what belongs to the body and what belongs to the soul. It speaks of the astral body as long as it is a question of the gaining of knowledge from an object which is present. But what gives knowledge duration is known as soul. From this it can at once be seen how close is the connection in man between the astral body and that part of the soul which gives a lasting quality to knowledge. The two are, to a certain extent, united into one principle of human nature. Consequently, this unity is often denoted the astral body. When exact terms are desired, the astral body is called the soul-body, and the soul, in so far as it is united with the latter, is called the sentient soul.
It is at this point that occult science draws the line between what belongs to the body and what belongs to the soul. It refers to the astral body when discussing knowledge gained from a present object. However, what gives knowledge its lasting quality is called the soul. From this, it's clear how closely connected the astral body is to that part of the soul that provides enduring knowledge. The two are, to some extent, combined into one principle of human nature. Therefore, this unity is often referred to as the astral body. When precise terms are needed, the astral body is called the mind-body, and the soul, as it is connected to the former, is called the aware spirit.
The ego rises to a higher stage of its being when it centres its activity on what it has gained for itself out of its knowledge of objective things. It is by means of this activity that the ego detaches itself more and more from the objects of perception, in order to work within that which is its own possession. The part of the soul on which this work [pg 030] devolves is called the rational- or intellectual-soul.3 It is the peculiarity of the sentient and intellectual souls that they work with that which they receive through sense-impressions of external objects of which they retain the memory. The soul is then wholly surrendered to something which is really outside it. Even what it has made its own through memory, it has actually received from without. But it is able to go beyond all this, and occult science can most easily give an idea of this by drawing attention to a simple fact, which, however, is of the greatest importance. It is, that in the whole range of speech there is but one name which is distinguished by its very nature from all other names. This is the name “I.” Every other name can be applied by any one to the thing or being to which it belongs. The word “I,” as the designation of a being, has a meaning only when given to that being by himself. Never can any outside voice call us by the name of “I.” We can apply it only to ourselves. I am only an “I” to myself; to every one else I am a “you,” and every one else is a “you” to me. This fact is the outward expression of a deeply significant truth. The real essence of the ego is independent of everything outside of it, and it is on this account that its [pg 031] name cannot be applied to it by any one else. This is the reason why those religions confessions which have consciously maintained their connections with occult science, speak the word “I” as the “unutterable name of God.” For the fact above mentioned is exactly what is referred to when this expression is used. Nothing outward has access to that part of the human soul of which we are now speaking. It is the “hidden sanctuary” of the soul. Only a being of like nature with the soul can win entrance there. “The divinity dwelling in man speaks when the soul recognizes itself as an ego.” Just as the sentient and intellectual souls live in the outer world, so a third soul-principle is immersed in the divine when the soul becomes conscious of its own nature.
The ego evolves to a higher level of existence when it focuses its efforts on what it has obtained for itself from its understanding of the external world. Through this effort, the ego separates itself more and more from the objects of perception in order to engage with what it considers its own. The aspect of the soul that engages in this activity is called the rational or intellectual soul. The unique characteristic of the sentient and intellectual souls is that they operate with what they receive through sensory experiences of external objects, which they then remember. The soul is thus completely absorbed by something that is truly outside of it. Even what it has internalized through memory has actually been received from the outside. However, it is capable of transcending all of this, and occult science can illustrate this easily by highlighting a simple yet profoundly important fact. In all of language, there is only one name that is inherently distinct from all other names. This name is "I." Any other name can be applied by anyone to the thing or being it refers to. The term "I," as a designation for a being, only holds meaning when that being refers to themselves. No outside voice can call us by the name "I." We can only use it to identify ourselves. I am merely an "I" to myself; to everyone else, I am a "you," and everyone else is a "you" to me. This reality expresses a deeply significant truth. The true essence of the ego is independent of everything external, which is why nobody else can use that name for it. This explains why religious traditions that have consciously maintained ties to occult science refer to the word "I" as the “unutterable name of God.” This embodies the point just mentioned. Nothing external can access that part of the human soul we are discussing. It is the "hidden sanctuary" of the soul. Only a being of like nature with the soul can enter there. “The divinity within man speaks when the soul recognizes itself as an ego.” Just as the sentient and intellectual souls exist within the outer world, so a third soul principle is immersed in the divine when the soul becomes aware of its own nature.
In this connection a misunderstanding may easily arise; it may seem as though occult science interpreted the ego to be one with God. But it by no means says that the ego is God, only that it is of the same nature and essence as God. Does any one declare the drop of water taken from the ocean to be the ocean, when he asserts that the drop and the ocean are the same in essence or substance? If a comparison is needed, we may say, “The ego is related to God as the drop of water is to the ocean.” Man is able to find a divine element within himself, because his original essence is derived directly from the Divine. Thus man, through the third principle of his soul, attains an inner knowledge of himself, just as through his astral body he gains knowledge of the outer world. For this reason occult science [pg 032] calls the third soul-principle the consciousness-soul, and it holds that the soul-part of man consists of three principles, the sentient-, intellectual-, and consciousness-souls, just as the bodily part has three principles, the physical, etheric, and astral bodies.
In this context, a misunderstanding can easily occur; it might seem like occult science claims that the ego is the same as God. However, it does not mean that the ego is God, only that it shares the same nature and essence as God. Does anyone claim that a drop of water taken from the ocean is the ocean when they say that the drop and the ocean are the same in essence or substance? If a comparison is needed, we may say, "The ego connects to God like a drop of water connects to the ocean." A person can find a divine element within themselves because their original essence comes directly from the Divine. Therefore, through the third principle of their soul, a person gains inner knowledge of themselves, just as through their astral body they acquire knowledge of the outer world. For this reason, occult science [pg 032] calls this third soul principle the soul-consciousness, and it asserts that the soul aspect of a person consists of three principles: the aware, smart, and mind-souls, just as the physical part has three principles: the physical, ethereal, and celestial bodies.
The real nature of the ego is first revealed in the consciousness-soul. Through feeling and reason the soul loses itself in other things; but as the consciousness-soul it lays hold of its own essence. Therefore this ego can only be perceived through the consciousness-soul by a certain inner activity. The images of external objects are formed as those objects come and go, and the images go on working in the intellect by virtue of their own force. But if the ego is to perceive itself, it cannot merely surrender itself; it must first, by inner activity, draw up its own being out of its depths, in order to become conscious of it. A new activity of the ego begins with this self cognition,—with self-recollection. Owing to this activity, the perception of the ego in the consciousness-soul possesses an entirely different meaning for man from that conveyed by the observation of all that reaches him through the three bodily principles and the two other soul-principles. The power which reveals the ego in the consciousness-soul is in fact the same power which manifests everywhere else in the world; only in the body and the lower soul-principles it does not come forth directly, but is manifested little by little in its effects. The lowest manifestation is through the physical body, thence a gradual ascent is made to that which [pg 033] fills the intellectual soul. Indeed, we may say that with each ascending step one of the veils falls away in which the hidden centre is wrapped. In that which fills the consciousness-soul, this hidden centre emerges unveiled into the temple of the soul. Yet it shows itself just here to be but a drop from the ocean of the all-pervading Primordial Essence; and it is here that man first has to grasp it,—this Primordial Essence. He must recognize it in himself before he is able to find it in its manifestations.
The true nature of the ego is first revealed in the consciousness-soul. Through feelings and reasoning, the soul gets lost in other things; but as the consciousness-soul, it connects with its own essence. Therefore, this ego can only be recognized through the consciousness-soul via a certain inner activity. The images of external objects are formed as those objects appear and disappear, and the images continue to influence the intellect by their own force. However, if the ego is to recognize itself, it cannot just give up itself; it must first, through inner activity, bring its own being from within to the surface in order to become aware of it. A new activity of the ego begins with this self-awareness—this self-recollection. Because of this activity, the perception of the ego in the consciousness-soul has an entirely different significance for a person compared to what is conveyed through observation of everything that comes at them through the three bodily principles and the two other soul principles. The power that reveals the ego in the consciousness-soul is actually the same power that appears everywhere else in the world; only in the body and the lower soul principles does it not emerge directly, but is instead revealed gradually through its effects. The lowest manifestation occurs through the physical body, from which a gradual ascent is made to that which [pg 033] fills the intellectual soul. In fact, we can say that with each ascending step, one of the veils covering the hidden center is lifted. In that which fills the consciousness-soul, this hidden center emerges unveiled into the temple of the soul. Yet, it reveals itself here as just a drop from the ocean of the all-encompassing Primordial Essence; and it is here that a person must first grasp it—this Primordial Essence. They must recognize it within themselves before they can find it in its manifestations.
That which penetrates into the consciousness-soul like a drop from the ocean is called by occult science Spirit. In this way is the consciousness-soul united with the spirit, which is the hidden principle in all manifested things. If man wishes to lay hold of the spirit in all manifestation, he must do it in the same way in which he lays hold of the ego in the consciousness-soul. He must extend to the visible world the activity which has led him to the perception of his ego. By this means he evolves to yet higher planes of his being. He adds something new to the principles of his body and soul. The first thing that happens is that he himself conquers what lies hidden in his lower soul-principles, and this is effected through the work which the ego carries on within the soul. How man is engaged in this work becomes evident if we compare a high-minded idealist with a person who is still given up to low desires and so-called sensual pleasures. The latter becomes transmuted into the former if he withdraws from certain lower tendencies and turns to [pg 034] higher ones. He thus works through his ego upon his soul thereby ennobling and spiritualizing it. The ego has become the master of that man's soul-life. This may be carried so far that no desire or wish can take root in the soul unless the ego permits its entrance. In this way the whole soul becomes a manifestation of the ego, which previously only the consciousness-soul had been. All civilized life and all spiritual effort really consist in the one work, which has for its object to make the ego the master. Every one now living is engaged in this work whether he wishes it or not, and whether or not he is conscious of the fact.
What enters the consciousness-soul like a drop from the ocean is referred to by occult science as Vibe. This is how the consciousness-soul connects with the spirit, which is the hidden principle in all manifested things. If a person wants to grasp the spirit in all manifestations, they must do so the same way they grasp their ego within the consciousness-soul. They need to project into the visible world the effort that has led them to recognize their ego. This process helps them evolve to higher levels of their existence. They contribute something new to the principles of their body and soul. The first outcome is that they conquer what is hidden in their lower soul principles, achieved through the work the ego performs within the soul. The involvement of a person in this work is clear when we compare a noble idealist with someone still caught up in base desires and so-called sensual pleasures. The latter transforms into the former by withdrawing from certain lower tendencies and embracing higher ones. This way, they work through their ego on their soul, thus ennobling and spiritualizing it. The ego becomes the master of that person's soul life. This can progress to the point where no desire or wish can take root in the soul unless the ego allows it. Consequently, the entire soul becomes a manifestation of the ego, which was previously the role of just the consciousness-soul. All civilized life and spiritual efforts essentially revolve around the single task of making the ego the master. Everyone alive today is engaged in this work whether they realize it or not.
Again, by this work human nature is drawn upward to higher stages of being. Man develops new principles of his being. These lie hidden from him behind what is manifest. If man is able by working upon his soul, to make his ego master of it, so that the latter brings into manifestation what is hidden, the work may extend yet farther and include the astral body. In that case the ego takes possession of the astral body by uniting itself with the hidden wisdom of this astral principle. In occult science the astral body which is thus conquered and transformed by the ego is called the Spirit-Self. (This is the same as what is known as “Manas” in theosophical literature, a term borrowed from the wisdom of the East.) In the Spirit-Self a higher principle is added to human nature, one which is present as though in the germ, and which in the [pg 035] course of the work of the human being on itself comes forth more and more.
Again, through this work, human nature is elevated to higher levels of existence. People develop new principles of their being. These principles are hidden from them behind what is visible. If a person is able to work on their soul, making their self the master of it, so that what is hidden comes to light, the work can extend even further to include the astral body. In this case, the self gains control of the astral body by connecting with the hidden wisdom of this astral principle. In occult science, the astral body that is conquered and transformed by the self is referred to as the Soul-Identity. (This is the same as what is known as “*Manas*” in theosophical literature, a term borrowed from Eastern wisdom.) The
Man conquers his astral body by pushing through to the hidden forces lying behind it; a similar thing happens, at a later stage of development, to the etheric body: but the work on the latter is more arduous, for what is hidden in the etheric body is enveloped in two veils, but what is hidden in the astral body in only one.4 Occult science gives an idea of the difference in the work on the two bodies by pointing out certain changes which may take place in man in the course of his development. Let us at first think of the way in which certain soul-qualities of man develop when the ego works upon the soul; how pleasures and desires, joys and sorrows, may change. We have only to look back to our childhood. What gave us pleasure then, what caused us pain? What have we learned in addition to what we knew as children? All this is but an expression of the way in which the ego has gained the mastery over the astral body, for it is [pg 036] this principle which is the vehicle of pleasure and pain, joy and sorrow. Compared with these things, how little in the course of time do certain other human qualities change, for example, the temperament, the deeper peculiarities of the character, and like qualities. A passionate child will often retain certain tendencies to sudden anger during its development in later life.
Man gains control over his astral body by pushing through to the hidden forces behind it; a similar process occurs later in the development of the etheric body. However, working on the etheric body is more challenging, as what’s concealed there is wrapped in two veils, while the astral body only has one. Occult science highlights the differences in the work on these two bodies by pointing out specific changes that can occur in a person as they develop. Let’s first consider how certain soul qualities develop when the ego interacts with the soul, affecting pleasures and desires, joys and sorrows. If we reflect on our childhood, what brought us joy then, and what caused us pain? What have we learned beyond what we knew as children? All of this shows how the ego has gained mastery over the astral body, as it is this principle that acts as the medium for pleasure and pain, joy and sorrow. In comparison, how little some other human qualities change over time, such as temperament, deeper character traits, and similar qualities. A passionate child often retains tendencies toward sudden anger as they grow older.
This is such a striking fact that there are thinkers who entirely deny the possibility of changing the fundamental character. They assume that it is something permanent throughout life, and that it is merely a question of its being manifested in one way or another. But such an opinion is due to defective observation. To one who is capable of seeing such things, it is evident that even the character and temperament of a person may be transformed under the influence of his ego. It is true that this change is slow in comparison with the change in the qualities before mentioned. We may compare the relation to each other of the rates of change in the two bodies to the movements of the hour-hand and minute-hand of a clock. Now the forces which bring about a change of character or temperament belong to the hidden forces of the etheric body. They are of the same nature as the forces which govern the kingdom of life,—the same, therefore, as the forces of growth, nutrition, and generation. Further explanations in this work will throw the right light on these things.
This is such a striking fact that there are thinkers who completely deny the possibility of changing one’s fundamental character. They believe it is something permanent throughout life, and that it only manifests in different ways. But this belief stems from poor observation. For anyone who can see these things, it’s clear that even a person's character and temperament can be transformed by their ego. It’s true that this change happens slowly compared to the changes in the previously mentioned qualities. We can compare the rates of change between the two to the movements of the hour hand and minute hand on a clock. The forces that cause a change in character or temperament come from the hidden forces of the etheric body. They are similar to the forces that govern the realm of life—the same as the forces of growth, nutrition, and reproduction. Further explanations in this work will shed light on these matters.
Thus it is not when man simply gives himself [pg 037] up to pleasure and pain, joy and sorrow, that the ego is working on the astral body, but when the peculiarities of these qualities of the soul are changed; and the work is extended in the same way to the etheric body, when the ego applies its energies to changing the character or temperament. This change, too, is one in which every person living is engaged, whether consciously or not. The most powerful incitement to this kind of change in ordinary life is that given by religion. If the ego allows the impulses which flow from religion to work upon it again and again, they become a power within it which extends to the etheric body and changes it as lesser impulses in life effect the transformation of the astral body. These lesser impulses, which come to man through study, reflection, the ennobling of feeling, and so on, are subject to the manifold changes of existence; but religious feelings impress a certain stamp of uniformity upon all thinking, feeling, and willing. They diffuse an equal and single light over the whole life of the soul.
So, it's not just when a person gives in to pleasure and pain, joy and sorrow that the self is influencing the astral body, but rather when the unique qualities of these emotions are altered; and this process also applies to the etheric body when the self invests energy in changing one's character or temperament. This transformation is something every individual is part of, whether they're aware of it or not. The most significant motivation for this kind of change in everyday life comes from religion. If the self consistently allows religious impulses to impact it, they become a powerful force within, extending to the etheric body and altering it in the same way that smaller impulses in life affect the transformation of the astral body. These smaller impulses, which come to individuals through study, reflection, and the refinement of feelings, are subject to the varied changes of existence; however, religious feelings imprint a certain consistency across all thoughts, emotions, and actions. They cast a unified and equal light over the entire life of the soul.
Man thinks and feels one thing to-day, another to-morrow, the causes of which are of many different kinds; but one who, consistently holding to his religious convictions, has a glimpse of something which persists through all changes, will relate his thoughts and feelings of to-day, as well as his experiences of to-morrow, to that fundamental feeling he possesses. Thus religious belief has the power of permeating the whole of the soul-life. Its influences increase in strength as time goes on because [pg 038] they are constantly repeated. Hence they acquire the power of working upon the etheric body.
People think and feel one thing today and something completely different tomorrow, and there are many reasons for this. However, someone who remains true to their religious beliefs and catches a glimpse of something that stays the same through all changes will connect their thoughts and feelings from today, as well as their experiences from tomorrow, to that core belief they hold. This is how religious faith can deeply influence a person's entire inner life. Its effects grow stronger over time because they are constantly reinforced. As a result, they begin to influence the etheric body.
In a similar way the influences of true art work upon man. If,—going beyond the outer form, colour and tone of a work of art,—he penetrates to its spiritual foundations with his imagination and feeling, then the impulses thus received by the ego actually reach the etheric body. When this thought is followed out to its logical conclusion, the immense significance of art in all human evolution may be estimated. Only a few instances are pointed out here of what induces the ego to work upon the etheric body. There are many similar influences in human life which are not so apparent at the first glance. But these instances are enough to show that there is yet another principle of man's nature hidden within him, which the ego is making more and more manifest. Occult science denotes this second principle of the spirit the Life-Spirit. (It is the same which in current theosophical literature is called Budhi, a term borrowed from Eastern wisdom.) The expression “Life-Spirit” is appropriate, because the same forces are at work within it as are active in the vital body, with the difference that when they are manifesting in the latter the ego is not active. When, however, these powers express themselves as the Life-Spirit, they are interpenetrated by the ego.
In a similar way, true art influences people. If someone goes beyond just the outer form, color, and tone of a piece of art and instead connects with its deeper spiritual essence through their imagination and feelings, then the impulses they receive actually affect their etheric body. When we explore this idea further, we can appreciate the immense importance of art in human evolution. Here, only a few examples are presented of what prompts the ego to influence the etheric body. There are many other similar influences in human life that aren’t immediately obvious. But these examples are enough to reveal another aspect of human nature within us, which the ego is gradually making more apparent. Occult science refers to this second principle of the spirit as the Life Force. (It is the same as what is commonly called Budhi in current theosophical literature, a term derived from Eastern wisdom.) The term “Life Force” is fitting because it embodies the same forces active in the vital body, except that these forces are not engaged when manifesting in the vital body. However, when these powers express themselves as the Life-Spirit, they are interwoven with the ego.
Man's intellectual development, the purification and ennobling of his feelings and of the manifestations of his will, are the measure of the degree in [pg 039] which he has transformed the astral body into the Spirit-Self. His religious experiences, as well as many others, are stamped upon the etheric body, making it into the Life-Spirit. In the ordinary course of life this happens more or less unconsciously; so-called initiation, on the contrary, consists in man's being directed by occult science to the means through which he may quite consciously take in hand this work on the Spirit-Self and Life-Spirit. These means will be dealt with in later parts of this book. In the meantime it is important to show that, besides the soul and the body, the spirit also is working within man. It will be seen later how this spirit belongs to the eternal part of man, as contrasted with the perishable body.
A person's intellectual growth, the refinement and elevation of their feelings and will, is the measure of how much they have transformed their astral body into the Spirit-Self. Their religious experiences and many others leave their mark on the etheric body, shaping it into the Life-Spirit. Usually, this process happens more or less unconsciously in everyday life; however, initiation involves being guided by occult knowledge to consciously engage in the work on the Spirit-Self and Life-Spirit. These methods will be discussed in later sections of this book. For now, it’s important to highlight that, in addition to the soul and body, the spirit is also at work within individuals. Later, it will be explained how this spirit is part of the eternal aspect of a person, unlike the transitory body.
But the work of the ego on the astral and etheric bodies does not exhaust its activity, which is also extended to the physical body. A slight effect of the influence of the ego on the physical body may be seen when certain experiences cause a person to blush or turn pale. In this case the ego is actually the occasion of a process in the physical body. Now if through the activity of the ego in man, changes occur influencing the physical body, the ego is really united with the hidden forces of the physical body, that is, with the same forces which bring about its physical processes. Occult science says that during such activity the ego is working on the physical body. This expression must not be misunderstood. It must on no account be supposed that this work is of a grossly material nature. What appears as [pg 040] gross material in the physical body is merely the manifested part of it; behind this are the hidden forces of its being, which are of a spiritual nature. When the ego puts forth its energies in the manner described, it unites itself, not with the outer material manifestation of the physical body, but with the invisible forces which bring that body into being and afterwards cause it to decay. This work of the ego on the physical body can only very partially become clear to man's consciousness in ordinary life. It can become fully clear only when, under the influence of occult science, man consciously takes the work into his own hands. Then he becomes aware that there is a third spiritual principle within him. It is that which occult science calls the Spirit-Man, as contrasted with physical man. (In theosophical literature this “Spirit-Man” is known as Atma.)
But the ego's influence on the astral and etheric bodies doesn’t stop there; it also affects the physical body. You can see a slight effect of the ego on someone physically when certain experiences make them blush or turn pale. In this case, the ego actually triggers a response in the physical body. When the ego operates in a person, it brings about changes that affect the physical body, which means the ego is connected to the underlying forces of that body — the same forces that drive its physical processes. Occult science states that during this activity, the ego is engaged with the physical body. This expression shouldn’t be misinterpreted. It should never be assumed that this work is purely material in nature. What seems to be grossly material in the physical body is just its outer manifestation; beneath that are hidden forces that are spiritual in essence. When the ego exerts its energies as described, it connects not with the visible material side of the physical body but with the invisible forces that create it and eventually lead to its decay. The ego's role in the physical body can only be partially understood by an average person's consciousness in everyday life. Complete understanding comes only when, influenced by occult science, a person consciously takes on this work. Then they realize that there's a third spiritual principle within them. This principle is referred to in occult science as the Spirit-Man, in contrast to physical man. (In theosophical literature, this “Spirit Guy” is known as Atma.)
Again, with regard to the Spirit-Man, it is easy to make a mistake. In the physical body we see man's lowest principle, and on this account find it hard to realize that the work on that body should be accomplished by the highest principle of the human entity. But just because the spirit active within the physical body is hidden under three veils, the highest kind of human effort is needed in order to make the ego one with that which is the hidden spiritual energy of the body.
Again, when it comes to the Spirit-Man, it's easy to get it wrong. In the physical body, we see the lowest aspect of humanity, which makes it challenging to grasp that the work on this body should be done by the highest aspect of a person. However, because the spirit that acts within the physical body is concealed under three layers, a very high level of human effort is required to unite the ego with the hidden spiritual energy of the body.
Occult science, therefore, represents man as a being composed of many principles. Those of a bodily nature are:
Occult science, therefore, shows that humans are made up of many principles. The physical ones are:
the physical body, | |
the etheric or vital body, | |
the astral body. |
The soul-principles are:
The core principles are:
the sentient-soul, | |
the intellectual- or rational-soul, | |
the consciousness-soul. |
It is in the soul that the ego diffuses its light. Of a spiritual nature are:
It is in the soul that the ego spreads its light. Of a spiritual nature are:
the Spirit-Self, | |
the Life-Spirit, | |
the Spirit-Man. |
It follows from what was said above that the sentient-soul and the astral body are closely united and in a certain sense are one. Similarly, the consciousness-soul and the Spirit-Self form a whole, for in the consciousness-soul the spirit shines forth, and thence irradiates with its light the other principles of the human being. Hence occult science also speaks of man's organization as follows. The intellectual-soul is simply called the ego, because it partakes of the nature of the ego, and in a certain sense is the ego, not yet conscious of its spiritual nature. We thus have seven divisions of man:
It follows from what was mentioned earlier that the sentient soul and the astral body are closely connected and, in some sense, are one. Similarly, the consciousness-soul and the Spirit-Self form a whole, because the spirit shines through the consciousness-soul and radiates its light to the other aspects of a person. Therefore, occult science describes the structure of humans in the following way. The intellectual soul is simply referred to as the ego, because it shares the nature of the ego and, in a certain sense, is the ego, but not yet aware of its spiritual nature. Thus, we have seven divisions of humans:
(1) physical body; | |
(2) etheric or vital body; | |
(3) astral body; | |
(4) Ego; | |
(5) Spirit-Self; | |
(6) Life-Spirit; | |
(7) Spirit-Man. |
Even one accustomed to materialistic habits of thought would not find in this sevenfold organization of man the “fanciful magic” often attributed to the number seven, if one would only keep strictly to the meaning of the above explanations without himself injecting arbitrarily the idea of something magical into the matter. Occult science speaks of these seven principles of man in exactly the same way, only from the standpoint of a higher form of observation of the world, as allusion is commonly made to the seven colours that make up white light, or to the seven notes of the scale (the octave being regarded as a repetition of the keynote). As light appears in seven colours, and sound in seven tones, so is the unity of man's nature manifested in the seven principles described. No more superstition attaches to the number seven in the case of occult science than when associated with the spectrum or with the scale.
Even someone used to thinking in materialistic terms wouldn't find the sevenfold organization of man to be the “fanciful magic” often associated with the number seven if they strictly adhere to the meanings of the explanations provided, without imposing any arbitrary magical ideas. Occult science discusses these seven principles of man in the same way, but from a higher observational perspective, similar to how people refer to the seven colors that create white light or the seven notes of the scale (with the octave seen as a repeat of the keynote). Just as light is expressed in seven colors and sound in seven tones, the unity of human nature is shown in the seven principles described. There is no more superstition linked to the number seven in occult science than there is when talking about the spectrum or the scale.
On one occasion when these facts were put forward verbally, the objection was made that the statement about the number seven does not apply to colours, since there are others beyond the red and violet rays, invisible to the eye. But even in this respect the comparison with colours holds good, for, in fact, the human being expands beyond the physical body on the one side, and beyond the Spirit-Man on the other; only to the methods of spiritual observation of which occult science here speaks, are these extensions of the human being “spiritually invisible,” just as the colours beyond red and violet [pg 043] are physically invisible. This explanation becomes necessary, because the opinion so easily arises that occult science does not seriously apply itself to scientific thinking, but treats such matters unscientifically. However, one who carefully considers the meaning of the statements made by occult science will find that in reality it is never at variance with genuine science; neither when it brings forward the facts of natural science as illustrations, nor when its statements are directly connected with natural research.
On one occasion, when these facts were presented verbally, someone raised the objection that the statement about the number seven doesn't apply to colors since there are other colors beyond red and violet rays that are invisible to the eye. But even in this regard, the comparison with colors is valid because, in reality, a human being extends beyond the physical body on one side and beyond the Spirit-Man on the other; it’s just that these extensions of the human being are considered “spiritually unseen,” similar to how colors beyond red and violet [pg 043] are physically invisible. This clarification is important because it's easy to think that occult science doesn’t seriously engage with scientific thinking and instead treats these matters unscientifically. However, anyone who carefully reflects on the meanings of the statements made by occult science will find that it never really contradicts genuine science; this holds true whether it uses natural science facts as examples or when its statements are directly related to natural research.
Chapter 3. Sleep and Death
The nature of waking consciousness cannot be fathomed without observing that condition which man experiences during sleep, and the problem of life cannot be approached without studying death. Any one failing to perceive the importance of occult science may distrust the manner in which it studies sleep and death. Occult science is, however, capable of appreciating the motives from which such distrust arises. For there is nothing incomprehensible in the assertion that man exists for an active, purposeful life, that his acts depend on his devotion thereto, and that absorption in such conditions as sleep and death can result only from a taste for idle dreaming, and can lead to nothing else than vain imaginings.
The nature of waking consciousness can't be understood without looking at what people experience during sleep, and you can't truly approach the problem of life without examining death. Anyone who doesn't recognize the significance of occult science might doubt how it explores sleep and death. However, occult science can appreciate why that doubt exists. There's nothing mysterious about the idea that humans are meant for an active, meaningful life, that our actions are tied to our commitment to that life, and that being overly focused on things like sleep and death usually comes from a desire for idle fantasies, leading to nothing but empty thoughts.
The refusal to accept anything of so fantastic a nature may readily be regarded as the expression of a sound mind, while indulgence in such “idle dreaming” is accounted morbid, and a pursuit fit only for people in whom the joy and ardour of life are lacking, and who are incapable of “real work.” It would be wrong to set this assertion aside at once as an injustice, for it contains a certain grain of truth. It is one quarter truth, and must be completed [pg 045] by the remaining three quarters belonging to it. Now if we dispute the one quarter which is right, with one who recognizes that one quarter quite distinctly but who does not dream of the other three quarters, we only rouse his suspicions. For it must be indeed granted absolutely that the study of that which lies hidden in sleep and death is morbid if it leads to weakness or to estrangement from real life. No less must we admit that much of that which has always called itself occult science in the world, and which is even now practised under that name, bears the impression of what is unhealthy and hostile to life; but this certainly does not spring from genuine occult science.
The refusal to accept anything so far-fetched can easily be seen as a sign of a sound mind, while indulging in such "daydreaming" is viewed as unhealthy, a pursuit only for those who lack the joy and passion for life and who are incapable of “actual work.” It would be a mistake to dismiss this claim outright as unfair, as it does hold a kernel of truth. It contains a quarter truth, which must be fleshed out with the other three-quarters that go with it. If we challenge the one quarter that is valid to someone who clearly understands that but has no awareness of the other three quarters, we only raise their suspicions. It must be recognized that exploring what lies hidden in sleep and death is indeed unhealthy if it leads to weakness or detachment from real life. We must also acknowledge that much of what has traditionally labeled itself as occult science in the world, and is still practiced under that name today, carries a sense of being unhealthy and life-denying; however, this certainly doesn’t stem from authentic occult science.
The real fact of the matter is this, that just as a man cannot always be awake, so neither is he sufficiently equipped for the actual conditions of life, in its entire range, without that which occult science has to offer him. Life continues during sleep, and the forces which work and labour during the waking state draw their strength and refreshment from that which sleep gives them. It is thus with the things under our observation in the manifested world. The boundaries of the world are wider than the field of this observation; and what man recognizes in the visible must be supplemented and fertilized by what he is able to know of the invisible world. A man who did not continually renew his exhausted forces by sleep, would bring his life to destruction; and in the same way a view of the world which is not fertilized [pg 046] by a knowledge of the unseen, must lead to a feeling of desolation.
The truth is this: just as a person can't always be awake, they aren't fully prepared for the realities of life without what occult science offers. Life goes on during sleep, and the energies that work and thrive when we're awake draw their strength and renewal from what sleep provides. This is true for the things we observe in the visible world. The limits of our world are broader than what we can see; what we understand in the visible must be enhanced and nourished by our knowledge of the invisible world. If a person didn't continuously refresh their drained energy through sleep, they would ruin their life. Similarly, a worldview that isn't enriched by an understanding of the unseen will lead to feelings of despair. [pg 046]
It is similarly so with regard to death. Living creatures fall a prey to death in order that new life may arise. It is occult science which throws light on Goethe's beautiful phrase: “Nature invented Death in order to have much Life.” Just as in the ordinary sense there could be no life without death, so can there be no real knowledge of the visible world without insight into the invisible. All discernment of the visible must plunge again and again into the invisible in order to develop. Thus it is evident that occult science alone makes the life of revealed knowledge possible. When it emerges in its true form it never enfeebles life, but strengthens it and ever renews its freshness and health, when, left to its own resources, it has become weak and diseased.
It’s the same when it comes to death. Living things succumb to death so that new life can emerge. It’s occult science that illuminates Goethe's beautiful saying: “Nature created Death so that it could have more Life.” Just as, in a straightforward sense, there can be no life without death, there can be no true understanding of the visible world without insight into the invisible. Every understanding of the visible must dive back into the invisible repeatedly in order to grow. Therefore, it’s clear that only occult science makes the life of revealed knowledge possible. When it appears in its true form, it never weakens life, but rather strengthens it and continuously revitalizes its freshness and health when, left on its own, it has become weak and unhealthy.
When a man sinks into sleep the connection between his principles changes, as described earlier in this work. The part of the sleeping man which lies upon his couch comprises the physical and etheric bodies, but not the astral body and not the ego. It is because the etheric body remains bound to the physical body in sleep that the life-activities continue. For the moment the physical body is left to itself, it must of necessity fall into decay. The things that are extinguished in sleep are ideas, pain, pleasure, joy, grief, the ability to express conscious will, and similar facts of existence. But the astral body is the vehicle of all these things. That the astral body, with all its joy and sorrow, its realm of [pg 047] thought and will, is annihilated in sleep is an opinion that cannot be entertained by an unbiased judgment; it exists still, but in another condition. In order that the human ego and the astral body may not only be endowed with pleasure and pain and all the other things we have named, but also have a conscious perception of them, it is necessary that the astral body should be united with the physical and etheric bodies. This is the case during waking life, but not in sleep. The astral body has withdrawn itself from the other bodies. It has adopted another kind of existence than that which it possesses while united with the physical and etheric bodies. Now it is the task of occult science to study this other kind of existence in the astral body. During sleep, the astral body withdraws from the possibility of external observation and occult science must trace it in its hidden life, until it again takes possession of its physical and etheric bodies on waking.
When a person falls asleep, the connection between their principles changes, as discussed earlier in this work. The part of the sleeping person on the bed includes the physical and etheric bodies, but not the astral body or the ego. The reason the etheric body stays linked to the physical body during sleep is that it allows life functions to continue. If the physical body were left unattended, it would inevitably start to decay. In sleep, what gets shut down are thoughts, pain, pleasure, joy, grief, the ability to express conscious will, and similar aspects of existence. The astral body is responsible for all of these experiences. The idea that the astral body, along with all its joy and sorrow, its realm of thought and will, is completely annihilated in sleep is not a view that can be accepted by impartial judgment; it still exists but in a different state. For the human ego and the astral body to not only experience pleasure and pain, and all the other mentioned feelings, but also to have conscious awareness of them, the astral body needs to be connected to the physical and etheric bodies. This occurs during wakefulness, not during sleep. The astral body has separated itself from the other bodies and has taken on a different form of existence than when it's connected to the physical and etheric bodies. It is now the job of occult science to explore this other form of existence in the astral body. During sleep, the astral body removes itself from the chance of external observation, and occult science must investigate its hidden life until it reclaims its physical and etheric bodies upon waking.
As in all cases when knowledge of the hidden things and events of life have to be dealt with, clairvoyant observation is necessary for the discovery of the real facts of the sleep state in its true nature, but if that which may be discovered by this means has once been made clear, it is comprehensible to really unprejudiced thought without further demonstration. For events in the unseen world show themselves by their effects in the manifested world. If what is revealed by clairvoyant vision is an explanation of visible events, such a confirmation by [pg 048] life itself is the proof which may rightly be demanded. Even one who will not use the means to be given later for the attainment of clairvoyant vision, may have the following experience: he may, in the first place, take the statements of the clairvoyant for granted, and then apply them to the material events within his experience. He will then find that life thereby becomes clear and comprehensible; and the more exact and minute his observations of ordinary life, the more readily will he come to this conclusion.
When it comes to understanding the hidden aspects of life, having clairvoyant insight is essential to uncover the true nature of the sleep state. Once this understanding is achieved, it becomes clear to anyone who is truly open-minded without needing more proof. Events in the unseen realm reveal themselves through their impacts in the visible world. If what is seen through clairvoyant vision explains observable occurrences, then life itself serves as the valid proof. Even someone who doesn't utilize the methods that will be provided later to gain clairvoyant insight can still have this experience: initially accepting the clairvoyant's statements and then relating them to actual events in their life. They'll discover that this approach makes life clearer and easier to understand; the more precise and detailed their observations of everyday life, the quicker they will reach this understanding.
Even though the astral body during sleep passes through no experiences, though it is not conscious of pleasure, pain, and the like, it does not remain inactive. On the contrary, it is a fact that active work is its function in the sleep state. For it is the astral body which strengthens and recuperates man's forces, exhausted during waking life. As long as the astral body is united with the physical and etheric bodies it is related to the outer world through these two bodies. They convey to it perceptions and representations. Through the impressions which they receive from their surroundings, it experiences pleasure and pain. Now the physical body can be preserved in the form and shape suitable to the individual only by means of the human etheric body. But this human form can be preserved only by an etheric body which on its part receives corresponding forces from the astral body. The etheric body is the builder, the architect, of the physical body. It can, however, construct in the true sense only when it receives from the astral body the impulse as to the [pg 049] manner in which it must build. In this latter are contained the models, according to which the etheric body gives the physical body its form. During our waking hours these models for the physical body are not present in the astral body, or, at least, only to a certain extent. For in waking life the soul replaces these models with its own images. When a person directs his senses upon his environment he thus creates in his ideas pictures which are copies of the world around him. In fact these copies at first disturb the prototypes which give the etheric body the impulse to preserve the physical body. Such disturbance could not be present if a man, by virtue of his own activity, could convey to his astral body those pictures which would give the right impulse to the etheric body. Yet this very disturbance plays an important part in human life, and is able to express itself because the models for the etheric body do not come into full play in the waking life. This fact is revealed by “fatigue.” Now, during sleep, no external impressions disturb the force of the astral body. Therefore in this condition it can expel fatigue. The work of the astral body during sleep consists in removing fatigue, and it can accomplish this only by leaving the physical and etheric bodies. During waking life the astral body does its work within the physical body; during sleep it works on the latter from without.
Even though the astral body has no experiences during sleep and isn’t aware of pleasure or pain, it’s not inactive. In fact, it actively works while in a sleep state. The astral body is responsible for strengthening and restoring a person's energy, which gets depleted during waking hours. As long as the astral body is connected to the physical and etheric bodies, it interacts with the outside world through these two. They send it perceptions and representations. Through the impressions received from their environment, it experiences pleasure and pain. The physical body can only maintain its form that suits the individual thanks to the human etheric body. However, this human form can be sustained only if the etheric body receives the necessary energy from the astral body. The etheric body acts as the builder, the architect, of the physical body. It can genuinely construct only when it gets guidance from the astral body about how to build. These guidelines contain the models that the etheric body uses to shape the physical body. When we’re awake, these models aren't fully present in the astral body, or at least not entirely. During waking life, the soul replaces these models with its own images. When a person focuses on their surroundings, they create mental pictures that replicate the world around them. In fact, these replicas initially disrupt the prototypes that guide the etheric body in preserving the physical body. Such disruption wouldn’t occur if a person could actively send those right images to their astral body, giving the correct signal to the etheric body. However, this very disturbance is crucial in human life and manifests itself because the models for the etheric body aren't fully engaged during waking hours. This is shown by “fatigue.” During sleep, no external impressions interfere with the astral body’s force. Therefore, in this state, it can alleviate fatigue. The work of the astral body during sleep is to remove fatigue, which it can achieve only by separating from the physical and etheric bodies. While awake, the astral body operates within the physical body; during sleep, it works from the outside.
For instance, just as the physical body has need of the outer world, which is of like substance with itself, for its supply of food, something of the same [pg 050] kind takes place in the case of the astral body. Let us imagine a physical human body removed from the surrounding world: it would die. That shows that physical life is an impossibility without the entire physical environment. In fact, the whole earth must be just as it is if physical human bodies are to exist upon it. For, in reality, the whole human body is only a part of the earth,—indeed, in a wider sense, part of the whole physical universe. In this respect it is related in the same sense as, for example, the finger of a hand to the entire human body. Separate the finger from the hand and it cannot remain a finger: it withers away. Such would also be the fate of the human body were it removed from that body of which it is a member,—from the conditions of life with which the earth provides it. Let it be raised above the surface of the earth but a sufficient number of miles and it will perish as the finger perishes when cut off from the hand. If this fact is less apparent in the case of a man's physical organism than in that of his finger and his body, it is merely because the finger cannot walk about on the body as man is able to do on the earth, and because on that account the dependence of the former is more obvious.
For example, just like the physical body relies on the outside world, which is made of the same material, for its food supply, the same concept applies to the astral body. Imagine a physical human body cut off from its surroundings: it would die. This demonstrates that physical life can't exist without the entire physical environment. In reality, the whole earth needs to be exactly as it is for physical human bodies to exist here. The human body is essentially a part of the earth—and, more broadly, part of the entire physical universe. In this way, it’s similar to how a finger is related to the whole human body. If you separate the finger from the hand, it can't remain a finger: it shrivels up. The same fate would befall the human body if it were taken away from the body it's a part of—from the life conditions provided by the earth. If it were lifted off the earth's surface just a few miles, it would die like the finger does when it's cut off from the hand. If this connection is less obvious in a person's physical body than in their finger and hand, it's only because the finger can’t move around on the body like a person can on the earth, making that dependence clearer.
In the same way that the physical body is embedded in the physical world to which it belongs, so does the astral body form a part of its own world, only it is torn out of it in waking life. We can form a clear idea of what happens by having recourse to an analogy. Imagine a vessel filled with water. No [pg 051] one drop is a separate thing in itself within that entire mass of water. But let us take a little sponge and with it suck up a single drop from the whole mass of water. Something of this kind happens to the human astral body on awaking. During sleep it is in a world resembling its own nature. In a certain sense it forms part of it. On awaking, the physical and etheric bodies suck it up: they absorb it; they contain the organs through which it perceives the outer world. In order to achieve this perception it has to leave its own world, for it is in that world alone that it can receive the models which it needs for the etheric body.
Just as the physical body is situated in the physical world it belongs to, the astral body is part of its own realm, but it gets pulled out of it during waking life. We can better understand this by using an analogy. Picture a container filled with water. Each drop is not an individual entity within that entire mass of water. Now, if we take a sponge and soak up one drop from the whole mass, something similar occurs with the human astral body upon waking. While asleep, it exists in a world that resembles its own nature, and in a way, it is a part of that world. When we wake up, the physical and etheric bodies draw it in: they absorb it; they have the organs that allow it to perceive the external world. To achieve this perception, it has to leave its own world, since it is only in that world where it can receive the models it needs for the etheric body.
Just as food is supplied to the physical body from its surroundings, so are the pictures of the world surrounding the astral body presented to it during the state of sleep. There, indeed, it lives in the universe, beyond the physical and etheric bodies: in that same universe out of which the whole man is born. The source of the images by means of which man receives his form is in this universe. He is linked in harmony with it; and when he awakens he rises above the surface of this all-pervading harmony to attain external perception. In sleep his astral body returns to the universal harmony. He brings so much strength from it to his bodies on awaking that he can once more dispense for a time with sojourning in the realm of harmony. The astral body returns during sleep to its home, and, on awaking, brings back into life freshly invigorated forces. That which the astral body thus gains, and brings [pg 052] with it on waking, finds its outer expression in the refreshment afforded by sound sleep.
Just like the body gets food from its environment, the astral body receives images of the world around it during sleep. In that state, it exists in the universe, separate from the physical and etheric bodies: in the same universe from which the entire human being is created. The source of the images that give form to a person lies in this universe. He is in harmony with it; and when he wakes up, he rises above this all-encompassing harmony to achieve external perception. During sleep, his astral body goes back to the universal harmony. It brings back so much energy upon waking that he can for a time do without being in the realm of harmony. The astral body returns to its home during sleep and, upon waking, brings back refreshed forces into life. What the astral body gains and brings back when waking finds its outward expression in the rejuvenation that comes from deep sleep.
Further exposition of occult science will show that this home of the astral body is more extensive than that which belongs to the physical body in the narrower sense of the physical environment. Thus, while man as a physical being is a member of this earth, his astral body belongs to worlds in which other heavenly bodies besides our earth are included. During sleep, therefore,—(this can be made clear, as we have said, only by further explanations)—it enters a world to which other stars than the earth belong. In recognition of the fact that man lives during sleep in a world of stars, that is, in an astral world, occult science calls that principle of man which has its real home in that “astral” world and which, every time it returns to the sleep state, draws renewed force from that world, the astral body.
Further exploration of occult science will reveal that the home of the astral body is larger than the space that belongs to the physical body in the more limited sense of the physical environment. So, while a person, as a physical being, is a part of this earth, their astral body is connected to worlds that include other celestial bodies beyond our planet. Therefore, during sleep—this can be better understood, as we mentioned, only through further explanations—it enters a realm that includes stars other than Earth. Recognizing that people exist during sleep in a starry world, or an astral world, occult science refers to that aspect of a person which truly resides in that “astral” world and which, each time it returns to the sleep state, draws renewed energy from that world, as the astral projection.
It should be superfluous to point out that a misunderstanding might easily arise with regard to these facts; in our time, however, when certain materialistic modes of representation exist, it becomes quite necessary to draw attention to them. In quarters where such representation prevails it may, of course, be said that such a thing as fatigue can be scientifically investigated only in accordance with physical conditions. Even if the learned are not yet unanimous with regard to the physical cause of fatigue, one thing is quite firmly established; we must accept certain physical processes which lie at the root of this phenomenon. It would be well, however, [pg 053] if it were recognized that occult science does not in any way oppose this assertion. It admits everything that is said in this connection, just as it is admitted that for the physical erection of a house one brick must be laid upon another, and that when the house is finished its form and construction can be explained by purely mechanical laws. But the thought of the architect is necessary for the building of the house. This cannot be discovered merely by examination of physical laws.
It should be obvious that misunderstandings can easily arise regarding these facts; however, in our time, when certain materialistic ways of thinking exist, it's important to highlight them. In environments where such thinking dominates, it can be argued that fatigue can only be scientifically studied based on physical conditions. Even if experts do not yet agree on the physical cause of fatigue, one thing is clear: we need to acknowledge certain physical processes that are fundamental to this phenomenon. It would also be beneficial to recognize that occult science does not oppose this idea. It accepts everything that's mentioned here, just as it is accepted that to physically build a house, one brick must be placed on top of another, and that when the house is complete, its shape and structure can be explained by purely mechanical laws. But the architect's vision is essential for constructing the house. This cannot be uncovered just by examining physical laws. [pg 053]
Just as the thought of the creator of a house stands behind the physical laws which make it explicable, so too, behind what is affirmed, with perfect accuracy by physical science, stands that of which occult science treats. This comparison is of course often put forward when the justification for a spiritual background to the world is in question; and it may be considered a trivial one. But what is important in such matters is not familiarity with certain conceptions, but that the proper weight should be given them in establishing a fact. One may be prevented from doing this simply because contrary ideas have so much power over the judgment that this weight is not felt.
Just like the idea of the designer of a house supports the physical laws that make it understandable, what is accurately confirmed by physical science also has a foundation in what occult science examines. This analogy is often brought up when discussing the need for a spiritual context in the world, and it might seem trivial. However, what's important in these discussions isn't just familiarity with certain ideas, but rather ensuring they are given the right significance when determining a fact. Sometimes, people struggle to do this because opposing beliefs can have such a strong influence on their judgment that this significance goes unnoticed.
Dreaming is an intermediate state between sleeping and waking. What dream experiences offer to thoughtful observation is the many-coloured interweaving of a picture-world, which nevertheless conceals within itself some sort of law and order. At first this world seems to have an ebb and flow, often in confused succession. Man in his dream-life is set [pg 054] free from the laws of waking consciousness which bind him to sense-perception and the laws of reason. And yet dreams have some sort of mysterious law, attractive and fascinating to human speculation, and this is the deeper reason why the beautiful play of imagination lying at the root of artistic feeling is always apt to be compared to dreaming. We need only recall a few characteristic dreams to find this corroborated. A man dreams, for example, that he is driving off a dog that is attacking him. He wakes, and finds himself in the act of unconsciously pushing off part of the bedclothes which had been lying on an unaccustomed part of his body and which had therefore become oppressive. What is it that dream-life makes, in this instance, out of an incident perceptible to the senses? In the first place, it leaves in complete unconsciousness what the senses would perceive in the waking state. But it holds fast to something essential—namely, the fact that the man wishes to repel something; and round about this it weaves a metaphorical occurrence.
Dreaming is a state somewhere between sleeping and waking. What dream experiences reveal to thoughtful observation is a colorful blend of a picture-world that, despite its chaos, hides some kind of laws and order within it. Initially, this world seems to ebb and flow, often in a confusing sequence. A person in their dream life is free from the waking consciousness that limits them to sensory perception and the rules of logic. Yet dreams have their own mysterious laws, which are intriguing and captivating to human thought. This is the deeper reason why the beautiful play of imagination at the core of artistic feeling is frequently compared to dreaming. We only need to think of a few typical dreams to see this confirmed. For example, a man dreams that he is fending off a dog that is attacking him. He wakes up to find himself unconsciously pushing away part of the bedclothes, which were resting on an unfamiliar part of his body and had become uncomfortable. What does dream life make of this, based on a sensory incident? First, it completely ignores what the senses would register in the waking state. But it clings to something essential—namely, the fact that the man wants to push something away; and around this, it constructs a metaphorical scenario.
The pictures, as such, are echoes of waking life. There is something arbitrary in the way in which they are drawn from it. Every one feels that the same external cause may conjure up various dream-pictures. But they give symbolic expression to the feeling that one has something to ward off. The dream creates symbols; it is a symbolist. Inner experiences can also be transformed into such dream-symbols. A man dreams that a fire is crackling beside him; he sees flames in his dream. He wakes up [pg 055] feeling that he is too heavily covered and has become too warm. The feeling of too great warmth expresses itself symbolically in the picture. Quite dramatic experiences may be enacted in a dream. For example, some one dreams that he is standing on the edge of a precipice. He sees a child running toward it. The dream makes him experience all the tortures of the thought—if only the child will not be heedless and fall over into the abyss! He sees it fall, and hears the dull thud of the body below. He awakes, and perceives that an object which had been hanging on the wall of the room has become unfastened, and made a dull sound by its fall. This simple event is expressed in dream-life by one which unravels itself in exciting pictures. For the present it is not at all necessary to engage in reflection as to the reason why, in the last example, the moment of the falling of a heavy object expresses itself in a series of events which seem to spread themselves over a certain length of time; it is only necessary to keep in view that the dream transforms into a picture that which would present itself to the waking sense-perception.
The images, in essence, are reflections of waking life. There’s something random about how they are taken from it. Everyone realizes that the same external trigger can create different dream images. Yet, they symbolically express the feeling that there’s something to be pushed away. The dream creates symbols; it is a symbol-maker. Internal experiences can also be turned into these dream symbols. A person dreams that there’s a fire crackling beside them; they see flames in their dream. They wake up feeling too heavily covered and overly warm. The sensation of being too warm is symbolically reflected in the image. Dramatic events can also unfold in a dream. For instance, someone dreams they are standing on the edge of a cliff. They see a child running toward it. The dream makes them feel all the agony of the thought—if only the child wouldn’t be careless and fall into the void! They see the child fall and hear the dull thud of the body below. They wake up and realize that an object that had been hanging on the wall has come loose and made a thudding sound when it fell. This simple occurrence is expressed in the dream as a series of intense images. For now, there’s no need to reflect on why, in the last example, the moment of a heavy object falling is portrayed through a series of events that seem to unfold over a certain duration; it’s only important to recognize that the dream transforms into an image what would appear to waking perception.
We see that the moment the senses cease their activity, creative power asserts itself in man. It is the same creative power which is present in absolutely dreamless sleep, and at that time recuperates man's exhausted forces. For this dreamless sleep to take place, the astral body must be withdrawn from the etheric and physical bodies. During the dream-state it is so far separated from the physical body as [pg 056] to have no further connection with the organs of sense; but it still maintains a certain connection with the etheric body. The capacity for perceiving the experiences of the astral body by means of pictures is due to this connection which it maintains with the etheric body. The moment this connection also ceases, the pictures sink into the obscurity of unconsciousness and dreamless sleep has set in.
We see that when the senses stop working, the creative power in humans comes forward. This is the same creative energy that exists during completely dreamless sleep, which helps recover our tired minds and bodies. For dreamless sleep to happen, the astral body needs to detach from the etheric and physical bodies. During dreaming, it is separated enough from the physical body to no longer engage with the senses, but it still keeps a certain link with the etheric body. The ability to visualize the experiences of the astral body is because of this connection with the etheric body. Once this connection is also broken, the images fade into the darkness of unconsciousness, and then dreamless sleep begins.
The arbitrary and often nonsensical element in dream-pictures arises from the fact that the astral body cannot, on account of its separation from the sense-organs of the physical body, relate its pictures to the correct objects and events of the outer environment. It is especially illuminating, in this matter, to examine a dream in which the ego is, as it were, split up; as, for example in the case of a person who dreams that he is a schoolboy and cannot answer the propounded question, while immediately afterward as the teacher, he himself answers it. The dreamer, being unable to make use of his physical organs of perception, is not able to connect both occurrences with himself, as the same individual. Therefore, in order to recognize himself also as a permanent ego, man must first be equipped with outer organs of perception. Only when he has acquired the faculty of self-consciousness without the aid of such organs will the permanent ego also become perceptible to him outside his physical body. Clairvoyant consciousness has to acquire this faculty, and the method of doing so will be treated in detail later in this work.
The random and often illogical aspects of dream imagery come from the fact that the astral body, being separate from the physical body's sense organs, cannot connect its images to the right objects and events in the outer world. It's particularly enlightening to analyze a dream where the self seems split, like in the case of someone who dreams they are a schoolboy unable to answer a question, only to immediately afterward, as the teacher, provide the answer. The dreamer, not using their physical senses, can't link both instances to themselves as the same person. Therefore, to recognize themselves as a continuous self, a person must first have physical senses. Only after developing self-awareness without reliance on these senses will the enduring self become evident to them outside their physical form. Clairvoyant awareness needs to develop this ability, and the process for achieving this will be discussed in detail later in this work.
Even death takes place for no other cause than a change in the connection of the principles of man's being. And what is visible to clairvoyant observation with regard to death may also be seen in its effects in the manifested world; in this case also, an unbiased judgment will find the teachings of occult science confirmed by observing external life. The expression of the invisible in the visible is, however, less evident with regard to these facts, and there is greater difficulty in feeling the full importance of that which in the events of outer life endorses the statements of occult science in this domain. These statements may be supposed to be mere pictures of fancy, even more readily than many other things that have been dealt with in this work, if we shut ourselves off from the knowledge that everywhere in the visible is contained an unmistakable foreshadowing of the invisible.
Even death happens for no other reason than a change in the connection of the elements of human existence. What can be seen by those with clairvoyant abilities about death can also be observed in its impacts on the physical world; in this case, a fair assessment will find that the insights of occult science are backed up by observations of external life. However, the expression of the unseen in the seen is less obvious regarding these facts, and it's more challenging to grasp the full significance of what in outer life supports the claims of occult science in this area. These claims might easily be seen as mere fanciful images, even more so than many other topics discussed in this work, if we block ourselves from realizing that the visible world always holds a clear hint of the invisible.
On the approach of sleep, only the astral body is released from its connection with the etheric and physical bodies, which still remain united, whereas at death the separation of the physical from the etheric body takes place. The physical body is abandoned to its own forces, and must therefore disintegrate as a corpse. At death the etheric body finds itself in a condition in which it has never been before during the time between birth and death,—with the exception of certain abnormal conditions to be dealt with later. That is to say, it is now united with the astral body in the absence of the physical body; for the etheric and astral bodies [pg 058] do not separate immediately after death: they are held together for a time by the agency of a force the presence of which can be easily understood; for were this force not present the etheric body could not detach itself from the physical body. It would remain bound to the latter, as is shown in the case of sleep, when the astral body is not able to rend asunder these two principles of man's being. This force comes into action at death. It releases the etheric from the physical body, so that the former remains united to the astral body. Clairvoyant observation shows that this connection varies with different people after death. The time of its duration is measured by days. For the present, this period of time is mentioned only for the sake of information.
As someone falls asleep, only the astral body separates from its link with the etheric and physical bodies, which still stay connected. In contrast, at death, the physical body separates from the etheric body. The physical body is left to its own processes and must eventually decompose as a corpse. When death occurs, the etheric body enters a state it has never experienced before during the time from birth to death—except for certain unusual conditions that will be discussed later. This means it is now joined with the astral body without the physical body present; the etheric and astral bodies do not separate immediately after death. They are held together for a while by a force that is easy to understand, as without this force, the etheric body wouldn't be able to detach from the physical body. It would remain tied to it, similar to what happens during sleep, when the astral body can't separate these two aspects of a person’s existence. This force activates at death, releasing the etheric body from the physical, allowing it to stay connected to the astral body. Clairvoyant observation indicates that this connection varies among different individuals after death, with its duration measured in days. For now, this timeframe is mentioned just for informational purposes.
Subsequently, the astral body is also released from the etheric body and goes on its way alone. During the union of the two bodies, the individual is in a state which enables him to be aware of the experiences of his astral body. As long as the physical body is there, the work of reinforcing the wasted organs has to be begun from without, as soon as the astral body is liberated from it. When once the physical body is separated, this work ceases. Nevertheless, the force which was expended in this way while the man was asleep, continues after death and can now be applied to some other end. It is now used for making the astral body's own experiences perceptible. During his connection with his physical body the outer world enters man's consciousness [pg 059] in images; after the body has been laid aside, that which is experienced by the astral body, when it is no longer connected with sense organs, with this outer physical world, becomes perceptible. At first it has no new experiences. Its connection with the etheric body prevents it from experiencing anything new.
After that, the astral body is released from the etheric body and moves on its own. When the two bodies are united, the individual can be aware of the experiences of the astral body. As long as the physical body is present, any work needed to repair the damaged organs must start from the outside, as soon as the astral body is freed from it. Once the physical body is separated, this work stops. However, the energy that was used while the person was asleep continues after death and can now be directed toward something else. It is now used to make the astral body's own experiences noticeable. While connected to the physical body, the outside world enters a person's consciousness in images; after the body is set aside, what the astral body experiences, when no longer linked to the senses or the physical world, becomes noticeable. Initially, it has no new experiences. Its connection with the etheric body stops it from having new experiences.
What, however, it does possess, is memory of its past life. The etheric body still being present causes that past life to appear as a vivid and comprehensive panorama. That is man's first experience after death. He sees his life from birth to death spread out before him in a series of pictures. Memory is only present in the waking state, when during life man is united with his physical body, and it is present only to the extent allowed by that body. Nothing is lost to the soul that has made an impression on it during life. Were the physical body a perfect instrument for the purpose, it would be possible, at any moment during life, to conjure up the whole of the past before the eyes of the soul. At death there is no longer any obstacle to this. As long as the etheric body remains, there exists a certain degree of perfection of memory. But this disappears according to the degree in which the etheric body loses the form which it possessed while united with the physical body, and which resembles that body. This is the very reason why the astral body separates, after a time, from the etheric body. It can remain united with the latter only so long as [pg 060] the form of the etheric body corresponds with that of the physical body.
What it does have, though, is memories of its past life. The etheric body is still there, making that past life appear as a vivid and detailed panorama. That’s the first experience for a person after death. They see their life from birth to death displayed before them in a series of images. Memory is present only in the waking state, while a person is connected to their physical body, and is only available to the extent that the body allows. Nothing that leaves an impression on the soul during life is ever lost. If the physical body were a perfect instrument for this purpose, a person could recall their entire past at any moment during life. After death, there are no more obstacles to this. As long as the etheric body remains, there's still a certain level of memory perfection. But this diminishes as the etheric body loses the form it had when it was connected to the physical body, which resembles that body. This is exactly why the astral body separates from the etheric body after a while. It can only stay connected to the latter as long as the form of the etheric body matches that of the physical body.
During the period of life between birth and death, separation of the etheric body occurs only in exceptional cases, and for no longer than a brief space of time. If, for example, a man exposes one of his limbs to pressure, part of his etheric body may become separated from the physical one. We say on such occasion that the limb has “gone to sleep,” and the peculiar sensation we feel results from the separation of the etheric body. (Of course a materialistic manner of explanation may here again deny the invisible behind the visible and say: all this arises merely from the physical disturbance caused by the pressure.) Clairvoyant vision can see in such a case, how the corresponding part of the etheric body extends beyond the physical limb. Now if a man experiences an unusual shock, or something similar, such a separation of the etheric body from a large part of the physical body may result, for a short time. That is the case when a man, for some reason or other, is suddenly brought face to face with death,—for example when drowning, or threatened by a fatal accident when mountaineering. What is related by people who have had such experiences comes, in fact, very near the truth, and can be ratified by clairvoyant observation. They declare that in such moments their whole lives pass before their minds as though in a huge memory-picture.
During the span of life from birth to death, the etheric body typically only separates in rare instances and for just a short time. For instance, if someone puts pressure on one of their limbs, part of their etheric body might detach from the physical body. We often say that the limb has “asleep,” and the unusual sensation we feel comes from this separation of the etheric body. (Of course, a materialistic explanation might deny the invisible aspects behind the visible and claim that everything is simply due to the physical disturbance caused by the pressure.) Clairvoyant vision can perceive how the corresponding part of the etheric body extends beyond the physical limb. If a person undergoes an intense shock or a similar event, a separation of the etheric body from a larger part of the physical body can happen for a brief period. This is what occurs when someone suddenly confronts death—like when drowning or facing a life-threatening accident while mountain climbing. The accounts of people who have gone through such experiences closely align with the truth and can be verified through clairvoyant observation. They often report that in those moments, their entire life flashes before their eyes like a massive memory-picture.
Out of the many examples which might here be adduced, [pg 061] allusion will be made to one only, because it originates from a man whose mode of thought would make everything said here about such things seem pure fancy.5 Moriz Benedict, the distinguished criminal anthropologist and eminent investigator in many other realms of natural science, relates in his Reminiscences an experience of his own,—to the effect that once, when on the point of drowning in a bath he had seen his whole life pass before his memory as though in a single picture. If other people describe differently the pictures seen by them under similar circumstances, and even in such a way that they seem to have little to do with the events of their past life, that does not contradict what has been said; for the pictures which arise in the quiet abnormal condition during the separation from the physical body are sometimes at first sight, unintelligible in their relation to life. Correct observation, however, would always recognize this relationship.
Out of the many examples that could be mentioned here, [pg 061] I will refer to only one, because it comes from a man whose way of thinking makes everything discussed here about such topics seem purely imaginary.5 Moriz Benedict, the renowned criminal anthropologist and prominent researcher in various other fields of natural science, shares an experience of his own in his Memories. He recounts that once, when he was on the verge of drowning in a bath, he saw his entire life flash before him as if in a single image. If other people describe the images they see in similar situations differently—even in ways that appear unrelated to their past experiences—that doesn’t contradict what has been stated. The images that emerge in the calm, unusual state during the separation from the physical body can sometimes initially seem disconnected from real life. However, careful observation would always recognize this connection.
Neither is it an objection if, for example, some one who was once on the point of drowning did not experience what has been described; for it must be borne in mind that this can happen only when the etheric body is really separated from the physical body,—when, moreover, the former is still united [pg 062] with the astral body. If, through the fright, a loosening of the etheric and astral bodies also takes place, the experience is not forthcoming, because then complete unconsciousness ensues, as in dreamless sleep.
It's not a problem if, for instance, someone who was almost drowning didn't have the experience described; it's important to remember that this can only happen when the etheric body is truly separated from the physical body—and at the same time, the etheric body is still connected to the astral body. If, due to the shock, there’s a separation of the etheric and astral bodies as well, then the experience won't occur because that leads to total unconsciousness, similar to dreamless sleep. [pg 062]
Immediately after death the events of the past appear as though compressed by the memory into a picture. After its separation from the etheric body, the astral body pursues its further wanderings alone. It is not difficult to realize that everything continues to exist which, by means of its activity, the astral body has made its own during its sojourn in the physical body. The ego has to a certain extent elaborated the Spirit-Self, the Life-Spirit, and the Spirit-Man. As far as these are developed, they do not owe their existence to the organs present in the different bodies, but to the ego; and it is precisely this ego which needs no outer organs for perception; nor does it require any such organs in order to retain possession of what it has made one with itself. It might be objected: “Why then is there no perception during sleep of the developed Spirit-Self, Life-Spirit, and Spirit-Man?” For this reason that the ego is chained to the physical body between birth and death. Even though, during sleep, it is out of the physical body with the astral body it nevertheless remains closely connected with the physical body; for the activity of the astral body is directed toward the physical body. On this account the ego is relegated to the outer world of sense for its observations, and cannot receive spiritual revelations [pg 063] in their direct form. Not until death do these revelations come within reach of the ego, because by means of death the ego is freed from its connection with the physical and etheric bodies. Another world may flash upon the consciousness the moment it is withdrawn from the physical world which during life monopolizes its activity.
Immediately after death, past events seem to crystallize into a single image in memory. Once separated from the etheric body, the astral body continues its journey on its own. It's easy to understand that everything the astral body has engaged with during its time in the physical body continues to exist. The ego has, to some extent, developed the Spirit-Self, the Life-Spirit, and the Spirit-Man. To the degree these aspects are developed, they don't rely on the organs found in the different bodies; they are a product of the ego. This ego doesn't need external organs for perception nor does it need them to hold onto what it has integrated into itself. Someone might ask: "Why can't we perceive the developed Spirit-Self, Life-Spirit, and Spirit-Man while we sleep?" The answer is that the ego is bound to the physical body between birth and death. Even though it leaves the physical body during sleep along with the astral body, it remains closely tied to the physical body because the astral body's activities focus on it. This means the ego must use the external world of senses for its observations and cannot receive spiritual insights [pg 063] in their pure form. Only after death are these insights accessible to the ego, as death liberates it from its ties to the physical and etheric bodies. A different reality can illuminate consciousness the moment it is released from the physical world that dominated its focus during life.
Now there are reasons why even at this juncture all connection with the outer physical world of sense does not cease for man. That is to say, certain desires remain which sustain the connection. There are desires which man creates just because he is conscious of his ego as the fourth principle of his being. These desires and wishes, springing from the existence of his three lower bodies, can operate only in the external world, and cease to operate when these bodies are cast aside. Hunger is caused by the external body; as soon as that external body is no longer connected with the ego, hunger ceases. Now, had the ego no further desires than those springing from its own spiritual nature, it might at death draw full satisfaction from the spiritual world into which it is transplanted. But life has given it other desires as well. It has kindled in it a longing for pleasures only to be enjoyed by means of physical organs, although these pleasures themselves do not originate in the nature of those organs. It is not only the three bodies which demand gratification from the physical world, but the ego itself finds pleasures in that world, for the enjoyment [pg 064] of which there exist no means whatever, in the spiritual world.
Now, even at this point, there are reasons why our connection to the outer physical world doesn’t stop for humans. In other words, there are certain desires that keep this connection alive. There are desires that people create simply because they are aware of their ego as the fourth aspect of their being. These desires and wishes, arising from the presence of their three lower bodies, can only function in the external world and stop when these bodies are discarded. Hunger is generated by the physical body; once that physical body is no longer linked to the ego, hunger disappears. If the ego had no other desires besides those stemming from its spiritual nature, it could find complete fulfillment in the spiritual world it enters after death. But life has given it other desires too. It has ignited in it a craving for pleasures that can only be experienced through physical senses, even though these pleasures don’t actually come from the nature of those senses. It’s not just the three bodies that seek satisfaction from the physical world; the ego itself also finds enjoyment there, for which there are no means of experience in the spiritual world.
During life the ego has two kinds of desires: those that spring from the bodies and must therefore be gratified within the bodies, but which must also come to an end with their disintegration; and those that arise from the spiritual nature of the ego. As long as the ego lives in the bodies, those cravings are satisfied by means of the bodily organs. For in the manifestations of the bodily organs the hidden spiritual element is at work, and the senses receive something spiritual as well, in everything of which they are cognizant. That spiritual element is also present after death, although in a different form. Everything spiritual that the ego longs for while in the world of sense, it still possesses when the senses are no longer there.
During life, the ego has two types of desires: those that come from the body and need to be fulfilled while in the body, which will also end when the body breaks down; and those that come from the spiritual side of the ego. As long as the ego exists in the body, these desires are satisfied through the body's organs. The body's organs are influenced by a hidden spiritual element, and the senses also perceive something spiritual in everything they encounter. This spiritual element still exists after death, but in a different form. Everything spiritual that the ego desires while in the sensory world is still possessed after the senses are gone.
Now if a third kind of wish were not added to these two, death would mean only a transition from desires which may be satisfied through the senses to such as are fulfilled by the revelation of the spiritual world. The third kind of desire is that which is created by the ego during life in the sense-world, because it finds pleasure in that world, even when no spiritual element is revealed in it. The humblest pleasures may be manifestations of the spirit. The satisfaction afforded a starving creature by taking food is a manifestation of the spirit, for by taking food something is thereupon brought about without which, in a certain sense, the spiritual nature could not develop. But the ego can go beyond the pleasure, [pg 065] which in this case is the outcome of necessity. It may even long for the delicious food quite apart from the service rendered to the spirit by taking nourishment.
Now, if a third type of desire were not added to these two, death would only mean a shift from desires that can be fulfilled through the senses to those satisfied by the revelation of the spiritual world. The third type of desire is created by the ego during life in the material world because it finds enjoyment in that world, even when there’s no spiritual aspect revealed in it. The simplest pleasures can be expressions of the spirit. The relief a starving being gets from eating is a manifestation of the spirit, as taking in food brings about something without which, in a certain sense, spiritual development couldn't occur. However, the ego can go beyond that pleasure, which in this situation is driven by necessity. It may even crave the delicious food independent of the benefit it provides to the spirit through nourishment. [pg 065]
It is the same with other things in the sense-world. Desires are created in this way which would never have appeared in the sense-world if the human ego had not been incorporated in it. Neither do such desires arise from the spiritual nature of the ego. The ego must have pleasures of the senses as long as it lives in the body, even though it be for the very reason that its own nature is spiritual. For the spirit manifests in material things, and the ego is enjoying nothing less than spirit when it surrenders itself to that element in the sense-world which is irradiated by the light of the spirit. Moreover, it will continue to enjoy this light even when the senses are no longer the medium through which the spiritual rays pass. But there is no fulfillment possible in the spiritual world for desires in which the spirit is not living even in the world of the senses.
It’s the same with other things in the sensory world. Desires are created like this, which would never have existed in the sensory world if the human ego hadn’t been part of it. These desires don’t come from the ego’s spiritual nature either. The ego needs sensory pleasures as long as it lives in the body, even if that’s because its own nature is spiritual. The spirit shows itself in material things, and the ego is experiencing nothing less than spirit when it connects with that part of the sensory world that is illuminated by the light of the spirit. Additionally, it will continue to enjoy this light even when the senses are no longer the means through which the spiritual rays shine. However, fulfillment in the spiritual world is impossible for desires that don’t have the spirit living in them, even in the sensory world.
When death takes place, the possibility of gratifying desires of this description is cut off. Pleasure in good things to eat can be induced only by the presence of the physical organs required for their consumption,—the palate, tongue, and so forth; but when man has laid aside his physical body he no longer possesses these organs. If, however, the ego still craves that kind of pleasure the craving must remain unsatisfied. As long as this pleasure corresponds to the spiritual need, it is caused only by the [pg 066] presence of the physical organs; but should it happen that the ego has created the desire without serving the spirit in so doing, it retains it after death in the form of a craving which thirsts in vain for gratification. We can form an idea of what man then experiences only by imagining some one suffering from burning thirst in a region where, far and wide, there is no water to be found. This is the predicament of the ego after death, as long as it retains ungratified desires for the pleasures of the outer world, and has no organs by means of which to satisfy them. Of course the burning thirst, serving as a comparison for the condition of the ego after death, must be thought of as enormously increased, and it must be imagined as extending to all desires still existing, for which all possibility of gratification is lacking.
When death occurs, the chance to fulfill desires of this kind is cut off. Enjoyment of good food can only happen when we have the physical organs needed to consume it—like the palate and tongue; but once a person has shed their physical body, they no longer have these organs. If the self still yearns for that type of pleasure, the longing will remain unfulfilled. As long as this pleasure aligns with spiritual needs, it only arises from having the physical organs; however, if the self has generated a desire that doesn't serve the spirit, it holds onto that desire after death as an unfulfilled craving that longs in vain for satisfaction. We can visualize what a person goes through by imagining someone suffering from intense thirst in a place where there's no water anywhere. This is the situation for the self after death, as long as it holds on to unfulfilled desires for worldly pleasures but lacks the means to satisfy them. Of course, the intense thirst—a comparison for the self’s condition after death—should be imagined as immensely heightened, extending to all desires that remain unfulfilled, for which there's no chance of satisfaction.
The next condition of the ego consists in freeing itself from this bond of attraction to the outer world. With regard to this world, it has to attain purification and liberation. It must be cleansed of all wishes which it has created while in the body, and which have no native rights in the spiritual world. As an object is caught and burned up by fire, so is the world of desire, described above, broken up and destroyed after death. A vista is then opened into that world which occult science calls the “consuming fire” of the spirit. This fire seizes upon desires of a sensual nature which however are not rooted in the spirit. Revelations of this kind which occult science is bound to make with regard to such events may [pg 067] appear hopeless and terrible. It may seem a fearful thing that a hope for the realization of which sense-organs are required, should after death be transformed into despair, and that a wish that can be fulfilled only by the physical world should be changed into torturing deprivation. Yet we can hold such an opinion only as long as we fail to realize that the wishes and desires seized by the “consuming fire” after death do not, in a higher sense, represent forces beneficial to life but destructive to it.
The next condition of the ego involves freeing itself from its attachment to the outside world. In relation to this world, it must achieve purification and liberation. It needs to be rid of all desires it has formed while in the body, which have no rightful place in the spiritual realm. Just as an object is caught and burned by fire, the world of desires mentioned earlier is shattered and destroyed after death. This opens up a view into what occult science refers to as the "burning fire" of the spirit. This fire takes hold of desires of a sensual nature that are not grounded in the spirit. Revelations about such events, which occult science is obligated to share, may seem grim and daunting. It might appear frightening that a hope requiring our senses should turn into despair after death, and that a desire that can only be fulfilled in the physical world should be transformed into painful deprivation. However, we can only hold such a view as long as we fail to understand that the wishes and desires engulfed by the “consuming fire” after death do not, in a higher sense, represent life-giving forces but are rather destructive to it.
By means of these forces the ego binds itself to the sense-world more closely than is necessary, in order to draw from it all the experience it requires. For the sense-world is a manifestation of the hidden and spiritual world which lies behind it; and the ego could never attain spiritual happiness through the bodily senses, which are the only form in which the spiritual can be manifested, unless it utilized the senses to seek the spiritual element in sense-experience. Nevertheless, the ego loses sight of the true spiritual reality in the physical world to such an extent that it experiences sensual desires irrespective of the needs of the spirit. If sense pleasure, as the expression of the spirit, serves to raise and develop the ego, any pleasure which is not an expression of the spirit warps and impoverishes it. Even though such a desire finds the means of its gratification in the sense-world, still its destructive effect upon the ego is thereby in no way diminished; [pg 068] but it is not until after death that its disastrous effects become apparent.
Through these forces, the ego connects itself to the physical world more closely than necessary, in order to gain all the experience it needs. The physical world is a reflection of the hidden, spiritual world behind it; and the ego can never achieve spiritual happiness through the physical senses, which are the only way the spiritual can be expressed, unless it uses those senses to search for the spiritual aspect in sensory experiences. However, the ego becomes so focused on the physical world that it feels sensual desires regardless of the spirit's needs. If sensory pleasure, as an expression of the spirit, helps to elevate and develop the ego, then any pleasure that does not express the spirit distorts and diminishes it. Even though such desires find their fulfillment in the physical world, their harmful impact on the ego is not reduced; [pg 068] but it is only after death that the disastrous effects become clear.
For this reason a man may, by gratifying such desires, create, during his life, new and similar desires, wholly unaware that he is enveloping himself in a “consuming fire.” What becomes visible to him after death is only what already surrounded him during his life, and by thus becoming visible it at once appears in its salutary and beneficent effect. A human being who loves another is certainly not attracted merely by that part of him which is perceptible to the physical senses—the only part which is cut off from observation after death—but after death, just that part of the dear one then becomes visible for the perception of which the physical organs were only the means. The one thing, in fact, which would prevent a man from beholding his friend clearly is the presence of desires which can be satisfied only by means of physical organs. Unless these desires are extinguished, he can have no conscious perception of his friend after death. When looked at in this light, the terrible and hopeless character which after-death experiences might assume for man, according to the descriptions given by occult science, becomes changed into one which is thoroughly satisfying and consoling.
For this reason, a person can, by indulging such desires, create new and similar desires throughout their life, completely unaware that they are wrapping themselves in a “consuming fire.” What becomes visible to them after death is only what already surrounded them during their life, and by appearing this way, it shows its healing and beneficial effects. A person who loves another is definitely not drawn just by the part of them that can be sensed physically—the only part that is no longer observable after death—but after death, that part of the loved one becomes visible for the perception that the physical senses only facilitated. The only thing that would keep someone from seeing their friend clearly is the presence of desires that can only be satisfied through physical means. Unless these desires are extinguished, they won’t have any conscious perception of their friend after death. When viewed this way, the terrifying and hopeless nature of after-death experiences, as described by occult science, transforms into something entirely fulfilling and reassuring.
Now the first after-death experiences differ entirely in yet another respect from those during life. During the time of purification man lives, as it were, backwards. He lives over again the whole span of his life since birth; beginning with the events immediately [pg 069] preceding his death, and reversing the order of his experiences, he goes through them again until he reaches back to childhood. In this process he sees with spiritually enlightened eyes all those things which were not inspired by the spiritual nature of the ego, with the difference that he now experiences these things in reverse order.
Now, the first experiences after death are completely different from those during life in another way. During the period of purification, a person lives, in a sense, backwards. They relive their entire life from birth, starting with the moments right before their death and reversing the order of their experiences until they go back to childhood. In this process, they see, with spiritually enlightened understanding, all the things that weren’t influenced by the spiritual nature of the self, but the difference is that they now experience these things in reverse order.
For instance, a man who died in his sixtieth year, and who at the age of forty had, in an outburst of anger, caused some one either physical or mental pain, will go through this experience again when, on the return journey of existence after death, he reaches that point in his fortieth year; but now he does not experience the satisfaction which his attack had afforded him during life; instead, he experiences the pain which he inflicted upon the other man. It may at once be seen, however, that whatever pain he feels in the after-death experience is caused by a desire of the ego arising only from the outer physical world; in reality the ego does not only injure another by the indulgence of such a desire, but it also injures itself; although the injury to itself is not apparent during life.
For example, a man who died at sixty and, at the age of forty, caused someone pain—either physical or emotional—in a moment of anger, will relive that experience when he returns to existence after death and reaches his fortieth year again. However, this time he won't feel the satisfaction he got from his actions in life; instead, he will feel the pain he caused the other person. It's clear that any pain he experiences in the afterlife comes from a desire of the ego that only arises from the outer physical world. In reality, the ego doesn't just harm others by giving in to such desires; it also harms itself, although the self-harm isn’t obvious during life.
After death, however, the whole of the harmful world of desires becomes visible to the ego, which then feels attracted toward every being or object which had kindled the desire, in order that this may be destroyed in the “consuming fire” by the same means that created it. When man, on his return journey, reaches the moment of his birth, then only have all such desires been purged in the purifying flames, [pg 070] and henceforth nothing remains to hinder him from devoting himself entirely to the spiritual world. He enters upon a new phase of existence. In the same way that he laid aside his physical body at death and, soon afterward, his etheric body, so does that part of his astral body dissolve which can only live in the consciousness of the outer physical world.
After death, the entire harmful world of desires becomes clear to the ego, which then feels drawn to every being or object that sparked those desires, in order to have them destroyed in the “intense fire” by the same means that created them. When a person, on their return journey, reaches the moment of their birth, only then are all those desires cleansed in the purifying flames, [pg 070] and from that point on, nothing holds them back from fully committing to the spiritual world. They enter a new phase of existence. Just as they shed their physical body at death and, shortly after, their etheric body, so does that part of their astral body dissolve which can only exist in the awareness of the outer physical world.
Occult science, therefore, recognizes three corpses,—the physical, etheric, and astral. The period at which the last is cast off by man is marked by the time of purification, which amounts to about one third of the time elapsed between birth and death. The reason why this is so can only be explained later, when the course of human life is examined from the standpoint of occult science. To clairvoyant observation, astral corpses, which have been cast off by human beings passing from the state of purification into a higher existence, are constantly visible in the world surrounding man, in exactly the same way that physical corpses, in places inhabited by men, are apparent to physical observation.6
Occult science identifies three types of bodies: the physical, etheric, and astral. The moment when a person sheds the last body is marked by a period of purification, which lasts about one-third of the time between birth and death. The reasoning behind this will be explained later, once we explore human life through the lens of occult science. To those with clairvoyant sight, astral bodies that have been released by individuals moving from the state of purification to a higher existence are continually visible in the environment around us, just as physical bodies are noticeable to our physical senses in areas where people live.6
After purification an entirely new state of consciousness begins for the ego. Whereas before death the outer perceptions must flow to the ego, in order that upon these perceptions the light of consciousness might be able to fall, so now in like manner from within, streams a world which attains consciousness. The ego is living in this world also between birth and death; only then this world [pg 071] is clothed in the manifestations of the senses. It is only when the ego, freed from all the ties of sense, turns inward to behold its own “holy of holies,” that its true innermost nature, which had hitherto been obscured by the senses, is revealed to it. In the same way that the ego is recognized inwardly before death, so, after death and purification, is the spiritual life inwardly revealed to it in all its fulness. This revelation really takes place immediately after the etheric body is laid aside; but it is obscured by the dark cloud of desires turned toward the outer world. It is as though a world of spiritual bliss were invaded by black demoniacal phantoms, caused by those desires which are being destroyed by the “consuming fire.” Indeed, these desires are not mere phantoms, but real entities, which become apparent immediately after the ego is deprived of physical organs, and is thus able to discern those things which are of a spiritual nature. These entities have the appearance of distorted caricatures of the objects with which the individual had formerly become acquainted through his senses.
After purification, the ego enters a completely new state of consciousness. Whereas before death the outer perceptions had to flow to the ego for the light of consciousness to shine upon them, now a world streams from within that gains consciousness. The ego exists in this world as well between birth and death; only then is this world wrapped in the manifestations of the senses. It’s only when the ego, free from all sensory attachments, turns inward to see its own “holy of holies” that its true innermost nature, which had previously been hidden by the senses, is revealed. Just as the ego is recognized inwardly before death, after death and purification, the spiritual life is inwardly revealed to it in all its fullness. This revelation actually occurs right after the etheric body is shed, but it’s clouded by the dark haze of desires directed toward the outer world. It’s as if a world of spiritual bliss is invaded by dark demonic phantoms created by the desires that are being consumed by the “consuming fire.” These desires aren’t just illusions; they are real entities that become visible once the ego is stripped of physical organs and can perceive what is spiritual. These entities appear as distorted caricatures of the objects the individual had previously known through the senses.
Clairvoyant observation shows that this place of purging fire is peopled by beings whose appearance may well seem horrifying and painful to spiritual vision, whose pleasure seems to consist in destruction, and whose passions impel them to evil-doing of such a description that the evil of the physical world seems insignificant in comparison. Whatever desires of the kind described above are brought into that world by man, are looked upon by these beings [pg 072] as food, by means of which their powers are continually strengthened and invigorated.
Clairvoyant observation reveals that this place of purging fire is inhabited by beings whose appearance may seem terrifying and painful to spiritual perception, whose pleasure appears to come from destruction, and whose emotions drive them to commit evil acts that make the physical world's evils seem trivial in comparison. Any desires of the kind mentioned above that a person brings into that world are seen by these beings as sustenance, through which their powers are constantly enhanced and revitalized. [pg 072]
The picture thus sketched of a world imperceptible to the senses may seem less incredible if we look with an unprejudiced eye on part of the animal world. What is a fierce, devouring wolf, from a spiritual point of view? What does it reveal to us through that which our senses perceive? Nothing else than a soul that lives in desires, and acts by desire. The external form of the wolf may be called an embodiment of those desires; and if man had no organs with which to perceive that form, if its desires appeared invisibly in their effects,—if, therefore, a force invisible to the eye were prowling about, and might be the cause of all that happened through the visible wolf,—he would still be forced to recognize the existence of a creature corresponding to it. Now the beings of the region of purifying fire are not visible to the physical eye, but to clairvoyant sight only; but their effects are clearly apparent. They bring about the destruction of the ego when it gives them nourishment. These effects are clearly visible if what began as a pleasure leads to excess and debauchery.
The image painted of a world unseen by our senses might not seem so unbelievable if we take an unbiased look at part of the animal kingdom. What is a fierce, predatory wolf, from a spiritual perspective? What does it show us through what we perceive with our senses? It's nothing more than a soul driven by desires, acting solely on those desires. The outward appearance of the wolf can be seen as a representation of those desires; and if humans had no way to perceive that form, if its desires were manifesting invisibly through their outcomes—if, in fact, an unseen force were lurking around, causing everything that happens through the visible wolf—people would still have to acknowledge the existence of a creature that correlates to it. The beings of the realm of purifying fire are not seen by the physical eye, only by clairvoyant sight; yet their effects are clearly noticeable. They lead to the destruction of the ego when it nourishes them. These effects become obvious when something that starts as a pleasure escalates into excess and indulgence.
For even what is perceptible to the senses would attract the ego only in so far as the pleasure had its root in the ego's own nature. The animal is prompted by desire for that in the outer world which its three bodies crave. Man has higher enjoyments, because to the three principles of his bodily nature is added the fourth, the ego. But if the ego seeks [pg 073] a gratification which does not tend toward the maintenance and development of its nature but to its destruction, then such a craving can be neither the effect of its three bodies, nor that of its own nature, but can only be caused by beings, concealed from the senses in their true form, but able furtively to approach that higher nature of the ego, and excite in it desires which, though it is cut off from the senses, can still be satisfied only by means of sense-organs.
For everything we can sense only attracts the ego as far as the pleasure comes from the ego itself. Animals are driven by their desires for what their three bodies need from the outside world. Humans experience higher pleasures because, in addition to the three principles of their physical nature, they have the fourth, the ego. However, if the ego seeks satisfaction that does not support its nature but instead harms it, then such a desire cannot stem from its three bodies or its true nature. It must come from beings hidden from our senses in their real form but capable of subtly affecting that higher nature of the ego and stirring up desires that, even though they are disconnected from the senses, can only be fulfilled through those senses.
For there are beings which feed on passions and desires of a worse kind than those of an animal nature, because they do not expend themselves on objects of the senses but seize upon the spiritual element and drag it down to a sensual level. Therefore the forms of such beings are more hideous, more horrible, to spiritual sight than are the forms of the fiercest animals, in which after all only passions rooted in the senses are incarnated. And the destructive forces of these beings immeasurably surpass any destructive rage existing in the animal world as perceived by the senses. Occult science must in this way enlarge man's view so as to include a world of beings standing, in a certain respect, lower than the visibly destructive animal world.
For there are beings that feed on passions and desires that are worse than those of animals because they don't focus on sensory objects but instead latch onto the spiritual element and pull it down to a more sensual level. As a result, the forms of these beings are more grotesque and terrifying to spiritual perception than the forms of the fiercest animals, which ultimately only represent passions rooted in the senses. The destructive powers of these beings far exceed any destructive rage found in the animal kingdom as experienced through the senses. Occult science must thus broaden humanity's perspective to include a realm of beings that are, in some ways, beneath the visible destructive animal world.
When man has passed through the world of purification after death, he finds himself in a world the contents of which are spiritual, and which also creates in him longings which can be satisfied only by spiritual things. But even now man distinguishes between that which properly belongs to his ego and what forms the environment of that ego—one might [pg 074] say, its spiritual outer world. Only that, of which he becomes sensible in this environment, pours in upon him in the same way that the perception of his own ego poured in upon him during his sojourn in the body. Whereas man's environment in the life between birth and death speaks to him through his bodily organs, after death when all the bodies are laid aside the language of his new environment penetrates directly into the innermost sanctuary of the ego. Man's whole environment is now filled with beings of a like nature with his ego, for only an ego has access to an ego. Just as minerals, plants, and animals surround man in the sense-world, and compose it, so, after death, is he surrounded by a world composed of beings of a spiritual nature.
When a person has gone through the purification process after death, they find themselves in a realm filled with spiritual elements, which stirs in them desires that can only be fulfilled by spiritual things. Even at this point, a person differentiates between what truly belongs to their inner self and what makes up the surroundings of that self—one could say, its spiritual external world. Only what they can perceive in this environment resonates with them just like the awareness of their own self did while they were alive. While a person's surroundings in life speak to them through their physical senses, after death, when all physical bodies are shed, the language of their new environment reaches directly into the deepest part of their being. Their entire environment is now filled with beings that share the same nature as their inner self, because only the inner self can connect with another inner self. Just as minerals, plants, and animals make up the physical world around a person, after death, they are surrounded by a realm consisting of spiritual beings.
Yet he takes something with him into this world which is not part of his environment there; it is what the ego has experienced in the world of the senses. First of all, the sum of these experiences appeared, as a comprehensive memory-picture, immediately after death, while the etheric body was still united to the ego. The etheric body itself is then, indeed, laid aside, but something of the memory-picture remains with the ego as an everlasting possession. Just as though an extract or essence were made out of all the events and experiences which a man encounters between birth and death, so might we describe that which is left behind. It is the spiritual product of life, its fruit. This product is of a spiritual nature. It contains everything spiritual which is revealed through the senses, yet this spiritual [pg 075] treasure could not have been gathered save by life in the sense-world.
Yet he brings something into this world that isn't part of his environment there; it’s what the ego has experienced in the world of the senses. First, the totality of these experiences appeared, as a complete memory image, right after death, while the etheric body was still connected to the ego. The etheric body itself is then set aside, but some of the memory image remains with the ego as a lasting possession. Just as if an extract or essence were created from all the events and experiences a person goes through between birth and death, we might describe what is left behind. It is the spiritual product of life, its fruit. This product is spiritual in nature. It contains everything spiritual that is revealed through the senses, yet this spiritual treasure could only have been gathered through living in the sensory world.
This spiritual fruit of the sense-world becomes after death the ego's own inner world. With it the ego enters a world, which consists of beings who reveal themselves in the same and only manner in which man in his innermost depths, can become conscious of his own ego. As a plant seed, which is the essence of the whole plant, grows only when buried in another world, the earth, so now that which the ego brings from the sense-world gradually unfolds itself as a seed under the influence of the spiritual environment in which it has been planted. Occult science can, of course, only portray in pictures what happens in this “spirit-world;” still those pictures present themselves as absolute reality to the clairvoyant's sight, when he investigates invisible happenings, corresponding to those which are visible to the physical eye. Whatever of that world can be described, may be visualized by comparison with the world of the senses for although it is of a purely spiritual nature, it nevertheless resembles the physical world in certain respects. Just as, for instance, in the physical world, a color appears when some object impresses the eye, so in the spirit-world a color appears to the ego when a being acts upon it. But this latter phenomenon is perceived in the same manner as the ego can be perceived inwardly between birth and death. It is not as though the light outside fell within upon the man, but as though another being directly affected [pg 076] the ego, causing the latter to picture this influence in a colour-form.
This spiritual aspect of the sensory world becomes the ego's inner world after death. With it, the ego enters a realm filled with beings that reveal themselves in the same way that a person, at their core, becomes aware of their own ego. Just as a plant seed, which contains the essence of the entire plant, grows when buried in another world, the earth, what the ego brings from the sensory world gradually develops like a seed under the influence of the spiritual environment where it has been planted. Of course, occult science can only depict through images what occurs in this "spiritual realm;" yet these images present themselves as absolute reality to the clairvoyant’s vision when they explore invisible events similar to those seen by the physical eye. Any aspect of that world that can be described can be imagined by comparing it to the sensory world, for although it is purely spiritual, it still resembles the physical world in certain ways. For example, just as a color appears in the physical world when an object impacts the eye, in the spirit-world, a color appears to the ego when a being acts upon it. However, this phenomenon is perceived in the same way that the ego can be perceived inwardly between birth and death. It’s not as if external light enters the person, but rather as if another being directly impacts the ego, causing it to envision this influence in a color form.
Thus do all things in the spiritual environment of the ego find expression in a world of coloured rays. As their origin is of a different kind, it goes without saying that these colours of the spiritual world are also of a somewhat different character from physical colours. A similar thing is true of other impressions received by man in the world of sense. But it is the sounds of the spiritual world that most nearly resemble the impressions of the sense-world; and the more at home a man becomes in the spiritual world, the more he realizes it as a life of self-determined motion, which may be compared with the sounds, and the harmony of sounds, of the physical world. Only he does not feel the tones as something approaching an organ from outside, but as a force streaming forth into the outer world through his ego. He feels the sound just as in the sense-world he feels his own speech or song, only he knows that in the spiritual world these sounds, streaming out from him, are at the same time the manifestations of other beings, who are pouring themselves into the world through him.
Thus, everything in the spiritual realm of the ego expresses itself in a world of colored rays. Since their origin is different, it’s clear that these colors of the spiritual world are also somewhat different in nature from physical colors. The same is true for other impressions that humans perceive in the sensory world. However, it’s the sounds of the spiritual world that most closely resemble the impressions of the sensory world; and the more comfortable a person becomes in the spiritual realm, the more they experience it as a life of self-determined motion, which can be compared to the sounds and harmonies of the physical world. But instead of feeling these tones as something external approaching him, he experiences them as a force flowing into the outer world through his ego. He perceives sound just as he does his own speech or song in the sensory world, but he understands that in the spiritual realm, these sounds flowing from him are simultaneously manifestations of other beings who are expressing themselves through him.
A still higher manifestation takes place in the spirit-land when the sound becomes the “spiritual word.” Then there streams through the ego not only the pulsing life of another spiritual being, but such a being itself communicates its own inner nature to the ego; and then, when the spiritual word streams through the ego, two beings live in one another, [pg 077] without that separating element which every companionship in the sense-world must carry with it. And this is really the nature of the communion of the ego with other spiritual beings after death.
A higher manifestation occurs in the spirit world when sound becomes the “spiritual phrase.” At that point, not only does the essence of another spiritual being flow into the ego, but that being also shares its inner nature with the ego. When the spiritual word flows through the ego, two beings exist within each other, [pg 077] without the separating element that every relationship in the physical world must have. This is, in fact, the essence of the connection between the ego and other spiritual beings after death.
There are three regions in the spiritual world, which may be compared to the three divisions of the physical sense-world. The first region is in a certain respect the “solid land” of the spiritual world, the second the “sphere of ocean and river,” and the third the “atmospheric region.” That which assumes physical form on earth, so that it can be perceived by physical organs, in accordance with its spiritual nature, is to be seen in the first region of the spirit-world. There, for instance, may be seen the force that fashions the form of a crystal. Only what is there revealed is the opposite of that which appears in the sense-world. In that world the space which is filled by a mass of rock appears to spiritual sight as a kind of hollow space; but round about this hollow is seen the force which fashions the form of the rock. The colour of the rock in the sense-world appears in the spiritual world as its complementary colour; thus a red stone is green when seen from the spirit-world, a green stone is red, and so on. Other qualities also appear in their opposites. Just as stone, masses of earth, and like materials make up the solid land—the continental region of the world of sense—so do the structures described above compose the solid land of the spiritual world.
There are three regions in the spiritual world, which can be compared to the three parts of the physical world. The first region is, in a way, the “solid ground” of the spiritual world, the second is the “ocean and river sphere,” and the third is the "atmospheric zone." What takes on physical form on earth, so it can be perceived by our physical senses, corresponds to its spiritual nature and is found in the first region of the spirit world. For example, here you can see the force that shapes the form of a crystal. However, what is revealed there is the opposite of what appears in the physical world. In that realm, the space occupied by a solid rock appears to spiritual vision as a kind of hollow space, but surrounding this hollow is the force that shapes the rock. The color of the rock in the physical world appears in the spiritual world as its complementary color; for instance, a red stone looks green when viewed from the spirit world, a green stone looks red, and so on. Other qualities also show up in their opposites. Just as stones, earth masses, and similar materials make up the solid land—the continental region of the physical world—so do the structures described above form the solid land of the spiritual world.
All that is life in the sense-world belongs to the ocean-region of the spiritual world. To the physical [pg 078] eye, life appears in its effects in plants, animals, and men. To spiritual vision, life is a flowing substance, like oceans and rivers, diffused through the spirit-world. A still better comparison is that of the circulation of the blood in the body; for whereas seas and rivers are seen to be irregularly distributed in the physical world, a certain regularity in distribution of the flowing life reigns in the spirit-world, as in the circulation of the blood. This “flowing life” is simultaneously heard as spiritual sound.
All that exists in the physical world belongs to the vast ocean of the spiritual realm. To our physical eyes, life is evident through its effects in plants, animals, and humans. However, to a spiritual perspective, life is like a flowing substance, similar to oceans and rivers, spread throughout the spirit world. An even better analogy is the circulation of blood in the body; while seas and rivers appear unevenly distributed in the physical world, there is a certain regularity in how life flows within the spirit world, just like blood circulation. This "fluid life" can also be perceived as a spiritual sound.
The third region of the spirit-world is its “atmosphere.” What is known in the physical world as “feeling” is also present there, permeating everything like the air on the earth. We must imagine a rushing sea of feeling. Pain and sorrow, joy and rapture, flow through this region, like wind and storms in the atmosphere of the physical world. Imagine a battle fought on earth. There confront one another not merely human forms, as seen by the physical eye, but feelings opposed to feelings, passions to passions; pain fills the battlefield just as much as do the forms of men. All that is seething there of passion, pain, and the joy of victory is not only perceptible in its effects as revealed to the physical senses; it may be seen with the spiritual senses as an atmospheric process in the spirit-world. Such an event in the spiritual world is like a thunderstorm in the physical, and the perception of these events may be compared to the hearing of words in the physical world. For this reason it is said that as the air envelops and permeates earthly things, [pg 079] so do “interweaving spiritual words” pervade the beings and events of the spirit-world.
The third area of the spirit world is its "vibe." What we refer to as "vibe" in the physical world is also present there, flowing through everything like air on earth. We need to envision a surging sea of emotions. Pain and sorrow, joy and ecstasy, sweep through this realm, like winds and storms in the atmosphere of the physical world. Picture a battle happening on earth. There, not only human figures confront each other as seen by the physical eye, but also feelings battling against feelings, passions clashing with passions; pain fills the battlefield just as much as the forms of people do. Everything that boils over with passion, pain, and the thrill of victory is not just noticeable through its effects on the physical senses; it can also be observed through spiritual senses as a process in the spirit world. Such an event in the spiritual world is like a thunderstorm in the physical world, and perceiving these events can be likened to hearing words in the physical realm. For this reason, it is said that just as air surrounds and permeates earthly matters, “blending spiritual words” fill the beings and events of the spirit world.
And still further observations are possible in this spirit-world. What may be compared to light and heat in the physical world is there too. That which permeates everything in the spirit-world, as earthly things and beings are permeated by heat, is the world of thought itself. There, however, thoughts must be regarded as living and independent beings. What is understood by man in the manifested world as thought is but a shadow of what lives as a thought-being in the spirit-world. Imagine thought, as it now exists in man, raised out of him and as an active, energetic being, endowed with an inner life of its own, and you have a feeble illustration of that which fills the fourth region of the spirit-world. In the physical world between birth and death what man understands as thought is but the manifestation of the thought-world as it is able to mould itself by means of the instruments afforded by the bodies. All such thoughts cherished by man, that carry with them an enrichment of the physical world have their origin in this region. By such thoughts are meant not only the ideas of great inventors and men of genius; but those ideas found in every individual which he does not owe solely to the external world, but through which he, so to speak, transforms that world.
Further observations can still be made in this spirit world. What can be compared to light and heat in the physical world exists there as well. What fills everything in the spirit world, just as earthly things and beings are filled with heat, is the world of thought itself. However, in that realm, thoughts should be viewed as living, independent entities. What people understand as thought in the physical world is merely a shadow of what lives as a thought-being in the spirit world. Imagine thought, as it currently exists in a person, being lifted out of them and functioning as an active, energetic being with its own inner life, and you get a faint idea of what fills the fourth region of the spirit world. In the physical world, between birth and death, what we understand as thought is just the manifestation of the thought-world as it can shape itself using the tools provided by our bodies. All such thoughts embraced by people that enrich the physical world originate in this region. These thoughts are not just the ideas of great inventors and geniuses; they also include the ideas found in every individual that are not solely derived from the external world but through which they, in a sense, transform that world.
In so far as feelings and passions are concerned, the cause of which lies in the outer world, these feelings are perceptible in the third region of the spirit-world; [pg 080] but everything which so lives in a man's soul as to make him a creator,—influencing, transforming and fertilizing his environment,—is manifest in its original and intrinsic form in the fourth division of the spirit-world.
As far as feelings and passions go, which come from the outside world, these emotions can be seen in the third area of the spirit world; [pg 080] but everything that lives in a person's soul enough to turn them into a creator—shaping, changing, and enriching their surroundings—exists in its original and true form in the fourth area of the spirit world.
That which exists in the fifth region may be compared to physical light. In its archetypal form it is wisdom in manifestation. Beings who diffuse wisdom throughout their surroundings, as the sun pours light on physical beings, belong to this realm. Whatever is illuminated by their wisdom stands forth in its true meaning and significance for the spiritual world, just as the colour of a physical object is seen when the light falls upon it. There are still higher regions of the spirit-world, which will be described later in this work.
That which exists in the fifth region can be compared to physical light. In its original form, it is wisdom in action. Beings who spread wisdom in their environment, just like the sun spreads light on physical beings, belong to this realm. Anything illuminated by their wisdom reveals its true meaning and significance for the spiritual world, just as the color of a physical object is seen when light shines on it. There are even higher areas of the spirit world that will be described later in this work.
Into this world the ego is plunged after death, together with the results it carries with it out of physical life. And these results are still united with that part of the astral body which is not cast off at the end of the time of purification. In fact, only that part falls away which, in its desires and wishes, turned, after death, toward physical life. The plunging of the ego into the spiritual world, with what it has acquired in the physical world, may be compared to the planting of a grain of seed in the soil in which it can mature. As the grain of seed draws substances and forces from its surroundings in order that it may develop into a new plant, so the condition of the ego, when implanted in the spiritual world, is one of development and growth.
After death, the ego enters this world, bringing along the outcomes of its physical existence. These outcomes are still connected to the part of the astral body that remains after the purification period. Only the part that yearned for physical life is discarded. The ego’s immersion into the spiritual realm, along with what it has gained in the physical world, can be likened to planting a seed in soil where it can grow. Just as the seed absorbs nutrients and energy from its environment to develop into a new plant, the ego, once situated in the spiritual world, is in a state of development and growth.
Hidden within that which is perceived by an organ, there lies the force whereby that same organ was formed. The eye perceives light; but without light there would be no eye. Creatures spending their lives in darkness do not develop organs of sight. Thus the whole of man's physical body is created out of the hidden forces of that of which he becomes conscious through his bodily organs. The physical body is built up by the forces of the physical world, the etheric body by those of the life-world, and the astral body is formed out of the astral world. Now when the ego is transferred to the spirit-world it is met by just those forces which remain hidden to physical perception.
Hidden within what we perceive with our senses, there exists the force that shaped those very senses. The eye sees light, but without light, the eye wouldn't exist. Creatures that live in darkness don't develop sight. Similarly, the entirety of a person's physical body is formed from the hidden forces of what they become aware of through their senses. The physical body is constructed by the forces of the physical world, the etheric body by those of the life-world, and the astral body is created from the astral world. When the ego moves to the spirit-world, it encounters those forces that remain unseen to physical perception.
What appear to man's view in the first region of the spirit-world are the spiritual beings that are always surrounding him, and that have built up his physical body. Thus in the physical world man perceives nothing but the manifestations of those spiritual forces which have formed his own physical body. After death he is in the very midst of these moulding forces, which, previously hidden, now appear to him in their true forms. In the same way, in the second region, he is in the midst of the forces by which his etheric body was organized, and in the third region there pour in upon him the potencies out of which his astral body was formed. The higher regions of the spirit-world also direct toward him those forces from which he was built in the life between birth and death.
What a person sees in the first area of the spirit world are the spiritual beings that are always around them and that have shaped their physical body. So, in the physical world, a person perceives only the manifestations of those spiritual forces that created their own body. After death, they find themselves right in the middle of these shaping forces, which were previously hidden and now reveal their true forms. Similarly, in the second area, they are surrounded by the forces that organized their etheric body, and in the third area, they are immersed in the energies that formed their astral body. The higher regions of the spirit world also send them the forces responsible for their existence during their life between birth and death.
These denizens of the spiritual world are at present [pg 082] working in co-operation with that which man has brought with him as the product of his last life, which now becomes a germ; and through this co-operation man is, first of all, built up anew as a spiritual being. The physical and etheric bodies are still joined in sleep; the astral body and the ego are, it is true, outside them, but still connected with them. Whatever influences the astral body and the ego receive, in such a state, from the spiritual world, can serve only to recuperate the forces exhausted during the waking state.
These inhabitants of the spiritual world are currently [pg 082] collaborating with what a person has brought from their previous life, which now becomes a seed; and through this collaboration, the individual is, first and foremost, rebuilt as a spiritual being. The physical and etheric bodies are still linked during sleep; the astral body and the ego are, indeed, outside of them, but still connected to them. Any influences the astral body and the ego receive, during this state, from the spiritual world can only help restore the energies depleted during waking hours.
But when the physical and etheric bodies have been laid aside, and, after the time of purification, also those parts of the astral body still bound by their desires to the physical world, then everything pouring in upon the ego from the spiritual world is not only a reforming but a reorganizing force. After a certain period, to be dealt with in later chapters, the ego again gathers round it an astral body which will be able to live in such an etheric and physical body as man possesses between birth and death. A man can once more pass through birth and renew his earthly existence, in which, however, will be incorporated the results of his former life. Until the rebuilding of his astral body, man is a witness of his reconstruction. As the powers of the spirit-world are not manifested to him through external organs, but from within outward, like his own ego in self-consciousness, he is able to observe that manifestation as long as his attention is not turned to an outer world of perception. But from the moment [pg 083] that the astral body is reconstituted, his attention is turned outward; the astral body once more craves an outer etheric and physical body. It is thus turned away from the inner revelations. For this reason there is now an intermediate state, during which man is immersed in unconsciousness. Consciousness can emerge again in the physical world only when the necessary organs for physical perception are formed.
But when the physical and etheric bodies are set aside, and after a period of purification, those parts of the astral body still attached to the physical world are also released, everything that flows into the ego from the spiritual world acts not only as a reforming force but also as a reorganizing one. After a certain period, which will be discussed in later chapters, the ego gathers around it an astral body that can exist within the etheric and physical body that humans have between birth and death. A person can once again undergo birth and renew their earthly existence, which will incorporate the experiences from their previous life. Until the astral body is rebuilt, a person observes their own reconstruction. Since the powers of the spiritual world aren't perceived through external organs, but rather from within, like their self-awareness, they can witness this manifestation as long as their focus isn't directed toward the external world of perception. However, once the astral body is reformed, their attention shifts outward; the astral body again desires an outer etheric and physical body. This causes a departure from inner revelations. Therefore, there exists an intermediate state during which a person is enveloped in unconsciousness. Consciousness can only re-emerge in the physical world once the necessary organs for physical perception are developed.
During this period, in which consciousness illuminated by inner perception ceases, the new etheric body begins to link itself to the astral and man can once again enter a physical body. In the linking together of these two bodies only such an ego could consciously take part as had of itself created the Life-Spirit and Spirit-Man out of the creative forces, hidden in the etheric and physical bodies. Until the individual has evolved as far as this, beings further advanced than himself in evolution must guide this linking together. The astral body is guided, by such beings as these, to parents through whom it may be endowed with the appropriate etheric and physical bodies. Before the attachment of the etheric body takes place, something of very great importance happens to the man who is about to re-enter physical existence.
During this time, when awareness illuminated by inner perception fades, the new etheric body starts to connect with the astral body, allowing a person to enter a physical body again. In this connection of the two bodies, only an ego that has created the Life-Spirit and Spirit-Man from the creative forces hidden in the etheric and physical bodies can consciously participate. Until an individual evolves to this point, more advanced beings in evolution must guide this connection. The astral body is directed by these beings to parents who will provide it with the suitable etheric and physical bodies. Before the etheric body attaches, something very significant happens to the person who is about to re-enter physical existence.
In his former life he created disturbing forces, which were revealed to him on the journey retraced after death. Let us again take an example. He caused some pain in an outburst of anger in the fortieth year of his former life. After death, [pg 084] the other's pain came before him as a force which had interfered with the evolution of his ego. It is likewise with all such events of his former life. On his re-entrance into physical life these hindrances to his evolution confront the ego anew. As, on the threshold of death, a sort of memory-picture arose before the human ego, so there now arises a vision of the life approaching. Again he sees a picture, this time showing all the obstacles which he has to clear away, if he is to advance in evolution. And what he thus sees becomes the starting-point for forces which he must bring with him into his new life. The picture of the pain he has caused the other man becomes a force which impels the ego, on entering life again, to make amends for this pain. Thus the previous life has a determining effect on the new one. The deeds of the new life are in a certain way caused by those of the former life. This connection, following the law, between an earlier and later existence is to be looked upon as the “Law of Destiny”; it has become usual to designate it “Karma,” a term borrowed from oriental wisdom.
In his previous life, he created troubling forces that were revealed to him during his journey after death. Let’s look at an example again. He caused some pain in a moment of anger during the fortieth year of his past life. After death, [pg 084] the pain he caused appeared to him as a force that disrupted his ego's growth. This applies to all similar events from his former life. When he returns to physical life, these obstacles to his evolution confront his ego once more. Just as a kind of memory-pictures emerged at the brink of death, now a vision of the life ahead unfolds. Once again, he sees a picture, this time showing all the challenges he must overcome if he wants to progress in his evolution. What he sees becomes the starting point for the energies he must carry with him into his new life. The image of the pain he caused another person transforms into a force that drives his ego, upon re-entering life, to make amends for that pain. Thus, the previous life significantly affects the new one. The actions taken in the new life are somewhat dictated by those from the former life. This connection, which follows the law between an earlier and a later existence, is known as the "Law of Fate"; it has become common to refer to it as "Karma" a term taken from Eastern wisdom.
The building up of a new set of bodies, however, is not the only task incumbent upon man between death and a new birth. While this building up is taking place, man lives outside the physical world. That world, however, continues to evolve during this time. The surface of the earth changes in comparatively short periods of time. What aspect did those regions which are now occupied by Germany bear a [pg 085] few thousand years ago? When man appears on earth in a new existence, the earth rarely looks the same as it did at the time of his last incarnation. During his absence from the earth all sorts of changes have occurred. Now hidden forces are also at work in this alteration of the face of the earth, proceeding from that very world in which man finds himself after death; and he himself must co-operate with these forces in the transformation of the earth. He can do so only under the direction of Higher Beings until, by the creation of his Life-Spirit and Spirit-Man, he has acquired a clear perception of the connection between the spiritual and its expression in the physical. But he takes part in the transformation of earthly conditions. It may be said that during the period between death and a new birth, man so transforms the earth that its conditions are in keeping with what he has evolved in himself. If we look at a given place on the earth at a definite moment, and see it again after a long lapse of time, under entirely changed conditions, the forces which have wrought the change have proceeded from those who are now dead. And it is this kind of connection which exists between them and the earth until the time of rebirth.
Building a new set of bodies, however, isn’t the only task facing a person between death and rebirth. While this construction takes place, a person exists outside the physical world. However, that world continues to evolve during this time. The surface of the earth undergoes changes in relatively short periods. What did the areas now known as Germany look like a few thousand years ago? When a person returns to earth in a new life, the earth rarely looks the same as it did during their last life. During their absence, all kinds of changes have occurred. Hidden forces are also at work in this transformation of the earth, coming from the very world where a person finds themselves after death; and they must collaborate with these forces in the earth’s transformation. They can only do this under the guidance of Higher Beings until, through the creation of their Life-Spirit and Spirit-Man, they gain a clear understanding of the connection between the spiritual and its expression in the physical. But they do take part in transforming earthly conditions. It can be said that during the time between death and rebirth, a person transforms the earth so that its conditions align with what they have evolved within themselves. If we observe a certain place on earth at a specific moment and then look at it again after a long time, under entirely different conditions, the forces that brought about the change have come from those who have now passed away. This kind of connection exists between them and the earth until the time of rebirth.
Clairvoyant observation sees in all physical existence the manifestation of a hidden spiritual element. To physical observation it is the light of the sun, climatic changes, and so on, that effect the transformation of the earth, but to clairvoyance it is the force of the dead that acts in the rays of light which [pg 086] fall on the plant from the sun. The clairvoyant sees how human souls hover about plants, how they change the surface of the earth. Not alone upon himself nor upon the preparations for his own new earthly existence, is man's attention bestowed after death.—No, he is called upon then to work upon the outer world, just as he is in life between the time of his birth and death.
Clairvoyant observation perceives in all physical existence the expression of a hidden spiritual element. To the ordinary observer, it's the sunlight, weather changes, and so on that bring about the transformation of the earth. However, to the clairvoyant, it's the force of the deceased that influences the rays of light falling on the plants from the sun. The clairvoyant observes how human souls linger around plants, altering the surface of the earth. After death, a person's focus isn't solely on themselves or their preparations for a new earthly existence. No, they are called to engage with the outer world, just as they do in life between the time of their birth and death.
Not only does the life of man affect the conditions of the physical world from the spirit-land; but vice versa, activity during physical existence has its effects in the spiritual world. An example may explain what happens in this respect. A bond of love exists between mother and child. This love arises from a mutual attraction caused by the forces of the sense-world. But in the course of time it changes. A spiritual tie gradually grows out of the sense-bond, and this spiritual tie is not created for the physical world only but for the spirit-world as well. The same applies to other ties. Whatever is created in the physical world by spiritual entities continues to exist in the spiritual world. Friends who were closely united in life belong to each other in spirit-land also, and when their bodies are laid aside they are in much more intimate communion than during physical life. For as spirits they exist for each other in the same way as, in the above description, spiritual beings reveal themselves to others by inner manifestation; and a tie created between two persons brings them together again in a new life. [pg 087] Thus in the truest sense of the word we may speak of finding one another again after death.
Not only does a person's life impact the conditions of the physical world from the spirit realm, but the opposite is also true: actions taken during physical existence have effects in the spiritual world. An example can clarify what happens in this regard. A bond of love exists between a mother and her child. This love comes from a mutual attraction created by the forces of the sensory world. However, over time, it transforms. A spiritual connection gradually develops from the sensory bond, and this spiritual connection is not meant just for the physical world, but also for the spirit world. The same applies to other relationships. Whatever is formed in the physical world by spiritual beings continues to exist in the spiritual realm. Friends who were closely connected in life remain linked in the spirit world too, and when their physical bodies are gone, they share an even deeper communion than they did during their physical existence. As spirits, they exist for each other in the same way that spiritual beings reveal themselves to others through inner manifestation; and a bond created between two people brings them back together in a new life. [pg 087] Thus, in the truest sense, we can speak of finding each other again after death.
What has once happened to a man between birth and death and from then till a new birth, repeats itself. Man returns to earth again and again when the fruit he has earned in a physical life has ripened in the spirit-world. It is not, however, a case of repetition without beginning or end; but man has emerged out of other forms of existence and passed into those which run their course in the manner just described, and he will again in the future pass into other forms. A viewpoint of these transition stages will be gained when the evolution of the universe in connection with man is subsequently considered from the standpoint of occult science.
What has happened to a person between birth and death, and from then until a new birth, happens again. People come back to earth repeatedly when the results of their physical life have matured in the spiritual realm. However, this isn’t just a cycle with no beginning or end; rather, people have come from different forms of existence and will move into new ones that follow this pattern. We’ll gain a better understanding of these transitional stages when we look at the evolution of the universe in relation to humanity from the perspective of occult science.
The occurrences between death and a new birth are of course still more concealed from outer sense-observation than is the spiritual foundation underlying manifested life between birth and death. This sense-observation can see only the effects of that portion of the hidden world where they impinge upon physical existence. With regard to this the question must arise whether man, on entering this life at birth, brings with him any results from the events described by occult science as having taken place between his last death and re-birth. If one finds the shell of a snail in which there is no trace of the animal he will, in spite of that, recognize that this snailshell was formed by the activity of an animal, and he cannot believe that the shell constructed a form for itself, by means of mere physical forces.
The events between death and rebirth are even less visible to our external observations than the spiritual foundation that underlies our lives between birth and death. Our senses can only perceive the effects of the hidden world where it interacts with physical existence. This raises the question of whether a person, upon entering this life at birth, carries with them any outcomes from the experiences described by occult science that took place between their last death and rebirth. For example, if you find a snail shell that shows no signs of the animal, you still recognize that the shell was created by the activity of a snail, and you cannot believe that the shell came into being solely through physical forces.
In the same way one who studies a man during life, and finds something in him which cannot be due to this life, might reasonably admit that it arises from what occult science describes, if by doing so an explanatory light is thrown on what is otherwise inexplicable.
In the same way, someone who studies a person during their life and discovers something in them that can't be attributed solely to this life might reasonably conclude that it comes from what occult science describes, especially if this perspective sheds light on things that are otherwise hard to understand.
Here, too, the unseen causes might appear intelligible to rational sense-observation from their visible effects, and whoever observes life with absolute impartiality will find that, with every fresh observation, this appears to be more and more true. The important question, however, is how to find the right point of view from which to observe their effects in life. Where, for example, are the effects of that to be found which occult science describes as incidents of the time of purification? How are the effects of the experience which, according to occult investigations, man undergoes in purely spiritual regions, manifested after this time of purification?
Here, too, the unseen causes might seem understandable to rational observation based on their visible effects, and anyone who looks at life with complete impartiality will find that, with each new observation, this seems to be increasingly true. The key question, however, is how to find the right perspective from which to observe their effects in life. For instance, where can we find the effects that occult science describes as events during the time of purification? How are the effects of the experiences that, according to occult studies, a person goes through in purely spiritual realms revealed after this time of purification?
Problems enough press upon every serious and profound student of life in this domain. We see one man born in want and misery, endowed only with inferior abilities, so that on account of these facts, which are incident to his birth, he appears predestined to a miserable existence. Another, from the first moment of his life, is tended and cherished by loving hands and hearts; brilliant talents are unfolded in him; his gifts point to a successful and satisfactory career. Two opposite views may be taken when met by such questions as these. The [pg 089] one will adhere to what the senses perceive and what the understanding, relying on these senses, is able to comprehend. This view will admit no problem in the fact that one man is born fortunate and the other unfortunate. Even if the word “chance” is not used, there will be no question of thinking that such things are brought about through any law of cause and effect. And with regard to talents and abilities, such a view will consider them as “inherited” from parents, grandparents, and other ancestors. It refuses to seek the causes in spiritual events which the man himself met with before birth—regardless of heredity—and by means of which he shaped his talents and abilities.
Every serious and thoughtful student of life faces many challenges in this area. We see one person born into poverty and suffering, with only limited abilities, so due to these circumstances of his birth, he seems destined for a miserable life. In contrast, another person, from the very start, is nurtured and cared for by loving hands and hearts; his brilliant talents are nurtured, and his gifts suggest a successful and fulfilling career. There are two opposing perspectives when confronted with such questions. One perspective relies on what the senses perceive and what the mind can understand based on those perceptions. This view sees no issue with the fact that one person is born lucky and another is unlucky. Even without using the word “chance,” it doesn’t question whether these situations arise from any law of cause and effect. Regarding talents and abilities, this perspective considers them as “inherited” from parents, grandparents, and other ancestors. It refuses to look for causes in spiritual experiences that the person may have encountered before birth—independent of heredity—and that shaped his talents and abilities.
Another view would find no satisfaction in such an interpretation. It would assert that even in the manifested world nothing happens in definite places or surroundings without our having to presuppose causes for the event in question. Even though in many cases such causes have not yet been investigated, they are there. An Alpine flower does not grow in the lowlands. Its nature has something which associates it with Alpine regions. Just so must there be something in a man which determines his birth in a certain environment. Causes belonging to the physical world alone are not sufficient to account for this. To a more profound thinker such an explanation appears in somewhat the same light as when one has dealt another a blow, the motive for which is not attributed to the feelings of the one but is to be explained by the physical mechanism of the hand.
Another perspective would find no satisfaction in such an interpretation. It would argue that even in the visible world, nothing occurs in specific places or settings without us having to assume causes for the event in question. Even though in many cases these causes haven't been investigated yet, they exist. An Alpine flower doesn't grow in the lowlands. Its nature is tied to Alpine regions. Similarly, there must be something in a person that determines their birth in a particular environment. Causes that belong only to the physical world aren't enough to explain this. To a deeper thinker, such an explanation is viewed similarly to when someone strikes another person, with the motive not attributed to the person's feelings but explained by the physical action of the hand.
Any explanation of abilities and talents solely by “heredity” is to such a viewpoint equally unsatisfactory. It is true one may say: “See how certain talents are inherited in families.” During two and a half centuries musical talents were inherited by members of the Bach family. Eight mathematicians sprang from the Bernoulli family, to some of whom quite different occupations were assigned in their childhood; but the inherited talents always drove them to the family vocation. It may be further pointed out how, by an exact investigation of the line of ancestry of a person in one way or another the gifts of this person have shown themselves in the forefathers, and only represent the sum of inherited talents. Whoever holds the latter of the two views above indicated will be sure not to let such facts pass unnoticed, but to him they cannot mean the same as they do to one who relies for his interpretation on the events of the world of sense alone. The former will point out that inherited talents can no more of themselves, combine into a complete personality than can the metal parts of a watch fit themselves together. And if objection is made that the co-operation of the parents may possibly produce the combination of talents,—that this as it were, takes the place of the watchmaker,—he will reply: “Look impartially at what is new in every child-personality, at that which is absolutely new; that cannot come from the parents, for the simple reason that it does not exist in them.”
Any explanation of abilities and talents based solely on genetics is equally unsatisfying from this perspective. It’s true that someone might say: "Check out how some talents run in families." For two and a half centuries, musical talents were passed through the Bach family. Eight mathematicians emerged from the Bernoulli family, some of whom were assigned completely different careers in their childhood; yet, their inherited talents always led them back to the family profession. It can also be noted that, through a thorough investigation of a person's ancestry, one can see how the gifts of that person have been reflected in their forebears, representing just the sum of inherited talents. Those who subscribe to the latter of the two viewpoints will certainly take note of such facts, but to him, they won't hold the same meaning as they do for one who relies solely on the physical events of the world. The former will argue that inherited talents cannot alone combine into a complete personality any more than the metal parts of a watch can assemble themselves. If someone counters that the collaboration of the parents could create this combination of talents—essentially acting as the watchmaker—he would respond: "Take an objective look at what makes each child's personality unique, at what is completely new; it can't come from the parents because it doesn't exist in them."
Inaccurate thinking may create much confusion [pg 091] in this domain. It is still worse when those who hold the second view are set down by the supporters of the first as opponents of what is, after all, borne out by “ascertained facts.” But it may well be that the latter have not the slightest intention of denying the truth or value of those facts. For instance, they see that a definite mental aptitude or predisposition is “inherited” in a family, and that certain gifts accumulated and combined in one descendant result in a remarkable personality. They are perfectly willing to acquiesce when it is said that the most celebrated name seldom stands at the beginning but at the end of a line of descent. But it should not be taken amiss if they are compelled to form very different opinions on the subject from those of people who are determined to accept nothing but material evidence. To the latter it may be said that it is true a man shows the characteristics of his ancestors, because the “spirit-soul”, which enters upon physical existence at birth, draws its bodily substance from that which heredity bestows on it. But this says nothing more than that a being shows the peculiarities of the body into which it has descended.
Inaccurate thinking can cause a lot of confusion [pg 091] in this area. It’s even worse when supporters of one viewpoint label those who hold a different perspective as opponents of what is, after all, supported by "verified facts." However, the latter may not intend to deny the truth or importance of those facts at all. For example, they observe that certain mental traits or predispositions are "gotten from parents" within a family, and that specific abilities accumulated and combined in one descendant lead to a remarkable personality. They are perfectly okay with the notion that the most famous names usually come at the end of a family tree rather than the beginning. But it's not unreasonable for them to have very different views on the topic compared to those who insist on accepting only material evidence. To the latter, it can be said that it is true a person displays traits of their ancestors because the “soul”, which enters physical existence at birth, draws its physical essence from what heredity provides. But this simply means that a being displays the characteristics of the body into which it has incarnated.
It is no doubt a singular—a trivial—comparison, but the unprejudiced person will not deny its justification, when one says that a human being, who shows the qualities of his forefathers, proves the origin of the personal qualities of that human being as little as the fact that man is wet because he has fallen into the water, proves something regarding [pg 092] his inner nature. And it may further be said that if the most celebrated name stands at the end of a line of family descent, it shows that the bearer of that name needed that particular ancestry to build the body necessary for the expression of his whole personality. But it is no proof that his actual personal qualities were transmitted to him: such a statement is, on the contrary, opposed to sound logic. If personal gifts were inherited, they would be found at the beginning of a line of descent,7 and starting from that point be transmitted to the descendants. As, however, they stand at the end, it is evident that they are not transmitted.
It may seem like a trivial comparison, but an unbiased person can't deny its validity when someone states that a human being who displays the traits of their ancestors doesn't necessarily reveal the true origin of their personal qualities any more than the fact that a person is wet from falling into the water reveals anything about their inner nature. Additionally, it can be said that if the most famous name appears at the end of a family lineage, it indicates that the person with that name required that particular ancestry to develop the physical attributes needed to express their entire personality. However, this does not prove that their actual personal qualities were inherited; in fact, that notion contradicts sound logic. If personal gifts could be inherited, they would appear at the beginning of a lineage and then be passed down to the descendants. Since they show up at the end, it is clear that they are not inherited.
Now it is not to be denied that those who speak of a spiritual causality in life have contributed no less to bringing about confusion of thought. Far too much generalizing and vague discussion comes from this quarter. To say that a man's personality is a combination of inherited characteristics may certainly be compared with the assertion that the metal parts of a watch have fitted themselves together. It must also be admitted that, with regard to many assertions about a spiritual world, it is as though some one said that the metal parts of a watch cannot put themselves together in such a way as to enable the hands to move forward; some intelligence must therefore be present to effect this forward movement. In face of such an assertion, he certainly [pg 093] builds on a far better foundation who says: “Oh! I care nothing for your ‘mystical’ beings who move the hands forward. What I want to know is the mechanical construction by means of which the forward movement of the hands is achieved.” It is by no means a question of merely knowing that behind a mechanism, a watch for instance, there is an intelligence (the watchmaker); it can only be of importance to know the ideas in the watchmaker's mind which preceded the construction of the watch. These thoughts may be rediscovered in the mechanism.
It's undeniable that those who talk about a spiritual cause in life have also created a lot of confusion. There's too much generalizing and vague discussion coming from this perspective. Saying that a person's personality is a mix of inherited traits is similar to claiming that the metal parts of a watch just came together on their own. It's also true that when it comes to many claims about a spiritual world, it's as if someone said that the metal parts of a watch can't arrange themselves to allow the hands to move forward; thus, some intelligence must be involved to make this movement happen. In response to such a claim, he certainly [pg 093] has a much better foundation when he says: "Oh! I'm not interested in your ‘mystical’ beings that make the hands move. What I want to understand is the mechanical setup that allows the hands to move forward." It’s not just about knowing that there’s an intelligence behind a mechanism, like a watchmaker; it’s crucial to understand the ideas in the watchmaker's mind that came before the watch was built. These ideas can be found in the mechanism itself.
Mere dreaming and imagining about the supersensual only result in confusion, for they are not calculated to satisfy opponents. The latter are right in saying that such general allusions to super-physical beings are not at all conducive to an understanding of facts. Of course, such opponents might also say the same of the exact statements of occult science. But, in that case, it may be pointed out that the effects of hidden spiritual causes are seen in manifested life. Let us assume for the moment that what occult science asserts, proven by observation, is correct:—that a man has gone through a [pg 094] time of purification after death, and that during this period he has experienced in his soul how a certain deed, performed by him in a former life, was a hindrance to his progressive evolution. While he was undergoing this experience, the impulse arose in him to make amends for that deed. He brings this impulse with him into a new life and its presence produces a tendency in his nature which draws him into conditions rendering the amendment possible.—Taking into consideration a number of such impulses, we have the cause for a man's being born into an environment corresponding to his destiny.
Just dreaming and imagining about the spiritual world leads to confusion because it doesn’t satisfy critics. They are right to say that vague references to supernatural beings don’t help in understanding actual facts. Of course, these critics could say the same about the specific claims of occult science. However, it can be pointed out that the effects of unseen spiritual causes are evident in real life. Let’s assume for a moment that what occult science claims, backed by observation, is correct:—that a person goes through a period of purification after death, and during this time, they realize how a particular action from a past life hindered their evolution. While experiencing this, they feel a desire to make up for that action. They carry this desire into a new life, which influences their nature and draws them into situations where making amends is possible. Considering several such desires, we can understand why a person is born into a specific environment that aligns with their destiny.
We may deal in the same way with another assumption. Let us again accept as correct the assertion of occult science that the fruits of a past life are incorporated in man's spiritual germ, and that the spirit-land in which man finds himself, between death and a new life, is the region in which these fruits ripen, and are transformed into talents and capabilities which will appear in a new life and will form the personality so that it appears as the effect of what was gained in a former life. It will become evident to any one who accepts these hypotheses and, bearing them in mind, surveys life impartially, that while, by their means, all material facts may be appreciated in their full truth and significance, at the same time everything becomes intelligible which, if only material facts were relied upon, must forever remain incomprehensible to one whose attention is turned toward the spiritual world. And more important still, that illogical reasoning of the kind indicated [pg 095] above will disappear, namely,—that because the most distinguished name in a line of descent stands at the end of it, its bearer must have inherited his gifts. Life becomes logically comprehensible through the supersensual facts ascertained by occult science.
We can approach another assumption in the same way. Let’s again accept the claim from occult science that the experiences of a past life are part of a person's spiritual essence, and that the spiritual realm where a person exists between death and a new life is the place where these experiences mature, transforming into talents and skills that will emerge in a new life and shape their personality as a result of what was learned in a previous life. Anyone who embraces these ideas and, keeping them in mind, looks at life objectively will see that while all material facts can be understood in their full truth and significance, everything also becomes clear that would otherwise remain confusing for those focused only on the physical world. More importantly, the flawed reasoning mentioned above will fade away—specifically, the assumption that because the most prominent name in a lineage appears at the end of it, the person must have inherited their talents. Life becomes logically understandable through the non-physical truths discovered by occult science.
Yet another weighty objection may be raised by the conscientious seeker after truth who desires to find his way to facts and has no experience of his own in the supersensual world. It may be urged that it is inadmissible to accept the existence of facts, of any kind, simply because by means of them something may be explained which is otherwise unintelligible. Such an objection is meaningless to one who knows the corresponding facts from supersensual experience, and in later chapters of this book the path will be indicated that may be followed in order to gain knowledge not only of the spiritual facts herein described, but also of the law of spiritual causation as a personal experience. Any one, however, who is not willing to enter upon this path may find the above objection important; and what can be said against it is also of value to one who is resolved to follow the path indicated. For if it is received in the right spirit, it is the very best preliminary step that can be taken on this path. It is perfectly true that one ought not to accept a statement about which one is otherwise ignorant merely because, by means of it, something otherwise inexplicable can be explained, but in the case of alleged spiritual facts the matter is different. If such statements [pg 096] are accepted, the intellectual consequence is not only that, by their means, life becomes intelligible, but that through admitting these hypotheses into the thought-world, experiences of quite a new kind are induced.
Another significant objection can be brought up by the thoughtful seeker of truth who wants to understand reality but lacks personal experience in the spiritual realm. It's argued that it's unreasonable to believe in the existence of any facts just because they help explain something that would otherwise be confusing. This argument holds no weight for someone who knows these spiritual facts from personal experience, and later in this book, I will outline the path to gain understanding not only of the spiritual truths described here but also of the principle of spiritual causation as a direct experience. However, anyone who isn't ready to embark on this journey might find the previous objection relevant; and responses to it are also valuable for those determined to follow the suggested path. If approached with the right mindset, this objection is actually the best preparatory step one can take on this path. It is indeed true that one should not accept a claim about which one is otherwise uninformed simply because it offers explanations for otherwise inexplicable events, but when it comes to supposed spiritual facts, the situation is different. Accepting these claims not only makes life more comprehensible but also leads to new kinds of experiences when these ideas are incorporated into our understanding. [pg 096]
Take the following case. Something befalls a man which causes him extremely painful sensations. He may meet the situation in one of two ways. He may submit to the occurrence as something affecting him painfully, and abandon himself to the painful sensation, even becoming absorbed in his grief; or he may meet it in another way. He may say: “It is really I myself who in a former life set the force in motion which has brought me into contact with this thing. I have really brought it on myself.” He may then awaken in himself all the feelings which such a thought brings in its train. It goes without saying that the thought must be entertained with perfect seriousness, and with the utmost possible force, if it is to have such consequences in the life of sensation and feeling. One who succeeds in this will meet with an experience which may be best illustrated by a comparison. Let us suppose that two men have each a stick of sealing wax in his hand. One begins reflecting upon its inner nature. These reflections may perhaps be very wise, but if the “inner nature” did not show itself in any way, some one might easily retort: “That is all imagination.” The other, however, rubs the sealing wax with a woolen rag, and then shows that it attracts small particles. There is an important difference between [pg 097] the thoughts which have passed through the first man's head and his reflections, and those of the second. The thoughts of the first man had no actual result; those of the second have called out a hidden force, consequently something real.
Consider this situation. A man experiences something that causes him intense pain. He can respond in one of two ways. He might accept the painful event as something that affects him negatively and get lost in his grief; or he might respond differently. He might say: “It’s really me who caused all this to happen in a past life. I brought this on myself.” He could then stir up all the feelings that come with such a thought. It’s understood that he must take this thought seriously and with great intensity for it to have a significant impact on his sensations and feelings. Someone who manages this will have an experience best explained by a comparison. Imagine two men each holding a stick of sealing wax. One starts to think deeply about its inner nature. His thoughts might be quite insightful, but if the "inner self" doesn’t reveal itself in any way, someone might easily say: “That's just your imagination.” However, the other man rubs the sealing wax with a wool cloth and then demonstrates that it attracts small particles. There’s a crucial difference between the thoughts the first man had and those of the second. The first man’s thoughts had no actual outcome; the second’s thoughts activated a hidden force, leading to something tangible.
The same thing happens with regard to the thoughts of a man in whose mind the idea arises that in a former life he has set going within himself the force which causes him to experience a certain event. The mere conception of this stirs up strength within him which enables him to face the event in quite a different manner from that in which he would have met it without entertaining such an idea. It dawns upon him that an event which he would otherwise have looked upon as an accident was really a necessity and he will immediately see that he had the right thought, because this thought had the power to reveal the facts to him. If such inner processes are repeated they will grow into a source of inner power and thus prove their truth by their fruitfulness; and little by little, this truth is found to be powerfully effective. Such processes have a salutary effect on body, soul, and spirit,—nay, they help life forward in every way. Man becomes aware that in this manner he takes the right position with regard to life's continuity; whereas, by taking into consideration only the one life between birth and death, he is the victim of a delusion.
The same thing happens when a man has the thought that he might have set in motion the force within himself that makes him experience a certain event in a past life. Just thinking about this awakens strength within him that allows him to approach the event in a completely different way than he would have without that thought. It strikes him that an event he would have seen as a coincidence was actually necessary, and he will quickly realize that his thought was correct because it revealed the truth to him. If these inner processes happen repeatedly, they will develop into a source of inner strength and prove their validity through their results; gradually, this truth becomes very powerful. Such experiences have a positive impact on body, soul, and spirit—and indeed, they help life progress in all aspects. A person realizes that this way, he is aligning himself correctly with the continuity of life; meanwhile, by only considering the single life from birth to death, he falls into a delusion.
Such an entirely inner proof of spiritual causation can of course be acquired only by each one for himself, in his own inner life. But it is in every [pg 098] one's power to have it. Those who have not acquired it certainly cannot judge of its convincing force; but those who have acquired it can scarcely entertain any further doubt in the matter. And there is no reason for surprise that this should be so. It is only natural that what is so wholly bound up with the constitution of man's inmost being and personality can be adequately proven only by inner experience. On the other hand, it cannot be alleged that because such a matter corresponds to inner experience it must therefore be settled by every one for himself, and that it is no subject for occult science. It is certain that every one must undergo the experience for himself, just as each must see for himself the proof of a mathematical problem. But the path by which such an experience may be gained is open to all, just as the method of proving a mathematical problem is available to every one.
Such a completely personal proof of spiritual causation can only be gained by each individual through their own inner life. However, everyone has the ability to achieve it. Those who haven't experienced it can't truly understand its convincing power, but those who have experienced it can hardly doubt it any longer. It's not surprising that it works this way. It's only natural that something so deeply connected to a person's innermost being and identity can only be proven through personal experience. On the other hand, it can't be said that just because it relates to inner experience, everyone must settle it for themselves, and that it isn’t a topic for occult science. It's clear that everyone must have the experience on their own, just as each person must verify the solution to a mathematical problem for themselves. But the way to gain such experience is accessible to all, just like the method for solving a mathematical problem is available to anyone.
It ought not to be denied—apart from clairvoyant observation of course—that by means of the force producing power of the corresponding thoughts, the just cited proof is the only one which stands firm before all unprejudiced logic. All other considerations are no doubt very important, but in all of them there will be something on which an opponent might seize as a point of attack. Surely one who has acquired a fairly impartial way of looking at things will find something in the possibility and actual fact of man's education, which has the power of logical proof that a spiritual being is struggling for existence within the sheath of the body. He will [pg 099] compare animals with man and say to himself that at the birth of the former there appears certain definite qualities and capacities as something, decisive in itself, which plainly shows how it has been designed by heredity and how it will unfold itself in the outer world. We see how a young chicken carries out life's functions in the appointed way from its birth; but by means of education something comes into touch with man's inner life which is independent of any connection with his heredity, and he may be in a position to assimilate the effects of such external influences. The educator knows that such influences are met by forces coming from man's inner nature. If this is not the case, all instruction and training are meaningless. The unprejudiced educator finds the boundary line between inherited talents and those inner forces of the man himself which shine through them and originate in former lives, to be very sharply marked. It is true, we cannot bring forward such weighty proofs for things of this kind as we can for certain physical facts, by means of scales; but then these are just the intimate things of life, and one who has the power to appreciate such impalpable proofs will find them convincing—even more convincing than palpable reality.
It shouldn’t be denied—aside from any psychic insight—that the proof mentioned earlier is the only one that holds up against all unbiased logic through the power of corresponding thoughts. While other aspects are certainly important, each one contains something an opponent could use as a point of attack. Anyone who has developed a fairly neutral perspective will find that the possibility and reality of human education provide strong logical evidence that a spiritual being is striving to exist within the body. They might compare animals to humans and realize that certain specific traits and abilities emerge at the birth of the former, clearly showing how their heredity shapes them and how they will develop in the world. We observe how a young chick instinctively performs life functions from birth; however, through education, something engages with a person's inner life that is separate from their hereditary links, allowing them to absorb the impacts of external influences. The educator understands that these influences interact with forces coming from the individual’s inner nature. If this weren’t true, all teaching and training would be pointless. An unbiased educator recognizes a clear distinction between inherited talents and the inner forces that rise above them and stem from past lives. It’s true that we can’t provide such strong proof for these kinds of things as we can for certain physical facts using scales; but these are the deeply personal aspects of life, and someone capable of appreciating such subtle evidence will find it even more convincing than tangible reality.
That animals may be trained, and thus, to a certain extent, acquire qualities and capacities by education, is no objection to one who is able to see reality, for apart from the fact that transitional stages are met with all over the world, the results of training an animal by no means fade away with [pg 100] its individual existence, as is the case with a man. What is more, the fact has been emphasized that faculties acquired by domestic animals through intercourse with man are transmitted, that is to say, continue in the species, not in the individual. Darwin describes how dogs fetch and carry without having been taught to do so, or without having seen it done. Who would make such an assertion with regard to human education?
That animals can be trained and, to some extent, gain abilities and skills through education is no issue for someone who can see reality. Aside from the fact that transitional stages are found everywhere, the effects of training an animal don't just disappear with its individual life, unlike in humans. Furthermore, it's been pointed out that skills gained by domestic animals through interaction with humans are passed down, meaning they continue in the species, not the individual. Darwin describes how dogs fetch and carry without being taught to do so or having seen it done. Who would make such a claim about human education? [pg 100]
Now there are thinkers whose observations have led them beyond the opinion that a man is built by purely inherited forces from without. They rise to the thought that a spiritual being, an individuality, exists before life in the body, and fashions it; but many of them find it impossible to conceive that there are repeated earthly lives, and that the fruits of former lives are moulding forces during the intermediate state between two lives. Let us take one instance from among the ranks of these thinkers. Immanuel Hermann Fichte, son of the great Fichte, in his Anthropology (p. 528) gives the observations which led him to the following conclusion:
Now there are thinkers whose insights have led them beyond the belief that a person is solely shaped by inherited external forces. They come to the idea that a spiritual essence, an individuality, exists before life in the body and shapes it; however, many struggle to accept the notion of multiple earthly lives and that the outcomes of past lives influence the forces at play during the intermediate period between two lives. Let’s consider one example from among these thinkers. Immanuel Hermann Fichte, son of the great Fichte, in his Anthropology (p. 528) shares the observations that led him to the following conclusion:
“Parents are not generators in the full sense of the word. They supply organic substance, and not alone this, but also that intermediate element of mental and sense nature which appears in temperament, colouring of character, definite tendencies, and so on, the common source of which proves to be ‘imagination’ in the wider sense indicated by us. In all these elements of personality, the mingling and particular combination of the souls of the parents [pg 101] is unmistakable; it is therefore a perfectly well-grounded assertion that this combination is simply the result of procreation, even if we regard procreation, as we must do, as really a soul-process. But the real ultimate centre of the personality is just what is lacking here; for a deeper and more searching observation reveals the fact that even those peculiarities of disposition are but a covering and an instrument for the containing of the individual's really spiritual and ideal capabilities, and are qualified to aid these in their development or to hinder them, but in no wise able to originate them.” It is further stated in the same work (p. 532): “Every individual pre-exists as regards the fundamental form of his spirit, for no individual, from a spiritual point of view, resembles another, just as no species of animal resembles another species.”
Parents are not creators in the truest sense of the word. They provide biological material and also contribute to the mental and sensory aspects that appear in temperament, character traits, specific tendencies, and so on, where the common source can be identified as ‘imagination’ in the broader sense we've discussed. In all these elements of personality, the blending and unique combination of the parents' spirits are evident; therefore, it's a reasonable claim that this combination is simply a product of reproduction, even if we see reproduction, as we must, as genuinely a soul process. However, the real essence of personality is absent here; a deeper and more thorough observation shows that even those distinctive traits of disposition are merely a facade and a means to encompass the individual's true spiritual and ideal capacities, which can either promote their development or hinder it, but certainly cannot create them. It is further stated in the same work (p. 532): "Every person exists with a unique spiritual essence, as no one individual is spiritually identical to another, much like no two species of animals are the same."
These thoughts reach only far enough to allow a spiritual being to come into the human body; but as the forces shaping such a being are not derived from causes existing in former lives, it would be necessary that, each time a fresh personality appears, a spiritual being should come forth from a Divine First Cause. With this hypothesis there would be no possibility of explaining the relationship which certainly exists between the potentialities struggling out of man's innermost being, and that which is forcing its way thither from his external earthly environment during life. Man's innermost being, issuing in the case of each single person from a Divine First Cause, would find what confronts [pg 102] him in earthly life quite strange and foreign. Only then would this not be the case—as, in fact, it is not—if there had already been a connection between the inner man and the outer world, and if the inner man were not living in it for the first time.
These thoughts only extend far enough to allow a spiritual being to come into a human body; however, since the forces shaping such a being don’t come from experiences in previous lives, it would be necessary that each time a new personality emerges, a spiritual being should originate from a Divine First Cause. With this idea, it would be impossible to explain the connection that definitely exists between the potentialities emerging from a person's innermost self and what is pushing its way in from the external earthly environment during life. The innermost self, coming from a Divine First Cause for each individual, would find what it encounters in earthly life completely strange and unfamiliar. Only then would this not be true—as it actually isn’t—if there had already been a connection between the inner self and the outer world, and if the inner self were not experiencing it for the first time.
The unprejudiced educator may undoubtedly observe clearly that he impresses the consciousness of his pupil with something taken from life's experiences which in itself is foreign to his merely inherited qualities, but which, however, appears to him as if the work out of which these experiences arise, had been done by him in the past. Only repeated lives on earth, in conjunction with the facts set forth by occult science as taking place in spiritual regions between two earthly lives,—only this view can afford a satisfactory explanation of present human life looked at from every side. I say expressly “present” human life, for occult investigation shows that the cycle of earthly life certainly had a beginning, and at that time man's spiritual being, which later entered a bodily frame, existed under different conditions. In the following chapter we shall go back to this primeval condition of human existence. When it has been shown, from the reports of occult science how human beings received their present form in connection with the evolution of the earth, it will also be possible to indicate more precisely how the spiritual germ of man's being descends from superphysical worlds into a bodily form, and how the spiritual law of causation, or “human destiny,” is developed.
The unbiased teacher can clearly see that they are imparting to their students insights drawn from life experiences that are not solely based on inherited traits. Yet, it seems to the teacher that the work that produced these experiences is something they have done in the past. Only the idea of multiple lifetimes on earth, combined with the principles outlined by occult science regarding spiritual experiences that occur between earthly lives, can provide a satisfactory explanation of present human life from every angle. I specifically mention “present” human life because occult studies reveal that the cycle of earthly existence indeed had a beginning, at which point a person's spiritual essence, which later took on a physical body, existed under different circumstances. In the next chapter, we will explore this original state of human existence. Once we demonstrate, based on occult science reports, how humans acquired their current form in relation to the earth's evolution, we will also be able to clarify how the spiritual essence of humanity descends from higher realms into a physical form, and how the spiritual law of causation, or “human destiny,” is formed.
Chapter IV. The Development of the World and Humanity
From the foregoing observations it will be seen that man's being is built up of four principles: the physical body, the etheric body, the astral body, and the vehicle of the ego. The ego works within the three other principles, and transforms them. By means of this transformation, are formed on a lower level, the sentient-soul, the rational- or intellectual-soul, and the consciousness-soul: on a higher level of human existence, are formed the Spirit-Self, the Life-Spirit, and Spirit-Man. The relations existing between these human principles and the whole universe are of a most varied character and their evolution is related to that of the universe. By studying this evolution an insight is obtained into the deeper mysteries of man's being.
From the observations above, we can see that a person's being is made up of four principles: the physical body, the etheric body, the astral body, and the ego. The ego operates within the other three principles and transforms them. Through this transformation, we develop, on a lower level, the sentient-soul, the rational or intellectual-soul, and the consciousness-soul; on a higher level of human existence, we develop the Spirit-Self, the Life-Spirit, and Spirit-Man. The relationships among these human principles and the entire universe are diverse, and their evolution is connected to that of the universe. By studying this evolution, we gain insight into the deeper mysteries of human existence.
It is clear that human life is related in the most varied ways to the environment or dwelling place in which it evolves. Physical science, through the facts presented to it, has already been driven to the opinion that the earth itself, man's dwelling place in the broadest sense of the word, has undergone evolution. Science points to former conditions of the earth when man, in his present form, did not yet [pg 104] exist on our planet and it shows how man has slowly and gradually evolved to his present condition from primitive states of civilization. Physical science, therefore, comes also to the conclusion that there is a connection between man's evolution and that of the heavenly body on which he lives—the earth.
It's clear that human life is connected in many ways to the environment or home in which it develops. Physical science, based on the facts it has gathered, has come to believe that the earth itself, our home in the broadest sense, has evolved. Science points to earlier conditions of the earth when humans, in our current form, did not yet exist on our planet, and it shows how we have slowly and gradually evolved from primitive states of civilization to where we are now. Therefore, physical science concludes that there is a link between human evolution and that of the celestial body we live on—the earth.
Occult science traces this connection by means of a knowledge which obtains its data from observation quickened by spiritual organs of perception. It traces man backwards in his course of development, and the fact becomes evident to occult science that the real inner spiritual being of man has progressed through a series of lives on this earth. Occult research arrives in this way at an epoch far back in the remote past, when for the first time that inner being of man made its entry into “external life” as we understand it. It was in this first earthly incarnation that the ego began to function in the three bodies—the astral body, the etheric or vital body, and the physical body; and it then carried over the results of that activity into its next life.
Occult science explores this connection through knowledge gained from observation enhanced by spiritual perception. It looks back at humanity's development and reveals that the true inner spiritual essence of a person has evolved through a series of lives on Earth. Through this research, occult science reaches a period very far back in history, when that inner essence first entered what we consider “external life.” It was during this initial earthly incarnation that the self began to operate within the three bodies—the astral body, the etheric or vital body, and the physical body—and it then transferred the outcomes of that experience into its next life.
If in our investigation we proceed backwards, in the manner indicated, as far as that epoch, we discover that the ego finds an earth condition in which the three bodies, physical, etheric, and astral, are already developed and in which they bear a certain relation to each other. The ego is, for the first time, united with the being composed of these three bodies; and henceforth takes part in the further evolution of the three bodies. Hitherto, up to the stage at [pg 105] which that ego came in touch with them, they had evolved without a human ego.
If we trace our investigation back to that time, we find that the ego encounters a state where the three bodies—physical, etheric, and astral—are already developed and have a particular connection with one another. For the first time, the ego is joined with the being made up of these three bodies; from then on, it participates in the ongoing evolution of them. Until that point, when the ego first connected with them, they had developed without a human ego.
Occult science must now go back still farther in its researches if it is to answer the questions, “How did the three bodies reach that stage of evolution at which they were able to receive an ego within them?” and “How did that ego itself come into being and acquire the capacity for working within these bodies?”
Occult science must now dig even deeper in its research if it is to answer the questions, "How did the three bodies evolve to the point where they could have an ego?" and "How did that ego come to exist and gain the ability to operate within these bodies?"
It is possible to answer these questions only when the gradual development of the earth-planet itself is studied from the occult point of view. By such investigation we arrive at a beginning of the earth-planet. That method of examination which is based only on the facts of the physical senses cannot arrive at conclusions concerning the beginning of the earth. A certain point of view which avails itself of such conclusions arrives at the result that everything material on the earth was formed out of a primeval essence, or vapour. It is not the purpose of this work to enter more fully into such conceptions of our planet's origin; for in occult science the important matter is not merely to inquire into the material processes of the earth's evolution, but first and foremost to discover the spiritual causes lying behind what is material.
You can only answer these questions by studying the gradual development of the Earth from an occult perspective. Through this investigation, we can understand the beginnings of the Earth. An approach that relies solely on physical observations can’t reach conclusions about the Earth’s inception. A certain perspective that uses this type of conclusion suggests that everything material on Earth came from a primordial essence or vapor. This work doesn’t aim to explore these concepts of our planet's origin in depth; in occult science, the key focus isn’t just on the material processes of the Earth’s evolution, but primarily on uncovering the spiritual causes behind what is material.
If we see before us a man raising his hand, we may consider his action in two different ways: we may examine the mechanism of the arm and the rest of the organism, in order to describe the process as it takes place from the purely physical standpoint, [pg 106] or we may direct the spiritual vision to what takes place in the man's soul and there discover what constitutes the inner motive for raising the hand. In this way an investigator, trained in occult research, sees spiritual processes behind all the events of the physical sense-world. In his eyes all transformations of the material part of the earth-planet are manifestations of spiritual forces lying behind what is material.
If we see a man raising his hand, we can look at his action in two different ways: we can analyze how his arm and the rest of his body work to describe the process from a purely physical perspective, [pg 106] or we can focus on what’s happening in the man's soul to understand what motivates him to raise his hand. In this way, an investigator trained in spiritual research sees spiritual processes underlying all events in the physical world. To them, all changes in the material part of the planet are expressions of the spiritual forces that lie behind what is material.
But if occult observation of this kind goes farther and farther back in the life of the earth it comes to that point in evolution at which material things first came into being. The material element is evolved out of the spiritual. Up to this point the spiritual element was the only one existing. By occult investigation the spiritual element is perceived, and the observer can see how it becomes partly condensed, as it were, into matter. We have before us a process which is taking place—on a higher level—much as though we were observing a lump of ice being formed by artificial means in a vessel of water. Just as we see the ice being condensed out of what was previously only water, so may we, by means of occult observation, watch the condensation of what was previously entirely spiritual, so to speak, into material things, processes, and beings. In this way the physical earth-planet was evolved out of a cosmic spiritual essence; and everything that is combined materially with the earth-planet has been condensed out of what was previously united with it spiritually. We must not, however, think that everything [pg 107] spiritual was at any one time changed into material form; but, in the latter we have before us merely the transformed portions of what was originally spiritual. Thus, even during the period of material evolution, it is always Spirit that is really the guiding and ruling principle.
But if we look deeper into the hidden aspects of this kind of observation, we can trace it back in the earth's history to the moment when material things first came into existence. The material element evolves from the spiritual. Before this point, only the spiritual element existed. Through spiritual investigation, we can perceive the spiritual element and see how it gradually condenses into matter. We have before us a process that, on a higher level, resembles watching a block of ice form artificially in a container of water. Just as we observe ice emerging from what was once just water, we can, through spiritual observation, witness the transformation of what was entirely spiritual into material things, processes, and beings. In this way, the physical earth was created from a cosmic spiritual essence; everything that is materially combined with the earth has been condensed from what was once spiritually united with it. However, we mustn't assume that everything [pg 107] spiritual was converted into material form at any one moment; rather, in the material, we only see the transformed aspects of what was originally spiritual. Thus, even through the phase of material evolution, it is always Spirit that remains the guiding and governing force.
It is obvious that the mode of thought which restricts itself to the processes of physical sense—and to what reason is able to infer from them—is incapable of expressing an opinion about the spiritual element of which we are speaking. Let us assume that a being might exist to whose senses ice would be perceptible, but not the finer condition of water, from which ice is detached by refrigeration. For such a being, water would be non-existent, and could become visible only when parts of it had been transformed into ice. In the same way, the spiritual element behind earthly processes remains hidden from one who only admits the existence of what is perceptible to his physical senses. And if, from the physical facts which he now perceives, he draws correct conclusions about earlier conditions of the earth-planet, he can penetrate only as far as that point in evolution at which the previous spiritual element was partially condensed into material substance. Such a method of observation no more discovers the spirit previously existing, than it perceives the spirit which even now rules unseen behind the world of matter.
It’s clear that a way of thinking that limits itself to physical senses—and what reason can infer from them—can’t express an opinion about the spiritual aspect we're discussing. Let’s imagine there’s a being whose senses can perceive ice but not the subtler state of water, which is turned into ice through freezing. For this being, water wouldn’t exist and could only become noticeable when parts of it have transformed into ice. Similarly, the spiritual aspect behind earthly processes remains hidden from someone who only acknowledges what their physical senses can detect. And if that person draws valid conclusions about earlier conditions of the Earth based on the physical facts they perceive, they can only understand as far back as the point in evolution when the previous spiritual element partially solidified into material substance. This way of observing doesn’t reveal the spirit that once existed any more than it perceives the spirit that currently operates unseen behind the material world.
Not until we come to the last chapters of this work can we deal with those methods by which man acquires [pg 108] the faculty of looking back, by means of occult perception, upon those earlier conditions of the earth which are now under discussion. For the present we shall merely intimate that the facts concerning the primeval past have not passed beyond the reach of occult research. If a being comes into corporeal existence his material part perishes after physical death. But the spiritual forces, which from out their own depth gave existence to the body, do not “disappear in this way.” They leave their traces, their exact images behind them impressed upon the spiritual ground-work of the world. Any one who is able to raise his perceptive faculty through the visible to the invisible world, attains at length a level on which he may see before him what may be compared to a vast spiritual panorama, in which are recorded all the past events of the world's history. These imperishable traces of everything immaterial are called in occult science the “Akashic Records.”
Not until we reach the last chapters of this work can we discuss the methods by which humans gain the ability to look back, through occult perception, at those earlier conditions of the earth that we are currently examining. For now, we will just suggest that the facts about the ancient past are still accessible to occult research. When a being comes into physical existence, their material body ceases to exist after physical death. However, the spiritual forces that created the body from within do not "disappear in this way." They leave their marks, their exact images behind, impressed upon the spiritual foundation of the world. Anyone who can elevate their perception from the visible to the invisible world eventually reaches a point where they can see what resembles a vast spiritual panorama, in which all past events of the world's history are recorded. These enduring traces of everything immaterial are known in occult science as the "Akashic Records."
Here it must once more be repeated that investigations of the supersensible realms of existence can be carried on only with the aid of spiritual perception, and consequently can be instituted in the sphere now under consideration, only by reading the Akashic Records above-mentioned. Nevertheless, what was said earlier in this book in a similar instance holds good here. Supersensible facts are only to be investigated by supersensible perceptions; but once investigated and communicated by occult science, they may be grasped by the ordinary powers of [pg 109] thought, if these are honestly exercised without bias. In the following pages the various conditions of the earth's evolution, as given by occult science, will be detailed. The transformation of our planet will be traced down to the conditions of life in which we now find it. Any one who surveys what comes before him at the present time merely through the evidence of his senses, and then lends an ear to what occult science has to say on the subject, namely:—how that which now lies before him has been evolved from a far distant past,—will be able, if his thought is genuinely unbiased, to say to himself: “In the first place, what occult science reports is quite logical; in the second place, I can, if I assume the reports of occult investigation to be correct, understand how things have become as they now appear.” By “logical” is not meant, in this connection, of course, that errors might not be made from a logical standpoint in some description given by occult research. We are here speaking of “logic” as it is understood in the ordinary life of the physical world. Just as a logical demonstration is accepted there as it is in physical research, even though a single investigator, in a certain domain of facts, may make illogical statements, so is it also with regard to occult science. It may even happen that an investigator who possesses the power of vision in supersensible spheres may make mistakes in a logical presentment of them, and may be corrected by another who has no supersensible perception, but has, none the less, a capacity for sound thinking. In reality, nothing [pg 110] of any weight can be said against the logical deductions of occult science. And it ought to be unnecessary to insist that nothing can be adduced, on purely logical grounds, against the facts themselves. In the domain of the physical world it can never be proved by logic, but only by ocular demonstration, whether or no there is such an animal as a whale; similarly, supersensible facts can be known only through occult perception.
Here, it should be reiterated that exploring the non-physical realms of existence can only be done with spiritual awareness, so these investigations can only take place within the context we're discussing by accessing the previously mentioned Akashic Records. Nevertheless, what was previously stated in this book in another context also applies here. Non-physical truths can only be examined through non-physical awareness; however, once they have been investigated and shared by occult science, they can be understood by ordinary thought processes, provided these are genuinely unbiased. In the following sections, the various stages of the Earth's evolution, as detailed by occult science, will be explained. The changes our planet has undergone will be traced to the conditions of life as we currently experience them. Anyone who looks at what is immediately before them solely through sensory perception, and then listens to what occult science has to say about it—specifically, how what they see has evolved from a distant past—will be able, if their thinking is truly impartial, to conclude: “Firstly, what occult science describes makes complete sense; secondly, if I accept the findings of occult exploration as accurate, I can understand how things have developed into their current state.” By “logical,” it is not meant to imply that there cannot be mistakes from a logical perspective in some accounts provided by occult research. Here we are discussing “logic” as it is understood in the everyday physical world. Just as a logical argument is accepted in physical research, even if one researcher makes illogical assertions about certain facts, the same applies to occult science. It’s even possible for a researcher who has the ability to see into non-physical dimensions to misrepresent these experiences logically and to be corrected by someone who lacks that insight but still has sound reasoning abilities. In reality, nothing of substance can be said against the logical conclusions of occult science. It should go without saying that nothing can be presented, purely on logical grounds, against the facts themselves. In the physical realm, whether or not a creature like a whale exists can never be established by logic alone but only through direct observation; similarly, non-physical truths can only be known through occult perception.
But it cannot be sufficiently emphasized that an obligation is laid upon the explorer of supersensible regions, before he determines to approach the invisible worlds with his own power of perception, to acquire first of all the aforementioned logical faculty, and this is none the less essential if he recognizes that the world, manifest to his senses, will become comprehensible if he accepts the communications of occult science as correct. All experiences in the supersensible world are nothing but an uncertain—nay, a dangerous—groping in the dark if we despise the method of preparation which has been described. Therefore in this book the facts concerning the supersensible processes of the earth's evolution will first be given, before the path leading to the attainment of supersensible knowledge is dealt with.
But it’s important to stress that anyone exploring the unseen realms must first develop their logical thinking skills before trying to access the invisible worlds with their own perception. This is crucial, even if they believe that the material world makes sense when they accept the teachings of occult science as true. Any experiences in the supersensible realm are merely uncertain—and even risky—feelings in the dark if we disregard the necessary preparation method described. Therefore, this book will first present the facts about the supersensible processes of the Earth's evolution before discussing the way to achieve supersensible knowledge.
We have also, it is true, to take into account that the man who, by sheer thinking, comes to accept what supersensible research has to impart, is by no means in the same position as one who listens to the account of a physical occurrence which he is unable to see. For thinking is in itself a supersensible activity. [pg 111] Materialistic thinking cannot of itself lead to supersensible phenomena. But if thought is directed to supersensible matters through the accounts given of them by occult science, it grows by its own activity into the supersensible world. What is more, one of the very best ways of acquiring supersensible perception is to grow into the higher worlds by meditation upon what has been communicated by occult science. For such a mode of entry insures great clearness of perception. For this reason such thinking is regarded by a certain school of occult investigation as a most valuable first step to take in occult training.
We also have to consider that the person who, through deep thinking, comes to understand what non-physical research has to offer, is not in the same situation as someone who hears about a physical event they can't witness. This is because thinking itself is a non-physical activity. [pg 111] Materialistic thinking alone cannot lead to non-physical phenomena. However, if thought is focused on non-physical matters through the information provided by occult science, it can develop into the non-physical realm through its own activity. Moreover, one of the best ways to gain non-physical perception is to access higher realms through meditation on what occult science has shared. This approach ensures clear perception. For this reason, this type of thinking is seen by a particular school of occult research as a crucial first step in occult training.
It will be readily understood that it is impossible to mention in this book all the details of the earth's evolution, as it has been spiritually perceived by occultists, in order to illustrate the way in which the supersensible world is reflected in the manifested. Nor was this what was intended when it was said that the unseen may everywhere be demonstrated by its manifest effects. It was meant rather that everything that man encounters may, step by step, become clear and comprehensible if he brings manifested events under the illumination of occult science. Only in a few characteristic instances will reference be made in the following pages to confirmations of the invisible by the manifest, in order to show how this may be done everywhere in the course of practical life, if desired.
It's clear that it’s impossible to cover all the details of the earth's evolution as viewed spiritually by occultists in this book, to show how the unseen world is reflected in what is visible. That wasn't the goal when it was stated that the invisible can be demonstrated by its visible effects. Instead, it was meant that everything a person encounters can gradually become clear and understandable if they examine visible events through the lens of occult science. In the following pages, there will be a few notable examples referencing how the invisible can be confirmed by the visible, to demonstrate how this can be done throughout practical life, if one wishes.
Pursuing the evolution of the earth backward according to the above method of scientific spiritual investigations we arrive at a spiritual condition of our planet. But if we go farther back along this path of research we find that everything spiritual had previously passed through a kind of physical incarnation. Thus we come upon a bygone physical planetary condition, which was afterwards spiritualized, and subsequently transformed into our earth by repeated materialization. Our earth is therefore presented to us as the reincarnation of a very ancient planet. But occult science can go back still farther; and it then finds the whole process twice repeated. Thus, our earth has passed through three previous planetary conditions separated by intermediate spiritual conditions of rest. The physical substance, however, proves to be finer and finer the farther back we follow the incarnations.
Tracing the evolution of the earth using the above method of scientific spiritual exploration, we arrive at a spiritual state of our planet. However, if we dig deeper along this research path, we discover that everything spiritual had previously undergone a type of physical embodiment. This leads us to a past physical planetary state that was later spiritualized and then transformed into our current earth through multiple materializations. Therefore, our earth is seen as the reincarnation of a very ancient planet. Yet, occult science can delve even deeper, revealing that the entire process has repeated itself twice. As a result, our earth has gone through three earlier planetary conditions, each separated by intermediate spiritual states of rest. However, the physical substance appears to become finer and finer the further back we trace the incarnations.
Now man, in the form in which he is at present evolving, makes his first appearance upon the fourth of the planetary incarnations which have been described, the Earth proper. And the essential characteristic of his form is that it is composed of four principles, the physical, etheric, and astral bodies and the ego. But that form could not have appeared if it had not been prepared by the preceding events of evolution. The method of preparation was that, in the earlier planetary incarnation, beings were evolved who already had three of the present four principles of man: the physical, etheric, and astral bodies. These beings who, in a certain [pg 113] sense, may be called man's ancestors, had as yet no ego, but they developed the three other principles and their mutual relationship to such a point that they became sufficiently mature to receive an ego. Thus man's ancestor attained to a certain degree of maturity of his three principles during the earlier planetary incarnation. This condition became spiritualized; and out of it a new planetary condition was formed in which man's matured ancestors were contained, as it were, in embryo. Because the whole planet had passed through a process of spiritualization and had appeared in a new form, it offered those embryos, with their physical, etheric, and astral bodies, which were contained therein, not only the opportunity of again evolving up to the level on which they had previously stood, but the further possibility, after having arrived at that level, of reaching out beyond themselves through receiving the ego.
Now, humanity, in the form in which it is currently evolving, makes its first appearance in the fourth planetary incarnation that has been described, the Earth. The main feature of this form is that it consists of four elements: the physical body, the etheric body, the astral body, and the ego. However, this form could not have emerged without the preparations made by earlier evolutionary events. The preparation involved the evolution of beings in the previous planetary incarnation, who already possessed three of the four elements present in humans today: the physical body, the etheric body, and the astral body. These beings, who could be called humanity's ancestors in a certain sense, did not yet have an ego, but they developed the other three elements and their interactions to the point where they became mature enough to receive an ego. In this way, humanity's ancestors reached a certain level of maturity of their three elements during the earlier planetary incarnation. This condition became spiritualized, leading to the formation of a new planetary state in which the matured ancestors of humanity were, in a way, contained in an embryonic form. Since the entire planet underwent a process of spiritualization and emerged in a new form, it provided those embryos, with their physical, etheric, and astral bodies, not only the chance to evolve back to the level they had previously attained but also the further opportunity, after reaching that level, to extend beyond themselves by receiving the ego.
The evolution of the Earth divides itself, therefore, into two parts. During the first period the Earth itself appears as a reincarnation of the previous planetary state. But that recurring state is a higher one than that of the previous incarnation, in consequence of the intervening period of spiritualization. And the Earth contains within itself the germs of man's ancestors belonging to the earlier planet. These were first developed up to the level they had previously reached. The attainment of this level marks the end of the first period. But now, owing to its own higher stage of evolution, the Earth is able [pg 114] to carry the germs still higher, that is, to qualify them for receiving the ego. The second period of the Earth's evolution is that of the development of the ego in the physical, etheric, and astral bodies.
The evolution of the Earth can be divided into two parts. In the first period, the Earth itself seems like a reincarnation of the previous planetary state. However, this recurring state is a more advanced one than the previous incarnation due to the spiritual growth during the intervening period. The Earth holds within it the seeds of human ancestors from the earlier planet. These were initially developed to the level they had achieved previously. Reaching this level marks the end of the first period. But now, because of its own advanced stage of evolution, the Earth can nurture these seeds further, preparing them to receive the ego. The second period of the Earth's evolution is focused on the development of the ego within the physical, etheric, and astral bodies.
In the same way that man had been thus carried a stage farther by the evolution of the Earth, so also had this been the case during the earlier planetary incarnations. For man had in some measure existed as early as the first of these. Light is therefore thrown on the present constitution of man if his evolution is followed back to the far-remote past of the first of the planetary incarnations mentioned above.
In the same way that humanity has progressed due to the evolution of the Earth, this has also happened during earlier planetary stages. Humans existed to some extent as early as the first of these stages. Therefore, understanding the present makeup of humans becomes clearer when tracing their evolution back to the distant past of the first mentioned planetary incarnations.
In occult science the first of these is called Saturn; the second is termed Sun; the third, Moon; and the fourth is the Earth. It must be distinctly understood that these occult terms are not to be in any way associated with the names used to designate the members of the present solar system.8 In occult science Saturn, Sun, and Moon [pg 115] are merely names for bygone forms of evolution through which the Earth has passed. In the course of the following account it will be shown what relation these worlds of remote antiquity bear to the celestial bodies composing the present solar system.
In occult science, the first is called Saturn; the second is known as Sunshine; the third is Moon; and the fourth is Planet Earth. It should be clearly understood that these occult terms should not be linked in any way to the names used for the members of the current solar system.8 In occult science, Saturn, Sun, and Moon [pg 115] are simply names for past forms of evolution that the Earth has gone through. The following account will explain the relationship between these ancient worlds and the celestial bodies that make up the current solar system.
The relationship of the four planetary incarnations previously mentioned, can here be only briefly sketched; for the events, the beings and their destiny on Saturn, Sun and Moon were in truth, just as varied as they are on the Earth itself. Therefore only a few characteristics of these conditions can be chosen to illustrate just how these earth conditions have evolved out of earlier ones. In this connection, one should bear in mind that the further back we go the more dissimilar to the present ones do these conditions become. And yet they can only be described by making use of ideas borrowed from existing conditions of the earth. If, for instance, light, heat, etc., are mentioned in connection with these earlier conditions, it must not be overlooked that they are not exactly the same as that which we now term light and heat. And yet such terminology is accurate, for the clairvoyant observer of earlier stages of evolution perceives something that has developed into the [pg 116] light and heat of the present time. And one who follows the descriptions thus given by occult science will, from the inner relation of these things, easily be able to form such perceptions as correspond to those events which have taken place in a primeval past.
The connection between the four planetary incarnations mentioned earlier can only be briefly outlined here; the events, the beings, and their destinies on Saturn, the Sun, and the Moon were, in reality, just as diverse as they are on Earth. Therefore, we can only highlight a few characteristics of these situations to show how current earthly conditions evolved from earlier ones. It's important to remember that the further back we go, the less similar these conditions are to the present ones. Yet, they can only be described using concepts borrowed from current earthly conditions. For example, when we refer to light, heat, etc., in relation to these earlier conditions, we must recognize that they are not exactly the same as what we call light and heat today. Still, this terminology is accurate because a clairvoyant observing these earlier stages of evolution perceives something that has developed into the [pg 116] light and heat we have now. Those who follow the descriptions provided by occult science will be able to easily grasp perceptions that correspond to events that occurred in a distant past.
Of course there will be considerable difficulty in treating of those planetary conditions which preceded the Moon incarnation. For during the latter, conditions prevailed which bore, at least to a degree, some resemblance still to earthly conditions. When one attempts to describe these conditions one finds that such resemblances to the present time form a certain basis on which may be expressed in clear concepts the observations made through clairvoyance. It is quite different when the Saturn and Sun evolutions are to be described. In that case, what lies before clairvoyant observation is utterly different from the objects and beings now belonging to the sphere of human life. And this difference makes it exceedingly difficult to bring the corresponding facts of primeval times within the scope of clairvoyant consciousness at all.
Of course, it will be quite challenging to discuss the planetary conditions that came before the Moon incarnation. During that time, conditions existed that, to some extent, still resembled earthly conditions. When trying to describe these conditions, one finds that the similarities to the present create a certain foundation upon which observations made through clairvoyance can be expressed in clear concepts. The situation is quite different when it comes to describing the Saturn and Sun evolutions. In that case, what clairvoyant observation reveals is completely different from the objects and beings that are now part of human life. This difference makes it extremely difficult to connect the corresponding facts of ancient times with clairvoyant conscious awareness at all.
Since however the present constitution of man cannot be understood without going back to the Saturn [pg 117] state, the description therefore must be given. And surely no one will misunderstand such a description who keeps in view the existence of the difficulty, and the fact that owing to it much that is said must be in the nature of a suggestion or hint of the facts in question, rather than an exact description of them.
Since the current state of humanity can’t be understood without reflecting on the Saturn state, a description must be provided. And surely, no one will misinterpret such a description if they consider the existence of the difficulty, and the reality that much of what is communicated will be more of a suggestion or hint about the relevant facts rather than a precise account of them.
The physical body is the oldest of the present four principles of man's being. It is also the one, which, in its way, has attained the greatest perfection. Occult research shows that this part of man already existed during the Saturn evolution. It will be shown in the following account that the form taken by the physical body on Saturn was, of course, something quite different from the present physical body of man. The earthly physical human body, from its nature, can only exist by being in connection with the etheric and astral bodies and the ego, in the manner described earlier in this book. Such a condition did not as yet exist on Saturn. The physical body was then passing through the first stage of its evolution, without having a human etheric body, an astral body, or an ego incorporated in it.
The physical body is the oldest of the four principles that make up human existence. It’s also the one that has achieved the most perfection in its own way. Research into the occult indicates that this aspect of humanity existed during the Saturn evolution. The following account will illustrate that the form the physical body took on Saturn was, of course, quite different from the physical body we have today. The earthly physical human body, by its very nature, can only exist through its connection with the etheric and astral bodies and the ego, as described earlier in this book. Such a condition didn’t exist on Saturn yet. The physical body was then in the early stages of its evolution, without a human etheric body, an astral body, or an ego integrated into it.
During the Saturn evolution it was growing ripe for the reception of an etheric body. For that purpose Saturn had eventually to pass into a spiritual condition, and then to be reincarnated as the Sun. During the Sun incarnation the physical body developed again to the stage it had reached on Saturn as from a germ brought over and only then could it be [pg 118] inter-penetrated by an etheric body. By means of this incorporation of an etheric body, a change took place in the nature of the physical body; it was raised to a second stage of perfection. A similar thing took place during the Moon evolution. Man's ancestor, as he had developed himself when passing from the Sun to the Moon, incorporated in himself the astral body. As a result, the physical body was changed for the second time, and thus raised to its third stage of perfection; at the same time the etheric body was likewise changed, and passed to its second stage of perfection. On the earth the ego was incorporated in man's ancestor, now composed of the physical, etheric, and astral bodies. Thereby the physical body reached its fourth stage of perfection, the etheric body its third, and the astral body its second stage; the ego is only now at the first stage of its existence.
During Saturn's evolution, it was preparing to receive an etheric body. For that to happen, Saturn had to first transition into a spiritual state and then be reborn as the Sun. During its time as the Sun, the physical body developed again to the level it had reached on Saturn, coming from a germ that was carried over, and only then could it be filled with an etheric body. With the addition of the etheric body, the physical body underwent a change; it was elevated to a second level of perfection. A similar process occurred during the Moon's evolution. Man's ancestor, as he evolved from the Sun to the Moon, integrated the astral body within himself. As a result, the physical body was transformed for the second time, reaching its third level of perfection; at the same time, the etheric body also changed, advancing to its second level of perfection. On Earth, the ego was incorporated into man's ancestor, who was now made up of physical, etheric, and astral bodies. This allowed the physical body to attain its fourth level of perfection, the etheric body its third, and the astral body its second level; meanwhile, the ego is only now at the first stage of its existence.
If we give ourselves up to an unprejudiced examination of man's nature, there will be no difficulty in acquiring a correct idea of these different stages of perfection of his separate principles. For this purpose we have merely to compare the physical with the astral body. It is true, the astral body, as a psychic principle, stands on a higher level of evolution than the physical body. And in future ages, when the former has been perfected, it will be of very much more consequence to man's complete being than the present physical body. Yet, in its own way, the latter has reached a certain high degree of perfection. Consider the marvelous wisdom with [pg 119] which the structure of the heart is planned, the amazing structure of the brain—nay, even of part of a single bone, such as the upper end of the thigh bone. In the end of this bone we find a net-work or scaffolding, wonderfully constructed and composed of delicate spicules and lamellæ. The whole is so arranged that with the least expenditure of material the most effective action on the joint-surfaces is obtained—hence the most efficient distribution of friction and a proper freedom of movement. Thus wise arrangements are found in the parts of the physical body. And if we go on to observe the harmonious co-operation of the part with the whole, we shall find that it is certainly true that this principle of man's being is perfect and it does not affect the question that in certain parts something apparently useless appears, or that disturbances of structure or functions may take place. It will even be found that such disturbances are in a way only the necessary shadows of the wisdom-filled light which is poured out over the whole physical organism.
If we take an unbiased look at human nature, we can easily understand the different stages of perfection in its individual principles. To do this, we just need to compare the physical body with the astral body. It’s true that the astral body, as a psychic principle, is at a higher level of evolution than the physical body. In future ages, once the astral body has reached its full potential, it will be far more important to our complete being than our current physical body. Still, in its own way, the physical body has attained a significant level of perfection. Just think about the incredible design of the heart, the amazing structure of the brain—really, even the details of a single bone, like the upper end of the thigh bone. At the end of this bone, we see a network or scaffolding that is marvelously constructed, made up of delicate spicules and lamellae. Everything is arranged so that with minimal material, the most effective movement at the joint surfaces is achieved—resulting in optimal friction distribution and proper mobility. Such wise designs are evident in the parts of the physical body. And if we observe how the parts work harmoniously together with the whole, we can definitely conclude that this aspect of human being is perfect. It doesn’t matter if some parts seem useless or if there are disturbances in structure or function. These disturbances may actually be just the necessary shadows that highlight the wisdom-filled light permeating the entire physical organism.
Now compare with this the astral body as the medium or vehicle of pleasure and pain, desires and passions. What uncertainty rules in it with regard to pleasure and pain; how the desires and passions, of which it is the scene, run counter to the higher goal of man; how senseless they often are. The astral body is only now on its way to attain the harmony and inner poise already possessed by the physical body. Similarly it might be shown that the [pg 120] etheric body is certainly more perfect in its own way than the astral but less perfect than the physical body. And it will equally result from a corresponding study of the ego that this, the real kernel of man's being, is now only at the beginning of its evolution. For how much has already been accomplished of its mission, that of transforming the other principles of man's being in order that they may become a revelation of the ego's own nature?
Now compare this to the astral body as the medium or vehicle of pleasure and pain, desires and passions. There’s so much uncertainty involved with pleasure and pain; how the desires and passions that play out within it go against the higher goals of humanity; how often they are meaningless. The astral body is currently on its path to achieving the harmony and balance that the physical body already possesses. Similarly, it can be shown that the [pg 120] etheric body is definitely more developed in its own way than the astral body, but less developed than the physical body. A thorough study of the ego will also show that this, the true essence of a person's being, is just at the beginning of its evolution. How much has already been achieved in its mission to transform the other aspects of a person's existence so they can reflect the ego's own nature?
The result of an outer examination of this kind is intensified for the occult student by something else. It might be pointed out that the physical body is attacked by diseases. Now occult science is in a position to show that a large proportion of all diseases owe their origin to the fact that the perverse actions and mistakes of the astral body are transmitted to the etheric body, and indirectly through the etheric, destroy the perfect harmony of the physical body. The deeper connection, which can here be only hinted at, and the true cause of many of the conditions of disease, elude that kind of scientific observation which confines itself solely to the facts obtained by means of the physical senses. The connection in most cases comes about in such a way that an injury to the astral body does not cause manifestations of disease in the physical body in the same incarnation in which the injury takes place, but in a later one. Hence the laws now under consideration have a meaning only for one who is able to admit that human earth-life is repeated again and again. But even if deeper knowledge of this [pg 121] kind is rejected, ordinary observation of life makes it plain that human beings indulge in far too many pleasures and desires which undermine the harmony of the physical body. And the seat of pleasure, desire, passion, is not in the physical but in the astral body. The latter is still so imperfect, in many respects, that it is able to destroy the harmony of the physical body.
The outcome of an external examination like this becomes even more significant for the occult student due to another factor. It can be pointed out that the physical body is vulnerable to diseases. Now, occult science demonstrates that a large number of illnesses stem from the fact that the dysfunctional actions and errors of the astral body are passed on to the etheric body, which then disrupts the perfect balance of the physical body. The deeper connection, which can only be briefly mentioned here, and the real cause of many health issues, escape that type of scientific observation that relies solely on information gathered through physical senses. In most cases, the connection occurs in a way that an injury to the astral body doesn't lead to physical manifestations of disease in the same lifetime as the injury, but rather in a future one. Therefore, the laws currently being discussed only hold significance for those willing to accept that human life on Earth is repeated over and over. Even if this deeper understanding is dismissed, ordinary life observations clearly show that people indulge in far too many pleasures and desires that disrupt the harmony of the physical body. The source of pleasure, desire, and passion resides not in the physical body but in the astral body. The astral body is still so flawed in many respects that it can destroy the harmony of the physical body.
It should also be mentioned here that such explanations as these are by no means intended as proofs of the assertions of occult science about the evolution of the four principles of man's being. The proofs are drawn from spiritual research, which shows that the physical body has behind it a transformation, enacted four times, into higher degrees of perfection, and that man's other principles have been perfected to a lesser degree, as has been described. It is desired merely to indicate here that these communications made by spiritual research relate to facts which are visible in their effects even to ordinary observation, in the degrees of perfection reached by the physical body, etheric body, and so forth.
It should also be noted that explanations like these are not meant to serve as proof of the claims made by occult science regarding the evolution of the four aspects of human existence. The evidence comes from spiritual research, which indicates that the physical body has undergone four transformations, evolving into higher levels of perfection, while the other aspects of man's being have achieved a lesser degree of perfection, as previously mentioned. The aim here is simply to point out that these insights from spiritual research pertain to facts that can even be observed in their effects by anyone, reflected in the levels of perfection reached by the physical body, etheric body, and so on.
If we wish to draw an approximately true picture of the conditions prevailing during the Saturn evolution, we must take into account the fact that while it lasted, there were virtually, as yet, none of the things and creatures existing which now belong to the earth and are included in the mineral, vegetable, and animal kingdoms. The beings of these three kingdoms [pg 122] were formed during later periods of evolution. Of all the earthly beings physically perceptible today, man alone existed at that time and of him only the physical body existed as described. But there are at present belonging to the earth not only the denizens of the mineral, vegetable, animal and human kingdoms, but other beings as well, not manifesting in a physical embodiment. Such entities were also present during the Saturn evolution, and their activity on the Saturn scene of action brought about the subsequent evolution of man.
If we want to create a fairly accurate picture of the conditions during the Saturn evolution, we need to consider that, at that time, there were basically none of the things and creatures that now exist on Earth and are part of the mineral, plant, and animal kingdoms. The beings in these three kingdoms were formed in later stages of evolution. Of all the beings that we can physically perceive today, only humans existed back then, and only in the form of their physical bodies as described. However, today Earth is home not only to the inhabitants of the mineral, plant, animal, and human kingdoms but also to other beings that don't have a physical form. These entities were also present during the Saturn evolution, and their actions played a significant role in the later evolution of humankind.
If the organs of spiritual perception are directed, not to the beginning and end, but to the middle period of evolution of this Saturn incarnation, we find there a condition which consists principally of heat. Nothing is to be found composed of gaseous, fluid, or even solid constituents. All these states appear only in later incarnations. Let us assume that a human being, with the present organs of sense, were to approach the Saturn condition as a spectator. None of the sense-impressions possible to him would confront him there except the feeling of warmth, or heat. Suppose such a being approached this Saturn; he would only sense, upon entering the space occupied by it, that it was in a different degree of heat from the rest of surrounding space. But he would not find that portion of space by any means equally warm throughout, for warmer and colder parts would alternate in the most complicated manner. Radiating heat would be felt along certain lines. And not only straight lines, but regular figures [pg 123] would be formed by the variation in heat. Something like a cosmic being, organically constructed in itself would be discerned, appearing in changing conditions, and consisting only of heat.
If we focus our spiritual awareness not on the beginning and end, but on the middle phase of this Saturn incarnation, we notice a condition that is mainly characterized by heat. There's nothing made up of gas, liquid, or even solid matter; those states emerge only in later incarnations. Imagine a person with our current senses trying to experience the Saturn condition as an observer. The only sensory experience available to them would be the sensation of warmth or heat. If such a being approached Saturn, they would only notice that it had a different temperature compared to the surrounding space. However, that area wouldn't be uniformly warm; it would have alternating warm and cold regions in a complex pattern. Heat would radiate along specific lines, and not just in straight paths but also in distinct shapes formed by the variations in temperature. One could perceive something like a cosmic entity, inherently structured, manifesting in fluctuating conditions and consisting solely of heat.
It is difficult for a man of the present day to form an idea of anything consisting only of heat, for he is not accustomed to think of heat as something self-existent, but as a perceptible quality of warm or cold gaseous, liquid, or solid bodies. To one who has adopted the physical conceptions of our time it will seem particularly absurd to speak of heat in the foregoing manner. He will, perhaps, say: “There are solid, liquid, and gaseous bodies; but heat only denotes a condition assumed by one of these three bodily forms. If the smallest particles of gas are in motion, the movement will be felt by heat. Where there is no gas, there can be no movement, consequently no heat.”
It's hard for someone today to imagine anything that is just heat, because we don't think of heat as something that exists on its own. Instead, we see it as a noticeable quality of warm or cold gases, liquids, or solids. To someone who has embraced modern scientific ideas, it would seem really odd to talk about heat like that. They might say: "There are solid, liquid, and gas states, but heat is just a condition that one of these states can be in. When the smallest particles of gas are moving, we experience that as heat. If there's no gas, there's no movement, and thus no heat."
To an occult investigator the fact appears differently. To him heat is something of which he speaks in the same sense as he speaks of gases, of liquids, or of solid bodies. To him it is simply a still finer substance than gas. And gas to him is nothing but condensed heat, in the same sense that liquid is condensed vapour, or a solid body condensed liquid. Thus the occultist speaks of heat bodies just as he does of bodies formed of gas and vapour.
To an occult investigator, the situation looks different. For him, heat is something he discusses just like he talks about gases, liquids, or solid objects. To him, it's simply a finer substance than gas. And gas, to him, is just condensed heat, in the same way that liquid is condensed vapor, or a solid object is condensed liquid. So, the occultist refers to heat bodies just like he does to bodies made of gas and vapor.
If we are to follow the spiritual investigator into this region, it is however necessary to admit that there is such a thing as psychic perception. In the world, as it presents itself to the physical senses, [pg 124] heat appears entirely as a condition of solid, liquid, or gaseous bodies; but that condition is merely the outward appearance of heat, or the effect of it. Physicists speak only of this effect of heat, not of its inner nature. Just let us try then to leave entirely out of consideration any effect of heat received through external bodies, and to realize merely the inner experience which comes from saying the words: “I feel warm,” “I feel cold.” That inner experience is the only thing capable of giving an idea of what Saturn was during its period of evolution described above. It would have been possible to pass right through the portion of space it occupied; no gas would have been there to exercise pressure, no solid or liquid body from which light-impressions could have come; but at every point of space occupied, one would have felt inwardly, without any external impression: “Here there is such and such a degree of heat.”
If we're going to follow the spiritual investigator into this area, we need to acknowledge that psychic perception exists. In the world as we see it through our physical senses, heat only seems to show up as a condition of solid, liquid, or gas. But that appearance is just the surface manifestation of heat, or its effect. Physicists focus only on this effect of heat, not on its true essence. So, let’s try to ignore any effects of heat that come from external sources, and instead focus on the inner experience we get from saying the words: “I feel cozy,” "I'm cold." That inner experience is the only way to understand what Saturn was like during its evolution described earlier. One could have passed right through the area it occupied; there would have been no gas to create pressure, no solid or liquid body to produce light impressions; but at every point in the space it took up, one would have felt internally, without any outside stimulation: “It’s this hot here.”
In a cosmic body of this character there are no conditions for the animal, vegetable, and mineral organisms of to-day.9 The beings whose sphere of action was this Saturn, were at quite a different stage of evolution from that of the present inhabitants of the earth who are perceptible to the senses. In the first place there were beings there who had no physical body like that of contemporary man. We [pg 125] must also guard against thinking of man's present physical embodiment, when mention is made of a “physical body” in this connection. We should instead carefully distinguish between the physical and the mineral body. A physical body is one governed by the physical laws which are now observable in the mineral kingdom. Now man's present physical body is not only ruled by those physical laws, but is also permeated with mineral matter. There can be no question as yet on Saturn of a physical-mineral body of this kind. There is only a physical bodily form, governed by physical laws; but these laws are manifested only through the agency of heat.
In a cosmic body like this, the conditions for today's animal, plant, and mineral organisms don’t exist. The beings that operated in this Saturn were at a very different level of evolution compared to the current inhabitants of Earth who can be perceived by the senses. Firstly, there were beings there that didn’t have a physical body like contemporary humans. We need to avoid equating humans' present physical form to what’s referred to as a “physical body” in this context. Instead, we should clearly differentiate between the physical body and the mineral body. A physical body is one that is governed by the physical laws currently observed in the mineral kingdom. However, today’s human physical body is not only influenced by those physical laws but is also filled with mineral matter. There’s no question on Saturn about having a physical-mineral body of this kind. There is only a physical bodily form, governed by physical laws; however, these laws are expressed solely through the influence of heat.
Therefore the physical body is a fine, subtle, ethereal heat body; and the whole of Saturn consists of such heat bodies. They are the beginnings of the present physical-mineral human body. The latter has been formed out of the former, because there have become incorporated with the original body the more recently formed gaseous, liquid, and solid substances.
Therefore, the physical body is a delicate, subtle, ethereal heat body; and the entirety of Saturn consists of these heat bodies. They are the early stages of the current physical-mineral human body. The latter has evolved from the former, as the more recently formed gaseous, liquid, and solid substances have integrated with the original body.
Among the beings of which we are now speaking, who, besides man, were inhabitants of Saturn, there were, for instance, some which did not need a physical body at all. The lowest principle of their nature was an etheric or vital body. On the other hand, they had one principle higher than the human principles. Man's highest principle is the Spirit-Man (Atma); these beings have one still higher. And between the etheric body and the Spirit-Man they have all the principles described in this treatise [pg 126] which are also found in man: the astral body, ego, Spirit-Self, and Life-Spirit. Just as our earth is surrounded by an atmosphere, so too was Saturn; only in this case the “atmosphere” was of a spiritual nature. It really consisted of the beings just named and some others. Now there was constant reciprocal action between the heat bodies of Saturn and the beings we have described. The latter projected the principles of their being down into the physical heat bodies of Saturn. And while there was no life in those heat bodies themselves, the life of their neighbours was expressed in them. They might be compared to mirrors; only there were reflected in them, not the images of the living beings mentioned above, but their conditions of life. Therefore, although nothing living could have been discovered in Saturn itself, yet it had a vivifying effect on its environment in celestial space, because it reflected back into space, like an echo, the life which had been sent down into it. The whole of Saturn appeared as a mirror of celestial life. The very high beings, whose life was reflected by Saturn, are called in occult science “Lords of Wisdom.”10 Their activity on Saturn was not just beginning in the middle period of that evolution, which has been described; in a certain way it had even then already ceased. Before they could be in a position to rejoice in the reflection of their own life from Saturn's heat bodies they had to make those bodies capable of producing [pg 127] such a reflection. Therefore their activity began soon after the beginning of the Saturn evolution. When this happened, the body of Saturn was still chaotic material, which could not have reflected anything.
Among the beings we're discussing, besides humans, who lived on Saturn, there were some that didn’t need a physical body at all. The most basic aspect of their nature was an etheric or vital body. However, they also had one principle that was above human principles. For humans, the highest principle is the Spirit-Man (Atma); these beings possessed something even higher. Between the etheric body and the Spirit-Man, they had all the principles outlined in this treatise [pg 126] that are also found in humans: the astral body, ego, Spirit-Self, and Life-Spirit. Just like Earth is surrounded by an atmosphere, Saturn had one too; but in this case, the "environment" was of a spiritual nature. It was essentially made up of the beings just mentioned and a few others. There was continual interaction between the heat bodies of Saturn and the beings we described. The latter projected the principles of their being into the physical heat bodies of Saturn. Although those heat bodies had no life of their own, they expressed the life of their neighbors. They could be compared to mirrors; but instead of reflecting the images of the living beings mentioned earlier, they reflected their life conditions. So, even though nothing alive could be found on Saturn itself, it had a life-giving effect on its surroundings in celestial space, because it reflected back into space, like an echo, the life that had been sent into it. The entire Saturn appeared as a mirror of celestial life. The very high beings, whose life was mirrored by Saturn, are referred to in occult science as "Masters of Knowledge."10 Their activity on Saturn didn’t just begin in the middle period of the evolution described; in a way, it had already begun to taper off. Before they could enjoy the reflection of their own life from Saturn’s heat bodies, they needed to make those bodies capable of producing [pg 127] such a reflection. Therefore, their activity started shortly after the beginning of Saturn's evolution. When this happened, Saturn's body was still made of chaotic material, which couldn’t reflect anything.
And in contemplating this chaotic matter, one has transferred himself, by spiritual observation, to the beginning of the Saturn evolution. What is to be observed there does not as yet bear anything of the later character of heat. If we wish to describe it, we can only speak of a quality which may be compared with the human will. From first to last it is nothing but “Will.” Therefore it is an entirely spiritual condition that meets us here. If we ask whence came this “Will,” we see it proceeding from the effluence of exalted beings, who brought their evolution, by steps only to be dimly conceived, up to such a height that when the Saturn evolution began they were able to pour forth “Will” from their own being. When this effluence had lasted a certain time, the activity of the Lords of Wisdom described above was combined with this Will. Through this means the will, which had hitherto had no attributes, gradually received the quality of reflecting life back into celestial space. In occult science the beings who found their happiness in pouring forth will, at the beginning of the Saturn evolution are called the “Lords of Will.”11
And while reflecting on this chaotic situation, one has, through spiritual observation, transported themselves to the start of the Saturn evolution. What can be observed there doesn’t yet show any of the later characteristics of heat. If we want to describe it, we can only refer to a quality that can be compared to human will. From beginning to end, it is nothing but "Will." Therefore, it is a completely spiritual state we encounter here. If we ask where this "Will," comes from, we see it arising from the outpouring of elevated beings who advanced their evolution, through steps hard to grasp, to such a point that when the Saturn evolution commenced, they could express "Will" from their own essence. Once this outpouring lasted for a certain period, the actions of the Lords of Wisdom mentioned earlier merged with this Will. As a result, the will, which until then lacked any attributes, gradually gained the ability to reflect life back into the celestial space. In occult science, the beings who found joy in expressing will at the beginning of the Saturn evolution are referred to as the "Masters of Will."11
After a certain stage of the Saturn evolution had been reached, through the co-operation of will and [pg 128] life, begins the influence of other beings, who are also within Saturn's environment. These are the “Lords of Motion.”12 They have no physical or etheric body. Their lowest principle is the astral body. When the Saturn bodies have acquired the capacity for reflecting life, the qualities which have their seat in the astral bodies of the Lords of Motion interpenetrate that reflected life. In consequence of this, it appears as though expressions of feelings, emotions, and similar psychic forces had been cast out of Saturn into celestial space. The whole of Saturn appears like one animated being, manifesting sympathies and antipathies. These psychic manifestations, however, are by no means its own, but merely the activity of the Lords of Motion reflected back.
After a certain point in the evolution of Saturn was reached, thanks to the collaboration of will and life, the influence of other beings within Saturn's environment starts to emerge. These are the “Lords of Motion.” They don't possess a physical or etheric body; their lowest aspect is the astral body. Once the beings of Saturn have developed the ability to reflect life, the qualities residing in the astral bodies of the Lords of Motion begin to blend with that reflected life. As a result, it seems like expressions of feelings, emotions, and other psychic forces have been launched out of Saturn into outer space. The entire Saturn appears to function like a single animated being, showing feelings of attraction and aversion. However, these psychic manifestations are not its own; they are simply the activity of the Lords of Motion reflected back.
This also having lasted for a certain period, there begins the activity of yet other beings, that is, of the “Lords of Form.”13 Their lowest principle, too, is an astral body; but that body is at a different stage of evolution from that of the Lords of Motion; whereas the latter communicate only general manifestations of feeling to the reflected life, the astral body of the Lords of Form operates in such a way that the manifestations of feeling are flung out into cosmic space as if they came from individual beings. It might be said that the Lords of Motion make the whole of Saturn appear as an animated being. The Lords of Form separate that life into individual living [pg 129] beings, so that Saturn now appears as a conglomerate of such psychic beings.
This phase also lasted for a while, and then the activity of other beings begins, namely the "Masters of Form."13 Their most basic essence is an astral body, but that body is at a different stage of evolution compared to the Lords of Motion. While the latter only communicate general feelings to the reflected life, the astral body of the Lords of Form works in a way that projects feelings out into cosmic space as if they originated from individual beings. One could say that the Lords of Motion make Saturn seem like a living entity. The Lords of Form, however, take that life and break it into individual living [pg 129] beings, meaning Saturn now appears as a collection of such psychic beings.
Let us imagine, for the sake of illustration, a mulberry or blackberry, made up, as it is, of small individual berries. In a similar manner, to clairvoyant vision, Saturn, during the period of evolution now being described, is made up of individual Saturn beings, which of course have neither life nor soul of their own, but reflect the life and soul of its denizens. Into this condition of Saturn now come beings whose astral body is also their lowest principle, but who have brought it to such a high stage of development that it operates in the same way as the present human ego. Through these beings, the ego in the environment of Saturn looks down on that planet, and imparts its nature to Saturn's individual living beings. Thus something is sent out from Saturn into cosmic space, which has an effect similar to that of human personality in the present conditions of life. The beings causing that effect are designated “Sons of Personality.”14 They confer on the Saturn bodies the appearance of personality. Personality itself, however, is not present on Saturn, but only, as it were, its reflected image, the shell or husk of personality. The real personality of these spirits is in the environment of Saturn. As a result of these Sons of Personality letting their essence stream back from the Saturn bodies in the manner described, that fine substance is bestowed on those bodies which has previously been described [pg 130] as heat. In the whole of Saturn there is no subjectivity; but the Sons of Personality recognize the image of their own subjectivity, when it streams out to them from Saturn as heat.
Let's picture, for illustration, a mulberry or blackberry, which consists of many small individual berries. Similarly, to clairvoyant vision, Saturn, during the evolutionary period we're talking about, is made up of individual Saturn beings, which don’t have their own life or soul, but reflect the life and soul of its inhabitants. Into this state of Saturn come beings whose astral body is also their lowest principle. However, these beings have developed it to such an advanced stage that it functions like the current human ego. Through these beings, the ego in the Saturn environment looks down on the planet and influences the nature of Saturn's individual living beings. Thus, something is sent out from Saturn into cosmic space, producing an effect similar to that of human personality in today's life. The beings creating that effect are referred to as “Personality Sons.”14 They give the Saturn bodies the appearance of personality. However, true personality is not present on Saturn, only a reflected image, the shell or husk of personality. The actual personality of these spirits exists in the Saturn environment. As a result of the Sons of Personality allowing their essence to stream back from the Saturn bodies in this way, that fine substance previously described [pg 130] as heat is granted to those bodies. Throughout Saturn, there is no subjectivity; yet the Sons of Personality recognize their own subjectivity when it streams out to them from Saturn as heat.
When all this is taking place, the Sons of Personality are on the same level on which man now stands. They are then passing through their “human” period. In order to look at this fact with an unprejudiced eye, we must imagine it possible for a being to be human without being in the exact form in which man now exists. The Sons of Personality are “human beings” on Saturn. They have as their lowest principle not the physical body, but the astral body with the ego. Hence they cannot express the experiences of their astral body in such physical and etheric bodies as those of contemporary man; they not only have an ego, however, but are aware of the fact, because the heat of Saturn brings that ego streaming back into their consciousness. In fact, they are human beings under different circumstances from those of earth.
When all this is happening, the Sons of Personality are on the same level as humans today. They are going through their "human" phase. To understand this fact without bias, we need to imagine that it’s possible for a being to be human without having the exact form that we see in people today. The Sons of Personality are "humans" on Saturn. Their most basic principle isn't the physical body, but the astral body with the ego. So, they can't express the experiences of their astral body through the physical and etheric bodies like those of modern humans; they not only have an ego, but they also are informed of it because the warmth of Saturn draws that ego back into their consciousness. In fact, they are human beings in circumstances that are different from those on Earth.
As the Saturn evolution progressed, facts follow of a different kind from those already related. Whereas everything hitherto was a reflection of outer life and feeling, there now begins a kind of inner life. In the Saturn world a life of light begins flickering here and there, and growing dim again. A quivering glimmer is seen in some places, something like flashes of lightning in others. The Saturn heat bodies begin to glimmer, to sparkle, and even to emit rays. This stage of evolution having been [pg 131] reached, there again arises the possibility for certain beings to develop their activity. They are those known to occult science as “Sons of Fire.”15 Although these beings have an astral body, they are unable at his particular stage of their existence to stir their own astral bodies; they would not be capable of any feeling or emotion unless they could act upon the Saturn heat bodies which have attained the stage of evolution described. That action affords them the possibility of recognizing their own existence from the effect which they produce. They cannot say to themselves, “I am here”; but rather, “My environment causes me to be here.” They have perceptions, and what they perceive is the light-effects in Saturn which have been described. These are, in a certain manner, their ego. This gives them a peculiar kind of consciousness. It is designated “picture-consciousness.” It may be represented as having the nature of human dream-consciousness, except that the degree of activity it enjoys must be imagined as being very much greater than it is in human dreams, and also that it is not a question of shadowy dream-pictures floating hither and thither, but of pictures that have a real connection with the play of light on Saturn.
As the evolution of Saturn continued, different kinds of facts emerged compared to those previously mentioned. While everything so far reflected external life and emotions, a kind of inner life began to take shape. In the Saturn realm, a life of light starts to flicker here and there, only to dim again. A shimmering light is seen in some areas, resembling flashes of lightning in others. The heat bodies of Saturn begin to shimmer, sparkle, and even emit rays. Once this stage of evolution is reached, certain beings have the opportunity to develop their activity. They are referred to in occult science as the “Sons of Fire.” Although these beings possess an astral body, they are unable at this particular stage of their existence to move their own astral bodies; they cannot experience any feelings or emotions unless they can act upon the Saturn heat bodies that have reached this described stage of evolution. This action allows them to recognize their own existence through the effects they produce. They cannot think, “I am here”; instead, they feel, “My environment causes me to be here.” They have perceptions, and what they perceive are the light effects on Saturn that have been described. In a way, these effects constitute their ego. This results in a unique kind of consciousness referred to as “picture-consciousness.” It could be compared to human dream-consciousness, but the level of activity it experiences is much greater than in human dreams, and it's not about vague dream images drifting around; it's about images that have a real connection with the play of light on Saturn.
During this reciprocal action between the Sons of Fire and the Saturn heat bodies, the germs of the human sense organs begin their evolution. The organs, by means of which contemporary man becomes cognizant of the physical world, begin to [pg 132] shine in their first delicate ethereal outlines. Human phantoms, displaying as yet nothing but the primeval light pictures of the sense-organs, become discernible within Saturn to the clairvoyant faculty of perception. Thus these sense-organs are the result of the activity of the Sons of Fire; but they are not the only spirits who shared in their creation. Other beings come upon the scene of Saturn at the same time as these Sons of Fire,—beings so far advanced in their evolution that they are able to make use of the germs of the human sense-organs for beholding the cosmic events taking place in the Saturn life. They are the “Lords of Love.”16 If they were not there, the Sons of Fire could not have the consciousness described above. They behold the events on Saturn with a consciousness which makes it possible for them to convey these events as pictures to the Sons of Fire. They themselves forego all the advantages which might accrue to them from contemplating events on Saturn; they renounce all joys and pleasures; they give up all these in order that the Sons of Fire may come into possession of them.
During the mutual interaction between the Sons of Fire and the Saturn heat bodies, the foundations of human sense organs begin to develop. These organs, which allow modern humans to perceive the physical world, start to emerge in their first subtle, ethereal forms. Human figures, showing only the primitive light images of the sense organs, become visible within Saturn to those with the ability to perceive clairvoyantly. Thus, these sense organs result from the work of the Sons of Fire; however, they are not the only beings involved in their creation. Other entities arrive on Saturn at the same time as the Sons of Fire—beings so advanced in their evolution that they can use the germs of the human sense organs to witness the cosmic events unfolding in Saturn’s existence. They are the "Masters of Love."16 Without their presence, the Sons of Fire would not possess the consciousness described above. They observe events on Saturn with a level of awareness that allows them to share these events as images with the Sons of Fire. They forgo all the benefits they could gain from witnessing events on Saturn; they renounce all joys and pleasures, giving everything up so that the Sons of Fire can experience them.
A new period of Saturn's existence succeeds these occurrences. Something else is added to the play of light. If what here presents itself to clairvoyant perception be reported, it may seem an absurdity to many. Within Saturn, intermingled sensations of taste seem to be surging. Sweet, bitter, sour, etc., are perceived throughout the interior of Saturn; [pg 133] while without, in cosmic space, all this expresses itself as tone, as a kind of music.
A new phase of Saturn's existence follows these events. Something new is added to the dance of light. If what is perceived by clairvoyant insight is shared, it might sound ridiculous to many. Inside Saturn, mixed sensations of taste seem to be rising. Sweet, bitter, sour, and so on are felt throughout Saturn's interior; [pg 133] while outside, in cosmic space, all this reveals itself as sound, like a kind of music.
In the course of these processes there are again certain beings who find it possible to develop activity on Saturn. These are the “Sons of Twilight, or Life.”17 They enter into reciprocal action with the forces of taste surging up and down within Saturn. By this means their etheric or vital body attains a state of such activity that it may be called a kind of metabolism. They bring life into the interior of Saturn. Hence processes of nutrition and excretion take place. This inner life makes it possible for yet other beings to come into the planet, the “Lords of Harmony.”18 They bestow a dim kind of consciousness on the Sons of Life, which is even more vague and dim than the dream-consciousness of contemporary man. It is of the kind that now comes to man in dreamless sleep, and is, indeed, of such a low order that it does not, so to speak, “enter into his consciousness.” Yet it is there. It differs from waking consciousness in degree and also in its nature. Plants, too, have this dreamless-sleep consciousness at the present time. Even though it does not bring about any perceptions of an external world, in the human sense of the word, yet it regulates the life processes and brings them into harmony with the processes of the outer world.
In the course of these processes, there are still certain beings who manage to be active on Saturn. These are the “Sons of Twilight, or Life.”17 They interact with the forces of taste rising and falling within Saturn. Through this interaction, their etheric or vital body reaches a level of activity that can be described as a form of metabolism. They introduce life into the depths of Saturn. As a result, processes of nutrition and excretion occur. This inner life allows other beings to enter the planet, the "Masters of Harmony."18 They provide a faint kind of consciousness to the Sons of Life, which is even more indistinct than the dream-like consciousness of modern humans. It resembles the state humans experience in dreamless sleep and is so primitive that it doesn't, so to speak, "enter his consciousness." Yet it exists. It differs from waking consciousness in both degree and nature. Plants, too, currently possess this dreamless-sleep consciousness. While it doesn't create perceptions of an external world in the human sense, it does regulate life processes and aligns them with the cycles of the outer world.
This adjustment cannot be perceived by the Sons of Life at the stage of Saturn's evolution now being [pg 134] described; but the Lords of Harmony perceive it, and therefore it is they who really do the adjusting. All this life is enacted within the human phantoms already described. To clairvoyant vision they consequently appear animated; yet their life is only a semblance of life. It is the life of the “Sons of Life,” who, so to speak, make use of the human phantoms in order to manifest themselves.
This adjustment can't be noticed by the Sons of Life at the current stage of Saturn's evolution being described; however, the Lords of Harmony can see it, so they are the ones who actually make the adjustments. All this life is played out within the human forms already mentioned. To clairvoyant vision, they seem lively; still, their life is just an appearance of life. It's the life of the “Children of Life,” who effectively use the human forms to express themselves.
Let us now turn our attention to the human phantoms with their semblance of life. During the Saturn period described, their form is constantly changing. Sometimes they bear one aspect, sometimes another. In the further course of evolution, their forms become more definite, and occasionally permanent. This is due to their becoming interpenetrated by the action of the Spirits described at the beginning of the Saturn evolution,—the Lords of Will (the Thrones). The consequence is that the human phantom itself is endowed with the simplest, dullest form of consciousness. This must be thought of as still duller than the consciousness of dreamless sleep. Under present conditions, minerals have that consciousness. It brings the inner being into harmony with the outer physical world. On Saturn it is the Lords of Will who regulate that harmony. And thus man appears as a copy of the Saturn life itself. That life which is on a large scale on Saturn, is at this stage on a small scale in man. Thus the first germ is prepared for that which is still only a germ in contemporary man the “Spirit-Man” (Atma). This dull human will (within Saturn) is [pg 135] manifested to clairvoyant faculty by effects which may be compared with odours. Outside in celestial space, there is a manifestation like that of a personality, which however is not directed by an inner ego but is regulated from without, like a machine. Those who regulate it are the Lords of Will.
Let’s now focus on the human phantoms that seem to have life. During the Saturn phase described, their form is constantly changing. Sometimes they look one way, sometimes another. As evolution continues, their forms become more defined and occasionally permanent. This happens because they become influenced by the Spirits mentioned at the start of Saturn's evolution—the Lords of Will (the Thrones). As a result, the human phantom is given the simplest, most primitive form of consciousness. This should be considered even duller than the consciousness found in dreamless sleep. Right now, minerals possess that kind of consciousness. It aligns the inner being with the outer physical world. On Saturn, it is the Lords of Will who maintain that harmony. Thus, man appears as a reflection of the Saturn life itself. The life that exists on a grand scale on Saturn is, at this stage, mostly on a smaller scale in humans. Therefore, the first essence is prepared for what is still just a seed in modern humans, the "Spirit Guy" (Atma). This primitive human will (within Saturn) is [pg 135] perceived by clairvoyant vision through effects akin to scents. Out in celestial space, there’s a manifestation resembling a personality, but it isn’t directed by an inner ego; instead, it’s operated externally, like a machine. Those who manage it are the Lords of Will.
It will become evident, from a survey of the foregoing, that starting from the previously described middle period of the Saturn evolution, the following steps of that evolution can be characterized by comparing their effects with the sense-perceptions of the present time. It might be said that the Saturn evolution manifests as heat; then a play of light is added; then an appearance of taste and sound; finally something emerges which manifests within the interior of Saturn as sensations of smell, and without, as a human ego acting mechanically.
It will be clear from looking at the previous discussions that starting from the middle phase of Saturn's evolution, the next steps of that evolution can be described by comparing their effects to today’s experiences. One could say that Saturn's evolution starts as heat; then light begins to play a role; next, we add sensations of taste and sound; and finally, something appears that expresses itself internally on Saturn as the sense of smell, while externally, it shows as a human ego functioning mechanically.
What have the Saturn revelations to say about what preceded the heat condition? Now this is something that cannot be compared with anything accessible to outer sense-perception. A state of things precedes the heat condition, which contemporary man experiences only in his inner being. When he gives himself up to ideas which he forms in his own soul, without having any inducement brought to bear on him by an external impression, then he has something within himself which cannot be perceived by any physical sense, but is only accessible to the perception of the higher clairvoyant vision. Manifestations precede the heat condition of Saturn, which can only be perceived by a clairvoyant. Three such [pg 136] conditions may be mentioned: pure psychic warmth, not outwardly perceptible; pure spiritual light, which is outward darkness; and lastly, something of a spiritual essence which is complete in itself, and needs no outer being in order to become self-conscious. Pure, inner heat accompanies the appearance of the Lords of Motion; pure, spiritual light, that of the Lords of Wisdom; pure inner being is linked with the first emanation of the Lords of Will.
What do the Saturn revelations reveal about what came before the heat condition? This is something that can't be compared to anything we can sense externally. There’s a state that precedes the heat condition, which modern people only experience within themselves. When someone immerses themselves in ideas formed in their own soul without any external influences, they connect with something that can't be perceived by any physical senses, but is accessible only to higher clairvoyant perception. There are manifestations that come before the heat condition of Saturn, which can only be recognized by a clairvoyant. Three such conditions can be noted: pure psychic warmth, which isn’t outwardly detectable; pure spiritual light, which appears as outer darkness; and finally, something of a spiritual essence that is complete by itself and doesn’t require an external being to become self-aware. Pure inner heat is associated with the appearance of the Lords of Motion; pure spiritual light relates to the Lords of Wisdom; and pure inner being is connected to the first emanation of the Lords of Will.
Thus, with the appearance of heat on Saturn, our evolution comes forth out of the inner life of pure spirituality into outwardly manifested existence. It will be particularly difficult for present-day consciousness to accept this, if it must be said in addition that at the same time, with the advent of the Saturn heat condition, what we call “Time” also makes its first appearance. That is to say, the previous conditions have nothing to do with time. They belong to that sphere which may be called, in occult science, “duration.” Consequently, everything that is said in this book about the conditions existing in the “Sphere of Duration” must be understood in such a way that when expressions referring to time conditions are used, they are only to be accepted for the sake of comparison and explanation. That which, in a certain sense, precedes “time,” can be expressed in human language only by terms which imply the idea of time. Even if we are aware that the first, second, and third Saturn conditions were not enacted “one after the other,” [pg 137] in the present sense of the word, yet we cannot do otherwise than describe them one after the other. Indeed, in spite of their duration or coexistence in time, they are so dependent on one another that this very dependence may be compared with sequence, in time.
So, with the emergence of heat on Saturn, our evolution steps out from the inner life of pure spirituality into a reality that is outwardly expressed. It will be especially hard for modern awareness to accept this, especially since it also needs to be said that with the onset of the Saturn heat condition, what we refer to as "Time" also makes its first appearance. In other words, the previous conditions have nothing to do with time. They belong to a realm that can be termed, in occult science, “length of time.” Therefore, everything discussed in this book about the state of affairs in the "Duration Sphere" must be understood in such a way that when expressions related to time are used, they should only be taken for the sake of comparison and explanation. That which, in a certain sense, comes before “time,” can only be conveyed in human language through terms that imply the concept of time. Even if we recognize that the first, second, and third Saturn conditions did not unfold “one by one,” [pg 137] in the current sense of the term, we still have to describe them sequentially. Indeed, despite their coexistence or duration in time, they are so interdependent that this very dependence can be likened to a sequence in time.
This indication of the first conditions of evolution on Saturn also throws light on any further questions that may be asked as to the origin of those conditions. From the purely intellectual point of view, it is, of course, quite possible, when dealing with the source of anything, to inquire after “the source of the source.” But in the face of facts, this is not possible. A comparison, however, will help us to realize this. If we find ruts on a road we may ask, “To what are they due?” And the reply may be, “To a carriage.” It may further be asked: “Whence did the carriage come? Whither is it going?” An answer founded on fact is again possible. We may then proceed to ask, “Who occupied the carriage? What purpose had the person in using it? What was he, or she, doing?” At last, however, we shall reach a point at which inquiry by means of facts finds its natural limit; and on inquiring further we get away from the original questions. We only continue the inquiry mechanically, as it were.
This indication of the initial conditions of evolution on Saturn also sheds light on any additional questions regarding the origin of those conditions. From a purely intellectual standpoint, it is certainly possible to ask, when considering the source of something, “the source of the source.” However, in light of the facts, this is not feasible. A comparison will help us understand this. If we see tracks on a road, we might ask, "What triggered them?" The answer could be, “A carriage.” Further questions might include: "Where did the carriage come from? Where is it headed?" An answer based on facts is again possible. We could then continue to ask, "Who was in the carriage? Why were they using it? What were they doing?" Eventually, though, we will reach a point where inquiries based on facts hit their natural limit; and by questioning further, we stray from the original inquiries. We merely prolong the questioning mechanically, so to speak.
In such matters as the one brought forward as a comparison, it is easy to see where facts demand the end of the inquiry. It is not so evident when we are face to face with great cosmic questions. But [pg 138] as the result of really exact observation, it will nevertheless be seen that all inquiry as to origins must come to an end at the Saturn condition portrayed above. For we have reached a region in which beings and events are no longer justified by that from which they proceed, but by themselves.
In cases like the one we’re discussing, it’s clear when the facts require us to stop investigating. It’s not as obvious when we’re dealing with major cosmic questions. But [pg 138] based on truly accurate observation, we can see that any investigation into origins must conclude at the Saturn state described above. This is because we've arrived at a point where beings and events are validated not by what they come from, but by their own existence.
As a result of the Saturn evolution it appears that the human germ developed up to a certain point. It attained the low, dim state of consciousness described above. We must not imagine that its evolution does not begin until the last of the Saturn stages. The Lords of Will carry on their work through all conditions. Only the result is most striking to clairvoyant perception in the last period. There is nothing like a fixed boundary between the activities of the several groups of beings. If it is said that the Lords of Will work first, then the Lords of Wisdom, and so on, it is not meant that they are working only at that time. They are working all through the Saturn evolution; only their activity can best be observed during the periods specified. The several groups have, as it were, the leadership at those times.
As a result of the evolution of Saturn, it seems that the human germ developed to a certain point. It reached the low, dim state of consciousness described above. We shouldn't think that its evolution only starts in the final stages of Saturn. The Lords of Will continue their work through all conditions. However, the results are most noticeable to clairvoyant perception in the last period. There’s no clear boundary between the activities of the various groups of beings. When it’s said that the Lords of Will work first, followed by the Lords of Wisdom, and so on, it doesn’t mean they only work during that time. They are active throughout the Saturn evolution; it’s just that their work is most observable during the specified periods. The different groups, so to speak, take the lead during those times.
Thus the whole Saturn evolution appears as a working out of what streamed forth from the Lords of Will through the Lords of Wisdom, Motion, Form, and the rest. Through this process those spiritual beings themselves experience evolution. For instance, after they have received their life reflected back from Saturn, the Lords of Wisdom stand on a different level than before. The result of that activity [pg 139] exalts the faculties of their own being. The consequence is that, on the completion of such activity, something similar to human sleep comes upon them. To their periods of activity in connection with Saturn succeed other periods, during which they live, as it were, in other worlds. At these times their activity is withdrawn from Saturn. On this account clairvoyant perception sees an ascent and a descent in the Saturn evolution that has been described. The ascent lasts until the formation of the heat condition. Then, with the play of light, the ebb-tide sets in. When the human phantoms have assumed form through the Lords of Will, the spiritual beings have also gradually withdrawn themselves. The Saturn evolution dies away; as a phase of evolution, it disappears. A kind of resting pause occurs.
So, the entire evolution of Saturn looks like a realization of what flowed from the Lords of Will through the Lords of Wisdom, Motion, Form, and others. Through this process, those spiritual beings also go through evolution. For example, after they receive their life reflected back from Saturn, the Lords of Wisdom exist on a different level than they did before. The outcome of that activity enhances their own abilities. As a result, when this activity is complete, something akin to human sleep comes over them. Their active periods in relation to Saturn are followed by other periods, during which they exist, so to speak, in different worlds. During these times, their activity is taken away from Saturn. Because of this, clairvoyant perception reveals an upward and downward movement in the described evolution of Saturn. The ascent continues until the creation of the heat condition. Then, with the emergence of light, a decline begins. When the human shapes have taken form through the Lords of Will, the spiritual beings have also gradually pulled back. The evolution of Saturn fades away; as a phase of evolution, it vanishes. A kind of restful pause happens.
The human germ at the same time enters upon a state of dissolution; not, however, a state in which it passes away, but one like that of a plant seed, resting in the earth in order that it may ripen into a new plant. Thus the human germ reposes, until a new awakening, in the depth of the cosmos. And by the time the moment of awakening has arrived, the spiritual beings described above have acquired, under other conditions, the faculties by means of which they can further advance the human germ. The Lords of Wisdom have, in their etheric body, gained the faculty not only of enjoying the reflection of life as they did on Saturn, but of pouring life forth from themselves, and endowing other beings with it. The [pg 140] Lords of Motion are now as far advanced as were the Lords of Wisdom on Saturn. Then the lowest principle of their being was the astral body; they now possess an etheric, or vital body; and in a corresponding degree the other spiritual beings have reached a further stage of evolution. All these spiritual beings are therefore able to work at the further evolution of the human germ in a different way than on Saturn.
The human germ simultaneously enters a state of dissolution; not one in which it simply fades away, but one similar to a plant seed, resting in the soil to mature into a new plant. In this way, the human germ lies dormant, awaiting a new awakening, deep within the cosmos. By the time that moment of awakening arrives, the spiritual beings mentioned earlier have developed, under different conditions, the abilities that will enable them to further nurture the human germ. The Lords of Wisdom have, within their etheric bodies, acquired the ability not just to enjoy life's reflections as they did on Saturn, but to emanate life from themselves and share it with other beings. The Lords of Motion have now progressed as far as the Lords of Wisdom did back on Saturn. At that time, their lowest aspect was the astral body; they now possess an etheric, or vital body. Likewise, the other spiritual beings have also reached a further stage of evolution. Thus, all these spiritual beings can contribute to the further development of the human germ in ways that are different from what occurred on Saturn.
But the human germ was dissolved at the end of the Saturn evolution. In order that the more highly evolved spirit-beings might resume their work where they had left it off, the human germ must once more briefly recapitulate the stages through which it had passed on Saturn. This, in fact, is what appears to clairvoyant faculties of perception. The human germ comes forth out of its retirement and begins to develop by its own ability, by means of the forces which had been implanted within it on Saturn. It comes forth out of the darkness as a “being of Will,” and assumes the appearance of life, of soul qualities, etc., up to that mechanical manifestation of personality which it possessed at the end of the Saturn evolution.
But the human germ ended when the Saturn phase was over. For the more advanced spiritual beings to continue their work where they left off, the human germ needed to briefly go through the stages it went through on Saturn again. This is exactly what clairvoyant perception can see. The human germ emerges from its withdrawal and starts to develop using its own abilities and the forces that were instilled in it during Saturn. It comes out of the darkness as a "Willpower," taking on the characteristics of life, soul qualities, and so on, up to the mechanical manifestation of personality it had at the end of the Saturn evolution.
The second of the great periods of evolution that have been mentioned, the “Sun period,” effects the raising of man's being to a higher stage of consciousness than that which it had attained on Saturn. Compared with man's present state of consciousness, the Sun condition might certainly be [pg 141] termed “unconsciousness.” For it is approximately that condition which contemporary man experiences during absolutely dreamless sleep. Or it might be compared to the low degree of consciousness in which our vegetable world now slumbers. For occult science there is no such thing as unconsciousness, but only different degrees of consciousness. Everything in the world is conscious.
The second great period of evolution that has been mentioned, the "Sun phase," raises humanity's existence to a higher level of consciousness than it reached on Saturn. Compared to our current state of consciousness, the Sun condition could definitely be described as "unconsciousness." It's similar to the state we experience during deep, dreamless sleep. Alternatively, it can be compared to the low level of consciousness that our plant life currently exists in. In occult science, there’s no such thing as unconsciousness, just different levels of consciousness. Everything in the world has awareness.
In the course of the Sun evolution, the human being attains a higher degree of consciousness through the incorporation within it of the etheric, or vital body. Before this can take place the Saturn conditions must be recapitulated in the manner described above. This recapitulation has quite a definite meaning. That is to say, when the period of rest which was spoken of in the foregoing statement has come to an end, that which was formerly Saturn issues forth, out of “cosmic sleep,” as a new celestial body, the Sun. But the conditions of evolution have meanwhile changed. The spiritual beings, whose activity on behalf of Saturn we have portrayed, have progressed onward into different conditions. Yet at first the human germ appears on the newly formed Sun in the form it possessed on Saturn. It has first of all so to transform the various stages of evolution through which it has passed on Saturn that they may suit the new conditions on the Sun. Consequently, the sun epoch begins with a recapitulation of the occurrences on Saturn, adjusted to the changed conditions of Sun life. Now when the human being has advanced so far that the stage of [pg 142] evolution it reached on Saturn has been adapted to the Sun conditions, the Lords of Wisdom already mentioned, begin to let the etheric, or vital body, pour into the physical body. The higher stage which man reaches on the Sun may therefore be characterized in this way: the physical body, already formed in the germ-state on Saturn, is raised to a second stage of perfection by becoming the vehicle of an etheric or vital body. This last-named etheric body attains its first degree of perfection on its own account during the Sun evolution. In order, however, that the second degree of perfection for the physical and the first for the etheric body may be reached, the intervention of still other spirit-beings is necessary during the further course of the Sun life, in a similar manner to that which has been described as taking place during the Saturn stage.
In the course of the Sun's evolution, humans achieve a higher level of consciousness through the integration of the etheric or vital body. Before this can happen, the conditions of Saturn must be revisited as described earlier. This revisitation has a specific meaning. When the period of rest mentioned previously comes to an end, what was once Saturn emerges from “cosmic slumber,” as a new celestial body, the Sun. However, the conditions for evolution have changed. The spiritual beings, whose roles in relation to Saturn we’ve discussed, have advanced into different circumstances. Yet initially, the human germ appears on the newly formed Sun in the same form it had on Saturn. It must first transform the various stages of evolution it underwent on Saturn so they fit the new conditions on the Sun. Therefore, the Sun epoch begins with a recapitulation of the events on Saturn, modified to align with the new conditions of Sun life. Now, when humans have progressed to the point where the stage of evolution they reached on Saturn adapts to the Sun's conditions, the previously mentioned Lords of Wisdom start to allow the etheric, or vital body, to flow into the physical body. The higher stage that humans reach on the Sun can thus be described this way: the physical body, which was already formed in its germ state on Saturn, is elevated to a second stage of perfection by becoming the vessel for an etheric or vital body. This etheric body achieves its first degree of perfection during the Sun's evolution. However, for the physical body to reach its second degree of perfection and the etheric body its first, the involvement of other spirit beings is needed as the Sun life progresses, similar to what occurred during the Saturn stage.
When the Lords of Wisdom begin to stream forth their etheric body, the Sun, previously dark, begins to shine. At the same time the first appearances of inner activity are seen in the human germ; life has begun. What had to be described as a semblance of life on Saturn now becomes actual life. The influx lasts for a certain time, at the end of which an important change for the human germ sets in—that is to say, it organizes itself into two parts. Whereas up to this point the physical and etheric bodies formed an intimately connected whole, the physical body now begins to detach itself as a separate part. Yet even that separated physical body is still pervaded by the etheric body. Therefore we [pg 143] have now to do with a human being composed of two principles. One portion is a physical body permeated by an etheric body; the other is an etheric body and nothing else. This separation comes to pass, however, during a period of rest in the Sun life. During this pause the shining, which had begun to appear, dies away. The separation takes place during a “cosmic night,” as it were. Yet this interval of rest is much shorter than the one between the Saturn and Sun evolutions mentioned above. At the expiration of the rest period the Lords of Wisdom work for a while on the two-fold being of man, just as they had previously done on the undivided being. Then the Lords of Motion begin their activity. They cause their own astral body to stream through the human etheric body. By this means man acquires the capacity for executing certain inner movements in the physical body. These movements may be compared with those of sap in a plant of our own time.
When the Lords of Wisdom start to project their etheric body, the Sun, which was previously dark, begins to shine. At the same time, the first signs of inner activity can be observed in the human germ; life has started. What was once just a semblance of life on Saturn now transforms into actual life. This influx lasts for a certain period, after which a significant change occurs for the human germ—specifically, it organizes itself into two parts. Up until this point, the physical and etheric bodies formed a closely connected whole; now, the physical body begins to separate as an individual entity. However, even the separated physical body is still infused with the etheric body. As a result, we are now dealing with a human being made up of two principles. One part is a physical body filled with an etheric body; the other is simply an etheric body. This separation occurs during a period of rest in the Sun's life. During this pause, the light that had begun to shine fades away. The separation happens during a “cosmic night,” so to speak. Yet this rest period is much shorter than the one between the Saturn and Sun evolutions mentioned earlier. When the rest period ends, the Lords of Wisdom work on the dual nature of man for a while, just as they had previously worked on the undivided being. Then the Lords of Motion begin their activity. They send their own astral body through the human etheric body. This enables man to develop the ability to perform certain inner movements in the physical body. These movements can be compared to the flow of sap in a plant of our time.
The Saturn body consisted exclusively of heat substance. During the Sun evolution that heat substance is condensed into a state which may be compared with that of our present-day gas or steam. In occult science “air” is the name ordinarily used for this condition. The first beginnings of such a state are seen after the Lords of Motion have begun their activity. The following spectacle is presented to clairvoyant consciousness. Within the heat substance there appears something like delicate formations which are set in rythmic motion by the forces [pg 144] of the etheric body. These formations represent the human physical body at the stage of evolution now attained by it. They are permeated through and through with heat, and are also wrapped, as it were, in a heat envelope. From a physical point of view, man's nature may now be said to be composed of heat structures with air forms embedded in them—the latter in regular motion. Hence, if we wish to retain the foregoing comparison with a plant of the present day, we must remember that it is not a solid plant organism which we have to consider, but an air or gas form,19 the movements of which may be compared with the circulation of the sap in plants of to-day.
The Saturn body was made up entirely of heat substance. As the Sun evolved, this heat substance condensed into a state similar to our current gas or steam. In occult science, “air” is the term typically used for this condition. The initial signs of this state appear after the Lords of Motion have started their activity. Clairvoyant consciousness observes the following scene: within the heat substance, delicate formations emerge, set in rhythmic motion by the forces of the etheric body. These formations represent the human physical body at the stage of evolution it has now reached. They are fully infused with heat and are also surrounded by a heat envelope. From a physical perspective, one could say that human nature now consists of heat structures with air forms embedded within them, the latter being in regular motion. Therefore, if we want to keep the earlier comparison with a modern plant, we should note that we are not looking at a solid plant organism, but rather an air or gas form, the movements of which can be likened to the circulation of sap in today's plants.
The evolution thus indicated continues. After a certain time another interval of rest sets in; after this the Lords of Motion go on working until their activity is supplemented by that of the Lords of Form. The effect of the latter is that the gas structures, which before were constantly changing, now assume lasting form. This, too, happens because the Lords of Form cause their forces to flow in and out of the human etheric body. When the Lords of Motion alone were acting on the gaseous organisms, these were in perpetual motion, not keeping their form for an instant. Now, however, they temporarily assume distinguishable shapes. Again, after a certain period, there occurs a time of rest; and then once more the Lords of Form continue [pg 145] their activity. But the conditions within the Sun evolution are now entirely changed. For the point has been reached when the Sun evolution has attained its zenith. This is the time at which the Lords of Personality, who attained their human stage on Saturn, ascend to a higher degree of perfection. They advance beyond the human stage; they attain a form of consciousness which contemporary man does not yet possess in his normal course of development on the earth. He will acquire it when the earth—the fourth of the planetary stages of evolution—has reached its goal and has entered upon the next planetary period. Then man will not only perceive around him what his present physical senses enable him to apprehend, but he will be able to see in images the inner psychic conditions of the beings surrounding him. He will have a (clairvoyant) picture-consciousness, although retaining complete self-consciousness. There will be nothing dream-like or vague in his clairvoyance, but he will perceive what is psychic, in pictures certainly, but in such a way that these images will be the expression of realities, as physical colours and sounds are now. Man, at present, can attain to this degree of clairvoyance only through occult training, which will be treated later in this book.
The evolution being described is ongoing. After some time, there’s another break, and then the Lords of Motion continue their work until they’re joined by the Lords of Form. The result of this is that the gas structures, which used to change constantly, now take on a stable form. This happens because the Lords of Form allow their forces to flow in and out of the human etheric body. When only the Lords of Motion were influencing the gaseous organisms, these forms were always in motion, never holding their shape for even a moment. Now, they temporarily take on recognizable shapes. Again, after a period, there’s another time of rest; and once again, the Lords of Form resume their activity. However, the conditions within the Sun's evolution have completely changed. We’ve arrived at a point where the Sun’s evolution has reached its peak. This is when the Lords of Personality, who reached their human stage on Saturn, ascend to a higher level of perfection. They move beyond the human stage and achieve a form of consciousness that modern humans do not yet have in their normal development on Earth. He will gain this when the Earth—the fourth stage of planetary evolution—reaches its goal and begins the next planetary phase. Then, he won’t just perceive what his current physical senses allow him to see; he’ll also be able to visualize the inner psychic states of the beings around him. He will have a (clairvoyant) picture-consciousness, while still maintaining full self-awareness. His clairvoyance will not be dream-like or vague; he will perceive what is psychic in images, but these will be an expression of realities, just like physical colors and sounds are today. Currently, a person can only reach this level of clairvoyance through occult training, which will be discussed later in this book.
Now this clairvoyance is attained by the Sons of Personality, as a gift of their normal evolution, midway in the Sun period; and it is just on this account that they become capable of acting on the newly formed etheric body of man during the Sun [pg 146] evolution, in a way similar to that in which they acted on the physical body on Saturn. Just as there the heat reflected their own personality back to them, so do the gaseous organisms now reflect back to them, in gleams of light, the images of their clairvoyant consciousness. They clairvoyantly behold what is taking place on the Sun. And this vision is by no means mere observation; it is as though something of the force which mortals call love made itself felt in the images which stream forth from the Sun. If a clairvoyant looks more closely, he will find the cause of this phenomenon. Exalted beings have blended their activity with the light that is being radiated from the Sun. They are the Lords of Love (the Christian Seraphim) already mentioned. Henceforth they act, together with the Sons of Personality, on the human etheric, or vital body. By means of that activity the etheric body advances a step farther along its path of evolution. It acquires the capacity not only of transforming the gaseous forms within it, but of so elaborating them that the first indications of a propagation of living human beings appear. Emanations, so to speak, are driven out (as though exuded) from the gaseous organisms that take on shapes resembling their mother-forms.
Now, this clairvoyance is achieved by the Sons of Personality as a natural part of their evolution, occurring midway through the Sun period. It's because of this that they can interact with the newly formed etheric body of humans during the Sun evolution, similar to how they interacted with the physical body on Saturn. Just as there the heat reflected their own personalities back to them, the gaseous organisms now reflect back to them, in flashes of light, the images of their clairvoyant awareness. They can see what is happening on the Sun. This vision is not merely observational; it's as if the force that humans call love is expressed in the images radiating from the Sun. If a clairvoyant looks more closely, they will discover the reason for this phenomenon. Elevated beings have merged their influence with the light emitted from the Sun. They are the Lords of Love (the Christian Seraphim) previously mentioned. From now on, they will work together with the Sons of Personality to influence the human etheric, or vital body. Through this interaction, the etheric body evolves further along its path. It gains the ability not only to transform the gaseous forms within it but also to develop them to the point where the first signs of new living human beings emerge. Emanations, so to speak, are expelled (as if released) from the gaseous organisms that take on shapes reminiscent of their source forms.
In order to describe the further course of the Sun evolution, reference must be made to a fact in the formation of worlds which is of the greatest possible significance. It is this,—that by no means every being attains the goal of its evolution in the [pg 147] course of one epoch; there are some that fall short of that goal. Thus, during the Saturn evolution, not all of the Sons of Personality actually reached the human stage for which, as described above, they were destined; and just as little did all the physical human bodies, developed on Saturn, attain the degree of maturity which qualifies them to become vehicles of an independent etheric body on the Sun. The consequence is that beings and organisms are present on the Sun which are not in harmony with their environment. These must now make up, during the Sun evolution, for what they failed to attain on Saturn. The following may, therefore, be clairvoyantly observed during the Sun period. When the Lords of Wisdom begin their pouring in of the etheric body, the Sun body is to some extent darkened. Structures are mingled with it which, properly speaking, belong to Saturn. They are heat organisms which are not able to condense themselves into air in the proper manner. These are the human beings left behind in the Saturn stage. They are not able to become vehicles of a normally developed etheric body.
To describe the ongoing evolution of the Sun, we need to highlight a crucial fact about the formation of worlds. Not every being reaches its evolutionary goal in one era; some fall short. During the Saturn evolution, for example, not all of the Sons of Personality actually progressed to the human stage they were meant to reach, as mentioned earlier. Likewise, not all of the physical human bodies that developed on Saturn achieved the level of maturity necessary to serve as vessels for an independent etheric body on the Sun. As a result, there are beings and organisms present on the Sun that don't fit well with their surroundings. These beings must now catch up during the Sun evolution for what they couldn't achieve on Saturn. Therefore, the following can be clairvoyantly observed during the Sun period: when the Lords of Wisdom begin to pour in the etheric body, the Sun’s body becomes somewhat darkened. Structures that genuinely belong to Saturn mix in with it. These are heat organisms that can't properly condense into air. They represent the human beings who were left behind in the Saturn phase and are unable to become vessels for a normally developed etheric body.
Now the heat substance of Saturn, which has thus been left behind, splits into two parts on the Sun. One part is absorbed, as it were, by human bodies, and henceforward forms a kind of lower nature within man's being. Thus something, which really corresponds to the Saturn stage, is incorporated in the bodily part of man on the Sun. Now just as the Saturn body of man made it possible for the Sons [pg 148] of Personality to raise themselves to the human stage, the Saturn part of man performs the same office on the Sun for the Sons of Fire. They raise themselves to the human stage by letting their forces flow in and out of the Saturn part of man, as did the Sons of Personality on Saturn.
Now, the heat from Saturn that has been left behind splits into two parts on the Sun. One part is absorbed by human bodies, and from then on, it creates a sort of lower nature within a person's being. So, something that really relates to the Saturn stage gets incorporated into the physical part of humans on the Sun. Just as the Saturn body of humans allowed the Sons of Personality to advance to the human stage, the Saturn part of humans serves the same purpose on the Sun for the Sons of Fire. They elevate themselves to the human stage by allowing their energies to flow in and out of the Saturn part of humans, just like the Sons of Personality did on Saturn.
This also happens during the middle period of the Sun evolution. The Saturn part of the human being is then so far matured that with its help the Sons of Fire (Archangeloi) are able to pass through their human stage. Another part of the Saturnian heat substance becomes detached and attains an independent existence alongside of and among the human beings on the Sun. This forms a second kingdom by the side of the human kingdom, a kingdom which develops on the Sun only a perfectly independent physical body, like a heat body. In consequence of this, the fully evolved Sons of Personality are not able to direct their activity toward any independent etheric body in the manner before described. But there were also certain Sons of Personality left behind at the Saturn stage who fell short of the human stage. A bond of attraction exists between them and the second Sun kingdom which has become independent. They must now act toward the backward kingdom on the Sun as their advanced brethren did on Saturn in regard to human beings. The latter had only their physical body perfected here. But there is no possibility on the Sun for such a work on the part of the backward Sons of Personality. They therefore separate themselves from the [pg 149] Sun body, and form an independent celestial body outside it. This body, accordingly, withdraws from the Sun, and from it the backward Sons of Personality act on the beings of the second Sun kingdom which have been described. In this way two world-organisms have been formed out of the one which was previously Saturn. The Sun has now in its environment a second celestial body, one which exhibits a kind of re-birth of Saturn, a new Saturn. From this Saturn the character of personality is conferred on the second Sun kingdom. Therefore within this kingdom we have to do with beings which have no personality on the Sun itself. Yet they reflect back to the Sons of Personality on the new Saturn the special personality of those spirits. Clairvoyant consciousness is able to observe among the human beings on the Sun, heat forces which act upon the regular course of Sun evolution, and in which the sway of the spirits described as belonging to the new Saturn is to be seen.
This also happens during the middle phase of the Sun's evolution. The Saturn aspect of humanity has matured enough that, with its help, the Sons of Fire (Archangels) can move beyond their human stage. Another part of the Saturnian heat substance gets separated and takes on an independent existence alongside and among the humans on the Sun. This creates a second kingdom next to the human kingdom, a kingdom that develops a completely independent physical body, like a heat body, solely on the Sun. Because of this, the fully developed Sons of Personality can no longer direct their efforts toward any independent etheric body as previously outlined. However, some Sons of Personality were left behind at the Saturn stage and did not reach the human stage. There is an attraction between them and the now-independent second Sun kingdom. They must now interact with the backward kingdom on the Sun the way their more advanced counterparts did on Saturn with humans. The latter only perfected their physical bodies here. But the backward Sons of Personality cannot perform such work on the Sun. As a result, they separate from the Sun body and create an independent celestial body outside of it. This body, therefore, detaches from the Sun, and the backward Sons of Personality influence the beings of the second Sun kingdom described before. In this manner, two world-organisms have emerged from what was previously Saturn. The Sun now has around it a second celestial body that represents a kind of rebirth of Saturn, a new Saturn. From this new Saturn, the trait of personality is passed on to the second Sun kingdom. Thus, within this kingdom, we encounter beings lacking personality on the Sun itself. Yet, they reflect back to the Sons of Personality on the new Saturn the unique personality of those spirits. Clairvoyant awareness can perceive among the humans on the Sun heat forces that influence the normal course of Sun evolution, in which the influence of the spirits associated with the new Saturn can be observed.
We notice the following facts about man's being during the middle period of the Sun evolution. It is divided into a physical body and an etheric body. Within these the activity of the advanced Sons of Personality plays, conjointly with that of the Lords of Love. Now part of the backward Saturn nature is mingled with the physical body. In this plays the activity of the Sons of Fire. We now see in everything which the Sons of Fire effect on the backward Saturn nature, the forerunners of the present human sense-organs. It has been shown how these Sons [pg 150] of Fire were already at work on the elaboration of the sense-germs in the heat substance on Saturn. The first outline of the present human glands is to be recognized in what is accomplished by the Sons of Personality conjointly with the Lords of Love (Seraphim).
We observe the following about human existence during the middle stage of the Sun's evolution. It consists of a physical body and an etheric body. Within these, the efforts of the advanced Sons of Personality work alongside the Lords of Love. Currently, part of the primitive Saturn nature is mixed with the physical body, where the activity of the Sons of Fire is taking place. We can now see in everything that the Sons of Fire influence in the primitive Saturn nature, the beginnings of the current human sense organs. It has been demonstrated how these Sons of Fire were already involved in developing the sense-germs in the heat substance on Saturn. The initial form of today's human glands can be traced back to what has been achieved by the Sons of Personality together with the Lords of Love (Seraphim).
But the above described is not the whole of the activity of the Sons of Personality dwelling on the new Saturn. They not only extend their activity to the second Sun kingdom mentioned above, but they also establish a kind of connection between that kingdom and the human senses. The heat substances of this kingdom flow in and out of the germs of the human sense-organs. By this means the human being on the Sun acquires a kind of perception of the lower kingdom situated outside him. That perception is naturally a dim one, closely corresponding to the dull Saturn-consciousness previously described. And it consists essentially of varied heat effects.
But what's described above isn't the full scope of the activities of the Sons of Personality living on the new Saturn. They not only reach out to the second Sun kingdom mentioned earlier, but they also create a connection between that kingdom and human senses. The heat substances from this kingdom flow in and out of the germs of human sense-organs. Because of this, a human being on the Sun gains a sort of perception of the lower kingdom that exists outside of them. This perception is naturally vague, closely related to the dull Saturn-consciousness described earlier. Essentially, it consists of various heat effects.
Everything here described as taking place in the middle of the Sun evolution continues for a certain definite period. Then a time of rest again occurs. After that, things continue for a while in the same manner up to a certain point of evolution, at which the human etheric body is so far matured that a united action of the Sons of Life (Angeloi) and the Lords of Harmony (Cherubim) can set in. To clairvoyant consciousness, certain manifestations now appear within man's being, which may be compared with perceptions of taste, and which are [pg 151] made known externally as sounds. A similar thing has already been stated about the Saturn evolution. But here on the Sun the processes relating to human beings are more from within and are full of more independent life.
Everything described here as happening during the Sun's evolution continues for a specific period. Then there’s another time of rest. After that, things carry on for a while in the same way until a certain point in evolution, when the human etheric body has developed enough that the united action of the Sons of Life (Angels) and the Lords of Harmony (Cherubim) can take place. To clairvoyant perception, certain manifestations now appear within humans, which can be compared to sensations of taste, and are expressed externally as sounds. A similar observation was made about the Saturn evolution. However, on the Sun, the processes related to human beings are more intrinsic and exhibit a greater sense of independent life.
The Sons of Life thereby acquire that dim picture-consciousness which the Sons of Fire had already attained on Saturn. In this the Lords of Harmony are their helpers. They really behold clairvoyantly what is now being enacted within the Sun evolution; only they give up all the results of that contemplation, and the enjoyment of those revelations of Wisdom that arise from it, and allow them to stream, like splendid visions of enchantment, into the dream-like consciousness of the Sons of Life. The latter again work these pictures of their visions into the etheric body of man, so that it attains higher and higher stages of development.
The Sons of Life thus gain a faint awareness of images that the Sons of Fire had already achieved on Saturn. In this, the Lords of Harmony help them. They can see clairvoyantly what is currently happening within the Sun's evolution; however, they relinquish all the outcomes of that observation and the enjoyment of the insights that come from it, allowing those to flow, like beautiful visions of magic, into the dream-like awareness of the Sons of Life. The Sons of Life then incorporate these images of their visions into the etheric body of humanity, enabling it to reach higher and higher levels of development.
Again an interval of rest ensues, again everything is awakened from “cosmic sleep”; and after further lapse of time the human being is sufficiently advanced to use its own forces. These forces are the same that were poured forth into man's being by the “Thrones” during the latter part of the Saturn period. This human being now evolves an inner life, which, in its manifestation to clairvoyant consciousness, may be compared with an inner perception of smell. But outside, in the direction of celestial space, man's being is manifested as a personality, though not one directed by an inner ego. It appears more like a plant with the character of a personality. [pg 152] It has been stated that at the end of the Saturn evolution personality is manifested somewhat machine like. And just as then, the first germ was developed of that which still remains a germ in contemporary man,—the Spirit-Man (Atma),—so at this point there is formed a similar first germ of the Life-Spirit (Budhi).
Once again, a period of rest follows, and everything is brought out of “cosmic dreaming”; after some time, humans are advanced enough to harness their own energies. These energies are the same ones that were infused into humanity by the "Game of Thrones" during the later part of the Saturn period. At this stage, humans develop an inner life that, when perceived clairvoyantly, can be likened to an inner sense of smell. However, on the outside, in the realm of celestial space, a person's being appears as a personality, but it’s not driven by an inner self. It seems more like a plant with a personality. [pg 152] It has been noted that by the end of the Saturn evolution, personality takes on a somewhat mechanical quality. Just as then, the first essence of what remains a potential in modern humans—the Spirit-Man (Atma)—is developed, similarly at this point, the initial essence of the Life-Spirit (Budhi) is formed.
When all this has continued for some time, an interval of rest again occurs. Following this, as in previous instances, the activity of the human being is resumed for a while. Then conditions commence, which mark a new intervention of the Lords of Wisdom. By its means human nature becomes capable of feeling the first traces of sympathy and antipathy for its environment. In all this there is still no real sensation but only a premonition of sensation. For the inner life-activity, which might be characterized in its manifestation as perception of smell, is revealed externally as a kind of primitive language. If the human being is inwardly conscious of a useful smell—or taste, or glitter,—it is manifested outwardly by a sound; and the same thing happens, in a corresponding way, with an inwardly uncongenial perception. Through all the events described, the real meaning of the Sun evolution for the human being is indicated. The human being has reached a higher stage of consciousness than that of the Saturn period. It is the consciousness of sleep.
After this goes on for a while, there's a break for rest. Then, similar to before, human activities start up again for a time. Conditions begin to change, signaling a new intervention from the Lords of Wisdom. This intervention allows humans to start experiencing the first hints of sympathy and dislike for their surroundings. At this point, there's still no true sensation, just a sense of something to come. The inner activity, which could be described as the perception of smell, shows up externally as a sort of basic language. If a person feels aware of a pleasant smell— or taste, or shine— it’s expressed outwardly through a sound; the same goes for unpleasant sensations. Through all these events, the true significance of the Sun evolution for humans is revealed. Humanity has reached a higher level of consciousness than during the Saturn phase. This level is akin to a state of sleep.
After a time, the point of evolution is also reached at which the higher beings connected with the Sun stage must pass into other spheres in order [pg 153] to work out that with which they have endowed themselves by their work on the human being. A long period of rest sets in, one similar to that between the Saturn and Sun evolutions. Everything that has been perfected on the Sun passes into a condition which may be compared with that of a plant when its powers of growth are resting in the seed. But just as those powers of growth appear again in a new plant, so does everything that was living on the Sun come forth again, after the period of rest, from the cosmic depths, to begin a new planetary existence.
After a while, the point in evolution is reached where the higher beings associated with the Sun stage must move into other realms to fulfill what they have gained through their work with humans. A long period of rest occurs, similar to that between the Saturn and Sun evolutions. Everything that has been perfected on the Sun enters a state comparable to a plant resting in its seed. Just as the growth powers emerge again in a new plant, everything that lived on the Sun re-emerges from the cosmic depths after the rest period to begin a new planetary existence.
The meaning of such a term of rest, or “cosmic sleep,” will readily be understood if we will only direct our spiritual vision to one of the orders of beings already mentioned, for instance, to the Lords of Wisdom. They were not far enough evolved on Saturn to be able to ray forth an etheric body from themselves. They were only prepared for this after they had gone through their experiences on Saturn. During the rest (Pralaya) they transform into actual capacity what has been previously only prepared within them. Thus on the Sun they are evolved far enough to pour forth life from themselves, and to endow the human being with an etheric body of its own.
The significance of a term like rest, or “cosmic sleep,” becomes clear when we focus our spiritual perspective on one of the previously mentioned orders of beings, such as the Lords of Wisdom. They hadn't evolved enough on Saturn to emit an etheric body. They were only ready for that after their experiences on Saturn. During this rest (Pralaya), they transform what has been internally prepared into actual ability. Thus, on the Sun, they have evolved sufficiently to radiate life from themselves and to give humans their own etheric body.
After the interval of rest, that which had previously been the Sun comes forth again out of the “cosmic sleep.” That is, it again becomes perceptible to the clairvoyant faculties which had been able [pg 154] to observe it before, but had lost sight of it during the resting period. There are now two points to be observed with regard to the newly appearing planetary organism, which may, in occult science, be denoted the “Moon” (and this must not be confused with that portion of it which is now the earth's moon). In the first place, that which had detached itself during the Sun period as a “new Saturn” is once more within the new planetary body. This Saturn has therefore been again united with the Sun during the term of rest. Everything which was in the original Saturn reappears at first as one world-organism. Secondly, the human etheric bodies which had been formed on the Sun have been absorbed, during the resting period, by that which constitutes the spiritual sheath of the planet. At this point of time, therefore, they do not make their appearance united with the corresponding physical human bodies, but these latter at first appear separately. They contain everything which had been gained for them on Saturn and the Sun, but they are without the etheric, or vital body. Indeed, they cannot incorporate that etheric body within themselves immediately, for it has also been passing, during the period of rest, through an evolution with which they are not yet harmonized.
After the break, what used to be the Sun appears again out of the "cosmic sleep." In other words, it becomes visible to the clairvoyant abilities that had been able to perceive it before but lost sight of it during the resting phase. There are two key points to note about the newly appearing planetary being, which can be referred to in occult science as the “Moon” (and this should not be confused with the Earth's current moon). First, what separated itself during the Sun period as a “new Saturn” is once again part of the new planetary entity. Thus, this Saturn has been rejoined with the Sun during the resting time. Everything that was in the original Saturn reemerges at first as a single world-organism. Second, the human etheric bodies that had formed on the Sun were absorbed, during the resting period, by what makes up the spiritual layer of the planet. At this moment, they do not show up combined with their corresponding physical human bodies; rather, those bodies initially appear separately. They contain everything that was accumulated for them on Saturn and the Sun, but they lack the etheric or vital body. In fact, they cannot immediately integrate that etheric body because it has been undergoing its own evolution during the rest period, which is not yet aligned with them.
What occurs at the beginning of the Moon evolution, in order to bring about this adjustment, is, first of all, another recapitulation of the Saturnian events. The physical part of man passes once more through the stages of the Saturn evolution, but [pg 155] under greatly altered circumstances. On Saturn there were only the forces of a heat body at work within him; now there are also those of the gas body that has been elaborated. These latter forces do not, however, appear quite at the beginning of the Moon evolution. Then everything appears as though man's being were composed only of heat substance, and as though the gas forces were lying dormant within that substance. Then comes a time when the first indications of these forces make their appearance; and lastly, in the latest period of the Saturn recapitulation, man's being has the same appearance as during the animated period of his Sun existence. Yet, all life still proves to be but a semblance of life.
At the start of the Moon evolution, to create this shift, there’s another replay of the Saturn events. The physical aspect of humans goes through the stages of Saturn evolution again, but under significantly different conditions. On Saturn, only the forces of a heat-based body were at play; now, the forces of the developed gas body are also involved. However, these gas forces don’t show up right at the beginning of the Moon evolution. Initially, it seems like human existence is solely made up of heat substance, as if the gas forces are lying dormant within it. Then, a time comes when the first signs of these forces begin to emerge; and finally, in the later stage of the Saturn replay, human existence resembles what it looked like during the active phase of their Sun existence. Still, all life feels like just an illusion of life.
Next occurs a period of rest similar to the short periods of rest of the Sun evolution. Then the pouring in of the etheric body, for which the physical body has now become ripe, begins anew. As in the case of the recapitulation of Saturn, this influx takes place in three distinct periods. During the second of these, man's being is so far adjusted to the new Moon conditions that the Lords of Motion are able to bring into play the faculty they have acquired. This faculty consists in pouring the astral body out of their own being into man's being. They prepared themselves for this work during the Sun evolution, and during the time of rest between the Sun and Moon they transformed what had been prepared into the faculty alluded to. This influx lasts for a while, then one of the shorter intervals of rest sets in. [pg 156] After that the influx continues until the Lords of Form begin their activity. In consequence of this pouring of the astral body into the human being by the Lords of Motion, man acquires his first psychic qualities. He begins to develop sensations in connection with the processes which take place within, through the possession of an etheric body, and which during the Sun evolution were still of a plant-like nature; these processes now give him sensations of pleasure and displeasure. But it is nothing more than a constant inner ebb and flow of such pleasure and displeasure, until the Lords of Form intervene. Then these changing feelings are so transformed that there appear in man's being what may be regarded as the first signs of wish or desire. The human being strives after a repetition of what has once caused pleasure, and tries to avoid what has been felt as antipathetic. However, since the Lords of Form do not give up their own nature to the human being, but merely let their forces stream in and out, desire is wanting in depth of feeling and independence. It is directed by the Lords of Form, and has an instinctive character.
Next comes a period of rest similar to the brief rest periods in the evolution of the Sun. Following this, the process of the etheric body, which the physical body is now ready for, begins again. Like during the recapitulation of Saturn, this influx occurs in three distinct phases. In the second phase, humanity is increasingly suited to the new Moon conditions, allowing the Lords of Motion to activate the abilities they’ve developed. This ability involves projecting the astral body from their own essence into humanity’s being. They prepared for this task during the Sun evolution and used the rest period between the Sun and Moon to transform their preparations into the ability mentioned. This influx lasts for a time, followed by one of the shorter rest intervals. After that, the influx resumes until the Lords of Form begin their work. As a result of the Lords of Motion pouring the astral body into human beings, people begin to develop their first psychic qualities. They start to experience sensations linked to the internal processes that, thanks to their etheric body, were once plant-like during the Sun evolution; these processes now lead to feelings of pleasure and discomfort. However, it remains just a continuous inner cycle of pleasure and discomfort until the Lords of Form intervene. Then, these shifting feelings transform into what can be seen as the first signs of wish or desire. Humans seek to repeat experiences that once brought them pleasure while avoiding those they found unpleasant. Nevertheless, because the Lords of Form don’t fully transfer their essence to humanity but instead allow their energies to flow in and out, desire lacks depth and independence. It is influenced by the Lords of Form and has an instinctual nature.
The human physical body on Saturn was a heat body; on the Sun a condensation into the gaseous state, or into “air,” has taken place. Now, as during the Moon evolution, the astral element is rayed into the physical part, which at a definite moment attains a further degree of condensation and arrives at a state which may be compared with that of a liquid substance of today. In accordance with the usage [pg 157] of occult science this state may be called “water.” By water, is not meant only the water we now have, but this term applies to every liquid form in existence. The physical human body now gradually assumes a form composed of three kinds of material structures. The densest is a “water body”; through this flow air currents; and all of this again is permeated by manifestations of warmth.
The human physical body on Saturn is a heat body; on the Sun, it changes into a gaseous state, or into “air”. Now, just like during the Moon evolution, the astral element penetrates the physical part, which at a certain point reaches a further level of condensation and ends up in a state that can be compared to a liquid substance of today. According to the practices of occult science, this state can be referred to as "water." This doesn’t just mean the water we have now; the term applies to every liquid form that exists. The physical human body is now gradually taking on a form made up of three types of material structures. The densest is a "water source,"; through this flow air currents, and all of this is also filled with warmth.
Now all the organisms do not attain full, adequate maturity during the Sun stage. Therefore there are organisms to be found on the Moon which are only at the Saturn stage, and others which have only reached the Sun stage. In this way two other kingdoms arise by the side of the normally evolved human kingdom. One consists of beings which have stopped short at the Saturn stage, and therefore have only a physical body, which even on the Moon is not yet able to become the vehicle of an independent etheric body. This is the lowest of the Moon kingdoms. A second consists of beings which have been left behind at the Sun stage, and which therefore do not mature sufficiently on the Moon to take on an independent astral body. These form a kingdom between the one just mentioned and the regularly developed human kingdom.
Now, not all organisms reach full, adequate maturity during the Sun stage. This is why there are organisms on the Moon that are only at the Saturn stage, and others that have only reached the Sun stage. This way, two additional kingdoms arise alongside the normally evolved human kingdom. One consists of beings that have stopped at the Saturn stage and therefore only have a physical body, which, even on the Moon, is not yet capable of becoming the vehicle for an independent etheric body. This is the lowest of the Moon kingdoms. A second consists of beings that have been left behind at the Sun stage, and therefore do not mature sufficiently on the Moon to develop an independent astral body. These form a kingdom between the one just mentioned and the regularly developed human kingdom.
But there is still something else taking place: The substances containing only heat forces and those containing only air forces, permeate these human beings. Thus it happens that the latter have within them on the Moon both a Saturnian and a solar nature. In this way a kind of cleavage has taken place [pg 158] in human nature; and by means of this cleavage, something very momentous is called forth within the Moon evolution after the activity of the Lords of Form has begun. The first evidences of a cleavage in the cosmic body of the Moon becomes then apparent. One part of its substances and beings separates from the other; two heavenly bodies are formed out of one. One of these becomes the abode of certain higher beings who were previously more closely connected with the undivided celestial body; while the other is occupied by human beings, the two lower kingdoms described above, and certain higher beings who did not pass over to the first celestial body.
But something else is happening: the substances that consist only of heat energy and those that consist only of air energy flow through these humans. As a result, these individuals possess both a Saturnian and a solar nature on the Moon. This creates a kind of split in human nature; and through this split, something significant emerges in the Moon’s evolution after the work of the Lords of Form begins. The first signs of a split in the Moon's cosmic body then become evident. One part of its substances and beings separates from the other; two celestial bodies form from one. One of these becomes the home of certain higher beings who were previously more closely connected with the unified celestial body, while the other is inhabited by humans, the two lower kingdoms mentioned above, and certain higher beings who did not transition to the first celestial body. [pg 158]
The first heavenly body, with the higher beings, appears like a reborn but refined Sun; the other is really the new formation, the “old Moon.” The regenerated Sun, on going out, takes with it only “heat” and “air” from the substances which have been formed on the Moon; on what is left as the Moon there is the liquid condition as well as the other two substances. As a result of this separation the beings which have withdrawn with the newborn Sun are not, in the first place, hampered in their further evolution by the denser Moon beings. Thus they are able to continue their own progress without hindrance. But thus they attain just that much more power to act now upon the Moon beings from their Sun. And they in turn also acquire thereby new possibilities of evolution. Most important of all, the Lords of Form are still in union with them. [pg 159] These accentuate the passions and the desire-nature, and this expresses itself gradually also in a further condensation of the physical human body. What was previously nothing but liquid in that body assumes a densely viscous form; and the air-like and heat-like formations are correspondingly condensed. Similar processes take place in the two lower kingdoms.
The first celestial body, along with the higher beings, looks like a newly reborn but refined Sun; the other is actually the new formation, the “the old Moon.” The regenerated Sun, upon rising, only takes with it "heat" and "air" from the materials that have formed on the Moon; what remains as the Moon has a liquid state along with the other two substances. Because of this separation, the beings that have transitioned with the newborn Sun are not initially hindered in their further evolution by the denser Moon beings. This allows them to continue their own progress without obstacles. As a result, they gain even more power to influence the Moon beings from their Sun. In turn, the Moon beings also gain new opportunities for evolution. Most importantly, the Lords of Form are still connected with them. [pg 159] These amplify the passions and desire-nature, which gradually leads to a further densification of the physical human body. What was once just liquid in that body takes on a thick, viscous form; and the air-like and heat-like structures are similarly condensed. Comparable processes occur in the two lower kingdoms.
The result of the separation of the Moon-body from the Sun-body is that the former bears the same relation to the latter as the Saturn-body once did to the whole cosmic evolution surrounding it. The Saturn-sphere was formed out of the body of the “Lords of Will” (the Thrones). From out its substance emanated back into cosmic space everything which the above-mentioned spiritual beings in the environment of Saturn experienced. And this radiation by degrees awakened independent life, by means of the subsequent processes. All evolution is due to the fact that independent beings differentiate themselves from their environment, then this environment like a reflection stamps itself upon those differentiated beings who then evolve further independently. The Moon-body, having likewise separated from the Sun-body, reflects at first the life of the latter. If nothing further had then happened, the following cosmic process would have taken place: There would have been a Sun-body in which spiritual beings adapted to that body would have lived through their experiences in the elements of heat and air.
The result of the separation of the Moon from the Sun is that the Moon now has the same relationship to the Sun as Saturn once had to the entire cosmic evolution around it. The Saturn sphere was formed from the body of the “Masters of Will” (the Thrones). Everything that the aforementioned spiritual beings experienced in the Saturn environment radiated back into cosmic space from its substance. This radiation gradually sparked independent life, through the processes that followed. All evolution comes from independent beings differentiating themselves from their environment, which then, like a reflection, leaves an imprint on those differentiated beings who continue to evolve independently. The Moon, having also separated from the Sun, initially reflects the life of the Sun. If nothing else had happened after that, the following cosmic process would have occurred: There would have been a Sun where spiritual beings suited to that body would have lived and gone through their experiences in the elements of heat and air.
Set over against this Sun-body would have been a Moon-body, in which other beings of like nature with the Sun-beings would have undergone their experiences in the conditions of heat, air, and water. The progress from the Sun-incarnation to that of the Moon would have consisted in the Sun-beings seeing their own life, as in a reflection of the events on the Moon. They would have thus been able to enjoy it, something which they were still incapable of doing during the Sun incarnation. But evolution did not remain at this stage. Something occurred which was of the deepest significance for all future evolution. Certain beings adapted to the Moon-body, take possession of the element of will (the heritage of the Thrones) which was at their disposal, and by its means develop a life of their own, which takes shape independently of the Sun-life. Alongside of those Moon experiences which are entirely under the influence of the Sun, there arise independent Moon experiences, and, at the same time, states of rebellion or mutiny against the Sun-beings. And the various kingdoms which had arisen on the Sun and Moon, first and foremost of which was the kingdom of man's ancestors, are drawn into these conditions. In this way the Moon-body contains within it, spiritually and materially, two kinds of life: one that is in inner union with the Sun-life, and another which has “fallen away” from it and goes its own way independently. This division into a twofold life appears in all subsequent events of the Moon incarnation.
Set against this Sun-body was a Moon-body, where beings similar to the Sun-beings experienced life in conditions of heat, air, and water. The transition from Sun-existence to Moon-existence involved the Sun-beings observing their own lives as if reflected in the events on the Moon. This allowed them to enjoy their experiences, something they were unable to do during their time on the Sun. However, evolution didn’t stay at this point. Something significant happened that would impact all future developments. Certain beings adapted to the Moon-body gained control over the element of will (the legacy of the Thrones) at their disposal and used it to create their own independent life, separate from the Sun-life. Alongside those Moon experiences fully influenced by the Sun, independent Moon experiences began to emerge, as well as acts of rebellion against the Sun-beings. The various kingdoms that had developed on the Sun and Moon, most notably the kingdom of man's ancestors, were drawn into these new conditions. Thus, the Moon-body holds within it, both spiritually and materially, two types of life: one that is intrinsically connected with the Sun-life, and another that has “fallen away” from it and pursues its own path. This split into two forms of life manifests in all the subsequent events of the Moon existence.
What presents itself to clairvoyant consciousness in this period of evolution may be realized from the following pictures. The whole basic mass of the Moon is formed of a semi-animated substance which at one time moves sluggishly, at another quickly. This is not yet a mineral mass like the rocks and constituents of the earth upon which present day humanity walks. We might call it a kingdom of plant-minerals, only we have to imagine that the main body of the Moon consists wholly of this plant-mineral substance, as the earth today consists of rock, soil and other substances. Just as now we have towering masses of rock, so there were then harder portions embedded in the Moon's bulk; these may be compared with hard wooden structures or formations of horn; and as plants now arise out of mineral soil, so the surface of the Moon was covered and penetrated by the second kingdom, consisting of a kind of plant-animal. Their substance was softer than the general mass of the Moon, and more mobile. This kingdom extended over the other, like a viscous sea.
What shows up to a clairvoyant awareness during this period of evolution can be understood through the following images. The entire core of the Moon is made up of a semi-animated substance that sometimes moves slowly and at other times quickly. This isn't like the mineral mass of the rocks and elements of the Earth that present-day humans walk on. We might refer to it as a kingdom of plant-minerals, but we should imagine that the main body of the Moon is entirely made of this plant-mineral substance, just as the Earth today is made of rock, soil, and other materials. Just as we have towering rock formations now, there were also harder parts embedded in the Moon’s structure; these can be compared to hard wooden structures or horn formations. And just as plants now grow out of mineral soil, the surface of the Moon was covered and pervaded by the second kingdom, which consisted of a sort of plant-animal. Their substance was softer and more mobile than the overall mass of the Moon. This kingdom spread over the other like a thick sea.
Man himself at that time may be called animal-man. He had in his nature the component parts of the other two kingdoms; but his being was thoroughly interpenetrated by an etheric and an astral body, upon which the forces of higher beings worked, issuing from the severed Sun. His form was thus brought to greater perfection. While the Lords of Form were giving him a form which adapted him to Moon life, the Sun-Spirits were giving him [pg 162] a nature which lifted him beyond that life. He had the power of ennobling his own nature with the faculties given him by these Spirits,—in fact, of raising what was akin to the lower kingdoms to a higher level.
Man during that time could be called animal-man. He had in his nature the basic elements of the other two kingdoms, but his existence was completely infused with an etheric and an astral body, influenced by the forces of higher beings coming from the separated Sun. This made his form more perfected. While the Lords of Form were shaping him for life on the Moon, the Sun-Spirits were giving him a nature that elevated him beyond that existence. He had the ability to enhance his own nature with the capacities bestowed upon him by these Spirits—in fact, to elevate what was connected to the lower kingdoms to a higher level.
Seen spiritually, the events now under consideration may be described in the following way. Man's ancestor had been brought to greater perfection by beings who had fallen away from the Sun kingdom. This improvement extended especially to everything that could be experienced in the element of water. Over that element the Sun-beings, who were rulers in the elements of heat and air, had less influence. The consequence of this was that in the organism of man's ancestor two kinds of beings manifested themselves. One part of the organism was wholly interpenetrated by the influences of the Sun-beings. In the other part, the rebellious Moon-beings were operative. Owing to this, the latter part was more independent than the former. In the former there could only arise states of consciousness in which the Sun-beings lived; in the latter there lived a kind of cosmic consciousness, such as was typical on Saturn, only now upon a higher level.
Seen from a spiritual perspective, the events we’re discussing can be described like this: Humanity's ancestors had been enhanced by beings who had separated from the Sun kingdom. This improvement mainly affected everything that could be felt in the water element. The Sun beings, who were rulers of the heat and air elements, had less control over this element. As a result, two kinds of beings were manifested within the organism of humanity's ancestor. One part of the organism was completely infused with the influences of the Sun beings, while the other part was influenced by the rebellious Moon beings. Because of this, the latter was more independent than the former. In the former, only states of consciousness that contained the essence of the Sun beings could arise; in the latter, there was a type of cosmic consciousness similar to what was present on Saturn, but at a higher level now.
Man's ancestor consequently felt himself to be an “image of the universe,” whereas his “Sun-part” felt itself to be only an “image of the Sun.” The two beings now came to a kind of conflict in man's nature. A settlement of this conflict was brought about by the influence of the Sun-beings, through which the material organism which made the independent [pg 163] universal consciousness possible, was rendered frail and perishable. From time to time this part of the organism had to be thrown off. During and also some time after the separation, man's ancestor was a being wholly dependent on the Sun influence. His consciousness became less independent; he lived within it, entirely surrendered to Sun-life. Then the independent portion of the Moon was once more renewed. After some time this process was repeated. Thus man's ancestor lived on the Moon in alternating conditions of clearer and duller consciousness; and the alternation was accompanied by a change of his being in a material respect. From time to time he laid aside his Moon-body and resumed it later. Seen physically, great variety appears in the kingdoms of the Moon above mentioned. The mineral-plants, plant-animals and animal-men are differentiated into groups. This will be understood when it is borne in mind that as a result of certain organisms having been left behind at each of the earlier stages of evolution, forms possessing most varied qualities took physical shape. There are formations still retaining the qualities of the early Saturn period, others showing those of the middle period and again others of the closing period of Saturn. A similar statement is true of all the stages of the Sun evolution.
Man's ancestor felt like an "image of the cosmos," while his “Sun-part” saw itself as just an "image of the sun." These two aspects of being began to conflict within human nature. This conflict was resolved through the influence of the Sun-beings, which made the physical body that allowed independent [pg 163] universal consciousness fragile and temporary. This part of the body would need to be shed from time to time. During and after this separation, man's ancestor was entirely reliant on Sun influence. His consciousness became less independent; he lived within it and was completely devoted to Sun-life. Then the independent aspect of the Moon was revitalized. This process repeated itself over time. Man's ancestor experienced life on the Moon in cycles of clearer and clouded consciousness; this alternation also brought changes to his physical being. Periodically, he would discard his Moon-body and take it back later. Physically, there was significant diversity in the previously mentioned kingdoms of the Moon. The mineral-plants, plant-animals, and animal-men were divided into groups. This is understandable when considering that certain organisms were left behind at each previous stage of evolution, resulting in forms with a wide range of qualities taking physical shape. Some formations still hold characteristics from the early Saturn period, others show traits from the middle period, and still others reflect the final period of Saturn. The same can be said for all stages of Sun evolution.
As organisms belonging to the evolving planet are left behind, so is it also with certain beings connected with that evolution. Through the progress of evolution up to the Moon period, different grades of [pg 164] such beings have already arisen. There are the Sons of Personality who not even on the Sun have attained their human stage; but there are also others who then caught up with evolving humanity. A number of the Sons of Fire, who should have attained humanity on the Sun, fell behind. Now, just as during the Sun evolution certain of the Sons of Personality withdrew from the Sun and caused the reappearance of Saturn as a separate body, so it also happens that in the course of the Moon evolution the beings described above separate and form individual celestial bodies. So far we have mentioned only the separation into Sun and Moon; but for the reasons already given, other world-organisms detached themselves from the Moon-body, which made its appearance after the great interval between the Sun and Moon.
As organisms on our evolving planet are left behind, the same is true for certain beings linked to that evolution. Through the progress of evolution up to the Moon period, different types of beings have already emerged. There are the Sons of Personality who haven't even reached their human stage on the Sun; however, there are others who have caught up with evolving humanity. Several of the Sons of Fire, who were supposed to have reached humanity on the Sun, fell behind. Now, just as during the Sun evolution, some of the Sons of Personality withdrew from the Sun, leading to the emergence of Saturn as a separate body, the same occurs during the Moon evolution when the aforementioned beings separate and form individual celestial bodies. So far, we've only mentioned the separation into Sun and Moon; however, for the reasons already stated, other world-organisms detached themselves from the Moon-body, which appeared after the significant gap between the Sun and Moon.
After a certain time we have a system of cosmic bodies the most advanced of which, as can easily be seen, must be called the New Sun. And just such a bond of attraction as was described above for the evolution as existing between the backward Saturn kingdom and the Sons of Personality on the new Saturn, is formed between each of these bodies and the corresponding Moon-beings. It would take us much too far to follow up in detail all the celestial bodies that come into existence. It must suffice to have pointed out the reason why a succession of them arises by degrees from the undivided world-organism which appears as Saturn at the beginning of human evolution.
After a certain period, we have a system of celestial bodies, the most advanced of which, as is clear, should be called the New Sun. Similarly, the type of attraction that was described earlier between the less developed Saturn realm and the Sons of Personality on the new Saturn exists between each of these bodies and their corresponding Moon-beings. It would take us too far off track to detail every celestial body that comes into existence. It’s enough to highlight the reason a succession of them gradually emerges from the unified world-organism that appears as Saturn at the start of human evolution.
After the intervention of the Lords of Form, on the Moon, evolution proceeds for a while in the manner described. At the end of this time there is again a pause. While it lasts, the coarser portions of the three Moon kingdoms are in a sort of resting state, but the finer parts, in particular the human astral body, extricate themselves from those coarser organisms. They reach a condition in which the higher forces of exalted Sun-beings are able to act upon them very powerfully. After the interval of rest they again interpenetrate those parts of man's being which are composed of the coarser substances. Because they received such powerful forces during the pause—in a free state—they are able to make those coarser substances ripe for the influence, after a certain time, of the Sons of Personality and the Sons of Fire, who have progressed normally.
After the intervention of the Lords of Form on the Moon, evolution continues for a while as described. After this period, there is another pause. During this time, the denser parts of the three Moon kingdoms are in a kind of resting state, but the finer aspects, especially the human astral body, separate from those denser organisms. They reach a state where the higher energies of elevated Sun-beings can strongly influence them. After the rest period, they once again penetrate the parts of human existence made up of coarser substances. Because they absorbed such strong energies during the pause—in a liberated state—they can prepare those denser substances for the eventual influence of the Sons of Personality and the Sons of Fire, who have progressed normally.
In the meantime these Sons of Personality have raised themselves to a level upon which they possess the “consciousness of inspiration.” Here they are not only able—as was the case with clairvoyant picture-consciousness—to observe the inner state of other beings in images, but to apprehend the inner nature itself of those beings, as though in a spiritual tone-language. But the Sons of Fire have risen to that height of consciousness possessed on the Sun by the Sons of Personality. Thus both kinds of spirits are able to influence the now more developed life of the human being. The Sons of Personality act on the astral body, the Sons of Fire on the etheric body of this human being. The astral body thereby [pg 166] acquires the character of personality. It now not only experiences pleasure and pain, but relates them to itself. It has not arrived at a complete ego-consciousness, that says to itself, “I am here”; but it feels itself upheld and protected by other beings in its environment. When looking, as it were, up to these, it is able to say, “This, my environment, keeps me alive.”
In the meantime, these Sons of Personality have elevated themselves to a level where they possess the “awareness of inspiration.” Here, they can not only observe the inner state of other beings in images—like clairvoyant picture-consciousness—but also grasp the true essence of those beings, almost as if in a spiritual tone-language. Meanwhile, the Sons of Fire have reached that level of consciousness found on the Sun, similar to that of the Sons of Personality. Thus, both types of spirits can influence the now more advanced life of humans. The Sons of Personality affect the astral body, while the Sons of Fire impact the etheric body of a human being. As a result, the astral body [pg 166] takes on the qualities of personality. It now not only feels pleasure and pain but also relates them to itself. It hasn't achieved complete ego-consciousness that asserts, "I'm here"; instead, it feels supported and protected by other beings in its surroundings. When looking up to these beings, it can say, "This environment keeps me alive."
The Sons of Fire now work upon the etheric body. Under their influence the movement of forces in that body becomes more and more an inner function of life. What then results finds physical expression in a circulation of fluids and in phenomena of growth. The gaseous substances have become condensed into liquid substances; we may speak of a kind of nutritive process, in the sense that what is received from without becomes transformed and elaborated within. Perhaps if we think of something intermediate between nutrition and respiration in the present meaning of the terms, we may get an idea of what then happened in this respect. The nutritive matter was drawn from the animal-plant kingdom by the human being. We must think of those animal-plants as floating or swimming—or even lightly attached in an element surrounding them, as the lower animals of the present time live in water, or land animals in air. Yet the element is neither water nor air in the present sense, but something midway between the two, a kind of thick vapour in which most heterogeneous substances move hither and thither, as though dissolved in currents flowing in all directions.
The Sons of Fire now focus on the etheric body. Under their influence, the movement of forces in that body increasingly turns into an inner function of life. The result of this is physically expressed through the circulation of fluids and growth phenomena. Gaseous substances have condensed into liquids; we can think of this as a type of nutritional process, where what is taken in from outside is transformed and processed internally. If we consider something that falls between nutrition and respiration in the current context, we might grasp what occurred in this regard. The nutritional matter was drawn from the animal-plant kingdom by humans. We should imagine these animal-plants as floating or swimming—or even lightly attached to an element surrounding them, similar to how lower animals today live in water, or land animals in air. However, this element is neither water nor air as we understand them today, but something in between, a sort of thick vapor where various substances move in all directions like they are dissolved in flowing currents.
The animal-plants appear only as condensed regular forms of this element, often differing little physically from their environment. The process of respiration exists alongside of the process of nutrition. It is not as it is upon the earth, but like a drawing in and a streaming out of heat. To clairvoyant observation it is as though during those processes, organs opened and closed, through which a warming current passed in and out, and through which airy and watery substances were also carried in and out. And since man's nature at this stage of evolution already possesses an astral body, respiration and nutrition are accompanied by feelings, so that a sort of pleasure ensues when materials which promote the upbuilding of man's nature are taken in from without. Aversion is caused if injurious substances flow in, or even if they merely approach.
The animal-plants appear only as condensed, regular forms of this element, often looking very similar to their surroundings. The process of respiration happens alongside nutrition. It's not like it is on Earth, but rather a drawing in and streaming out of heat. To someone with clairvoyant vision, it seems like during these processes, organs open and close, allowing a warm current to pass in and out, along with airy and watery substances. Since humans at this stage of evolution already have an astral body, respiration and nutrition come with feelings, leading to a sort of pleasure when beneficial materials are taken in from the outside. Dislike arises if harmful substances enter, or even if they just come close.
Just as during the Moon evolution the respiratory and the nutritive processes were closely connected, as has been described, so was the process of perception in close connection with reproduction. No immediate effect was produced on any of the senses by the things and beings in the environment of Moon humanity. Perception was, on the contrary, of such a nature that the presence of things and beings called up pictures in the dull, dreamy consciousness. These pictures were much more closely connected with the real nature of the environment than the present sense-perceptions, which record [pg 168] in colour, sounds, smell etc., so to speak, only the outside of things and beings.
Just like the Moon's evolution, where breathing and nutrition were closely linked, the process of perception was closely tied to reproduction. The things and beings around Moon humanity didn’t have any immediate effect on the senses. Instead, perception was such that the presence of these things and beings triggered images in a dull, dreamy consciousness. These images were much more connected to the true nature of the environment than present-day sense perceptions, which only capture the surface of things and beings in terms of color, sound, smell, etc.
In order to get a clearer idea of the human consciousness on the Moon, let us imagine human beings immersed in the vaporous environment described above. Most varied processes take place in this vapour-element. Materials unite, substances break asunder one from the other; some parts become condensed, others rarified. All this happens in such a way that human beings do not see or hear anything of it directly, but it calls up pictures in their consciousness. These may be compared with the images of our present dream-consciousness, as for instance when an object falls to the ground, and a sleeping man does not discern what has really happened but perceives it in the form of a picture; let us say he thinks that a shot has been fired. However, the pictures in the Moon-consciousness are not arbitrary, as is the case with such dream-pictures; although they are symbols, not representations, yet they correspond with outer events. A definite outer event can call up only one definite picture. The Moon-being is therefore in a position to regulate his conduct by means of these pictures, as present-day man does by means of his perceptions. We must nevertheless be careful to notice that conduct, regulated by perception, is governed by choice whereas action, under the influence of the pictures we have described, takes place as if prompted by some dim instinct.
To get a clearer understanding of human consciousness on the Moon, let’s imagine people surrounded by the misty environment described earlier. Various processes happen in this vapor. Materials merge, substances separate; some parts become denser, while others get thinner. All of this occurs in such a way that people don’t directly see or hear it, but it creates images in their minds. These can be compared to the images from our current dreams, like when an object falls, and a person asleep doesn’t actually recognize what happened but sees it as an image; for example, he thinks a gunshot was fired. However, the images in Moon consciousness aren’t random like typical dream images; even though they’re symbols and not exact representations, they still relate to real external events. A specific external event can lead to only one specific image. The Moon being can therefore guide their actions using these images, much like modern humans do with their perceptions. Yet, we must be careful to note that actions guided by perception are based on choice, whereas actions influenced by these images happen more like an instinctual response.
It is by no means as though only outer physical [pg 169] processes become perceptible through this picture-consciousness, but it is through the pictures that the spiritual beings, who rule behind the physical facts together with their activities, become likewise perceptible. Thus the Lords of Personality become visible, so to speak, in the phenomena of the animal-plant kingdom; the Sons of Fire appear behind and in the mineral-plant beings; and the Sons of Life appear as beings whom man is able to imagine unconnected with anything physical,—whom he sees, as it were, as etheric-psychic organisms.
It's not just the outer physical processes that are revealed through this picture-consciousness; it's also through these images that the spiritual beings, who govern the physical world along with their activities, become noticeable. In this way, the Lords of Personality can be seen, in a sense, in the phenomena of the animal-plant kingdom; the Sons of Fire are revealed behind and within the mineral-plant beings; and the Sons of Life appear as entities that humans can envision without any physical connection—seeing them, so to speak, as etheric-psychic organisms.
Though these pictures of the Moon-consciousness were not representations, only symbols of outer things, they nevertheless had a much more important effect on the inner nature of man than the images now caused by perception. They were able to set the whole inner being into motion and activity. The inner processes were moulded in conformity with them. They were genuine formative forces. Man's being became what those formative forces made it; it became, to a certain extent, a representation of the events of its consciousness.
Though these images of Moon-consciousness weren't actual representations, just symbols of external things, they still had a much bigger impact on a person's inner nature than the images created by perception today. They could activate and energize the entire inner being. The inner processes were shaped to align with them. They were real formative forces. A person's being became what those formative forces shaped it to be; it became, to some extent, a reflection of the events of their consciousness.
The further evolution progresses in this manner, the more it results in a deeply incisive change in man's being. The power issuing from the pictures in the consciousness gradually becomes unable to extend over the whole human bodily frame, which divides into two parts, or two natures. Members are formed subject to the shaping influence of the picture-consciousness, and they become to a great extent a copy of that life of imagination in the way [pg 170] just described. Other organs escape such an influence. They are, as it were, too dense, too much determined by other laws, to conform themselves to the picture-consciousness. These organs withdraw from the human influence; but they come under another, that of the exalted Sun-beings themselves. A period of rest, however, is first seen to precede this stage of evolution. During this pause, the Sun-Spirits are gathering force to influence the Moon-beings under quite new circumstances.
As evolution continues, it leads to a profound transformation in what it means to be human. The energy from images in our awareness gradually fails to cover the entire human body, which splits into two parts or two natures. Parts of the body form based on the influence of this image-consciousness, becoming largely a reflection of that imaginative life as previously described. Other organs resist this influence; they are simply too solid and governed by different laws to adapt to the image-consciousness. These organs distance themselves from human influence but come under the sway of the elevated Sun-beings instead. However, a period of rest is observed before this stage of evolution, during which the Sun-Spirits gather strength to impact the Moon-beings in entirely new ways.
After this term of rest, man's being is distinctly divided into two natures. One of these is withdrawn from the independent action of the picture-consciousness; it assumes a more definite form, and comes under the influence of forces which, though issuing from the Moon body, are only called forth there through the influence of the Sun-beings. This part of the human being shares more and more in the life which is stimulated by the Sun: the other part rises, like a kind of head, out of the first one. It is flexible, can move itself, and takes shape in conformity with the life of dull human consciousness. Yet the two parts are closely connected with each other; they send one another their vital fluids, and members extend from one into the other.
After this period of rest, a person's being is clearly divided into two natures. One of these is separate from the independent action of the picture-consciousness; it takes on a more defined form and is influenced by forces that, although originating from the Moon body, are activated there through the influence of the Sun beings. This part of the human being increasingly engages with the life ignited by the Sun: the other part rises, like a sort of head, from the first. It is adaptable, can move on its own, and takes shape in line with the life of ordinary human consciousness. However, the two parts are closely interconnected; they exchange vital energies, and members extend from one into the other.
An important harmony is now attained by the working out, during the time in which all this happened, of such a relation between the Sun and Moon as is in keeping with the aim of this evolution. It has already been intimated in a former passage how the advancing beings throughout their stages of evolution, [pg 171] shape their celestial bodies from out the general cosmic mass. They emanate, as it were, the forces which govern the aggregation of the substances. The Sun and Moon have thus separated from each other, as was necessary for the preparation of the right abodes for their respective beings. But this regulation of material and its forces by the spirit is carried very much farther. The beings themselves condition as well, certain movements of the heavenly bodies, and the definite revolutions of them around each other. In consequence, those bodies occupy changing positions with regard to each other. And if the position or situation of one body relative to another is altered, the effects of their respective inhabitants upon each other also change. So it is with the Sun and Moon. Through the movement of the Moon around the Sun, which by this time had come about, the human beings come alternately at one time more into the sphere of the Sun's influence, at another they are turned away from it and are then thrown back more on their own resources. The movement is a consequence of the “fall” of certain Moon-beings, as already described, and of the settlement of the conflict which was thereby brought about. It is the physical expression of the new relation of spiritual forces created by this falling away. As a consequence of the rotation of the one sphere round the other the beings inhabiting these heavenly bodies experience the alternating conditions of consciousness above described. We may put it thus, that the Moon alternately [pg 172] turns its life toward the Sun and away from it. There is a Sun time and a planetary time and during this latter, the Moon-beings develop on the side of the Moon which is turned away from the Sun.
An important harmony is now achieved through the development of a relationship between the Sun and Moon that aligns with the purpose of this evolution. It has already been suggested in a previous section how the evolving beings shape their celestial bodies from the general cosmic material. They essentially emit the forces that govern the gathering of substances. The Sun and Moon have thus separated from one another, as was necessary to create suitable environments for their respective beings. However, the regulation of matter and its forces by spirit goes much deeper. The beings themselves also influence certain movements of the heavenly bodies and their specific revolutions around each other. As a result, these bodies occupy shifting positions relative to one another. If the position or relationship of one body changes with regard to another, the effects of their respective inhabitants on each other also shift. This is true for the Sun and Moon. With the Moon's movement around the Sun, which has now occurred, humans intermittently find themselves more within the Sun's influence at certain times and, at other times, turned away from it, relying more on their own resources. This movement is a result of the "fall" of certain Moon-beings, as previously described, and the resolution of the conflict it caused. It physically expresses the new relationship of spiritual forces created by this separation. As one sphere rotates around the other, the beings inhabiting these celestial bodies experience the alternating conditions of consciousness mentioned earlier. We can say that the Moon alternately directs its life toward the Sun and away from it. There is Sun time and planetary time, and during this latter period, the Moon-beings develop on the side of the Moon that is facing away from the Sun.
It is true however, that so far as the Moon is concerned, in addition to the movement of the celestial bodies, still something else must be considered. That is to say, clairvoyant consciousness, on looking back, can plainly see the Moon-beings wandering around their own planet, at quite regular periods of time. Thus at certain times they seek localities where they can give themselves up to the Sun influence; at other periods they wander to places where they are not subject to that influence, and where they can, as it were, reflect upon their own being.
It is true, however, that when it comes to the Moon, besides the movements of celestial bodies, there is something else to consider. In other words, clairvoyant consciousness, when looking back, can clearly observe the Moon-beings roaming around their own planet at fairly regular intervals. At certain times, they seek out locations where they can fully immerse themselves in the influence of the Sun; at other times, they go to places where they aren’t affected by that influence and where they can, in a sense, contemplate their own existence.
In order to complete the picture of these events, we must further notice that the Sons of Life attain their human stage during this period. Man's senses, the beginnings of which already existed on Saturn, cannot even yet, on the Moon, be used for his own perception of external objects. But at the Moon stage those senses become the instruments of the Sons of Life, who make use of them in order to perceive through them. These senses, belonging to the physical human body, enter thereby into reciprocal relations with the Sons of Life, by whom they are not only used but improved.
In order to fully understand these events, we should also point out that the Sons of Life reach their human form during this time. The senses of humans, which began to develop on Saturn, still can't be used for perceiving external objects on the Moon. However, at the Moon stage, these senses become tools for the Sons of Life, who use them to gain perception. These senses, part of the physical human body, then interact with the Sons of Life, who not only use them but also enhance them.
Through the changing relations of the Sun, there appears now in the human being himself, as has been already indicated, a change in the conditions of life. Things so shape themselves that when the human [pg 173] being is dominated by the Sun influence, he devotes himself more to the Sun life and its phenomena than to himself. At such times he feels the greatness and glory of the universe; he, so to speak, absorbs them. Those very exalted beings who dwell on the Sun then influence the Moon, which again influences human beings. This influence, however, does not extend to the whole of man, but chiefly to those parts which have thrown off the influence of their own picture-consciousness. It is then that especially the physical and the etheric bodies attain a definite size and form. On the other hand, the phenomena of consciousness retire into the background. But when the human being is turned away from the Sun, it is occupied with its own nature; an inner activity begins, especially in the astral body while the outer form, on the contrary, becomes more insignificant, and less perfect in form.
Through the changing relationships of the Sun, there is now a shift in human life itself, as mentioned before. Things unfold in such a way that when people are influenced by the Sun, they engage more with the life of the Sun and its phenomena rather than with themselves. During these times, they feel the vastness and beauty of the universe; they, so to speak, soak it in. Those highly elevated beings who reside on the Sun then influence the Moon, which in turn affects human beings. However, this influence doesn’t extend to the entirety of a person but primarily to those aspects that have shed the impact of their own conscious thoughts. It is then that especially the physical and etheric bodies achieve a specific size and form. Conversely, the phenomena of consciousness fade into the background. But when a person turns away from the Sun, their focus shifts to their own nature; an inner activity begins, particularly in the astral body, while the outer form, on the other hand, becomes less significant and less refined in shape.
Thus during the Moon evolution there are two states of consciousness to be clearly distinguished, alternating with each other; duller during the Sun period and clearer during the time when life is left more to its own resources. The first state though duller, is on the other hand more unselfish; man then lives a life more devoted to the outer world, to the universe. It is an alternation of states of consciousness, which on one hand may be compared with the alternation of sleeping and waking in present day humanity, as well as with his life between birth and death, on the other hand with the more spiritual existence between death and a new birth. The [pg 174] awakening on the Moon, when the Sun period gradually ceases, might be described as something intermediate between the awakening of contemporary man each morning, and his being born. And in the same way the gradual dulling of consciousness at the approach of the Sun period resembles a condition midway between falling asleep and dying. For on the old Moon there was not yet such a consciousness of birth and death as man now possesses. Man gave himself up to the enjoyment of the universe in a kind of Sun life. During this period he was carried beyond his own life; he lived more spiritually. We can only attempt an approximate description, by way of comparison, of what man experienced during such times. He felt as though the forces of the universe were streaming into him, pulsing through him. He felt as though intoxicated with the harmonies of the universe which he thus experienced.
So, during the Moon's evolution, there are two distinct states of consciousness that alternate with each other: one is duller during the Sun period and the other is clearer when life is allowed to thrive more on its own. The first state, while duller, is also more selfless; people then live a life that is more focused on the outer world and the universe. This alternation of consciousness can be compared to the cycle of sleeping and waking in modern humans and also to life between birth and death, on one hand, and to a more spiritual existence between death and rebirth, on the other. The awakening on the Moon, as the Sun period gradually fades, can be seen as something like the awakening of a person every morning, and the experience of being born. Similarly, the slow dulling of consciousness as the Sun period approaches is akin to being in a state that is between falling asleep and dying. On the old Moon, there was no real awareness of birth and death like we have now. People immersed themselves in enjoying the universe, living in a kind of Sun life. During this time, they experienced a sense of transcendence beyond their own lives, living more spiritually. We can only try to describe, through comparison, what people experienced during such times. They felt as though the forces of the universe were flowing into them, pulsating through them. They felt as if they were intoxicated by the universal harmonies they encountered.
As such times his astral body was as though set free from the physical body; also part of the etheric body went with it out of the physical body. This organism, consisting of the astral and etheric bodies, was like a delicate, wonderful musical instrument, from the strings of which the mysteries of the universe reverberated. And the members of that part of the human being on which consciousness had but slight influence were shaped in accordance with the harmonies of the universe. For the Sun-beings worked in those harmonies. Thus this part of man was given its form by the spiritual sounds of the universe; and at the same time the alternation between [pg 175] the clearer state of consciousness during the Sun period, and the duller one, was not so abrupt as was that between the waking state and that of absolutely dreamless sleep in contemporary man. The picture-consciousness was not so clear as the present waking consciousness; but on the other hand, the other consciousness was not so dull as the dreamless sleep of the present day.
During those times, his astral body seemed to break free from his physical body; a part of the etheric body also left with it. This being, made up of the astral and etheric bodies, was like a delicate, beautiful musical instrument, resonating with the mysteries of the universe. The aspects of the human being that were least influenced by consciousness were shaped according to the universe's harmonies. The Sun-beings worked within those harmonies. So, this part of man was given its form by the spiritual sounds of the universe; and at the same time, the shift between the clearer consciousness during the Sun period and the duller state was not as jarring as the transition between waking and completely dreamless sleep in modern humans. The picture-consciousness wasn’t as clear as today's waking consciousness; however, the other consciousness wasn’t as dull as the dreamless sleep experienced today.
Thus the human being had a conception, even though dim, of the play of the cosmic harmonies in his physical body and in that part of his etheric body which had remained united with the physical body. During the time when, so to speak, the Sun did not shine on humanity, the picture-concepts replaced these harmonies in man's consciousness. There was then a revival particularly of those parts of the physical and etheric bodies which were under the immediate power of consciousness. On the other hand, other parts of the human being, now not exposed to the formative forces streaming from the Sun, underwent a kind of hardening and drying up process. When the Sun period again drew near, the old bodies decayed; they fell away from the human being, and as though from the grave of his old bodily form, the rejuvenated human being appeared, who even in this new form, was still uncomely.
Thus, humans had a vague understanding of the cosmic harmonies at play within their physical bodies and in the parts of their etheric bodies that remained connected to the physical. During the time when, so to speak, the Sun did not shine on humanity, these harmonious concepts were replaced in people’s minds by imagery. This led to a revival, particularly in the areas of the physical and etheric bodies that were directly affected by consciousness. On the other hand, other parts of the human being, now shielded from the shaping forces of the Sun, went through a hardening and drying process. As the Sun period approached again, the old bodies deteriorated; they separated from the human being, and from the remnants of their former bodily form, a rejuvenated person emerged, who, even in this new form, was still not attractive.
A renewal of the life-process had taken place. By the operation of the Sun-beings and their harmonies, the new-born body shaped itself again in its perfection, and the process described above was repeated. Man felt that renewal as if it were the putting on of [pg 176] new garments. The kernel of his being had not passed through an actual birth or death; it had only passed from a spiritual tone-consciousness, in which it was given over to the outer world, to one of a more inner nature. It had sloughed off its skin. The old body had become useless; it was thrown off and renewed. This then more clearly describes what has been characterized above as a kind of reproduction, and which as has been said, is closely connected with perception. Man's being has brought forth his likeness with respect to certain parts of the physical and etheric bodies. However a being totally different from the parent being does not come into existence, but the kernel of the parent-being passes over into the offspring. No new being arises, but the same one in a new form.
A renewal of the life process had occurred. Through the actions of the Sun-beings and their harmonies, the new body took shape again in its perfection, and the previous process was repeated. A person experienced that renewal like putting on new clothes. The core of their being had not undergone a literal birth or death; it had simply transitioned from a spiritual consciousness that engaged with the outer world to one of a more inner nature. It had shed its outer layer. The old body had become obsolete; it was discarded and renewed. This better describes what was previously referred to as a form of reproduction, which, as mentioned, is closely tied to perception. A person's being has produced a likeness in certain aspects of the physical and etheric bodies. However, a completely new being does not emerge; rather, the essence of the parent being transfers to the offspring. No new being is created, but the same being takes on a new form.
Thus the Moon human being experiences a change of consciousness. When the Sun period draws near, his pictured images become dimmer and dimmer, and blissful devotion takes possession of him; the harmonies of the universe resound in his peaceful inner being. Toward the end of this time the images of the astral body begin to be animated; he begins to be more conscious of himself and able to experience sensation. Man experiences something like an awakening from the bliss and tranquility in which he was wrapped during the sun period.
Thus, the Moon human begins to experience a shift in consciousness. As the Sun period approaches, his imagined visions fade more and more, and a joyful devotion fills him; the harmonies of the universe echo in his calm inner self. Towards the end of this time, the images of the astral body start to come to life; he becomes more aware of himself and able to feel sensations. It’s like he’s waking up from the bliss and peace that surrounded him during the Sun period.
And he feels that being as something belonging to him, as a completion of his own nature; he feels it as that which gives him existence, as his “ego.” That being is one of the Sons of Life. Man feels toward him somewhat like this: “I have lived in this being, even when I was given up to the glory of the universe in the Sun period,—only then he was not visible to me; now he is.” And it is also this Son of Life from whom proceeds the force which, during the Sunless period, acts upon the body of man. Then when the Sun period again approaches, man feels as though he himself became one with the Son of Life. Even if man does not see him, he nevertheless feels closely united with him.
And he feels that this being belongs to him, as a part of his own nature; he senses it as that which gives him existence, as his “ego.” That being is one of the Sons of Life. Man feels towards him somewhat like this: "I have existed in this state, even when I was absorbed in the awe of the universe during the Sun period—back then, he wasn’t apparent to me; now he is." And it is also this Son of Life from whom comes the force that, during the Sunless period, affects the body of man. When the Sun period approaches again, man feels as though he becomes one with the Son of Life. Even if man doesn’t see him, he still feels a close connection to him.
Now the connection with the Sons of Life was such that not every individual human being had a Son of Life to himself, but an entire group of people felt such a being belonging to them. Thus people on the Moon lived segregated into groups, and each group felt in one of the Sons of Life its common “group-ego.” The etheric body of each particular group had a specific form, in this way these groups differed from each other. But as the physical bodies shaped themselves in conformity with the etheric bodies, the differences of the latter were also stamped upon the former; and the individual groups of human beings appeared as so many species of people. As the Sons of Life looked down on the human groups belonging to them, they saw themselves to a certain extent reproduced [pg 178] in manifold individual human beings. And therein they felt their own egohood. They, so to speak, mirrored themselves in man. This was indeed the mission of the human senses at that time. It has already been shown that the senses did not as yet transmit objective perceptions. But they reflected the nature of the Sons of Life. What those Sons of Life perceived through reflection, gave them their “ego-consciousness.” What was aroused in the human astral body by this reflection was the dull dim pictures of the Moon-consciousness. By thus acting conjointly and reciprocally with the Sons of Life, the human beings laid the foundations of the nervous system within their physical bodies. The nerves appear, one might say, as continuations of the senses, directed inwardly into the human body.
Now the connection with the Sons of Life was such that not every individual had a Son of Life for themselves, but rather an entire group felt a kind of shared being. So, the people on the Moon lived separated into groups, and each group recognized one of the Sons of Life as its common "collective identity." The etheric body of each group had a specific form, which is how these groups differed from one another. As the physical bodies adapted to match the etheric bodies, the differences in the latter were also reflected in the former; therefore, the individual groups of humans appeared as different types of people. When the Sons of Life looked down on the human groups associated with them, they saw themselves somewhat reproduced [pg 178] in many individual humans. And in that, they felt their own sense of self. They, in a way, reflected themselves in people. This was indeed the purpose of human senses at that time. It has already been established that the senses did not yet convey objective perceptions. Instead, they reflected the essence of the Sons of Life. What those Sons of Life perceived through this reflection gave them their “self-awareness.” What was stirred in the human astral body by this reflection were the faint, blurry images of Moon-consciousness. By interacting together and reciprocally with the Sons of Life, humans laid the groundwork for the nervous system within their bodies. The nerves can be seen, so to speak, as extensions of the senses, directed inward into the human body.
It is evident, from this description, in what manner the three kinds of Spirits, those of Personality, of Fire, and of Life, act upon Moon-humanity. If we look back upon the most important, namely the middle period of the Moon evolution, we may say that the Sons of Personality are at that time implanting in the human astral body independence and the character of personality. It is owing to this fact that man can turn his attention inwards and work upon himself during those times when the Sun is not shining upon him.
It’s clear from this description how the three types of Spirits—the Spirits of Personality, Fire, and Life—affect Moon-humanity. If we reflect on the most significant phase, specifically the middle period of Moon evolution, we can say that the Sons of Personality are, at that time, instilling independence and a sense of personality in the human astral body. Because of this, humans can look inward and make changes to themselves even when the Sun isn't shining on them.
The Sons of Fire act upon the etheric body in so far as the independent formation of the human being becomes imprinted upon it. Through their means it comes to pass that human beings are again [pg 179] conscious of themselves, as such, every time the body is renewed. Thus a kind of memory is bestowed on the etheric body through the Sons of Fire.
The Sons of Life act on the physical body in such a way that it is able to become the expression of the astral body which has now become independent. They thus make it possible for the physical body to become a physiognomic copy of its astral body. On the other hand, higher spiritual beings, in particular the Lords of Form and of Motion, reach down into the physical and etheric bodies, as far as these are developing during the Sun periods, regardless of the independent astral body. Their intervention comes from the Sun, in the manner described above.
The Sons of Life influence the physical body so that it can express the independent astral body. They enable the physical body to become a visual representation of its astral counterpart. Meanwhile, higher spiritual beings, especially the Lords of Form and Motion, interact with the developing physical and etheric bodies during the Sun periods, independent of the astral body. Their influence comes from the Sun, as described earlier.
Under the influence of such facts, the human being gradually matures to a point where it can develop within itself the germ of the Spirit-Self just as during the second half of the Saturn evolution it developed the germ of the Spirit-Man and on the Sun that of the Life-Spirit. Thereby all the Moon conditions are changed. Human beings have not only become more noble and refined through successive transformations and renewals, but they have also gained in power. For this reason the picture-consciousness was more and more maintained during the Sun periods. It also gained influence in the formation of the physical and etheric bodies, which hitherto had been formed entirely by the action of the Sun-beings.
Under the impact of these facts, humans gradually grow to a point where they can cultivate the seed of the Spirit-Self within themselves, just as during the second half of the Saturn evolution they developed the seed of the Spirit-Man, and on the Sun, that of the Life-Spirit. As a result, all the conditions of the Moon are transformed. Humans have not only become more noble and refined through ongoing changes and renewals, but they have also gained strength. For this reason, the picture-consciousness was increasingly maintained during the Sun periods. It also influenced the development of the physical and etheric bodies, which until then had been shaped solely by the actions of the Sun-beings.
What took place on the Moon through human beings and the Spirits connected with them became [pg 180] more and more like that which had formerly been effected by the Sun with its higher beings. The consequence was that those Sun-beings were able more and more to concentrate their forces on their own evolution. By this means the Moon became, after a time, mature enough to be again re-united with the Sun. To spiritual vision, these occurrences take place as follows: The “rebellious Moon-beings” had been gradually overcome by the Sun-beings and compelled to submit to them in such a manner, that their activities became a part of and subordinate to the activities of the Sun-beings. It is true that this happened only after the lapse of long ages during which the Moon periods had become shorter and shorter, and the Sun periods longer and longer. Now there again comes an evolution during which the Sun and Moon form one world-organism. By this time the physical human body has become quite etheric.
What happened on the Moon through humans and the Spirits connected to them became [pg 180] more and more similar to what had previously been accomplished by the Sun with its higher beings. As a result, these Sun-beings were increasingly able to focus their energies on their own development. This allowed the Moon to become, over time, mature enough to be rejoined with the Sun. To spiritual sight, these events unfold as follows: The “rebellious Moon beings” were gradually overcome by the Sun-beings and forced to submit to them in a way that their activities became a part of and dependent on the activities of the Sun-beings. It is true that this occurred only after long ages during which the Moon periods became shorter and shorter, and the Sun periods became longer and longer. Now, another evolution begins in which the Sun and Moon form one world-organism. By this time, the physical human body has become quite etheric.
When it is said that the physical body has become etheric, it must not be imagined that under such circumstances there is no existing physical body. What was formed as a physical body during the Saturn, Sun, and Moon periods, still exists. It is important to recognize the physical element even where it is not externally and physically manifested. It may also be present in such a way that it shows outwardly an etheric or even an astral form. We must distinguish between the outward appearance and the inner law. What is physical may become etheric and astral, at the same time retain in itself [pg 181] the physical law. That is the case when the physical body of man has attained a certain degree of perfection on the Moon. It becomes etheric in form.
When we say that the physical body has become etheric, we shouldn't think that the physical body no longer exists. The physical body that was created during the Saturn, Sun, and Moon periods is still here. It's crucial to acknowledge the physical element even when it isn't visibly or physically present. It can also appear in a way that shows an etheric or even an astral form on the outside. We need to differentiate between how things appear and the inner essence. What is physical can transform into etheric or astral, while still containing the principles of the physical. This happens when a person's physical body reaches a certain level of perfection on the Moon, taking on an etheric form.
But when clairvoyant observation, which can perceive such things, is directed toward an etheric body of this kind, that body is seen to be ruled by physical, not etheric, laws. The physical element has in this case been taken into the etheric world, there to rest and to be nurtured as though in a mother's tender care. Later it again emerges in a physical form, but at a higher stage. If Moon-humanity had kept its physical body in its coarse physical form, the Moon would never have been able to unite itself with the Sun. By accepting the etheric form, the physical body becomes more closely related to the etheric body, and by this means can again be more closely interpenetrated with those parts of the etheric and astral bodies which had been forced to withdraw from it during the Sun periods of the Moon evolution. Man, who appeared as a being with a two-fold nature during the separation of Sun and Moon, again becomes an undivided being. The physical becomes more psychic. Therefore the psychic also becomes more closely connected with the physical.
But when clairvoyant observation, which can perceive such things, is directed toward an etheric body like this, that body is seen to follow physical, not etheric, laws. The physical element has, in this case, been absorbed into the etheric world, where it rests and is nurtured as if in a mother's tender care. Later, it emerges again in a physical form, but at a higher stage. If Moon-humanity had kept its physical body in its coarse physical state, the Moon would never have been able to unite with the Sun. By taking on the etheric form, the physical body becomes more closely aligned with the etheric body, allowing it to interconnect more with those parts of the etheric and astral bodies that had been forced to withdraw during the Sun phases of Moon evolution. Man, who appeared as a being with a dual nature during the separation of Sun and Moon, again becomes a unified being. The physical becomes more psychic. Therefore, the psychic also becomes more closely linked to the physical.
Now the Sun-Spirits, into whose immediate sphere this undivided human being has entered, are able to act upon it in quite a different manner from their previous influence from without on the Moon. Man is now in a more psycho-spiritual environment. Owing to this, the Lords of Wisdom are able to effect something momentous. They imbue and inspire him [pg 182] with wisdom. He thereby becomes in a certain sense an independent soul. And to the influence of these beings is added that of the Lords of Motion. They act principally on the astral body, so that under their influence it produces psychic activity, and an etheric body filled with wisdom. The latter is the foundation of that which has been described above as the rational or intellectual soul in contemporary man, whereas the astral body, inspired by the Lords of Motion, is the germ of the sentient soul. And because all this is effected in man's being in his progressed condition of independence, these germs of the rational and sentient soul appear as the expression of the Spirit-Self. In this connection the mistake must not be made of thinking that at this period of evolution the Spirit-Self was something separate from the intellectual and sentient souls. The latter are only the expression of the Spirit-Self, which signifies their higher unity and harmony.
Now the Sun-Spirits, into whose immediate sphere this unified human being has entered, can influence it in a completely different way than before when they were impacting it from outside on the Moon. Humanity is now in a more psycho-spiritual environment. Because of this, the Lords of Wisdom can accomplish something significant. They fill and inspire him with wisdom. He thus becomes, in a way, an independent soul. Additionally, the influence of the Lords of Motion comes into play. They primarily affect the astral body, so that under their guidance it generates psychic activity, along with an etheric body filled with wisdom. The latter serves as the foundation for what has been described earlier as the rational or intellectual soul in modern humans, while the astral body, inspired by the Lords of Motion, represents the seed of the sentient soul. Since all this takes place in the heightened state of independence of man, these seeds of the rational and sentient soul emerge as the expression of the Spirit-Self. It is important to note that one should not think that during this stage of evolution the Spirit-Self is separate from the intellectual and sentient souls. The latter are merely manifestations of the Spirit-Self, which signifies their higher unity and harmony.
It is especially significant that the Lords of Wisdom intervene at this period in the manner described. For they do this not only with regard to humanity but also for the benefit of the other kingdoms which have been elaborated on the Moon. Upon the reunion of Sun and Moon these lower kingdoms are drawn into the Sun sphere. Everything in them which was physical becomes etheric. There are, therefore, minela-plants and plant-animals now in the Sun, just as there is humanity there. But those other creatures are still endowed with their own laws of being. They therefore feel like strangers in [pg 183] their environment. They came upon the scene with a nature but little in harmony with their surroundings. But as they have become etheric, the activity of the Lords of Wisdom may also extend to them. Everything which has come from the Moon into the Sun now becomes pervaded with the forces of the Lords of Wisdom. Hence what is developed out of the Sun-Moon organism during this period of evolution may be called in occult science the “Cosmos of Wisdom.”
It’s especially important that the Lords of Wisdom intervene during this time in the way described. They do this not only for humanity but also for the benefit of the other realms that have developed on the Moon. When the Sun and Moon reunite, these lower realms are pulled into the Sun's sphere. Everything physical in them becomes etheric. So, there are now mineral-plants and plant-animals in the Sun, just like there are humans there. But those other beings still follow their own laws of existence. As a result, they feel out of place in their environment. They arrived with a nature that is not very compatible with their surroundings. However, since they have become etheric, the influence of the Lords of Wisdom can also reach them. Everything that has come from the Moon into the Sun is now infused with the energies of the Lords of Wisdom. Thus, what evolves from the Sun-Moon organism during this period of evolution can be called in occult science the "Universe of Insight."
When, therefore, after an interval of rest, our Earth system appears as the successor of this Cosmos of Wisdom, all the beings newly emerging on the earth, developing out of their Moon-germs, prove to be filled with wisdom. And this is the reason why earthly man when contemplating the things around him, is able to discover the wisdom concealed in their inner nature. The wisdom in each leaf of a plant, in every bone in animal and man, in the marvelous structure of the brain and heart, fills us with admiration. If man requires wisdom to understand things, and therefore gathers wisdom from them, this shows that there is wisdom in the things themselves. For however much man might have striven to understand things by means of wise perceptions, he could not draw wisdom from them unless it had first been put into them. He who tries by means of wisdom to understand things, assuming at the same time that wisdom had not first been concealed within them, may just as reasonably believe that he can empty water out of a glass into [pg 184] which it has not first been poured. As will be shown later in this book, the Earth is the “old Moon” risen again. And it appears as an organism full of wisdom, because it was permeated by the Lords of Wisdom and their forces during the epoch that has been described.
When, after a period of rest, our Earth system emerges as the successor of this Cosmos of Wisdom, all the new beings coming into existence on Earth, developing from their Moon-germs, are shown to be filled with wisdom. This is why, when humans reflect on the things around them, they can uncover the wisdom that lies within their essence. The wisdom in every leaf of a plant, in every bone of animals and humans, and in the incredible structure of the brain and heart inspires admiration. If humans need wisdom to grasp things and seek it from them, it indicates that there is wisdom in the things themselves. No matter how hard a person may try to understand things through wise insights, they wouldn't be able to draw wisdom from them unless it had been placed there first. Anyone who attempts to use wisdom to comprehend things while believing that wisdom isn't already hidden in them might as well think they can pour water from a glass into another empty glass without first having poured it in. As will be explained later in this book, the Earth is the “old Moon” reborn. It presents itself as an organism rich in wisdom because it was infused with the Lords of Wisdom and their forces during the described epoch.
It will easily be understood that this description of the Moon condition could take account only of certain temporary forms of evolution. It was necessary to pause at certain things in the progress of events, and single them out for delineation. It is true that this kind of description gives only isolated pictures, and it may be deplored for this reason, that in the foregoing account the evolutionary scheme was not brought down to a system of precise and definite concepts. But in the face of such an objection it may be well to point out that the description was intentionally given in less clearly defined outlines. For it is not of so much consequence here to give speculative ideas and to construct theories as to represent what really passes before the spiritual eyes of clairvoyant consciousness, when looking back upon these events. With regard to the Moon evolution this cannot be done in such sharp and definite outlines as are characteristic of earthly perceptions. In the Moon period we are mainly concerned with variable, changing impressions, with shifting, moving pictures and their transitory stages. We have, moreover, to bear in mind that we are contemplating an evolution continuing through long, long periods of time, and that [pg 185] out of all that presents itself, it is possible to seize upon only momentary pictures and fix them for delineation.
It’s easy to see that this description of the Moon’s condition can only account for certain temporary forms of evolution. It was necessary to pause at specific events in the progression and highlight them. It’s true that this type of description offers only isolated snapshots, and it might be criticized for not presenting the evolutionary scheme as a system of clear and definite concepts. However, in response to such criticism, it’s important to note that the description was deliberately provided in less sharply defined terms. The goal here isn’t so much about offering speculative ideas and building theories, but rather to reflect what genuinely appears before the spiritual eyes of clairvoyant awareness when looking back at these events. Regarding Moon evolution, this can’t be done in the clear and precise outlines typical of earthly perceptions. During the Moon period, we mainly deal with variable, changing impressions, with shifting, moving images and their temporary stages. Additionally, we must keep in mind that we are observing an evolution that continues over very long periods of time, and that from all that unfolds, we can only capture momentary images and fix them for description.
The Moon period actually reached its highest point at the time when the astral body, implanted in man, had brought him so far along the evolutionary path that his physical body afforded the Sons of Life the possibility of attaining their human stage. Man had then attained all that this epoch could give him for himself, for his inner nature on the upward path. The following, or second half of the Moon evolution may therefore be termed the “ebb-tide,” or wane. But even during this ebb-tide one sees a most important thing taking place with regard to man's environment, and even with regard to himself. It is now that wisdom is implanted in the Sun-Moon body. It has been shown that during the ebb-tide the germs of the intellectual and sentient souls are implanted. But the development of these, as well as of the consciousness-soul and with it the birth of the “Ego”—the free self consciousness—does not ensue until the Earth period.
The Moon phase actually peaked when the celestial body inside humans had advanced them so far along the evolutionary journey that their physical form allowed the Sons of Life to reach their human stage. At that point, humanity had achieved everything this era could offer for their personal growth and inner journey. The next stage, or second half of the Moon evolution, can therefore be referred to as the “low tide,” or decline. However, even during this ebb-tide, significant developments occur concerning humanity's surroundings and their own nature. It's during this time that wisdom is embedded in the Sun-Moon body. It has been established that during the ebb-tide, the seeds of the intellectual and sentient souls are sown. But the growth of these, alongside the consciousness-soul and the emergence of the "Self"—the true self-awareness—doesn't begin until the Earth phase.
At the Moon stage the intellectual- and sentient-souls have as yet no appearance of being used by human beings as a means of expression; they appear rather as instruments of those Sons of Life who belong to humanity. Were we to describe the feeling of the human dweller on the Moon in this respect, we should have to say that he experiences the following: “The Son of Life lives in and through me; he surveys through me the [pg 186] environment of the Moon; in me he reflects upon the things and beings of that environment.” The Moon human being feels himself overshadowed by the Son of Life, and looks upon himself as the instrument of that higher being. During the time of the separation of Sun and Moon he felt a greater measure of independence when the Sun was turned away from him; but at the same time he also felt as though the ego belonging to him, which had disappeared from the picture-consciousness during the Sun period, now became visible. It was, for Moon-humanity, what may be described as a change in the states of consciousness, so that the Moon-being had this feeling: “In the Sun period my ego wafts me away into higher regions, into the presence of exalted beings, and when the Sun disappears it descends with me into lower worlds.”
At the Moon stage, the intellectual and emotional souls don’t seem to be used by humans as a way to express themselves; instead, they function more like tools for those Sons of Life who are part of humanity. If we were to capture the feelings of a human living on the Moon in this context, we would say that they experience the following: "The Son of Life exists in and through me; he watches the Moon's surroundings through me; within me, he thinks about the things and beings in that environment." The Moon human feels overshadowed by the Son of Life, viewing themselves as the instrument of that higher being. During the separation of the Sun and Moon, they felt a greater sense of independence when the Sun was turned away, but at the same time, they felt as if their ego, which had vanished from their consciousness during the Sun phase, now became visible again. For Moon-humanity, this was what we could describe as a shift in consciousness states, leading to the feeling: "During the Sun phase, my ego elevates me to higher levels, bringing me closer to uplifting beings, and when the Sun sets, it comes down with me into lower realms."
The actual Moon evolution was preceded by a preparatory stage. In a certain way the Saturn and Sun evolutions were recapitulated. Now, after the reunion of Sun and Moon, during what we have termed the ebb-tide, two epochs may be distinguished one from the other. In the course of these, even physical condensation occurs to a certain degree. Therefore psycho-spiritual conditions of the Sun-Moon organism alternate with others of a more physical nature. In such physical epochs human beings and those of the lower kingdoms appear as though they were preparing, in stiff not yet self-reliant forms, the type of what they were to become in a more independent manner during the [pg 187] Earth period. We may therefore speak of two preparatory epochs in the Moon evolution, and of two others during the ebb-tide. In occult science such epochs may be termed cycles.20 In that period which follows the two preparatory epochs, and precedes those of the ebb-tide—that is to say, during the time of the separation of the Moon—three epochs can again be distinguished. The middle period is the time when the Sons of Life reached the human level. It is preceded by a period in which all conditions lead up to that crowning event; and it is followed by one which may be called a time of adaptation and of perfecting the new creations.
The actual evolution of the Moon was preceded by a preparatory stage. In a way, the evolutions of Saturn and the Sun were reviewed. Now, after the reunion of the Sun and Moon, during what we call the ebb-tide, we can distinguish two different periods. During these periods, physical condensation occurs to some extent. Therefore, the psycho-spiritual conditions of the Sun-Moon organism alternate with those that are more physical in nature. In these physical periods, human beings and those from lower kingdoms seem to be preparing, in rigid and not yet independent forms, for the type of beings they would become in a more self-reliant way during the [pg 187] Earth period. Thus, we can speak of two preparatory periods in the Moon's evolution, and two more during the ebb-tide. In occult science, these periods can be referred to as cycles. In the time that follows the two preparatory periods and precedes those of the ebb-tide—that is, during the separation of the Moon—three periods can again be distinguished. The middle period is when the Sons of Life reached the human level. It is preceded by a period where all conditions lead up to that significant event; and it is followed by one that may be called a time of adjustment and of refining the new creations.
In this way the middle period of the Moon evolution is again divided into three epochs, which, with the two preparatory periods and the two during the ebb-tide make up seven Moon cycles, or rounds. It may therefore be said that the whole Moon evolution passes through seven cycles, or rounds. Between them are intervals of rest, which have been mentioned repeatedly in the above description. Yet we can approach a true concept of these facts only if we do not think of the changes between the periods of activity and those of rest, as sudden ones. For instance, the Sun-beings little by little withdraw their activity from the Moon. A time begins for them which, viewed from without, appears to be their resting period, whereas in reality [pg 188] an intense, independent activity still continues on the Moon itself. Thus the active period of one kind of being repeatedly extends into the resting time of another. If we take account of such things we may speak of a rhythmic ascent and descent of forces in cycles. Indeed, similar divisions are to be recognized even within the seven Moon cycles mentioned. We may then call the whole Moon evolution one great cycle, and the seven divisions, or rounds, within it, “small” cycles; and again, the separate parts of these, “smaller” cycles. This systematic arrangement into seven times seven divisions is also noticeable in the Sun evolution and can be indicated during the Saturn period. Yet we must bear in mind that the boundaries between the divisions are somewhat obliterated even in the Sun, and still more so in Saturn. These boundaries become more and more defined the nearer evolution advances to the Earth period.
In this way, the middle phase of Moon evolution is divided into three epochs, which, along with the two preparatory periods and the two during the ebb-tide, make up seven Moon cycles, or rounds. So, we can say that the entire Moon evolution goes through seven cycles, or rounds. Between them are rest periods, which have been mentioned several times in the description above. However, we can only get a true understanding of these facts if we don't think of the changes between active periods and rest periods as abrupt. For example, the Sun beings gradually withdraw their activity from the Moon. A time begins for them that, from the outside, looks like their resting period, while in reality, an intense, independent activity continues on the Moon itself. Thus, the active period of one type of being often overlaps with the resting time of another. If we consider this, we can talk about a rhythmic rise and fall of forces in cycles. Indeed, similar divisions can be seen even within the seven Moon cycles mentioned. We can call the entire Moon evolution one large cycle, with the seven divisions, or rounds, being “small” cycles; and within these, the separate parts are “smaller” cycles. This systematic arrangement of seven times seven divisions is also noticeable in the Sun evolution and can be identified during the Saturn period. However, we must keep in mind that the boundaries between divisions are somewhat blurred even in the Sun, and even more so in Saturn. These boundaries become clearer as evolution approaches the Earth period.
At the close of the Moon evolution, which has been sketched in the foregoing pages, all the beings and forces connected with it enter upon a more spiritual form of existence. This is on quite a different plane from that of the Moon period, and also from that of the Earth evolution which follows. A being possessed of faculties so highly developed as to enable him to perceive all the details of the Moon and Earth evolutions need not necessarily be able to see what happens during the interval between the [pg 189] two periods. For one possessing such vision, beings and forces would, at the end of the Moon period, disappear, as it were, into nothingness; and after an interval they would issue forth again from the dusky twilight of the cosmic depths. Only a being endowed with considerably higher faculties would be capable of following up the spiritual events which take place during this interval.
At the end of the Moon's evolution, as described in the previous pages, all the beings and forces associated with it transition to a more spiritual form of existence. This exists on a completely different level from both the Moon period and the Earth evolution that follows. A being with such advanced abilities that it can perceive all the details of both the Moon and Earth evolutions doesn’t necessarily have the capability to see what occurs during the time between these two periods. For someone with such perception, beings and forces would seem to vanish into nothingness at the end of the Moon period, and after a while, they would emerge again from the dim shadows of the cosmic depths. Only a being with significantly higher abilities would be able to track the spiritual events happening during this time.
When this interval is over, the beings who took part in the evolutionary processes on Saturn, Sun, and Moon reappear endowed with new faculties. Beings of a higher order than man have, by their former achievements, won the power of bringing man's evolution forward to a point at which he would be able to unfold in himself, during the Earth period, a form of consciousness which stands a step higher than the picture-consciousness he had possessed during the Moon period. But man must first be prepared to receive this gift.
When this time ends, the beings who were involved in the evolutionary processes on Saturn, Sun, and Moon come back with new abilities. Beings that are of a higher order than humans have, through their past accomplishments, gained the ability to advance human evolution to a stage where humans can develop a level of consciousness that is a step above the image-based consciousness they had during the Moon period. However, humans need to be ready to accept this gift first.
During the Saturn, Sun, and Moon evolutions, he incorporated within his being the physical, etheric, and astral bodies. But those bodies were only endowed with such faculties and powers as enabled them to have a picture-consciousness; the organs and forms by means of which they could attain to a cognizance of a world of outer sense-objects, such as is requisite for the Earth stage, were still wanting. Just as the new plant unfolds only what is concealed in the seed originating from the old plant, so do the three principles of man's nature appear, at the beginning of the new stage of evolution, with such [pg 190] forms and organs as will enable them to develop only a picture-consciousness. It is necessary first to prepare them for the unfolding of a higher state of consciousness.
During the Saturn, Sun, and Moon phases, he integrated the physical, etheric, and astral bodies into himself. But these bodies only had the abilities that allowed them to have a picture-consciousness; they were still missing the organs and forms needed to perceive the world of physical objects, which is essential for the Earth stage. Just as a new plant reveals what is hidden in the seed from the old plant, the three aspects of human nature emerge at the start of the new stage of evolution with the forms and organs that will only allow them to develop a picture-consciousness. It's crucial to prepare them first for the emergence of a higher level of consciousness.
This takes place in three preliminary stages. During the first, the physical body is raised to a level at which it becomes able to undergo the necessary remodeling which is to serve as a basis for consciousness of outer objects. This is one of the preliminary stages of the actual earth evolution, and may be called a recapitulation of the Saturn period on a higher level. For during this period, as during the Saturn period, higher beings are working only on the physical body. When the latter has progressed far enough in its evolution, all beings must first again pass into a higher form of existence before the etheric body can also progress. The physical body must, as it were, be recast, in order to be able, in its remodeled state, to receive the more highly constituted etheric body. After this interval devoted to a higher form of existence, a kind of recapitulation of the Sun evolution on a higher level, occurs for the purpose of shaping the etheric body. And after another interval, a similar thing occurs for the astral body, by means of a recapitulation of the Moon evolution.
This happens in three initial stages. In the first stage, the physical body is elevated to a point where it can undergo the necessary changes that will serve as the foundation for awareness of external objects. This is one of the early stages of actual earth evolution and can be seen as a recap of the Saturn period on a more advanced level. During this time, just like in the Saturn period, higher beings focus solely on the physical body. Once the physical body has evolved enough, all beings must transition into a higher state of existence before the etheric body can also advance. Essentially, the physical body must be reshaped to be able to accept the more refined etheric body. Following this phase of higher existence, there is a recap of the Sun evolution at a higher level to shape the etheric body. After another period, a similar process occurs for the astral body, involving a recap of the Moon evolution.
Let us now turn our attention to the evolutionary processes taking place after the close of the third recapitulation described. All beings and forces have passed again into a state of spiritualization. During that state they ascended into higher worlds. [pg 191] The lowest of the worlds, in which something of them is still to be perceived during this spiritualizing epoch, are the same in which contemporary man sojourns between death and a new birth. These are the regions of the spirit-world. Thence the beings and forces gradually descend again into lower worlds. Before the physical Earth evolution begins they have so far descended that their lowest manifestations are to be seen in the astral or psychic world.
Let’s now focus on the evolutionary processes that occur after the end of the third recapitulation we just discussed. All beings and forces have once again entered a state of spiritualization. During this time, they rise into higher realms. [pg 191] The lowest of these worlds, where some aspects of them can still be sensed during this spiritual phase, are the same ones where modern humans exist between death and rebirth. These are the areas of the spirit world. From there, the beings and forces gradually move down into lower realms. By the time physical evolution on Earth begins, they have descended enough that their lowest expressions can be observed in the astral or psychic world.
Everything human existing at that period is still in its astral form. In order to understand this condition of humanity, attention should be paid especially to the fact that though man has within him the physical, etheric and astral bodies, yet the physical and etheric bodies are not present in their own forms but in astral form. It is not physical form that makes the physical body physical, but the fact that it embodies physical laws, although possessing an astral form. It is a being in a psychic form with a physical law of existence. The etheric body is in a similar position.
Everything human that existed at that time is still in its astral form. To understand this state of humanity, it's important to note that while a person has physical, etheric, and astral bodies, the physical and etheric bodies aren't in their actual forms but in astral form. It's not the physical form that makes the physical body physical; it’s the fact that it embodies physical laws, even though it has an astral form. It's a being with a psychic form that follows physical laws of existence. The etheric body is in a similar situation.
To spiritual vision the Earth at this stage of evolution appears at first as a heavenly body all soul and spirit, in which, therefore, even physical and life forces appear in a psychic form. In this world-organism everything which will subsequently be moulded into the creatures of the physical earth is contained in a germinal state. The globe is luminous; but its light is not yet such as could be seen by physical eyes, supposing even that they had then [pg 192] existed. The globe shines only in psychic light to the opened vision of the seer.
To spiritual vision, the Earth at this stage of evolution initially appears as a heavenly body full of soul and spirit, where even physical and life forces take on a psychic form. In this world-organism, everything that will later shape into the creatures of the physical Earth exists in a germinal state. The globe is glowing; however, its light isn't something that could be seen by physical eyes, even if they had existed then. The globe shines only in psychic light to the opened vision of the seer.
A process now takes place on this globe which may be designated “condensation.” The result of this is that after a time a fiery form appears in the midst of the psychic globe; this condition was similar to that of Saturn in its densest state. This fiery form is interpenetrated by the action of the various beings who are taking part in the evolution. The reciprocal action which is to be observed between those beings and the planetary body is like a rising out of and a diving into the earth's fiery globe. Hence the earth's globe is by no means a homogeneous substance, but has somewhat the character of an ensouled and spiritualized organism. The beings destined to become human on the earth in man's present form are as yet in a condition which renders them the least capable of sharing in the activity of plunging into the fiery globe. They remain almost entirely in the uncondensed environment. They are still living in the bosom of the higher spiritual beings. At this stage they come in contact with the fiery earth at only one point of their psychic form, and this causes one part of their astral form to be densified by the heat. Thus earth-life is enkindled in them. They therefore still belong to psycho-spiritual worlds with regard to the greater part of their nature, but by coming in contact with the earth's fire, vital heat plays around them.
A process is currently happening on this planet that can be called “condensation.” As a result, after some time, a fiery form emerges in the center of the psychic globe; this state is similar to how Saturn was in its densest form. This fiery shape is influenced by the actions of the various beings participating in evolution. The interaction observed between those beings and the planetary body is like rising up from and diving into the Earth's fiery core. Therefore, the Earth's globe is not a uniform substance, but resembles a living and spiritualized organism. The beings destined to become human in their current form are still in a state that makes them the least capable of diving into the fiery core. They remain mostly in an uncondensed environment, still living among higher spiritual beings. At this stage, they only connect with the fiery Earth at one point of their psychic form, which causes part of their astral form to become denser due to the heat. This ignites life on Earth within them. Thus, they still belong primarily to psycho-spiritual realms, but by coming into contact with the Earth's fire, vital heat surrounds them.
If we wish to draw a material, yet supersensible, [pg 193] picture of these human beings in the very beginning of the earth's evolution, we must imagine a psychic ovoid, or egg, contained within the circumference of the earth, and enclosed on its lower surface, as an acorn is by its cup. The substance of the cup, however, consists solely of heat or fire. The process of being enveloped by heat not only causes the kindling of life in the human being, but a change appears simultaneously in the astral body. In this body becomes incorporated the first germ of what afterwards becomes the sentient-soul. We may therefore say that man at this stage of his existence consists of the sentient-soul, the astral body, the etheric body, and the physical body, which latter is formed out of fire. Those spiritual beings who participate in human existence surge through the astral body. Man feels himself bound to the earth body by the sentient-soul. He has therefore at this time a preponderating picture-consciousness, in which are manifested those spiritual beings in whose bosom he reposes; and the feeling of his own body seems to be merely a point within that consciousness. He looks down, so to speak, from the spiritual world upon earthly possession, which he feels belongs to him.
If we want to create a tangible yet non-physical image of these human beings at the dawn of the earth's evolution, we should envision a psychic egg inside the earth's outer limits, enclosed on the bottom like an acorn in its cup. However, the cup is made entirely of heat or fire. This enveloping heat not only ignites life within the human being but also triggers a transformation in the astral body. This body starts to incorporate the initial spark of what later evolves into the sentient-soul. So, we can say that at this stage of existence, humans consist of the sentient-soul, the astral body, the etheric body, and the physical body, which is formed from fire. Spiritual beings that are part of human existence flow through the astral body. A person feels connected to their physical body through the sentient-soul. At this time, they have a dominant picture-consciousness, which shows those spiritual beings that cradle them; and the awareness of their own body feels like just a focal point within that consciousness. They perceive earthly possessions from the spiritual realm, feeling as though they belong to them.
Further and further the condensation of the earth now proceeds and at the same time the differentiation of the various parts of man, as has been described, becomes more and more defined. From a definite point of evolution onward, the earth is so far condensed that only part of it is fiery; another [pg 194] part has assumed a substantial shape, which may be termed “gas” or “air.” A change also takes place now in man. He is not only brought into contact with the heat of the earth, but the air substance is incorporated in his fire-body. And as heat kindled life in him, the air playing around him creates an effect within him which may be called (spiritual) sound. His etheric body begins to resound. Simultaneously, a part of the astral body becomes separated from the remainder; this part is the germ of the intellectual-soul which appears later.
As the earth continues to condense, the different aspects of humanity become increasingly distinct, as previously described. From a certain point in evolution, the earth has condensed to the point where only a portion remains fiery; another segment has taken on a solid form that we can refer to as “gas” or “air.” A transformation also occurs in humans. They are not only exposed to the earth's heat, but the air substance also gets integrated into their fiery essence. Just as heat ignites life within them, the air surrounding them creates an effect that can be described as (spiritual) sound. Their etheric body starts to resonate. At the same time, a part of the astral body separates from the rest; this part is the seed of the intellectual-soul that will emerge later.
In order to bring before our eyes what takes place in the human soul at this time, we must notice that the beings superior to man are surging through the airy-fiery body of the earth. In the fire-earth it is at first the Sons of Personality who are of importance to man, and when man is stirred into life by the heat of the earth his sentient soul says to itself, “These are the Sons of Personality.” In the same way the beings called “Archangels” earlier in this book (in accordance with Christian esotericism) appear in the air-sphere. It is their influences which man feels within him as sound, when the air plays around him. And the intellectual-soul then says to itself, “These are the Archangels.” Thus what man at this stage perceives, through his connection with the earth, is not as yet a collection of physical objects, but he lives in sensations of heat which rise up to him, and in sounds; in those heat currents and sound waves, however, he feels the Sons of Personality and the Archangels. It is true that he cannot [pg 195] perceive those beings directly, only, as it were, through a veil of heat and sound. While these perceptions are penetrating from the earth into his soul, there continue to ascend and descend within it the images of those higher beings in whose tender care he feels himself to be.
To highlight what happens in the human soul during this time, we need to recognize that beings greater than humans are flowing through the airy-fiery body of the earth. Initially, in the fire-earth, the Sons of Personality are significant to humanity, and when man comes to life through the earth's heat, his sentient soul reflects, “These are the Sons of Personality.” Similarly, the beings referred to as "Archangels" earlier in this book (according to Christian esotericism) appear in the air-sphere. It is their influence that man senses within himself as sound when the air surrounds him. Then, the intellectual-soul thinks, “These are the Archangels.” At this stage, what man perceives through his connection to the earth isn't merely a collection of physical objects; instead, he experiences sensations of heat that rise up to him and sounds. In those heat currents and sound waves, he feels the presence of the Sons of Personality and the Archangels. While it’s true that he cannot perceive these beings directly, he senses them, so to speak, through a veil of heat and sound. As these perceptions flow from the earth into his soul, the images of those higher beings, in whose gentle care he feels he is, continue to rise and fall within him.
Now evolution takes a further step, which is once more expressed in condensation. Watery substance is incorporated into the Earth-body, so that now the latter consists of three parts,—igneous, aeriform, and aqueous. Before this happens, something of great importance takes place. An independent celestial body is split off from the fiery-aeriform earth; this new body becomes in its later development our present sun.21 Previously, earth and sun had formed one body. After the sun had been split off, the earth still has at first everything within it which is in and on the present moon. The separation of the sun takes place because higher beings could no longer carry on their own evolution as well as their task on Earth within this atmosphere, now densified to the consistency of water. They separate from the general mass of the Earth the only substances useful to them, and fare forth to make a new abode for themselves in the sun. They now influence the earth from the sun, from outside. Man, however, needs for his further evolution an environment [pg 196] in which matter becomes still more condensed.
Now evolution takes another step, which is again shown through condensation. Watery substance is incorporated into the Earth's body, so that it now consists of three parts—igneous, gaseous, and watery. Before this happens, something very important occurs. An independent celestial body is separated from the fiery-gaseous Earth; this new body later develops into our current sun.21 Before, Earth and sun were one entity. After the sun was separated, the Earth still contains everything that is present on the current moon. The separation of the sun happens because higher beings could no longer continue their own evolution along with their responsibilities on Earth within this atmosphere, which had now become as dense as water. They extract from the Earth only the substances useful to them and set out to create a new home for themselves in the sun. They now influence the Earth from the sun, from the outside. However, for further evolution, man needs an environment where matter becomes even more condensed.
With the incorporation of watery substance in the earth-body a change also takes place in man. Henceforth not only does fire stream into him and air play around him, but watery substance is incorporated into his physical body. At the same time his etheric part changes: that is, it is now perceived by man as a fine light-body. Previous to this, man had felt currents of heat rising up to him from the earth: he had felt air surrounding him through tones; now, the watery element also penetrates his fire-air body, and he sees its ebb and flow as the alternate flaring up and dimming of light. But a change has also taken place in his soul. To the germs of the sentient and intellectual souls is added that of the consciousness-soul. The “Angels” work in the element of water; they are also the real producers of light. It was as though they appeared to man in light.
With the addition of water to the earth's body, a change occurs in humans as well. From now on, not only does fire flow into them and air surround them, but water is also integrated into their physical bodies. At the same time, their etheric aspect transforms: it is now experienced as a subtle light-body. Before this, people felt heat currents rising from the earth and sensed the air around them through sounds; now, the water element also seeps into their fire-air body, and they perceive its rise and fall as the flickering and dimming of light. A change has also happened in their souls. The seeds of the sentient and intellectual souls are now joined by that of the consciousness-soul. The “Angels” work with the water element; they are also the true sources of light. It seemed as if they appeared to people in light.
The higher beings who were previously in the Earth-planet itself, now influence it from the sun. On this account all effects produced on the earth are changed. The human being chained to earth would no longer be able to feel the influence of the sun-beings within him, if his soul were unceasingly turned toward the earth, from which his physical body is taken. A change now appears in the conditions of human consciousness. At certain times the sun-beings wrest the soul of man from his physical body, so that man is now alternately purely psychic, [pg 197] in the bosom of the sun-beings, and, when united with the body, in a condition in which he receives earth influences. When in the physical body, heat currents stream up to him; a sea of air is sounding round him and water pours into and out of him. When man is out of his body the images of the higher beings in whose care he is, float through his soul.
The higher beings who were once part of the Earth now influence it from the sun. Because of this, all effects produced on Earth have changed. A human being, anchored to the Earth, wouldn’t be able to feel the influence of the sun beings within him if his soul continually focused on the Earth, from which his physical body is drawn. A shift now occurs in the state of human consciousness. At times, the sun beings pull the soul of a person from his physical body, so that a person alternates between being purely spiritual, in the presence of the sun beings, and when connected with the body, in a state where he is impacted by earthly influences. When in the physical body, warm currents rise to him; a sea of air surrounds him, and water flows in and out of him. When a person is outside of his body, the images of the higher beings who care for him float through his soul.
The earth passes through two periods at this stage of its evolution. During one of these it allows its substances to circulate around the human souls and clothe them with bodies; during the other, the souls have withdrawn from it, and only the bodies are left and the human beings are in a condition of sleep. It is speaking quite in conformity with facts to say that in those times of a remote past the earth passed through a day and a night time. (Expressed in terms of physical space this means that through the reciprocal action of the sun-beings and the earth-beings, the earth is brought into a movement in relation with the sun; thus there is brought about the alternation of day and night periods described above. The day period is when the surface of the earth, on which man is evolving, is turned toward the sun; the night period, the time when man leads a purely psychic existence, is when the earth's surface is turned away from the sun. Now it must not, of course, be imagined that in that far-off time the earth's motion around the sun was like its present motion. The conditions were still utterly different. But even at this early point it is helpful to realize that the motions [pg 198] of the celestial bodies are a consequence of the mutual relations of the spiritual beings inhabiting them. Spiritual-psychic causes produce in the celestial bodies positions and motions which permit the manifestation of spiritual conditions on the physical plane.)
The Earth goes through two phases during this stage of its evolution. In one phase, it allows its materials to circulate around human souls and give them bodies; in the other phase, the souls have withdrawn, leaving only the bodies behind, and humans are in a state of sleep. It’s accurate to say that in those ancient times, the Earth experienced periods of day and night. (In physical terms, this means that through the interaction between solar beings and Earth beings, the Earth moves in relation to the sun, leading to the alternation of day and night as described above. The day phase is when the surface of the Earth, where humanity is evolving, faces the sun; the night phase, when humans exist purely on a psychic level, is when the Earth’s surface is turned away from the sun. It should not be imagined that in those distant times the Earth’s motion around the sun was like it is today. The conditions were still radically different. But even at this early stage, it’s helpful to realize that the movements of celestial bodies are a result of the mutual relationships of the spiritual beings residing in them. Spiritual and psychic influences cause the celestial bodies to have positions and motions that allow for the manifestation of spiritual conditions on the physical plane.)
If our gaze were turned upon the earth during its night period, its body would appear like a corpse. For it consists to a great extent of the decaying bodies of those human beings whose souls are in another state of existence. The organized watery and aeriform structures of which human bodies were formed become disintegrated, and dissolve into the rest of the earth's substance. Only that part of man's body which was formed from the very beginning of the earth evolution by the co-operation of fire and the human soul, and which subsequently became denser and denser, continues to exist as an insignificant looking embryo. Now when the day period begins, the earth once more participates directly in the sun influence, and human souls press forward into the sphere of physical life. They come in contact with the embryos, and cause them to spring up and assume an external form, which appears like an image of man's psychic being. Something like a delicate fertilization then takes place between the human soul and the bodily embryo.
If we looked at the earth during the night, it would seem like a lifeless body. It's mostly made up of the decaying remains of humans whose souls have moved on to another existence. The structured water and air that made up human bodies break down and mix into the earth. Only the part of the human body formed from the very start of the earth's evolution through the combination of fire and the human soul, which got denser over time, remains as a tiny, insignificant embryo. When day begins, the earth once again feels the sun's influence, and human souls move into the sphere of physical life. They connect with the embryos, helping them grow and take on a shape that reflects the human psyche. A kind of delicate fertilization occurs between the human soul and the bodily embryo.
The souls thus embodied now begin once more to attract the aeriform and watery substances and incorporate them in their own bodies. Air is expelled and absorbed by the organized body,—the first beginning [pg 199] of that which later appears as the respiratory process. Water too is absorbed and expelled; the nutritive process in its original form has begun. But these processes are not yet perceived as external ones. A kind of external perception takes place in the soul only by means of the already characterized kind of fertilization. Here the soul vaguely feels its awakening to physical existence when it comes in contact with the embryo which is held toward it from the earth. It then feels something which may be put into words thus: “This is my form.” And such a feeling, which might even be called a dawning consciousness of self, abides within the soul through this union with the physical body. But the soul still feels the process of absorbing air in an absolutely psycho-spiritual way, as an image, which appears in the form of tone-pictures surging up and down; these give form to the embryo which is being incorporated within them. The soul everywhere feels itself in the midst of sound waves, and that it is fashioning the body in accordance with those tone forces. Thus are human forms developed at that stage of evolution. They cannot be observed in any external world by our present consciousness. They evolve like vegetable or flower forms of fine substance, therefore appear like flowers waving in the wind.
The souls that have taken shape now start to draw in air and water and blend them into their own bodies. Air is exhaled and inhaled by the organized body—the initial stage of what will later be recognized as the breathing process. Water is also taken in and released; the basic form of nutrition has begun. But these processes aren’t yet understood as external phenomena. A sort of external awareness arises in the soul only through the specific type of fertilization. In this moment, the soul vaguely senses its awakening to physical life when it connects with the embryo that is presented to it from the earth. It then experiences something that can be expressed as: “This is my document.” Such a feeling, which could even be described as a budding self-awareness, remains within the soul through its connection with the physical body. However, the soul perceives the process of absorbing air in a completely psycho-spiritual manner, as an image that manifests as sound-like sensations rising and falling; these shape the embryo being integrated within them. The soul senses itself surrounded by sound waves, realizing that it is shaping the body according to those tonal forces. This is how human forms develop at that stage of evolution. They can’t be observed in any external reality through our current consciousness. They evolve like delicate plant or flower forms, thus appearing like flowers swaying in the breeze.
During his Earth period, man experiences the blissful feeling of being fashioned into such forms. The absorption of the watery parts is felt in the soul as an accession of force, or inner strength. From [pg 200] without it appears as growth of the physical human structure. As the direct influence of the sun decreases, the human soul also loses the power of controlling these processes. By degrees they are cast aside. Only those parts are left which allow the embryo, above described, to mature. But man leaves his body, and returns to the spiritual form of existence. (As not all parts of the earth's body are employed in building up human bodies, we must not imagine that during the earth's night period, it is composed exclusively of disintegrating corpses and embryos waiting to be awakened. All these are imbedded in other structures, which are formed out of the earth's substances. The status of those structures will be explained later.)
During his time on Earth, a person feels the joyful experience of being shaped into these forms. The absorption of water is sensed in the soul as an increase in energy or inner strength. From [pg 200] without it, it appears as growth of the physical human body. As the direct influence of the sun diminishes, the human soul also loses the ability to control these processes. Gradually, they are discarded. Only those elements remain that allow the embryo, as previously described, to develop. But a person leaves their body and returns to a spiritual form of existence. (Since not all parts of the Earth's body are used to create human bodies, we shouldn’t think that during the Earth's night period, it's made up solely of decaying corpses and embryos waiting to be awakened. All these are embedded in other structures, which are formed from the Earth's materials. The condition of those structures will be explained later.)
Now, however, the process of condensing the earth's substance continues. To the watery element is added the solid or “earthly” substance (“earthly” in the sense of occult science). And when this happens man also, during his earth period, begins to incorporate the earthly element in his body. As soon as this incorporation begins, the forces which the soul brings with it out of the disembodied state, no longer have the same power as before. Previously, the soul had fashioned its body out of the igneous, aeriform, and watery elements, in accordance with the tones which resounded and the light-pictures which played around it. The soul cannot do this with regard to the solidified form. Other forces now interpose to shape it. What is left behind of man, when the soul withdraws from the body, is not [pg 201] only an embryo to be fanned into life by the returning soul, but a structure containing in itself reanimating power. The soul, at its departure, not only leaves its image behind on earth but sends down some of its animating power into that image.
Now, however, the process of condensing the earth's substance continues. The watery element is joined by the solid or "worldly" substance ("worldly" in the context of occult science). When this occurs, a person, during their time on Earth, starts to integrate the earthly element into their body. Once this integration begins, the forces that the soul carries with it from the disembodied state no longer have the same strength as before. Previously, the soul created its body from the fiery, airy, and watery elements, shaped by the resonating tones and the light-images surrounding it. The soul can't do this with the solidified form. Different forces now come into play to shape it. What remains of a person when the soul departs from the body is not just an embryo waiting to be brought to life by the returning soul, but a structure that possesses its own reanimating power. When the soul leaves, it not only leaves its image behind on Earth but also sends some of its animating power down into that image.
Now on its reappearance on earth the soul alone no longer suffices to awaken the image to life; reanimation must take place in the image itself. The spiritual beings influencing the earth from the sun now uphold the reanimating force that is in the human body, even though man himself is not upon the earth. Thus, during its incarnation, the soul is not only sensible of the sounds and light-pictures floating around, in which it feels the beings next above it, but, through receiving the earthly element, it comes under the influence of those still higher beings who have taken up their abode on the sun. Previously, man felt that he belonged to the psycho-spiritual beings with whom he was united when free from the body. His ego was still within them. Now that ego confronts him during physical incarnation, quite as much as everything else which is around him during that period. Independent images of the psycho-spiritual being of man were henceforth on the earth. These structures, in comparison with the present human body, were of a finer material. For the earthly part mixed with them only in its finest state, much in the same way as when man of the present day absorbs the finely distributed substances of an object through his organ of smell. Human bodies were like shadows. But as they were distributed over [pg 202] the whole earth they came under earth influences, which varied in their nature on different parts of the earth's surface. Whereas formerly bodily images corresponded to the human soul animating them, and on that account were essentially alike over the whole earth, differences now appeared between human forms. In this manner the way was prepared for what appeared later as differences of race.
Now, when the soul reappears on earth, it can no longer bring the image to life on its own; the image must be reanimated as well. The spiritual beings influencing the earth from the sun now support the reanimating energy within the human body, even if the person is not physically present. During its incarnation, the soul not only perceives the sounds and light-images around it, sensing the beings that are slightly above it, but by taking in the earthly element, it also comes under the influence of even higher beings who reside on the sun. Previously, humans felt connected to the psycho-spiritual beings they were united with when they were free from their bodies, as their ego remained part of them. Now, that ego confronts the individual during physical existence, just like everything else in their surroundings during that time. Independent images of the psycho-spiritual essence of humans were established on earth. These forms, compared to the current human body, were made of a finer material, as the earthly aspect only mingled with them in its purest state, similar to how a modern person absorbs the subtle substances of an object through their sense of smell. Human bodies resembled shadows. However, as they were spread across the entire earth, they fell under earthly influences, which varied across different regions. While in the past, bodily images matched the human soul animating them, making them essentially similar across the earth, differences began to emerge between human forms. This laid the groundwork for what later appeared as racial differences.
When the human body became independent, the previous close union of the earth-man with the psycho-spiritual world was to a certain extent dissolved. Henceforth, when the soul left the body, the latter, in a way, continued to live. If evolution had gone on advancing in this manner, the earth would have hardened under the influence of its solid elements. To the eyes of the seer who looks back on those conditions, human bodies, when abandoned by their souls, appear to become more and more solidified. And after a time the human souls returning to earth would have found no available material with which to combine. All the substances available for man would have been used up in filling the earth with the hardened, wood-like remains of incarnations.
When the human body became independent, the previous close connection between man and the psycho-spiritual world was somewhat broken. From that point on, when the soul left the body, the body seemed to continue existing in a way. If evolution had continued on this path, the earth would have become more solid from its dense elements. To the seer who reflects on those times, human bodies, once abandoned by their souls, seem to become increasingly solidified. Eventually, when human souls returned to earth, they would have found no available material left to combine with. All the substances needed for humans would have been consumed in filling the earth with the hardened, wood-like remnants of past lives.
Then an event took place which gave a new turn to the whole evolution. Everything in the solid earthly substance which could contribute to permanent induration was eliminated. At this point our present moon left the earth. And what had previously directly conduced to a moulding of permanent forms, now operated from the moon indirectly and in a diminished degree. The higher beings, on whom [pg 203] that moulding of forms depended, had resolved to exercise their influences upon their earth no longer from its interior, but from without. By this means there was brought about in the bodily structure of man a difference which must be called the beginning of the separation into a male and a female sex.
Then an event happened that changed the entire evolution. Everything in the solid earthly matter that could contribute to lasting solidification was removed. At this point, our present moon departed from the earth. What had previously helped shape permanent forms now influenced them indirectly and to a lesser extent from the moon. The higher beings, on whom [pg 203] that shaping of forms depended, decided to exert their influence on the earth no longer from within but from the outside. This led to a change in the physical structure of humans that marked the beginning of the separation into male and female genders.
The finely constituted human forms which formerly inhabited the earth, had produced through cooperation of the two forces within themselves, that of the embryo and that of the animating force, the new human form, their descendant. These descendants are now transformed. In one group the animating power of the psycho-spiritual element was paramount; in another the animating germinal force. This was caused by the weakening of the power of the solid element in consequence of the moon's leaving the earth. The reciprocal action of these two forces now became more delicate than it had been before—when it occurred within one single body, consequently the descendant also became more delicate and fine. He entered the earth in a delicate condition, and only gradually incorporated more solid parts within him. In this way the possibility of union with the body was once more given to the human soul returning to earth. It no longer animated the body from without, because that animation took place on the earth itself; but it became united with the body, and enabled it to grow. Of course a certain limit was set to that growth. Through the separation of the moon, the human body had for a time become supple; but the more it continued to [pg 204] grow on the earth, the more the solidifying forces got the upper hand. At length the share borne by the soul in the organization of the body grew less and less, and the body disintegrated when the soul ascended to psycho-spiritual modes of existence. One can trace how the forces gradually acquired by man during the Saturn, Sun, and Moon evolutions take part more and more in the progress of man during the described formative periods of the earth. The first part to be kindled by the earth's fire is the astral body, still containing within it the etheric and physical bodies in a state of solution. Then the astral body is organized into a more subtle astral part, the sentient soul, and into a grosser etheric part, which henceforth is in contact with the earth-element; when this occurs, the etheric or vital body, already fore-shadowed, makes its appearance. And while the intellectual and consciousness-souls are being evolved in the astral man, there are incorporated into the etheric body those coarser parts which are susceptible to sound and light.
The finely structured human forms that once populated the earth created a new human form, their descendant, through the cooperation of the two forces within them: the embryo and the animating force. These descendants have now changed. In one group, the animating energy of the psycho-spiritual element was dominant; in another, the animating germinal force. This shift happened because the solid element's power weakened when the moon departed from the earth. The interaction between these two forces became more subtle than before—when it occurred within a single body—leading to descendants that were also more delicate and refined. They entered the earth in a fragile state and gradually incorporated more solid parts into themselves. This way, the possibility for the human soul returning to earth to unite with the body was restored. It no longer animated the body from the outside, as that animation now took place on earth itself; instead, it became united with the body, enabling it to grow. Naturally, there was a limit to that growth. After the moon's separation, the human body became more flexible for a time; but as it continued to grow on earth, the solidifying forces gained dominance. Eventually, the soul's contribution to the body's organization diminished, and the body disintegrated when the soul ascended to higher psycho-spiritual levels of existence. You can see how the forces gradually developed in humanity during the Saturn, Sun, and Moon evolutions increasingly involved the progress of humans during these formative periods of the earth. The first aspect ignited by the earth's fire is the astral body, which still contains the etheric and physical bodies in a dissolved state. Then, the astral body is organized into a more subtle astral component, the sentient soul, and a denser etheric component, which now connects with the earth-element; when this happens, the etheric or vital body, already foreshadowed, comes into being. As the intellectual and consciousness-souls develop in the astral man, coarser parts sensitive to sound and light are incorporated into the etheric body.
At the time when the etheric body still further densifies and changes from a light-body into a fire or heat-body, the stage of evolution has been reached at which, as described above, parts of the solid earth-element are incorporated into man. Because the etheric body has condensed to the consistency of fire, it is now able, by means of the forces of the physical body previously implanted in it, to combine with those substances of the physical earth attenuated as far as the fire-state. But by itself it would no [pg 205] longer be able to introduce air substances into the body which has meanwhile become more solidified. Then, as indicated above, the higher beings dwelling on the sun interpose, breathing air into the body. While man, by virtue of his past, is able of himself to become permeated with earthly fire, higher beings direct the breath of air into his body. Heretofore the etheric body of man, as a receiver of sound, had been the director of the air current. It permeated man's physical body with life. Now the physical body gets life from without. The result is that this life becomes independent of the soul part of man. On departing from the earth, the soul leaves behind not only the seed of its form, but also a living image of itself. The Lords of Form now remain united with that image, and the life they have bestowed, they transfer to man's descendants, when his soul has left the body. Thus comes about what may be called heredity, and when the human soul once more appears on earth it feels that it is in a body animated by the life of its ancestors. It feels itself especially attracted to just that kind of a body. In this way something like a memory is formed of the ancestor with whom the soul feels itself to be at one. This memory passes through the line of descendants in the form of a consciousness possessed in common. The ego thus flows down through the generations.
When the etheric body further densifies and transforms from a light body into a fire or heat body, it marks a stage in evolution where, as mentioned earlier, parts of the solid earth element are integrated into humans. Because the etheric body has thickened to a fiery consistency, it now can use the forces of the physical body that were previously embedded in it to connect with the substances of the physical earth that have been thinned to a fiery state. However, on its own, it can no longer introduce air substances into the body, which has by now become more solid. As noted before, higher beings residing on the sun intervene by breathing air into the body. While humans, due to their past, can become infused with earthly fire, higher beings guide the breath of air into their bodies. Until now, the etheric body of humans had acted as a receiver of sound and controlled the air currents, filling the physical body with life. Now, the physical body receives life from outside itself. As a result, this life becomes separate from the soul aspect of an individual. When the soul departs from the earth, it leaves behind not just the essence of its form, but also a living image of itself. The Lords of Form remain connected to that image and transfer the life they have imparted to the descendants of the individual after the soul has left the body. This is how heredity happens; when the human soul reappears on earth, it feels that it exists in a body sustained by the life of its ancestors and is particularly drawn to that specific type of body. In this manner, a kind of memories develops of the ancestor with whom the soul feels connected. This memory carries through the line of descendants as a shared consciousness. The self, therefore, flows down through the generations.
At this stage of evolution man, during his life on earth, was conscious of himself as an independent being. He felt the inner fire of his etheric body to [pg 206] be combined with the external fire of the earth. He could feel the heat that was streaming through him as his own ego. In those heat currents, interwoven with life, are to be found the first beginnings of the circulation of the blood. But in what flowed into him as air, he did not exactly feel as his own being. Indeed, it was the forces of the higher beings we have described that were working in that air. But still there was left to him, within the air that flowed through him, that part of the active forces which belonged to him by virtue of his previously formed etheric powers. He was master in one part of those air currents. And to that extent, it was not only the higher beings who were shaping him, but he himself. He formed the air parts of his being in accordance with the images of his astral body. While air was thus flowing into his body from without, a process which became the basis of respiration, part of the air was formed within him into an organism which became fixed and was the basis of the subsequent nervous system. Thus man at this period was connected with the external earth by heat and air.
At this point in evolution, humans were aware of themselves as independent beings during their time on earth. They felt the inner energy of their etheric body merging with the external energy of the earth. They could sense the heat flowing through them as part of their identity. In these currents of heat, intertwined with life, were the early stages of blood circulation. However, when it came to the air they breathed, they didn't quite feel it as part of themselves. In fact, it was the forces of the higher beings we previously mentioned that influenced that air. Yet, within the air that flowed through them, there remained a portion of the active forces that belonged to them due to their already developed etheric powers. They had control over part of those air currents. Thus, it wasn't only the higher beings shaping them, but they were also shaping themselves. They formed the air components of their being according to the images from their astral body. While air flowed into their bodies from outside—a process that laid the groundwork for respiration—part of the air was transformed within them into an organism that became fixed and established the foundation for the future nervous system. Therefore, at this time, humans were connected to the external earth through heat and air.
On the other hand, he was not conscious of the introduction within himself of the solid element of the earth. Although it contributed to his own embodiment, he could not perceive directly what was being supplied but could only do so through a dim consciousness in the image of the higher beings who were active in the process. In the same kind of picture-form, as an expression of the beings above him, man had previously perceived [pg 207] the introduction of the fluid element into the earth. Through the densification of his earthly form the pictures have now undergone a change in his consciousness. The solid element has been mixed with the fluid. This incoming of the solid element must also be seen to be the work of higher beings operated from without. It is no longer possible for the human soul to have the power of directing the supply for that supply has now to serve his body, which is being built up from without. He would spoil its form if he were to direct the influx himself.
On the other hand, he wasn't aware of the solid element of the earth being introduced within him. Even though it contributed to his own physical existence, he couldn’t directly perceive what was being provided; he could only sense it through a vague awareness of the higher beings involved in the process. In a similar way, as a reflection of the beings above him, he had previously recognized the introduction of the fluid element into the earth. With the solidification of his earthly form, those images have now changed in his consciousness. The solid element has mixed with the fluid. This arrival of the solid element should also be viewed as the work of higher beings acting from the outside. It’s no longer possible for the human soul to manage this supply, as it now has to support his body, which is being formed from the outside. He would distort its shape if he tried to control the influx himself.
What, therefore, reaches him from without appears to him to be directed by authoritative orders issuing from the higher beings who are at work on the shaping of his body. Man feels himself to be an ego; he has within him, as part of his astral body, his intellectual-soul, through which he inwardly perceives, in the form of pictures, what is happening externally, and by means of which he permeates his delicate nervous system. He feels himself to be descended from ancestors, by virtue of the life flowing down through the generations. He breathes, and feels it to be the effect of the higher beings who have been described as the Lords of Form. He is likewise subject to their impulses in all that which comes to him from the outside (as his food). What he finds most obscure is his origin as an individual. As to that, he only knows that he has been under the influence of the Lords of Form expressing themselves in earth-forces. In his relations with the [pg 208] outer world, man was guided and ruled. This finds expression through the fact that man has a consciousness of the psycho-spiritual activities operating behind his physical environment. It is true that he does not see the spiritual beings in their own form, but he is conscious in his soul of sounds and colors. He knows, however, that it is the actions of spiritual beings that are realized through that world of images. What those beings communicate to him, reaches him as sound; their manifestations appear to him in light-pictures.
What reaches him from the outside seems to him to be directed by authoritative commands coming from the higher beings who are involved in shaping his body. A person perceives themselves as an individual; they have within them, as part of their astral body, their intellectual-soul, which allows them to inwardly sense, in images, what is happening externally and through which they influence their delicate nervous system. They feel a connection to their ancestors, thanks to the life that flows down through the generations. They breathe, feeling it to be the result of the higher beings known as the Lords of Form. They are also influenced by these beings in everything that comes from outside, like their food. What they find most confusing is their origin as individuals. They only know that they have been under the influence of the Lords of Form expressed through earth-forces. In their interactions with the outer world, a person is guided and governed. This is shown by the fact that they are aware of the psycho-spiritual dynamics at play behind their physical surroundings. While it’s true that they cannot see the spiritual beings in their true form, they are aware, at a soul level, of sounds and colors. They understand that the actions of spiritual beings are manifested through that realm of images. What those beings communicate reaches them as sound; their expressions appear to them in light-images.
The innermost concepts, of which earthly man becomes conscious, are those conveyed to him by the element of fire or warmth. He can already distinguish between his own inner heat and the heat currents of the earth's periphery. In these latter are manifested the Sons of Personality. But man has only a dim consciousness of what is behind the currents of external heat. It is in those very currents that he feels the influence of the Lords of Form. When powerful effects of heat are produced in man's environment, the soul feels that spiritual beings are now heating the earth's circumference—beings, from whom a spark has been detached, which warms his inner being.
The deepest concepts that earthly humans become aware of are those communicated to them through the element of fire or warmth. They can already tell the difference between their own inner heat and the heat currents at the edge of the earth. Within these currents are the Sons of Personality. However, people only have a vague understanding of what lies behind the external heat currents. It is within these currents that they sense the influence of the Lords of Form. When strong heat effects occur in a person's surroundings, the soul feels that spiritual beings are heating the earth's surface—beings from whom a spark has been taken, which warms their inner being.
In the effect of light, however, man does not yet distinguish in quite the same manner between the outer and the inner. When light-pictures appear around him, they do not always produce the same feeling in the soul of the earth-man. There were times when he felt them as external images. This [pg 209] was during the period when he had just descended from the disembodied state into incarnation. It was the period of his growth on earth. As the time approached for the embryo to be developed those images faded, and man only retained something like inner memory-pictures of them. The actions of the Sons of Fire (Archangels) were contained in those light-pictures, which appeared to man to be the servitors of the Fire-spirits who sent down a spark into his own inner being. When their outer manifestations died away, man felt them inwardly in the form of images (memories). He felt himself united with their forces. And so indeed he was. For by means of what he had received from them, he was able to work upon his surrounding atmosphere. This, under his influence, began to emit light.
In the light's influence, however, humans do not yet see the distinction between the outer and inner in quite the same way. When images of light appear around them, they don’t always evoke the same feelings in the soul of earthly beings. There were times when they experienced these as external visions. This was during the time when they had just transitioned from a disembodied state into a physical form. It marked a period of growth on Earth. As the embryo developed, those images began to fade, leaving humans with only vague inner memory-images of them. The actions of the Sons of Fire (Archangels) were woven into those light-images, which appeared to humans as the servants of the Fire-spirits that sent a spark into their inner being. When their outer forms disappeared, humans felt these inwardly as images (memories). They sensed a connection with their forces. And indeed, they were connected. Through what they had received from them, they could influence their surrounding atmosphere. This, under their influence, began to radiate light.
At that time nature forces and human forces were not as yet separated from each other as they subsequently became. What happened on earth still emanated to a great extent from human forces. Viewing nature processes on the earth from the outside, one would then have seen in them not only something independent of man, but also the effect of human activity within those processes. Sound-perceptions assumed a still more different form to the earth-man. From the beginning of earth-life they had been perceived as outer tones. Whereas the external air pictures were perceived up to the middle of earth existence, the external tones could be heard even after that middle period. And only toward the end of his life did the earth-man become [pg 210] insensible to them. But the memory-pictures of those sounds remained. In them were contained the manifestations of the Sons of Life (Angels). When, toward the end of his life, man felt himself inwardly united with those forces, he was able, by imitating them, to produce mighty effects in the earth's watery element. The waters surged in and above the earth under his influence. Man had perceptions of taste only during the first quarter of his earth-life, and even then they seemed to the soul like a memory of the experience of his disembodied state. As long as they lasted, his body continued to grow more and more solid by assimilating external substances. In the second quarter of earth life growth still continued, but the form was already fully developed. At this time man could perceive other living beings near him only through their heat, light, and sound effects; for he was not as yet capable of imagining the solid element. During the first quarter of his life he received the taste-impressions described, only through the watery element.
At that time, nature and human forces weren’t as separate as they later became. What happened on Earth was still largely influenced by human actions. If you looked at natural processes on Earth from an outside perspective, you would see not just something independent of humans, but also how human activity affected those processes. The way sounds were perceived also changed significantly for Earth humans. From the start of life on Earth, sounds were experienced as external tones. While external visual images could be perceived until the middle of Earth's existence, external sounds could still be heard even after that point. It wasn't until the end of his life that the Earth human became unresponsive to them. However, the memories of those sounds lingered on. Those sounds contained the manifestations of the Sons of Life (Angels). When, towards the end of his life, a person felt an inner connection with those forces, he could imitate them and create powerful effects in the watery element of Earth. The waters surged beneath and above the Earth due to his influence. A person could only experience taste during the first quarter of their Earth life, and even then, it felt to the soul like a memory of being disembodied. As long as those tastes lasted, the body became increasingly solid by absorbing external substances. In the second quarter of Earth life, growth continued, but the form was already fully developed. During this time, a person could only perceive other living beings nearby through their heat, light, and sound effects, as he wasn’t yet capable of imagining solid forms. Throughout the first quarter of his life, he experienced taste impressions only through the water element.
Man's external bodily form was an image of this inner psychic condition. Those parts were most fully developed which contained the first fore-shadowing of the later form of the head. The other organs appeared only as appendages. These were shadowy and indistinct. Yet earth-beings varied with regard to form. There were some in whom the appendages were more or less developed, according to the earth-conditions under which they lived. This varied with people's different dwelling [pg 211] places on the earth. Where they were more involved in the things of earth, the appendages became more prominent. Those human beings who at the beginning of physical development on earth were the ripest, owing to their previous evolution, having come in contact with the fire-element at the very beginning before the earth had been condensed into air, were those now able to develop the first beginnings of the head most completely. They were those persons possessing most inner harmony.
A person's outer physical form reflected their inner mental state. The parts of the body that were most developed hinted at the future shape of the head. The other organs seemed to be mere add-ons, vague and unclear. However, beings on Earth varied in form. Some had more or less developed appendages depending on the environmental conditions they faced. This variation was influenced by where people lived on the planet. In areas where they were more engaged with earthly matters, the appendages became more pronounced. Those humans who, at the beginning of physical development on Earth, were most advanced due to their prior evolution and had encountered the fire element before the Earth became air, were the ones who could develop the initial stages of the head most fully. They were individuals with the greatest inner balance.
Others were ready for contact with the fire-element only when the earth had already evolved air within it. They were more dependent upon outer conditions than the first mentioned, who distinctly felt the Lords of Form through heat, and during their earth-life felt as though they retained a memory of having belonged to those spirits and of having been connected with them in the disembodied state. The second species of human beings only had the memory of the disembodied state to a more limited degree; they were conscious of their fellowship with the spiritual world chiefly through the light-influences of the Sons of Fire (Archangels). A third type of human beings was still more entangled in earthly existence. It was they who were unable to come in contact with the fire-element until the earth was separated from the sun and had absorbed the watery element within itself. Their feeling of fellowship with the spiritual world was especially slight at the beginning of earth-life. Only when the activities of the Archangels, and more especially of the [pg 212] Angels, influenced the inner imaginative life, did they feel this connection to any degree. On the other hand, at the beginning of the earth-period they were full of active impulses for performing deeds which can be accomplished under earthly conditions only. In them the extremities were particularly strongly developed.
Others were ready to connect with the fire element only after the earth had developed air within it. They relied more on external conditions than the first group, who clearly sensed the Lords of Form through heat and felt as if they held a memory of belonging to those spirits and being linked with them in a disembodied state. The second type of human beings had a more limited memory of the disembodied state; they primarily experienced their connection to the spiritual world through the light influences of the Sons of Fire (Archangels). A third group of humans was even more caught up in earthly existence. They couldn't connect with the fire element until the earth separated from the sun and absorbed the watery element. Their sense of connection to the spiritual world was especially weak at the start of earth life. It was only when the activities of the Archangels, and particularly those of the Angels, impacted their inner imaginative life that they felt this connection at all. Conversely, at the beginning of the earth period, they were full of active urges to perform tasks that could only be achieved under earthly conditions. In them, the extremities were particularly well developed.
When the Moon-forces, before the separation of the moon from the earth, tended more and more to harden the latter, it happened that among the descendants of the embryos left behind upon the earth by man, there were some in whom human souls returning from the disembodied state could no longer incarnate in consequence of the Moon-forces. The form of these descendants was too much solidified and through the Moon-forces, had become too unlike the human form to be able to reassume it. Consequently certain human souls no longer found it possible, under these circumstances, to return to earth. Only the ripest and strongest of these souls felt competent to transform the earth-body during its growth, so that it could blossom into a human form. Only a portion of the bodily descendants of man became the vehicles of earthly human beings. Another part, because of its solidified form, was able to receive only souls on a lower level than those of men. But there was one group of human souls, however, which was prevented from participating in the earth-evolution of that time. In this way they were driven to embark on another course.
When the Moon's forces, before the moon separated from the Earth, increasingly hardened the latter, it turned out that among the descendants of the embryos left on Earth by humans, there were some in whom human souls returning from the disembodied state could no longer incarnate due to the Moon's influence. The form of these descendants had become too solidified and, because of the Moon's forces, had transformed too much to resemble the human form, making it impossible for them to reassume it. As a result, certain human souls could no longer return to Earth under these conditions. Only the most mature and strongest of these souls felt capable of transforming the earthly body during its growth so that it could develop into a human form. Only a portion of humanity's bodily descendants became the vessels for earthly human beings. Another part, due to its solidified form, could only receive souls of a lower level than those of humans. However, there was one group of human souls that was prevented from joining in the Earth’s evolution at that time. This situation forced them to embark on a different path.
There were souls who, as far back as the separation [pg 213] of the sun from the earth, found no place on the latter. For their further evolution they were removed to a planet which, under the guidance of cosmic beings, was detached from the universal world-substance,—that substance of which the earth formed a part at the beginning of its physical evolution, and from which the sun had separated. This planet, in its physical expression, is the one known to outer science as “Jupiter.” (Here we are speaking of celestial bodies, planets, and their names exactly in the sense of a more ancient science, and as is in harmony with occult science. Just as the physical earth is only the physical expression of a great psycho-spiritual organism, so is every other celestial body. And as the seer does not denote only the physical planet by the word “earth,” nor only the physical fixed star by “sun,” so when speaking of “Jupiter,” “Mars,” and the other planets, he signifies far-reaching spiritual relationships. The form and mission of the heavenly bodies have, in the nature of things, been essentially changed since the times of which we are here speaking,—in a certain respect even their position in celestial space has been changed. It is possible only for one who follows with the seer's vision the evolution of those celestial bodies back to remote ages of the past, to apprehend the connection of contemporary planets with their predecessors.) On Jupiter the souls that have been described continued their evolution.
There were souls who, as far back as when the sun separated from the earth, found no place on the latter. For their further evolution, they were taken to a planet that, under the guidance of cosmic beings, was separated from the universal world-substance—the substance from which the earth was formed at the beginning of its physical evolution and from which the sun had separated. This planet, in its physical form, is the one known to outer science as “Jupiter.” (Here we're talking about celestial bodies, planets, and their names in the way that aligns with an older understanding and is consistent with occult science. Just as the physical earth is merely a physical manifestation of a vast psycho-spiritual organism, so is every other celestial body. And just as the seer does not refer only to the physical planet by the word “earth,” nor only to the physical fixed star by “sun,” when discussing “Jupiter,” “Mars,” and the other planets, he points to deep spiritual connections. The form and purpose of these heavenly bodies have, by nature, significantly changed since the times we are referencing—in some respects, even their positions in celestial space have shifted. Only someone who follows the evolution of these celestial bodies back to the distant past, with the vision of a seer, can truly understand the relationship between contemporary planets and their predecessors.) On Jupiter, the souls that have been described continued their evolution.
And later, when the earth was tending more and more toward solidification, still another abode had [pg 214] to be prepared for souls who even though they were able to occupy the solidified bodies for a time, could no longer do so when this solidification had progressed too far. An appropriate place for their further evolution was prepared on “Mars.” Even as far back as the time when the soul was still united with the sun, and was incorporating the sun's air elements within itself, certain souls were proving unfit to participate in the earth's evolution. They were too powerfully affected by the earthly bodily form. Accordingly, even at that time, they had to be withdrawn from the direct influence of the Sun-forces. These had to influence them from without. The planet Saturn became the scene of their further evolution.
And later, as the earth was becoming more solid, another place needed to be created for souls who, while they could occupy solid bodies for some time, could no longer do so as the solidification progressed too far. A suitable location for their continued evolution was prepared on “Mars.” Even back when the soul was still connected to the sun and was integrating the sun's air elements within itself, some souls were proving unfit to take part in the earth's evolution. They were too strongly affected by the earthly bodily form. So, even at that time, they had to be removed from the direct influence of the Sun's forces. They needed to be influenced from the outside. The planet Saturn became the setting for their further evolution.
Thus, in the course of the earth's evolution, the number of human forms decreased, and forms appeared which had not embodied human souls. These were able to receive only astral bodies as the human physical and etheric bodies on the old Moon had done. While the earth was becoming depopulated as far as human beings were concerned, these other beings were colonizing it. Eventually all human souls would have been compelled to leave the earth if, by detaching the Moon from it, a way had not been provided to preserve those human bodies which at that time could still harbor human souls. It was made possible for these, during their earth life, to withdraw the human ego from the effects of the Moon-forces coming directly from the earth, thus allowing it to mature sufficiently within themselves [pg 215] until it could be exposed directly to those forces. As long as the embryo was developing within man, it was under the influence of those beings who, under the leadership of the mightiest of their number, had detached the moon from the earth in order to conduct the evolution of the latter over a critical point.
So, as the Earth evolved, the number of human forms decreased, and new forms emerged that didn't have human souls. These new beings could only receive astral bodies, similar to how human physical and etheric bodies did on the old Moon. While the Earth was becoming less populated by humans, these other beings were populating it. Eventually, all human souls would have been forced to leave the Earth if the Moon hadn't been detached, which created a way to preserve those human bodies that could still harbor human souls at that time. This allowed those souls, during their life on Earth, to detach their human ego from the Moon's influences coming directly from the Earth, enabling them to develop enough within themselves until they could face those forces directly. While the embryo was developing within humans, it was influenced by those beings who, led by the most powerful among them, had detached the Moon from the Earth to help guide Earth's evolution past a critical point. [pg 215]
When the earth had developed the air element within it, astral beings were present as described above, who had belonged to the old Moon and who had been left behind. They had fallen short even of the lowest human souls in their evolution. They became the souls of those forms which already before the separation of the Sun had to be abandoned by man. These beings are the ancestors of the animal kingdom. As time went on, they developed especially those organs which in man thus far only existed as appendages. Their astral body had to work on the physical and etheric bodies in the same way as did the human astral body during the old Moon-period. Now the animals which had thus come into existence had souls which could not dwell in the individual animals. The soul extended its being also to the descendant. Virtually, animals descended from one form have a soul in common. Only when the descendant diverges from the ancestral type through special influences, does a new animal soul become incarnated. In this sense, in accordance with occult science, we can speak of a species or group-soul, in animals.
When the Earth developed the air element, astral beings, as mentioned earlier, who belonged to the old Moon and had been left behind, were present. They were less evolved than even the most basic human souls. They became the souls of forms that had to be abandoned by humans before the separation of the Sun. These beings are the ancestors of the animal kingdom. Over time, they specifically developed organs that in humans only exist as appendages. Their astral body worked on the physical and etheric bodies just like the human astral body did during the old Moon period. The animals that came into existence this way had souls that could not reside individually in each animal. The soul extended its existence to the descendants as well. Essentially, animals that descend from the same form share a common soul. A new animal soul incarnates only when a descendant diverges from the ancestral type due to special influences. In this sense, according to occult science, we can refer to animals as having a species or group-soul.
Something of a similar nature took place at the [pg 216] time of the separation of sun and earth. There came forth from the watery element, forms no further evolved than man was before the old Moon-evolution. They could only receive an impression from anything of an astral nature when the latter influenced them from without. This could not happen until after the departure of the sun from the earth. Whenever the sun-period of the earth set in, the astral element in the sun stimulated these forms in such a way that they formed their vital body out of the etheric part of the earth. When the sun turned away from the earth, that etheric body was again dissolved into the common earth-life. And as a result of the co-operation of the astral part of the sun with the etheric part of the earth, there emerged from the watery element those physical forms which became the ancestors of the present vegetable kingdom.
Something similar happened at the time when the sun and the earth separated. From the watery element emerged forms that were no more advanced than humans were before the old Moon evolution. They could only be influenced by anything astral when it affected them from the outside. This could only occur after the sun had moved away from the earth. Whenever the sun's period over the earth began, the astral element of the sun energized these forms in such a way that they developed their vital body from the etheric part of the earth. When the sun turned away from the earth, that etheric body was once again dissolved into the common life of the earth. As a result of the collaboration between the astral part of the sun and the etheric part of the earth, those physical forms emerged from the watery element, becoming the ancestors of the current plant kingdom.
Man became an individualized soul-being on earth. His astral body, which had been poured into him on the Moon through the Lords of Motion, now became organized on earth into the sentient-intellectual-and consciousness-souls. And when the consciousness-soul had progressed so far that it was able to form for itself during earth-life, a body adapted to that life, the Lords of Form endowed that body with a spark from their fire. The “ego” was enkindled within it. Every time man left the physical body he was in the spiritual world, in which he met the beings who, during the Saturn, Sun, and Moon evolutions, had given him his physical, etheric, and astral bodies, [pg 217] and who had developed them as far as the earth-stage. Since the spark of ego had been enkindled during earth-life, there had also come about a change in the disembodied life. Up to this point of evolution, man had had no independence in the spiritual world. Within that world he did not feel himself a separate being, but as though he were a member of the exalted organism which was composed of the beings superior to him. The “ego experience” on earth now takes effect also in the spiritual world. Henceforth man feels himself to be, to a certain degree, a unit in that world. But he feels also that he is unceasingly linked with it. In the disembodied state he again finds the Lords of Form, in a higher aspect, and this aspect he had perceived in their manifestation on earth by means of the spark of his ego.
Man became an individual soul-being on earth. His astral body, which had been instilled in him on the Moon by the Lords of Motion, was now organized on earth into sentient, intellectual, and consciousness souls. And when the consciousness soul advanced enough to form a body suited for life on earth, the Lords of Form granted that body a spark from their fire. The "ego" ignited within it. Each time man left the physical body, he entered the spiritual world, where he encountered the beings who had given him his physical, etheric, and astral bodies during the Saturn, Sun, and Moon evolutions, [pg 217] and who had developed them to their stage on earth. Since the spark of ego had been ignited during earth life, a change had also occurred in the disembodied state. Until this point in evolution, man had no independence in the spiritual world. In that world, he didn't see himself as a separate being but rather as part of the elevated organism composed of superior beings. The “ego trip” on earth now also affects the spiritual world. From now on, man perceives himself as, to some degree, a unit in that realm. Yet he also feels that he is constantly connected to it. In the disembodied state, he again encounters the Lords of Form in a higher aspect, which he had sensed in their presence on earth through the spark of his ego.
At the separation of the moon from the earth, the disembodied soul began to have experiences in the spiritual world which were connected with that separation. To develop such human forms upon earth which could receive soul individuality, only became possible through the fact that a part of the shaping forces passed over from the Earth to the Moon. Thus human individuality came within the sphere of the Moon-beings. And in the disembodied state the reminiscence of earthly individuality could only operate because, even in that state, the soul remained within the sphere of those mighty spirits who had brought about the separation of the moon. The process worked in such a manner that immediately [pg 218] after leaving the earth-body the soul could only see the exalted Sun-beings as though in a lustre reflected from the Moon-beings. And it was only when sufficiently prepared by gazing at that reflected splendor, that the soul attained to the vision of the exalted Sun-beings themselves.
At the time the moon separated from the earth, the disembodied soul started to have experiences in the spiritual world that were linked to that separation. The development of human forms on earth that could hold soul individuality became possible because a part of the shaping forces transferred from the Earth to the Moon. This connection allowed human individuality to emerge within the realm of the Moon-beings. In the disembodied state, the memory of earthly individuality could only function because, even in that state, the soul remained within the influence of those powerful spirits who had caused the separation of the moon. The process worked in such a way that immediately after leaving the earth-body, the soul could only perceive the exalted Sun-beings as if through a light reflected from the Moon-beings. It was only after being adequately prepared by observing that reflected brilliance that the soul could reach the vision of the exalted Sun-beings themselves.
The mineral kingdom of the earth also arose out of what was ejected from human evolution in general. Its structures are what remained solidified after the moon was detached from the earth. The only soul-element which felt attracted to those structures was that which had been left behind at the Saturn stage, and was therefore only adapted for developing physical forms. All the occurrences treated of here and in what follows were enacted in the course of exceedingly long periods. But the question of chronology cannot be entered into here.
The mineral kingdom of the earth also emerged from what was released through human evolution as a whole. Its structures are what solidified after the moon separated from the earth. The only soul-element drawn to those structures was the one that had been left behind at the Saturn stage, making it only suited for developing physical forms. All the events discussed here and in what follows took place over incredibly long periods. However, we can't get into the question of chronology here.
The events described, present the evolution of the earth from without. Seen spiritually from within, the facts present themselves as follows: The spiritual beings who drew the moon out of the earth and incorporated their own existence with the moon,—thus becoming earth-moon beings,—brought about a certain formation of the human organism by means of the forces which they sent to the earth from the moon. Their influence affected the “ego” which man had acquired, and made itself felt in the interplay of that “ego” with the astral, etheric, and physical bodies. They made it possible for man to reflect within himself consciously and to reproduce within his cognition, the wisdom revealed in the cosmos. [pg 219] It will be remembered that during the old Moon-period man, owing to the separation from the sun at the time, acquired a certain independence in his organism, a more unfettered stage of consciousness than that which he had been able to derive directly from the Sun-spirits. This free, independent consciousness—a heritage from the old Moon-evolution—appeared again during the earth-period in question. But it was just this consciousness which, through the influence of the described earth-moon beings, could again be brought into union and harmony with the universe and be made a reflection of it. This would have happened if no other influence had asserted itself. Without that influence, man would have become a being whose consciousness would not have reflected the world in pictures of cognition, through his own free volition, but through natural necessity. But things did not happen in this way. At the time when the moon split off, certain spiritual beings interposed in human evolution who had retained so much of their Moon nature that they could not take part in the exodus of the sun from the earth, and were shut out from the influence of the spirits who from the earth-moon had exerted their activity upon the earth. These spirits with the old Moon nature were, so to say, banished to the earth, but with an irregular development. In their Moon-nature was that which had rebelled against the Sun-spirits during the old Moon-evolution, and which had so far been a blessing to man that it had led him to a free, [pg 220] independent state of consciousness. The consequences of the peculiar development of these spirits during the earth-period entailed their becoming adversaries of the spirits who, acting from the moon, desired to make human consciousness an automatic reflector of the universe. What had helped man to a higher state of development of the old Moon, proved to be in opposition to the possibilities which had arisen through the evolution of the earth. The opposing forces had brought with them from their Moon nature the power of working upon the human astral body, namely,—as above indicated,—the power of making it independent. They exercised that power by giving the astral body a certain degree of independence—even throughout the earth-period—compared with the automatic (involuntary) state of consciousness which had been brought about by the spirits of the earth-moon.
The events described show the evolution of the earth from an external perspective. When viewed spiritually from the inside, the facts unfold as follows: The spiritual beings who drew the moon away from the earth and merged their existence with the moon—thus becoming earth-moon beings—shaped a certain formation of the human body through the forces they sent from the moon to the earth. Their influence affected the "self" that humans had developed, making its presence felt in the interaction of that “self” with the astral, etheric, and physical bodies. They enabled humans to consciously reflect within themselves and reproduce in their understanding the wisdom revealed in the cosmos. [pg 219] It’s important to remember that during the old Moon-period, humans, due to their separation from the sun at that time, gained a certain independence in their beings, achieving a stage of consciousness that was freer than what they could derive directly from the Sun-spirits. This free, independent consciousness—a legacy from the old Moon evolution—reappeared during the earth period in question. However, it was precisely this consciousness that, through the influence of the earth-moon beings mentioned, could be reunited and harmonized with the universe, becoming a reflection of it. This would have occurred if no other influences had intervened. Without that influence, humans would have turned into beings whose consciousness would not have reflected the world in cognitive images through their own free will, but rather through natural necessity. But that’s not how things transpired. When the moon separated, certain spiritual beings intervened in human evolution who had retained enough of their Moon essence that they could not be part of the sun’s departure from the earth and were denied the influence of the spirits who, from the earth-moon, had acted upon the earth. These spirits with the old Moon essence were, in a sense, cast down to the earth, but with an irregular development. Within their Moon essence lay that which had rebelled against the Sun-spirits during the old Moon evolution, and this rebellion had been beneficial to humanity as it led them to a free, [pg 220] independent state of consciousness. The peculiar development of these spirits during the earth period resulted in them becoming adversaries to the spirits who, acting from the moon, wanted to make human consciousness an automatic reflector of the universe. What had helped humans reach a higher state of development in the old Moon was now in conflict with the possibilities that had emerged through the evolution of the earth. The opposing forces carried with them their Moon essence, which gave them the ability to influence the human astral body, namely—as previously noted—the power to make it independent. They exercised this power by giving the astral body a certain level of independence—even throughout the earth period—compared to the automatic (involuntary) state of consciousness established by the earth-moon spirits.
It is difficult to express in the language of to-day the effects on man, in that far-off time of the spiritual beings referred to. They must not be thought of as analogous to natural influences of the present time, nor yet as similar to the influence of one human being on another, when the first awakens in the second inner powers of consciousness by words which help the second person to understand something, or which stimulate him to virtue or vice. The effect referred to as operative in that primeval age was not a force of nature but a spiritual influence, conveyed in a spiritual way, which descended upon man as a spiritual influx from higher spirits, conformable [pg 221] with man's state of consciousness at that time. If we think of this influence as a force of nature we altogether miss its essential reality. If we say that the spirits with the old Moon nature tempted man in order to lead him astray for their own ends, we are using a symbolical expression, which is good as long as we remember that it is but a symbol and are at the same time clear in our minds that a spiritual fact underlies the symbol.
It’s hard to express in today’s language how spiritual beings from a distant past affected humans. They shouldn’t be viewed as similar to the natural influences we experience now, nor should they be compared to how one person can inspire another through words that help them understand or motivate them towards good or bad behavior. The effect of those beings in that ancient time wasn’t a natural force but rather a spiritual influence, delivered in a spiritual manner, which came upon humans as a spiritual influx from higher beings, aligned with their level of consciousness at that time. If we think of this influence as just a natural force, we completely miss its true essence. When we say that the spirits of the old Moon nature tempted humanity to lead them astray for their own purposes, we’re using a symbolic expression. This is fine as long as we remember it’s just a symbol and are clear that there’s a spiritual reality behind it.
The influence brought to bear on man by the spirits who had remained behind during the Moon-evolution had a two-fold result. Man's consciousness was divested of the character of being merely a mirror of the universe, because the possibility was aroused in the human astral body of regulating and controlling, by means of this astral body, the images in the consciousness. Man became the ruler of his own knowledge. But on the other hand it was the astral body that was the starting point of that rulership, and consequently the ego set over the astral body came to be continually dependent upon it. Hence man was from this time forth exposed to the lasting influences of a lower element in his nature. It was possible for him in his life to sink below the height on which he had been placed by the spirits of the earth-moon in the course of the world's progress. And subsequently he was open to the lasting influence on his nature of the irregularly evolved Moon-spirits. We may call these Moon-spirits Luciferian, to distinguish them from the other spirits who, from the earth-moon, made consciousness into [pg 222] a mirror of the universe, without bestowing free will. The Luciferian spirits endowed man with the possibility of developing free activity in his consciousness, and at the same time created the possibility of error and evil.
The influence exerted on humans by the spirits that stayed behind during the Moon evolution had two main effects. First, human consciousness was no longer just a reflection of the universe; instead, the human astral body gained the ability to regulate and control the images in consciousness. People became the masters of their own knowledge. However, the astral body was the foundation of that mastery, meaning the ego that governed the astral body became reliant on it. As a result, humans were now subject to the lasting influences of a lower aspect of their nature. It became possible for them to fall below the level that the spirits of the Earth-Moon had established during the progress of the world. Subsequently, they became open to the ongoing influence of the irregularly evolved Moon spirits. We can refer to these Moon spirits as Luciferian, to differentiate them from the other spirits that, from the Earth-Moon, turned consciousness into a reflection of the universe without granting free will. The Luciferian spirits gave humans the chance to develop free will in their consciousness, while also introducing the potential for error and evil.
As a result of these events man was brought into a different connection with the Sun-spirits from that which had been destined for him by the spirits of the earth-moon. These wished to develop the reflecting human consciousness in such a manner that within the whole life of the human soul, the influence of the Sun-spirits would have become dominant. These purposes were thwarted, and an opposition was thus created in human nature between the influence of the Sun-Spirits and that of the spirits who were irregularly developed on the old Moon. Owing to this opposition, the inability to recognize the physical Sun-influences as such also arose in man; they were hidden by the earthly impressions of the outer world. Filled with these impressions, the astral part of man was drawn into the sphere of the ego. This ego,—which otherwise would have felt only the spark of fire bestowed on it by the Lords of Form, and which would have submitted to the bidding of those spirits in everything that had to do with external fire,—henceforth worked upon external heat phenomena through the element with which it had itself been inoculated. A bond of attraction was thereby established between the ego and the earth-fire.
As a result of these events, humanity was put into a different relationship with the Sun spirits than what the earth-moon spirits had intended. They aimed to develop human consciousness in a way that allowed the influence of the Sun spirits to dominate throughout a person’s life. These plans were disrupted, creating a conflict within human nature between the influence of the Sun spirits and that of the spirits who had developed irregularly on the old Moon. Because of this conflict, humans also became unable to recognize the physical influences of the Sun; they were obscured by the earthly impressions of the outer world. Caught up in these impressions, the astral part of humans was pulled into the sphere of the ego. This ego, which would have felt only the spark of fire granted to it by the Lords of Form and which would have followed their guidance regarding anything related to external fire, now interacted with external heat phenomena through the element it had absorbed. This created a bond of attraction between the ego and the earth-fire.
In this way man became more involved in earthly materiality than had been ordained for him, which [pg 225] was effected through the earth-moon spirits in man's body. The real individual ego was thereby set free from the mere earth-ego so that although man during earth-life only partially felt himself to be an ego, he at the same time felt his earth-ego to be a continuation of that of his ancestors through the generations. The soul was conscious of a kind of “group-ego” in earth-life, dating back to remote ancestors; man felt himself to be a member of this group. Only in the disembodied state could the individual ego be conscious of itself as a separate being. But this state of isolation was impaired because the ego was still burdened with a memory of the earth-consciousness (earth-ego.) This memory clouded its vision of the spiritual world, which began to be covered as with a veil between death and birth just as it is hidden from physical vision upon earth.
In this way, people became more wrapped up in worldly materiality than was intended for them, which was brought about through the earth-moon spirits in a person’s body. The true individual self was therefore freed from the merely earthly self, so that even though during earthly life a person only partially recognized themselves as an individual, they simultaneously felt their earthly self to be a continuation of their ancestors through the generations. The soul was aware of a kind of “group self” in earthly life, reaching back to distant ancestors; individuals felt connected to this group. Only in a disembodied state could the individual self recognize itself as a separate being. However, this state of isolation was hindered because the self was still weighed down by memories of earthly consciousness (earth-self). This memory obscured its perception of the spiritual world, which began to be veiled between death and rebirth, just as it is hidden from physical sight on earth.
The many changes which took place in the spiritual world while human evolution was passing through the conditions just described, found physical expression in the gradual adjustment of the mutual relations existing between the sun, moon, and earth (and, moreover, between other celestial bodies).
The various changes that occurred in the spiritual realm while humanity was evolving through the conditions just mentioned found physical expression in the gradual adjustment of the relationships between the sun, moon, and earth (and also among other celestial bodies).
The alternation of day and night stands out as one result of those relations. (The motions of celestial bodies are regulated by the beings who inhabit them. The earth's motion, of which day and night are the result, was induced by the mutual relations of various spirits superior to man. The moon's motion had been brought about in the same way, in [pg 226] order that after the separation of the moon from the earth, the Lords of Form might, by means of the revolution of the former around the latter, work upon the human physical body in the right way, and with the right rhythm.) The ego and astral body of man now worked within the physical and etheric bodies by day; at night that activity ceased: for the ego and the astral body then left the physical and etheric bodies and came wholly within the sphere of the Sons of Life or Angels, the Sons of Fire or Archangels, the Sons of Personality, and the Lords of Form. Besides the Lords of Form, the Lords of Motion, of Wisdom and the Thrones also included the physical and etheric bodies in their sphere of influence at this time. The injurious effects produced on man by the errors of his astral body during the day, could thus be counter-balanced.
The cycle of day and night is one outcome of these connections. (The movements of celestial bodies are influenced by the beings that reside on them. The earth's motion, which causes day and night, was created through the interactions of various spirits that are greater than humanity. The moon's movement was similarly influenced so that after the moon separated from the earth, the Lords of Form could work on the human physical body in the right way and with the right rhythm through the moon's orbit around the earth.) During the day, a person's ego and astral body operate within their physical and etheric bodies; at night, this activity stops: the ego and astral body leave the physical and etheric bodies and enter fully into the realm of the Sons of Life or Angels, the Sons of Fire or Archangels, the Sons of Personality, and the Lords of Form. Along with the Lords of Form, the Lords of Motion, Wisdom, and the Thrones also included the physical and etheric bodies in their sphere of influence at this time. This way, the harmful effects caused by the astral body’s mistakes during the day could be balanced out.
As people upon Earth now again multiplied there was no reason why human souls should not incarnate in their descendants. The earth moon-forces now acted in such a way that under their influence the human bodies became entirely capable of incarnating human souls. The souls who had previously removed to Mars, Jupiter and the other planets were now guided to earth, and there was thus a soul ready for each human being born in the physical line of descent. This went on through long periods so that the immigration of souls to earth corresponded to the increase of human beings. Souls now leaving their bodies at physical death retained the echo of their earthly individuality as a memory [pg 227] in the disembodied state. This memory acted in such a way that whenever a body was born on earth suitable for them, they again incarnated it. Consequently there were among the human descendants some whose souls came from without and who appeared on earth for the first time since its very earliest periods, and there were others whose souls had continually incarnated on the earth. In subsequent periods of earthly evolution the number of young souls appearing for the first time grows ever smaller and smaller, and the reincarnated souls become more and more numerous; yet for long ages the human race was composed of the two types of beings conditioned by these facts.
As people on Earth continued to multiply, there was no reason why human souls couldn't take on new lives in their descendants. The forces from the moon were now functioning in such a way that, under their influence, human bodies became fully capable of housing human souls. The souls that had previously moved to Mars, Jupiter, and the other planets were now being drawn back to Earth, meaning there was a soul ready for every human being being born in the physical lineage. This process continued for long periods, so the influx of souls to Earth matched the growing population of humans. Souls leaving their bodies at physical death retained a memory of their earthly individuality in the disembodied state. This memory worked so that whenever a suitable body was born on Earth, they would incarnate again. As a result, there were among the human descendants some whose souls came from elsewhere and who appeared on Earth for the first time since its earliest days, while others had continuously incarnated on Earth. As time went on, the number of young souls appearing for the first time became smaller and smaller, and the reincarnated souls became increasingly numerous; yet for long ages, the human race consisted of these two types of beings shaped by these circumstances.
Henceforth man on earth felt himself united with his forefathers through the group-ego which he had in common with them. On the other hand, the experience of the individual ego was all the stronger in the disembodied state between death and a new birth. The souls which entered human bodies from celestial space were in a different position from those which had one or more earthly lives behind them. The former, as souls entering upon the physical earth-life, brought with them only the conditions to which the higher spiritual world and their experiences outside the sphere of earth had subjected them. The others had, by their actions in former lives, added conditions of their own. The fate of the first was determined only by facts lying outside of the new earth-conditions; that of the reincarnate souls [pg 228] is also determined by what they themselves have done in former lives under earthly conditions. Individual human Karma makes its first appearance simultaneously with reincarnation.
From now on, humans on Earth felt connected to their ancestors through a shared group identity. On the flip side, the sense of individual identity was even stronger in the disembodied state between death and rebirth. The souls that entered human bodies from the celestial realm were in a different situation compared to those who had one or more earthly lives behind them. The former, as souls starting their physical life on Earth, brought with them only the influences of the higher spiritual world and their experiences beyond Earth. The latter had, through their actions in previous lives, created their own influences. The fate of the first group was determined solely by circumstances beyond the new earthly conditions, while the fate of the reincarnated souls is also shaped by what they had done in past lives under earthly conditions. Individual human karma first emerges at the same time as reincarnation.
Because the human etheric body was withdrawn from the influence of the astral body in the manner above indicated, the generative faculty was not included in the sphere of human consciousness, but was under the sway of the spiritual world. When the time had come for a soul to descend to earth, procreative impulses arose in the human being. The entire process, to a certain degree was veiled in mysterious obscurity as far as earthly consciousness was concerned. The consequences of this partial separation of the etheric from the physical body were felt during earthly life also. The qualities of the etheric body were capable of being especially heightened by spiritual influence. In the life of the soul this expressed itself through a special perfection of memory. Independent logical thought was at this period only in its most rudimentary stage in man; on the other hand, the faculty of memory was almost unlimited. Externally it appeared as though man had direct knowledge of the working forces of every living being. He had at his disposal the vital and generative forces of the animal and, more especially, of the vegetable kingdom. He was able, for instance, to draw out of a plant the force which impels it to grow, and to use that force, just as we now use the forces of inanimate nature; for example, [pg 229] the power dormant in coal which is extricated and used for propelling engines.22
Because the human etheric body was separated from the influence of the astral body as described earlier, the ability to reproduce wasn't part of human awareness but was under the influence of the spiritual world. When it was time for a soul to come to earth, procreative urges emerged in humans. This entire process was somewhat shrouded in mystery when it came to earthly consciousness. The effects of this partial separation between the etheric and physical body were also felt during earthly life. The qualities of the etheric body could be especially enhanced by spiritual influence. In the soul’s life, this manifested as an extraordinary memory. Independent logical thought was still in its early stages for humans at this time; however, the ability to remember was nearly limitless. On the surface, it seemed as though humans had direct knowledge of the forces at work in every living being. They could access the vital and reproductive energies of the animal kingdom and especially the plant kingdom. For example, they could extract the force that drives a plant to grow and use that energy, similar to how we now harness the forces of inanimate nature; for instance, the energy stored in coal that is released to power engines. [pg 229]
The inner soul life of man was also transformed in many different ways by the Lucifer influence. Many kinds of feelings and emotions due to it might be instanced. Of these only one can be mentioned. Previous to this influence, the human soul acted, in that which it had to shape and to do, according to the purposes of higher spiritual beings. The plan of everything that was to be carried out was determined from the beginning. And in proportion to the degree to which human consciousness was evolved, it was able to foresee how things must develop in the future in accordance with that preconceived plan. That consciousness of the future was lost when the veil of earthly perceptions was woven across the manifestations of higher spiritual beings and in these the real forces of the Sun-spirits were hidden. Henceforth the future became uncertain, and in consequence of this the possibility of fear was implanted in the soul. Fear is a direct result of error.
The inner life of a person was also transformed in many ways by the influence of Lucifer. There are many feelings and emotions that could be mentioned because of it, but only one will be noted here. Before this influence, the human soul acted in shaping and doing things according to the intentions of higher spiritual beings. The plan for everything that was to be carried out was set from the start. As human consciousness evolved, it was able to anticipate how things would develop in the future based on that initial plan. However, that awareness of the future was lost when earthly perceptions obscured the manifestations of higher spiritual beings, hiding the true forces of the Sun-spirits. From that point on, the future became uncertain, and as a result, the possibility of fear was instilled in the soul. Fear is a direct result of error.
It is however evident that through the Luciferian influence, man became independent of certain definite forces to which he had previously submitted without the exercise of his will. Henceforth he was able to form resolutions of his own. Freedom is the result of the Luciferian influence, and fear and [pg 230] similar feelings are only the phenomena attendant on the evolution of human freedom.
It is clear that due to the influence of Lucifer, humans became independent from certain specific forces that they had previously submitted to without exercising their will. From that point on, they were able to make their own decisions. Freedom is a result of this Luciferian influence, while fear and similar emotions are just the side effects of the development of human freedom. [pg 230]
Spiritually seen, fear makes its appearance in this way. Within the earth-forces, under whose influence man had come by means of the Luciferian powers, other beings were operating, which had developed irregularly much earlier in the course of evolution than the Luciferian powers. With the earth-forces man admitted into his nature the influence of these other beings. They gave the quality of fear to feelings, which without them would have operated quite differently. They may be called Ahrimanic beings. They are the same that Goethe calls Mephistophelian.
Spiritually speaking, fear shows up in this way. Within the earth forces, which man encountered through the influence of the Luciferian powers, there were other beings at work—ones that had developed in a much more irregular way much earlier in evolution than the Luciferian powers. By connecting with the earth forces, man also allowed the influence of these other beings into his nature. They infused feelings with the quality of fear, which would have been experienced quite differently without them. These beings can be referred to as Ahrimanic beings. They are the same ones that Goethe refers to as Mephistophelian.
Although the Luciferian influence manifested itself at first only in the most advanced individuals, it soon spread to others. The descendants of the advanced individuals intermingled with the less progressive described above, and in this way the Luciferian force was conveyed to the latter. But the etheric body of these souls returning from the different planets could not be protected to the same extent as that of the descendants of those who remained on earth. The protection of the etheric body of these descendants emanated from an exalted Being in Whom was vested the leadership of the cosmic when the separation of the sun from the earth took place. That Being is the Ruler of the Kingdom of the Sun. With him those lofty spirits, whose cosmic development was sufficiently matured, departed for their dwelling-place in the Sun. But there were [pg 231] other beings who had not reached such a height at the separation of the sun; these were obliged to seek other spheres. It was through their instrumentality that Jupiter and other planets became detached from that general cosmic substance of which, at the outset, the earthly physical organism consisted. Jupiter now became the abode of those beings who were not highly enough developed to live on the sun, and the most advanced of these became the leader. As the Leader of the Sun evolution became the “higher ego” which worked in the etheric body of the descendants of those who had remained on earth, so the Jupiter leader became that “higher ego” which manifested as a common consciousness in certain other human beings. Those were the human beings descending from the intermixing of those who had only appeared on earth at the time of the air-element and had gone over to Jupiter. These human beings may be called, in conformity with occult science, “Jupiter-humanity.” They were scions of the human race which had adopted human souls far back in that ancient time; but who, at the beginning of earthly evolution, were not yet mature enough to take part in the first contact with fire. They were souls midway between the human and animal soul-kingdoms.
Although the influence of Lucifer first showed up only in the most advanced individuals, it quickly spread to others. The descendants of these advanced individuals mixed with the less progressive ones mentioned earlier, and in this way, the Luciferian force was passed on to them. However, the etheric bodies of those souls returning from different planets couldn't be protected to the same extent as those of the descendants of those who stayed on Earth. The protection of the etheric body of these descendants came from a high Being who held leadership of the cosmos at the time of the separation of the sun from the Earth. That Being is the Ruler of the Kingdom of the Sun. Along with Him, those elevated spirits whose cosmic development was sufficiently advanced departed for their home in the Sun. But there were other beings who hadn't reached such a level at the time of the separation; they had to seek other realms. It was through them that Jupiter and other planets became separated from the general cosmic matter that, at the beginning, made up the earthly physical organism. Jupiter then became the home of those beings who weren't developed enough to live on the Sun, and the most advanced among them took on leadership. Just as the Leader of the Sun's evolution became the “higher ego” that operated in the etheric body of the descendants of those who remained on Earth, the Jupiter leader became that “higher ego” which expressed itself as a shared consciousness in certain other human beings. These were the humans descending from the mixing of those who had only appeared on Earth during the time of the air element and had moved over to Jupiter. These humans can be referred to, according to occult science, as “Jupiter-humanity.” They were descendants of the human race that had integrated human souls long ago; however, at the start of Earth's evolution, they were not yet mature enough to participate in the first contact with fire. They were souls caught between the human and animal soul kingdoms.
Now there were other beings who, under the leadership of the greatest one among them had detached Mars from the general cosmic substance, to make it their dwelling place. Under their influence there [pg 232] arose a third kind of humanity, formed by interbreeding,—the “Mars-humanity.” (This knowledge throws light upon the origin of the formation of the planets of our solar system; for all the members of that system originated through the various stages of maturity reached by the beings inhabiting them. But of course it is not possible to enter into all the details of cosmic differentiation here.) Those people who felt in their etheric body the influence of the exalted Sun-being Himself may be called “Sun-humanity.” The Being Who lived in them as the Higher Ego—of course only in the race, not in the individual,—is the same to Whom various names were given in later times, when man had gained conscious knowledge of Him. It is he Who appears to the human race today as the Christ.
Now there were other beings who, led by the greatest among them, had separated Mars from the general cosmic substance to make it their home. Under their influence, there arose a third kind of humanity, formed through interbreeding,—the “Mars-humanity.” (This knowledge sheds light on how the planets in our solar system were formed; all the members of that system developed through the various stages of maturity reached by the beings inhabiting them. However, it's not possible to go into all the details of cosmic differentiation here.) Those people who felt the influence of the exalted Sun-being within their etheric body can be called “Sun-humanity.” The Being who lived within them as the Higher Ego—of course only in the race, not in the individual—is the same Being to whom various names were given later, as humans gained conscious knowledge of Him. He appears to the human race today as the Christ.
“Saturn-humanity” is also to be distinguished at that time. The “higher ego” of this race appeared as a being who, with his associates, had been forced to leave the general cosmic substance before the separation of the Sun. In these individuals not only the etheric body but also the physical body was partly exempt from the Luciferian influence. But the etheric body was nevertheless not well enough protected in the less developed races of mankind to be able to sufficiently resist the influences of the Luciferian beings. These individuals could arbitrarily use the spark of the ego within them to such a degree that they were able to call forth mighty and destructive effects of fire around them. The result was a mighty terrestrial catastrophe. A large part of [pg 233] the inhabited earth was wrecked by fiery storms, and with it the human beings that had fallen into sin. Only a very small part of those who had remained untouched by sin, were able to take refuge in a region which had so far been shielded from the fatal human influence.
"Saturn-humanity" should also be distinguished during that time. The "superior ego" of this race emerged as a being who, along with his companions, had to leave the general cosmic substance before the separation of the Sun. In these individuals, not only was the etheric body partly free from Luciferian influence, but their physical bodies were also somewhat protected. However, the etheric bodies of the less developed human races were not sufficiently shielded to resist the influences of the Luciferian beings. These individuals could freely use the spark of the ego within them to such an extent that they were capable of creating powerful and destructive fires around them. The outcome was a significant terrestrial catastrophe. A large portion of the inhabited earth was devastated by fiery storms, and so were the human beings who had fallen into sin. Only a very small number of those who remained untouched by sin were able to find refuge in a region that had so far been protected from the deadly human influence.
The country occupying that part of the earth now covered by the Atlantic Ocean proved to be peculiarly well fitted for the abode of the new human race. Thither that part of humanity repaired which had preserved purity. Only stray groups of humanity inhabited other regions. Occult science gives the name of “Atlantis” to that part of the earth which once existed between the present continents of Europe, Africa, and America. (This particular stage of human evolution has its special nomenclature in theosophical literature. The period preceding the Atlantean is called the Lemurian age, whereas that during which the Moon-forces had not yet fully developed is called the Hyperborean age. This is preceded by yet another, which coincides with the earliest period of the evolution of the physical earth. Biblical tradition describes the period before the influence of the Lucifer-beings came into play as the Paradise time, and the descent to earth, or entanglement of humanity in the sense-world, as the expulsion from Paradise.)
The country that now lies beneath the Atlantic Ocean was particularly well-suited for the new human race. It was here that the part of humanity that had maintained its purity gathered. Only small groups of people lived in other areas. Occult science refers to that part of the earth that once existed between the present continents of Europe, Africa, and America as “Atlantis”. (This specific stage of human evolution has its own terminology in theosophical literature. The time before the Atlantean period is called the Lemurian age, while the time when the Moon-forces had not yet fully developed is known as the Hyperborean age. This is preceded by another phase that aligns with the earliest period of the physical earth's evolution. Biblical tradition describes the time before the influence of the Lucifer-beings as the Paradise time, and the descent to earth or the entanglement of humanity in the material world as the expulsion from Paradise.)
The Atlantean period of evolution was the real time of separation into the Saturn, Sun, Jupiter, and Mars humanities. Up to that time only predispositions for this separation had been developed. The [pg 234] division between the state of waking and sleeping had special consequences, which appeared particularly in the Atlantean race. During the night the human astral body and ego were in the sphere of the beings superior to man, as far up as the Sons of Personality. Man could perceive the Sons of Life (the Angels) and the Sons of Fire (the Archangels) through that part of his etheric body which was not united with the physical body. For he was able to remain united, during sleep, with that part of his etheric body which was not interpenetrated by the physical body. It is true, his perception of the Sons of Personality was vague, owing to the Luciferian influence; but not only the Angels and Archangels became visible to man in this condition but also those beings who were not able to enter upon earthly existence because they had lagged behind on the Sun or Moon, and were therefore obliged to remain in the psycho-spiritual world. But man, by means of the Luciferian influence, drew them into his soul which was separated from his physical body during sleep. Thus he came in contact with beings whose influence was highly corrupting. They increased in his soul the propensity for error; especially the tendency to misuse the powers of growth and reproduction, which since the separation of the physical and etheric bodies were now under his control.
The Atlantean period of evolution was the actual time of division into the Saturn, Sun, Jupiter, and Mars humanities. Until then, only the groundwork for this separation had been laid. The division between waking and sleeping states had specific consequences, particularly evident in the Atlantean race. At night, the human astral body and ego existed in the realm of beings that were superior to humans, reaching up to the Sons of Personality. Humans could perceive the Sons of Life (the Angels) and the Sons of Fire (the Archangels) through the part of their etheric body that wasn't connected to the physical body. This allowed them to stay connected, during sleep, with the part of their etheric body that wasn't intertwined with the physical body. It's true that their perception of the Sons of Personality was blurry due to the Luciferian influence; however, not only did Angels and Archangels become visible in this state, but also beings who were unable to enter earthly existence because they had fallen behind on the Sun or Moon, thus forced to remain in the psycho-spiritual world. Through the influence of Lucifer, humans drew these beings into their souls, which had detached from their physical bodies during sleep. As a result, they engaged with beings whose influence was deeply corrupting. These beings increased the inclination for error in their souls, particularly the tendency to misuse the powers of growth and reproduction, which had now fallen under their control since the separation of the physical and etheric bodies.
Certain human beings of the Atlantean period however became entangled in the sense world only to a very limited degree. Through them, [pg 235] the Luciferian influence became, instead of a hindrance to human evolution, a means of further progress. It enabled them to develop knowledge of earthly matters sooner than would otherwise have been possible. They sought to expel error from their imaginative life and to interpret, by means of cosmic phenomena, the original purposes of spiritual beings. They kept themselves free from those impulses and desires of the astral body which were directed merely toward the sense-world. Hence they became more and more free from the errors of the astral body. This resulted in a condition through which they were able to confine their perceptions to that part of the etheric body which was separated from the physical body in the manner described above. Under these conditions the capacity of the physical body for perception was practically extinguished and the physical body itself was as though dead. For through the etheric body, these individuals were wholly united with the kingdom of the Lords of Form, and were able to learn from them how they were being guided and directed by that exalted Being the “Christ,” who was the Leader at the time of the separation of sun and earth. These people were Initiates. But since human individuality had been brought into the sphere of the Moon-beings, as described above, these Initiates could not as a rule come into direct contact with the Christ-Being, they could only see it as a reflection, shown them by the Moon-beings. Thus they did not see the Christ-Being directly, but only the reflection of its glory.
Certain people from the Atlantean period became involved with the physical world only to a very limited extent. Through them, [pg 235] the Luciferian influence became, instead of a barrier to human growth, a means of further advancement. It allowed them to gain understanding of earthly matters sooner than would normally have been possible. They aimed to eliminate falsehood from their imaginative lives and to interpret, through cosmic phenomena, the original intentions of spiritual beings. They distanced themselves from those impulses and desires of the astral body that were focused solely on the physical world. As a result, they became increasingly free from the errors of the astral body. This led to a state in which they could limit their perceptions to that part of the etheric body which was separate from the physical body in the way described above. Under these conditions, the physical body's ability to perceive was nearly extinguished, and the physical body itself was as if it were dead. Through the etheric body, these individuals were completely connected with the realm of the Lords of Form and were able to learn from them how they were being guided and directed by that exalted Being, the "Jesus," who was the Leader at the time of the separation of sun and earth. These individuals were Initiates. However, since human individuality had been brought into the domain of the Moon-beings, as described earlier, these Initiates could not typically come into direct contact with the Christ-Being; they could only perceive it as a reflection shown to them by the Moon-beings. Thus, they did not see the Christ-Being directly, but only the reflection of its glory.
They became leaders of the rest of humanity, to whom they were able to impart the mysteries they had seen. They attracted disciples, to whom they communicated the methods for attaining the condition which leads to Initiation. Only those could attain knowledge of the Christ who belonged to the Sun-humanity mentioned above. They cultivated their mystic learning, and the occupations which promoted it, at a particular spot which, in occult science terminology may be called the Christ oracle, or Sun oracle, the term “oracle” being used to denote a place where the purposes of spiritual beings are unveiled.
They became leaders of humanity, sharing the mysteries they had encountered. They gathered disciples and taught them the methods for achieving the state that leads to Initiation. Only those who belonged to the Sun-humanity mentioned earlier could gain knowledge of Christ. They nurtured their mystical learning and the activities that supported it in a specific location, which in occult terminology is referred to as the Christ oracle or Sun oracle, with the term “Oracle” used to signify a place where the intentions of spiritual beings are revealed.
Other oracles were called into being by the members of the Saturn, Mars, and Jupiter humanities. The intuitive vision of their Initiates was confined to seeing those beings who were revealed to them in their etheric bodies as their respective “higher egos.” Thus adherents of the Saturn, Jupiter, and Mars wisdom arose. Besides these methods of Initiation, there were others for those who had assimilated too much of the Luciferian spirit to allow as large a part of the etheric body to be separated from the physical body as was the case with the Sun humanity. Nor could they be brought to the revelation of the Christ through these conditions. Because their astral body was more influenced by the Lucifer principle, they were obliged to undergo a more difficult preparation, and then, in a less disembodied state than the others, they were able to receive [pg 237] the revelation, not indeed of the Christ Himself, but of other exalted beings.
Other oracles were created by the members of the Saturn, Mars, and Jupiter groups. The intuitive insight of their Initiates was limited to seeing the beings that were shown to them in their etheric bodies as their respective "big egos." This led to the emergence of followers of the Saturn, Jupiter, and Mars wisdom. In addition to these initiation methods, there were others for those who had absorbed too much of the Luciferian spirit to allow as great a separation of the etheric body from the physical body as was the case with the Sun group. They could also not experience the revelation of the Christ under these conditions. Because their astral body was more influenced by the Lucifer principle, they had to go through a more challenging preparation, and then, in a less disembodied state than the others, they were able to receive [pg 237] the revelation, not of the Christ Himself, but of other elevated beings.
There were beings who, although they had left the earth at the separation of the sun, did not stand on such a high level that they were able to continue taking part in the Sun evolution. They formed an abode for themselves away from the sun, after its separation from the earth: this was Venus. Their leader was the being who now became a “higher ego” to these Initiates and their adherents. A similar thing happened with the leading spirit of Mercury for another group of people. In this way the Venus and Mercury oracles arose. One kind of human beings, who had most completely absorbed the Luciferian influence, could reach only one of the higher beings who, with his associates, had been the first to be expelled from the Sun evolution. This being has no particular planet in cosmic space, but still lives within the periphery of the earth, with which he was once more united after the return from the sun. The group of people, to whom this being was revealed as its “higher ego” may be called the followers of the Vulcan oracle. Their attention was more directed to earthly phenomena than that of the other Initiates. They laid the first foundations of what afterwards became the human arts and sciences. On the other hand, the Mercury Initiates established the study of the more super-sensible things; and the Venus Initiates did this to a still greater extent.
There were beings who, despite leaving the Earth when the Sun separated, weren't at a high enough level to keep participating in the Sun's evolution. They created a home for themselves away from the Sun after it separated from the Earth: this was Venus. Their leader became a “greater self” for these Initiates and their followers. A similar situation occurred with the leading spirit of Mercury for another group of people. This led to the emergence of the Venus and Mercury oracles. One group of humans, who had most fully embraced the Luciferian influence, could only connect with one of the higher beings who, along with his companions, was the first to be cast out from the Sun's evolution. This being doesn't have a specific planet in cosmic space but still resides within the Earth's periphery, having been reunited with it after returning from the Sun. The group of people who recognized this being as their “inflated ego” can be called the followers of the Vulcan oracle. Their focus was more on earthly phenomena than that of the other Initiates. They laid the groundwork for what would later become human arts and sciences. Conversely, the Mercury Initiates pursued the study of more spiritual matters, while the Venus Initiates went even further in this direction.
The Vulcan, Mercury, and Venus Initiates differed [pg 238] from those of Saturn, Jupiter, and Mars in the manner of receiving their Mysteries; the latter received them more as a revelation from above, and in a more finished state; whereas the former gained their knowledge more in the form of their own thoughts—in the form of ideas. The Christ Initiates occupied a middle position. While having a direct revelation, they acquired the capacity for clothing their Mysteries in a human form of conception. The Saturn, Jupiter, and Mars Initiates were obliged to express themselves more in symbols; the Christ, Venus, Mercury, and Vulcan Initiates were able to impart their knowledge more through ideas or concepts.
The Vulcan, Mercury, and Venus Initiates were different [pg 238] from those of Saturn, Jupiter, and Mars in how they received their Mysteries; the latter received them more as a revelation from above, and in a more complete state; whereas the former gained their knowledge more through their own thoughts—in the form of ideas. The Christ Initiates were in a middle position. While having a direct revelation, they developed the ability to express their Mysteries in a way that was relatable to humans. The Saturn, Jupiter, and Mars Initiates had to express themselves more through symbols; the Christ, Venus, Mercury, and Vulcan Initiates could share their knowledge more through ideas or concepts.
Whatever knowledge of this kind reached Atlantean humanity came indirectly through the Initiates. But the rest of mankind also received special faculties through the Lucifer principle; for, through the intervention of lofty cosmic beings, what otherwise might have wrought ruin was transformed into good. One of these faculties was that of speech. This was brought about by the condensation of man's physical body and by the separation of part of his etheric from his physical body. For some time after the separations of the moon, man felt himself connected with his physical ancestors through the group-ego. But this common consciousness, linking posterity with its ancestors, was gradually lost in the course of generations. Later descendants had an inner memory of only their more recent ancestors, no longer of their earlier forefathers. [pg 239] It was only in conditions akin to sleep, during which mankind came in contact with the spiritual world, that the remembrance of one ancestor or another again emerged. Then people thought of themselves as one with that ancestor whom they believed to be reappearing in them. This was an erroneous idea of reincarnation, which arose especially in the later Atlantean period. The true doctrine of reincarnation could be learned only in the schools of the Initiates. They could see how the human soul passes through the disembodied state on its way from one incarnation to another, and they alone were able to impart the real truth of the matter to their disciples.
The knowledge that reached the people of Atlantis came indirectly through the Initiates. However, the rest of humanity also gained unique abilities through the Lucifer principle; elevated cosmic beings turned what could have caused destruction into something beneficial. One of these abilities was speech. This emerged from the densification of the human body and the separation of part of the etheric body from the physical body. For a while after the moon's separations, people felt a connection to their physical ancestors through the group-ego. But over generations, this shared awareness, linking descendants to their ancestors, gradually faded. Later generations only remembered their more recent ancestors, losing touch with their earlier forefathers. It was only during sleep-like states, when humanity connected with the spiritual world, that the memory of an ancestor would occasionally surface. In those moments, people thought of themselves as being one with that ancestor, believing they were reappearing within them. This was a mistaken idea of reincarnation, which became more common in the later Atlantean period. The true understanding of reincarnation could only be learned in the Initiates' schools. They could see how the human soul transitions through the disembodied state between incarnations, and they were the only ones able to share this real truth with their students. [pg 239]
In the remote past which is now under consideration, man's physical form was very different from his present form. It was still, to a great extent, the expression of the qualities of his soul. Man was composed of a softer and more delicate substance than that which he has since acquired. That which is now solidified in the limbs was then soft, flexible, and plastic. The bodily structure of the more psychic and spiritual human beings was delicate, supple, and expressive. These less evolved spiritually possessed coarser, heavier, less mobile bodily structures. A high degree of psychic maturity contracted the extremities, and the Stature remained small; backwardness of the soul and entanglement in sensuality were outwardly expressed by gigantic size. While man was growing to maturity his body was being formed in accordance with what was developing [pg 240] in his soul, in a way which would appear incredible and fabulous to contemporary ideas. Depraved passions, impulses, and instincts brought in their train a colossal increase of matter. Man's present physical form has come about through a contraction, thickening, and consolidation of the Atlantean human form. And whereas man, before the Atlantean period, had been an exact image of his soul-nature the events of the Atlantean evolution bore within them the causes which lead to the formation of post-Atlantean man, whose physical form is solid and comparatively independent of the qualities of the soul. (The forms of the animal kingdom had solidified during far more remote Earth periods than those of man.) The laws now governing the shaping of forms in the kingdom of nature certainly did not prevail in the remote past.
In the distant past we’re discussing, the human body looked very different from how it does now. It still largely reflected the qualities of the soul. People had a softer and more delicate composition compared to what they have today. What is now solid in our limbs was once soft, flexible, and pliable. The physiques of the more spiritually developed humans were gentle, graceful, and expressive, while those who were less spiritually advanced had coarser, heavier, and less agile bodies. A higher level of spiritual maturity resulted in smaller extremities and a shorter stature, while spiritual backwardness and a preoccupation with physical desires were shown through larger sizes. As a person matured, their body formed in harmony with the development occurring in their soul, in a way that would seem unbelievable now. Corrupt passions, urges, and instincts led to a massive increase in physical matter. The current physical form of humans developed through a process of contraction, thickening, and solidification of the Atlantean human shape. While humans before the Atlantean period perfectly mirrored their soul nature, the events of Atlantean evolution created the conditions that led to the formation of post-Atlantean humans, whose physical bodies are solid and relatively independent of their soul qualities. (The forms of animals had already become solid in far earlier periods of Earth’s history than those of humans.) The laws that now govern how forms are shaped in the natural world certainly did not exist in that far-off past.
Toward the middle of the Atlantean evolution a calamity gradually befell humanity. The Mysteries of the Initiates had to be carefully kept secret from those who had not purified their astral bodies from sin. Had they gained insight into that hidden knowledge, into the laws by means of which higher beings directed the forces of nature, they would have employed those forces thus placed at their disposal for their own perverted needs and passions. The danger was all the greater because mankind was coming, as has been described, into the sphere of lower spiritual beings, who could not take part in the regular evolution of the earth and were therefore working against it. These persistently [pg 241] influenced humanity in such a way as to instil into it interests which were actually directed against human welfare. But mankind still had the power to employ the forces of growth and reproduction belonging to animal and human nature in their own service.
Toward the middle of Atlantean evolution, a disaster gradually struck humanity. The secrets of the Initiates had to be carefully kept hidden from those who had not purified their astral bodies from sin. If they had gained access to that hidden knowledge, to the laws by which higher beings directed the forces of nature, they would have used those forces for their own twisted desires and needs. The threat was even greater because humanity was entering a realm of lower spiritual beings, who could not participate in the Earth’s normal evolution and were therefore working against it. These beings consistently influenced humanity in ways that instilled interests which were actually detrimental to human welfare. However, humanity still had the ability to use the forces of growth and reproduction inherent in animal and human nature for their own benefit.
Not only humanity in general, but even some of the Initiates yielded to temptation from low spiritual beings. They were induced to employ the supersensible forces mentioned above for a purpose which ran counter to human evolution. And for this purpose they sought out associates who were not initiated, and who made use of the secrets of the supersensible forces of nature for low ends. The result was a great corruption of human nature. The evil spread further and further; and since the forces of growth and generation, if torn from their original sphere and used independently, have a mysterious connection with certain forces working in air and water, there were thus unchained, through human action, mighty, destructive natural forces which led to the gradual ruin of the Atlantean territory by the agency of air and water catastrophes. Atlantean humanity was obliged to migrate—i. e., that portion of it which did not perish in the storms.
Not only humanity as a whole, but even some of the Initiates, fell for the temptations of lower spiritual beings. They were led to use the higher spiritual forces mentioned earlier for purposes that went against human evolution. For this, they looked for partners who weren’t initiated and who exploited the secrets of these higher forces in a selfish manner. This resulted in a significant corruption of human nature. The evil spread more and more; and since the forces of growth and reproduction, when removed from their original context and used independently, have a mysterious connection to certain forces in air and water, powerful destructive natural forces were unleashed through human actions. This ultimately led to the gradual destruction of the Atlantean territory due to disasters involving air and water. Atlantean humanity was forced to migrate—meaning that part of it that survived the storms.
In consequence of these storms the surface of the earth was altered. On one side, Europe, Asia, and Africa gradually assumed their present shape; on the other, America appeared. Great migrations took place to these countries. Those migrations which were directed eastward from Atlantis are especially [pg 242] important for us of today. Europe, Asia, and Africa were gradually colonized by the descendants of the Atlanteans. Various peoples fixed their abode in these continents. They were at different stages of development, and also at different levels of corruption. And with them came the Initiates, guardians of the oracle-Mysteries. They established sanctuaries in various parts, in which the cults of Jupiter, Venus, etc., were cultivated sometimes in a good, sometimes in an evil manner. The betrayal of the Vulcan Mysteries exercised an especially unfavourable influence, for the attention of their adherents was mostly centered on earthly matters. By this betrayal, mankind was made dependent on spiritual beings who, as a result of their past evolution, rejected everything emanating from the spiritual world which had been evolved through the separation of the earth from the sun. In accordance with the tendency they had thus developed, they worked upon just that element in man which was formed through his having perceptions of the sense-world, behind which the spiritual world lies hidden. Henceforth beings acquired great influence over many of the human inhabitants of the earth, and indeed their influence asserted itself more and more by depriving mankind of the feeling for spiritual things.
As a result of these storms, the surface of the earth changed. On one side, Europe, Asia, and Africa slowly took on their current shapes; on the other, America emerged. There were significant migrations to these lands. The migrations heading eastward from Atlantis are particularly important for us today. The descendants of the Atlanteans gradually colonized Europe, Asia, and Africa. Various peoples settled in these continents, each at different stages of development and levels of corruption. Along with them came the Initiates, the guardians of the oracle-Mysteries. They established sanctuaries in various locations, where the worship of Jupiter, Venus, and others was practiced, sometimes positively and sometimes negatively. The betrayal of the Vulcan Mysteries had a particularly negative impact, as the focus of their followers was mostly on worldly matters. This betrayal caused humanity to become dependent on spiritual beings that, due to their past evolution, rejected everything from the spiritual world that had emerged from the separation of the earth from the sun. Consistent with the tendencies they developed, they influenced that aspect of humanity formed through perceptions of the material world, behind which the spiritual world remains concealed. From that point on, these beings gained increasing influence over many people on earth, and their influence continued to grow by diminishing humanity's connection to spiritual matters.
Since the size, form, and flexibility of the physical human body were still largely affected by the qualities of the soul, the consequence of the betrayal of the Mysteries also appeared in changes of the human race in these respects. Wherever the corruption of [pg 243] humanity manifested itself especially in the abuse of supersensible powers for the satisfaction of lower inclinations, desires and passions, unsightly human shapes, grotesque in form and size were the result. These were not able to survive the Atlantean period, and became extinct. Post-Atlantean humanity was formed physically from those Atlantean ancestors in whom such a solidification of the bodily form had taken place that it no longer yielded to those powers of the soul which had now become perverted.
Since the size, shape, and flexibility of the physical human body were still mostly influenced by the qualities of the soul, the betrayal of the Mysteries also led to changes in humanity in these aspects. Wherever the corruption of humanity showed itself, especially through the misuse of spiritual powers for fulfilling base inclinations, desires, and passions, it resulted in unattractive human forms that were grotesque in shape and size. These could not survive the Atlantean period and became extinct. Post-Atlantean humanity was physically developed from those Atlantean ancestors who had undergone such a solidification of the body that it no longer responded to those powers of the soul that had now become distorted.
There was a certain period in the Atlantean evolution during which, by means of the law ruling in and around the earth, just those conditions prevailed which tended to solidify man's bodily form. Those human racial types which had been solidified before this period could, it is true, reproduce themselves for a long time, yet the souls incarnating in them gradually became so cramped that they had to die out. It is true that some of these race-types survived into the post-Atlantean times; those which had remained sufficiently agile lasted even for a very long time in modified form. Human forms which had remained flexible, after the period just described, became bodies for such souls as had, in a large measure, undergone the pernicious influence of the betrayal described above. These forms were destined to speedy extinction.
There was a specific time in Atlantean history when the natural laws governing the earth created conditions that helped to solidify human physical forms. Although the human racial types that had already become solidified before this time could still reproduce for quite a while, the souls entering these bodies gradually became so restricted that they eventually had to die out. Some of these racial types did persist into post-Atlantean times; those that remained flexible lasted for a long time, albeit in altered forms. The human shapes that stayed adaptable after this described period became homes for souls that had largely been affected by the harmful influence mentioned earlier. These forms were fated to disappear quickly.
In consequence of what had thus happened, beings had brought their influence to bear upon human evolution, since the middle of the Atlantean period, beings whose influence tended to make mankind live [pg 244] in the physical sense world in an unspiritual manner. This went so far that, instead of man's seeing the real form of that world, phantoms, hallucinations, and illusions of every kind appeared to him. Mankind was exposed not merely to the Luciferian influence but to that of those other beings mentioned above, whose leader may be called Ahriman, according to the appellation given him later in the Persian civilization. (He is the same as Mephistopheles.) Through this influence man was subject, after death, to powers which made him appear even then as a being adhering only to material earthly conditions. He lost more and more the unobstructed vision of the events of the spiritual world. He was forced to feel himself in Ahriman's power, and to a certain extent shut out from intercourse with the spiritual world.
As a result of what had happened, beings influenced human evolution since the middle of the Atlantean period, beings whose impact caused humanity to live in the physical world in an unspiritual way. This went so far that, instead of seeing the true nature of that world, people encountered phantoms, hallucinations, and illusions of all kinds. Mankind was not only exposed to Luciferian influence but also to that of other beings mentioned earlier, whose leader is known as Ahriman, a name given to him later in Persian civilization. (He is the same as Mephistopheles.) Through this influence, after death, humans were subjected to powers that caused them to appear as beings solely tied to material earthly conditions. They increasingly lost the clear vision of the events in the spiritual world. They were compelled to feel themselves under Ahriman's control and, to some extent, isolated from contact with the spiritual world.
There was one oracle-sanctuary of special importance, which in the universal decline had preserved the ancient cult in its purest form. It was one of the Christ oracles, and on that account it was able to preserve not only the Christ Mystery itself but those of the other oracles as well. For in the manifestation of the loftiest of the Sun-spirits, were also revealed the regents of Saturn, Jupiter, and the other planets. In the Sun oracle the secret of producing in some particular human being, such human etheric bodies as had been possessed by the best of the Jupiter, Mercury, and other Initiates was known. By means of the methods used for this purpose, which cannot be further dealt with here, impressions [pg 245] of the best etheric bodies of the ancient Initiates were preserved, in order that they might subsequently be stamped upon suitable individuals. The same process could be employed with the astral bodies of the Venus, Mercury, and Vulcan Initiates.
There was one oracle sanctuary of special significance, which, despite the general decline, had maintained the ancient cult in its purest form. It was one of the Christ oracles, and for that reason, it was able to keep alive not only the Christ Mystery itself but also those of the other oracles. In the manifestation of the highest of the Sun-spirits, the rulers of Saturn, Jupiter, and the other planets were also revealed. In the Sun oracle, the secret of creating specific human etheric bodies, similar to those possessed by the greatest of the Jupiter, Mercury, and other Initiates, was known. Through the methods used for this purpose, which won't be explained further here, impressions of the best etheric bodies of the ancient Initiates were preserved so that they could later be imprinted on suitable individuals. The same process could be applied to the astral bodies of the Venus, Mercury, and Vulcan Initiates.
At a certain time the Leader of the Christ Initiates found Himself isolated with a few associates, to whom He was able to impart, to a very limited extent only, the mysteries of the cosmos. For those associates were individuals who were endowed with the natural ability to permit the least possible degree of separation between the physical and etheric bodies. They were altogether, at that time, the best possible individuals for promoting the further progress of humanity. Their experiences in the realm of sleep had become rarer and rarer. The spiritual world was more and more closed to them. Therefore they were also lacking in the comprehension of all that had been revealed to man in ancient times when he was not in his physical, but only in his etheric body. Those immediately surrounding the leader of the Christ oracle were the farthest advanced with regard to the union of the physical body with that part of the etheric body which had previously been separated from it. This union came about in the human being little by little, as a result of the transformation which had taken place in the Atlantean continent and the earth in general.
At one point, the Leader of the Christ Initiates found Himself alone with a few associates, to whom He could only share a limited understanding of the mysteries of the cosmos. These associates had a natural ability to keep the separation between the physical and etheric bodies to a minimum. At that time, they were the best individuals to help advance humanity. Their experiences in the realm of sleep had become increasingly rare. The spiritual world was shutting itself off from them more and more. As a result, they lacked an understanding of all that had been revealed to humanity in ancient times when people existed solely in their etheric bodies, not their physical ones. Those closest to the leader of the Christ oracle were the most developed regarding the connection between the physical body and the part of the etheric body that had been separated from it. This connection developed little by little in humans due to the changes that occurred on the Atlantean continent and in the earth as a whole.
The physical and etheric bodies of man fitted more and more into each other. Hence the memory lost [pg 246] its former unlimited capacity, and the human life of thought began. That part of the etheric which was united with the physical body transformed the physical brain into an actual instrument of thought, and man from this time, first really felt his “ego” within his physical body. Self-consciousness awoke. This was at first the case with only a limited number of the human race, pre-eminently with the associates of the leader of the Christ oracle. The bulk of humanity, scattered over Europe, Asia, and Africa, retained in varying degrees the remnant of the old conditions of consciousness. Hence they had direct experience of the supersensible world.
The physical and etheric bodies of humans became more interconnected. As a result, memory lost its previous limitless capacity, and human thought began to emerge. The part of the etheric connected to the physical body turned the physical brain into a true instrument of thought, allowing humans to first genuinely perceive their “self” within their physical bodies. Self-awareness emerged. Initially, this was true for only a select few among humanity, especially those close to the leader of the Christ oracle. Most people, spread across Europe, Asia, and Africa, continued to experience varying degrees of the old states of consciousness. This allowed them to have direct experiences of the supersensible world.
The associates of the Christ Initiate were people of highly developed intelligence but of less experience in supersensible spheres than any of their contemporaries. The Initiate journeyed with them to a country in central Asia. He wished them to be guarded as much as possible from contact with those of less developed consciousness. He instructed his followers along the lines of the mysteries which had been revealed to him and especially did he do this with their descendants. Thus he gathered round him a people who had received into their hearts the impulses corresponding to the Mysteries of the Christ Initiation. Out of this company he chose the seven best, that they might be endowed with the etheric and astral bodies which bore the impress of the etheric bodies of the seven best Atlantean Initiates. Thus he educated a successor to each of the Christ, Saturn, Jupiter, etc., Initiates. These seven [pg 247] Initiates became the teachers and leaders of the people who, in the post-Atlantean period, had colonized the south of Asia, especially ancient India. Since these great teachers were endowed with the etheric bodies of their spiritual ancestors, the contents of their astral body, that is, the science and knowledge they themselves had worked out, was far below what was revealed to them through their etheric body. Therefore if these revelations were to speak within them, they were obliged to impose silence on their own science and knowledge. Then the exalted beings who had also spoken to their spiritual ancestors spoke out of and through them. Except during the times when these beings were speaking through them, they were simple people, endowed with the measure of intelligence and feeling which they had cultivated and worked out for themselves.
The associates of the Christ Initiate were highly intelligent individuals, but they had less experience in spiritual matters than their peers. The Initiate took them on a journey to a region in central Asia. He wanted to shield them as much as possible from those with less developed awareness. He taught his followers based on the insights that had been revealed to him, especially focusing on their descendants. In this way, he brought together a group of people who embraced the impulses aligned with the Mysteries of the Christ Initiation. From this group, he selected the seven best individuals to receive the etheric and astral bodies that reflected the etheric bodies of the seven finest Atlantean Initiates. Thus, he prepared a successor for each of the Christ, Saturn, Jupiter, and other Initiates. These seven Initiates became the mentors and leaders for the people who, during the post-Atlantean era, settled in southern Asia, particularly ancient India. Since these great teachers were imbued with the etheric bodies of their spiritual ancestors, the knowledge contained within their astral bodies—the science and understanding they had developed—was significantly less than what was revealed to them through their etheric bodies. Therefore, to allow these revelations to express themselves through them, they had to silence their own knowledge and insights. When they did, the exalted beings, who had also communicated with their spiritual ancestors, spoke through them. Outside of these moments, they were ordinary individuals, possessing the level of intelligence and emotions they had cultivated on their own.
There lived at this time in India a race of people who had retained a particularly vivid remembrance of the ancient soul-condition of the Atlanteans, which permitted experiences in the spiritual world. Moreover, the heart and soul of a great number of these people were powerfully attracted by such experiences. By a wise decree of fate, the majority of the race had come to southern Asia from among the best portions of the Atlantean population. Besides this majority, other Atlanteans had migrated thither at different times. The Christ Initiate, referred to above, appointed his seven great disciples to be the teachers of this association of people, to whom they imparted their wisdom and precepts. [pg 248] Many of these ancient Indians needed but little preparation for reviving within them the scarcely extinct faculties leading to observation of the supersensible world. For longing after that world was really a fundamental quality of the Indian soul. It was felt that man's original home was in that world. He is transplanted out of it into this one, which offers only outer sense-observation and the intelligence connected with it.
At this time in India, there was a group of people who had a strong memory of the ancient spiritual state of the Atlanteans, which allowed them to experience the spiritual world. Many of these individuals were deeply drawn to such experiences. By a wise twist of fate, most of them had migrated to southern Asia from the best parts of the Atlantean population. Additionally, other Atlanteans had moved there at various times. The Christ Initiate mentioned earlier appointed his seven main disciples to teach this community, sharing their wisdom and teachings. [pg 248] Many of these ancient Indians required little preparation to awaken the nearly dormant abilities needed to perceive the supersensible world. A longing for that world was a fundamental aspect of the Indian soul. It was believed that humanity's true home was in that realm. People were moved from there to this world, which only provides outer sensory observations and the intelligence linked to them.
The supersensible world was felt to be the real world, and the sense-world to be a deception of the human power of observation, an illusion (Maya). By every possible means these people strove to open up a view of the real world. They could take no interest in the illusory sense-world, or at any rate only so far as it proved to be a veil for the supersensible. The power going out from the Seven Great Teachers to such people as these, was a mighty one. What they were able to reveal entered deeply into the Indian soul; and since the possession of the transmitted etheric and astral bodies invested the teachers with lofty powers, they were also able to work magically on their disciples. They did not really teach; they worked as though by magic power from one personality to another. Thus there arose a civilization completely saturated with supersensible wisdom. The contents of the books of wisdom of the Hindus, the Vedas, do not give the original form of the lofty wisdom imparted by the great teachers of most ancient times, only a feeble echo of it. Only the seer's eye, looking backward is able [pg 249] to find unwritten primeval wisdom behind the written words.
The supersensible world was perceived as the genuine world, while the sensory world was seen as a trick of human perception, an illusion (Maya). These individuals did everything they could to gain insight into the real world. They had little interest in the deceptive sensory world, except to the extent that it served as a cover for the supersensible. The strength that flowed from the Seven Great Teachers to them was immense. What they revealed resonated deeply with the Indian soul; and because the teachers possessed transmitted etheric and astral bodies, they held extraordinary powers, allowing them to work magically on their disciples. They didn’t really teach in the traditional sense; they seemed to transfer power from one person to another magically. As a result, a civilization emerged that was deeply infused with supersensible wisdom. The wisdom contained in the Hindu texts, the Vedas, does not capture the original form of the profound teachings from ancient great teachers, but merely offers a faint echo of it. Only the seer’s eye, looking back, can discover unwritten primordial wisdom hidden behind the written words.
A particularly prominent feature of this ancient wisdom is the harmonious accord of the various wisdom oracles of the Atlantean time. For each of the Great Teachers was able to unveil the wisdom of one of these oracles, and these different aspects were in complete harmony, because behind them all was the fundamental wisdom of the Christ Initiation. It is true the teacher who was the successor of the Christ Initiate did not impart to his disciples what the Christ Initiate himself was able to reveal. The latter had remained in the background during this period of evolution. At first he was unable to entrust his high office to any post-Atlantean. The difference between him and the Christ Initiate of the Seven Great Indian Teachers was that the former was able to work his vision of the Christ Mystery completely into the form of human ideas, whereas the Indian Christ Initiate could only offer a reflection of the Mystery in signs and symbols; for his humanly cultivated power of conception did not suffice for such a Mystery. However, from the union of the Seven Teachers there resulted a knowledge of the supersensible world, presented in one great wisdom-panorama, of which only separate portions could be imparted in the ancient Atlantean oracles. The great Regents of the cosmos were revealed, and the One great Sun-spirit, the Hidden One, ruling over those who were manifested through the seven teachers, was delicately indicated.
A key aspect of this ancient wisdom is the harmonious connection among the various wisdom oracles from the time of Atlantis. Each of the Great Teachers was able to reveal the insights of these oracles, and these different perspectives were completely in sync, all stemming from the core wisdom of the Christ Initiation. It's true that the teacher who followed the Christ Initiate did not share with his students everything that the Christ Initiate himself could express. The latter had taken a step back during this period of evolution. Initially, he couldn't pass on his significant role to anyone from the post-Atlantean era. The main difference between him and the Christ Initiate among the Seven Great Indian Teachers was that the former could completely translate his vision of the Christ Mystery into human concepts, while the Indian Christ Initiate could only present a glimpse of the Mystery through signs and symbols; his human understanding wasn't enough for such a profound Mystery. However, from the collaboration of the Seven Teachers emerged a knowledge of the non-physical world, depicted in a grand panorama of wisdom, from which only fragments could be shared in the ancient Atlantean oracles. The great rulers of the cosmos were revealed, and the singular great Sun-spirit, the Hidden One, who governs those manifested through the seven teachers, was subtly alluded to.
What is here meant by “ancient Indians” is not the same as what is usually understood by that term. No outer documents exist of the period in question. The people usually known as “Indians” belong to a stage of historical evolution which was developed long after the time spoken of here. We have to distinguish a first post-Atlantean period of the earth, in which the Indian civilization now described was the predominant one; then came a second post-Atlantean period in which the prevailing civilization was that which later in this work is called the “ancient Persian,” and still later was developed the Egypto-Chaldean civilization, also to be described. During the evolution of these second and third post-Atlantean epochs, “ancient” India also went through a second and third epoch, and to this third epoch belongs what is usually related of ancient India. What is described here must therefore not be applied to the “ancient India” mentioned elsewhere.
What is meant here by “ancient Indian people” is not the same as the usual understanding of that term. There are no external documents from the period in question. The people commonly referred to as “Indigenous peoples” belong to a stage of historical evolution that developed long after the time we are discussing. We need to distinguish a primary post-Atlantean period of the earth, during which the Indian civilization described here was the dominant one; then came a second post-Atlantean period when the prevailing civilization, later referred to as the "ancient Persian culture," emerged, and subsequently developed the Egypto-Chaldean civilization, which will also be described. During the evolution of these second and third post-Atlantean epochs, “old” India also experienced a second and third epoch, and what is typically recounted about ancient India belongs to this third epoch. Therefore, what is described here should not be applied to the "old India" mentioned elsewhere.
Another feature of this ancient Indian civilization is that which afterward led to the division of the race into castes. The inhabitants of India were descendants of Atlanteans who belonged to the various types of Saturn and Jupiter humanities, etc. By means of supersensible teachings it was seen that it is not by chance that a soul is incarnated in a particular caste, but that the soul itself has determined its lot. Such an understanding of supersensible teachings was made much easier, because it was possible to revive in many people the inner remembrance of their ancestors which has been described [pg 251] above; this, of course, might also easily lead to an erroneous idea of reincarnation. Just as, in the Atlantean age, it was only through the Initiates that the true idea of reincarnation could be realized, so in India, in most ancient times, it was possible only through direct contact with the great teachers. It is true that the erroneous idea of reincarnation mentioned above found the widest acceptance imaginable among the bands of people who were dispersed over Europe, Asia and Africa in consequence of the Atlantean catastrophe. And because the Initiates who had gone astray during the Atlantean evolution had imparted the mystery of reincarnation to immature souls, mankind began to confuse more and more the true with the false ideas. Many of these people indeed retained a kind of dim clairvoyance, as a heritage from the Atlantean period. Just as the Atlanteans had entered the spiritual world during sleep, their descendants had experience of it in abnormal states, intermediate between sleeping and waking. Then there arose in these people the images of the ancient times of their forefathers. They believed themselves to be reincarnations of people who had lived in those times. Teachings about reincarnation, which were at variance with the true ideas of the Initiates, were widely spread over the earth.
Another aspect of this ancient Indian civilization is what eventually led to the division of the population into castes. The people of India were descendants of Atlanteans who belonged to various types of Saturn and Jupiter humanity, among others. Through higher teachings, it was understood that a soul's incarnation in a specific caste is not random; rather, the soul itself chooses its path. This understanding of higher teachings was made easier because many people could recall their ancestors' experiences, as mentioned above; however, this could also lead to misunderstandings about reincarnation. Just as true knowledge of reincarnation was only accessible through the Initiates during the Atlantean age, in ancient India, it was attainable only through direct contact with the great teachers. It is true that the misleading ideas about reincarnation mentioned earlier gained widespread acceptance among the groups of people scattered across Europe, Asia, and Africa as a result of the Atlantean catastrophe. Because the Initiates who went astray during the Atlantean evolution shared the concept of reincarnation with immature souls, humanity increasingly confused true ideas with false ones. Many of these people did retain a kind of vague clairvoyance as a legacy from the Atlantean period. Just as the Atlanteans entered the spiritual world during sleep, their descendants experienced it in altered states between sleeping and waking. This led to the emergence of images from the ancient times of their ancestors within these individuals. They believed themselves to be reincarnations of people who had lived during those times. Teachings about reincarnation that contradicted the true ideas of the Initiates were widely spread across the earth.
As a result of the long-continued migrations which had taken place from west to east since the beginning of the Atlantean catastrophe, a group of people settled in western Asia whose posterity is known to [pg 252] history as the Persian race and the tribes related thereto. Here we look back to a much earlier period than the historical times of these peoples. Next after the Indian period, we have first to do with the very early ancestors of the later Persians, among whom arose the second great civilization of post-Atlantean evolution. The peoples of this second era had a different mission from that of the Indians. Their longings and inclinations were not fixed on the supersensible world alone; they were also directed toward the physical sense-world, and the earth became dear to them. They valued what man is able to acquire on it, and what he is able to win by means of its forces. Their achievements as a warlike people, and the methods which they discovered of acquiring the earth's treasures, are connected with this peculiarity of their nature. There was no danger of their turning their backs upon the “illusion” of the physical senses in their yearning after the supersensible, but rather of their entirely severing the connection of their souls with the supersensible world, through their appreciation for the physical world.
Due to the long migrations that took place from west to east since the start of the Atlantean disaster, a group of people settled in western Asia whose descendants are known in history as the Persian race and related tribes. Here, we look back at a much earlier time than the recorded history of these peoples. Following the Indian period, we first encounter the very early ancestors of the later Persians, who gave rise to the second great civilization of post-Atlantean evolution. The people of this second era had a different mission from that of the Indians. Their desires and inclinations were not solely focused on the spiritual realm; they also turned their attention to the physical world, and they grew fond of the earth. They valued what humans can achieve on it and what can be gained through its resources. Their accomplishments as a warrior society, as well as the methods they developed to acquire the earth's riches, are tied to this aspect of their nature. They didn’t risk turning away from the "illusion" of physical senses in their quest for the spiritual world, but rather faced the danger of completely disconnecting their souls from the spiritual realm due to their appreciation for the material world.
The oracle-sanctuaries, which had been transferred hither from the ancient Atlantean territory, also reflected, in their own way, the general character of the people. In them forces were present which it had formerly been possible to acquire through experiences in the supersensible world, and which could still be controlled in certain lower forms; these forces were used in the sanctuaries to [pg 253] direct the phenomena of nature in such a way as to make them subservient to man's personal interests. This ancient people still had a great mastery over those forces of nature which subsequently withdrew from the influence of the human will. The guardians of the oracles mastered certain inner forces connected with fire and other elements. They can be called magicians. What supersensible knowledge and force they had retained as a heritage from ancient times was certainly slight in comparison with man's powers in the remote past. But it nevertheless took all kinds of forms, from the noble arts, the only object of which was the welfare of humanity,—down to the most reprehensible transactions.
The oracle sanctuaries, which had been moved here from the ancient Atlantean land, also reflected the general character of the people in their own way. They housed forces that had once been accessible through experiences in the spiritual realm and that could still be controlled in certain lower forms. These forces were utilized in the sanctuaries to manipulate the phenomena of nature, making them serve personal interests. This ancient people still had a strong command over the natural forces that later retreated from human influence. The guardians of the oracles had mastery over specific inner forces tied to fire and other elements. They can be described as magicians. The spiritual knowledge and power they had inherited from ancient times was certainly minimal compared to the abilities of humans in the distant past. However, it still manifested in various forms, ranging from noble arts aimed solely at the well-being of humanity to the most dishonorable transactions.
The Luciferian influence held sway over these people in a peculiar manner. It had brought them into connection with everything which diverts mankind from the purposes of those exalted beings who alone would have guided human evolution, had not the Luciferian influence interposed. Even those members of this race who were still gifted with some remnant of the old clairvoyant condition, described above as a state intermediate between sleeping and waking, felt themselves powerfully attracted by the lower beings of the spiritual world. In order to counteract these characteristic qualities it was necessary that a spiritual impulse should be given to this people. A leadership was established among them by the guardian of the Mysteries of the Sun [pg 254] oracle, from the same source from which the spiritual life of ancient India proceeded.
The Luciferian influence had a strange hold over these people. It connected them with everything that distracts humanity from the goals of the higher beings who would have guided human evolution, if not for the interference of the Luciferian influence. Even those within this race who still retained some hint of the old clairvoyant state, described as a mix between sleeping and waking, felt a strong attraction to the lower beings of the spiritual world. To counteract these traits, a spiritual impulse needed to be given to this people. Leadership was established among them by the guardian of the Mysteries of the Sun oracle, from the same source as the spiritual life of ancient India. [pg 254]
The leader of ancient Persian civilization, who was sent by the guardian of the Sun oracle to the people now under consideration, may be designated by the same name as the historical Zarathustra, or Zoroaster. Only the fact must be emphasized that the personality indicated belongs to a much earlier period than the historical possessor of the name. In this connection it is not a question of outer historical research, but of spiritual knowledge. And any one who instinctively thinks of a later time in connection with the bearer of the name Zarathustra may reconcile this idea with occult science on learning that the historical character represents himself as a successor of the first great Zarathustra, whose name he took, and in the spirit of whose teaching he worked.
The leader of ancient Persian civilization, sent by the guardian of the Sun oracle to the people being discussed, may be referred to by the same name as the historical Zarathustra, or Zoroaster. It's important to emphasize that this figure existed much earlier than the historical person who bore the name. In this context, we’re not talking about traditional historical research, but rather spiritual knowledge. Anyone who instinctively associates the name Zarathustra with a later time can reconcile that thought with occult science upon realizing that the historical figure considered himself a successor to the first great Zarathustra, whose name he adopted, and in the spirit of whose teachings he operated.
The impulse which Zarathustra had to give to his people was to show them that the physical world of sense is not merely the lifeless material, devoid of spirit, which it appears to a man who gives himself up exclusively to the influence of the Luciferian being. To this being man owes his personal independence and sense of freedom; but it should work within him in harmony with the opposite spiritual being. With the pre-historic Persians it was a question of keeping alive the sense of this last-named spiritual-being. Through their inclination toward the physical sense world they ran the risk of complete amalgamation with the Luciferian beings. Now [pg 255] Zarathustra, through the guardian of the Sun oracle, had received an Initiation that enabled him to receive the revelations of the great Sun-spirits. In particular states of consciousness, brought about by his training, he was able to see the Regent of the Sun-spirits, who, as described above, had taken under His protection the human etheric body.
The goal that Zarathustra wanted to achieve for his people was to show them that the physical world of senses isn’t just a lifeless, spiritless material, as it seems to someone who only follows the influence of the Luciferian being. This being gives humans their personal independence and sense of freedom; however, it should work within them in harmony with the opposing spiritual being. For the ancient Persians, it was important to keep the awareness of this latter spiritual being alive. Their tendency toward the physical world put them at risk of merging completely with the Luciferian beings. Now [pg 255] Zarathustra, through the guardian of the Sun oracle, had undergone an Initiation that allowed him to receive revelations from the great Sun-spirits. In specific states of consciousness, achieved through his training, he could see the Regent of the Sun-spirits, who, as mentioned earlier, had taken the human etheric body under His protection.
Zarathustra knew that This Spirit directs the course of human evolution, but that He must first, at a certain time, descend to earth out of cosmic space. For this purpose it was necessary that He should be able to live in a human astral body, just as in man. He had worked in the etheric body since the entrance of the Luciferic nature. It was therefore necessary that a man should appear who had retransformed the astral body to the same level that it would have reached in the middle of the Atlantean evolution, had there been no Luciferian influence. Had Lucifer not appeared, mankind would certainly have attained this level before, but without personal independence or the possibility of freedom. Now, however, in spite of those qualities he should again arise to this height. Zarathustra, endowed with prophetic vision, could see that in the future it would be possible, within human evolution for a personality to exist, who would have a suitable astral body for that purpose. But he also knew that the great Sun-spirit could not appear on earth before that time, though He could be perceived by a seer in the spiritual part of the Sun. When as a seer he turned his attention to the Sun, Zarathustra was [pg 256] able to see This Spirit, whom he proclaimed to his people. He announced that the Sun-spirit was at first to be found only in the spiritual world, but that later He would descend to earth. This was the great Sun-spirit, or Spirit of Light (the Aura of the Sun, Ahura-mazdao, or Ormuzd). He was revealed to Zarathustra and his followers as the Spirit who, for the time being, was turning the light of His countenance on man from the spiritual world, and that it was He Who might be expected to appear in a human body amongst men in the future. It was the Christ, before his appearance on earth, whom Zarathustra proclaimed as the Spirit of Light. On the other hand he represented Ahriman (Angra mainju) as a power working injuriously on the life of the human soul, when it engrosses that soul completely. This power is none other than the one previously described, which had acquired special dominion over the earth since the betrayal of the Vulcan Mysteries. Together with the message concerning the Light God, Zarathustra proclaimed teachings about those spiritual beings who were revealed to the seer's purified perception as associates of the Spirit of Light. These were in strong contrast to the tempters who appeared to that unpurified clairvoyance which was left over from the Atlantean period. It had to be made clear to the ancient Persians that in man's soul, so far as it is engaged in work and endeavor in the physical sense world, a conflict is going on between the power of the Light God and his adversary. It had also to be shown [pg 257] them how man must act so as not to be engulfed by Ahriman, and how to turn his influence to good through the power of the Light God.
Zarathustra understood that this Spirit guides human evolution, but that He must, at a certain time, come down to earth from cosmic space. For this to happen, it was essential for Him to be able to exist in a human astral body, just like in a person. He had been active in the etheric body since the onset of the Luciferic nature. Therefore, it was necessary for a person to emerge who had transformed the astral body back to the level it would have reached during the Atlantean evolution, if there had been no Luciferian influence. If Lucifer hadn't appeared, humanity would have likely reached this level sooner, but without personal independence or the possibility of freedom. Now, however, despite those qualities, he should rise to this height again. Zarathustra, gifted with prophetic vision, could see that in the future, it would be possible for a personality to have a suitable astral body for that purpose within human evolution. But he also understood that the great Sun-spirit couldn't appear on earth before that time, although a seer could perceive Him in the spiritual part of the Sun. When Zarathustra, as a seer, focused on the Sun, he was able to see this Spirit, whom he proclaimed to his people. He announced that the Sun-spirit would initially be found only in the spiritual world but that He would eventually descend to earth. This was the great Sun-spirit, or Spirit of Light (the Aura of the Sun, Ahura-mazdao, or Ormuzd). He revealed Himself to Zarathustra and his followers as the Spirit who, for the time being, was shining the light of His presence on humanity from the spiritual world, and it was He who might be expected to appear in human form among people in the future. It was the Christ, before His arrival on earth, whom Zarathustra declared as the Spirit of Light. Conversely, he depicted Ahriman (Angra mainju) as a force that negatively impacts the human soul when it completely consumes that soul. This force is none other than the one previously mentioned, which gained special control over the earth after the betrayal of the Vulcan Mysteries. Along with the message about the Light God, Zarathustra shared teachings about the spiritual beings revealed to the seer's purified perception as companions of the Spirit of Light. These beings contrasted sharply with the tempters who appeared to the unpurified clairvoyance leftover from the Atlantean period. It needed to be made clear to the ancient Persians that in human souls, while engaged in work and effort in the physical world, a conflict exists between the power of the Light God and His adversary. It also had to be explained to them how individuals must act to avoid being consumed by Ahriman and how to channel His influence positively through the power of the Light God.
The third era of post-Atlantean civilization began among the peoples who finally gathered together in western Asia and northern Africa after the migrations. This civilization was developed among the Chaldeans, Babylonians, and Assyrians on the one hand, and among the Egyptians on the other. In these peoples the taste for the physical world of sense developed in a different form from that which it had taken among the Persians. The former had acquired the quality of mind lying at the root of the faculty of thought which has arisen since Atlantean times, that is, the gift of reason. Indeed, it was the mission of post-Atlantean humanity to develop within itself those faculties of the soul which it was possible to acquire through the newly awakened powers of thought and feeling. These powers cannot be directly stimulated from the spiritual world, but result from man's observing the sense-world, becoming familiar with it, and working upon it. The conquest of the physical world of sense by these human faculties must be regarded as the mission of post-Atlantean humanity. Step by step that conquest proceeded. It is true that even in ancient India, man, through the condition of his soul, was already turned toward that world; but he still looked upon it as illusion, and his spirit turned to the supersensible world. In the Persian race, on the contrary, there sprang up the endeavour to conquer the [pg 258] physical world of sense, but the attempt was still largely made with those powers of the soul which had been left over as an inheritance from the time when man could still reach the spiritual world directly. Among the peoples of the third epoch of civilization, the soul had for the most part lost the supersensible faculties. It was obliged to seek manifestations of the spiritual in the surrounding world of sense, and to continue its development by discovering the means of civilization existing in that world. Men sought to investigate, through the physical world, the spiritual laws underlying it, and in this way human sciences arose. Human technical skill, artistic work, and their tools and means came about through the recognition and use of the forces of the physical world. To a man of the Chaldaic-Babylonian race the sense-world was no longer an illusion but a manifestation, in its different kingdoms, in mountains and seas, in air and water, of the spiritual activity of powers existing behind it, whose laws man was striving to learn.
The third era of post-Atlantean civilization began among the peoples who finally came together in western Asia and northern Africa after the migrations. This civilization developed among the Chaldeans, Babylonians, and Assyrians on one side, and the Egyptians on the other. The way these groups engaged with the physical world differed from how the Persians did. The former had developed the mindset that underpins the ability to think, which has emerged since Atlantean times, specifically the gift of reason. In fact, the purpose of post-Atlantean humanity was to develop those aspects of the soul that could be cultivated through the newly awakened powers of thought and feeling. These powers can’t be directly triggered from the spiritual world; instead, they arise from people observing the sensory world, getting to know it, and working with it. Taking control of the physical sensory world with these human faculties should be seen as the mission of post-Atlantean humanity. Progress toward this goal happened gradually. It’s true that even in ancient India, individuals, due to their soul's condition, were already inclined towards that world; however, they perceived it as an illusion and their spirit was directed toward the supersensible world. In contrast, the Persian race aimed to conquer the physical sensory world, but they still largely relied on those soulful powers inherited from when humans could still access the spiritual world directly. Among the peoples of this third epoch of civilization, the soul had mostly lost its supersensible abilities. It needed to find signs of the spiritual within the surrounding sensory world and advance its development by discovering the means of civilization present in that world. People sought to explore spiritual laws through the physical world, leading to the emergence of human sciences. Human craftsmanship, artistic endeavors, and the tools and methods they used came about through understanding and utilizing the forces of the physical world. For someone from the Chaldaic-Babylonian race, the sensory world was no longer seen as an illusion but as a manifestation, in its various realms—mountains, seas, air, and water—of the spiritual forces at work behind it, whose laws people were eager to uncover.
To the Egyptian, the earth was a field of work, given to him in a condition which he must, by his own powers of intelligence, so transform that it should bear the impress of human power. From Atlantis, oracle-sanctuaries, originating chiefly from the Mercury oracle, had been transplanted to Egypt. Yet there were others as well,—for example, Venus oracles.
To the Egyptians, the land was a workplace, given to them in a state they needed to transform using their own intelligence, so it would reflect human effort. From Atlantis, oracle sanctuaries, mainly from the Mercury oracle, had been brought to Egypt. However, there were others too—like the Venus oracles.
In that which was fostered, in their oracle-sanctuaries, among the Egyptian peoples, the germ of a [pg 259] new culture was planted. This germ proceeded from a great leader who had received his training in the Persian Zarathustra Mysteries, who was the reincarnated individuality of a disciple of the great Zarathustra himself. Let us call him “Hermes.” Through acceptance of the Zarathustra Mysteries he was able to find the right way to guide the Egyptian people. This people had so turned its attention to the physical sense-world, during earthly life between birth and death that it was able only to a limited extent to directly behold the spiritual world behind the physical phenomena, although it recognized the spiritual laws of the world. Thus it could not think of the spiritual world as the one in which it could live while on earth, but on the other hand, it could be shown how man will live, in the disembodied state after death in the world of those spirits who, during earthly life, appear through their impressions upon the sense-world.
In what was nurtured in their oracle-sanctuaries among the Egyptian people, the seed of a new culture was planted. This seed came from a great leader who had trained in the Persian Zarathustra Mysteries and was the reincarnated essence of a disciple of the great Zarathustra himself. Let's call him “Hermes.” By embracing the Zarathustra Mysteries, he found the right way to guide the Egyptian people. This society had focused so much on the physical world during their earthly life that they could only limitedly perceive the spiritual world behind physical phenomena, even though they recognized the spiritual laws governing it. Therefore, they could not see the spiritual world as one they could inhabit while on earth, but they could be shown how humans will exist in a disembodied state after death among those spirits who, during earthly life, manifest through their impressions on the physical world.
Hermes taught that man qualifies himself for union with spiritual forces after death, in proportion as he uses his powers on earth for furthering the purposes of those spiritual forces. Those especially, who had worked most zealously in this way between birth and death would be united with the lofty Sun-God Osiris. On the Chaldaic-Babylonian side of this stream of civilization the direction of the human mind toward the physical sense-world was more conspicuous than on the Egyptian side. The laws of that world were being investigated and from its reflection in the sense-world these people [pg 260] looked up to the corresponding spiritual prototypes. Yet in many respects the nation remained wedded to physical things. Instead of the star-spirit, the star was put first, and instead of other spiritual beings their earthly counterparts were made prominent. Only the leaders attained to really deep knowledge concerning the laws of the supersensible world and its connection with the physical. The contrast between the knowledge of the Initiates and the perverted beliefs of the people became more apparent in these nations than anywhere else.
Hermes taught that a person prepares for a connection with spiritual forces after death based on how they used their abilities on earth to support those spiritual purposes. Those who worked the hardest in this way during their lifetime would be united with the great Sun-God Osiris. On the Chaldaic-Babylonian side of this civilization stream, there was a more noticeable focus on the physical world than on the Egyptian side. They were investigating the laws of that world, and from their understanding of the physical realm, they looked up to its corresponding spiritual models. However, in many ways, the nation remained attached to physical things. Instead of focusing on the spirit of the stars, they prioritized the stars themselves, and rather than elevating other spiritual beings, they highlighted their earthly counterparts. Only the leaders gained a truly profound understanding of the laws of the non-physical world and its relationship with the physical one. The gap between the knowledge of the Initiates and the distorted beliefs of the public became clearer in these nations than anywhere else.
Very different conditions existed in those parts of Southern Europe and western Asia where the fourth epoch of post-Atlantean civilization was unfolded. In occult science, it is called the Greco-Roman period. Descendants of peoples inhabiting widely distant parts of the older world had met together in these countries. Here were oracle-sanctuaries which conformed to the various Atlantean oracles; here were people with the heritage of ancient clairvoyance as a natural gift, and others who were able to acquire it, with comparative ease, by training. The traditions of the ancient Initiates were not only preserved in special places, but worthy successors to them arose, who attracted disciples capable of rising to lofty levels of spiritual vision. Moreover, these races had within them the impulse to create a domain within the sense-world which expresses the spiritual in perfect form through the physical.
Very different conditions existed in those parts of Southern Europe and western Asia where the fourth epoch of post-Atlantean civilization unfolded. In occult science, it's called the Greco-Roman period. Descendants of peoples from widely distant areas of the older world came together in these countries. Here were oracle sanctuaries that aligned with various Atlantean oracles; here were people with the natural gift of ancient clairvoyance and others who could acquire it with relative ease through training. The traditions of the ancient Initiates were not only preserved in specific places, but worthy successors emerged, attracting disciples capable of achieving high levels of spiritual vision. Moreover, these races had the drive to create a realm within the physical world that expresses the spiritual in perfect form.
Greek art is, among other things, a result of this impulse. It is only necessary to gaze with the eye [pg 261] of the spirit upon a Greek temple, in order to see that in this marvel of art, material substance is so worked upon by man that it appears in every detail as the expression of spirit. The Greek temple is the “House of the Spirit.” One sees in its form what otherwise only The Spiritual eye of the seer perceives. The temple of Zeus-(or Jupiter) is so constructed as to present to the physical eye a fitting shrine for what the guardian of the Zeus-(or Jupiter) Initiation saw with spiritual vision. And it is the same with all Greek art. The wisdom of the Initiates flowed in mysterious ways into poets, artists, and thinkers. The Mysteries of the Initiates are found again, in the form of conceptions and ideas, in the systems of thought by which ancient Greek philosophers interpreted the universe. The influences of the spiritual life, the Mysteries of the Asiatic and African sanctuaries of Initiation, flowed into these nations and to their leaders. The great Indian teachers, the associates of Zarathustra, and the followers of Hermes had attracted disciples. These, or their successors, thereupon founded sanctuaries for Initiation, in which the ancient wisdom was revived in a new form. These were the Mysteries of antiquity. Here disciples were prepared to be brought into the condition of consciousness through which they might attain vision of the spiritual world.23 From these sanctuaries of Initiation [pg 262] the Mysteries flowed forth to those who cultivated Spiritual Mysteries in Asia Minor, Greece, and Italy. (Important centres of Initiation were formed in the Greek world in the Orphic and Eleusinian Mysteries. In the Pythagorean School of wisdom, lingered the effects of the great wisdom-teachings and methods of past ages. On his distant travels, Pythagoras had been initiated into the secrets of the most varied kinds of Mysteries.)
Greek art is, among other things, a result of this impulse. It’s enough to look with a spiritual eye at a Greek temple to see that in this marvel of art, material substance is shaped by humans so that it expresses spirit in every detail. The Greek temple is the “House of the Spirit.” You can see in its form what only the spiritual eye of the seer typically perceives. The temple of Zeus (or Jupiter) is designed to present a suitable shrine for what the guardian of the Zeus (or Jupiter) Initiation saw through spiritual vision. The same applies to all Greek art. The wisdom of the Initiates flowed mysteriously into poets, artists, and thinkers. The Mysteries of the Initiates are reflected, in the form of concepts and ideas, in the systems of thought by which ancient Greek philosophers interpreted the universe. The influences of spiritual life, the Mysteries of the Asiatic and African sanctuaries of Initiation, reached these nations and their leaders. The great Indian teachers, the followers of Zarathustra, and the disciples of Hermes had attracted followers. These, or their successors, then founded sanctuaries for Initiation, reviving the ancient wisdom in a new form. These were the Mysteries of antiquity. Here, disciples were prepared to reach a state of consciousness through which they might attain vision of the spiritual world. From these sanctuaries of Initiation, the Mysteries spread to those who cultivated Spiritual Mysteries in Asia Minor, Greece, and Italy. (Important centers of Initiation were established in the Greek world through the Orphic and Eleusinian Mysteries. In the Pythagorean School of wisdom, the influences of ancient wisdom-teachings and methods of previous ages remained. During his extensive travels, Pythagoras was initiated into the secrets of various types of Mysteries.)
But human life between birth and death in the post-Atlantean period had also an influence on the disembodied state after death. The more man's interests were fixed on the physical sense-world, the greater was the possibility of Ahriman gaining a hold upon the soul during earthly life and retaining his power of it after death. This danger was least among the peoples of ancient India, for during earthly life they had felt the physical sense-world to be an illusion, and thus had eluded the power of Ahriman after death. The danger for the primitive Persian peoples, who between birth and death had fixed their attention, with great interest, upon the physical sense-world was much greater. They would have largely fallen a prey to Ahriman's wiles had not Zarathustra pointed out, emphatically through his teaching concerning the Light of God, that behind the physical sense-world there exists the world of the Spirits of Light. In proportion to the ability of the people of this civilization to receive something into their souls out of the world of thought thus created, were they able to escape Ahriman's clutches [pg 263] during earthly life, and thereby elude him in the life after death, during which they were to be prepared for a new earth-life. The power of Ahriman in earthly life tends to make the physical sense-existence appear to be the only one, and thus to bar the way to any vista of a spiritual world. His power in the spiritual world leads man to complete isolation, and to the concentration of all his interest upon himself. Those who, at the time of death, are in Ahriman's power, are born again as egoists.
But human life between birth and death in the post-Atlantean period also influenced the disembodied state after death. The more a person's interests were focused on the physical world, the greater the chance that Ahriman could gain control over the soul during earthly life and maintain that power after death. This danger was least among the ancient Indian peoples, who viewed the physical world as an illusion, helping them escape Ahriman’s influence after death. The risk was much higher for the primitive Persian peoples, who, during their lives, were intensely focused on the physical world. They would have largely fallen victim to Ahriman's tricks if Zarathustra hadn’t strongly emphasized through his teachings about the Light of God that behind the physical world lies the realm of the Spirits of Light. The more these people were able to absorb concepts from this created world of thought into their souls, the better they could escape Ahriman’s grasp during earthly life and thus elude him in the afterlife, where they were meant to prepare for a new earthly existence. Ahriman's power in earthly life tends to make physical existence seem like the only reality, blocking any awareness of a spiritual world. His influence in the spiritual realm leads people to total isolation and a focus solely on themselves. Those who are under Ahriman’s power at death are reborn as egoists. [pg 263]
It is now possible for occult science to describe life between death and a new birth as it is, provided the Ahrimanic influence has, to a certain degree, been overcome. It is in this sense that it has been described by the author in the first chapter of this book as well as in other writings. And it must be described in this way if that which can be experienced by man during this form of existence is to be visualized and if he has attained to purely spiritual perception for that which really exists. The degree to which the individual experiences this, depends upon the extent to which he has overcome the Ahrimanic influence.
It is now possible for occult science to describe life between death and a new birth as it is, as long as the Ahrimanic influence has been somewhat overcome. This is how it has been explained by the author in the first chapter of this book and in other writings. It must be described this way for a person to visualize what can be experienced during this stage of existence and to gain a purely spiritual perception of what truly exists. The extent to which an individual experiences this depends on how much they have overcome the Ahrimanic influence.
Man is approaching nearer and nearer to what it is possible for him to become in the spiritual world. How this progress is thwarted by other influences must however be clearly brought out in our consideration of the course of human evolution.
Man is getting closer and closer to what he can achieve in the spiritual world. However, we must clearly highlight how this progress is hindered by other influences as we examine the course of human evolution.
During the Egyptian period Hermes taught the people to prepare themselves during earth-life, for communion with the Spirit of Light. But because [pg 264] at that time human interests, between birth and death, were already so constituted that it was only possible to a slight degree to see through the veil of the physical sense-world, therefore the spiritual vision of the soul after death was also clouded and the perception of the world of light remained dim.
During the Egyptian era, Hermes taught people how to prepare themselves in life for communion with the Spirit of Light. However, since human interests between birth and death were already structured in such a way that it was only slightly possible to see beyond the veil of the physical world, the soul's spiritual vision after death was also obscured, and the understanding of the world of light remained faint.
The obscuration of the spiritual world after death reached a climax in the souls who passed into the disembodied state out of a body belonging to the Greco-Roman civilization. During their earthly life they had brought to perfection the cultivation of physical sense-existence, and had thus condemned themselves to a shadowy existence after death. Hence the Greek felt life after death to be a shadowy existence, and it is not mere rhetoric but the realization of truth when the hero of that time, who is given up to the life of the senses, says, “Better a beggar on earth than a king in the realm of shades.” All this was still more marked in those Asiatic peoples who had fixed their attention with veneration and worship on material images instead of on their spiritual archetypes. A large proportion of mankind was in this condition at the time of the Greco-Roman era of civilization. It can be seen how man's mission in post-Atlantean times, which consisted in the conquest of the physical sense-world, must necessarily lead to estrangement from the spiritual world. Thus greatness in one respect necessarily involves deterioration in another.
The obscuring of the spiritual world after death peaked for the souls who transitioned into the disembodied state from the Greco-Roman civilization. During their earthly lives, they had perfected the cultivation of physical sensory experiences, thereby condemning themselves to a shadowy existence after death. As a result, the Greek viewed life after death as a dim existence, and it’s not just rhetoric but a realization of truth when the hero of that time, who is immersed in sensory life, says, “It's better to be a beggar on earth than a king in the world of the dead.” This was even more pronounced in those Asian cultures that focused their reverence and worship on material images rather than their spiritual ideals. A significant portion of humanity was in this state during the Greco-Roman era. It’s clear how man's mission in post-Atlantean times, which was to conquer the physical sensory world, had to lead to a disconnect from the spiritual realm. Thus, greatness in one area inevitably means decline in another.
Man's connection with the spiritual world was kept alive in the Mysteries. Through these the Initiates, [pg 265] in special states of the soul, were able to receive revelations from that world. They were more or less the successors of the guardians of the Atlantean oracles. To them was revealed what had been hidden through the influence of Lucifer and Ahriman. Lucifer concealed from man what had flowed from the spiritual world into the human astral body, without his co-operation, up to the middle of the Atlantean period. Had the etheric body not been partially separated from the physical body, man would have been able to experience within himself this part of the spiritual world as an inner revelation to his soul. As a result of Lucifer's encroachment, this could be done only in special states of the soul. At those times a spiritual world appeared to man in the guise of the astral. The corresponding spiritual beings manifested themselves in forms which embodied only the higher principles of the human being, and in those principles the symbols of their particular spiritual forces were astrally visible. Superhuman forms were manifested in this way.
Man's connection to the spiritual world was sustained through the Mysteries. In these practices, the Initiates, [pg 265] in unique states of consciousness, could receive insights from that realm. They were essentially the successors of those who oversaw the Atlantean oracles. They were shown what had been hidden by the influences of Lucifer and Ahriman. Lucifer hid from humanity what had streamed from the spiritual world into the human astral body, without his participation, until the mid-Atlantean period. If the etheric body hadn't been partially detached from the physical body, humans could have directly experienced this aspect of the spiritual world as an inner revelation to their souls. Due to Lucifer's interference, this could only occur in specific states of consciousness. During those moments, the spiritual world appeared to humanity in the form of the astral. Corresponding spiritual beings revealed themselves in forms that represented only the higher aspects of human nature, and in those aspects, the symbols of their unique spiritual forces were visually present in the astral realm. Superhuman forms manifested in this way.
After the encroachment of Ahriman, still another kind of Initiation was added to this one. Ahriman concealed from man everything out of the spiritual world which would have appeared behind physical sense-perception, had he not interfered in human affairs from the middle of the Atlantean period onward. The Initiates of the Mysteries owed the revelation of what he had thus kept hidden, to the fact that they had developed within their souls all those faculties which man had attained [pg 266] since that time, beyond the degree necessary for physical sense-impressions. Thus there were revealed to them the spiritual powers lying behind the forces of nature. They could speak of the spiritual beings behind nature. The creative might of those forces acting in nature below man, was revealed to them. That which had been active since Saturn, Sun and the old Moon and had shaped man's physical, etheric and astral body as well as the mineral, plant and animal kingdoms, formed the contents of a certain kind of mystery-secrets,—namely those over which Ahriman held his hand. That which had formed the sentient-, rational-and consciousness-souls and which had been concealed from man by Lucifer, was revealed in a second kind of Mystery-secrets.
After Ahriman's interference, a new type of Initiation was introduced. Ahriman hid from humans everything from the spiritual world that would have been visible beyond physical perception if he hadn't meddled in human affairs from the middle of the Atlantean period onward. The Initiates of the Mysteries gained insight into what he had kept hidden because they had cultivated within themselves all the abilities that humanity has developed since then, surpassing what was necessary for just physical sense impressions. This allowed them to see the spiritual powers behind the forces of nature. They could discuss the spiritual beings that exist within nature. They were shown the creative power of those forces acting in nature beneath humanity. This knowledge encompassed what had been active since Saturn, Sun, and the old Moon and had shaped the physical, etheric, and astral bodies of humans, as well as the mineral, plant, and animal kingdoms, forming part of a certain type of mystery secrets—specifically those under Ahriman's control. Additionally, the aspects that had formed the sentient, rational, and consciousness-souls and had been hidden from humanity by Lucifer were revealed in another type of mystery secrets.
But what the Mysteries could only prophesy was, that in time a man would appear possessing an astral body which, despite Lucifer, could become conscious of the light-world of the Sun-spirit through the etheric body, apart from any special condition of the soul. And the physical body of that human being must be of such a nature, that everything in the spiritual world would be revealed to him, which Ahriman is able to conceal from man up to the time of physical death. Physical death could bring no change into the life of such a being, that is to say, could have no power over it. The “Ego” so manifests in such a human being that the entire spiritual life is at the same time contained in his physical life. Such a being is the vehicle of the [pg 267] Spirit of Light, to whom the Initiate ascends from two directions, being led, under special conditions of the soul, either to the Superhuman Spirit or to the Being of the forces of nature. When the Initiates of the Mysteries foretold the appearance in the course of time, of such a human being, they were prophets of the Christ.
But what the Mysteries could only predict was that eventually a man would come who had an astral body that, despite Lucifer, could become aware of the light-world of the Sun-spirit through the etheric body, independent of any specific condition of the soul. This person's physical body had to be such that everything in the spiritual world would be revealed to him, which Ahriman can hide from people until the time of physical death. For such a being, physical death would not bring any change to their life, meaning it would have no power over it. The "Self" in this human being manifests in such a way that their entire spiritual life is simultaneously present in their physical life. This being serves as the vessel for the [pg 267] Spirit of Light, to whom the Initiate rises from two directions, being guided, under special conditions of the soul, either to the Superhuman Spirit or to the essence of the forces of nature. When the Initiates of the Mysteries prophesied the future appearance of such a human being, they were foreseeing the Christ.
A personality arose, as the special prophet of this coming manifestation, within a nation which possessed through natural inheritance the qualities of the peoples of western Asia, and through education the learning of the Egyptians—the Hebrew nation. This prophet was Moses. The influences of Initiation had entered so deeply into his soul that in certain states of consciousness the being who had undertaken in the regular course of the earth evolution to shape human consciousness from the Moon, was revealed to him. In thunder and lightning Moses realized not merely physical phenomena, but manifestations of this Spirit. At the same time the other kind of Mysteries had influenced his soul, so that he was able to distinguish, in astral vision, how the superhuman becomes human by means of the ego. Thus, from two directions, He Who was to come, was revealed to Moses as the highest form of the Ego.
A unique individual emerged as the special prophet of this upcoming revelation within a nation that naturally inherited the qualities of the peoples of western Asia and, through education, gained the wisdom of the Egyptians—the Hebrew nation. This prophet was Moses. The influences of initiation had penetrated so deeply into his soul that, in certain states of awareness, he was shown the being who had, through the natural progression of Earth’s evolution, been responsible for shaping human consciousness since the Moon. In moments of thunder and lightning, Moses understood not just physical events but manifestations of this Spirit. Simultaneously, other types of mysteries had impacted his soul, allowing him to perceive, in astral vision, how the superhuman transforms into the human through the ego. Therefore, from two different paths, the one who was to come was revealed to Moses as the highest expression of the Ego.
And in Christ the lofty Sun-spirit appeared in human form as the great ideal for human life on earth. At His coming, all mystery-wisdom had in some respects to take a new form. Up to that time this wisdom had existed exclusively for the purpose [pg 268] of enabling man to put himself into such a condition of soul in which he would be able to view the kingdom of the Sun-spirit as something outside of earthly evolution. Henceforth it was the mission of Mystery-wisdom to make man capable of recognizing in the incarnated Christ the Primordial Being. From this Primordial Being man was enabled to understand the natural and spiritual worlds.24
And in Christ, the high Sun-spirit appeared in human form as the ultimate example for human life on earth. With His arrival, all mystery-wisdom had to take on a new role in some ways. Up until that point, this wisdom had existed solely to help people reach a state of soul where they could see the kingdom of the Sun-spirit as something beyond earthly evolution. From now on, the aim of Mystery-wisdom was to enable people to recognize the incarnated Christ as the Primordial Being. Through this Primordial Being, people could understand the natural and spiritual worlds.
At the point in His life at which the astral body of Christ Jesus contained everything which it is possible for the Luciferian influence to conceal, He came forward as the Teacher of humanity. From that moment, the faculty was implanted in human earthly evolution for assimilating that wisdom whereby the physical goal of the earth may gradually be reached. At the moment when the Event of Golgotha was accomplished, human nature was endowed with another faculty, that by which Ahriman's influence may be turned into good. Henceforth man was able to take with him through the gate of death that which saves him from isolation in the spiritual world. What happened in Palestine was the central point, not only of human physical evolution but also of the other worlds to which man belongs; and when the “Mystery of Golgotha” had been accomplished, when the “death on the cross” had been suffered, Christ appeared in that world where souls sojourn after death, and set limits to the power of Ahriman. From that moment the region which the Greeks had [pg 269] called the “realm of shades” was illuminated by that flash of the Spirit indicating to its dwellers that light was to return. What had been gained for the physical world by the “Mystery of Golgotha” cast light also into the spiritual world.
At the stage in His life when the astral body of Christ Jesus held everything that could be hidden by the Luciferian influence, He stepped forward as the Teacher of humanity. From that moment on, the ability to absorb that wisdom, which would allow humanity to gradually achieve its physical purpose on Earth, was planted in human development. When the event at Golgotha took place, humanity received another capability, the one that allows the influence of Ahriman to be transformed into good. From then on, people could carry with them through the gate of death that which protects them from isolation in the spiritual realm. What transpired in Palestine was not just the focal point of human physical evolution but also pivotal for the other realms to which humans belong; and after the “Golgotha Mystery” was fulfilled, and the “death on the cross” endured, Christ appeared in the realm where souls reside after death, limiting Ahriman's power. From that moment, the area the Greeks referred to as the “world of shadows” was brightened by a flash of the Spirit, signaling to its inhabitants that light would return. What was achieved for the physical world through the “Golgotha Mystery” also illuminated the spiritual world.
Up to this event post-Atlantean human evolution had been a time of ascent in the physical sense-world, but of descent as far as the spiritual world was concerned. Everything which flowed into the sense-world proceeded from what had been in the spiritual world from remote ages. Since the coming of Christ, those who attain to the Mystery of Christ are able to take with them into the spiritual world what they have won in the physical. And from the spiritual world it then flows back again into the earthly sense-world, since reincarnated souls, on re-entering earth-life, bring with them what the Christ-impulse between death and a new birth, has bestowed.
Up until this event, human evolution after Atlantis was characterized by physical progress, but a decline in spiritual awareness. Everything that entered the physical world came from what had existed in the spiritual world for ages. Since the arrival of Christ, those who understand the Mystery of Christ can carry into the spiritual realm what they have achieved in the physical realm. From there, it flows back into the earthly sense-world, as reincarnated souls, upon returning to life on Earth, bring with them what the Christ-impulse has given them between death and rebirth.
What flowed into human evolution with the appearance of the Christ, acted in it like a seed. Only slowly can this seed mature. Only the smallest part of these profound new wisdom teachings, up to the present time, has reached down into physical existence. Christian evolution has just barely begun. During the successive periods of time following the appearance of the Christ, this Christian Evolution was able to reveal only so much of its inner essential nature as the humanity, the peoples of that time, were capable of receiving; only as much as they could grasp with their faculties of comprehension. [pg 270] The first form into which this essence of Christianity could be poured may be described as a comprehensive ideal of life. As such it was opposed to those forms of life which had been developed in post-Atlantean humanity. The conditions operating in human evolution since the repopulation of the earth in the Lemurian period have been described above. Accordingly, humanity can be traced back to different beings who, coming from other worlds, incarnated in the bodily descendants of the ancient Lemurians. The various races of man are a consequence of this, and the most diverse vital interests appeared in these reincarnated souls, as a result of their Karma. As long as all this was being worked out, there could be no ideal of “universal humanity.” Human nature originated in unity, but earthly evolution up to the present time has led to division. In the figure of the Christ, we see an ideal which opposes all division, for in the man who bears the name of Christ there lives the lofty Sun-being from Whom every human ego is descended. The Hebrew nation still felt itself to be a nation, and each individual a member of that nation. When once the idea was grasped that in Christ-Jesus there lives the ideal Man who stands above all that tends to divide humanity, Christianity became the Ideal of an all-Embracing brotherhood. Above all individual interests and relations, the feeling arose in some that the innermost ego of all human beings is of the same origin. (In addition to all the earthly forefathers, the great common Father [pg 271] of all humanity appears. “I and the Father are one.”)
What entered human evolution with the arrival of Christ acted like a seed. This seed can only mature slowly. So far, only a tiny fraction of these profound new teachings has made its way into our physical existence. The evolution of Christianity has only just begun. Over the periods that followed Christ's appearance, this Christian evolution could only reveal its essential nature to the extent that the people of that time were ready to receive it; only as much as they could understand with their faculties of comprehension. [pg 270] The first way this essence of Christianity could be expressed was as a broad ideal of life. This ideal stood in contrast to the lifestyle forms that had developed in post-Atlantean humanity. The conditions that have influenced human evolution since the earth was repopulated in the Lemurian period have been described above. Thus, humanity can be traced back to various beings who, coming from other worlds, reincarnated in the physical descendants of the ancient Lemurians. The different races of humanity resulted from this, and the various vital interests emerged in these reincarnated souls due to their Karma. While all of this was unfolding, there could be no ideal of "global humanity." Human nature originated in unity, but earthly evolution has led to division up to this point. In the figure of Christ, we see an ideal that opposes all division because in the man named Christ lives the higher Sun-being from whom every human ego descends. The Hebrew nation still saw itself as a nation, and each individual as a part of that nation. Once the idea was understood that in Christ-Jesus dwells the ideal Man who transcends all that divides humanity, Christianity became the ideal of a comprehensive brotherhood. Above all individual interests and relationships, some began to feel that the innermost ego of all people shares the same origin. (Along with all the earthly ancestors, the great common Father [pg 271] of all humanity emerges. “The Father and I are one.”)
In the fourth, fifth, and sixth centuries after Christ, the era in which we are still living was being prepared in Europe. It was gradually to replace the fourth, or Greco-Roman civilization. It is the fifth post-Atlantean period. The races which, after many wanderings and varied fortunes, became the vehicles of this new civilization were descendants of those Atlanteans who had remained less affected than others by what had been going on meanwhile during the four preceding periods of civilization. They had not penetrated into the countries in which those respective civilizations took root. On the contrary, they had, in their way, handed on Atlantean forms of civilization. There were many among them who had retained in a high degree the inheritance of the ancient dim clairvoyance, the state described above as intermediate between sleeping and waking. Such people knew the spiritual world from their own experience, and could reveal to their fellow-men what takes place there. Thus there sprang up a great number of narratives of spiritual beings and events, and the national treasures of legends and sagas had their origin in spiritual experiences of this kind. For the dim clairvoyance lasted on, in many people, into times not far removed from the present. There were other people who, although they had lost clairvoyance, nevertheless developed the faculties they acquired for use in the physical sense-world in accordance with feelings and emotions which corresponded [pg 272] to clairvoyant experiences. And even the Atlantean oracles had their successors in the new civilization.
In the fourth, fifth, and sixth centuries after Christ, the era we currently live in was being developed in Europe. This new era was gradually replacing the fourth, or Greco-Roman civilization. It marks the fifth post-Atlantean period. The groups that eventually became the bearers of this new civilization, after many journeys and various fortunes, were descendants of those Atlanteans who were less influenced by the happenings of the four previous periods of civilization. They hadn’t settled in the areas where those civilizations thrived. Instead, they continued to carry on Atlantean cultural practices. Many among them retained a strong sense of the ancient dim clairvoyance, a state described earlier that lies between sleeping and waking. These individuals had firsthand knowledge of the spiritual world and could share their insights with others. This gave rise to numerous stories of spiritual beings and events, forming the national treasures of legends and sagas based on such spiritual experiences. The dim clairvoyance persisted in many people well into times not too far removed from today. There were others who, even though they had lost their clairvoyant abilities, still developed skills for engaging with the physical world, driven by feelings and emotions that echoed those clairvoyant experiences. Moreover, the Atlantean oracles had their counterparts in the new civilization.
There were everywhere Mysteries, but in them that Mystery of Initiation was most cultivated, which leads to the unveiling of that part of the spirit-world which Ahriman keeps hidden. The spiritual powers existing behind the forces of nature were here revealed. In the mythologies of European nations are contained the remnants of what the Initiates of these Mysteries were able to disclose to men. It is true that these mythologies also contain the other kind of mystery, although in a more imperfect form than that possessed by the Southern and Eastern Mysteries. Superhuman beings were also known in Europe, but they were seen to be in perpetual conflict with the associates of Lucifer. And the Light-God too was proclaimed, but in such a form that it was doubtful whether he would overcome Lucifer. On the other hand, these Mysteries were illuminated by the figure of the coming Christ. It was announced of Him that His kingdom would replace that of the other Light-God.25
There were mysteries everywhere, but the one focused on initiation was the most developed. It leads to revealing that part of the spirit world that Ahriman keeps hidden. The spiritual powers behind nature’s forces were unveiled here. European mythologies contain remnants of what the initiates of these mysteries were able to share with humanity. It's true that these mythologies also hold another type of mystery, though in a less complete form than that found in the Southern and Eastern Mysteries. Superhuman beings were known in Europe, but they were seen as constantly battling the followers of Lucifer. The Light-God was also acknowledged, but it was uncertain if he would defeat Lucifer. Conversely, these mysteries were highlighted by the figure of the coming Christ. It was proclaimed that His kingdom would take over that of the other Light-God.25
From such influences as these, there came about a cleavage in the soul of the people of the fifth epoch of civilization which still continues, and is manifest in most diverse phenomena. The soul had not retained, from ancient times a sufficiently strong attraction for spiritual things to enable it to hold fast [pg 273] the connection between the worlds of spirit and sense. The attraction existed only as a training of feeling and emotion, not as direct vision of the spiritual world. On the other hand, man's attention was more and more directed toward the world of the senses and its conquest; and the intellectual powers which had been awakened in the latter part of the Atlantean period, all those human powers of which the physical brain is the instrument, were concentrated upon the sense-world, and upon gaining knowledge of and mastery over it. Two worlds, so to speak, were developed within man: the one directed toward the life of physical sense; the other susceptible to the revelation of the spirit in such a way as to permeate with feeling and emotion even though lacking clairvoyant vision. The tendency to this cleavage of soul already existed when the teaching concerning the Christ was introduced into Europe.
Due to influences like these, a split emerged in the soul of the people during the fifth era of civilization, which still continues and is evident in many different forms. The soul had not maintained, from ancient times, a strong enough connection to spiritual matters to keep the link between the worlds of spirit and physical reality. This connection existed only as a development of feelings and emotions, not as a direct perception of the spiritual world. Meanwhile, people's focus increasingly shifted toward the sensory world and its mastery; the intellectual abilities that had been awakened in the later part of the Atlantean period—those human faculties that the physical brain facilitates—became concentrated on the sensory world, seeking knowledge and control over it. Two distinct worlds emerged within individuals: one geared toward sensory life, and the other open to experiences of the spirit, capable of being influenced by feelings and emotions, even without clairvoyant insight. The inclination toward this soul split was already present when the teachings about Christ were introduced in Europe.
This message from the spiritual world was received into men's hearts, and permeated feeling and emotion; but it was not possible to bridge the gulf between this state of devotion and what human intelligence, concentrated on the sense-world, was learning in the sphere of physical existence. What is now known as the contradiction between external science and spiritual knowledge is simply a consequence of this fact. The Christian mysticism (of Eckhart, Tauler and others) is the result of Christianity becoming permeated with feeling and emotion. Science, occupied as it is exclusively with the world of sense and its results in life, is the consequence [pg 274] of the other tendency of the soul, and all achievements in the sphere of outer material civilization are entirely due to this divergence of tendencies. Since those human faculties, of which the brain is the instrument, were concentrated exclusively on physical life, they were able to reach that pitch of perfection which makes contemporary science, technical skill, and other forms of mental activity possible. Such a material civilization could originate only among the nations of Europe, for they are those descendants of Atlantean ancestors who converted their natural inclination toward the physical sense-world into faculties only when it had reached a certain degree of maturity. Previously they had allowed it to lie dormant, and had lived on what remained in them of the Atlantean clairvoyance and on the communications of their Initiates. While mental culture was outwardly almost entirely given up to these influences, in them ripened slowly the desire for the material conquest of the world.
This message from the spiritual world touched people's hearts and influenced their feelings and emotions; however, it was impossible to bridge the gap between this state of devotion and what human understanding, focused on the physical world, was discovering in the realm of tangible existence. What’s now recognized as the contradiction between external science and spiritual knowledge is simply a result of this reality. The Christian mysticism of thinkers like Eckhart, Tauler, and others emerged from Christianity being infused with feeling and emotion. Science, which is solely focused on the sensory world and its outcomes in life, stems from another aspect of the soul, and all advancements in the realm of outer material civilization are entirely due to this divergence in tendencies. Since the human faculties, with the brain as their tool, were focused entirely on physical life, they were able to achieve the level of excellence that enables modern science, technical skill, and other forms of intellectual activity. Such material civilization could only develop among the nations of Europe, as they are the descendants of Atlantean ancestors who redirected their natural attraction to the physical sense-world into faculties only after it had matured to a certain point. Previously, they allowed it to lie dormant, relying on what was left of their Atlantean clairvoyance and the teachings of their Initiates. While intellectual culture was largely given over to these influences, the desire for material conquest of the world slowly grew within them.
Now, however, the dawn of the sixth post-Atlantean era of civilization is already at hand. What is to arise at a certain time in human evolution has ripened slowly in the preceding age. The first beginnings of that which can even now be developed, is to be discovered in the thread which binds together the two tendencies of the human breast, material civilization and life in the spiritual world. To this end it is necessary, on the one hand, that the results of spiritual vision should be understood; and on the other, that in the observations and experiences of [pg 275] of the sense-world the revelations of the Spirit be recognized. The sixth civilization-epoch will bring to full development the harmony between the two.
Now, however, the dawn of the sixth post-Atlantean era of civilization is already upon us. What is meant to emerge at a certain point in human evolution has developed gradually in the previous age. The initial signs of what can even now be actualized can be found in the connection between the two inclinations of the human heart: material civilization and life in the spiritual world. To achieve this, it is essential that, on one hand, the insights from spiritual vision are understood; and on the other hand, that we recognize the spirit’s revelations in our observations and experiences of the sensory world. The sixth civilization era will fully develop the harmony between the two.
Herewith the studies in this book have reached a point where we may turn from the perspectives of the past to those of the future. But it will be better to precede the latter by a study of the Knowledge of Higher Worlds and of Initiation. Then, after this study and in connection with it, we shall be able to indicate in brief the outlook for the future, in so far as that can be done within the framework of this book.
Here, the studies in this book have reached a point where we can shift from looking at the past to considering the future. However, it would be better to first explore the Knowledge of Higher Worlds and Initiation. After this exploration and in relation to it, we will be able to briefly outline the outlook for the future, as much as can be done within the limits of this book.
Chapter V. Understanding the Higher Worlds
At the present stage of evolution there are three possible conditions of soul in which man ordinarily lives his life between birth and death: waking, sleeping and, between the two, dreaming. The last-mentioned will be briefly dealt with in a later part of this book; for the moment we shall consider life simply as it alternates between its two main conditions—waking and sleeping. Before he can “know” for himself in higher worlds, man has to add to these two a third condition of soul.
At this point in our evolution, there are three main states of the soul in which people live their lives between birth and death: waking, sleeping, and, in between, dreaming. We'll touch on dreaming later in this book; for now, let's look at life as it shifts between the two primary states—waking and sleeping. Before a person can “know” for themselves in higher realms, they need to develop a third state of the soul.
During waking life the soul is given up to the impressions of the senses, and to the thoughts and pictures that these evoke in it. During sleep the senses cease to make any impression, and the soul loses consciousness. The whole of the day's experience sinks down into the sea of unconsciousness. Let us now consider how it would be if man were able to become conscious during sleep, notwithstanding that all impressions of the senses were completely obliterated, as they are in deep sleep. Now would any memory remain to him of what had happened while he was awake. Would his soul find [pg 277] itself in a state of vacuity? Would it be incapable of having any experiences? This is a question that can only be answered if conditions like or similar to those under discussion can actually be brought about. If the soul is capable of experiencing anything, even when sense-activities and recollection of such activities are lacking, then that soul would, so far as the external world is concerned, be “asleep”; and yet the soul would not be sleeping but awake to a world of reality.
During awake time, the soul is tuned into sensory impressions and the thoughts and images they trigger. When we sleep, our senses stop making any impressions, and the soul becomes unconscious. All of the day’s experiences fade into the depths of unconsciousness. Now, let’s think about what it would be like if a person could be conscious during sleep, even when all sensory impressions were completely absent, as they are during deep sleep. Would they remember anything from when they were awake? Would their soul find itself in a state of emptiness? Would it be unable to have any experiences? This question can only be answered if we can actually create conditions like those we are discussing. If the soul can have experiences, even without sensory activities or memories of those activities, then that soul would, as far as the external world is concerned, be "sleeping"; yet, the soul would not be sleeping but awake to a reality beyond.
Now such a condition of consciousness can be attained if man makes these psychic experiences possible toward which occult science guides him. And everything that occult science tells us about those worlds beyond the sensible, has been found through such a condition of consciousness.
Now, this state of awareness can be achieved if a person makes these psychic experiences possible, guided by what occult science teaches. Everything that occult science reveals about those realms beyond our senses has been discovered through this state of awareness.
In the foregoing parts of this book certain communications have been made concerning the higher worlds; and in the following pages, as far as is possible in a book of this kind, methods will be discussed whereby the state of consciousness requisite for such investigations may be acquired. This state of consciousness resembles that of sleep, in only one respect, namely: that through it, all outward sense activity ceases, and also all thoughts that might be aroused by the action of the senses, are obliterated. But although the soul has no power to experience anything consciously in sleep, yet it receives this power through this very state of consciousness. And through it a capacity for experiencing is awakened in the soul which in every day life can be awakened [pg 278] only through sense impressions. The awakening of the soul to this higher state of consciousness is called Initiation.
In the earlier parts of this book, we've discussed certain insights about the higher worlds; in the following pages, we'll explore methods for achieving the state of consciousness needed for these investigations as much as possible in a book like this. This state of consciousness is similar to sleep in one way: all external sensory activity stops, and any thoughts triggered by sensory experiences are completely erased. However, even though the soul can't consciously experience anything while in sleep, it gains that ability through this state of consciousness. This state awakens a capacity for experience in the soul that can only be activated in everyday life through sensory impressions. The awakening of the soul to this higher state of consciousness is referred to as Kickoff.
The methods of initiation lead man away from the state of ordinary day-consciousness into such a soul activity as enables him to use his spiritual organs of perception. Like germs these organs lie dormant in the soul and must be developed. Now it may be that a person, at some particular moment of his earthly life, makes the discovery that these higher organs have developed within his soul without previous preparation. It is a kind of involuntary self-awakening. Such a person will become conscious of a change affecting his entire being; his soul's experiences will have been enriched beyond measure and he will find that no experiences of the sense-world can bring him such spiritual happiness, such soul satisfaction and inner warmth as that which now opens up to him, which no physical eye can see and no hand can touch. From the spiritual world strength and a sense of security in all situations in life, will flow into his will. There are instances of such self-initiation; but they should not give rise to the idea that the only right course is to wait for the coming of such self-initiation, and to do nothing toward bringing about initiation through regular training. We need not here give further space to the subject of self-initiation, since it may take place without regard to rules of any kind whatsoever.
The methods of initiation take a person away from regular day-to-day awareness into a state of inner activity that allows them to use their spiritual senses. Like dormant seeds, these senses lie inactive within the soul and need to be cultivated. There may come a time when someone realizes that these higher senses have developed within them without any prior preparation. It’s like an involuntary awakening. This person will become aware of a shift in their entire existence; their soul’s experiences will have become immensely richer, and they will discover that no experiences in the physical world can provide the same spiritual joy, soul satisfaction, and inner warmth as what is now available to them—something that cannot be seen or touched by any physical means. From the spiritual realm, strength and a sense of security in all situations will flow into their will. There are cases of such self-initiation, but they shouldn't suggest that the only correct path is to wait for such an awakening and do nothing to create initiation through regular practice. We won't elaborate further on self-initiation here, as it can occur without adhering to any specific rules.
What we have to consider is how by training, one [pg 279] may develop those organs of perception, lying dormant in the Soul. Those who do not feel themselves especially impelled toward doing something for their own development may easily say that man stands under the guidance of spiritual powers, that such guidance should therefore not be interfered with, and that the moment, deemed by those powers to be the right one for revealing another world to the soul, should be awaited in patience. Indeed, persons who are of this opinion are inclined to consider it a kind of presumption, or unjustifiable desire for any one to interfere with the wisdom of such spiritual guidance.
What we need to think about is how, through training, one [pg 279] can develop those dormant organs of perception within the Soul. Those who don’t feel particularly driven to improve themselves might easily argue that people are guided by spiritual powers, and that this guidance shouldn’t be interrupted. They believe we should patiently wait for the moment that these powers deem right for revealing another world to the soul. In fact, those who hold this view often see it as arrogant or unreasonable for anyone to interfere with the wisdom of such spiritual guidance.
Those who think in this way will only change their opinion if some other mode of presenting the case makes a sufficiently strong impression upon them. If they were to say to themselves, “This wise guidance has endowed me with certain faculties, and it has done so, not that I should let them lie idle, but rather that I should use them. Indeed, the very wisdom of such guidance lies in the fact of its having placed in me the rudiments of those organs necessary for a higher state of consciousness. I can, therefore, rightly comprehend this guidance only when I regard it as my duty to do everything in my power that may serve to bring such rudimentary growths to their proper development.” Should such thoughts make a sufficiently strong impression on the mind, scruples against training for the attainment of higher consciousness will disappear.
Those who think this way will only change their minds if another way of presenting the situation makes a strong enough impact on them. If they were to tell themselves, “This wise guidance has given me certain abilities, and it hasn't done so for me to waste them, but rather to use them. In fact, the real wisdom of this guidance is that it has provided me with the fundamentals needed for a higher state of consciousness. Therefore, I can only fully grasp this guidance if I see it as my responsibility to do everything I can to help these basic skills grow correctly.” If such thoughts impact the mind strongly enough, any hesitation about training for higher consciousness will fade away.
There is, it is true, another scruple which may [pg 280] arise in the mind with regard to such schooling. A person may say to himself: “This development of the inner faculties of the soul means an invasion of man's most hidden sanctuary. It involves a certain change of the entire human being: the method for such a change cannot be worked out by any ordinary procedure of thought, for the manner in which the higher worlds are attained can be known only to those to whom the path has become visible by reason of experience. If, therefore, I turn to such an one, I am allowing him to exercise his influence over the innermost sanctuary of my soul.” Any one given to this attitude of mind will hardly find it reassuring if the methods for bringing about a higher state of consciousness are imparted to him in book form. For it is not a question of receiving communications either verbally or from some person who, having the knowledge, has set the same down in a book to which we have access. Now there are people possessing knowledge of the rules for developing the spiritual organs of perception who are of the opinion that these rules ought not to be entrusted to a book. These people, for the most part, consider the communication of certain truths relating to the spiritual world as forbidden. But this view must be characterized as in a certain sense out of date in view of the present stage of human evolution. It is true that the communication of the rules referred to can be made only up to a certain point. Yet what is imparted leads so far that one who applies it to his soul-life makes such progress in [pg 281] knowledge that he is able to go on by himself. This way then leads onward in a manner of which a true idea can be gained only through what has been previously experienced. From all these facts, scruples may arise concerning the path of spiritual knowledge.
There is, indeed, another hesitation that might come to mind regarding this kind of education. A person might think to themselves: "This development of the inner abilities of the soul means stepping into the most personal part of a person. It requires a significant transformation of the entire human being: this transformation can't be accomplished through regular thinking, as the path to higher realms is only known to those who have experienced it. So, if I seek guidance from someone like that, I’m permitting them to impact the deepest part of my soul." Anyone with this mindset will hardly feel comforted if the methods for achieving a higher state of consciousness are presented to them in a book. It’s not about receiving information either verbally or from someone who knows and has written it down in a book we can read. There are people who understand the rules for developing the spiritual senses who believe these rules shouldn’t be put in writing. Most of these individuals view the sharing of certain truths about the spiritual realm as forbidden. However, this perspective can be seen as somewhat outdated given where humanity stands today in its evolution. While it’s true that the communication of the mentioned rules can only go so far, what’s taught is sufficient that anyone who applies it to their spiritual life will make enough progress to continue on their own. This path then leads onward in a way that can only be fully understood through past experiences. Because of all this, doubts may arise about the journey of spiritual knowledge.
These scruples however disappear when one clearly understands the essential nature of that course of development which is adapted to our age. Of this latter method of developing we shall speak here and other methods will be only briefly referred to.
These doubts, however, fade away when you fully grasp the fundamental nature of the developmental path suited to our time. We'll discuss this method of development here, while other methods will only be mentioned briefly.
The method of training to be here discussed furnishes to him who has the will for a higher development, the means for accomplishing the transformation of his soul. Any questionable encroachment on the personality of the student would only then be possible, should the teacher proceed to carry out the change by methods of which the pupil was not conscious. But no true teacher of occult science in our day would make use of any such method, by which indeed, the pupil would be reduced to a blind tool. The teacher gives his pupil instructions as to the rules of conduct he is to pursue, and the pupil carries them out. At the same time, should the case seem to demand it, the teacher does not withhold the reasons justifying these rules of conduct.
The method of training we'll discuss here provides anyone who is willing to pursue higher development with the means to transform their soul. Any questionable interference with a student's personality would only be possible if a teacher attempted to make changes through methods that the student was unaware of. However, no genuine teacher of occult science today would use such methods, which would ultimately reduce the student to a mindless tool. The teacher gives the student clear instructions on the conduct they should follow, and the student puts these instructions into practice. At the same time, if necessary, the teacher does not hesitate to explain the reasons behind these rules of conduct.
The acceptance of the rules, and their application by a person seeking spiritual development, need not be a matter of blind belief. Such a belief ought to be quite out of the question in this sphere. One [pg 282] who studies the nature of the human soul as far as it can be followed by ordinary self-observation, without occult training may, after accepting the rules recommended for spiritual training, ask himself, “How do these rules act upon the life of the soul?” This question may be satisfactorily answered previous to any schooling by an unbiased use of common sense. Before these rules are adopted, true conceptions may be gained as to the way in which they operate. The effect can be experienced only during training, but even then the experience will always be accompanied by an understanding of the experience, if each step that is to be taken is tested by sound judgment. And in this age any true spiritual science will only suggest such rules for training as can be vindicated by sound judgment. For him who is willing to simply trust himself to such schooling and does not permit prejudice to drive him into blind faith, all scruples will vanish and objections against a regular training for higher states of consciousness will no longer disturb him.
Accepting the rules and applying them for spiritual growth doesn’t have to be about blind faith. Such faith should be completely out of the question in this area. A person who observes the nature of the human soul through ordinary self-reflection, without any special training, can ask after accepting the recommended rules for spiritual practice, "How do these rules influence the soul's journey?" This question can be answered satisfactorily even before any formal education by using common sense objectively. Before adopting these rules, one can gain a clear idea of how they work. The effects can be experienced during training, but even then, the experience will always come with an understanding of it, as long as each step is assessed with good judgment. In today’s world, any genuine spiritual practice will only propose rules for training that can be justified by sound reasoning. For those willing to trust in such training and who don’t allow bias to push them into vision impaired faith, all doubts will fade away, and objections to systematic training for higher states of consciousness will no longer trouble them.
Even such people as may have arrived at a state of inward maturity,—which sooner or later would lead to the self-awakening of these spiritual organs of perception—even for these, training is by no means superfluous. On the contrary it is especially adapted to them. For there are but few cases in which personal initiation does not have to travel along tortuous and devious ways, and training spares them the traversing of such by-paths, leading them forward in a straight line. In cases where [pg 283] such self-initiation comes to a soul, the reason is that the required degree of ripeness had already been attained in the course of previous incarnations.
Even people who have reached a level of inner maturity—which would eventually lead to the awakening of their spiritual perception—still benefit from training. In fact, it is particularly suited for them. There are very few instances where personal initiation doesn’t involve winding and complex paths, and training helps them avoid these detours, guiding them forward in a straight line. When self-initiation happens for a soul, it's because they’ve already reached the necessary level of maturity during previous lifetimes.
It may easily happen that such a soul possesses a certain dim intuition of its ripeness, and by reason of this very feeling may assume an attitude of disinclination toward training. A feeling of this kind may produce a certain degree of pride, which refuses to place confidence in a teacher. Now it can happen that a certain degree of soul development may remain hidden up to a certain age and only then reveal itself. But such schooling may be just the very means needed to call it forth. Should the person hold aloof from such training, it may happen that the power will remain dormant during that particular Life, and will only reappear in a later incarnation.
It can easily happen that a person has a vague sense of their own potential, and because of this feeling, they might become resistant to learning. This kind of attitude can create a level of pride that prevents them from trusting a teacher. It's possible that some level of personal growth might stay hidden until a certain age and only then come to light. However, that kind of education might be exactly what is needed to bring it out. If the individual avoids such training, they might lose the chance to develop those abilities in this lifetime, and they could only show up again in a future incarnation.
The rising to a supersensible state of consciousness can only proceed from ordinary waking day-consciousness. It is in this consciousness that the soul lives prior to its ascent, and schooling will furnish the means to lead it out of this consciousness. The first steps which the schooling here under consideration prescribes, are such as can still be characterized as actions of the ordinary day-consciousness. It is just those quiet acts of the soul which are the most effective steps. This requires that the soul should give itself up to definite perceptions and these perceptions are such as are able by their very nature to exercise an awakening influence upon certain hidden faculties of the inner nature of man.
The shift to a higher state of awareness can only happen from our regular waking consciousness. It’s in this state that the soul exists before it elevates, and education will provide the way to guide it beyond this awareness. The initial steps that this education suggests can still be seen as actions of everyday consciousness. It’s those subtle acts of the soul that are the most powerful. This means the soul must surrender to specific perceptions, and these perceptions have the innate ability to awaken certain hidden abilities within our inner nature.
They thereby differ from those perceptions of waking day-life, whose purpose is to portray external objects. The more faithfully they present these things, the truer they are. It is, indeed, in accordance with their nature that they should be true in this sense, but this is not the mission of those perceptions which the soul is to consider, when in pursuit of spiritual training; and they are therefore so formed as not to present anything external, having rather within themselves the power to act upon the soul. The best percepts for the purpose are the emblematic or symbolic ones. Yet other percepts may be used. For it does not depend at all on what the percepts contain, but solely on the fact that the soul puts forth all its powers in order not to have anything in the consciousness except the one percept in question. Whereas, in ordinary life, its forces are divided among many things and perceptions change rapidly, the important point in spiritual training is the concentration of the whole inner life upon one single perception. And this perception must be voluntarily brought to the centre of one's consciousness. Symbolic perceptions are better than those which reflect outer objects or events, because the latter are related to the outer world, and the soul has to depend less on itself than in the case of symbolic perceptions, formed by its own inner energy. The chief object at which to aim is the intensity of the force to be exercised by the soul. It is not what is before the soul that is essential, but the greatness of the effort and the length of time spent concentrating upon one [pg 285] perception. Strength ascends from unknown depths of the soul, from which it is drawn up by concentration on one perception. Occult science contains many such perceptions, all of which have been proven to possess the power alluded to above.
They differ from those perceptions of everyday life, which aim to depict external objects. The more accurately they represent these things, the truer they are. This aligns with their nature to be true in this sense, but this isn’t the goal of the perceptions the soul should focus on during spiritual training; instead, they are designed not to present anything external, possessing the power to influence the soul from within. The best types of perceptions for this purpose are emblematic or symbolic ones, although other perceptions can also be used. It doesn't matter what the perceptions include; it solely depends on the soul channeling all its energy to focus on just one perception. In everyday life, its energies are split among many things and perceptions shift quickly, but the key in spiritual training is concentrating all inner life on a single perception. This perception must be intentionally brought to the forefront of one’s consciousness. Symbolic perceptions are more effective than those that reflect external objects or events, because the latter are tied to the outside world, requiring the soul to rely less on itself compared to symbolic perceptions created from its own inner strength. The primary goal is the intensity of the force exerted by the soul. What matters is not what is in front of the soul, but the magnitude of the effort and the duration of concentration on one perception. Strength emerges from the unknown depths of the soul, drawn upward through focused attention on one perception. Occult science contains many such perceptions, all of which have been shown to possess the power mentioned earlier.
One gains a comprehension of this immersion or sinking down into a percept by calling the Memory-Concept before the soul. Say, for instance, that we allow the eye to rest on a tree, and then turn away from the object so that it is no longer presented to our sight; we shall, nevertheless, be able to retain the image of the tree in the soul. Now this image or perception of the tree which we have when it is no longer in sight, is a recollection of the tree. Then assume that this recollection is retained in the soul, and the soul reposes, as it were, in this recollection, taking care to exclude all other perceptions from the memory. The soul then dwells in that memory-concept of the tree, and we then have to do with the immersion of the soul into a concept. Yet this concept is the image of an actual thing perceived through the senses. If however, of our own free will, we take such images into our consciousness, gradually the effect desired will be attained.
One understands this immersion or sinking into a perception by calling the Memory-Concept to mind. For example, if we focus our eyes on a tree and then look away, so that it’s no longer in our sight, we can still keep the image of the tree in our mind. This image or perception of the tree that we have when it’s out of sight is a recollection of the tree. Now, suppose this recollection remains in the mind, and the mind relaxes in this recollection, making sure to exclude all other perceptions from memory. The mind then lives in that memory-concept of the tree, and we are dealing with the immersion of the mind into a concept. Yet, this concept is the image of an actual thing that was perceived through the senses. If, however, we choose to bring such images into our awareness, we will gradually achieve the desired effect.
One example of meditation based upon a symbolical concept will now be placed before the reader. Such a concept must first be built up in the soul, and this may be done in the following manner. Let us think of a plant, calling to mind how it is rooted in the ground, the way in which leaf after leaf shoots forth, until finally the blossom unfolds. And then [pg 286] let us imagine a human being placed beside this plant, and let us call up in our soul the thought that he has qualities and characteristics which, when compared with those of the plant, will be found to be more perfect. We dwell on the fact that this being is able to move here and there, according to his will and his desires, while the plant remains stationary, rooted in the soil.
One example of meditation based on a symbolic concept will now be presented to the reader. Such a concept must first be developed in the soul, and this can be done in the following way. Let’s think of a plant, recalling how it is rooted in the ground, how leaf after leaf emerges, until finally the blossom opens. And then [pg 286] let’s imagine a human next to this plant, and let’s evoke the thought in our soul that they have qualities and characteristics which, when compared to those of the plant, are more refined. We reflect on the fact that this being can move freely according to their will and desires, while the plant stays fixed, rooted in the soil.
But now let us also consider: Yes, man is certainly more perfect than the plant; but on the other hand, I find in him qualities which I cannot perceive in the plant and through the lack of which, the plant appears more perfect than man in certain respects. Man is filled with passions and desires and these govern his conduct. With him we can speak of sin committed by reason of his impulses and passions, whereas in the plant, we see that it follows the pure laws of growth from leaf to leaf, and that the blossom without passion opens to the chaste rays of the Sun. So we can see that man possesses a certain perfection beyond the plant, but that on the other hand he has paid for this perfection by admitting into his being inclinations, desires and passions in addition to the pure forces of the plant. And then we call to mind the green sap flowing through the plant, and think of it as the expression of the pure and passionless laws of growth. And then again, we call to mind the red blood as it courses through the veins of man, and we recognize in it an expression of man's instincts, his passions and desires. Let a vivid picture of all this arise in our souls. We then think of man's [pg 287] faculties of development; how he can purify and cleanse his inclinations and passions through his higher soul faculties. We think how through this process something that is low is destroyed in these inclinations and passions which thereby are born upon a higher plane. Then we may be able to think of the blood as the expression of these purified and cleansed inclinations and passions.
But now let’s also think about this: Yes, humans are definitely more advanced than plants; however, I notice traits in humans that I can’t see in plants, which make plants seem more perfect than humans in certain ways. Humans are full of passions and desires that drive their actions. With humans, we can talk about sin arising from their impulses and passions, while in plants, we observe that they follow the pure laws of growth from leaf to leaf, and the flower opens to the gentle rays of the sun without any passion. So, while humans have a certain superiority over plants, they pay for this with the inclusion of inclinations, desires, and passions alongside the pure forces of plants. Then we think of the green sap flowing through plants, viewing it as the embodiment of the pure and passionless laws of growth. We also recall the red blood flowing through human veins, recognizing it as a reflection of human instincts, passions, and desires. Let a vivid image of all this fill our minds. We consider human potential for growth; how they can purify and refine their inclinations and passions through their higher faculties. We realize that through this process, something base is transformed within these inclinations and passions, allowing them to emerge on a higher plane. Then we might think of the blood as the representation of these purified and elevated inclinations and passions.
Now we gaze in spirit on the rose and say to ourselves: “In the red sap of the rose is the erstwhile green sap of the plant—now changed to crimson—and the red rose follows the same pure, passionless laws of growth as does the green leaf.” Thus the red of the rose may offer us a symbol of a kind of blood which is the expression of cleansed impulses and passions, purged of all lower elements, and resembling in their purity the forces working in the red rose. Let us now try not only to assimilate such thoughts within our reason, but also let them come to life within our feelings. We can experience a blissful sensation when contemplating the purity and passionless nature of the growing plant. We can awaken the feeling within us how certain higher perfections must be paid for through the acquisition of passions and desires. This, then, can change the blissful sensation previously experienced into a serious mood: and then only can it stir within us the feeling of liberating happiness, if we abandon ourselves to the thought of the red blood that can become the carrier of inner pure experiences, like the red sap of the rose. The important point is that we [pg 288] should not look coldly and without feeling upon these thoughts which serve to build up such a symbolical concept. After dwelling for a time upon the above mentioned thoughts and feelings, let us try to transmute them into the following symbolical concept. Let us imagine a black cross. Let this be the symbol for the destroyed lower element of our desires and passions and there where the beams of the cross intersect, let us imagine seven red radiating roses arranged in a circle. Let these roses be the symbol for a blood that is the expression of cleansed and purified passions and desires.26
Now we reflect on the rose and tell ourselves: "In the red sap of the rose is the once green sap of the plant—now changed to crimson—and the red rose grows according to the same straightforward, emotionless rules as the green leaf." Thus, the red of the rose can symbolize a type of blood that represents cleansed impulses and passions, stripped of all base elements, and resembling in their purity the forces at work in the red rose. Let’s not only try to understand such thoughts intellectually but also let them resonate within our feelings. We can feel a joyful sensation while appreciating the purity and emotionless nature of the growing plant. We can awaken the understanding that certain higher perfections require us to acquire passions and desires. This can shift the joy we felt earlier into a more serious mood; only then can it stir in us the feeling of liberating happiness if we surrender to the idea of the red blood that can carry inner pure experiences, like the red sap of the rose. The crucial point is that we [pg 288] should not approach these thoughts coldly and without emotion, as they help create such a symbolic concept. After reflecting for a while on these thoughts and feelings, let’s try to transform them into the following symbolic idea. Let’s picture a black cross. Let this symbolize the destroyed lower aspect of our desires and passions, and where the beams of the cross intersect, let’s visualize seven red roses radiating outward in a circle. Let these roses symbolize a blood that expresses cleansed and purified passions and desires.
Now we must call up this symbolical concept before our soul just as has been described in the case of a memory-concept. Such a concept has an awakening power if one abandons oneself to it in inner meditation. One must try during this meditation to exclude all other concepts. Only the described symbol must float before the soul as vividly as possible.
Now we need to bring this symbolic concept to mind just like we did with the memory concept. This concept has the ability to awaken us if we fully engage with it during inner meditation. During this meditation, we should focus solely on this concept and try to push away all other thoughts. Only the symbol we discussed should stay vividly in our minds.
It is not without significance that this symbol has been introduced, not merely as an awakening percept, but because it has been constructed out of certain perceptions concerning plants and man. For the effect of such a symbol depends upon the fact of its [pg 289] being put together in this definite manner, before employing it as an instrument for meditation. Should it be called up without a previous process of construction such as has here been delineated, the picture must remain cold and will be far less effective than if it had by previous preparation gathered force with which to give warmth to the soul. During meditation, however, one should not call up in the soul all the preparatory thoughts, but merely allow the life-like image to float before one's mind and at the same time permit those feelings which are the result of these preparatory thoughts to vibrate with it. Thus the symbol becomes a sign, co-existent with the inner experience. And it is the dwelling of the soul in this experience that is the active principle. The longer one can do this, without admitting disturbing impressions, the more effective will be the whole process.
It's important to note that this symbol has been introduced not just as a triggering idea, but because it has been created from specific perceptions about plants and humanity. The effectiveness of this symbol relies on the way it has been assembled before using it as a tool for meditation. If it’s invoked without the preparatory process that has been described here, the image will feel lifeless and be much less impactful than if it has been built up beforehand, gathering the strength needed to bring warmth to the soul. During meditation, however, you shouldn't focus on all the preparatory thoughts; instead, let the vivid image appear in your mind while allowing the feelings from those preparatory thoughts to resonate along with it. This way, the symbol turns into a sign that coexists with the inner experience. The soul's engagement in this experience is what drives the process. The longer you can maintain this without letting in distracting thoughts, the more effective the whole experience will be.
It is well, however, in addition to the time used in meditation itself, to repeat the building up of the image through the feelings, as described above, so that the corresponding sensation may not pale.
It’s also good, besides the time spent meditating, to revisit the process of creating the image through your feelings, as described above, so that the related sensation doesn't fade.
The greater the patience brought to bear in performing these acts of repetition, the more effective becomes this image for the soul.27
The more patience you put into doing these repetitive actions, the more powerful this image becomes for the soul.27
Such a symbol as has just been described represents no external object or being evolved by nature, but for this very reason it possesses an awakening power for certain inner faculties. It is true, someone may raise the objection: certainly the “whole” as a symbol, does not exist in nature; yet all its details are borrowed from nature, the black color, the roses, etc. It can all be observed through the senses. He who is troubled by such objections, ought to consider that it is not the images of these sense perceptions that awaken the higher faculties of the soul, but that this result is produced purely by the manner in which these details are combined. And this combination does not then picture something that exists in the sense-world.
A symbol like the one just described doesn’t represent any external object or being created by nature, but because of this, it has the power to awaken certain inner abilities. It’s true that someone might argue: the "whole" as a symbol doesn’t exist in nature; however, all its details are taken from nature—the black color, the roses, etc. Everything can be perceived through our senses. Those who are troubled by such objections should recognize that it’s not the images of these sensory perceptions that awaken the higher aspects of the soul, but rather the way these details are combined. And this combination doesn’t depict something that exists in the sensory world.
A symbol was chosen as an example to show the process of effective meditation of the soul. Many symbols of this kind are used in occult training and are built up according to varying methods. Certain sentences, formulæ, and single words can also be given as subjects for meditations, and in every case the means used will have the same object, namely: to detach the soul from sense-impressions and to stimulate it to an activity in which the impressions of the physical senses play no longer any part and in which the unfoldment of inner latent soul capacities becomes the essential.
A symbol was selected as an example to demonstrate the process of effective meditation for the soul. Many symbols like this are used in occult training and are developed through various methods. Certain phrases, formulas, and individual words can also serve as topics for meditation, and in every case, the goal remains the same: to separate the soul from sensory experiences and to encourage it to engage in activities where physical senses no longer matter, allowing the emergence of inner, dormant soul abilities to take precedence.
There are, however, also meditations based exclusively upon feelings, sensations, etc., and these are especially effectual. Let us, for instance, take the feeling of joy. In the normal course of life the soul [pg 291] experiences pleasure when there exists an outer stimulus to pleasure. If a healthily constituted soul perceives some act performed by a person, indicative of the doer's goodness of heart, then the soul will assuredly feel pleasure and joy at such an act. But the soul is able to reflect upon such an act, and can say to itself that an act done from sheer kindness of heart is one in which the doer is following the interests of his fellow-creatures rather than his own, and such an act may be called ethically good. But the soul can lift itself above the perception of any particular case in the outer world which has given it joy or pleasure, and instead may arrive at a general concept of kindness. It can for instance, think of kindness coming into existence through one soul making the interests of others his own. And the soul can then experience joy over the ethical idea of kindness. Therefore, the joy is then not over this or that event of the sense-world, but it is the joy over the idea as such. If the student now tries for some time to let this joy come to life within his soul, then this is a meditation on a feeling, on a sensation. It is then not the idea which is the active principle in the awakening of the inner soul faculties, but the sustained dwelling upon that feeling within the soul which has not been caused by merely a single external impression.
There are, however, also meditations that focus solely on feelings, sensations, etc., and these can be particularly effective. For example, let’s consider the feeling of joy. In everyday life, the soul feels pleasure when there’s external stimulation for it. If a healthy soul observes someone doing a good deed, it will definitely feel happiness and joy from that action. However, the soul can also reflect on that action and recognize that an act done purely out of kindness shows the doer is prioritizing the needs of others over their own, which can be seen as ethically good. The soul is capable of rising above individual instances in the outside world that bring joy or pleasure and can formulate a broader idea of kindness. It can think of kindness as arising when one soul genuinely considers the interests of others. The soul can then find joy in the ethical notion of kindness itself. Thus, the joy is not tied to a specific event in the sensory world, but rather in the idea itself. If the student spends some time nurturing this joy within their soul, it becomes a meditation on a feeling or sensation. In this case, it’s not the idea that triggers the activation of the inner faculties, but the continuous focus on that feeling within the soul that doesn’t arise from just a single external impression.
Occult science being in a position to penetrate far deeper into the being of things than can be done by ordinary perception, the teacher will be able to indicate to the pupil feelings and sentiments which [pg 292] are still more powerful as awakening agents for the unfolding of the soul's faculties when used as subjects of meditation. Yet, necessary as this will be for the higher degrees of training, it should be remembered that energetic meditating upon subjects, such as kindness of heart may carry the student very far on his way.
Occult science can explore deeper aspects of existence than regular perception allows, so the teacher will help the student recognize feelings and emotions that are even stronger catalysts for awakening the soul's abilities when meditated upon. While this will be crucial for advanced training, it’s important to remember that actively meditating on topics like kindness can take the student quite a distance on their journey.
Since the natures of human beings differ, special methods of training are effective for particular individuals. As to the duration of time to be devoted to meditation, we may remind the student that the greater the length of time during which he can meditate uninterruptedly, the stronger will be the effect. But every excess in these matters should be avoided. There is, however, a certain inner discretion, resulting from these exercises themselves which teaches the pupil to keep within due bounds in this regard. Those who pursue their studies in occult science under the personal guidance of a teacher will receive from him precise instruction and advice in these particulars. Nevertheless, it must be emphatically understood that only experienced occultists are in a position to impart such advice.
Since people are all different, specific training methods work better for certain individuals. Regarding how long to meditate, it's important to remember that the longer you can meditate without interruption, the stronger the effects will be. However, it’s crucial to avoid any extremes in this practice. There’s also a certain inner awareness that develops from these exercises which teaches students to stay within appropriate limits. Those studying occult science under a teacher will get clear guidance and advice on these matters. However, it’s essential to understand that only experienced occultists are qualified to offer such advice.
Such exercises in meditation will generally require practice for some time before the student can become aware of any result. What is essential to occult science is patience and perseverance. He who is unable to awaken these two qualities within himself and who cannot continually practice his exercises in quietude, so that patience and perseverance are always the predominant note in his soul-life, cannot [pg 293] attain very great progress. From what has been said above, the reader will have gathered that meditation is a means of acquiring knowledge of the higher worlds, but he will also see that not just any percept whatsoever, taken at random, is productive of this result, but only those of the kind before-mentioned.
Such meditation exercises usually need some practice before a student notices any results. What's crucial for occult science is patience and perseverance. If someone can't cultivate these two qualities within themselves and fails to consistently practice their exercises in stillness, so that patience and perseverance are always dominant in their inner life, they won't make much progress. From what has been discussed, the reader should understand that meditation is a way to gain knowledge of higher realms, but it’s important to note that not just any perception taken randomly will lead to this outcome; only the specific kinds mentioned earlier will do so. [pg 293]
The path here indicated leads in the first place to what is called imaginative knowledge, and this is the first step toward the higher knowledge. Knowledge, dependent upon sense-perceptions and upon the working up of such perceptions by reason, which is sense-bound, is, to use the occult term, known as “objective cognition.” Beyond this are higher degrees of knowledge, the imaginative stage being, as we have said, the first. Now the term “imaginative” can cause confusion in the minds of some, to whom “imagination” stands only for “imaginings”—that is concepts that lack reality. In occult science, however, “imaginative” cognition must be understood to be that kind of cognition which results from a supersensible state of consciousness of the soul. The things perceived in this state of consciousness are spiritual facts, and spiritual beings, to which the senses have no access, and—since this condition of the soul is caused by meditating upon symbols, or “imaginations”—the sphere to which this condition of higher consciousness belongs may be termed the imaginative world, and the knowledge relating to it, imaginative knowledge. “Imaginative” stands, therefore, in this sense, for that which [pg 294] is “actual” in a higher sense than are the facts and beings of physical sense-perception.
The path outlined here leads initially to what is known as imaginative knowledge, which is the first step toward higher knowledge. Knowledge that relies on sensory perceptions and the processing of these perceptions through reason, which is limited to the senses, is referred to with the occult term “objective understanding.” Beyond this, there are higher levels of knowledge, with the imaginative stage being, as we've mentioned, the first. The term creative can confuse some people, as they might equate "creativity" only with "imaginations"—essentially concepts that aren’t grounded in reality. In occult science, however, "creative" cognition refers to a type of understanding that arises from a supersensible state of consciousness of the soul. The things perceived in this state of consciousness are spiritual truths and spiritual beings that sensory perception cannot access. Since this state of the soul is triggered by meditating on symbols, or “creativity”, this higher state of consciousness can be considered the imaginative world, and the knowledge associated with it, imaginative knowledge. Thus, creative denotes what is [pg 294] “actual” in a higher sense than the facts and beings of physical sensory perception.
A very natural objection to the use of the symbolic pictures here characterized is that they arise from a dreamy thinking and an arbitrary imagination, and might therefore have doubtful consequences. But any such doubts are unjustified in regard to the symbols given by true occult schools. For these symbols are chosen in such a way that they can be looked at quite apart from their connection with outer sense reality, and their value is to be found exclusively in the power with which they work upon the soul when it turns its attention wholly away from the outer world, when it suppresses all sense-impressions and shuts out every thought to which it might be stimulated from without. The process of meditations is best demonstrated by comparison with sleep. In one respect it is like the state of sleep; in another, the exact opposite of it. It is a sleep which when compared to the day-consciousness, represents a higher state of being. The point is that by concentration on the given conception or image, the soul is obliged to call up much stronger forces out of its own depths than it uses in ordinary life or knowledge. Its inner activity is thereby enhanced. It becomes detached from the body, as it does in sleep; but instead of passing, as in the latter case, into unconsciousness, it experiences a world it did not know before. Although as regards detachment from the body this condition may be compared with sleep, yet it is such that, compared with ordinary [pg 295] waking consciousness, it may be characterized as a more intense waking state. By this means the soul learns to know itself in its true, inner, independent being. But in ordinary life, owing to the weaker development of its forces, it is only with the help of the body that the soul arrives at self-consciousness. Therefore it does not experience itself but merely sees itself in that image which—like a kind of reflection—is traced, by the physical body (or, properly speaking, by its processes).
A common objection to using the symbolic images described here is that they come from fanciful thinking and arbitrary imagination, which could lead to questionable outcomes. However, any such concerns are unfounded when it comes to the symbols presented by genuine occult schools. These symbols are selected in a way that allows them to be appreciated independently of their connection to external reality, and their worth is found solely in their ability to influence the soul when it completely turns its focus away from the outside world, suppresses all sensory experiences, and blocks out any external thoughts that might arise. The process of meditation is best understood by comparing it to sleep. In one way, it resembles sleep; in another, it is the exact opposite. It is a state that, when viewed next to everyday consciousness, represents a higher state of existence. The key is that by concentrating on a specific concept or image, the soul is compelled to tap into much stronger forces from within than it does in typical life or knowledge. This enhances its inner activity. It becomes detached from the body, similar to what happens in sleep; but rather than sinking into unconsciousness, it discovers a realm it has never encountered before. Although this state can be compared to sleep in terms of detachment from the body, it is more accurately described as a more intense state of wakefulness when contrasted with regular waking consciousness. This process allows the soul to understand itself in its true, inner, independent essence. However, in ordinary life, due to its less developed forces, the soul can only reach self-awareness with the help of the body. Therefore, it only perceives itself through the image that is formed as a kind of reflection traced by the physical body (or, more accurately, by its processes).
These symbols built up in the manner above described are not as yet related to anything real in the spiritual world, but they serve to detach the human soul from sense-observations and from that instrument, the brain, to which the reason is at first fettered. This detachment is not effected until man is able to feel: “I am now perceiving something by means of powers for which neither my senses nor my brain serve as the instruments”; and the first thing man thus experiences is a liberation from the organs of sense. He is then able to say to himself: “My consciousness does not vanish when I cease to take cognizance of sense-perceptions and ordinary reasoned thought; I can lift myself out of those conditions and then feel myself as a being alongside of that which I was before”—and this is the first purely spiritual experience; the perception of a psycho-spiritual Ego-being. This has arisen as a new self out of that self which is linked to the physical senses and physical reason only.
These symbols created in the way described above are not yet linked to anything real in the spiritual world, but they help to separate the human soul from sensory observations and from the brain, which initially confines reason. This separation doesn't happen until a person can feel: "I’m now sensing something through abilities that neither my senses nor my brain can measure."; and the first thing a person experiences in this way is a release from the sensory organs. They can then tell themselves: "My awareness doesn't go away when I'm no longer aware of sensory perceptions and typical reasoning; I can rise above those states and recognize myself as a being different from who I was before."—and this is the first purely spiritual experience; the awareness of a psycho-spiritual Ego-being. This has emerged as a new self from the self that is only connected to physical senses and physical reason.
Had this detachment from the world of the senses [pg 296] and from the reason been effected without meditation, the person would have lapsed into the nothingness of the unconscious state. This psycho-spiritual being was our possession prior to meditation also, but it then lacked the organs for perception of the spirit-world; and it might, indeed, have been compared to the physical body without the eye to see—the ear to hear. The strength thus employed in meditation has, in fact, been the creative means by which these psycho-spiritual organs have been formed out of a previously unorganized psycho-spiritual being. But this which man thus creates for himself is also the first thing to be perceived by him. The first experience is therefore in a certain sense, a kind of “self-perception.” It belongs to the nature of spiritual training that the soul, through the self training which it gives itself at this point of its development, becomes fully conscious that the first thing it perceives in the world of imaginative forms, which appear as a result of the exercises described, is itself. It is true that these images make their appearance as a new world, but the soul must recognize that they are, however, at first nothing but the reflection of its own being, which has been strengthened by exercises. And it must not only recognize this by correct reasoning, but must have arrived at such a cultivation of the will that it is able at any time to put away and obliterate the images from the consciousness.
Having separated from the sensory world and from reason, without meditation, a person would fall into a state of unconsciousness. This psycho-spiritual essence was ours before meditation too, but it didn't yet have the ability to perceive the spirit world; it could be likened to a physical body without eyes to see or ears to hear. The effort used in meditation has actually been the creative force that shaped these psycho-spiritual faculties from an unorganized psycho-spiritual state. What one creates in this way is also the first thing they perceive. The initial experience is, in a sense, a kind of “self-perception.” As a part of spiritual development, the soul, through the self-training it undertakes at this stage, becomes fully aware that the first thing it perceives in the imaginative forms resulting from these exercises is itself. While these images may seem like a new world, the soul must recognize that they are initially just reflections of its own being, which has been enhanced through practice. It must not only understand this through reasoning but also cultivate its will to the point where it can discard these images from consciousness whenever it chooses.
The soul must be able to act with complete independence within these images. This is part of true [pg 297] spiritual training at this stage. If it could not do this, it would be in the same position, in the sphere of spiritual experiences, as a soul in the physical world which, on looking at an object, has its attention so arrested by it that it cannot look away. An exception to this possibility of obliteration is formed by a group of inner imaginative experiences which should not be extinguished at this stage of spiritual training. They correspond to the inmost kernel of the soul's being, and the occult student recognizes in those images that which forms the very essence of his being which passes through the various repeated earth lives. At this point the knowledge of repeated earth lives becomes an actual experience. In relation to everything else the before-mentioned independence of experience must prevail. And only after acquiring the faculty of obliterating experiences, is the spiritual outer world really approached. What is obliterated returns in another form, and is experienced as a spiritual outer reality. One feels that out of something indefinite one grows psychically into something definite. From this self-perception, one must then proceed to the observation of a psycho-spiritual outer world. This comes to pass when we can order our inner experience after the manner to be indicated in the following pages.
The soul needs to be able to act completely independently within these images. This is part of genuine spiritual training at this stage. If it couldn’t do this, it would be like a soul in the physical world that is so captivated by an object it can’t look away. An exception to this possibility of being overwhelmed is a group of inner imaginative experiences that should not be extinguished at this stage of spiritual training. They correspond to the innermost core of the soul's being, and the occult student recognizes in those images what forms the essence of their being that passes through various lives on Earth. At this point, the knowledge of past lives becomes a real experience. In relation to everything else, the previously mentioned independence of experience must take precedence. Only after developing the ability to let go of certain experiences can one truly approach the spiritual outer world. What is let go returns in another form and is experienced as a spiritual outer reality. One senses that from something vague, one psychically grows into something clear. From this self-awareness, one must then move to observing a psycho-spiritual outer world. This occurs when we can organize our inner experiences as will be detailed in the following pages.
At first, the soul of the occult student is feeble in all that appertains to a perception of the psycho-spiritual world; and he will therefore need all the inner energy he can summon in order, while meditating, to hold firm the symbols or other concepts which [pg 298] he has built up from the impulses of the sense-world. Should he, however, desire to attain to an actual observation of the higher world, he will not alone have to maintain his hold on these, he must also, after having done this, be able to remain in a condition in which not only no influences of the outer sense-world can affect the soul, but in which also the images above characterized shall have been effaced from his consciousness. Only now can that which has been previously formed by means of meditation enter the plane of his consciousness. The important point is that there should be at this stage sufficient soul force to spiritually perceive that which has thus been formed through meditation, so that it may not elude the observer's attention, as is always the case if this inner energy is still insufficiently developed.
At first, the soul of the occult student is weak when it comes to perceiving the psycho-spiritual world, so he will need to summon all the inner energy he can during meditation to hold onto the symbols or concepts he has created from his sensory experiences. However, if he wants to actually observe the higher world, he must not only keep a firm grip on these symbols but also be able to maintain a state where no influences from the outer sensory world can affect his soul, and where the images he has formed are erased from his consciousness. Only then can what he has previously formed through meditation enter his awareness. The key point at this stage is that there should be enough soul force to spiritually perceive what has been created through meditation, ensuring it does not slip away from the observer's attention, which usually happens if this inner energy is still underdeveloped.
That which is here evolved as a psycho-spiritual organism and which should be comprehended through self-perception, is delicate and subtle. The disturbing influences of the outer sense-world, however one may try to exclude them, are nevertheless great. It is not merely a question of those disturbances to which we are able to pay heed, but far more of those which in ordinary life are ever eluding our notice. But it is just through the very nature of man that a transitory condition in this respect becomes possible. What the soul, in its waking state, was powerless to effect, owing to the disturbances of the physical world, it is capable of achieving during sleep. One who gives himself [pg 299] up to serious meditation will, with the proper attention, become aware of a certain change in his sleep. He will feel that while sleeping, he is yet not quite asleep, but that his soul has times when, although asleep, still it is, in a certain way, active. During these conditions, nature wards off the influences of the outer world which the waking soul is not yet able to keep away of its own strength. When, however, the meditation exercises have taken effect, the soul, during sleep, detaches itself from unconsciousness, and becomes aware of the psycho-spiritual world. This can happen in two ways: the person may, while asleep, become aware that is is in another world, or he may, after awakening, remember that he has been in another world. But the former of these two feelings requires the greater degree of inner energy, for which reason the second is the more common among beginners in occult training. But it may gradually come to pass that the student will become aware of having been during the entire time of sleep in this other world, only emerging therefrom when he awakes. And his memory of beings and facts connected with this other world will become ever more and more distinct, thus showing that in one form or another he has now entered upon what one may call continuity of consciousness. (The continuation of consciousness during sleep.)
What evolves here as a psycho-spiritual being, which should be understood through self-awareness, is intricate and subtle. Yet, the disruptive influences of the external sensory world are significant, no matter how much we try to shut them out. It's not just about the disturbances we notice; it's also about those that constantly escape our attention in daily life. However, it's precisely because of human nature that a temporary state in this regard becomes possible. What the soul struggles to accomplish while awake, due to the distractions of the physical world, it can achieve during sleep. Someone who commits to deep meditation will, with focus, begin to notice a shift in their sleep. They will sense that while they are sleeping, they aren’t completely unconscious; their soul can be active even in sleep. In these moments, nature shields them from external influences that the waking self hasn’t yet learned to fend off. Once the meditation practices take effect, the soul can separate from unconsciousness during sleep and become aware of the psycho-spiritual realm. This awareness can occur in two ways: the individual might realize they are in another world while asleep, or they might recall upon waking that they have been in another world. The first experience requires a higher level of inner energy, which is why the second is more common for beginners in spiritual training. Over time, however, students may come to realize they have been in this other world throughout their entire sleep, only waking up when they return to awareness. Their memories of beings and events from this other realm will become increasingly clear, indicating that they have begun what might be called a continuity of consciousness. (The continuation of consciousness during sleep.)
Still, for this to be so, it is not necessary that man's consciousness should always continue during sleep. Much will already have been attained in the matter of the continuity of consciousness should [pg 300] the person, whose sleep is in general like that of the ordinary individual, have certain periods during his sleeping hours when he is aware of being in the psycho-spiritual world; or if, on awakening, he is able to remember such a condition of consciousness. It should, however, be borne in mind that what is here described is to be understood only as a transition state. It is well to pass through this state as a part of training; yet it should not be imagined that any conclusive views concerning the psycho-spiritual world may be gained from this transition state, for in this condition the soul is uncertain, and unable as yet to rely upon its own perceptions. But through such experiences the soul gathers ever more strength enabling it also during waking hours to ward off the disturbing influences of the physical outer and inner world and thus to attain psycho-spiritual observation. Then impressions through the senses no longer reach the soul; brain-fettered reason is silent and even the image of the meditation, through which one has only prepared oneself for spiritual vision, has been dropped from consciousness. Whatever is given out through occult science in this or that form should never originate in any psycho-spiritual observation other than that which is made with fully waking consciousness. The first experience is one in which the student can say to himself: Even should I now disregard everything that can come to me through impressions from the outer physical world, still I look upon my inner being not as upon one in which all activity has ceased, but I look upon a being [pg 301] which is self-conscious in a world of which I know nothing as long as I permit myself to be governed only by the impressions of ordinary reason and of the senses. The soul at this moment has the sensation that, in the manner described above, it has given birth to a new being as its own essential soul-kernel. And the being possesses totally different qualities from those which were previously present in the soul.
Still, for this to happen, it's not necessary for a person's consciousness to always continue during sleep. A lot can already be achieved regarding the continuity of consciousness if a person, whose sleep is generally like that of an ordinary individual, has certain times during sleep when they are aware of being in the psycho-spiritual world; or if, upon waking, they can remember that state of consciousness. It should be noted that what is described here is meant to be understood only as a transitional state. It's beneficial to go through this state as part of training; however, it shouldn't be assumed that any definitive insights about the psycho-spiritual world can be gathered from this transitional state, since in this condition the soul is uncertain and still unable to trust its own perceptions. But through such experiences, the soul gathers increasing strength, allowing it to fend off the disruptive influences of the physical outer and inner world during waking hours, thus enabling psycho-spiritual observation. At this point, sensory impressions no longer reach the soul; reason, constrained by the brain, is silent, and even the image of the meditation that initially prepared one for spiritual vision is no longer in consciousness. Anything conveyed through occult science in any form should never come from any psycho-spiritual observation other than that made with fully waking consciousness. The first experience is one where the student can tell themselves: Even if I now ignore everything that comes to me through impressions from the outer physical world, I still perceive my inner being not as one where all activity has stopped, but as a being [pg 301] that is self-aware in a world of which I know nothing as long as I allow myself to be governed only by the impressions of ordinary reason and the senses. At this moment, the soul feels that, as described above, it has given birth to a new being as its own essential soul-core. And this being has entirely different qualities from those that were previously present in the soul.
The second experience of the soul is one in which man has his former being, like a second independent one, alongside of himself. That which had up to this time been imprisoned, evolves now into something we are able to confront; we feel, in fact, at certain times outside of what we have been accustomed to regard as our own being, as our own ego. It is as though one now lived in two egos,—one, which we have hitherto known; the other, a newly born being, superior to the first,—and we become aware that the former ego acquires a certain independence in its relationship to the second, just as the physical body has a certain measure of freedom in its relation to that first ego.
The second experience of the soul is one where a person feels their former self, like a separate independent version, existing alongside them. What has been trapped until now starts to evolve into something we can face; we truly feel, at times, outside of what we've usually seen as our own essence, as our own self. It's as if we live with two selves—one that we've known until now, and the other, a newly emerged self, superior to the first. We become aware that the former self gains a certain independence in relation to the second, just as the physical body has some degree of freedom in its connection to that first self.
This is an event of great importance, for through it man comes to know what it means to live in that world which he has been endeavoring to reach by means of training. It is this second, this new-born, ego which can be led to cognizance of the spiritual world, and in it can be developed that which has as much significance for the spiritual world as our sense organs have for the physical world of the [pg 302] senses. Should this development have attained to the requisite degree, the student will not only be aware of himself as a new-born ego, but he will recognize the spiritual facts and entities around him, just as he perceives the physical world through the action of his physical senses; and this is a third important experience.
This is a significant event because it allows a person to understand what it means to live in the world they've been trying to reach through training. It's this second, newly awakened self that can become aware of the spiritual world, and within it can grow something that is as essential to the spiritual realm as our senses are to the physical world of the [pg 302] senses. If this development reaches the necessary level, the student will not only recognize themselves as this new self, but they will also see the spiritual truths and beings around them, just as they perceive the physical world through their physical senses; and this marks a third important experience.
To meet properly this stage of spiritual training one must take into account that with the strengthening of the forces of the soul a degree of self-love and egoism appears with such intensity as is quite unknown in the ordinary life of the soul. It would be a mistake for anyone to think that it is only a case of ordinary self-love at this point. Self-love becomes so strong at this stage of development that it acquires the strength of a nature-force within the soul, and a vigorous training of the will is necessary in order to conquer this powerful egoism. This training of the will must go hand in hand with the rest of the spiritual training. A strong inclination exists to feel absolutely happy in a world which we have gradually created for ourselves. And we must be able to obliterate, in the manner above described, that to which we have previously devoted ourselves with all our powers. We must efface ourselves in the imaginative world we have reached. But this effacement is opposed by the strongest impulses of egoism.
To properly engage with this stage of spiritual training, one must recognize that as the soul's forces grow stronger, a level of self-love and egoism arises with an intensity that is quite unfamiliar in the usual experience of the soul. It would be a mistake for anyone to think that this is just a typical case of self-love at this point. Self-love becomes so intense at this stage of development that it takes on the force of a natural element within the soul, and a robust training of the will is needed to overcome this powerful egoism. This will training must go hand in hand with the rest of the spiritual training. There is a strong tendency to feel completely happy in a world we have gradually created for ourselves. And we must be able to eliminate, in the way described above, the things to which we have previously devoted ourselves with all our strength. We must erase ourselves in the imaginative world we have achieved. But this erasure is resisted by the strongest impulses of egoism.
The idea might easily arise that the exercises in spiritual training are something merely external which have no connection with the moral development [pg 303] of the soul. In this connection it must be said that the moral force necessary for the conquest of egoism, as described, cannot be gained unless the moral condition of the soul is brought to a corresponding stage. Progress in spiritual training is unthinkable unless moral progress takes place at the same time. The conquest of egoism is impossible without moral force. All talk of spiritual training not being at the same time moral training is certainly contrary to fact.
The idea might easily come up that the exercises in spiritual training are just surface-level activities with no link to the moral growth of the soul. In this context, it should be noted that the moral strength needed to overcome selfishness, as mentioned, cannot be achieved unless the moral state of the soul reaches a similar level. Progress in spiritual training is unimaginable without simultaneous moral progress. Overcoming selfishness is impossible without moral strength. Any claim that spiritual training isn't also moral training is definitely misleading.
Only he who passes through such an experience might advance the following objections: how can one be sure to be dealing with actualities, and not with mere fancies, visions or hallucinations, when he thinks he is having spiritual perceptions? Now the matter lies thus: every person, who has been systematically trained and who has arrived at the stage already characterized, will be in a position to note the difference between his own percept and a spiritual reality, just as well as a man endowed with sound sense knows the difference between the percept of a bar of hot iron and the actual presence of such a bar that he touches with his hand. The difference is determined by experience and by nothing else; and in the spiritual world, too, life is the touchstone. Just as we know that in the world of the senses an imagined bar of iron, however hot, will burn no one's fingers, so does the trained occultist know whether he is passing through a spiritual experience merely in his imagination or whether his awakened spiritual organs of perceptions are impressed [pg 304] by actual facts or beings. The precautions to be taken during schooling, in order that the student may not fall a victim to such delusions will be dealt with in the following pages.
Only someone who has gone through such an experience can raise the following questions: how can you be sure you're dealing with reality and not just fantasies, visions, or hallucinations when you think you're having spiritual insights? Here’s the situation: anyone who has been systematically trained and reached the level already described will be able to recognize the difference between their own perceptions and a spiritual reality, just like a person with common sense can tell the difference between feeling a hot iron bar and just imagining it. The difference is determined by experience, and that applies to the spiritual world as well; life serves as the test. Just as we know that an imagined hot iron bar won’t burn anyone's fingers, the trained occultist understands whether they're experiencing something spiritual purely in their imagination or if their awakened spiritual senses are actually perceiving real facts or beings. The precautions needed during training to prevent students from falling victim to such delusions will be discussed in the following pages. [pg 304]
It is of the greatest importance that the student should have attained to a certain very definite condition of the soul when the consciousness of the new-born ego commences. For through his ego, man is the ruler of his sensations, feelings, and conceptions, his impulses, desires, and passions. Observations and percepts cannot be left in the soul to follow their own devices; they must be regulated according to the laws of thought. And it is the ego, as it were, that controls these thought-laws, and by means of them brings order into the life of perception and thought.
It is crucial for the student to reach a specific state of mind when the awareness of the newly formed self begins. Through this self, a person can manage their sensations, feelings, thoughts, impulses, desires, and passions. Observations and perceptions cannot be allowed to wander freely in the mind; they need to be organized according to logical principles. It is, in a sense, the self that governs these principles of thought, and through them, it brings structure to the experience of perception and thought.
It is similar with regard to desires and passions, inclinations and impulses. The fundamental ethical laws become the guides of these forces of the soul, and by reason of the moral judgment, the ego becomes the soul's guide within this domain. Now if a person detaches a higher ego from his ordinary ego, the latter becomes to a certain extent independent. That much life-power is now taken away from it as is needed for the use of that higher ego. But let us consider the case of a person who has not, as yet, developed certain ability and firmness in exercising the laws of thought and in the power of judgment, but who nevertheless desires to bring about the birth of his higher ego. He will be able to leave to his ordinary ego only as much thought capacity as he [pg 305] has previously developed. If the amount of well-ordered thinking is insufficient, then the ordinary ego which has now become independent, will certainly fall victim to confused, disordered, fantastic thoughts and judgment, and moreover, since in such a case the new-born ego must inevitably be weak also, the disordered lower ego will gain the upper hand, and the person will lose his ability for balanced judgment. Had he developed sufficient capability and firmness in logical thinking, he might have calmly left his ordinary ego to go its own way.
It's the same with desires and passions, inclinations and impulses. The fundamental ethical principles guide these forces of the soul, and through moral judgment, the ego becomes the soul's guide in this area. If someone separates a higher ego from their everyday ego, the everyday ego gains a degree of independence. It loses as much life-force as is needed for the higher ego to function. Now, consider someone who hasn’t yet built the ability and strength to use the laws of thought and judgment but still wants to cultivate their higher ego. They can only leave their everyday ego as much thinking capacity as they’ve already developed. If that amount of organized thinking is too small, the now-independent everyday ego will surely succumb to chaotic, disordered, and unrealistic thoughts and judgments. Additionally, since the newly formed ego will inevitably be weak, the chaotic lower ego will take control, causing the person to lose their capacity for balanced judgment. If they had developed enough ability and strength in logical thinking, they could have confidently allowed their everyday ego to do its own thing.
In the ethical sphere it is precisely the same. Should a person not have attained firmness in the matter of his moral judgment, should he not have become sufficiently master over his inclinations, impulses, and passions, he will then render his ordinary ego independent while in a condition in which it will be overwhelmed by all these soul forces. It may then happen that the person will become worse through the birth of his higher ego than he was before. Had he waited to bring about this birth until he had sufficiently developed his ordinary self, attaining firmness in the matter of ethical judgment, stability of character, and depth of conscience, he would then have been in a position to have all these virtues left within that first ego when the birth of the second came about. Neglecting to do so, however, lays him open to the danger of losing his moral balance, which under the right course of training cannot happen.
In the ethical realm, it’s exactly the same. If a person hasn’t developed a solid moral judgment or gained enough control over their inclinations, impulses, and passions, they risk making their ordinary self independent while being overwhelmed by all these inner forces. This could lead to the person becoming worse with the emergence of their higher self than they were before. If they had waited to let this higher self emerge until they had sufficiently developed their ordinary self—achieving a solid ethical judgment, stability of character, and depth of conscience—they would have been able to incorporate all these virtues into their first self when the second one emerged. However, neglecting to do this puts them at risk of losing their moral balance, which, with proper training, shouldn't happen.
Anyone who has the firm intention of doing all in his power that may give confidence to the first ego in the execution of what it has to fulfil, need never be dismayed when the second ego becomes detached as the result of such spiritual training. Yet he must remember that the power of self-delusion in man is very great with regard to the belief that he has now reached the stage of “ripeness” for any special thing.
Anyone who is determined to do everything they can to support the first self in carrying out its responsibilities should never feel discouraged when the second self detaches as a result of that spiritual training. However, they must keep in mind that people often have a strong tendency to deceive themselves into thinking they have now reached the stage of “ripeness” for any particular thing.
During the spiritual training here described the student develops his thought-life to such an extent that he is not exposed to dangers which are often thought to be connected with training. This cultivation of thought brings about all the inner experiences that are necessary, but causes them to be so enacted that the soul lives through them without any injurious shocks. Without an adequate development of thought, these experiences may produce a feeling of great uncertainty in the soul. The method here emphasized calls forth experiences in such a way that they may produce all their effect and yet not cause serious shocks. By developing the life of thought the student becomes more of a spectator of the experiences of his inner life, whereas without such thought-development he is in the very midst of the experience and is shaken by all the shocks incidental to it.
During the spiritual training being discussed, the student enhances their thinking to the point where they are not faced with the dangers often believed to come with this kind of training. This development of thought leads to all the necessary inner experiences but does so in a way that allows the soul to go through them without suffering any harmful shocks. Without sufficient thought development, these experiences can create a feeling of deep uncertainty in the soul. The method highlighted here brings about experiences in a way that allows them to have their full impact without causing serious shocks. By nurturing their thought life, the student becomes more of a viewer of their inner experiences, while without this thought development, they find themselves right in the middle of the experience and are affected by all the shocks that come with it.
Systematic training points out certain qualities which the student must acquire by means of exercises, in order to find the way to the higher worlds and especial stress is laid on the following,—control of the soul over its thoughts, its will, and its feelings. The manner in which this control is acquired through exercise has a dual aim. On the one hand, the soul by this practice acquires a firmness, reliance, and balance, which will not forsake it even after the birth of the second ego; and on the other hand, this latter ego is provided with strength and inner fortitude for its journey.
Systematic training highlights specific qualities that the student needs to develop through practice to access higher realms. Emphasis is placed on the following: the soul’s control over its thoughts, will, and emotions. The way this control is gained through practice has a dual purpose. On one hand, the soul gains firmness, confidence, and stability, which it retains even after the emergence of the second ego; on the other hand, this second ego is equipped with strength and inner resilience for its journey.
What is required is that man's thinking power shall in all domains conform to facts. In the physical world of the senses, life is the great teacher of the human ego with regard to reality. Were the soul to allow its thoughts to roam aimlessly hither and thither, it would soon be corrected by life, unless it were willing to enter into combat with it; the soul must conform its thoughts to the facts of life. Now, when man leads his thoughts away from the world of the physical senses, he misses the corrective influence of this latter. If his thought is not able to be its own mentor, it will be as unsteady as a will-o'-the-wisp. Consequently, the student's thought must be exercised in such a way that its course and object are self-determined. Inner firmness and a capacity to concentrate strictly on one object: this is what such thinking must of itself engender. And for this reason the thought exercises should not be concerned with complicated objects or those foreign to [pg 308] life, but should, on the contrary, deal with those that are simple and familiar. Any one who succeeds in fixing his mind, over a period of several months and for a space of at least five minutes a day, on such ordinary objects as a pin or a lead pencil, excluding for the time being all other thoughts not concerned with the object under contemplation, will have accomplished much in the right direction. (A new article may be chosen each day, or the same one adhered to for the space of several days.)
What is needed is for people's thinking to align with facts in all areas. In the physical world we experience with our senses, life serves as a crucial teacher for the human spirit regarding reality. If the mind allows its thoughts to wander aimlessly, life will quickly correct it, unless it chooses to resist; the mind must align its thoughts with the realities of life. When a person distracts their thoughts from the physical world, they miss out on this corrective influence. If their thoughts cannot guide themselves, they will be as unreliable as a fleeting shadow. Therefore, a student's thoughts must be exercised in a way that they are self-directed in both course and purpose. This kind of thinking must naturally develop inner strength and the ability to focus intently on one thing. For this reason, thought exercises should not involve complicated or unrelated subjects, but should instead focus on simple and familiar objects. Anyone who can concentrate on an everyday object, like a pin or a pencil, for at least five minutes a day over several months—while putting aside all other unrelated thoughts—will have made significant progress in the right direction. (A new object can be chosen each day, or the same one can be focused on for several days.)
Even those who feel themselves to be “thinkers” need not despise this method of preparing themselves for occult training, because by fixing the attention for a time upon a really familiar object one may be sure that he will be thinking in accordance with facts, and one who asks himself the questions: “What are the constituent parts of a pencil?” “How are these materials prepared?” “How are they afterwards put together?” “When were pencils invented, etc.?” will surely be adapting his perceptions to realities more than he who meditates on the descent of man, or asks himself what life is.
Even those who see themselves as "thinkers" shouldn't dismiss this method of preparing for occult training. By focusing on a familiar object for a while, you can be sure you're thinking in line with facts. Someone who asks themselves questions like: "What are the main parts of a pencil?" "How are these materials made?" "How are they assembled?" "When were pencils invented, etc.?" will definitely be aligning their perceptions with reality more than someone who only meditates on the evolution of man or wonders about the meaning of life.
Simple thought exercises prepare us better for an adequate concept of the world in its Saturn, Sun, and Moon stages of development than those based on learned and complicated ideas. For the important thing is not at all just to think, but to think in conformity with facts by means of an inner force. Once one has been trained to accuracy by means of an obvious, physical sense process, the desire to think in conformity with facts will have become habitual, [pg 309] even if thought does not feel itself under the control of the physical sense-world and its laws; we then lose the tendency to let our thoughts drift about aimlessly.
Simple thought exercises prepare us better for a clear understanding of the world in its stages of development—Saturn, Sun, and Moon—than complex ideas we’ve learned. What matters isn’t just thinking, but thinking in line with facts using our inner strength. Once we’re trained to think accurately through a straightforward physical sense process, the desire to think aligned with facts becomes a habit, [pg 309] even if our thoughts don’t feel controlled by the physical sense world and its laws; we then lose the tendency to let our thoughts wander aimlessly.
And as in the world of thought, so in the realm of the will, the soul must become the ruler. In the physical sense-world it is life that rules. It urges upon man this or that as a necessity, and the will feels itself constrained to satisfy these same wants. In following higher training, man must accustom himself to obey his own commands strictly, and those who acquire this habit will feel less and less inclined to desire what is of no moment. All that is unsatisfying and unstable in the life of the will comes from the desire for things of the possession of which we have formed no distinct concept. Discontent such as this may, when the higher ego is desirous of emerging from the soul, throw that person's whole inner life into disorder; and it is a good exercise to give oneself for the space of several months some command to be carried out at a specified time of day: “To-day, at this or that particular hour, you will do this or that thing.” Thus we gradually become able to command the time at which a thing is to be done and the manner in which it is to be performed, so as to admit of its being accomplished with utmost exactitude. Thus we lift ourselves above the bad habit of saying, “I should like this,” and “I want the other,” while exercising no thought of the possibility of its accomplishment.
And just as in the world of thought, in the realm of will, the soul must take charge. In the physical world, it's life that has the authority. It pushes us towards certain necessities, and our will feels compelled to meet those needs. By engaging in higher training, individuals must train themselves to strictly follow their own directives, and those who develop this habit will find themselves less and less drawn to things that don’t matter. Everything that is unsatisfying and unstable in the will's life stems from the desire for things we have no clear concept of possessing. Such dissatisfaction, when the higher self wants to rise from the soul, can disrupt a person's entire inner life; it’s beneficial to set a specific task to complete at a certain time of day for several months: "Today, at a specific time, you will do a particular thing." This way, we gradually gain the ability to decide when and how something should be done, ensuring it can be accomplished with great precision. In doing so, we elevate ourselves above the bad habit of saying, "I want this," and "I want that." without considering the possibility of actually achieving it.
In the second part of Faust, Goethe puts the following words into the mouth of a seeress: “Him I love who craves the impossible,” and Goethe himself, in his “Prose Proverbs,” says: “To live in the idea means treating the impossible as though 't were possible.”
In the second part of Faust, Goethe has a seeress say: “I love the person who yearns for the impossible,” and Goethe himself, in his “Prose Quotes,” writes: "Living in the idea means treating the impossible as if it were possible."
Such sentiments must not be put forward as objections against what has here been stated, for the demands made by Goethe and his seeress (Manto) can be fulfilled only by those who have first educated themselves through desire for that which is possible, and have in so doing, arrived at being able, by means of their strong “will,” to treat the “impossible” in such a manner that through their willing it becomes transformed into the possible.
Such feelings shouldn't be raised as objections to what has been said here because the demands made by Goethe and his seeress (Manto) can only be met by those who have first educated themselves through a desire for what is possible. In doing so, they've developed the ability, through their strong "will" to approach the "not possible" in a way that transforms it into the possible through their determination.
A certain equanimity should pervade the soul of the occult student concerning the world of feeling. And to attain this result, it is necessary that the soul should have mastery over the expressions of joy and sorrow, pleasure and pain. But it is just concerning the acquisition of this faculty that some prejudice might arise: one might be afraid of becoming dull and indifferent if he does not “rejoice with them that do rejoice, and weep with them that weep.” Yet this is not what is meant. What is pleasurable should rejoice the soul, and sorrow should give it pain, but what the soul is to learn to achieve is control over the expression of joy and sorrow. If that is his aim, the student will become aware that, far from becoming “dull and unsympathetic,” he will be growing all the more receptive to the joy and [pg 311] sorrow around him. But it is true that the student will here find that he needs to watch himself carefully for a considerable time to be able to acquire the faculty indicated. He must be careful to see that he partakes of pain and pleasure to the full, yet without so giving himself up to either that he gives involuntary expression to it. It is not justified sorrow that should be suppressed, but the involuntary weeping; not the revulsion against a mean act, but the blind raging in anger; not the precaution against danger, but the senseless “being afraid,” etc.
A sense of calm should fill the mind of the occult student regarding emotions. To achieve this, it's important for the soul to have control over expressions of joy and sorrow, pleasure and pain. However, some might worry that gaining this control could make them dull and indifferent if they don't “Celebrate with those who celebrate, and mourn with those who mourn.” This isn’t the case. What brings joy should uplift the soul, and sorrow should cause it pain, but the goal is to gain control over how joy and sorrow are expressed. If this is the student’s objective, they'll find that, rather than becoming "boring and unempathetic," they will be even more in tune with the joy and [pg 311] sorrow around them. It is true that the student will need to monitor themselves closely for an extended period to develop this ability. They must ensure that they fully experience pain and pleasure, but without letting themselves become overwhelmed to the point of expressing it involuntarily. It’s not justified sorrow that should be hidden, but the uncontrolled tears; not the aversion to a bad deed, but the mindless rage in anger; not the caution against danger, but the irrational "being scared," etc.
It is only by means of such exercises that the occult student can gain the inner calmness of soul necessary in order that, at the birth of the higher ego, the soul may not find itself as a kind of double, leading a second and unhealthy life alongside of the higher self. It is especially in these matters that we should not yield to self-deception. Some people may be of the opinion that they already possess in everyday life a certain degree of equanimity, and that they therefore stand in no need of such exercises; yet it is especially those who doubly need them. For it is quite possible to remain equable when surveying the things of this life, and then when ascending into the higher world to show evidences of a want of equanimity all the greater because it had only been held in check. For it should be emphatically understood that in the matter of occult training it is not so much a question of what we may already seem to possess, but of carefully and regularly practicing what we need. Contradictory [pg 312] as this phrase may appear, it is nevertheless true that though life may have trained us to this or to that, the qualities to serve us in occult training are those that we have acquired for ourselves. Should life have rendered us excitable, we must train ourselves to conquering this trait; yet if life has engendered in us equanimity, we should so rouse ourselves by our own efforts that the soul may be capable of responding to the impressions it receives. The man who cannot laugh at anything, has just as little control over his laughter as one who is perpetually giving way to uncontrolled laughter.
It is only through such exercises that the occult student can achieve the inner calmness needed so that when the higher self is born, the soul doesn't end up as a sort of split personality, leading an unhealthy life alongside the higher self. We must be especially careful not to trick ourselves in this regard. Some may think they already have a certain level of calm in their everyday lives and therefore don’t need these exercises; however, it’s those individuals who need them the most. It’s entirely possible to keep calm while dealing with the challenges of life, yet when reaching for higher truths, one can show an even greater lack of calmness, as it had merely been suppressed. It's essential to understand that in the realm of occult training, it's not about what we may appear to possess, but about diligently practicing what we actually need. While this may sound contradictory, it’s true that even if life has trained us in certain ways, the qualities we need for occult training are those we have developed ourselves. If life has made us easily excitable, we must work on overcoming that trait; on the other hand, if life has given us calmness, we should push ourselves so that our soul can respond well to the impressions it receives. A person who can’t laugh at all has just as little control over their laughter as someone who constantly gives in to uncontrolled laughter.
Thought and feeling may be cultivated by yet another means, namely, by the acquirement of the characteristic known as positiveness. There is a beautiful legend in which it is related of Christ Jesus, that He, with others, passed the dead body of a dog. The others turned aside from the hideous sight, but Christ Jesus spoke admiringly of the creature's beautiful teeth. One can, through practice, attain to the condition of mind in regard to the world, which is indicated in this legend. Error, vice, and ugliness should not deter the soul from seeing truth, goodness, and beauty, wherever they are to be found. Nor is this positiveness to be mistaken for want of judgment, or for deliberately closing the eyes to what is bad, false, and inferior. He who can admire the beautiful teeth of a decaying animal can also see that decaying corpse—yet the corpse does not hinder his observing the beauty of the teeth. Thus, though what is bad cannot be deemed good, nor [pg 313] error acclaimed as truth, we can yet train ourselves so that what is bad need not prevent us from recognizing what is good, nor need errors render us insensible to that which is true.
Thought and feeling can also be developed through another approach, which is by gaining the trait known as positivity. There’s a beautiful legend about Christ Jesus that tells how He, along with others, passed by the dead body of a dog. While the others turned away from the ugly sight, Christ Jesus praised the creature's beautiful teeth. One can, with practice, reach a mindset toward the world as shown in this legend. Mistakes, wrongdoing, and unpleasantness shouldn’t stop us from recognizing truth, goodness, and beauty wherever they exist. This positivity shouldn't be confused with a lack of judgment or willfully ignoring what is bad, false, and inferior. A person who can admire the beautiful teeth of a decaying animal can also see the decaying corpse—yet the corpse does not stop them from appreciating the beauty of the teeth. Therefore, while what is bad cannot be called good, nor can error be celebrated as truth, we can still train ourselves so that what is bad doesn’t prevent us from seeing what is good, nor do errors make us blind to what is true.
Thought, combined with will, attains to a certain maturity if we strive never to allow what we have already experienced or learned to rob us of our unbiased receptiveness for new experiences. Such a thought as: “I have never heard that before; I don't believe it!” should lose all significance where the occult student is concerned; indeed, he should endeavour, for a fixed period of time, to allow every thing and every creature to convey something new to his mind. Every breath of air, every leaf on the tree, the prattling of a child,—each and all will teach him something, provided he be willing to bring a different point of view to bear upon it from the one he has hitherto held.
Thought, when combined with will, reaches a certain level of maturity if we work to never let our past experiences or knowledge prevent us from being open to new experiences. A thought like: “I’ve never heard that before; I don’t believe it!” should have no weight for the occult student; in fact, he should strive, for a set period of time, to let everything and everyone teach him something new. Every breath of air, every leaf on the tree, the chatter of a child—each of these can teach him something, as long as he is willing to approach it from a different perspective than the one he has held before.
It may, of course, be possible to go too far in this particular, and we must not at any time lose sight of the experiences we have previously had. Indeed, what we experience in the present should be judged in accordance with the sum of our past experiences. These must be laid on one side of the scale, while on the other the occult student should place an inclination for ever gathering new knowledge. Above all, a belief in the possibility that new experiences may contradict the old.
It’s definitely possible to go overboard with this, and we must never forget the experiences we’ve had in the past. In fact, we should evaluate our current experiences based on all our previous ones. We should weigh those past experiences on one side of the scale, while on the other, the aspiring learner should maintain a strong desire to keep acquiring new knowledge. Above all, we must believe that new experiences can sometimes challenge what we already know.
Thus we have enumerated those five qualities of the soul which the occult student in regular training, should acquire; control of the trend of his thoughts; [pg 314] control of the impulses of his will; equanimity in sorrow and joy; positiveness in his judgment of the world; and impartiality in his view of life. After giving consecutive periods of time to the acquiring of these qualities through continued practice, the student must go still further, and bring all these qualities into a harmonious whole within the soul, to achieve which, he will have to practice the exercises in twos and twos together, or three and one, simultaneously, so as to bring about the harmony desired.
So, we’ve listed the five qualities of the soul that an occult student in regular training should develop: control over their thoughts; [pg 314] control over their will’s impulses; calmness in both sorrow and joy; decisiveness in their judgment of the world; and fairness in their perspective on life. After dedicating consistent time to develop these qualities through ongoing practice, the student needs to go further and integrate all these qualities into a cohesive whole within the soul. To achieve this, they will need to practice the exercises in pairs or in combinations of three and one at the same time to create the desired harmony.
The exercises indicated above are thus given out by occult teaching because if faithfully carried out, they not only produce in the occult student what we have called above direct results, but they lead indirectly to much else that is needed on the path to the higher worlds. He who practices these exercises sufficiently will, while doing so, become aware of many a lack and many a failing in his own soul-life, and he will at the same time find in them the very means necessary to give strength and security to the intellect, to the emotional tendencies and to the character as well. He will assuredly need many additional exercises, according to his capacities, temperament, and character; these, however, will present themselves if the above be frequently carried out. Indeed, one will notice that the already indicated exercises, indirectly, gradually yield that which at first does not seem to be in them. A person endowed with but little self-confidence, for instance, finds in the course of time, that by persistent practice the [pg 315] needed confidence in himself has come about. And it is the same with many other soul qualities.28
The exercises mentioned above are provided by occult teachings because if done consistently, they not only produce what we referred to earlier as direct results, but they also indirectly lead to many other things that are necessary on the journey to the higher realms. Those who practice these exercises enough will, during the process, become aware of many deficiencies and shortcomings in their own inner life, and they will simultaneously discover the very tools needed to strengthen and stabilize their intellect, emotional tendencies, and character. They will certainly require many additional exercises based on their abilities, temperament, and character; however, these will present themselves if the aforementioned ones are practiced regularly. In fact, one will notice that the exercises mentioned earlier gradually yield outcomes that may not seem apparent at first. For instance, a person with little self-confidence will realize over time that through ongoing practice, they have developed the confidence they needed. The same applies to many other inner qualities.
It is a matter of significance that the occult student is capable of raising these capabilities to ever higher degrees; and he must succeed in so controlling his thoughts and feelings that the soul will have power to maintain complete inner quietude for certain periods of time—periods during which he can keep out of his mind and heart all those things that in any way concern the outer everyday life, its joys and sorrows, its pleasures and cares, even its tasks and demands. At such a time nothing should be allowed entrance into the soul except what the soul itself admits. An abjection may easily be made to this. One might imagine that alienation must result if the student withdraws in heart and spirit from life and its duties for a certain part of the day. Yet in reality, this is by no means the case. For those who, in the above manner, give themselves up to periods of inner quietude and peace will find that out of these there grows such a fund of energy for fulfilling the outer duties of life that they are not only not less efficiently performed, but assuredly more so.
It’s important for the occult student to be able to enhance these abilities to higher levels. They must learn to control their thoughts and feelings so that the soul can maintain complete inner calm for specific periods. During these times, they should keep out of their mind and heart everything related to everyday life—its joys, sorrows, pleasures, and worries, as well as its tasks and responsibilities. At such moments, nothing should be allowed into the soul except what it willingly accepts. Some might argue that this could lead to a sense of alienation if the student withdraws emotionally and spiritually from life and its responsibilities for a portion of the day. However, that is not the case at all. Those who commit to these periods of inner peace will discover that they gain an abundance of energy to tackle their external duties, resulting in even better efficiency in their tasks.
It is of great benefit at such times to detach oneself entirely from thoughts of personal affairs, and to be able to raise oneself to that which affects not oneself alone, but all mankind. If he is then able to [pg 316] fill his soul with messages from a higher spiritual world, and if they have the power of enthralling his soul to as intense a degree as any personal concern or care, then indeed will his soul have gathered fruit of especial value.
It’s really helpful during times like these to completely set aside thoughts about personal issues and focus on what impacts not just oneself but all of humanity. If one can then fill their soul with messages from a higher spiritual realm, and if those messages can captivate their soul just as much as any personal concern or worry, then their soul will truly have gained something incredibly valuable.
Those who thus exert themselves to regulate their soul-life will arrive at the possibility of a degree of self-observation that will permit them to review their personal affairs with the same tranquillity as those of others. Seeing one's own experiences and one's own joys and sorrows in the light in which those of another appear, is a good preparation for occult training. We bring this exercise gradually to the necessary stage, if, after the day's work is over, we allow the pictures of the day's occurrences to pass before the mind's eye. We would then see ourselves within our own experiences as in a picture; in other words, we would look at ourselves in our daily life, as an outside observer.
Those who work to manage their inner life will reach a level of self-awareness that allows them to look at their own situations with the same calmness they have when observing others. Viewing our own experiences, joys, and sorrows from the perspective we hold for someone else's is a great way to prepare for deeper learning. We gradually develop this practice by reflecting on the day's events after work. This lets us see ourselves within our own experiences like it's a picture; in other words, we can view our daily lives as an outside observer.
A certain practice in self-observation having been gained by concentrating the attention upon short divisions of the day's experience, the student will become more and more expert in this kind of retrospect, continued practice enabling him to review the events of the whole day completely and quickly. It will become ever more and more the ideal of the occult student to assume such an attitude with regard to the events of life which confront him that he will be able to await their approach with absolute calm and inner confidence, no longer judging them by the state of his own soul but according to their [pg 317] own inner meaning and inner worth. And it is by looking to this ideal that he will create a condition of soul that will enable him to meditate profoundly, as described above, upon symbolical and other thoughts and feelings.
Once the practice of self-observation is developed by focusing on brief segments of the day's experiences, the student will become increasingly skilled at this kind of reflection. With consistent practice, they will be able to review the events of the entire day thoroughly and swiftly. It will increasingly become the goal of the occult student to adopt an attitude toward life’s events that allows them to face these situations with complete calm and confidence, no longer evaluating them based on their own emotional state but rather according to their inherent meaning and value. By aspiring to this ideal, they will cultivate a mindset that enables them to meditate deeply, as discussed earlier, on symbolic and other thoughts and feelings.
The conditions here described must be fulfilled, because supersensible experience is built upon the foundation on which the student stands in his ordinary soul-life, before he enters the supersensible world. In a two-fold way, all supersensible experience is dependent upon the soul's point of departure before entering that world. One who is not intent, from the outset, on making sound powers of judgment the foundation of his spiritual training will develop supersensible capacities which perceive the spiritual world inaccurately and incorrectly. To a certain extent his spiritual organs of perception will develop in the wrong way. And just as a man with a defective or diseased eye cannot see correctly in the sense-world, so it is not possible to have true perceptions with spiritual organs which are not built upon the foundation of sound powers of judgment. One who starts from an immoral state of soul rises into the spiritual worlds with his spiritual vision stupified and clouded. In regard to supersensible worlds he is like a person in the sense-world who makes observations in a state of lethargy. The latter, however, will not be able to make any statements of consequence, whereas the spiritual observer, even in his stupefaction, is more awake than a person in the ordinary state of consciousness, and [pg 318] the results of his observations will therefore be erroneous in regard to the spiritual world.
The conditions described here must be met because experiences beyond the senses are built on the foundation of the student’s ordinary soul life before entering that supersensible world. In two ways, all supersensible experiences depend on the soul's starting point before entering that realm. If someone does not prioritize developing sound judgment as the basis of their spiritual training from the beginning, they will develop supersensible abilities that misinterpret the spiritual world. To a certain extent, their spiritual perception organs will develop incorrectly. Just like a person with an impaired or unhealthy eye cannot see accurately in the physical world, it is impossible to have true perceptions with spiritual organs that are not based on sound judgment. Someone who begins from an immoral state of soul ascends into the spiritual realms with a muddled and clouded vision. When it comes to supersensible worlds, they are like a person in the physical world who makes observations while in a lethargic state. However, the latter will not be able to make any significant statements, while the spiritual observer, even in their stupor, is more aware than someone in a normal state of consciousness, and as a result, their observations will be inaccurate regarding the spiritual world.
The highest possibilities of imaginative cognition can be realized by supporting the aforesaid meditations by that which one might call “sense-free” thinking. Now when we formulate an idea based upon observations made in the physical sense-world, our thought is not free from sense-impressions. Yet it is not as though man could formulate only such ideas: human thought need not become void and meaningless simply because it is not filled with observations derived through the channels of the senses. The most direct and the safest way for the occult student to acquire this “sense-free” thinking, is to make the facts of the higher worlds presented by occult science, the subject of his thoughts. These facts cannot be observed by means of the physical senses; nevertheless, the student will find that he will be able to grasp them—if only he has enough patience and perseverance. No one can explore higher worlds, or make his own observations therein, without having been trained. But it is quite possible without training to understand everything which investigators communicate about those regions. Should anyone ask, “How can I accept on trust what the occultist tells me, being myself as yet unable to see it?”—such an objection would be groundless, for it is perfectly possible to arrive through mere reflective thinking at the sure conviction that the matters thus communicated are true.
The greatest potential for imaginative thinking can be achieved by supporting the mentioned meditations with what one might call "nonsensical" thinking. When we form an idea based on observations from the physical world, our thoughts are influenced by sensory impressions. However, it's not true that people can only create ideas this way: human thought doesn’t have to be empty or meaningless just because it isn’t shaped by sensory observations. The easiest and most reliable way for someone studying the occult to develop this nonsense thinking is to focus on the facts of higher realms presented by occult science. These facts can’t be perceived through physical senses; however, the student will discover that they can understand them—if they have enough patience and determination. No one can explore higher worlds or make observations there without training. But it is entirely possible to comprehend everything that researchers share about those areas without prior training. If someone asks, "How can I trust what the occultist says, especially since I can't see it for myself?"—such a concern would be unfounded, as it is absolutely possible to reach a firm conviction through simple reflective thinking that the information shared is indeed true.
If a man is unable, through reflecting, to arrive at such a conviction, the reason is not that he cannot possibly “believe” something he cannot see, but simply because he has not as yet applied his powers of reflective thinking in a sufficiently unbiased, comprehensive and profound manner.
If a man can't come to that conclusion through reflection, it's not because he can't possibly "believe" in something he can't see, but simply because he hasn't yet used his capacity for reflective thinking in a sufficiently open-minded, thorough, and deep way.
In order to be clear on this point, it must be borne in mind that human thought, if it arouses itself to energetic activity, can understand more than it usually imagines possible. For in thought there is an inner essence which is in connection with the supersensible world. The soul is not usually conscious of this connection, because it is wont to train its faculty of thought only through the world of sense. On this account it thinks incomprehensible what is imparted to it from the supersensible world. What is thus communicated is, however, not only intelligible to thought which has been spiritually trained, but to any thinking which is fully conscious of its power and is willing to make use of it.
To be clear on this point, we need to remember that human thought, when it engages actively, can understand more than we typically think is possible. Within thought, there’s a deeper essence connected to the non-physical world. Usually, the soul isn’t aware of this connection because it tends to develop its thinking abilities only through sensory experiences. This is why it finds difficult to grasp what comes from the non-physical realm. However, what is communicated is not only understandable to those who have developed their spiritual thinking, but also to any thinker who is fully aware of their capabilities and is willing to use them.
By the persevering assimilation of what occult teachers are able to impart to us we habituate ourselves to a line of thought that is not derived from sense-observation, and we learn to recognize how, within the soul, one thought is allied to another, and how one thought calls forth another, even when the connection of ideas is not occasioned by any power of sense-observation. The essential point is that by this method we become aware of the fact that the world of thought possesses an inner life, and that while we are engaged in thought we are, indeed, in [pg 320] the realm of a supersensible living power. Thus we may say to ourselves: “There is something within me that develops an organism of thought; nevertheless, I am one with this something.” And thus in yielding to this sense-free thinking, we experience something like a being, which flows into our inner life, just as the qualities of the things of the senses flow into us through our physical organs when used for sense-observation.
By consistently absorbing what occult teachers share with us, we train ourselves to engage in a way of thinking that doesn't come from sensory observation. We learn to see how thoughts are connected within the soul, how one thought leads to another, even when there's no sensory observation linking them. The key point is that through this approach, we become aware that the world of thought has its own inner life, and that while we are thinking, we are truly in the realm of a non-physical living energy. So, we might say to ourselves: “There's something inside me that forms a way of thinking; still, I am connected to this something.” By embracing this thinking that is free from the senses, we feel something like a being flowing into our inner life, just as the qualities of sensory experiences enter us through our physical senses when we observe the world.
“Out there in space,” says the observer of the sense-world, “is a rose: it is not unfamiliar to me, for both scent and colour proclaim its presence.” And in like manner, when sense-free thought is working within us, we need only be sufficiently unbiased in order to be able to say: “Something real proclaims its presence to me, linking thought to thought and constituting a thought-organism”—only there is a difference to be noted between the communication coming to the observer from the outer world of the senses, and that which actually reaches the sense-free thinker. The former feels that he is standing without—in front of the rose—whereas he who has given himself up to thinking which is untrammelled by the senses will feel within himself whatever thus proclaims its presence to him; he will feel himself one with it.
"In outer space," says the observer of the sensory world, “is a rose: I’m familiar with it, because both its scent and color signal its presence.” Similarly, when pure thought is at work within us, we just need to be open-minded enough to say: “Something real reveals itself to me, linking one thought to another and creating a thought-organism.” — but it’s important to note the difference between the information the observer receives from the outer sensory world and what actually reaches the thinker who is free from sensory influence. The former feels as though he is standing outside—before the rose—while someone who immerses themselves in thought without the constraints of the senses will feel inside themselves whatever is announcing its presence; they will feel one with it.
Those who, more or less, unconsciously consider as beings only that which they can perceive as external objects, will, it is true, be unable to entertain the feeling that whatever has the nature of a being, can also manifest itself within man by his becoming [pg 321] one with it. In order to judge correctly one must be able to have the following inner experiences: one must learn to distinguish between the thought combinations created through one's own volition, and those experienced without any voluntary exercise of the will. In the latter case, we may then say: I remain quite still within myself; I produce no trains of thought; I yield to that which “thinks within me.” Then we are fully justified in saying: Within me a being is acting, just as we are justified in saying that the rose acts upon us when we see a certain red, when we perceive a certain odor.
Those who, more or less, unconsciously see as real only what they can perceive as external objects will, indeed, struggle to feel that anything with the nature of a being can also show itself within a person when they become one with it. To judge correctly, one must be able to have the following inner experiences: one must learn to recognize the difference between the thought patterns created through their own will and those that occur without any intentional effort. In the latter case, we can say: I remain completely still within myself; I don’t produce any trains of thought; I surrender to that which “thinks inside me.” Then we can rightly say: Within me a being is acting, just as we can rightly say that the rose affects us when we see a certain red or when we smell a particular fragrance. [pg 321]
Nor is there any contradiction in having derived the contents of our ideas from communications made by the occult seer. The ideas are, it is true already there when we devote ourselves to them; yet they cannot be “thought”, without in each case being created anew within the soul. The important point is that the occult teacher seeks to awaken in his hearers and readers the kind of thoughts which they must first call forth from within themselves, whereas he who describes some physical object indicates something that the listener or reader may observe within the sense-world.
There’s no contradiction in saying that the content of our thoughts comes from what the mysterious seer conveys. It’s true these ideas already exist when we engage with them; however, they can’t be "thinking" without being newly created within our minds each time. The key point is that the occult teacher aims to inspire his listeners and readers to bring forth thoughts from within themselves, while someone who describes a physical object points out something that can be directly observed in the physical world.
(The path which leads to sense-free thinking by means of the communications made by occult science is thoroughly safe. But there is also another method even safer and above all things more exact, yet for this very reason more difficult for the majority. This method is set forth in my two books, “Goethe's Conception of the World” and “The [pg 322] Philosophy of Spiritual Activity.” These writings set forth what human thought can achieve for itself, if the thinking is not under the influence of the physical sense impressions but relies merely upon itself. Then pure thinking works within man like a living being. At the same time nothing in the above-mentioned writings is derived from communications due to occult science itself, and yet it is shown that pure, self-reliant thinking can obtain information about the world, life and man.
The path to thinking without relying on the senses through the insights of occult science is completely safe. However, there is an even safer method that is also more precise, but for that reason, it's more challenging for most people. This method is explained in my two books, “Goethe's View of the World” and “The[pg 322]Philosophy of Spiritual Activity.” These works demonstrate what human thought can accomplish when it's not influenced by physical sensory experiences but instead relies solely on itself. Then pure thinking operates within a person like a living entity. At the same time, nothing in the aforementioned writings comes from insights provided by occult science itself, yet they illustrate that pure, independent thinking can gain knowledge about the world, life, and humanity.
These writings therefore occupy a very important intermediate position between the actual cognition of the sense-world and that of the spiritual world. They present that which thinking can gain when it raises itself above sense-observation and yet does not enter into occult research. Anyone who allows these books to work upon his whole soul, already stands within the spiritual world, but it appears to him as a world of thought. Those who are in a position to allow this intermediate condition to act upon them, will be following a safe and sane path and can thus win for themselves a feeling concerning the higher worlds, which will for all future time ensure for them most abundant results.)
These writings hold a significant place between what we can perceive in the physical world and what exists in the spiritual realm. They show what our thinking can achieve when it goes beyond just what we see and doesn't dive into hidden knowledge. Anyone who engages with these books on a deep level is already part of the spiritual world, but it presents itself to them as a world of ideas. Those who can embrace this in-between state will follow a secure and rational path, gaining a sense of the higher realms that will continue to provide them with rich insights in the future.
The object of meditating upon the above described symbolical concepts and feelings is, strictly speaking, the development of the higher organs of cognition within man's astral body. They are in the first place created from the substance of the astral body. These new organs of observation establish a connection [pg 323] with a new world wherein man learns to know himself as a new ego.
The purpose of reflecting on the symbolic ideas and emotions described above is, in a strict sense, to develop the higher faculties of understanding within a person's astral body. Firstly, these faculties are formed from the substance of the astral body. These new observation abilities create a link with a new realm where an individual comes to recognize themselves as a new ego. [pg 323]
These new organs of perception are first of all to be distinguished from those of the physical sense-world by being active organs. Whereas the eye and ear are passive, allowing light and sound to work upon them, it may be said of these perceptive organs of the soul and spirit that, while functioning they are in a perpetual state of activity, and that they seize hold of their objects and facts, as it were, in full consciousness. This gives rise to the feeling that psycho-spiritual cognition is a union with,—a “dwelling within,”—the corresponding facts.
These new organs of perception should firstly be distinguished from those of the physical sense world by being active organs. While the eye and ear are passive, allowing light and sound to affect them, it can be said that these perceptive organs of the soul and spirit are always in a state of activity when they are functioning, actively engaging with their objects and facts with full awareness. This leads to the feeling that psycho-spiritual understanding is a connection with,—a “living inside,”—the relevant facts.
These separately evolving psycho-spiritual organs may be compared to “lotus flowers” corresponding to the appearance which they present to the clairvoyant consciousness, as they are formed from the substance of the astral body.29
These separately developing psycho-spiritual organs can be likened to “lotus flowers” based on the appearance they show to clairvoyant awareness, as they are created from the material of the astral body.29
Very definite kinds of meditation act upon the astral body in such manner that certain psycho-spiritual organs, the so-called “lotus flowers,” are developed. Any proper meditation undertaken with the view of attaining to imaginative cognition has its effect upon one or another of these organs.30
Certain specific types of meditation affect the astral body in a way that develops specific psycho-spiritual organs, known as “lotus flowers.” Any effective meditation aimed at achieving imaginative understanding impacts one or more of these organs.30
A regular course of training arranges and orders the separate exercises to be practised by the occult student, so that these organs may either simultaneously [pg 324] or consecutively attain their suitable development, and on this process the student will have to bring much patience and perseverance to bear. Those, indeed, who are possessed of no more than the average amount of patience with which man, under ordinary conditions of life is endowed, will not reach very far. For it takes a long—often a very long time indeed—before these organs have reached a point at which the occult student is able to use them for observing things in the higher worlds. At this point comes what is known as “illumination,” in contradistinction to the “preparation,” or “purification,” which consists in the practices undertaken for the formation of these organs. (The term “purification” is used because in order to reach certain phases of inner life, the pupil cleanses himself through the corresponding exercises, of that which belongs to the world of sense observation.)
A regular training program organizes the different exercises for the occult student so that these abilities can either develop at the same time or consecutively. The student will need to have a lot of patience and perseverance throughout this process. In fact, those only equipped with the average level of patience that most people have will not get very far. It often takes a long—sometimes very long—time before these abilities are developed enough for the occult student to use them for observing things in higher realms. At this stage, what is known as "lighting," occurs, which is different from the "prepping," or "cleaning," involved in the exercises aimed at developing these abilities. The term "cleansing" is used because, to reach certain levels of inner life, the student cleanses themselves through the corresponding exercises of what belongs to the world of sensory observation.
It is, however, quite possible that before actual illumination, the student may get repeated “flashes of light” from a higher world. These he should receive gratefully. Even these can make him a witness of the spiritual realms. Yet he must not falter should this never be vouchsafed him during his entire period of preparation, and should its consequent duration seem all too long to him. Indeed, those who yield to impatience “because they can as yet see nothing,” have not yet acquired the right attitude toward the higher worlds. Those alone will be in a position to grasp this who can view the exercises they undertake as an object in themselves. For [pg 325] this practice is in truth a working on something psycho-spiritual, namely, on their own astral body; even though they do not “see,” they can “feel” that they are working on the psycho-spiritual plane. Only when we have a preconceived idea of what we “wish to see,” are we unable to experience this feeling. In that case we may consider as nothing what is, in reality, of immeasurable importance. But one should observe minutely everything which one experiences while practicing,—experiences which are so fundamentally different from those of the sense-world. We shall then become aware that we cannot work upon our astral body as though it were some indifferent substance; but that in it there lives a totally different world of which the life of our senses does not inform us.
It is definitely possible that before true understanding, the student may have brief moments of insight from a higher realm. They should appreciate these moments. Even these can allow them to witness the spiritual dimensions. However, they must not give up if they don’t experience this throughout their entire preparation, even if the wait feels excessively long. In fact, those who become impatient “because they can't see anything yet” haven't developed the right mindset toward the higher realms. Only those who can see their exercises as valuable in themselves will truly understand this. For this practice is essentially about working on something psycho-spiritual, specifically on their own astral body; even if they don’t “see,” they can “feel” that they are engaging on the psycho-spiritual level. Only when we have a specific idea of what we “want to see” do we fail to experience this feeling. In such cases, we might dismiss as insignificant what is actually of immense importance. It’s essential to carefully observe everything that occurs during practice—experiences that are fundamentally different from those in the physical world. We will then realize that we cannot treat our astral body as if it were a mere object; instead, it contains a completely different world that our senses do not reveal to us.
Higher entities act upon the astral body in the same way in which the world of the physical senses acts upon the physical body, and we “come upon” that higher life in our own astral body, provided only we do not shut ourselves out from it. If we are perpetually saying: “I am aware of nothing,” then it is generally the case that we imagined that these experiences should appear thus and so; and because we do not see what we imagined we should see, we say, “I can see nothing.”
Higher beings influence the astral body just like the physical world influences the physical body, and we "come across" that higher existence in our own astral body, as long as we don’t exclude ourselves from it. If we keep saying: "I don't know anything." it’s usually because we thought these experiences should happen a certain way; and since we don’t see what we expected, we say, "I can't see anything."
However, he who is able to acquire the right attitude of mind with regard to his practice during training, will find more and more that he has something which he loves for its own sake and which, as an immeasurably important vital function, he can [pg 326] no longer do without. He will then know that through these very practices he is standing in the psycho-spiritual world and will await with patience and resignation what may further transpire. This attitude of mind of the student may best be expressed in such words as these: “I will do all the exercises which have been assigned to me; for I know that in the fullness of time as much will come to me as I should receive; I do not ask for it impatiently, but I prepare myself to receive it.” On the other hand one should not raise the objection: The occult student, then, is expected perhaps for a long time to feel around in the dark, because he cannot know that he is on the right path with his exercises, before he obtains results. It is not true, however, that he must wait until the results prove to him the correctness of the exercises. If the attitude of the student is right, then the satisfaction which he experiences in the practice of these exercises, in itself carries the conviction that he is doing the right thing, and he does not need to wait for results to prove it. The correct practice of exercises in occult training brings with it a satisfaction that is not merely satisfaction, but conviction—the conviction that I am doing something which shows me that it is leading me forward in the right direction. Every occult student may have this conviction at any moment if he pays careful attention to his experiences. Should he not exercise such attention, he will simply pass by these experiences just as a wayfarer in profound thought does not notice the trees alongside of the [pg 327] road, though he would surely see them if he would but direct his attention to them.
However, anyone who can develop the right mindset regarding their practice during training will realize more and more that they have something they cherish for its own sake, which, as an incredibly important vital function, they can no longer live without. They will then understand that through these very practices, they are engaging in the psycho-spiritual world and will patiently await whatever may happen next. This mindset of the student can be summed up in words like this: “I will complete all the exercises given to me because I know that eventually, I will get what I’m meant to receive; I don’t rush it, but I get ready to accept it.” On the other hand, one should not argue: the occult student is expected to fumble around in the dark for a long time, unsure if they are on the right path with their exercises until they see results. However, it is not the case that they must wait for results to validate their exercises. If the student's mindset is correct, then the satisfaction they find in practicing these exercises inherently confirms that they are on the right track, and they don't need to wait for results to prove it. The proper practice of exercises in occult training produces a satisfaction that is more than just contentment; it is conviction—the conviction that they are doing something that clearly leads them in the right direction. Every occult student can experience this conviction at any moment if they pay close attention to their experiences. If they do not exercise such attention, they will simply overlook these experiences, much like a traveler deep in thought fails to notice the trees alongside the [pg 327] road, even though they would certainly see them if they directed their attention to them.
It is by no means desirable that results, other than those which are always due to such practice, should in any way be hastened. For such results might easily be only an infinitesimal part of what should really take place. Indeed, in the matter of occult development, partial results are, more often than not, the cause of considerable delay in complete development. Contact with such forms of spiritual life corresponding to partial development, tends to dull the perceptive faculties to the influences of those powers which would lead on to higher stages of development; while the benefit derived from such a “glimpse” of the spiritual world, is after all only a seeming one, because this glimpse cannot divulge the truth, but only deceptive illusions.
It’s not a good idea to rush results, other than those that naturally come from regular practice. These results might end up being just a tiny fraction of what should actually happen. In fact, when it comes to spiritual development, partial results often cause significant delays in achieving full development. Interacting with forms of spiritual life linked to partial development can dull our ability to perceive the influences of the powers that would guide us to higher levels of growth. The benefits from such a "peek" into the spiritual world are ultimately just an illusion, as this glimpse can’t reveal the truth, only misleading images.
The psycho-spiritual organs, the “lotus flowers,” shape themselves in such a manner that to clairvoyant consciousness they appear in the vicinity of particular physical organs of the body of the person undergoing training. From among these psycho-spiritual organs the following should be enumerated: that which is to be perceived between the eye-brows is the so-called two-petalled lotus flower; that in the region of the larynx is the sixteen-petalled lotus; in the region of the heart is to be found the twelve-petalled lotus flower and the fourth is near [pg 328] the navel. Others appear in close conjunction with other parts of the physical body.31
The psycho-spiritual organs, referred to as "lotus flowers," are shaped in such a way that to a clairvoyant, they seem to be located near specific physical organs in the person undergoing training. Among these psycho-spiritual organs, we can identify the following: the two-petaled lotus, which is perceived between the eyebrows; the sixteen-petaled lotus found in the area of the larynx; the twelve-petaled lotus located in the heart; and the fourth lotus near the navel. Others appear closely associated with different parts of the physical body.31
The lotus flowers are formed in the astral body, and by the time one or the other has developed, we become conscious of them. We then feel that we can make use of them, and that by doing so we really enter a higher world. The impressions received of that world still resemble in many respects those of the physical senses; and one with imaginative cognition will be able to designate the new higher world as impressions of heat or cold, perceptions of sound or words, effects of light or color—because it is in this way that he perceives them. He is, however, conscious of the fact that these perceptions express something different in the imaginative world from what they do in the actual sense-world; and he recognizes that behind them lie causes which are not physical, but psycho-spiritual ones.
The lotus flowers form in the astral body, and by the time one or the other has developed, we become aware of them. We then feel we can use them, and by doing so, we truly enter a higher realm. The impressions we receive from that realm still resemble, in many ways, those of our physical senses; and someone with imaginative understanding will be able to refer to the new higher realm as feelings of heat or cold, sounds or words, and effects of light or color—because that's how they perceive them. However, they are aware that these perceptions convey something different in the imaginative realm compared to the physical sense realm; and they recognize that behind them are causes that are not physical, but rather psycho-spiritual.
Should he receive an impression of heat he will not, for instance, attribute this to a piece of hot iron, but will regard it as the emanation of some soul-process, which he has hitherto experienced only with his soul's inner life. He knows that behind imaginative experiences exist psycho-spiritual things and processes just as behind physical perceptions we have physical entities and material facts.
If he feels heat, he won't think it's just a hot piece of iron; instead, he'll see it as a result of some kind of soul process that he's only felt within his own inner life. He understands that there are psycho-spiritual elements and processes behind imaginative experiences, just like there are physical entities and material facts behind what we perceive physically.
And yet this similarity, apparent between the world of imagination and the physical world, is [pg 329] modified by one important difference. There is something present in the physical world which, when met in the imaginative world, bears quite another appearance. In the former we are aware of a perpetual ebb and flow, an alternation between birth and death. But in the imaginative world there appears, in place of this phenomenon, a continual metamorphosis of the one into the other. In the physical world we see, for instance, how a plant fades away, but in the imaginative world there emerges, in proportion as the plant fades, another form, not physically discernible, into which the withering plant is gradually transformed. When once the plant has faded away completely, this form will have become fully developed in its place. Birth and death are conceptions which lose their value in the imaginative world, making way for a comprehension of the transmutation of the one into the other.
And yet this similarity, noticeable between the world of imagination and the physical world, is [pg 329] affected by one key difference. There’s something in the physical world that, when encountered in the imaginative world, looks completely different. In the physical world, we recognize a constant cycle, a back-and-forth between birth and death. But in the imaginative world, instead of this cycle, there’s a continuous transformation of one into the other. In the physical world, for example, we see a plant withering away, but in the imaginative world, as the plant fades, another form, not physically visible, emerges into which the dying plant is gradually changing. Once the plant has completely faded, this form will have fully developed in its place. Birth and death lose their meaning in the imaginative world, making room for an understanding of the transformation of one into the other.
This being the case, those truths concerning which we have already made certain communications in an earlier chapter of this book (see Chapter II, “The Nature of Man”) become accessible to the imaginative perception. Physical sense-perception is able to perceive only what takes place in the physical body, processes which are enacted within the “domain of birth and death.” The other principles of man's being, namely, the etheric or vital body, the sentient body, and the ego, are subject to the law of transmutation, and the perception of them is unlocked by imaginative cognition. Any one who has advanced this far will observe that that which lives [pg 330] on under other conditions of being after death, detaches itself from the physical body.
Given this, the truths we've already discussed in an earlier chapter of this book (see Chapter II, "The Nature of Humanity") become accessible through imaginative perception. Physical sense-perception can only perceive what happens within the physical body, processes that occur in the “realm of birth and death.” The other aspects of a person's existence, like the etheric or vital body, the sentient body, and the ego, are governed by the law of transmutation, and understanding them requires imaginative cognition. Anyone who has progressed this far will notice that what continues to exist under different conditions after death separates from the physical body.
But development does not come to a standstill within the imaginative world. Anyone who would like to remain stationary in it, would, it is true, be able to note the entities in process of transmutation, but he would be unable to interpret the meaning of these processes of change. He would not be in a position to find his way about in this newly attained world. For the imaginative world is a realm of unrest—there is naught in it but movement and change; nowhere are there stationary points. Such points of rest are reached only by the person who, having transcended the stage of imaginative knowledge, has attained to that grade of development known to occult science as “understanding through inspiration.”
But development doesn't stop in the imaginative world. Anyone who wants to stay put there may notice the entities undergoing transformation, but they wouldn't be able to understand the meaning behind these changes. They wouldn't be able to navigate this newly acquired world. The imaginative world is a place of constant motion—there's nothing but movement and change; there are no fixed points. Such stable points are only reached by those who, having moved beyond the stage of imaginative knowledge, have achieved the level of development known in occult science as “understanding through inspiration.”
It is not necessary for one seeking knowledge of the supersensible world to develop his capacities so that the imaginative cognition should have been acquired in full measure, before moving on to the stage of “inspiration.” His exercises may, indeed, be so regulated that two processes may go on simultaneously, one leading to imagination and the other to inspiration. The student will then in due time enter a higher world, in which he not only perceives, but where he can also find his way about, as it were, and which he becomes able to interpret. Progress, as a rule, consists in the occult student perceiving some apparitions of the imaginative world and becoming [pg 331] conscious, after a while, that he is beginning to get his bearings.
It's not necessary for someone seeking knowledge of the supersensible world to fully develop their abilities to the point of complete imaginative understanding before moving on to the stage of “inspo.” Their training can actually be structured so that both processes happen at the same time, with one leading to imagination and the other to inspiration. The student will eventually enter a higher realm where they not only perceive but can also navigate and interpret it. Typically, progress for the occult student involves seeing certain visions of the imaginative world and gradually becoming aware that they are starting to find their way around.
Yet the world of inspiration is something quite new compared with the purely imaginative realm. By means of the latter we learn to know the transformation of one process into another; while through the former we come to recognize the inner qualities of ever changing beings. Imagination shows us the soul-expression of such beings; through inspiration we penetrate into their spiritual core. Above all, we become aware of a multiplicity of spiritual beings and of their relation to one another. In the physical sense-world we have also, of course, to do with a multiplicity of different beings, yet in the world of inspiration this multiplicity is of a different character. In that world each being sustains quite definite relations to all the other beings, not, however, as in the physical world through outer influence upon them, but through their essential inner nature.
Yet the world of inspiration is something completely new compared to the purely imaginative realm. With imagination, we learn to see how one process transforms into another; through inspiration, we recognize the inner qualities of constantly changing beings. Imagination reveals the soul-expression of these beings; through inspiration, we delve into their spiritual essence. Above all, we become aware of a variety of spiritual beings and their relationships with one another. In the physical world, we also deal with many different beings, but in the world of inspiration, this variety has a different nature. In that world, each being maintains specific relationships with all the other beings, not through external influences as in the physical world, but through their essential inner nature.
When we become aware of a being in the world of inspiration, no external impression made upon another is apparent, such as might be compared with the influence of one physical being upon another; a relation nevertheless exists which is purely the result of the inner constitution of the two beings. This relationship may be compared with that in which the separate sounds or letters of a word stand to one another in the physical world. If we take the word “man,” the impression made is due to a consonance of the letters, m-a-n. There is no impact nor other outer influence passing from the “m” to [pg 332] the “a,” but both letters sound together within “a whole,” owing to their very nature. This is why observations made in the world of inspirations can only be compared to reading and the observer sees the beings of this world like written characters which he must learn and whose inner relations must reveal themselves to him like a supersensible writing. Therefore occult science can call cognition through inspiration, figuratively, the “reading of the secret script.” How one may read by this “secret script” and how one can communicate what has thus been read will now be made clear by reference to previous chapters in this book. Man's being was first described as composed of different principles. It was then further shown how the cosmos in which man is developing, passes through various conditions; those of Saturn, Sun, Moon, and Earth. The perception by means of which we are able on the one hand to discern the principles of the human being, and, on the other, the successive states of the Earth and its previous transformations, is revealed to the imaginative cognition. But it is now further necessary that the relations existing between the Saturn state and man's physical body; between the Sun state and the etheric body, etc., be understood. It must be shown that even during the Saturn state the germ of man's physical body came into existence, and that it has then further developed to its present form during the Sun, Moon, and Earth periods.
When we recognize a presence in the world of inspiration, there's no visible external impact between them, like how one physical being affects another. However, a relationship exists that purely arises from the inner nature of both beings. This relationship can be likened to the way the distinct sounds or letters of a word relate in the physical world. For example, with the word “dude,” the impression it creates comes from the harmony of the letters: m-a-n. There’s no direct influence from the “m” to the "a," yet both letters resonate together within “a whole lot,” due to their inherent qualities. This is why experiences in the world of inspirations can only be likened to reading, where the observer perceives the beings of this world like written characters that must be learned, and whose inner links must reveal themselves like a non-physical writing. Hence, occult science describes cognition through inspiration metaphorically as the “reading the secret script.” How one reads this “hidden code” and communicates what has been read will now be clarified by referring back to earlier chapters in this book. Initially, man's essence was described as made up of different principles. It was then shown how the universe in which man is evolving, goes through various phases: those of Saturn, Sun, Moon, and Earth. The perception that allows us to discern both the principles of human existence and the successive states of the Earth along with its earlier transformations is revealed through imaginative understanding. Additionally, it’s crucial to comprehend the connections between the Saturn phase and man’s physical body, the Sun phase and the etheric body, and so on. It must be demonstrated that even during the Saturn phase, the seed of man's physical body began to form, which has since evolved into its current state throughout the Sun, Moon, and Earth periods.
It had to be shown for example, what changes took place in the human being owing to the separation of [pg 333] the sun from the earth, and also that something similar again took place in connection with the moon. We had, moreover, to make plain what contributed to the bringing about of such changes in mankind as those which took place in the Atlantean era, how they were manifested in the successive Indian, ancient Persian, Egyptian, and other periods. The description of this sequence of events is not the result of imaginative perception, but of inspirational cognition derived from the reading of the secret script. For such reading, the imaginative perceptions are like letters, or sounds, although such reading is not alone necessary for interpretations like the above. It would be impossible to comprehend the whole life-process of man by means of imaginative cognition alone. One might possibly be in a position to note how, in the process of dying, the psycho-spiritual principles detach themselves from what remains in the physical world, but it would be impossible to understand the connection between what happens to man after death and the preceding and following stages, were we unable to find our way through the facts obtained by imaginative cognition. Without inspirational knowledge the entire imaginative world would remain mere writing, at which we gaze but which we are unable to read.
It needed to be demonstrated, for instance, what changes occurred in humans due to the separation of [pg 333] the sun from the earth, and similarly with the moon. We also had to clarify what led to the changes in humanity that occurred during the Atlantean era and how these changes were reflected in the subsequent Indian, ancient Persian, Egyptian, and other periods. The account of this sequence of events doesn’t come from mere imagination but from insightful understanding gained through reading a hidden script. In this context, imaginative perceptions function like letters or sounds, yet this kind of reading is not solely sufficient for interpretations like the one above. It would be impossible to fully grasp the life process of a human being using imaginative insight alone. One might observe how, in the process of dying, the psycho-spiritual aspects separate from what remains in the physical realm, but understanding the link between what happens to a person after death and the stages before and after would be impossible without navigating through the facts gathered by imaginative insight. Without inspirational knowledge, the entire imaginative realm would just be words on a page that we can look at but cannot understand.
As the student proceeds from imagination to inspiration he will soon see how wrong it would be to neglect this understanding of the facts of the universe and limit himself only to those facts which, so to speak, touch his close personal interests. Indeed, [pg 334] those who are not initiated into these matters may be inclined to say: “The only thing that seems of any importance to me is that I should ascertain the fate of the human soul after death. If anyone can give me information upon that subject, it will suffice; but of what use is it for occult science to present to me such remote subjects as the Saturn and Sun states, or the separation of the moon and the sun, etc.?”
As the student moves from imagination to inspiration, they'll quickly realize how wrong it is to ignore an understanding of the universe's facts and to restrict themselves only to those facts that, so to speak, affect their immediate personal interests. In fact, [pg 334] those who aren't familiar with these topics might say: "The only thing that really matters to me is discovering what happens to the human soul after death. If anyone can share information on that topic, that's all I need; but what value does it have for occult science to discuss distant subjects like the states of Saturn and the Sun, or the separation of the moon and the sun, etc.?”
Those, however, who have been properly instructed in these things will recognize that a true understanding of what they desire to learn could not be obtained without knowledge of these matters, which appear so unnecessary to them. A delineation of man's states after death would remain utterly incomprehensible and valueless to one who is unable to connect it with ideas derived from those very far-off events. Even the most elementary observations of a clairvoyant necessitate his acquaintance with such things.
Those who have been properly taught about this will see that a real understanding of what they want to learn can’t be achieved without knowledge of these seemingly unnecessary topics. A description of a person's condition after death would be completely meaningless to someone who can't link it to ideas from distant events. Even the simplest observations from a clairvoyant require their familiarity with these matters.
When, for example, a plant passes from the blossom to a state of fruition, the clairvoyant observes a change in the astral being, which, while the plant is in blossom, has covered and surrounded the blossoming plant from above like a cloud. Had fructification not taken place, this astral being would have been changed into quite a different form from the one it now assumes in consequence of this fertilization. Now we understand the entire process thus clairvoyantly observed, if we have learned to comprehend our own nature through a knowledge of that [pg 335] great cosmic process, in which the earth and all its inhabitants were involved at the time of the separation from the sun. Before fertilization, the plant is in the same condition as was the whole earth before the sun separated from it. After the fertilization of the blossom, however, the condition of the plant is that of the earth after the separation of the Sun had taken place, while the moon-forces were still active in it.
When a plant transitions from flowering to bearing fruit, the clairvoyant can see a shift in the astral being, which, while the plant is blooming, has enveloped the flowering plant like a cloud from above. If fertilization hadn’t occurred, this astral being would have transformed into a completely different form than the one it takes on as a result of this fertilization. We can now understand the whole process as observed clairvoyantly, if we have learned to understand our own nature through knowledge of that [pg 335] great cosmic process in which the earth and all its inhabitants were involved at the time of the separation from the sun. Before fertilization, the plant is in the same state as the whole earth was before it separated from the sun. However, after the fertilization of the flower, the plant’s condition reflects that of the earth after the sun had separated, while the moon-forces were still active within it.
Those who have thoroughly assimilated the idea to be gained by a comprehension of this separation of the sun, will now be able to interpret correctly the significance of the process of plant fertilization, when it is said that “the plant previous to fructification is in a ‘sun state,’ and afterward in the ‘moon state.’ ” Indeed, it may be said of even the smallest occurrence in the world that it can be fully understood only when the reflection of great cosmic events is recognized in it. Otherwise its inner nature remains just as unintelligible as Raphael's Sistine Madonna would be for one who could see only a small blue speck, while the rest of it remained covered.
Those who have fully grasped the concept of the separation of the sun will now be able to accurately interpret the significance of plant fertilization when it's said that “The plant before it bears fruit is in a ‘sun state,’ and afterward, it’s in the ‘moon state.’” In fact, it can be said that even the smallest events in the world can only be completely understood when we recognize the reflection of larger cosmic events within them. Otherwise, their true nature remains just as incomprehensible as Raphael's Sistine Madonna would be for someone who could only see a small blue dot while the rest of it was hidden.
Everything that happens to man is a reflection of all those great cosmic events that have to do with his existence. Those who wish to understand the observations made by clairvoyant consciousness of the phenomena taking place between birth and death, and again between death and a new birth, will be able to do so if they first acquire the faculty of interpreting imaginative observations by means of conceptions [pg 336] gained by reflecting upon great cosmic events. These contemplations, indeed, furnish the key to a comprehension of human life. Therefore the study of Saturn, Sun, and Moon are, from the standpoint of occult science, at the same time a study of man.
Everything that happens to a person is a reflection of all the major cosmic events tied to their existence. Those who want to understand the insights gained from clairvoyant awareness of the phenomena occurring between birth and death, and again between death and a new birth, can do so if they first develop the ability to interpret imaginative insights through concepts gained by reflecting on significant cosmic events. These reflections truly provide the key to understanding human life. Thus, the study of Saturn, the Sun, and the Moon is, from the perspective of occult science, simultaneously a study of humanity. [pg 336]
Through inspiration one arrives at a knowledge of the relationships between the beings of the higher world, and a further stage of cognition makes it then possible to recognize the inner essential nature of these beings themselves. This stage of cognition is known to occult science as that of intuitive cognition.32
Through inspiration, one gains an understanding of the relationships between the entities of the higher realm, and a further stage of awareness allows for the recognition of the true inner nature of these entities. This stage of awareness is known in occult science as intuitive knowledge.32
Cognition of a sense-being implies standing outside of it, and judging it according to outer impressions. Intuitive cognition of a spiritual being implies being at one with it; uniting oneself with the inner nature of that being. Step by step, the occult student ascends toward such cognition. Imagination leads him no longer to consider phenomena as the external qualities of beings, but to recognize them as psycho-spiritual emanations; inspiration leads him further into the inner nature of these beings. Here we can again illustrate by means of the foregoing chapters what is the meaning of intuition. In those earlier chapters it has not [pg 337] only been stated how the progress of the Saturn, Sun and Moon evolutions proceeded; but also that beings took part, in widely different ways, in that progress, and mention was made of the Thrones or Spirits of Will, the Spirits of Wisdom, the Spirits of Motion, and so on. In connection with the earth's development, reference was made to the Luciferian spirits and spirits of Ahriman. The structure of the world was traced back to those beings who took part in it. All knowledge pertaining to these beings is derived from intuitive cognition, which is also necessary, if we wish to understand man's life.
Understanding a sense-being means standing apart from it and evaluating it based on external impressions. Intuitive understanding of a spiritual being means becoming one with it; merging with the inner essence of that being. Gradually, the occult student moves toward this kind of understanding. Imagination leads them to stop viewing phenomena as mere external traits of beings, but to see them as psycho-spiritual emanations; inspiration takes them deeper into the inner essence of these beings. We can illustrate this again using the previous chapters to grasp what intuition means. In those earlier chapters, it was not only explained how the evolution of Saturn, Sun, and Moon unfolded; it was also noted that beings participated in that evolution in various ways, including mentions of the Thrones or Spirits of Will, the Spirits of Wisdom, the Spirits of Motion, and so on. In relation to Earth’s development, there was discussion about Luciferian spirits and the spirits of Ahriman. The world's structure was traced back to those beings involved in it. All knowledge related to these beings comes from intuitive understanding, which is also essential for us to comprehend human life.
That which is released from the human physical body at death passes on through various states in the future. The more immediate conditions after death might, to some extent, be described by referring to imaginative cognition, but that which takes place when man has proceeded farther into that time lying between death and a new birth would be entirely incomprehensible to the imagination, did not inspiration come to its aid. For inspiration alone can disclose what can be revealed about man's life after its purification in the “land of spirits.” We come to a point where inspiration is no longer adequate—where it reaches the limit of its possibilities. For there is a period in human development, between death and a new birth, in which the human being is accessible only to intuition.
What is released from the human body at death moves through various states in the future. The immediate conditions after death can be somewhat described through imaginative thinking, but what happens when a person goes further into the time between death and rebirth would be completely beyond imagination, if not for the help of inspiration. Only inspiration can reveal what can be understood about a person's life after it has been purified in the "land of spirits." We reach a point where inspiration is no longer enough—where it hits the limits of what it can do. There is a period in human development, between death and rebirth, when a person can only be understood through intuition.
Yet this part of the human being is always within man, and if we wish to understand it in its true inner nature we must also seek it, between birth and death, [pg 338] by means of intuition. Anyone attempting to fathom man by means of imagination and inspiration alone would miss the very innermost being, that which continues from incarnation to incarnation. It is therefore by intuitive cognition alone that adequate research concerning reincarnation and Karma becomes possible, and all genuine knowledge of these processes is derived from research undertaken by means of intuition. If a man wishes to know his own inner self, he can only do so by intuition; by its aid he becomes aware of what it is that moves onward within him from incarnation to incarnation; and should it fall to anyone's lot to know something about his earlier incarnations, this can only take place through intuitive cognition.
Yet this aspect of our humanity is always present within us, and if we want to truly understand it, we must seek it out, between birth and death, [pg 338] through intuition. Anyone trying to grasp the essence of a person using only imagination and inspiration would overlook the deepest self, that which persists from one life to the next. Therefore, only through intuitive understanding can we conduct meaningful research on reincarnation and Karma, and all authentic knowledge about these processes comes from research conducted through intuition. If someone wants to know their own inner self, they can only achieve this through intuition; with its help, they become aware of what continues to move forward within them from one life to the next, and if someone happens to learn about their past lives, it can only happen through intuitive understanding.
Cognition through inspiration and intuition is attainable only by means of psycho-spiritual exercises, and they resemble those meditations practiced for the attainment of imagination which have already been described. While, however, in exercises for the development of the imagination, a connection is set up with impressions belonging to the world of the physical senses, such connections gradually cease in the case of exercises for inspiration. In order to understand more clearly what must be done, let us recall once more the symbol of the “rosy cross.” When we meditate on this we have before us a picture, of which the component parts have been taken from the world of the senses: there is the black colour of the cross, the roses, etc., [pg 339] and yet the combination of those various parts into the “rosy cross” is not derived from the world of the senses. If the student now endeavours to banish from his consciousness both the black cross and the red roses, as pictures of sense-realities, only retaining in his soul that spiritual activity which has been used in putting these parts together, he will then have a means for a meditation that will gradually lead him on to inspiration. He should put the question to himself somewhat in the following manner: “What have I done inwardly to construct that symbol from cross and rose? What I did (an act of my own soul), I will retain within my hold; but the picture itself I will allow to fade away out of my consciousness. I shall then be able to feel within me all that my soul did in order to produce the picture, though I no longer recall the picture itself. I will now live wholly within my own activity that created the picture. I will not meditate upon a picture, but upon the powers of my own soul which are capable of creating pictures.”
Gaining insight through inspiration and intuition can only be achieved through psycho-spiritual exercises, which are similar to the meditations aimed at enhancing imagination that we previously discussed. However, while exercises for developing imagination connect us with impressions from the physical world, those connections gradually fade away in exercises focused on inspiration. To better understand what needs to be done, let's revisit the symbol of the "Rosy cross." When we meditate on this, we have an image that includes elements from the sensory world: the black color of the cross, the roses, etc., [pg 339] but the way these pieces come together to form the "rose cross" doesn’t come from the sensory world. If the student now tries to remove both the black cross and red roses from their mind, treating them as sensory images, while holding on to the spiritual activity used to assemble these parts, they will find a way to meditate that will eventually lead to inspiration. They should ask themselves something like this: “What have I done internally to create that symbol of the cross and rose? What I did (an act of my own soul) I will keep to myself; but the image itself I will allow to fade from my awareness. I will then be able to feel everything my soul did to create the image, even if I no longer remember the image itself. I will now fully engage in my own activity that formed the image. I will not focus on an image, but on the abilities of my own soul that can create images.”
Such meditations must now be practised with various other symbols. This leads then to cognition through inspiration. Here is another example, that of meditating upon the growth and subsequent withering of a plant. Let the picture of a slowly growing plant arise in the soul, as it sprouts from the seed, unfolds leaf after leaf, then blossoms and fruits; then again as it begins to wither on to its complete dissolution. By the help of meditations on such a symbol as this, the student gradually attains [pg 340] a feeling concerning growth and decay of which the plant is but a symbol. If the exercises be persevered in continuously, the image of the transformation which underlies physical growth and decay can be evolved from this feeling.
Such meditations should now be practiced with various other symbols. This leads to understanding through inspiration. Here’s another example: meditating on the growth and eventual dying of a plant. Let the image of a slowly growing plant form in your mind, as it sprouts from the seed, unfolds leaf by leaf, then blooms and bears fruit; and then, as it starts to wither, it moves toward complete decay. Through meditations on symbols like this, the student gradually develops a sense of the growth and decay that the plant represents. If these exercises are practiced consistently, the image of the transformation underlying physical growth and decay can arise from this feeling. [pg 340]
But if one wishes to attain the corresponding stage of inspiration, this exercise must be practised quite differently. Here one's own activity of soul must be called to mind,—that which had obtained the conception of growth and decay from the image of the plant. The plant must now be allowed to vanish altogether from the consciousness, and the attention be concentrated entirely upon the student's own inner activity. It is only such exercises as these that help us to rise to inspiration. At first the occult student will find it difficult to fully grasp how to set about such an exercise. This is because man is used to permitting his inner life to be governed by outward impressions, and thus falls immediately into uncertainty and wavering when now he must unfold in addition a soul life which has freed itself from all connections with outward impressions.
But if someone wants to reach that level of inspiration, they need to practice this exercise in a completely different way. They have to remember their own inner activity—the understanding of growth and decay inspired by the image of a plant. The plant should now be completely removed from consciousness, and the focus should be entirely on the student's inner activity. Only exercises like this can help us achieve inspiration. Initially, the occult student might struggle to understand how to approach such an exercise. This is because people are used to letting their inner lives be influenced by external impressions, leading them to feel uncertain and hesitant when they are required to cultivate an inner life that is independent of these outer influences.
Here the student must clearly understand that he should only undertake these exercises if along with them he cultivates everything that may lead to firmness and stability in his judgment, emotional life, and character; these precautions are even more necessary than when seeking to acquire the faculty of imagination. Should he take these precautions, he will be doubly successful, for, in the first place, he will not risk losing the balance of his personality [pg 341] through the exercises; and secondly, he will acquire the capacity of being really able to carry out what is demanded in these exercises. They will be deemed difficult only as long as one has not yet attained a particular attitude of soul, and certain feelings and sentiments. He who patiently and perseveringly cultivates within his soul such qualities as are favourable to the growth of supersensible cognition, will not be long in acquiring both the understanding and the faculty for these practices.
Here, the student needs to clearly understand that they should only take on these exercises if they also work on developing everything that contributes to strength and stability in their judgment, emotional well-being, and character. These precautions are even more crucial than when trying to develop the imagination. By taking these precautions, they will be twice as successful. First, they won't risk losing the balance of their personality through the exercises; and second, they'll genuinely be able to accomplish what these exercises require. They will seem difficult only until one reaches a certain mindset and emotional state. Those who patiently and persistently cultivate qualities within themselves that support the development of higher knowledge will quickly gain both the understanding and the ability to perform these practices. [pg 341]
Any one who can acquire the habit of frequently entering into the quiet of his own soul, and who, instead of brooding over himself, transforms and orders those experiences he has had in life, will gain much. For he will perceive that his thoughts and feelings become richer, if through memory he establishes a relationship between the different experiences of life. He will become aware that he gains stores of new knowledge not only through new impressions and new experiences, but also by letting the old ones be active within him.
Anyone who can develop the habit of regularly entering the calm of their own mind, and who, instead of dwelling on themselves, organizes and reflects on their life experiences, will benefit greatly. They will realize that their thoughts and feelings become deeper when they connect different life experiences through memory. They'll notice that they gain a wealth of new knowledge not just from fresh impressions and experiences, but also by allowing past ones to resonate within them.
He who allows his experiences and his opinions free play, keeping himself with his sympathies and antipathies, personal interests and feelings entirely in the background, will prepare an especially fertile soil for supersensible cognition. He will in very truth be developing what may be called a rich inner life. But what is of primary importance is the balance and equilibrium of the qualities of the soul. People are very apt to become one-sided when indulging in certain activities of the soul. Thus, when [pg 342] a person has come to know the advantages of contemplation, and of dwelling upon pictures derived from his own thought-world, he is apt to develop a tendency to withdraw himself from the impressions of the outer world. Yet such a step only leads to parching and withering the inner life; and he will go farthest who manages to retain an unchecked receptivity for all impressions of the outer world, while possessing the power to withdraw within his own inner self. It is by no means necessary to think only of the so-called important events of life: every one, in every sphere of life, be his four walls ever so humble, will be possessed of experience enough, provided only his mind is truly receptive. Experiences need not be sought—they abound on every hand.
Whoever allows their experiences and opinions to flow freely, keeping their likes and dislikes, personal interests, and feelings in the background, will create a particularly rich ground for deeper understanding. They will truly be developing what we might call a vibrant inner life. However, what’s most important is the balance and harmony of the soul's qualities. People often become one-dimensional when they focus too much on certain activities of the soul. For example, when someone learns to appreciate contemplation and reflects on thoughts from their own mind, they might start pulling away from the influences of the outside world. But this only leads to a drying out of their inner life; the person who goes furthest is the one who can maintain an openness to all external impressions while having the ability to turn inward. It’s not necessary to only think about the so-called significant events of life: everyone, in every corner of life, no matter how modest their surroundings, will have enough experience, as long as their mind is genuinely open. Experiences don’t have to be chased—they are everywhere.
Of particular importance is the way in which experience may be utilized by the human soul. For instance, one may make the discovery that someone whom he or another greatly reveres, has some quality that must be regarded as a flaw in his character. An experience of this kind may lead the person to whom it comes to thoughts which will tend toward one of two different directions. He may simply feel that he can never again regard the person in question with the same degree of veneration; or on the other hand, he may say to himself: “How has it been possible for this revered person to be burdened with such a failing? How can I present the matter to my mind so as to see in this failing not merely a fault, but something that is the outcome of his life, possibly even caused by his noble [pg 343] qualities?” Whoever can place the question thus before his own mind may, perhaps, arrive at the conclusion that his veneration for his friend need not suffer the least diminution, in spite of the failing that has come to light.
What's especially important is how the human soul can use experience. For example, someone might realize that a person they or someone else greatly admires has a trait that should be seen as a flaw in their character. This kind of experience can lead the individual to think in one of two ways. They might feel that they can never view that person with the same level of respect again; or, on the other hand, they might ask themselves: "How could this respected person have such a flaw? How can I view this flaw not just as a mistake, but as something that comes from their life, possibly even stemming from their admirable [pg 343] qualities?" Anyone who can frame the question this way may indeed come to realize that their admiration for their friend doesn’t have to lessen at all, despite the flaw that has been uncovered.
Experiences of this nature will, each time they are met with, add something to our understanding of life. Yet it would certainly be a bad thing for one to allow himself to be tempted through this generous view of life, to excuse everything in those whom he happens to like, or to drop into the habit of ignoring every blamable action, in order thereby to seek some benefit to his own inner development. Blaming or excusing the mistakes of others merely as a result of an inner impulse, does not further our development. This can only happen if our action is governed by the particular case itself, regardless of what we may thereby gain or lose. It is absolutely true that we cannot learn by condemning a fault, but only by understanding it; but, at the same time, if, owing to understanding it, we exclude all disapproval of it, we likewise would not progress very far.
Experiences like this, each time we encounter them, will add to our understanding of life. However, it would be unwise for someone to use this generous perspective on life as an excuse for everything done by people they like, or to develop a habit of ignoring all questionable actions to gain some advantage in their personal growth. Blaming or excusing others' mistakes solely based on an internal impulse doesn't contribute to our development. Real growth can only happen when our actions are guided by the specifics of the situation, regardless of what we might gain or lose from it. It's true that we can't learn by simply condemning a fault; we can only learn by understanding it. However, if we exclude all disapproval because we understand the fault, we won't make much progress either.
Here, again, the important thing is to avoid one-sidedness, either in one direction or the other, and to establish harmony and balance of all qualities in the soul; and this is especially to be kept in mind in regard to one quality which is pre-eminently important to man's development: the feeling of devotion. Those who can cultivate this feeling, or on whom nature herself has bestowed so inestimable a [pg 344] gift, have a good foundation for the powers of supersensible cognition. Those who in childhood and youth have been able to look up to certain persons with feelings of devoted admiration, beholding in them some high ideal, will already possess in the depths of their souls the soil in which supersensible cognition may flourish abundantly. And those who, possessed of the maturer judgment of later life, can direct their gaze upon the starry heavens and surrender themselves unreservedly to admiration of the revelations of the Higher Powers, are in a like manner ripening their senses for the acquisition of knowledge with regard to the supersensible worlds. So is it also with those who can admire the powers ruling over human life itself. It is by no means of small importance for a fully matured man to be able to feel veneration to the highest degree for other people whose worth he senses or recognizes. For it is only where veneration such as this is present that a vista of the higher worlds can be revealed. Those who possess no sense of reverence will never go very far in their attainment of cognition; for from those who decline to appreciate anything in this world, the essence of all things will assuredly be withheld.
Here, again, what’s essential is to avoid being one-sided, whether in one direction or the other, and to create harmony and balance of all qualities in the soul; this is particularly important when it comes to one quality that is crucial for personal development: the feeling of devotion. Those who can nurture this feeling, or who have been naturally gifted with it, lay a strong foundation for the powers of higher knowledge. Those who, in childhood and youth, could look up to certain individuals with feelings of deep admiration, seeing in them a high ideal, will already have within their souls the fertile ground where higher understanding can thrive. Similarly, those who can, with the more mature judgment of adulthood, gaze up at the starry sky and wholeheartedly appreciate the wonders of the Higher Powers are also preparing themselves to gain insights into the spiritual realms. The same goes for those who can admire the forces that govern human life itself. It is quite significant for a fully developed individual to feel the utmost reverence for other people whose worth they recognize. Only where such reverence exists can a glimpse of the higher worlds be unveiled. Those who lack a sense of reverence will never go far in their pursuit of understanding; for those who refuse to appreciate anything in this world will surely miss out on the essence of all things.
Nevertheless, any one who permits his feelings of reverence and devotion to kill his healthy self-consciousness and self-confidence, is guilty of sinning against the laws of balance and equilibrium. The occult student must work constantly in order to mature his own nature; then indeed he may well have [pg 345] confidence in his own personality, and believe that its powers are increasing more and more. Any one arriving at the right feeling in this respect will say to himself: “There are within me hidden powers, and I am able to call them forth from within. If, therefore, I see something which fills me with reverence because it is above me, I need no longer merely venerate it, but I may confidently assume that, if I develop all that is in me, I may raise myself to the level of the object of my veneration.”
However, anyone who lets their feelings of reverence and devotion undermine their healthy self-awareness and self-confidence is failing to uphold the principles of balance and stability. An occult student must consistently work to develop their own nature; only then can they truly have confidence in themselves and believe that their abilities are growing increasingly powerful. Anyone who reaches the right mindset in this regard will think to themselves: "I have hidden powers inside me, and I can bring them out when needed. So, if I come across something that commands respect because it transcends me, I don’t just have to honor it anymore; I can confidently believe that if I nurture everything within me, I can rise to the level of what I admire."
The more capable a man is of fixing his attention upon these events of life with which he is not directly familiar, the greater will be the possibility of providing himself with a foundation for development in higher worlds. The following example will make this evident. Let us assume that some one is placed in a position in which it rests with him either to do, or leave undone, a certain thing. His judgment bids him “Do this,” while at the same time there may be a certain indefinite something in his feelings which deters him from the deed. It may so happen that the person in question will pay no heed to this inexplicable something, carrying out the action in accordance with his judgment. But it may also be that the person so placed will yield to this inner impulse and not perform the act. Now, pursuing the matter further, he may find that mischief would have resulted from his following the dictates of his reason, and that a blessing awaited him through the omission of the act. An experience of this nature may lead a man's thoughts into quite a definite channel, [pg 346] and then he will put the matter to himself in this way: “There is something within me that is a surer guide than that measure of judgment of which I am at present possessed: I must therefore retain an open mind toward this inner something, to the height of which my own capacity for judgment has not yet attained.”
The more a person can focus on life events that they're not directly familiar with, the better chance they have of building a foundation for growth in higher realms. Here's an example to illustrate this. Imagine someone has the choice to either take action or refrain from doing something. Their judgment tells them, “Do this,” but they might feel an ambiguous hesitation that holds them back. It’s possible that this person will ignore that vague feeling and go ahead with the action based on their judgment. However, they might also choose to listen to that inner impulse and decide not to act. If they explore this further, they could realize that following their reason would have led to trouble, while avoiding the action brought them some kind of blessing. An experience like this can really shape a person’s thinking, [pg 346] and they might start to think: “There's something inside me that's a more trustworthy guide than my current judgment: I need to stay open to this inner voice that my present judgment hasn't fully grasped yet.”
The soul derives much benefit when it directs its attention to occurrences in life such as these, for they demonstrate that man's healthy premonitions bear something in them which is of greater moment than he, with his present degree of judgment, is able to perceive. Attention in this direction has the effect of enlarging the life of the soul. Yet here again certain peculiarities may arise which are of themselves dangerous. One who accustoms himself to a perpetual disregarding of his judgment, owing to this or that “premonition,” would easily become a shuttle-cock tossed at the mercy of every kind of undefined impulse; indeed, it is not a far cry from such habitual indecision to a state of absolute superstition.
The soul gains a lot when it focuses on life events like these, as they show that a person’s strong instincts hold deeper significance than he can understand with his current level of judgment. Focusing on this can expand the soul’s experience. However, certain issues may arise that can be quite dangerous. Someone who constantly dismisses their judgment because of this or that "forewarning," can easily become like a shuttlecock, tossed around by every vague impulse; in fact, it’s not a big leap from such chronic indecisiveness to total superstition.
Every superstition is disastrous to the student of occult science. The possibility of gaining admission, by legitimate means, to the realms of the spiritual life must depend upon a careful exclusion of all superstition, phantasy, and dreaming. One who is pleased at having had a certain experience which cannot be grasped by human reason will not approach the spiritual world in the right manner. No partiality for the “inexplicable” will ever make one qualified for discipleship of the Spirit. Indeed the pupil should utterly discard the notion that a true mystic is one who is always ready to surmise the presence of what cannot be explained or explored. The right way is to be prepared to recognize on all hands hidden forces and hidden beings, yet at the same time to assume that what is “unexplored” today will be able to be explored when the requisite ability has been developed.
Every superstition is harmful to the student of occult science. The chance of gaining access, through legitimate means, to the realms of spiritual life relies on carefully excluding all superstition, fantasy, and dreaming. Someone who is pleased with having had an experience that can't be understood by human reason won't approach the spiritual world appropriately. No preference for the “incomprehensible” will ever qualify someone for discipleship of the Spirit. In fact, the student should completely reject the idea that a true mystic is always prepared to assume the presence of what cannot be explained or explored. The correct approach is to be ready to recognize hidden forces and beings on all sides, while also assuming that what is “untapped” today can be explored once the necessary skills have been developed.
There is a certain mood of soul which it is important for the pupil to maintain at every stage of his development. He should not let his urge for higher knowledge lead him to keep on aiming to get answers to particular questions. Rather should he continually be asking: How am I to develop the needed faculties within myself? For when by dint of patient inner work some faculty develops in him, he will receive the answer to some of his questions. Genuine pupils of the Spirit will [pg 348] always take pains to cultivate this attitude of soul. They will thereby be encouraged to work upon themselves, that they may become ever more and more mature in spirit, and they will abjure the desire to extort answers to particular questions. They will wait until such time as the answers come.
There’s a specific mindset that students need to maintain throughout their development. They shouldn't let their desire for deeper knowledge push them into just seeking answers to specific questions. Instead, they should keep asking themselves: How can I develop the necessary skills within myself? Because when, through dedicated inner work, a skill develops, they will find that some of their questions are answered. True students of the Spirit will always make an effort to nurture this mindset. This will motivate them to improve themselves, helping them grow more mature in spirit, and they will let go of the urge to extract answers to specific questions. They will hold on until the answers come naturally.
Here again, however, there is the possibility of a one-sidedness, which may prevent the pupil from going forward in the way he should. For at some moment he may quite rightly feel that according to the measure of his powers he can answer for himself even questions of the highest order. Thus at every turn moderation and balance play an essential part in the life of the soul.
Here again, however, there is the chance of being one-sided, which might stop the student from progressing as they should. At some point, they might rightly feel that based on their skills they can handle even the most significant questions on their own. So at every turn, moderation and balance are crucial in the life of the soul.
Many more qualities of soul could be cited that may with advantage be fostered and developed, if the pupil is seriously wanting to work through a training for Inspiration; and in connection with every one of them we should find that emphasis is laid on the supreme importance of moderation and balance. These attributes of soul help the pupil to understand the exercises that are given for the attainment of Inspiration, and also make him capable of carrying them out.
Many more qualities of the soul could be mentioned that can be beneficially nurtured and developed if the student sincerely wants to pursue training for Inspiration. In connection with each of these qualities, it’s important to highlight the critical need for moderation and balance. These soul traits help the student comprehend the exercises provided to achieve Inspiration and also enable them to effectively carry them out.
The exercises for Intuition demand from the pupil that he let disappear from consciousness not only the pictures to which he gave himself up in contemplation in order to arrive at Imaginative cognition, but also that meditating upon his own activity of soul, which he practiced for the attainment of Inspiration. This means that he is now to have in his soul literally nothing of what he has experienced hitherto, whether outwardly or inwardly. If, after discarding all outward and inward experience, nothing whatever is left in his consciousness that is to say, if consciousness simply slips away from him and he sinks into unconsciousness then that will tell him that he is not yet ripe to undertake the exercises for Intuition and must continue working with those for Imagination and Inspiration. A time will come however when [pg 349] an effect will linger in the consciousness which can just as well be made the object of meditation, as were before those outer and inner impressions. This something is, however, of a very special nature, and in comparison with all previous experiences, it is something absolutely new. When it occurs, we recognize it as something we have never known before. It is a perception, just as an actual sound is a perception, that strikes upon the ear; yet it can enter the consciousness only through intuition, just as the sound can only enter the consciousness by way of the ear. Thus with intuition, the last remnants of the physical and sentient are stripped from man's impressions, while the spiritual world begins to expand before the understanding in a form that has nothing in common with the characteristics of the world of the physical senses.
The exercises for Intuition require the student to let go of not only the images he immersed himself in during contemplation to achieve Imaginative cognition, but also the reflection on his own soul's activities that he practiced for gaining Inspiration. This means that he must now have absolutely nothing in his soul from what he has experienced so far, whether externally or internally. If, after letting go of all external and internal experiences, nothing remains in his consciousness—meaning that consciousness simply fades away and he falls into unconsciousness—then this indicates that he is not yet ready to take on the exercises for Intuition and should continue working with those for Imagination and Inspiration. However, a time will come when an effect remains in consciousness that can just as easily be the focus of meditation, as were those outer and inner impressions before. This aspect is of a very unique nature, and in comparison to all previous experiences, it is something entirely new. When it happens, we recognize it as something we have never encountered before. It is a perception, just like an actual sound is a perception that reaches the ear; yet it can only enter consciousness through intuition, just as sound can only reach consciousness through the ear. Thus, with intuition, the last traces of the physical and sensory are stripped from man's impressions, while the spiritual world begins to unfold before understanding in a form that has nothing in common with the features of the physical senses.
Imaginative cognition is attained by developing the lotus flowers within the astral body. Through those exercises undertaken for the attainment of inspiration and intuition, particular movements, formations and currents which were previously absent, now appear in the human etheric or vital body. These are the very organs which enable man to “read the secret script,” and bring that which lies beyond it within his reach. For to the clairvoyant, the changes which occur in the etheric body of a person attaining to inspiration and intuition appear in the following manner. Near the physical heart a new center is forming in the etheric body, which [pg 350] develops into an etheric organ. From this organ, movements and currents flow toward different parts of the human body, in the most varied manner. The most important of these currents approach the lotus flowers, pass through them and their separate petals, and thence direct their course outward, pouring themselves into outer space in the form of rays. The more developed a person is, the greater will be the circumference around him in which these rays become discernible. This centre near the heart is not, however, formed at the very beginning, under correct training. It is first prepared. A temporary center is first formed in the head: this then moves down to the region of the larynx and is finally transferred into the region of the heart. Under an irregular course of development it would be possible for the organ in question to develop near the heart at the outset. In that case the student, instead of arriving in due course at adequate, tranquil clairvoyance by regular means, would run the risk of turning into a visionary and dreamer.
Imaginative thinking is achieved by nurturing the lotus flowers within the astral body. Through the exercises aimed at gaining inspiration and intuition, specific movements, formations, and currents that were once absent now emerge in the human etheric or vital body. These are the very organs that allow a person to “read the hidden script,” bringing what lies beyond into their reach. For the clairvoyant, the changes that happen in the etheric body of someone gaining inspiration and intuition appear in the following way. Near the physical heart, a new center is forming in the etheric body, which [pg 350] develops into an etheric organ. From this organ, movements and currents flow to different parts of the human body in various ways. The most significant of these currents approach the lotus flowers, pass through them and their individual petals, and then change direction, pouring out into space as rays. The more advanced a person is, the larger the area around them in which these rays become visible. However, this center near the heart is not formed right away under proper training; it's first prepared. A temporary center initially forms in the head, then moves down to the larynx region, and finally relocates to the heart area. If development follows an irregular path, it's possible for the organ in question to develop near the heart from the start. In that case, instead of achieving adequate, calm clairvoyance through normal means, the student risks becoming a daydreamer and visionary.
Subsequent development enables the occult student to render these currents and organized parts of this etheric body independent of his physical body and to use them independently. The lotus flowers then serve him as instruments by which to move his etheric body. Yet, before this can take place, certain currents and radiations must come into action around his entire etheric body, surrounding this, as it were, with a fine network, thus encasing it as though it were a separate entity. When this has [pg 351] taken place, the movements and currents of the etheric body can without hindrance touch the outer psycho-spiritual world and unite with it so that outer psycho-spiritual occurrences and inner ones (those within the human etheric body) blend into one another. When this comes to pass, the moment has arrived when man can consciously experience the world of inspiration. This cognition takes place in a manner different from cognition of the physical sense-world. In this latter, we become aware of the world by means of our senses and form our ideas and concepts from these perceptions. But in the case of cognition through inspiration, this is not so.
The ongoing development allows the occult student to detach these currents and organized parts of the etheric body from the physical body and use them separately. The lotus flowers then act as tools to move the etheric body. However, before this can happen, certain currents and radiations need to activate around the etheric body, creating a delicate web that encapsulates it as if it were a distinct entity. Once this occurs, the movements and currents of the etheric body can freely engage with the outer psycho-spiritual world and connect with it, causing external and internal psycho-spiritual experiences (those within the human etheric body) to merge. When this happens, the moment arrives when a person can consciously experience the world of inspiration. This understanding occurs differently than how we perceive the physical sensory world. In that context, we become aware of our surroundings through our senses and form our ideas and concepts based on those impressions. But when it comes to understanding through inspiration, it works differently.
What is thus perceived is instantaneous; there is no thinking after the perception has taken place. That which in the case of physical sense-cognition is only afterward gained through the concept, is, in the case of inspiration, simultaneous with the perception. One would therefore become merged with the surrounding psycho-spiritual world, and be unable to differentiate oneself from it had not the fine network above alluded to been previously formed in the etheric body.
What is perceived happens instantly; there’s no thinking after the perception occurs. What is usually understood through physical senses afterward is, in the case of inspiration, simultaneous with the perception. Thus, one would become merged with the surrounding psycho-spiritual world and wouldn’t be able to differentiate oneself from it if the delicate network mentioned earlier hadn’t already been created in the etheric body.
When exercises for intuition are practiced, they not only affect the etheric body but extend their influence to the supersensible forces of the physical body. But it must not, of course, be imagined that effects are brought about in the physical body which are discernible to ordinary sense-observation, for these effects the clairvoyant alone is able to judge, and they have nothing to do with external powers [pg 352] of perception. They come as the result of a ripened consciousness, when this latter is able to have intuitional experiences, even though it has divested itself of all previous inner and outer experiences. The experiences of intuition are, however, subtle, delicate and intimate, in comparison with which the physical body, at its present stage of development, is coarse. For this reason, it offers a positive hindrance to the success of any exercises for attaining intuition. Nevertheless, should these be pursued with energy and perseverance, and with the requisite inner calm, they will ultimately overcome those powerful hindrances of the physical body. The occult student will become aware of this when he notices how, by degrees, particular actions of his physical body which hitherto had taken place without his own volition, now come under his control. He will also become aware that for a brief time he will feel the need, for instance, of so regulating his breathing (or some similar act) as to bring it into a kind of harmonious accord with whatever is being enacted within his soul, be it exercises or other forms of inner concentration.
When intuition exercises are practiced, they not only influence the etheric body but also extend their impact to the subtle energies of the physical body. However, it shouldn't be assumed that these effects are noticeable to regular sensory observation. Only someone with clairvoyant abilities can perceive these effects, which are unrelated to external means of perception. They emerge from a developed consciousness that can have intuitive experiences, even when it has shed all past inner and outer experiences. Intuitive experiences are subtle, delicate, and personal, especially when compared to the physical body, which, at its current level of development, is more coarse. For this reason, it acts as a significant barrier to successfully achieving intuition. However, if these exercises are pursued with energy, persistence, and the necessary inner calm, they will eventually overcome the strong barriers posed by the physical body. The occult student will realize this as he notices how, gradually, specific actions of his physical body, which once occurred without his intention, now come under his control. He will also feel that for a brief time, he needs to adjust his breathing—or some similar action—to create a harmonious alignment with whatever is happening within his soul, whether it's exercises or other forms of inner concentration. [pg 352]
The ideal development would be that no exercises should be done by means of the physical body but that everything which has to take place within it should result only as a consequence of exercises for intuition. As, however, the physical body offers such powerful impediments, the training may permit of some alleviations. These consist in exercises which affect the physical body; yet everything in [pg 353] this domain that has not been directly imparted by the teacher, or those having knowledge and experience of these things, is fraught with danger. Such exercises, for instance, include a certain regulated process of breathing to be carried out for a very short space of time. These regulations of the breathing correspond in quite a definite way to particular laws of the psycho-spiritual world. Breathing is a physical process, and when this act is so carried out as to be the expression of a psycho-spiritual law, physical existence receives the direct stamp, as it were, of spirituality, and the physical matter is transformed.
The ideal development would be that no exercises should be performed with the physical body, but that everything happening within it should only come as a result of exercises for intuition. However, since the physical body presents strong obstacles, the training may allow for some adjustments. These consist of exercises that impact the physical body; yet anything in this area that hasn’t been directly taught by knowledgeable teachers or those experienced in these matters can be dangerous. Such exercises include a specific, controlled breathing technique to be done for a very short period. These breathing regulations align closely with specific laws of the psycho-spiritual realm. Breathing is a physical act, and when done in a way that expresses a psycho-spiritual law, physical existence acquires a direct mark, so to speak, of spirituality, and the physical matter transforms.
For this reason occult science is able to call the change due to such direct spiritual influence, a transmutation of the physical body, and this process represents what is called “working with the philosopher's stone” by him who has a knowledge of these matters. He who knows these things, frees himself indeed from those concepts which have been limited by superstition, humbug and charlatanry. The significance of the phenomena does not become less to him who knows, just because, as a spiritual investigator, all superstition is foreign to him. When he has acquired a concept of a significant fact, he may be allowed to call it by its correct name although that name has been fixed upon it as a result of misunderstanding, error and nonsense.
For this reason, occult science can refer to the change caused by direct spiritual influence as a transformation of the physical body. This process is what is referred to as “working with the philosopher's stone” by those who are knowledgeable in these areas. Those who understand these concepts free themselves from the beliefs limited by superstition, deceit, and fraud. The significance of the phenomena does not diminish for someone knowledgeable, just because, as a spiritual investigator, all superstition is alien to them. Once they have grasped the concept of a significant fact, they are justified in calling it by its correct name, even if that name has arisen from misunderstanding, error, and nonsense.
As the occult student climbs the path leading to cognition of the higher worlds, he becomes aware at a particular point that the cohesion of the powers of his own personality is assuming a different form from that which it possesses in the world of the physical senses. In the latter the ego brings about a uniform co-operation of the powers of the soul—primarily of thought, feeling and will. These three soul powers are actually, under normal conditions of human life, in perpetual relation one with another. For instance, we see a particular object in the external world, and it is pleasing or is displeasing to the soul; that is to say, the perception of the thing will be followed by a sense of either pleasure or displeasure. Possibly we may desire the object, or may have the impulse to alter it in some way or other; that is to say, desire and will associate themselves with perception and feeling. Now this association is due to the fact that the ego co-ordinates presentment (thinking), feeling, and willing, and in this way introduces order among the forces of the personality. This healthy arrangement would be interrupted should the ego prove itself powerless in this respect: if, for instance, the will went a different way from the feeling or thinking. No man would be in a healthy condition of mind who, while thinking this or that to be right, nevertheless wished to do something which he did not consider right.
As a student of the occult progresses on the path to understanding the higher worlds, they reach a point where they realize their personal powers are taking on a different form than what they have in the realm of physical senses. In that realm, the ego facilitates a consistent collaboration of the soul's powers—primarily thought, feeling, and will. Normally, these three aspects of the soul are in constant interaction with each other in everyday human life. For example, when we see a specific object in the external world, it either brings pleasure or displeasure to the soul; in other words, perceiving something triggers a sense of either enjoyment or dissatisfaction. We might feel a desire for that object or feel compelled to change it in some way; this indicates that desire and will are connected to perception and feeling. This connection happens because the ego coordinates perception (thinking), feeling, and will, thus creating order among the personality’s forces. If the ego fails to manage this—such as when the will diverges from feeling or thinking—that healthy arrangement would be disrupted. No one would be in a healthy state of mind if, while believing something is right, they nonetheless wish to do something they do not consider right.
The same would hold good if a person desired, not the thing that pleased him, but that which displeased him. Now the person progressing toward higher cognition becomes aware that feeling, thinking, and willing do actually assume a certain independence; that, for example, a particular thought no longer urges him, as though of itself, to a certain condition of feeling and willing. The matter resolves itself thus: We may comprehend something correctly by means of thinking, but in order to arrive at a feeling or impulse of the will on the subject, we need a further independent impetus, coming from within ourselves. Thinking, feeling and willing no longer remain three forces, radiating from the ego as their common centre, but become, as it were, independent entities, just as though they were three separate personalities. For this reason, therefore, a person's own ego must be strengthened, for not only must it introduce order among three powers, but the leadership and guidance of three entities have devolved upon it.
The same applies if someone desires not what makes them happy, but what makes them unhappy. As a person progresses toward deeper understanding, they realize that feeling, thinking, and willing start to have a certain independence. For instance, a specific thought no longer drives them spontaneously to a certain feeling or desire. It breaks down like this: We can understand something clearly through thinking, but to develop a feeling or will about it, we need an additional independent drive that comes from within us. Thinking, feeling, and willing no longer remain three forces radiating from the ego as a common center; they become, in a sense, independent entities, almost like three separate personalities. For this reason, a person's ego must be strengthened, as it must not only bring order among these three powers but also take on the leadership and guidance of these three entities.
And this is what is known to occult science as the cleavage of the personality. Here is once more clearly revealed how important it is to add to the exercises for higher training others for giving fixity and firmness to the judgment, and to the life of feeling and will. For if certainty and firmness are not brought into the higher world, it will at once be seen how weak the ego proves to be, and how it can be no fitting ruler over the powers of thought, feeling and will. In the presence of this weakness, [pg 356] the soul would be dragged by three different personalities in as many directions, and its inner individual separateness would cease. But should the development of the occult student proceed on the right lines, this multiplication of himself, so to speak, will prove to be a real step forward, and he will nevertheless continue, as a new ego, to be the strong ruler over the independent entities which now make up his soul.
And this is what occult science calls the splitting of the personality. Once again, it's clear how important it is to complement higher training exercises with those that provide stability and strength to judgment, as well as to our feelings and will. If we don't bring certainty and firmness into the higher realm, it becomes obvious how weak the ego is and how unfit it is to control the powers of thought, feeling, and will. When faced with this weakness, the soul would be pulled in three different directions by three distinct personalities, causing its inner individuality to fade away. However, if the occult student’s development follows the right path, this multiplication of self, so to speak, will become a genuine advancement, and he will still be, as a new ego, a strong ruler over the independent entities that now comprise his soul.
In the subsequent course of development this division or cleavage is carried further; thought, now functioning independently, arouses the activities of a fourth distinct psycho-spiritual being; one that may be described as a direct influx into the individual, of currents which bear a resemblance to thoughts. The entire world then appears as thought-structure, confronting man just like the plant and animal worlds in the realm of the physical senses. In the same manner feeling and will, which have become independent, stimulate two other powers within the soul to work in it as separate entities. And yet a seventh power and entity must be added, which resembles the ego itself. Thus man, on reaching a particular stage of development, finds himself to be composed of seven entities, all of which he has to guide and control.
In the next phase of development, this division or split continues; thought, now functioning on its own, triggers the activities of a fourth distinct psycho-spiritual being, which can be seen as a direct influx into the individual of energies that resemble thoughts. The entire world then appears as a structure of thoughts, facing humans just like the plant and animal worlds do in the physical senses. Similarly, feelings and willpower, which have become independent, activate two other abilities within the soul to function as separate entities. Yet, an additional power and entity, akin to the ego itself, must be included. Therefore, as humans reach a certain stage of development, they discover they are made up of seven entities, all of which they need to guide and control.
The whole of this experience becomes associated with a further one. Before entering the supersensible world, thinking, feeling, and willing were known to man merely as inner soul-experiences. But as soon as he enters the supersensible world he becomes [pg 357] aware of things which do not express physical sense realities, but psycho-spiritual realities. Behind the characteristics of the new world of which he has become aware, he now perceives spiritual beings. These now present themselves to him as an external world, just as stones, plants and animals in the physical sense world, have impressed his senses. Now the occult student is able to observe an important difference between the spiritual world unfolding itself before him and the world he has hitherto been accustomed to recognize by means of his physical senses. A plant of the sense-world remains what it is, whatever man's soul may think or feel about it. This is not the case, however, with the images of the psycho-spiritual world, for these change according to man's own thoughts and feelings. Man stamps upon them an impression which is the result of his own being.
The entire experience connects with another one. Before entering the non-physical world, thinking, feeling, and willing were just internal experiences for humans. But as soon as he steps into the non-physical world, he becomes aware of things that don’t reflect physical sensations but instead reveal psycho-spiritual realities. Behind the traits of this new world that he has recognized, he now sees spiritual beings. These beings present themselves as an external world, just like stones, plants, and animals do in the physical world, which have influenced his senses. Now, the occult student can notice a significant difference between the spiritual world unfolding before him and the world he has previously understood through his physical senses. A plant in the physical world remains what it is, regardless of how a person's soul may think or feel about it. However, this isn’t true for the images of the psycho-spiritual world, as they change based on a person’s own thoughts and feelings. A person leaves an imprint on them that reflects their own essence.
Let us imagine a particular picture presenting itself to man in the imaginative world. As long as he maintains indifference toward it, it will continue to show a particular form. As soon, however, as he is moved by feelings of like or dislike with regard to it, its form will change. Pictures, therefore, at first present not only something independent and external to man, but they reflect also what man himself is. These pictures are permeated through and through with man's own being. This falls like a veil over the other beings. In this case man, even if confronted by a real being, does not see this, but sees what he himself has created. Thus he may [pg 358] have something true before him, and yet see what is false. Indeed, this is not only the case in respect to what man has observed concerning his own being, but everything that is in him impresses itself upon the spiritual world.
Let's picture a specific image appearing to a person in the world of imagination. As long as they remain indifferent to it, the image will keep a certain shape. However, as soon as they feel positive or negative emotions towards it, its shape will change. So, these images not only present something independent and external to the person, but they also mirror who the person is. These images are fully infused with the person’s essence. This acts like a veil over other beings. In this case, even when facing a real being, the person doesn't see it; instead, they see what they have created themselves. Thus, they might have something real in front of them, yet perceive something false. In fact, this is true not only regarding what a person has noticed about themselves, but everything within them leaves an impression on the spiritual world.
If, for example, a person has secret inclinations, which owing to education and character are precluded from revealing themselves in life, those inclinations will, nevertheless, take effect in the psycho-spiritual world, which is thus colored in a peculiar way, due to that person's being, quite irrespective of how much he may or may not know of his own being. And in order to be able to advance beyond this stage of development, it becomes necessary that man should learn to distinguish between himself and the spiritual world around him. It is necessary that he should learn to eliminate all the effects produced by his own nature upon the surrounding psycho-spiritual world. This can be done only by acquiring a knowledge of what we ourselves take with us into this new world. It is therefore primarily a question of self-knowledge, in order that we may become able to perceive clearly the surrounding psycho-spiritual world. It is true that certain facts of human development entail such self-knowledge as must naturally be acquired when one enters higher worlds. In the ordinary world of the physical senses man develops his ego, his self-consciousness, and this ego then acts as a point of attraction for all that appertains to man. All personal propensities, sympathies, antipathies, passions, opinions, etc., possessed [pg 359] by a person, group themselves, as it were, around this ego, and it is this ego likewise to which human Karma is attached. Were we able to see this ego unveiled, it would also be possible to see just what blows of fate it must yet endure in this and future incarnations, as a result of its life in previous incarnations and the qualities acquired. Encumbered as it is with all this, the ego must be the first picture that presents itself to the human soul, when ascending into the psycho-spiritual world. This double of the human being, in accordance with a law of the spiritual world, is bound to be his first impression in that world. It is easy to explain this fundamental law to ourselves, if we consider the following. In the life of the physical senses man is cognizant of himself only so far as he is inwardly conscious of himself in his thinking, feeling, and willing. This cognition is an inner one; it does not present itself to him externally, as do stones, plants and animals; but even through inner experiences, man learns to know himself only partially, for he has within him something that prevents deep self-knowledge, namely, the impulse to immediately transform this quality, when through self-cognition he is forced to admit its presence and concerning which he is unwilling to deceive himself.
If, for instance, someone has hidden tendencies that, due to their upbringing and personality, they can't express in their life, those tendencies will still manifest in the psycho-spiritual realm, which gets shaped in a unique way by that person's existence, regardless of how aware they are of their own nature. To grow beyond this stage of development, it's essential for a person to learn to differentiate between themselves and the spiritual world around them. They need to understand how to remove all the influence their own nature has on the surrounding psycho-spiritual environment. This can only be achieved by gaining insight into what we bring with us into this new world. So, it's fundamentally about self-awareness, enabling us to clearly perceive the surrounding psycho-spiritual realm. It's true that certain aspects of human development come with a level of self-awareness that naturally arises when one enters higher realms. In the ordinary physical world, a person develops their ego and self-consciousness, and this ego then acts as a magnet for everything related to that individual. All personal tendencies, likes, dislikes, passions, opinions, etc., that a person has tend to gather around this ego, and it is this ego that human Karma is linked to. If we could see this ego without any barriers, we could also see what challenges it must still face in this and future lives, due to its experiences in past lives and the qualities it has developed. Burdened with all this, the ego is the first image that appears to the human soul when rising into the psycho-spiritual world. This reflection of the human being, in alignment with a law of the spiritual realm, will inevitably be their first experience in that world. It's easy to understand this basic law when we consider the following: In physical life, a person is only aware of themselves as much as they are internally conscious of their thoughts, feelings, and desires. This awareness is internal; it doesn't present itself externally like stones, plants, and animals do. However, even through inner experiences, people can only partially know themselves because there is something within that hinders deep self-awareness—the desire to immediately change this quality when self-awareness forces them to recognize its presence, and they are unwilling to deceive themselves about it.
If he did not yield to this impulse, but simply turned his attention away from himself—remaining as he is—he would naturally deprive himself of even the possibility of knowing himself in regard to that particular matter. Yet should he “explore” [pg 360] himself, facing his characteristics without self-deception, he would either be able to improve them, or in his present condition of life he would be unable to do so. In the latter case a feeling would steal over his soul which we must designate a feeling of shame. Indeed, this is the way in which man's sound nature acts; it experiences through self-knowledge various feelings of shame. Even in ordinary life this feeling has a certain definite effect. A healthy-minded person will take care that that which fills him with this feeling does not express itself outwardly or manifest itself in deeds. Thus the sense of shame is a force urging man to conceal something within himself, not allowing it to be outwardly apparent.
If he doesn't give in to this impulse and just shifts his focus away from himself—staying as he is—he's basically denying himself even the chance to understand himself about that particular issue. But if he **"explores"** himself, confronting his traits without any self-deception, he might be able to improve them, or in his current state, he might find it impossible to do so. In the latter scenario, a feeling would gradually overtake his soul that we can call shame. This is how a person's true nature functions; it experiences various feelings of shame through self-awareness. Even in everyday life, this feeling has a specific impact. A mentally healthy person will make sure that what causes this feeling doesn't show outwardly or manifest in actions. Therefore, the sense of shame acts as a force pushing a person to hide something inside, preventing it from becoming obvious to others.
If we consider this well, we shall find it possible to understand why occult science should ascribe more far-reaching effects to another inner experience of the soul, very closely allied to this feeling of shame. Occult science finds that within the hidden depths of the soul a kind of secret feeling of shame exists, of which man in his life of the physical senses is unaware. Yet this secret feeling acts much in the same way as the conscious feeling of shame of ordinary life to which we have alluded; it prevents man's inmost being from confronting him in a recognizable image, or double. Were this feeling not present, man would see himself as he is in very truth; not only would he experience his thoughts, ideas, feelings and decisions inwardly, but he would perceive these as he now perceives stones, animals and plants.
If we think about this carefully, we'll realize why occult science attributes more significant effects to another inner experience of the soul that is closely related to this feeling of shame. Occult science identifies a certain hidden sense of shame deep within the soul, which a person is generally unaware of during their physical life. However, this hidden feeling operates similarly to the conscious feeling of shame we mentioned earlier; it stops a person's true essence from appearing to them in a recognizable form. If this feeling didn't exist, a person would see themselves for who they truly are; they would not only experience their thoughts, ideas, feelings, and decisions internally but would also perceive them just like they perceive stones, animals, and plants.
This feeling, therefore, is that which veils man from himself, and at the same time hides from him the entire spiritual world. For owing to this veiling of man's inner self, he becomes unable to perceive those things by means of which he is to develop organs for penetrating into the psycho-spiritual world; he becomes unable to so transform his own being as to render it capable of obtaining spiritual organs of perception.
This feeling, then, is what hides a person from themselves and also obscures the entire spiritual world. Because of this blockage of a person's inner self, they become unable to understand the things that would help them develop the abilities to access the psycho-spiritual realm; they can't change their own being in a way that allows them to gain spiritual perception.
If man aims however to form these organs of perception through correct training, that which he himself really is appears before him as the first impression. He perceives his double. This self-recognition is inseparable from perception of the rest of the psycho-spiritual world. In the everyday life of the physical world the feeling of shame here described acts in such a manner as to be perpetually closing the door which leads into the psycho-spiritual world. If man would take but a single step in order to penetrate into that world, this instantly appearing but unconscious feeling of shame, conceals that portion of the psycho-spiritual world which would reveal itself. The exercises here described do, however, unlock this world: and it so happens that the above-mentioned hidden feeling acts as a great benefactor to man, for all that we may have gained, apart from occult training, in the matter of judgment, feeling and character, is insufficient to support us when confronted by our own being in its true form; its apparition would rob us of all feeling of selfhood, self-reliance and self-consciousness. [pg 362] And that this may not happen, provision must be made for cultivating sound judgment, good feeling and character, along with the exercises given for the attainment of higher knowledge.
If a person aims to develop these sensory organs through proper training, their true self appears to them as the first impression. They recognize their own reflection. This self-awareness is connected to perceiving the rest of the psycho-spiritual world. In everyday life within the physical world, the feeling of shame described here continuously shuts the door to the psycho-spiritual world. If someone were to take even a single step toward entering that world, this immediate yet unconscious feeling of shame hides the part of the psycho-spiritual realm that would otherwise reveal itself. However, the exercises described here do unlock this world: and it turns out that this hidden feeling acts as a significant ally for people, because everything we may have learned, aside from occult training, about judgment, feeling, and character is not enough to support us when faced with our true selves; its manifestation would strip us of all sense of identity, confidence, and self-awareness. [pg 362] To prevent this from happening, we must make an effort to cultivate sound judgment, good feelings, and character, along with the exercises provided for gaining higher knowledge.
A correct method of tuition teaches the student as much of occult science as will, in combination with the many means provided for self-knowledge and self-observation, enable him to meet his double with assured strength. It will then appear to the student that he sees, in another form, a picture of the imaginative world with which he has already become acquainted in the physical world. Anyone who has first learned in the physical world, by means of his understanding, to apprehend rightly the law of Karma, is not likely to be greatly frightened when he sees his fate traced upon the image of his double. Anyone who, by means of his own powers of judgment, has made himself acquainted with the evolution of the universe, and the development of the human race, and who is aware that at a particular epoch of this development the powers of Lucifer penetrated into the human soul, will have little difficulty in enduring the sight of the image of his own individuality when he knows that it includes those Luciferian powers and all their accumulated effects.
A proper way of teaching helps the student learn enough about hidden knowledge so that, combined with the various tools for self-awareness and self-reflection, they can confidently confront their own dual nature. At this point, the student will notice that they are seeing, in a different form, a reflection of the imaginative world they’ve already encountered in the physical realm. Anyone who has learned in the physical world, through their understanding, to correctly grasp the law of Karma is unlikely to be overly scared when they see their destiny revealed in the image of their double. Anyone who, using their own judgment, has come to understand the evolution of the universe and the development of humanity—and is aware that at a certain moment in this evolution, the powers of Lucifer influenced the human soul—will find it relatively easy to accept the sight of their own individuality when they recognize that it encompasses those Luciferian powers and all the consequences that come with them.
This will suffice to show how necessary it is that no one should demand admission into the spiritual world before having learned to understand certain truths concerning it; learning them by means of his own judgment, as developed in this world of [pg 363] the physical senses. All that has been said in this book previous to the chapter concerning “Perception of the higher worlds,” should have been assimilated by the student in the course of his regular development, by means of his ordinary judgment, before he has any desire to seek entrance himself into the supersensible worlds.
This is enough to show how important it is that no one should seek to enter the spiritual world before they’ve learned to understand certain truths about it; they should learn these truths through their own judgment, as developed in this physical world through their senses. Everything discussed in this book before the chapter on "Understanding higher realms" should have been understood by the student during their regular development, using their normal judgment, before they feel any urge to seek entry into the higher realms.
Where the training has been such as to pay little heed to firmness and surety of judgment, and to the life of feeling and character, it may happen that the student will approach the higher world before being possessed of the necessary inner capacities. The meeting with his double would in this case overwhelm him. But what might also happen is that the person introduced into the supersensible world then would be totally unable to recognize this world in its true form, for it would be impossible for him to differentiate between what he sees in the things, and what they really are. For this distinction becomes possible only when a person himself has beheld the image of his own being and becomes able to separate from his surroundings everything which proceeds from his inner being.
If the training has focused little on developing strong decision-making skills and emotional awareness, the student might find themselves in the spiritual realm before they've built the necessary inner strengths. In this case, encountering their double could be overwhelming. Alternatively, the individual introduced to the spiritual world may struggle to recognize it as it truly is, as they wouldn't be able to tell the difference between what they perceive and the actual essence of things. This distinction can only be made when a person has confronted their own true self and can separate from their environment everything that arises from within them.
In respect to life in the world of physical sense, man's double becomes at once visible through the already mentioned feeling of shame when man nears the psycho-spiritual world, and in so doing, it also conceals the whole of that world. The double stands before the entrance as a “guardian,” denying admission to all who are as yet unfit, and it is therefore designated in occult science as the [pg 364] “guardian of the threshold of the psycho-spiritual world.” However, we may call it the “lesser guardian,” for there is another, of whom we shall speak later.
In terms of life in the physical world, a person's double becomes clearly visible through the previously mentioned feeling of shame as they approach the psycho-spiritual world, effectively hiding that entire realm. The double acts as a “guardian” blocking entry to anyone who is not yet ready, and in occult science, it is referred to as the [pg 364] "guardian of the threshold of the psycho-spiritual realm." However, we can refer to it as the "minor guardian," since there is another guardian that we will discuss later.
And besides this meeting with his double on entering the supersensible world as here described, man encounters the Guardian of the Threshold when he passes the portals of physical death, and it gradually reveals itself during that psycho-spiritual development which takes place between death and a new birth. However, the encounter can in no wise crush us, for we then know of other worlds of which we are ignorant during the life between birth and death. A person entering the psycho-spiritual world without having encountered the Guardian of the Threshold would be liable to fall a prey to one delusion after another. For he would never be able to distinguish between that which he himself brings into that world and what really belongs to it. But correct training should lead the student into the domain of truth, not of error, and with such training the meeting must, at one time or another, inevitably take place, for it is the one indispensable precaution against the possibilities of deception and phantasm in the observation of supersensible worlds. It is one of the most indispensable precautions to be taken by every occult student, to work carefully upon himself in order not to become a visionary, subject to every possible deception and self-deception, suggestion and auto-suggestion. Wherever correct occult training is followed, the causes of such [pg 365] deceptions are destroyed at their source. It would of course be impossible to speak here exhaustively of the many details to be included in such precautions, and we can only indicate in general the underlying principles. The illusions to be taken into account arise from two sources. In part they proceed from the fact that our own soul-being colors reality. In the ordinary life of the physical sense-world, the danger arising from this source of deception is comparatively small, because here the outer world always obtrudes itself upon the observer in its own sharp outline, no matter how much the observer is inclined to color it according to his wishes and interests. As soon, however, as we enter the imaginative world, the images are changed by such wishes and interests, and we then have actually before us that which we ourselves have formed or, at any rate, helped to form. Now, since through this meeting with the Guardian of the Threshold the occult student becomes aware of everything within him, of that which he can take with him into the psycho-spiritual world, this source of delusion is removed, and the preparation which the occult student undergoes prior to his entering that world is in itself calculated to accustom him to exclude himself—even in matters appertaining to the physical world—when making his observations, thus allowing things and occurrences to speak for themselves. Any one who has sufficiently practiced these preparatory exercises may await this meeting with the Guardian of the Threshold in all tranquillity; by this meeting [pg 366] he will be definitely tested whether he is now really capable of putting aside his own being even when confronting the psycho-spiritual world.
And besides this meeting with his counterpart upon entering the spiritual realm as described here, a person encounters the Guardian of the Threshold when they pass through the gates of physical death. This encounter gradually reveals itself during the psycho-spiritual development that happens between death and rebirth. However, this meeting can't overpower us, as we then become aware of other realms that we’re unaware of during the life between birth and death. If someone enters the psycho-spiritual world without first meeting the Guardian of the Threshold, they risk falling prey to one illusion after another. They wouldn’t be able to differentiate between what they personally bring to that world and what actually belongs to it. Proper training should guide the student toward truth, not error, and this meeting must eventually happen, as it is a crucial safeguard against the potential for deception and hallucination when observing spiritual realms. It's essential for every occult student to work diligently on themselves to avoid becoming a visionary susceptible to any possible deceptions, self-deceptions, suggestions, or auto-suggestions. Where correct occult training is practiced, the sources of such deceptions are eliminated at their origin. Of course, it’s impossible to discuss exhaustively all the details involved in these safeguards, and we can only outline the general principles. The illusions to be aware of come from two main sources. Partly, they arise from our own soul's influence on reality. In everyday life within the physical sense world, the danger from this source of deception is relatively low, because the external world always presents itself to the observer with clear definitions, regardless of how much the observer might want to color it with their desires or interests. However, once we enter the imaginative realm, the images are altered by those desires and interests, leading us to face what we ourselves have created or, at the very least, helped to create. Now, since through this meeting with the Guardian of the Threshold, the occult student becomes aware of everything within them, and what they can carry into the psycho-spiritual world, this source of delusion is eliminated. The preparation that the occult student undergoes before entering that world is designed to help them exclude themselves—even in matters relating to the physical world—when making observations, allowing events and occurrences to present themselves without bias. Anyone who has sufficiently practiced these preparatory exercises can approach this meeting with the Guardian of the Threshold calmly; this meeting will definitively test whether they can genuinely set aside their own being even when facing the psycho-spiritual realm.
In addition to this there is another source of delusion. This becomes apparent when we place the wrong interpretation upon an impression we receive. We may illustrate it by means of a very simple example taken from the world of the physical senses. It is the delusion we may encounter when sitting in a railway carriage; we think the trees are moving in the reverse direction to the train, whereas in fact we ourselves are moving with the train. Although there are many cases in which such illusions occurring in the physical world are more difficult to correct than the simple one we have mentioned, yet it is easy to see that, even within that world, means may be found for getting rid of those delusions if a person of sound judgment brings everything to bear upon the matter which may help to clear it up.
Besides this, there's another source of deception. This becomes clear when we misinterpret an impression we receive. We can illustrate this with a very simple example from our physical senses. It’s the illusion we might experience when sitting in a train; we might think the trees are moving opposite to the train, when in reality, we’re the ones moving with it. Although there are many situations where such illusions in the physical world are harder to correct than this simple one, it's clear that even within that world, there are ways to dispel those misconceptions if a sensible person applies everything they can to clarify the situation.
But as soon as we penetrate into the psycho-spiritual world such elucidations become less easy. In the world of sense, facts are not altered by human delusions about them; it is therefore possible to correct a delusion by unprejudiced observation of facts. But in the supersensible world this is not immediately possible. If we desire to study a supersensible occurrence and approach it with the wrong judgment, we then carry that wrong judgment over into the thing itself, and it becomes so interwoven with the thing, that the two cannot be easily distinguished. The error then is not in the person [pg 367] and the correct fact external to him, but the error will have become a component part of the external fact. It cannot therefore be cleared up simply by unprejudiced observation of the fact. This is enough to indicate an extremely fertile source of illusion and deception for one who would venture to approach the supersensible world without adequate preparation.
But once we dive into the psycho-spiritual realm, such explanations become more complicated. In the physical world, facts remain unaffected by our misconceptions; therefore, it's possible to correct a misunderstanding through unbiased observation of facts. However, in the supersensible realm, this isn’t immediately achievable. If we aim to study a supersensible event but approach it with a flawed perspective, we end up projecting that flawed perspective onto the event itself, making it so intertwined with the event that distinguishing between the two becomes difficult. The mistake isn’t just with the individual and the correct fact existing separately; rather, the misunderstanding becomes part of the external fact itself. Thus, it can't simply be resolved through unbiased observation of the fact. This underscores a significant source of illusion and deception for anyone who might try to engage with the supersensible realm without proper preparation.
As the occult student has now acquired the faculty to exclude those illusions originating from the coloring of the supersensible world-phenomena with his own being, so must he now acquire the faculty of making ineffective the second source of illusions mentioned above.
As the occult student has now developed the ability to eliminate those illusions that come from mixing his own being with the phenomena of the supersensible world, he must now also learn to render ineffective the second source of illusions mentioned above.
Only after the meeting with his double, can he eliminate what comes from himself and thus he will be able to remove the second source of delusion when he has acquired the faculty for judging by the very nature of a fact seen in the supersensible world, whether it is a reality or an illusion. Now if the illusions were of precisely the same appearance as the realities, differentiation would be impossible. But this is not the case. Illusions of the supersensible world have in themselves qualities which distinguish them definitely from the realities, and the important thing is for the occult student to know by what qualities he may be able to recognize those realities.
Only after meeting his double can he eliminate what comes from himself, allowing him to remove the second source of delusion. This happens when he's developed the ability to judge by the inherent nature of a fact seen in the supersensible world, whether it’s real or just an illusion. If the illusions looked exactly like the realities, it would be impossible to tell them apart. But that’s not the case. Illusions of the supersensible world have distinctive qualities that clearly set them apart from realities. It's crucial for the occult student to know which qualities help him recognize those realities.
Nothing seems more natural than that those ignorant of occult training should say: “How, then, is it at all possible to guard against delusions, since [pg 368] their sources are so numerous?” And further: “Can an occult student ever be safe from the possibility that all his so-called higher experiences may not turn out to be based on mere deception and self-deception (suggestion and auto-suggestion)?” Any one advancing these objections ignores the fact that all true occult training proceeds in such a manner as to remove those sources of delusion. In the first place, the occult student during his preparation, will have become possessed of enough knowledge about all that which may lead to delusion and self-delusion, that he will be in a position to protect himself against them. He has, in this respect, an opportunity, like that of no other human being, to render himself sober and capable of sound judgment for the journey of life. Everything he learns teaches him not to rely upon vague presentiments and premonitions. Training makes him as cautious as possible, and, in addition to this, all true training leads in the first place to concepts of the great cosmic events, to matters, therefore, which necessitate the exertion of the judgment, a process by which this faculty is at the same time rendered keener and more refined. But those who decline to occupy themselves with these remote subjects, and prefer keeping the revelations nearer at hand, might miss the strengthening of that sound power of judgment which gives certainty in distinguishing between illusion and reality. Yet even this is not the most important thing, but the exercises themselves, carried out through a systematic course of occult [pg 369] training. These must be so arranged that the consciousness of the student is enabled during meditation to scan minutely all that passes within his soul. In order to bring about imagination, the first thing to be done is to form a symbol. In this there are still elements taken from external observation; it is not only man who participates in their content, he himself does not produce them. Therefore he may deceive himself concerning them and assign their origin to wrong sources. But when the occult student proceeds to the exercises for inspiration, he drops this content from his consciousness and immerses himself only in the soul-activity which formed the symbol. Even here error is still possible: education and study etc., have induced a particular kind of soul-activity in man. He is unable to know everything about the origin of this activity. Now, however, the occult student removes this, his own soul-activity, from his consciousness; if then something remains, nothing adheres to it that cannot easily be reviewed; nothing can intrude itself in respect to its entire content that cannot easily be judged.
Nothing seems more natural than for those unaware of occult training to ask: "How can anyone realistically protect themselves from delusions when there are so many sources?" And they might also wonder: "Can an occult student ever be completely safe from the chance that all their so-called higher experiences are just tricks or self-deception (suggestion and auto-suggestion)?" Anyone raising these objections overlooks the fact that all genuine occult training is designed to eliminate those sources of delusion. First of all, as the occult student prepares, they gain enough knowledge about all the things that could lead to delusion and self-delusion, allowing them to protect themselves. In this respect, they have an opportunity unmatched by any other person to develop clarity and sound judgment for life’s journey. Everything they learn instructs them not to depend on vague feelings and premonitions. Their training makes them as cautious as possible, and true training primarily leads to an understanding of great cosmic events, requiring the exercise of judgment, which simultaneously sharpens and refines this skill. However, those who choose not to engage with these distant subjects and prefer to keep revelations closer might miss out on strengthening their sound judgment, which is crucial for distinguishing between illusion and reality. Yet, even this isn’t the most important aspect; rather, it’s the exercises performed through a systematic course of occult training. These exercises must be arranged so that during meditation, the student’s consciousness is able to closely examine everything within their soul. To foster imagination, the initial step is to create a symbol. This includes elements derived from external observation; it’s not just humans who contribute to their content, as they don’t originate them themselves. Therefore, they might mislead themselves regarding their roots. But when the occult student engages in exercises for inspiration, they set aside this content from their consciousness and focus solely on the soul activity that created the symbol. Even here, mistakes can occur: schooling and study have shaped a specific kind of soul activity within a person, and they may not fully understand its origins. Now, however, the occult student detaches this personal soul activity from their consciousness; if something remains, it has nothing attached that cannot be easily reviewed or judged.
In his intuition, therefore, the occult student possesses something which shows him the pure, clear reality of the psycho-spiritual world. And if he applies this recognized test to all that meets his observation in the realm of psycho-spiritual realities, he will be well able to distinguish appearance from reality. He may also feel sure that the application of this law provides just as effectually against delusions in the spiritual world as does the knowledge [pg 370] in the physical world that an imaginary piece of red-hot iron cannot burn him.
In his intuition, the occult student has something that reveals the clear, true reality of the psycho-spiritual world. By applying this recognized test to everything he observes in the realm of psycho-spiritual realities, he can easily tell the difference between appearance and reality. He can also be confident that applying this principle is just as effective in preventing delusions in the spiritual world as the understanding in the physical world that an imaginary piece of red-hot iron can't burn him. [pg 370]
It is obvious that this test applies only to our own experiences in the supersensible world, and not to communications made to us which we have to apprehend by means of our physical understanding and our healthy sense of truth. The occult student should exert himself to draw a distinct line of demarcation between the knowledge he acquires by the one means, and by the other. He should be ready on one the hand to accept communications made to him regarding the higher worlds, and should seek to understand them by using his powers of judgment. When, however, he is confronted by an “experience,” which he may so name because it is due to personal observation, he will first carefully test the same to ascertain whether it possesses exactly those characteristics which he has learned to recognize by means of infallible intuition.
It’s clear that this test applies only to our own experiences in the supersensible world, not to the messages we receive that we need to understand through our physical reasoning and genuine sense of truth. The occult student should make a clear distinction between the knowledge gained from one method and the other. He should be open to accepting messages about higher realms and try to understand them by using his judgment. However, when faced with an "experience" which he may call that because it comes from personal observation, he should first carefully check it to see if it has the exact characteristics he has learned to recognize through infallible intuition.
The meeting with the Guardian of the Threshold being over, the occult student will have to face other new experiences, and the first thing that he will become aware of is the inner connection which exists between this Guardian of the Threshold and that soul-power we have already characterized, when describing the cleavage of personality, as being the seventh power to resolve itself into an independent entity. This seventh entity is, indeed, in certain respects no other than the double, or Guardian of the Threshold itself, and it lays a particular task upon [pg 371] the student. Namely, that which he is in his lower self and which now appears to him in the image, he must guide and lead by means of the new-born higher self. This will result in a sort of battle with this double, which will continually strive for the upper hand. Now to establish the right relationship to it, to allow it to do nothing except what takes place under the influence of the new-born ego, this is what strengthens and fortifies man's forces.
The meeting with the Guardian of the Threshold finished, the occult student will have to confront new experiences, and the first thing he will notice is the inner connection that exists between this Guardian of the Threshold and that soul-power we've already described, when talking about the split in personality, as being the seventh power that can become an independent entity. This seventh entity is, in some ways, nothing other than the double, or Guardian of the Threshold itself, and it places a specific task on the student. Essentially, he must guide and lead what he is in his lower self, which now appears to him in the form of an image, by using the newly awakened higher self. This will result in a kind of struggle with this double, which will constantly attempt to gain control. Now, establishing the right relationship with it, allowing it to do nothing without the influence of the new-born ego, is what strengthens and empowers a person.
This matter of self-cognition is, in certain respects, different in the higher worlds from what it is in the physical sense-world. For whereas in the latter, self-cognition is only an inner experience, the newly born self immediately presents itself as an outward psycho-spiritual apparition. We see our new-born self before us like another being, yet we cannot perceive it in its entirety, for, whatever the stage to which we may have climbed on our journey to the supersensible worlds, there will always be still higher stages which will enable us to perceive more and more of our “higher self.” It can therefore only partially reveal itself to the student at any particular stage. Having once caught a glimpse of this higher self, man feels a tremendous temptation to look upon it in the same manner in which he is accustomed to regard the things of the physical sense-world. And yet this temptation is salutary; it is indeed necessary, if man's development is to proceed in the right manner. The student must here note what it is that appears as his double, as the Guardian of the Threshold, and place it by the side [pg 372] of the higher self, in order that he may rightly observe the disparity between what he is and what he is to become. But while thus engaged in observation he will find that the Guardian of the Threshold will assume quite a different aspect, for it will now reveal itself as a picture of all the obstacles which oppose the development of the higher ego, and he then becomes aware of what a load he drags about with him in his ordinary ego. And should the student's preparation not have rendered him strong enough to be able to say: “I will not remain at this point, but will persistently work my way upward toward the higher ego,” he will grow weak and will shrink back dismayed before the labor that lies before him. He has plunged into the psycho-spiritual world, but gives up working his way farther, and becomes a captive to that image which, as Guardian of the Threshold, now confronts the soul. And the remarkable thing here is that the person so situated will have no feeling of being a captive. He will, on the contrary, think he is going through quite a different experience, for the image called forth by the Guardian of the Threshold may be such as to awaken in the soul of the observer the impression that in the pictures which appear at this stage of development he has before him the whole universe in its entirety—the impression of having attained to the summit of all knowledge, and of there being, therefore, nothing left to strive after. Therefore, instead of feeling himself a captive, the student would believe himself rich beyond all measure, and in possession [pg 373] of all the secrets of the universe. Nor need this experience fill one with surprise, though it be the reverse of the facts, for we must remember that by the time these experiences are felt, we are already standing within the psycho-spiritual world, and that the special peculiarity of this world is that it reverses events—a fact which has already been alluded to in our consideration of life after death.
This idea of self-awareness is, in some ways, different in the higher realms compared to how it is in the physical world. In the physical world, self-awareness is just an internal experience, but in the higher realms, the newly awakened self immediately appears as an external psycho-spiritual presence. We see our new self in front of us like another being, but we can't fully grasp it. No matter how far we've progressed on our journey to the spiritual dimensions, there will always be higher levels that allow us to see more of our “higher self” Thus, it can only partially show itself to us at any given stage. Once we get a glimpse of this higher self, we feel a strong temptation to view it just like we see things in the physical world. However, this temptation is beneficial; it's necessary for our development to continue in the right direction. We need to recognize what appears as our double, as the Guardian of the Threshold, and compare it to our higher self to clearly see the difference between who we are and who we are meant to be. While observing this, we'll notice that the Guardian of the Threshold will take on a different form, showing up as a representation of all the challenges we face in developing our higher ego. We then realize how much baggage we carry with our ordinary ego. If we haven't prepared ourselves to be strong enough to say: "I won’t stay at this level; I’ll keep working my way up to a higher ego." we may become weak and shrink back in fear of the work ahead. We have entered the psycho-spiritual realm, but if we give up trying to progress, we become trapped by the image that now stands before our soul as the Guardian of the Threshold. Interestingly, the person in this situation often doesn’t feel like a captive. On the contrary, they may believe they are undergoing a completely different experience, as the image summoned by the Guardian might create the impression that they are seeing the whole universe at this stage of development, leading them to feel they have reached the peak of all knowledge and have nothing left to pursue. As a result, instead of feeling trapped, the student may think they are incredibly wealthy and possess [pg 373] all the universe's secrets. This experience shouldn't be surprising, even if it contradicts reality, because by the time we feel these things, we are actually within the psycho-spiritual world, which uniquely distorts events—a fact we've previously mentioned when discussing life after death.
The image seen by the occult student at this stage of development shows him a different aspect from that in which the Guardian of the Threshold first revealed itself. In the double first mentioned, were to be seen all those qualities which, as the result of the influence of Lucifer, are possessed by man's ordinary ego. But in the course of human development, another power has, in consequence of Lucifer's influence, also been drawn into the human soul; this is known as the force of Ahriman. It is this force that, during his physical existence, prevents man from becoming aware of those psycho-spiritual beings which lie behind the surface of the external world. All that man's soul has become under the influence of this force, may be discerned in the image revealing itself during the experience just described. Those who have been sufficiently prepared for this experience will, when thus confronted, be able to assign to it its true meaning, and then another form will soon become visible—one we may describe as the “greater Guardian of the Threshold.” This one will tell the student not to rest content with the stage to which he has attained, but [pg 374] to work on energetically. It will call forth in him the consciousness that the world he has conquered will only become a truth, and not an illusion, if the work thus begun be continued in a corresponding manner. Those, however, who have gone through incorrect occult training and would approach this meeting unprepared, would then experience something in their souls when they come to the “greater Guardian of the Threshold,” which can only be described as a “feeling of inexpressible fright”, of “boundless fear.”
The image that an occult student sees at this stage of development reveals a different aspect compared to how the Guardian of the Threshold first showed itself. In the earlier image, all the qualities resulting from Lucifer's influence, which are part of the ordinary human ego, were visible. However, as human development progresses, another power, stemming from Lucifer's influence, has also entered the human soul; this is known as the force of Ahriman. This force prevents individuals from recognizing the psycho-spiritual beings that exist beyond the superficial external world during their physical lives. Everything that the human soul has become due to this influence can be seen in the image that emerges during this experience. Those who are adequately prepared for this encounter will be able to assign the true meaning to it when faced with it, and soon afterward, another form will become apparent—something we can refer to as the “Greater Guardian of the Threshold.” This entity will instruct the student not to be satisfied with their current progress but rather [pg 374] to work intensely. It will awaken in the student the understanding that the world they have mastered will only become a reality, not an illusion, if they continue this work in a corresponding way. However, those who have undergone improper occult training and attempt to engage in this meeting unprepared will experience something in their souls upon approaching the “Greater Guardian of the Threshold,” which can only be described as a “feeling of indescribable fear” and “endless fear.”
Just as the meeting with the “lesser Guardian” gives the occult student the opportunity of judging whether or not he is proof against delusions such as might arise through interweaving his own personality with the supersensible world, so too must he be able to prove from the experiences which finally lead to the “greater Guardian,” whether he is able to withstand those illusions which are to be traced to the second source mentioned farther back in this chapter. Should he be proof against the powerful illusion by which the world of images to which he has attained, is falsely displayed to him as a rich possession, when actually he is only a captive, then he is guarded also against the danger of mistaking appearance for reality during the further course of his development.
Just like meeting with the "junior Guardian" allows the occult student to assess whether he can resist delusions that may arise from mixing his own personality with the spiritual world, he must also verify through the experiences that ultimately lead to the “Greater Guardian,” whether he can withstand the illusions related to the second source mentioned earlier in this chapter. If he can resist the powerful illusion that makes the world of images he's accessed seem like a valuable possession, when in reality he is merely a captive, then he will also be protected from the risk of confusing appearance with reality as he continues his development.
To a certain degree the Guardian of the Threshold will assume a different form in the case of each individual. The meeting with him corresponds exactly to the way in which the personal element in [pg 375] supersensible observations is overcome, and therefore the possibility exists of entering a realm of experience which is free from any tinge of personality and is open to every human being.
To some extent, the Guardian of the Threshold will take on a unique form for each individual. The encounter with him directly reflects how the personal aspect of supersensible observations is transcended, making it possible to access a realm of experience that is free from any personal bias and is available to everyone.
When the occult student has passed through the above experiences, he will be capable of distinguishing in the psycho-spiritual world between what he himself is and what is outside of him, and he will then recognize why an understanding of the cosmic occurrences narrated in this book, is necessary to man's understanding of humanity itself and its life process. In fact, we can understand the physical body only when we recognize the manner in which it has been built up through the developments undergone in the Saturn, Sun, Moon, and Earth periods, and we understand the etheric body when we follow its evolution through the Sun, Moon, and Earth stages of evolution. We further comprehend what is bound up with our earth-development at present, if we can grasp how all things proceed by the process of gradual evolution. Occult training places us in a position to recognize the connection between everything that is within man and the corresponding facts and beings existing in the world external to him. For it is a fact that each principle of man stands in some connection with the rest of the world. The outlines of these subjects could only be briefly sketched in this book. It must however be borne in mind that the physical body had, at the time of the Saturn development, for instance, no more than its [pg 376] rudimentary beginnings. Its organs—such as the heart, lungs, and brain—developed later during the Sun, Moon, and Earth periods, for which reason heart, lungs and brain are related to the evolutionary process of Sun, Moon and Earth.
When the occult student has gone through the experiences mentioned above, they will be able to differentiate in the psycho-spiritual world between what they are and what is external to them. They will then understand why grasping the cosmic events described in this book is essential for understanding humanity and its life process. In fact, we can only comprehend the physical body when we recognize how it has been formed through developments in the Saturn, Sun, Moon, and Earth periods. We understand the etheric body when we trace its evolution through the Sun, Moon, and Earth stages of development. Furthermore, we grasp what is tied to our current earth development only if we can understand how everything evolves gradually. Occult training enables us to see the connections between everything within a person and the corresponding facts and beings in the external world. Each principle of humanity is linked to the rest of the world. The outlines of these topics can only be briefly sketched in this book. However, it’s important to remember that the physical body had, during the Saturn development, merely its rudimentary beginnings. Its organs—like the heart, lungs, and brain—developed later during the Sun, Moon, and Earth periods, which is why the heart, lungs, and brain relate to the evolutionary processes of the Sun, Moon, and Earth.
It is the same with the members of the etheric body, the sentient body, and the sentient soul. Man is the outcome of the entire world surrounding him, and every part of his constitution corresponds to some event, to some being in the external world. At a certain stage of his development the occult student comes to a realization of this relation of his own being to the great cosmos, and this stage of development may in the occult sense be termed a becoming aware of the relationship of the little world, the microcosm—that is, man himself—to the great world, the macrocosm. And when the occult student has struggled through to such cognition, he may then go through a new experience; he begins to feel himself united, as it were, with the entire cosmic structure, although he remains fully conscious of his own independence. This sensation is a merging into the whole world, a becoming “at one” with it, yet without losing one's own individual identity. Occult science describes this stage as the “becoming one with the macrocosm.” It is important that this union should not be imagined as one in which separate consciousness ceases and in which the human being flowers forth into the universe, for such a thought would only be the expression of an opinion resulting from untutored reasoning.
It’s the same with the members of the etheric body, the sentient body, and the sentient soul. A person is shaped by the entire world around them, and every part of their being corresponds to some event or being in the external world. At a certain point in their development, the occult student realizes this connection between their own existence and the vast cosmos. This stage of development can be described in occult terms as becoming aware of the relationship between the little world, the microcosm—that is, the individual person—and the great world, the macrocosm. Once the occult student has worked through to this understanding, they may experience something new; they begin to feel themselves connected, in a sense, to the entire cosmic structure while still being fully aware of their own independence. This feeling is a merging with the whole world, becoming "at once" with it, yet without losing their own individual identity. Occult science refers to this stage as “uniting with the universe.” It’s important to note that this union shouldn’t be imagined as a state where separate consciousness disappears, causing the human being to dissolve into the universe, as that idea would simply reflect a misunderstanding based on uninformed reasoning.
Following this stage of development something takes place that in occult science is described as “beatitude.” It is neither possible nor necessary that this stage be more closely described, for no human words have the power to picture this experience and it may rightly be said that any conception of this state could be acquired only by means of such thought-power as would no longer be dependent upon the instrument of the human brain. The separate stages of higher knowledge, according to the methods of initiation that have been here described, may be enumerated as follows:
Following this stage of development, something occurs that occult science refers to as “blessedness.” It's neither possible nor necessary to describe this stage in detail, as no human words can capture this experience. It's fair to say that any understanding of this state could only be achieved through a level of thought that transcends the capabilities of the human brain. The individual stages of higher knowledge, according to the initiation methods described here, can be listed as follows:
1. The study of occult science, in the course of which we first of all make use of the reasoning powers we have acquired in the world of the physical senses.
1. The study of occult science, where we primarily utilize the reasoning skills we've developed in the realm of physical senses.
2. Attainment of imaginative cognition.
2. Development of creative thinking.
3. Reading the secret script (which corresponds to inspiration).
3. Reading the hidden message (which relates to inspiration).
4. Working with the philosopher's stone (corresponding to intuition).
4. Working with the philosopher's stone (related to intuition).
5. Cognition of the relationship between the microcosm and the macrocosm.
5. Understanding the connection between the small and the large.
6. Being one with the macrocosm.
6. Connecting with the greater universe.
7. Beatitude.
Blessing.
These stages however need not necessarily be thought of as following one another consecutively, for in the course of training, the occult student, according to his individuality, may have attained a preceding stage only to a certain degree when he has already begun to practice exercises, corresponding [pg 378] to the next higher stage. For instance, it may be that when he has gained only a few reliable imaginative pictures, he will already be doing exercises which lead him on to draw inspiration, intuition, or cognition of the relationship between microcosm and macrocosm into the sphere of his own experiences.
These stages don't necessarily have to follow one after the other. During training, an occult student might reach a previous stage to a certain extent but simultaneously start practicing exercises that align with the next higher stage, depending on their individuality. For example, a student might only have a few reliable imaginative images and still be engaged in exercises that help them draw inspiration, intuition, or understanding of the relationship between the microcosm and macrocosm in their own experiences.
When the occult student has experienced intuition he comes to know not only the forms of the psycho-spiritual world, not only can he recognize their inter-relationship through the “secret script,” but he attains a cognition of these beings themselves through whose co-operation the world, to which he belongs, comes into being. Thus he learns to know himself in the true form which he possesses as a spiritual being in the psycho-spiritual world. He has struggled through to the higher ego, and has learned how he must continue the work in order that he may master his double, the Guardian of the Threshold. But he has also met the “greater guardian of the Threshold” who stands before him perpetually urging him to further labors. It is this greater Guardian of the Threshold who now becomes the ideal he must strive to resemble, and when the student has acquired this feeling he will have risen to that important stage of development in which he will be in a position to recognize who it is that is really standing before him as that “greater Guardian.” For henceforth, in the student's consciousness, the Guardian is gradually transformed into the figure of the Christ, whose Being and intervention [pg 379] in the evolution of the earth have been dealt with in a foregoing chapter.
When the occult student has had a moment of intuition, he starts to understand not just the forms of the psycho-spiritual world, but he can also see how they are interconnected through the "hidden code," and he gains an understanding of the beings themselves that help create the world he inhabits. This process allows him to truly recognize his own essence as a spiritual being within the psycho-spiritual realm. He has worked hard to reach the higher self and understands how to continue his journey in order to master his shadow self, the Guardian of the Threshold. However, he has also encountered the “greater guardian of the threshold” who is always there, pushing him toward further challenges. This greater Guardian of the Threshold now becomes the ideal he needs to aspire to, and once the student internalizes this aspiration, he will have reached a crucial stage of development where he can identify who stands before him as the "Greater Guardian." From this point on, the Guardian gradually transforms in the student's mind into the figure of Christ, whose essence and role in the earth's evolution have been discussed in a previous chapter.
Thus the student, through his intuition, will have become initiated into that sublime Mystery which is linked with the name of Christ. The Christ reveals himself to him as the “Great Ideal of humanity on earth.”
Thus the student, through his intuition, will have become initiated into that profound Mystery associated with the name of Christ. Christ reveals himself to him as the “Great ideal of humanity on Earth.”
When in this manner through intuition, the Christ has been recognized in the spiritual world, then we can also understand those events that took place historically upon earth during the fourth post-Atlantean period (the Greco-Roman time), and how at that time the great Sun-Spirit, the Christ-Being, intervened in the world's development, and how He still continues to guide its evolution. These are matters the student will then know by personal experience. Therefore it is through intuition that the meaning and significance of the earth's evolution are disclosed to the occult student.
When we recognize Christ in the spiritual realm through intuition, we can better understand the historical events that occurred on Earth during the fourth post-Atlantean period (the Greco-Roman era) and how the great Sun-Spirit, the Christ-Being, intervened in the world's development during that time, and how He continues to guide its evolution. These are things the student will learn through personal experience. Thus, it's through intuition that the meaning and significance of Earth's evolution are revealed to the occult student.
The path leading to cognition of the supersensible worlds as above indicated, is one which all men may travel, whatever their position under the present conditions of life may be. And in speaking of such a path it must be borne in mind that, while the goal of cognition and truth is the same at all times of the earth's development, yet the starting-point for man has varied considerably at different periods. For instance, the man of the present day who wishes to find his way into supersensible worlds, cannot start from the same point as the Egyptian candidate for initiation of old. This is why it is impossible [pg 380] for modern humanity to apply, without modification, the exercises given to the candidate for initiation in ancient Egypt. For since those times men's souls have passed through different incarnations, and this passing onward from incarnation to incarnation is not without significance and importance. The capacities and qualities of souls change from one incarnation to another. Those who have studied human history only superficially can note that since the twelfth and thirteenth centuries all life conditions have changed and that opinions, feelings and even human capabilities have become different from what they were before that time. The path here described for the acquirement of higher knowledge is one which is suitable for souls incarnating in the immediate present. It fixes the starting-point of spiritual development just where the man of the present day stands, in whatever conditions of life he may be placed.
The path to understanding the spiritual worlds, as previously mentioned, is accessible to everyone, regardless of their current life circumstances. It's important to keep in mind that while the end goal of knowledge and truth remains constant throughout the development of the Earth, the starting point for individuals has varied greatly at different times. For example, today’s person seeking to explore spiritual realms cannot begin from the same point as an ancient Egyptian initiator. Therefore, modern humanity cannot directly use the practices designed for ancient Egyptian initiates without modifications. Since that era, souls have undergone numerous incarnations, and this journey from one life to the next is significant and impactful. The abilities and characteristics of souls evolve from one incarnation to another. Those with only a shallow understanding of human history can observe that since the twelfth and thirteenth centuries, all aspects of life have transformed, leading to changes in opinions, emotions, and even human abilities compared to earlier times. The path outlined for obtaining higher knowledge is suitable for souls currently incarnating. It establishes the starting point for spiritual growth exactly where today’s individual is, no matter what their life circumstances are.
From epoch to epoch, progressive evolution leads humanity, in respect to the path of higher cognition, to ever changing modes, just as outer life likewise changes its form. For at all times it is necessary that perfect harmony should reign between external life and initiation. It will be pointed out in the next chapter of this book what changes initiation, which in the ancient mysteries lead into the higher worlds, must undergo, in order to become modern “initiation” for the attainment of supersensible cognition in its present form.
From era to era, progressive evolution guides humanity towards a higher understanding, leading to constantly changing methods, just as external life also transforms. At all times, it’s essential that there is perfect harmony between external life and initiation. The next chapter of this book will explain what changes initiation, which in the ancient mysteries led to higher realms, must undergo to become a modern “initiation” for achieving non-physical understanding in its current form.
Chapter VI. The Current and Future Evolution of the World and Humanity
It is impossible to know anything in the occult sense of the present and future of human or planetary evolution without understanding that evolution in the past. For, that which presents itself to the occult student's observation when he watches the hidden events of the past, contains at the same time everything that he can learn of the present and future. In this book we have spoken of the Saturn, Sun, Moon and Earth evolutions. We cannot follow the evolution of the earth, as the occultist understands it, unless we observe the events of preceding evolutionary periods. For what meets us today, within the bounds of our earthly globe, comprises in a certain sense the facts of the evolution of the Moon, Sun and Saturn. The beings and things that took part in the evolution of the Moon have gone on developing, and all that now belongs to the earth, is the outcome of that development.
It’s impossible to understand anything about the current and future evolution of humanity or the planet without knowing about its past evolution. What the occult student observes when looking at the hidden events of the past includes everything they can learn about the present and future. In this book, we’ve discussed the evolutions of Saturn, the Sun, the Moon, and the Earth. We can’t trace the evolution of the Earth, as an occultist understands it, without examining the events of earlier evolutionary periods. What we experience today on our planet reflects, in a way, the facts of the Moon, Sun, and Saturn's evolutions. The beings and things that were part of the Moon's evolution have continued to develop, and everything that now belongs to the Earth is a result of that development.
But not all that has evolved from the Moon to the Earth is perceptible to physical sense-consciousness. A part of what came over to us from the Moon evolution is revealed only at a certain stage of clairvoyant consciousness, at which knowledge of [pg 382] supersensible worlds is reached. When this knowledge is gained, the fact that our earthly planet is united to a supersensible world is recognized. The latter includes that part of lunar existence which is not sufficiently densified to be observed by the physical senses. In the first place it does not include it as it was at the time of the evolution of the original Moon. If this clairvoyant consciousness occupies itself with the perception of these things, which it can have at present, this latter gradually separates into two images. One presents the shape borne by the earth during the lunar evolution, the other shows itself in such a way, that we recognize as its content a form as yet in the germinal stage which will become a reality—in the sense in which the earth is now a reality—but only in the future.
But not everything that has come from the Moon to the Earth can be perceived with our physical senses. Some of what we inherited from the Moon's evolution can only be understood at a certain level of clairvoyant awareness, which allows access to knowledge about supersensible worlds. Once this knowledge is attained, we recognize that our earthly planet is connected to a supersensible realm. This realm includes aspects of lunar existence that are not dense enough to be detected by the physical senses. Firstly, it does not encompass how the Moon was during its original evolution. When this clairvoyant awareness focuses on perceiving these elements, it gradually divides into two images. One shows the form the Earth took during the lunar evolution, while the other reveals a content that resembles a form still in its early stages, which will eventually become a reality—similar to how the Earth exists now—but only in the future.
On further observation it is seen that the results, in a certain sense, of that which is taking place on the earth are continually streaming into that future form, so that in it we have before us that which our earth will ultimately become. The effects of earthly existence will unite with the events in the world described, and out of this the new cosmos will arise, into which the Earth will be transformed as the Moon was transformed into the Earth. This future form is called in occult science the Jupiter condition. The clairvoyant observer of this Jupiter state sees the revelation of certain events which must take place in the future. The reason for this is that in the supersensible part of the Earth which had its origin in the Moon, beings and things are present which [pg 383] will assume definite form when certain events have actually happened in the physical world. Therefore there will be something in the Jupiter condition which was already predetermined by the Moon evolution and it will contain new factors, which can come into the whole evolution only in consequence of terrestrial events. In this way clairvoyant consciousness is able to learn something of what will happen during the Jupiter state.
As we take a closer look, we see that the outcomes of what’s happening on Earth are constantly flowing into a future form, showing us what our planet will eventually become. The impacts of life on Earth will merge with the events in the world described, resulting in the new cosmos that Earth will transform into, just like the Moon was transformed into Earth. This future state is referred to in occult science as the Jupiter condition. A clairvoyant observing this Jupiter state perceives the unfolding of certain events that *must* occur in the future. This is because, in the non-physical portion of the Earth that originated from the Moon, beings and things exist that will take on specific forms once certain events have actually taken place in the physical world. Therefore, within the Jupiter condition, there will be elements that were already determined by the Moon's evolution, along with new factors that can only emerge as a result of earthly events. This way, clairvoyant awareness can gain insights into what will transpire during the Jupiter state.
The beings and facts observed in this field of consciousness have not the nature of sense-images; they do not even appear as fine air-structures from which effects might proceed which resemble sense-impressions. They give purely spiritual impressions of sound, light and heat. These are not expressed through any material embodiments. They can be apprehended only by clairvoyant consciousness. One may say, however, that these beings which at present manifest on the psycho-spiritual plane, possess a “body.” This body, however, appears like a sum of condensed memories which they carry within their souls.
The beings and facts observed in this realm of consciousness are not like sensory images; they don’t even seem like delicate air-forms that could produce effects resembling sensory impressions. They provide purely spiritual impressions of sound, light, and heat. These are not expressed through any physical forms. They can only be perceived by clairvoyant awareness. However, one could say that these beings currently showing up on the psycho-spiritual level have a “body.” This body, though, appears more like a collection of compressed memories they carry within their souls.
One can distinguish within their being what they are now experiencing and what they have experienced and now remember. This last is contained within them like a bodily element. They are conscious of it in the same way that an earthly human being is conscious of his body.
One can recognize what they are currently experiencing and what they have experienced and now remember within themselves. This memory is held inside them like a physical part of them. They are aware of it just like a person is aware of their body.
At a stage of clairvoyant development higher than that just described as necessary for a knowledge of the Moon and Jupiter, the student is able to perceive [pg 384] supersensible beings and things which are, in fact, the more highly developed forms of those present during the Sun condition, but which have now reached stages of existence so lofty as to be quite imperceptible to a consciousness capable of observing the Moon forms only. During meditation the picture of this world also divides in two. The one leads to a knowledge of the Sun state of the past; the other represents a future form of the earth existence—namely, that into which the earth will have been transformed when the fruits of all that takes place on it and Jupiter have merged into the forms of that future world. What can thus be observed of this future world may be characterized in occult phraseology as the Venus condition.
At a higher level of clairvoyant development than what’s needed to understand the Moon and Jupiter, the student can perceive [pg 384] supersensible beings and things that are actually more advanced forms of those present during the Sun phase, but have now reached such high stages of existence that they are completely undetectable to a consciousness that can only observe the Moon forms. During meditation, this world also splits into two parts. One path leads to an understanding of the Sun state of the past; the other represents a future state of earthly existence—specifically, what the Earth will become once the results of everything that happens on it and Jupiter have fused into the forms of that future world. What can be observed about this future world can be described in occult terminology as the Venus condition.
In a similar manner, to a still more highly evolved clairvoyant consciousness, a future state of evolution is revealed, which we may call the Vulcan state. It stands in the same relationship to the Saturn state as the Venus condition does to that of the Sun, or the Jupiter state to the evolution of the Moon. Therefore, when we contemplate the past, present, and future of the earth's evolution, we may speak of the Saturn, Sun, Moon, Earth, Jupiter, Venus, and Vulcan evolutions.
In a similar way, a more advanced clairvoyant awareness reveals a future evolution state that we can call the Vulcan state. It relates to the Saturn state in the same way the Venus state relates to the Sun, or the Jupiter state to the Moon’s evolution. So, when we think about the past, present, and future of the earth's evolution, we can refer to the Saturn, Sun, Moon, Earth, Jupiter, Venus, and Vulcan evolutions.
Just as these far-reaching conditions of the evolution of our earth lie disclosed to clairvoyant vision, the same vision is also able to cover the nearer future. There is a picture of the future corresponding to every picture of the past. In speaking of such things, however, one fact must be emphasized which [pg 385] should be taken into strict account: that in order to recognize facts of this kind, one must absolutely do away with the idea that they can be fathomed through mere philosophical reflection. These things cannot, and never should be investigated by that kind of thinking. Anyone would be labouring under a prodigious delusion who, after becoming acquainted with the teachings of occult science regarding the Moon state, thinks that he could discover the future conditions of Jupiter by comparing those of the Moon and Earth. These conditions must be investigated only when the requisite clairvoyant consciousness has been attained; but once communicated to others after such investigation, they can be understood without clairvoyant consciousness.
Just as the extensive processes of our Earth's evolution can be seen through clairvoyant insight, this same insight can also reveal the near future. For every picture of the past, there's a corresponding picture of the future. However, one important fact must be emphasized: to recognize these kinds of facts, one must completely eliminate the notion that they can be understood through simple philosophical thought. These matters cannot and should not be explored through that type of thinking. Anyone would be greatly mistaken if they learned about the teachings of occult science concerning the Moon state and thought they could uncover the future conditions of Jupiter by comparing them to the Moon and Earth. These conditions should only be examined once the necessary clairvoyant awareness has been achieved; however, once shared with others after such an examination, they can be comprehended without clairvoyant awareness.
Now the occultist finds himself in quite a different position, with regard to observations concerning the future, from that in which he stands with regard to those of the past. It is impossible at first for man to contemplate future events as impartially as he does those of the past. Future events excite human will and feeling; while the past affects us in quite a different way. He who observes life knows how true this is of everyday existence; but how enormously this truth is enhanced, and what an intimate bearing it has upon the hidden facts of life, can only be realized by one who has some knowledge of the supersensible world. That is the reason why those who know such things are very definitely limited as to what they are allowed to give out. Certain things bearing on the future can, in fact, be imparted only [pg 386] to those who have themselves determined to follow the path leading to the supersensible worlds. Such people by their mental attitude have acquired something which gives them the disinterestedness necessary for the reception of these teachings. For this reason certain secret facts, even of the past and present, can be spoken of only to those who are prepared for them in this way. These are facts so closely connected with future evolution, that their effect on the human soul is similar to that produced by communications regarding the future itself.
Now the occultist finds himself in a very different situation when it comes to thoughts about the future compared to those about the past. At first, it’s impossible for a person to view future events as objectively as they do past ones. Future events stir human will and emotions, while the past impacts us in a different way. Those who observe life know how true this is in everyday existence; but the depth of this truth and its significant connection to the hidden aspects of life can only be appreciated by someone who has some understanding of the supersensible world. That’s why those who possess such knowledge are very much restricted in what they can share. Certain insights about the future can really only be shared with those who have chosen to pursue the path leading to the supersensible worlds. These individuals, through their mindset, have developed a detachment that allows them to receive these teachings. For this reason, specific secret truths, even those of the past and present, can only be discussed with those who are prepared for them in this way. These truths are so closely linked to future developments that their effect on the human soul is similar to the impact of information about the future itself. [pg 386]
This explains, also, why the information in this book concerning the present and the future is given in the merest outline as compared with the more detailed descriptions of the evolution of the world and of humanity in the past. What is said here is not intended to appeal to the love of sensation in the smallest degree; not even to awaken it. We shall only state where the answer can be found to vital questions which naturally present themselves to one who holds a certain definite attitude of mind.
This also explains why the information in this book about the present and the future is provided only in basic outlines, while the past's descriptions of the world's and humanity's evolution are more detailed. What is presented here isn't meant to entice those with a love for sensationalism, nor to provoke it. We will simply indicate where to find answers to important questions that naturally arise for someone with a specific mindset.
Just as the great cosmic evolution can be portrayed in the successive states, from the Saturn to the Vulcan period, so also is this possible for shorter periods of time; for example, for those of the evolution of the earth. Since that mighty upheaval which terminated the ancient Atlantean life, successive periods of human evolution have followed one another which have been called in this work the ancient Indian, the ancient Persian, the Egypto-Chaldean, and the Greco-Roman. The fifth period is that in [pg 387] which humanity finds itself to-day,—it is the present time. This period gradually took its rise in the eleventh, twelfth, and thirteen centuries a.d., after a period of preparation commencing in the fourth and fifth centuries. The Greco-Roman period preceding it began about the eighth century b.c. When one-third of this period had elapsed, the Christ-event took place.
Just like the great cosmic evolution can be shown in its various stages, from the Saturn period to the Vulcan period, the same can be done for shorter timeframes, such as the evolution of the Earth. Since the massive upheaval that ended the ancient Atlantean civilization, there have been successive periods of human evolution referred to in this work as the ancient Indian, the ancient Persian, the Egypto-Chaldean, and the Greco-Roman. The fifth period is where humanity is right now—this present time. This period gradually began in the 11th, 12th, and 13th centuries A.D., following a preparation phase that started in the 4th and 5th centuries. The Greco-Roman period that came before it started around the 8th century B.C. When one-third of this period had passed, the Christ-event occurred.
During the transition from the Egypto-Chaldean to the Greco-Roman period, the attitude of the human mind and, indeed, all human faculties, underwent a change. In the first of these two periods what we now know as logical thinking, as a mere intellectual concept of the world, was still wanting. The knowledge which a man now acquires through his intelligence, he then gained in a manner suited to that time,—directly through an inner, in a certain sense, clairvoyant cognition. He perceived the things around him, and while perceiving them there arose within his soul the percept, the image that was needed. Whenever knowledge is gained in this way, not only pictures of the physical sense-world come to light, but from the depths of consciousness a certain knowledge of facts and beings arises which are not of the physical world. This was a remnant of the ancient dim clairvoyance, once the common property of the whole of humanity.
During the shift from the Egypto-Chaldean period to the Greco-Roman era, the way people thought and all of their mental faculties underwent a transformation. In the earlier period, what we now recognize as logical thinking, understood merely as an intellectual view of the world, was still absent. The knowledge that a person acquires today through intelligence was obtained back then in a way that fit that time—directly through an inner, somewhat clairvoyant understanding. People observed the world around them, and while doing so, an image or perception emerged within their souls that was necessary. When knowledge is gained in this manner, not only do images of the physical world emerge, but from deep within consciousness, a certain understanding of facts and beings that belong to a realm beyond the physical also arises. This was a remnant of the ancient, vague clairvoyance that was once common to all humanity.
During the Greco-Roman period an ever-increasing number of individuals appeared without these capacities. Intelligent reflection concerning things took their place. Mankind was more and more shut [pg 388] off from the immediate perception of the psycho-spiritual world, and was more and more restricted to forming a picture of it through intelligence and feeling. This condition lasted more or less during the whole of the fourth division of the post-Atlantean period. Only those individuals who had preserved the old mental state as an inheritance could still become directly conscious of the spiritual world. But these were stragglers from an earlier time. Their manner of gaining knowledge was no longer suitable for later conditions. For, as a consequence of the laws of evolution, old faculties of the soul lose something of their former significance when new faculties appear. Human life then adapts itself to these new faculties, and can no longer use the old ones properly.
During the Greco-Roman era, more and more people showed a lack of these abilities. Thoughtful consideration of things took their place. Humanity increasingly distanced itself from directly experiencing the psycho-spiritual world and relied more on intellect and emotions to form an understanding of it. This situation persisted throughout most of the fourth phase of the post-Atlantean period. Only those who had retained the old mental state as a legacy could still directly perceive the spiritual world. However, they were outliers from an earlier time. Their way of acquiring knowledge was no longer appropriate for later circumstances. As a result of the laws of evolution, older soul faculties lose some of their earlier relevance when new faculties emerge. Human life then adapts to these new abilities and can no longer properly utilize the old ones.
There were individuals, however, who began in full consciousness to add to the powers of intelligence and feeling already gained, the development of other and higher powers, which made it possible for them once more to penetrate into the psycho-spiritual world. To this end they were obliged to set to work in a different way from that in which the pupils of the old Initiates had been trained. The latter had not been obliged to take into account those faculties of the soul which were developed only in the fourth period. The method of occult training which has been described in this work as that of the present age, began in its first rudiments in the fourth period. But it was then only in its beginning, it could not attain real maturity until the fifth period [pg 389] (from the twelfth and thirteenth centuries onward). Those who sought to rise into supersensible worlds in this manner could learn something of the higher regions of existence through the exercise of their own imagination, inspiration, and intuition. Those who went no further than the development of the faculties of reason and feeling could learn only through tradition what had been known to ancient clairvoyance. This was handed on, either by word of mouth or in writing, from generation to generation.
There were people, however, who consciously started to enhance their existing intelligence and emotions by developing other, more advanced abilities, allowing them to re-enter the psycho-spiritual realm. To achieve this, they had to approach their training differently than the students of the old Initiates. The latter didn’t need to consider those aspects of the soul that only emerged in the fourth period. The method of occult training described in this work as relevant to the present age began to take shape in its early stages during the fourth period. However, it was only just beginning and couldn’t truly develop until the fifth period [pg 389] (from the twelfth and thirteenth centuries onward). Those who aimed to rise into the supersensible realms in this way could gain insights into the higher levels of existence through their own imagination, inspiration, and intuition. Those who stopped at merely developing their reasoning and emotional faculties could only learn through tradition what had been passed down from the ancient clairvoyants. This knowledge was shared either orally or in writing from one generation to the next.
Neither could those born later know anything of the real nature of the Christ-event save by such traditions, if they did not rise to the level of the supersensible worlds. Certainly there were such Initiates who still possessed the natural faculties of supersensible perception and yet who, through their development, had ascended into the higher worlds, in spite of their disregard of the new powers of intelligence and feeling. Through them a transition was effected from the old method of Initiation to the new. Such persons lived in later times as well. The essential characteristic of the fourth period is that, by the exclusion of the soul from direct communion with the psycho-spiritual world, the human faculties of intelligence and feeling were thereby strengthened and invigorated. The souls whose powers of intelligence and feeling had at that time developed to a great extent as the result of former incarnations, carried over with them the fruits of this development into their incarnations during the fifth period. As [pg 390] a compensation for this exclusion from the higher worlds, mighty traditions of Ancient Wisdom then existed, especially those of the Christ-event, which by the power of their content gave men confident knowledge of the higher worlds.
Neither could those born later understand the true nature of the Christ-event except through traditions, unless they reached the level of the spiritual realms. There were definitely Initiates who still had the natural abilities for spiritual perception and had developed to ascend into the higher worlds, despite neglecting the new powers of intellect and emotion. Through them, a shift occurred from the old method of Initiation to the new. Such individuals existed in later times as well. The key feature of the fourth period is that, by cutting off the soul from direct connection with the psycho-spiritual world, human abilities of intellect and emotion were strengthened and enhanced. The souls whose abilities of intellect and emotion had developed significantly from previous incarnations carried the benefits of this growth into their lives during the fifth period. As a compensation for this separation from the higher worlds, powerful traditions of Ancient Wisdom existed, especially those related to the Christ-event, which provided people with confident knowledge of the higher realms.
But there were still certain human beings existing who had evolved the higher powers of cognition in addition to the faculties of reason and feeling. It devolved upon them to learn the facts of the higher worlds, and especially of the Mystery of the Christ-event, by direct supersensible perception. From these individuals there always flowed into the souls of other men as much as was intelligible and good for them.
But there were still some people around who had developed advanced thinking skills in addition to reasoning and emotions. It was up to them to understand the truths of the higher realms, particularly the mystery of the Christ-event, through direct non-sensory perception. From these individuals, a stream of knowledge and goodness flowed into the souls of others that was understandable and beneficial for them.
The first spreading of Christianity was to take place just at a time when the capacities for supersensible cognition were undeveloped in a great part of humanity. And this is why tradition at that time possessed such mighty power. The strongest possible force was necessary to lead mankind to a faith in a supersensible world which they themselves could not perceive. How Christianity worked during that period has been shown in previous pages. There were always those, however, who were able to rise into higher worlds through imagination, inspiration, and intuition. These men were the post-Christian successors of the old Initiates, the teachers and members of the Mysteries. Their task was to recognize again, through their own faculties, what man had been able to perceive through ancient clairvoyance, and through the methods of ascent into higher worlds [pg 391] taught in the old Initiations; and in addition to this, to acquire the knowledge of the real nature of the Christ-event.
The initial spread of Christianity happened at a time when many people lacked the ability to understand things beyond the physical world. This is why tradition held such great power during that period. It took a strong influence to encourage people to believe in a spiritual world that they couldn't see for themselves. How Christianity operated during that time has been discussed in earlier sections. Nevertheless, there were always individuals who could reach higher realms through imagination, inspiration, and intuition. These individuals were the successors, after the rise of Christianity, of the old Initiates, the teachers and members of the Mysteries. Their role was to rediscover, using their own abilities, what humanity had once perceived through ancient clairvoyance and the methods of ascent taught in the old Initiations; and, in addition, to gain an understanding of the true nature of the Christ-event. [pg 391]
Thus there arose, among these “New Initiates,” a knowledge embracing everything contained in the old form of Initiation; but the central point of this teaching was the higher knowledge concerning the Mysteries of the coming of the Christ. Such teaching could only filter through into the general life of the world in scanty measure while the human souls of the fourth period were further developing the faculties of intellect and feeling; therefore, while this lasted, the doctrine was in truth secret. Then began the dawn of the new period designated as the fifth. Its essential characteristic lay in the progress made in the evolution of the intellectual faculties, which were then developed to a very high degree, and will unfold still further in the future. This process has been slowly going on from the twelfth and thirteenth centuries, becoming ever more rapid from the sixteenth century up to the present time.
Thus, among these "New Members," a knowledge emerged that encompassed everything from the old form of Initiation; however, the main focus of this teaching was the deeper understanding of the Mysteries related to the coming of Christ. This knowledge could only gradually integrate into the general life of the world while human souls in the fourth period were still developing their intellectual and emotional abilities; therefore, during this time, the doctrine was essentially kept secret. Then began the dawn of the new period known as the fifth. Its key feature was the advancements made in the evolution of intellectual faculties, which were developed to a very high degree and will continue to evolve even further in the future. This process has been gradually occurring since the twelfth and thirteenth centuries, becoming increasingly rapid from the sixteenth century to the present day.
Under these influences the evolution of the fifth period became an ever-increasing endeavour to foster the powers of intellect, while, on the contrary, the knowledge by faith of former times, and traditional wisdom, gradually lost its hold over the human soul. On the other hand, however, from the twelfth and thirteenth centuries on, there developed that which may be called an ever increasing flow of cognition born of modern clairvoyant consciousness. This “hidden knowledge” flows even though [pg 392] at first quite imperceptibly, into the human concepts of that period. It is only natural that even up to the present time the purely intellectual forces should have maintained an antagonistic attitude toward this knowledge. But that which must come to pass will do so in spite of all temporary antagonism. That “hidden knowledge” which is taking possession of humanity more and more may be called symbolically, the “wisdom of the Holy Grail.”
Under these influences, the evolution of the fifth period became an increasing effort to enhance intellectual abilities, while, conversely, the faith-based knowledge of earlier times and traditional wisdom gradually lost its influence on the human soul. However, starting from the twelfth and thirteenth centuries, there emerged what can be described as an ever-growing flow of understanding arising from modern clairvoyant awareness. This “secret knowledge” flows, even though [pg 392] at first it was quite subtle, into the human concepts of that time. It is only natural that even to this day, purely intellectual forces have maintained an opposing stance toward this knowledge. But what needs to happen will unfold regardless of any temporary opposition. That "secret knowledge" that is increasingly capturing humanity can symbolically be called the “wisdom of the Holy Grail.”
For he who learns to understand this symbol in its deeper meaning, as it is told in story and legend, will find that it symbolizes the nature of what has been called above, the knowledge of the new Initiation, with the Christ Mystery as its central point. Modern Initiates may therefore be called “the Initiates of the Grail.” The preliminary stages of the path to the supersensible worlds described in this book, leads to the “Wisdom of the Grail.” It is a peculiarity of this wisdom that its facts can be investigated only when the necessary means, as described in this book, have been acquired. Once investigated, however, these facts can be understood by means of those very soul-forces which are the result of the evolution of the fifth period. Indeed, it will become more and more evident that to an ever increasing extent those forces find satisfaction through this knowledge. We are now living at a time in which this knowledge must be absorbed by human consciousness in general to a much fuller extent than was formerly the case. And it is from this point of view that the teachings contained in this [pg 393] Christ-event will grow ever more powerful in proportion as human evolution assimilates the Wisdom of the Grail. The inner side of the development of Christianity will more and more keep pace with the exoteric side. That which may be learned through imagination, inspiration and intuition, concerning the higher worlds, in connection with the Christ Mystery, will penetrate ever more and more human thinking, feeling, and willing. The “hidden wisdom of the Grail” will be revealed, and as an inner force will more and more permeate the manifestations of human life.
For anyone who learns to grasp this symbol in its deeper meaning, as it's shared in stories and legends, they'll discover that it represents the nature of what we've referred to as the knowledge of the new Initiation, with the Christ Mystery at its core. Modern Initiates may therefore be called "the Grail Initiates." The initial steps on the path to the spiritual worlds described in this book lead to the “Wisdom of the Holy Grail.” A unique aspect of this wisdom is that its truths can only be explored once the necessary tools, as outlined in this book, have been obtained. Once explored, however, these truths can be understood through those very soul-forces that arise from the evolution of the fifth period. In fact, it will become increasingly clear that to a greater extent, those forces find fulfillment through this knowledge. We currently live in a time when this knowledge needs to be absorbed by human consciousness much more fully than it has been in the past. From this perspective, the teachings contained in this [pg 393] Christ-event will grow stronger as human evolution incorporates the Wisdom of the Grail. The inner development of Christianity will increasingly keep pace with its outward expression. What can be learned through imagination, inspiration, and intuition about the higher worlds in connection with the Christ Mystery will increasingly permeate human thinking, feeling, and will. The "hidden knowledge of the Grail" will be unveiled, and as an inner force, it will increasingly influence the expressions of human life.
Through the whole of the fifth period, knowledge concerning the supersensible world will flow into human consciousness; and when the sixth period begins, humanity will be able to regain on a higher level that clairvoyance which it possessed at an earlier epoch in a dim and indistinct manner. Yet the new acquisition will take a form quite different from the old. What the soul knew of higher worlds in ancient times, was not permeated by its own forces of intellect and feeling. Its knowledge was instinctive. In the future it will not only have instincts, but it will understand them, and feel them to be the essence of its own nature. When the soul learns a fact concerning some other being or thing, its intellect will find this fact verified through its own nature. Or when some fact regarding an ethical law or human conduct presents itself, the soul will say to itself: “My feeling is only justified when I carry out what is implied in this knowledge.” Such a [pg 394] condition of soul will have to be developed by a large part of humanity in the sixth period.
During the entire fifth period, knowledge about the supersensible world will come into human consciousness; and when the sixth period starts, humanity will be able to regain a higher level of clairvoyance that it once had, albeit in a vague and unclear way. However, this new understanding will take a form that's quite different from the old. The soul’s awareness of higher worlds in ancient times was not influenced by its own intellect and emotions; instead, it was intuitive. In the future, it won’t just have instincts, but it will also get it them and recognize them as part of its own essence. When the soul learns something about another being or object, its intellect will confirm this information through its own nature. Likewise, when a fact about an ethical law or human behavior arises, the soul will think to itself: "My feelings are only valid when I act based on this knowledge." This state of the soul will need to be developed by a significant portion of humanity in the sixth period.
In a certain manner, that which human evolution accomplished during the third period—the Egypto-Chaldean—is repeated in the fifth. At that time the soul could still perceive certain facts of the supersensible worlds, but this perception was disappearing. For the intellectual faculties were at that time beginning to develop and it was their mission to at first exclude man from the higher worlds. In the fifth period supersensible facts which in the third period were perceived in hazy clairvoyance, are again becoming manifest; but they are now interpenetrated by the intellectual and emotional life of the individual man. They are also imbued with what may be imparted to the soul by a knowledge of the Christ Mystery; therefore they assume a form totally different from that which they had previously.
In a way, what humanity achieved during the third period—the Egypto-Chaldean—is happening again in the fifth. Back then, the soul could still sense certain truths about the unseen worlds, but that ability was fading. This was because intellectual abilities were starting to develop, and their role was initially to separate humans from the higher realms. In the fifth period, the unseen truths that were vaguely perceived in the third period are becoming clear again; however, they are now intertwined with the individual's intellectual and emotional life. They are also enriched by what the soul can gain from understanding the Christ Mystery; as a result, they take on a completely different form than they did before.
Whereas in ancient times impressions from the higher worlds were felt as forces acting from out a spiritual world to which man did not properly belong, through development in later times these impressions are felt as those of a world into which man is growing, of which he more and more forms a part. Let no one suppose that a repetition of the Egypto-Chaldean civilization can take place in such a way that the soul would merely regain what then existed, and which has been handed on from that time. The Christ-impulse, rightly understood, impels the human soul which has experienced it, to feel and conduct itself as a member of a spiritual world, [pg 395] now recognizing it as a world to which it belongs, outside of which it previously existed.
In ancient times, people felt influences from higher realms as forces coming from a spiritual world that they didn’t truly belong to. Over time, these influences have evolved, and now they are experienced as part of a world that humans are growing into, a world they increasingly belong to. No one should think that we can just recreate the Egypto-Chaldean civilization as it once was, simply regaining what existed back then. The Christ impulse, when properly understood, encourages the human soul that has experienced it to view itself and act as a member of a spiritual world, now recognizing it as a realm to which it belongs, instead of a place it used to exist outside of. [pg 395]
In the same way that the third reappears in the fifth period, in order to become penetrated with those new qualities which the human soul gained during the fourth, so similarly the second period will revive within the sixth and the first, the ancient Indian, during the seventh. All the marvelous wisdom of ancient India which the great teachers of that day were able to proclaim, will reappear in the seventh period, as living truth in human souls.
In the same way that the third period shows up again in the fifth, to absorb the new qualities that the human soul developed during the fourth, the second period will also come back in the sixth, and the first, the ancient Indian, will return in the seventh. All the incredible wisdom of ancient India, which the great teachers of that time were able to share, will re-emerge in the seventh period, as a living truth within human souls.
Now the changes in the earthly environment of man take place in a manner which bears a certain relationship to his own evolution. When the seventh period has run its course, the earth will experience an upheaval which may be compared with the one which separated Atlantean from post-Atlantean times. And the transformed earth will again continue its evolution in seven divisions of time. The human souls which will then incarnate will experience, on a more exalted level, the kinship with the higher worlds which was possessed by the Atlanteans at a lower stage. But only those individuals will be able to cope with the new conditions of the earth who have built into their souls the qualities made possible by the influences of the Greco-Roman age, and of the periods following it,—the fifth, sixth, and seventh of the post-Atlantean evolution.
Now, the changes in the earth's environment happen in a way that relates to human evolution. When the seventh period comes to an end, the earth will go through an upheaval similar to the one that marked the transition from Atlantean to post-Atlantean times. The changed earth will continue its evolution in seven segments of time. The human souls that will incarnate then will experience a deeper connection to the higher worlds, similar to what the Atlanteans had but at a lower level. However, only those individuals who have developed the qualities influenced by the Greco-Roman era and the subsequent periods—the fifth, sixth, and seventh of post-Atlantean evolution—will be able to adapt to the new conditions on earth.
The inner nature of such souls will correspond to that which the earth has become by that time. All other souls must then remain behind, although up to [pg 396] that point they had been able to choose whether or not they would create for themselves the conditions necessary to advance with the others. Those souls alone will be ripe for the conditions arising after the next great catastrophe, who at the point of transition from the fifth to the sixth post-Atlantean period have attained the capacity for penetrating supersensible cognition with the forces of intelligence and feeling. The fifth and sixth are in a way the decisive periods. Those souls which have attained the goal of the sixth period will continue to develop accordingly in the seventh; but the others will, under the altered conditions of their surroundings, find but little opportunity to proceed with their neglected task. Only in a distant future will conditions again appear which will permit of this being done.
The inner nature of such souls will reflect what the earth has become by that time. All other souls will have to stay behind, even though they could have chosen until then whether or not to create the necessary conditions to progress with the others. Only those souls who are ready for the conditions that will arise after the next major catastrophe—who, at the transition from the fifth to the sixth post-Atlantean period, have developed the ability to understand deeper knowledge through their intelligence and emotions—will move forward. The fifth and sixth periods are crucial. Souls that reach the goal of the sixth period will continue to grow in the seventh; however, those who do not will find it hard to make any progress on their overlooked tasks due to the changed circumstances around them. Only in a distant future will conditions allow this to happen again.
Thus evolution proceeds from period to period. Clairvoyance observes not only those changes in the future in which the earth alone takes part, but those also which take place in conjunction with the heavenly bodies in its environment. A time will come in which the terrestrial and human evolution will be advanced so far that those forces and beings which were compelled to detach themselves from the earth during the Lemurian period, so as to afford to earth-beings the possibility of further progress, will be able once more to unite with the earth. Then the moon will again be united with the earth. This will happen because a sufficiently large number of human souls will then possess the inner powers [pg 397] which will enable them to render the Moon forces fruitful for further development. And this will occur at a time when, side by side with the high development of a certain number of human souls, another development, that of those who have chosen the path of evil, will parallel it. These straggler-souls will have accumulated in their Karma so much sin, ugliness and evil, that at first they will form a separate community, a perverse and erring section of humanity, keenly opposing what we understand as “good.” The “good” humanity will acquire little by little the power of using the Moon forces, and will thereby so transform the evil section as to enable it to keep pace with the advance of evolution as a separate earth kingdom. Through these labours of the good part of humanity, the earth, then reunited with the moon, will be able, after a certain period of development, to again unite with the sun and also with the other planets.
So, evolution moves from one era to the next. Clairvoyance not only sees the changes in the future that involve Earth, but also those that happen in relation to the celestial bodies around it. A time will come when both terrestrial and human evolution will progress to a point where the forces and beings that had to separate from Earth during the Lemurian period to allow Earth’s beings to advance will be able to reunite with it. Then the moon will once again be connected to Earth. This will happen because a significant number of human souls will have developed the inner abilities that will allow them to utilize the Moon’s forces for further growth. And this will take place when, alongside the advanced development of certain human souls, there is also a parallel development of those who choose the path of evil. These lost souls will have gathered so much sin, ugliness, and malice in their Karma that initially, they will form a separate community, a misguided and errant part of humanity, vehemently opposing what we consider “good.” The “good” humans will gradually gain the ability to harness the Moon’s forces, transforming the evil group so that they can keep up with the evolution as a distinct earthly kingdom. Through the efforts of the good part of humanity, Earth, then reunited with the moon, will eventually, after a certain period of development, be able to reunite with the sun and the other planets.
After an intermediate state, which will be a sojourn in a higher world, the earth will be transformed into the Jupiter condition. That which we now call the mineral kingdom will not exist on Jupiter; the forces of this mineral kingdom will be transformed into plant forces and the plant kingdom, which will have quite a new form compared with its present one, will appear in the Jupiter state as the lowest of the kingdoms, while above it, we find the animal kingdom, likewise transformed. Next comes a human kingdom—the descendants of the evil earth humanity. And then will appear the descendants [pg 398] of the good earth humanity, as a human kingdom on a higher level. A great part of the work of this last human kingdom consists in ennobling the souls which have sunk into the evil community, so that they may still gain admittance into the true human kingdom.
After a transitional period, which will be a stay in a higher realm, Earth will be transformed into a Jupiter-like state. What we currently refer to as the mineral kingdom will not exist on Jupiter; the energies of this mineral kingdom will shift into plant energies, and the plant kingdom, which will look completely different from how it appears now, will emerge in the Jupiter state as the lowest of the kingdoms. Above it, we will find the animal kingdom, also transformed. Following that will be a human kingdom—the descendants of the corrupt Earth humanity. Then, the descendants of the virtuous Earth humanity will emerge as a human kingdom on a higher level. A significant part of the mission of this last human kingdom is to uplift the souls that have fallen into the corrupt society, so they may still gain entry into the true human kingdom. [pg 398]
The Venus condition will be of such a nature that the plant kingdom will have disappeared also; the lowest kingdom will be the animal kingdom once more transformed, and above that there will be three successive human kingdoms of different degrees of perfection. The earth will remain united with the sun during the Venus period; while during that of Jupiter it will have happened that, at a certain point, the sun separates from Jupiter, the latter receiving its influence from outside. Then there is again a union between the sun and Jupiter, the transformation gradually passing into the Venus state. During that state another planet detaches itself from Venus, containing all kinds of beings which have opposed evolution, an “irredeemable moon,” as it were, following a path of evolution which is of a character impossible to describe, because it is too unlike anything which man can experience on earth. But evolved humanity will pass on in a fully spiritualized state of existence to the Vulcan evolution, a description of which lies beyond the scope of this work.
The Venus condition will be such that the plant kingdom will have vanished as well; the lowest kingdom will be the animal kingdom once again transformed, and above that, there will be three successive human kingdoms at different levels of perfection. The earth will stay connected with the sun during the Venus period; whereas during the Jupiter period, at some point, the sun will separate from Jupiter, which will then receive its influence from outside. After that, there will be a reunion between the sun and Jupiter, gradually leading into the Venus state. During that state, another planet will break away from Venus, containing all kinds of beings that have resisted evolution, an “lost cause moon,” so to speak, following an evolutionary path that is too unlike anything humans can experience on earth to describe accurately. However, evolved humanity will transition into a fully spiritualized state of existence leading to the Vulcan evolution, a description of which is beyond the scope of this work.
We see that from the fruits of the “Wisdom of the Grail” springs the highest ideal of human evolution conceivable for man: spiritualization attained by him through his own efforts. For in the end this [pg 399] spiritualization appears as a product of the harmony which he wrought out in the fifth and sixth periods of the present evolution, between the faculties of reason and emotion which he had then attained and cognition of supersensible worlds. That which he thus achieves within his soul will finally become in itself the outer world. The human spirit rises to the mighty impressions of its outer world and at first divines, later recognizes spiritual beings behind these impressions; the human heart senses the unspeakable exaltedness of the Spirit. Man can, however, also recognize that his inner experiences of intellect, feeling and character are but the germs of a nascent spirit world.
We see that from the results of the “Grail Wisdom” emerges the highest ideal of human evolution imaginable for people: spiritual growth achieved through their own efforts. Ultimately, this [pg 399] spiritual growth is a product of the harmony he established in the fifth and sixth periods of the current evolution, between the faculties of reason and emotion he had developed and the understanding of non-physical realms. What he achieves within his soul will eventually manifest as the outer world. The human spirit responds to the powerful impressions from the outer world and initially senses, later recognizes, spiritual beings behind these impressions; the human heart feels the indescribable greatness of the Spirit. However, a person can also understand that their inner experiences of intellect, emotion, and character are just the beginnings of a developing spiritual world.
He who thinks that human liberty is not compatible with a foreknowledge and predestination of future conditions, ought to consider that man's freedom of action in the future depends just as little on the arrangement of predestined things as does his liberty of action with regard to inhabiting a house a year hence, on the plans for which he is now settling. He will be as free as his innermost being will permit, within the house he has built; and he will be as free on Jupiter and on Venus as his inner life permits, even under the conditions which will arise there. Freedom will not depend on what has been predetermined by antecedent conditions, but on what the soul has made out of itself.
Anyone who believes that human freedom doesn't go along with knowing and being destined for what will happen in the future should think about how much control a person's future actions really have. Just like deciding to live in a house a year from now depends just as little on its planned layout as possible. A person will be as free as their true self allows them to be within the house they’ve created; and they will experience the same level of freedom on Jupiter and Venus as their inner self allows, regardless of the future conditions there. Freedom isn't determined by what has been set by previous circumstances, but by what the soul has developed within itself.
In the earth condition is contained that which has developed within the preceding Saturn, Sun and [pg 400] Moon states. Earth-man finds “wisdom” in the processes going on around him. This wisdom is there as the fruit of what has happened in the past. The Earth is the descendant of the “old Moon”; and the latter developed with all that belonged to it, into the “Cosmos of Wisdom.” The Earth is now at the commencement of an evolution, which will introduce a new force into this wisdom. It will cause man to feel himself an independent member of a spiritual world. This will come to pass because his ego will have been formed within him during the Earth period by the Lords of Form, as was his physical body on Saturn by the Lords of Will, his vital body on the Sun by the Lords of Wisdom, and his astral body on the Moon by the Lords of Motion.
In the state of the Earth lies everything that has developed during the previous phases of Saturn, Sun, and Moon. Earth humans discover "wisdom" in the processes happening around them. This wisdom is a result of past events. The Earth is a descendant of the "old Moon," which evolved along with everything associated with it into the "Cosmos of Wisdom." The Earth is now at the start of an evolution that will introduce a new force into this wisdom, making humans feel like independent members of a spiritual world. This will happen because their ego will have been shaped within them during the Earth phase by the Lords of Form, just as their physical body was formed on Saturn by the Lords of Will, their vital body on the Sun by the Lords of Wisdom, and their astral body on the Moon by the Lords of Motion.
By means of the co-operation of the Lords of Will, Wisdom and Motion, that which manifests as wisdom is brought forth. Through the labours of these three classes of spirits, the beings and processes of earth can harmonize in wisdom with the other beings of their world. It is the Lords of Form who bestowed on man his independent ego. In the future this ego will harmonize with the beings of Earth, Jupiter, Venus, and of Vulcan, by means of the force added to the existing wisdom during the Earth period. It is the force of love. This force must begin to arise within earth-humanity and the Cosmos of Wisdom develop into a Cosmos of Love. Everything which the ego is able to unfold within itself must give birth to love. The all-embracing archetype of love is set forth in the revelation of [pg 401] that lofty Sun-spirit indicated in the description of the Christ Mystery. Through Him the germ of love is planted in the innermost core of the human being; and from this starting-point it must flow through the whole of evolution. Just as the wisdom previously formed manifests in the forces of the earthly sense-world, in the “elementary forces” of to-day, so love itself will manifest in the future, in all phenomena, as the new “elementary force.”
Through the collaboration of the Lords of Will, Wisdom, and Motion, what we know as wisdom is brought to life. Thanks to the efforts of these three groups of spirits, the beings and processes on Earth can align in wisdom with other beings in their world. It is the Lords of Form who granted humanity its independent ego. In the future, this ego will connect with the beings of Earth, Jupiter, Venus, and Vulcan, enhanced by the force added to existing wisdom during the Earth period. This force is love. This force must begin to emerge within humanity and the Cosmos of Wisdom should evolve into a *Cosmos of Love*. Everything that the ego can develop within itself must give rise to love. The all-encompassing archetype of love is revealed in the teachings of [pg 401] as indicated by that elevated Sun-spirit described in the Christ Mystery. Through Him, the seed of love is planted deep within each person, and from this point, it must flow throughout all of evolution. Just as the wisdom previously formed is expressed in the forces of the earthly sensory world, in today’s "basic forces," so love itself will be expressed in the future, in all phenomena, as the new "basic force."
The secret of all future development is a recognition that everything achieved by man from a right comprehension of evolution is a sowing of seed which must ripen into love. And the greater the amount of love-force, so much the greater will be the creative force available for the future. In that which will grow from love, will lie the mighty forces leading to that culminating point of spiritualization described above. The greater the amount of spiritual knowledge that flows into human and terrestrial evolution, so much more living and fruitful seed will be stored up for the future. Spiritual knowledge is transmuted through its own nature into love. The whole process which has been described, beginning with the Greco-Roman period and extending throughout the present time, shows how this transformation, for which the beginning has now been made for future times, is to take place and to what end. That which has been prepared as wisdom on Saturn, Sun and Moon, is active in the physical, etheric and astral bodies of man; it shows itself there as the “Wisdom of the World”, but within the [pg 402] “ego” it becomes intensified. The wisdom of the outer world becomes inner wisdom in man from the Earth period onward and when it is concentrated in him, it becomes the germ of love. Wisdom is the necessary preliminary condition for love; love is the fruit of wisdom, reborn in the ego.
The key to all future development is realizing that everything humans achieve through a proper understanding of evolution is like planting seeds that must grow into love. The more love there is, the greater the creative power available for the future. What comes from love will contain the powerful forces leading to that ultimate point of spiritual growth mentioned earlier. The more spiritual knowledge that contributes to human and earthly evolution, the more living and productive seeds will be saved for the future. Spiritual knowledge transforms through its own essence into love. The entire process described, starting from the Greco-Roman period and continuing to the present, illustrates how this transformation, which has now begun for future times, will happen and for what purpose. What has been set up as wisdom on Saturn, Sun, and Moon is active within the physical, etheric, and astral bodies of humans; it is expressed there as the "Worldly Wisdom", but within the “self”, it becomes more intense. The wisdom of the external world becomes internal wisdom in humans from the Earth period onward, and when it is concentrated within them, it becomes the seed of love. Wisdom is the essential foundation for love; love is wisdom reborn within the ego.
Chapter VII. Insights from the Field of Occult Science Human Etheric Body
When the higher principles of man are observed with clairvoyant vision, the mode of perception is never precisely the same as that which comes from the outer senses. If we touch an object, and experience a sensation of warmth, we must distinguish between that which comes from the object, that which, as it were, streams out from it, and our own psychic experience. The inner psychic experience of perceiving warmth is something distinct from the heat which streams from the object. Now let us imagine this psychic experience quite by itself without the outer object. Let us call up the experience of a sensation of heat in our soul, without the presence of any external physical object to cause it. If such a sensation simply existed without cause, it would be mere fancy. The student of occult science experiences such inner perceptions without any physical cause. But at a certain stage of development they present themselves in such a manner that he knows (it has been shown that by the very nature of the experience he can know) that the inner perception is not fancy, but is caused by a psycho-spiritual being [pg 404] belonging to a supersensible world, just as the ordinary sensation of heat, for example, is caused by an external physical-sense object.
When the higher principles of humanity are perceived with insightful vision, the way we understand things is never exactly the same as how we perceive through our physical senses. If we touch an object and feel warmth, we have to differentiate between the warmth that comes from the object itself, which seems to radiate from it, and our own inner experience. The internal experience of feeling warmth is separate from the heat coming from the object. Now, let’s imagine this inner experience completely apart from the outside object. Let’s evoke the sensation of heat within our soul, without any external physical object triggering it. If such a sensation simply existed without a cause, it would be simply imaginary. A student of occult science can experience such inner perceptions without any physical trigger. However, at a certain point in their development, these perceptions emerge in such a way that they understand (as it has been demonstrated that the nature of the experience allows them to know) that the inner perception is not imaginary, but is caused by a psycho-spiritual entity [pg 404] belonging to a higher, non-physical realm, just as the ordinary sensation of heat, for instance, is caused by an external physical object.
It is the same with the perception of colour in the supersensible world. Here we must distinguish between the colour associated with the outer object, and the inner colour-sensation in the soul. Let us call up the soul's inner sensation when it perceives a red object in the physical, outer world of the senses. Let us imagine that we retain a very vivid recollection of the impression, but that we are looking away from the object. Let us imagine what we still retain as a memory-picture of the colour, to be an inner experience. We shall then distinguish between that which is an inner experience of the colour, and the external colour itself. These inner experiences differ entirely in their content from impressions of the outer senses. They bear much more the impress of what is felt as joy and sorrow than that of normal physical sensation. Now let us imagine an inner experience of this kind arising in the soul, without any suggestion from an outer sense object. A clairvoyant may have an experience of this kind, and may know too, in that case, that it is no fancy, but the expression of a psycho-spiritual being. Now if this psycho-spiritual being excites the same impression as does a red object of the physical-sense world, then that being is red. There will, however, always be the external impression first, and then the inner experience of colour, in the case of the physical-sense object; in that of the genuine clairvoyance [pg 405] of a man of to-day, it must be the contrary,—first the inner experience, shadowy, like a mere recollection of colour, and then a picture, growing more and more vivid. The less heed we pay to this necessary sequence of events the less we are able to distinguish between actual, spiritual perception and the delusions of fancy (illusion, hallucination, etc.).
It’s the same with how we perceive color in the otherworldly realm. We need to differentiate between the color linked to the outer object and the inner color sensation in the soul. Let’s recall the soul’s inner sensation when it sees a red object in the physical world. Imagine we remember that impression very vividly, even though we’re not looking at the object. What we retain as a mental image of that color becomes an inner experience. We’ll then distinguish between this inner experience of color and the external color itself. These inner experiences completely differ in content from impressions of the external senses. They more closely reflect feelings of joy and sorrow than typical physical sensations. Now, let’s imagine this inner experience emerging in the soul without any input from the outer senses. A clairvoyant might have an experience like this and recognize that it’s not just an imagination, but the expression of a psycho-spiritual being. If this psycho-spiritual being evokes the same impression as a red object in the physical world, then that being is red. However, there will always be an external impression first, followed by the inner color experience in the case of physical objects; in the case of true clairvoyance in a modern individual, it must be the opposite—first the inner experience, which is vague like a mere memory of color, and then a picture that becomes clearer. The less attention we pay to this essential order of events, the harder it is to tell the difference between real, spiritual perception and the tricks of the mind (like illusion, hallucination, etc.).
The vividness of the picture in a psycho-spiritual perception of this kind, whether it remains quite shadowy, like a dim concept, or whether it impresses us as intensively as an outer object, depends altogether upon the clairvoyant's stage of development. Now, the general impression obtained by the clairvoyant of the etheric body, may be thus described. When the clairvoyant has strengthened his will power to such a degree that, in spite of the fact that an individual stands before him in a physical body, he can abstract his attention from what the physical eye sees,—he is then able to see clairvoyantly into the space occupied by the man's physical body. Of course, a great increase of will power is necessary, in order to withdraw the attention not only from something in the mind, but from something standing before one, in such a way that the physical impression is quite extinguished. But this increase of will is possible, and is brought about by exercises for the attainment of supersensible cognition. The clairvoyant can then first have a general impression of the etheric body. Within his soul there arises the same inner sensation which he has, let us say, at the sight of a peach blossom; then [pg 406] this becomes vivid, so that he is able to say that the etheric body has the colour of peach blossoms. He next perceives the separate organs and currents of the etheric body. A further description of the etheric body may be given by relating the psychic experiences which correspond to sensations of heat or of sound-impressions, etc., for this etheric body is not merely a colour phenomenon. The astral body and the other principles of the human being, may also be described in like manner. He who takes this into consideration will understand just how descriptions should be taken which are given by occult science.
The clarity of the image in a psychological and spiritual perception, whether it stays vague like a faint idea or comes across as strong as a physical object, entirely depends on the clairvoyant's level of development. The overall impression that the clairvoyant gets of the etheric body can be described as follows. When the clairvoyant has boosted his willpower to such an extent that, even though a person is right in front of him in a physical form, he can focus his attention away from what the physical eye sees, he is then able to see clairvoyantly into the space occupied by the person's physical body. Naturally, a significant increase in willpower is required to shift attention not just from something in the mind but from something in front of him, effectively canceling out the physical impression. However, this increase in will is possible and can be achieved through practices aimed at attaining higher knowledge. The clairvoyant can then first gain a general impression of the etheric body. He experiences the same inner sensation, for example, as when he sees a peach blossom; this then becomes vivid, allowing him to say that the etheric body has the color of peach blossoms. He then perceives the individual organs and flows within the etheric body. Further descriptions of the etheric body can be made by relating to the emotional experiences that correspond to sensations of heat or sound, etc., as this etheric body is not just a color phenomenon. The astral body and other aspects of the human being can also be described similarly. Those who keep this in mind will understand how to interpret descriptions provided by occult science.
The Astral World
The Astral Realm
As long as we observe the physical world only, the earth, as man's dwelling place, appears like a separate cosmic body. But when supersensible cognition rises to higher spheres, this separation ceases. Thus one can say that the imagination, when beholding the earth, at the same time also perceives the Moon condition as it has developed up to the present time.
As long as we focus only on the physical world, Earth, as a home for humanity, seems like an isolated cosmic entity. However, when our understanding goes beyond the senses and reaches higher levels, this separation disappears. So, we can say that when we imagine the Earth, we also perceive the condition of the Moon as it has evolved up to now.
Now that world which is entered in this way is one to which not only the supersensible part of the Earth belongs, but is one in which also other cosmic bodies are imbedded, which in a physical sense are entirely separate from the earth. Therefore, the observer of supersensible worlds thus beholds not only the supersensible part of the earth, but also the supersensible part of other cosmic beings. If one should be impelled to ask why clairvoyants do not [pg 407] describe the appearance of Mars, etc., he should bear in mind that it is primarily a question of observing supersensible conditions of other planetary bodies, whereas the questioner is thinking of physical sense conditions. Therefore in this work it was possible to speak of certain relations of the earth's evolution to the simultaneous evolution on Saturn, Jupiter, Mars, etc. Now when the human astral body has been drawn away by sleep, it belongs not only to the earth, but to worlds of which still other regions of the universe (stellar worlds) are a part. Indeed, these worlds extend their influence to man's astral body even when he is awake. For this reason the name “astral body” appears to be justified.
Now, the world that we enter this way is not just the non-physical part of the Earth, but also a realm that includes other cosmic bodies, which are completely separate from the Earth in a physical sense. Therefore, when someone observes these non-physical worlds, they see not only the non-physical aspect of the Earth but also the non-physical parts of other cosmic entities. If one were to ask why clairvoyants do not describe the appearance of Mars or similar celestial bodies, they should remember that it primarily involves observing the non-physical conditions of other planets, while the questioner is thinking about physical conditions. Thus, in this work, we can discuss certain connections between the Earth's evolution and the concurrent evolution occurring on Saturn, Jupiter, Mars, and others. When the human astral body is separated during sleep, it belongs not only to Earth but also to worlds that are part of other regions of the universe (star systems). In fact, these worlds influence a person's astral body even while they are awake. That’s why the term "astral body" seems appropriate.
Of Man's Life After Death
Life After Death
Mention has been made, in the course of this book, of the time during which the astral body still remains joined to the etheric body of man after death. During this time there exists a slowly paleing recollection of the whole earth life just ended. The duration of this time varies in different individuals. It depends upon the strength with which the astral body clings to the etheric body, on the power which the former has over the latter. Supersensible cognition can gain an idea of this power by observing a person who, judging from his degree of fatigue, must of necessity fall asleep, but, by sheer inner force, keeps awake. It then appears that different people can keep awake for different lengths of time without being overpowered by sleep. The memory [pg 408] of the past life, in other words the connection with the etheric body, lasts about as long after death as the length of time a man can keep awake when, in the most extreme case, he is compelled to.
Mention has been made, in the course of this book, of the time during which the astral body still remains connected to the etheric body of a person after death. During this period, there exists a gradually fading memory of the entire recently ended earthly life. The duration of this time varies among different individuals. It depends on how strongly the astral body clings to the etheric body and the control the former has over the latter. Super-sensible awareness can grasp this control by observing a person who, judging by their level of fatigue, must inevitably fall asleep but, through sheer inner strength, stays awake. It then becomes clear that different people can remain awake for varying lengths of time without being overwhelmed by sleep. The memory of the past life, in other words, the connection with the etheric body, lasts about as long after death as the time a person can stay awake when, in the most extreme case, they are forced to. [pg 408]
When the etheric body is detached from the individual after death, something of it nevertheless remains for man's whole subsequent development; this may be described as an extract, or the essence of it. This extract contains the result of the past life, and is the vehicle of all that which, during man's spiritual development between death and a new birth, unfolds like a germ for the following life.
When the etheric body separates from a person after death, a part of it still stays with them for their entire future development; this can be thought of as an extract or essence. This extract holds the outcomes of the past life and serves as the foundation for everything that unfolds during a person's spiritual growth between death and their next birth, much like a seed for the upcoming life.
The duration of time between death and a new birth is determined by the fact that the ego, as a rule, returns to the physical sense-world only when that world has been so transformed that the ego can experience something new. During its sojourn in spiritual regions, its dwelling place on earth undergoes a change. But this change is connected with the great changes in the universe, with changes in the constellation of the earth, sun and so forth. These are changes in which certain repetitions take place, in connection with new conditions. They find an external expression in the fact, for example, that the point in the vault of heaven at which the sun rises at the beginning of spring makes a complete circuit in the course of about twenty-six thousand years. Hence this vernal point, in the course of the period mentioned, moves from one region of the [pg 409] heavens to another. In the course of the twelfth part of that time, that is to say, in about twenty-one hundred years, conditions on the earth have changed sufficiently for the human soul to experience something new upon it since its previous incarnation. However, since the experiences of an individual vary according to whether he is incarnated as a woman or as a man, there are, as a rule, two incarnations within the time stated, one as a man and one as a woman. But these things are also dependent upon the nature of the forces which man carries with him from his earthly existence through death. Therefore all the statements given here are to be taken only in a general sense, but can be subject to the greatest variations in special cases.
The time between death and a new birth is typically determined by when the ego returns to the physical world, and it usually does so only after that world has changed enough for the ego to experience something new. While in the spiritual realm, the physical environment undergoes transformation. This change is tied to significant shifts in the universe, including those involving the positions of the earth, sun, and more. These shifts include certain patterns that occur alongside new conditions. For instance, the location in the sky where the sun rises at the beginning of spring completes a full cycle roughly every twenty-six thousand years. Therefore, this spring point moves to different areas of the heavens during that time span. Over the course of one-twelfth of that period, or about two thousand one hundred years, the conditions on earth have evolved enough for a human soul to encounter something new since its last incarnation. However, individual experiences differ based on whether one is born as a woman or a man, which typically results in two incarnations during that time frame: one as a man and one as a woman. These matters also depend on the specific forces that a person carries over from their earthly life through death. Thus, all these statements should be understood generally, but they can vary greatly depending on individual circumstances.
The Course Of Human Life
The Journey of Life
Man's life, as it manifests itself in the sequence of events between birth and death, can be fully understood only by taking into account both the physical body with its senses and the changes undergone by man's supersensible principles. Occult science views those changes in the following manner. Physical birth is seen to be the detachment of the human being from its maternal covering. Forces which before birth the embryo shared in common with its mother's body, are present independently in the child after birth. But in later life supersensible events, similar to those of the sense-world at physical birth, become perceptible to supersensible observation. That is, the etheric body of the human being up to the change [pg 410] of teeth (the sixth or seventh year) is still enveloped in an etheric sheath. The etheric sheath falls away at that period, and then the “birth” of the etheric body occurs. But man is still surrounded by an astral sheath, which falls away between its twelfth and sixteenth year (at the time of puberty). This is the “birth” of the astral body; and at a still later period the real ego is born.33
A person's life, as it unfolds from birth to death, can only be fully understood by considering both the physical body with its senses and the changes that occur in the person's non-physical aspects. Occult science explains these changes in the following way. Physical birth is seen as the separation of the individual from their mother's body. The forces that the embryo shared with the mother's body before birth become independent in the child after birth. However, in later life, non-physical events, similar to those experienced in the sensory world during physical birth, become recognizable through non-physical observation. That is, the etheric body of a person is still wrapped in an etheric sheath until around the time of the change of teeth (around the sixth or seventh year). The etheric sheath falls away at that time, marking the "birth" of the etheric body. But the person is still surrounded by an astral sheath, which disappears between the ages of twelve and sixteen (during puberty). This represents the "birth" of the astral body; and at a later stage, the true self is born.
Now after the birth of the ego, man lives in such a way that he adapts himself to the conditions of the world and of life, and occupies himself within them, in accordance with the principles active through his ego,—the sentient,- the intellectual- and the consciousness-soul. Then there comes a time in which the etheric body retraces the process of its development from the seventh year onward, in reverse order. At first the astral body has so developed itself that it unfolds that which was present within it at birth as a germ. After the birth of the ego, this astral body enriches itself by experiencing the outer world. Finally, at a definite time, it begins to nourish itself spiritually by consuming its own etheric body; it actually lives upon the etheric body. The decay of the physical body in old age is a consequence of this.
Now, after the birth of the ego, a person lives in a way that allows them to adapt to the conditions of the world and life, engaging with them based on the principles guided by their ego—the sentient, intellectual, and consciousness-soul. Eventually, there comes a time when the etheric body retraces its developmental process from the age of seven onward, but in reverse order. Initially, the astral body has developed to the point where it reveals what was present within it at birth as a seed. After the birth of the ego, this astral body enriches itself by experiencing the external world. Finally, at a certain point, it begins to spiritually nourish itself by consuming its own etheric body; it essentially sustains itself on the etheric body. The deterioration of the physical body in old age results from this process.
The course of human life therefore falls into three divisions: a time of unfoldment for the physical and [pg 411] etheric bodies, then one in which the astral body and the ego develop, and lastly that in which the etheric and physical bodies are changed back again. But the astral body plays a part in all the events that take place between birth and death. Since it is really born in a spiritual sense only between the twelfth and sixteenth years and must, during man's declining years, draw upon the forces of the etheric and physical bodies, that which it is able to perform by its own powers will develop more slowly than if it were not within a physical and an etheric body. After death, when the physical and etheric bodies have fallen away, evolution, during the time of purification, proceeds in such a manner that it occupies about one-third of the duration of life between birth and death.
The journey of human life can be divided into three phases: a period of growth for the physical and etheric bodies, a stage where the astral body and the self develop, and finally, a phase when the etheric and physical bodies are transformed back. However, the astral body is involved in all the experiences from birth to death. It truly comes into being in a spiritual sense between the ages of twelve and sixteen and must rely on the energy of the etheric and physical bodies as a person ages. Therefore, its abilities will develop more slowly than they would if it weren't influenced by these bodies. After death, when the physical and etheric bodies have shed, evolution during the time of purification unfolds in such a way that it takes about one-third of the lifespan between birth and death.
The Higher Regions Of The Spiritual World
The Higher Regions of the Spiritual World
By imagination, inspiration, and intuition, supersensible cognition gradually ascends into those regions of the spiritual world within which it can reach the beings who have to do with human and cosmic evolution. And thus it also becomes possible to trace human evolution between death and a new birth in such a way that it becomes comprehensible. Now there are still higher regions of existence, which can only be briefly indicated here. When supersensible cognition has risen to intuition, it lives in a world of spiritual beings. These too, are evolving. That which concerns humanity of the present day extends upward, in a certain sense, as far as the [pg 412] world of intuition. True, man receives impulses from yet higher worlds in the course of his evolution between death and re-birth. But he does not experience these impulses directly; they are brought to him by beings belonging to the spiritual world. And if these are considered, everything that happens reveals itself to man. But the special conditions of these beings, that which they themselves require in order to guide human evolution, can only be observed by means of a cognition that transcends intuition. We thus have a glimpse of worlds which we must so picture that within them the most highly spiritual features of the earth are there among the lowest. Logical decisions, for example, count among the highest things within the earthly sphere; while the activities of the mineral kingdom are among the lowest. Now in those higher spheres, logical decisions correspond to about what the mineral activities are on earth. Above the domain of intuition, lies the region in which the cosmic plan is woven out of spiritual causes.
Through imagination, inspiration, and intuition, supersensible understanding gradually rises into those areas of the spiritual world where it can connect with the beings involved in human and cosmic evolution. This makes it possible to trace human evolution between death and rebirth in a way that is understandable. There are even higher realms of existence that can only be briefly mentioned here. When supersensible understanding reaches intuition, it exists in a realm of spiritual beings, who are also evolving. What pertains to humanity today extends upward, in a sense, to the world of intuition. Indeed, humans receive impulses from even higher realms during their evolution between death and rebirth. However, they do not experience these impulses directly; they are conveyed to them by beings from the spiritual world. Considering these beings reveals everything that happens to humanity. But the specific conditions of these beings, and what they themselves need to guide human evolution, can only be understood through a knowledge that goes beyond intuition. We thus catch a glimpse of worlds that we must envision as having the most highly spiritual aspects of the Earth coexisting with the lowest. For instance, logical decisions are considered among the highest things in the earthly realm, while the activities of the mineral kingdom are seen as the lowest. In those higher realms, logical decisions correspond to what mineral activities are on Earth. Above the realm of intuition lies the area where the cosmic plan is shaped by spiritual causes.
The Principles Of Man
The Principles of Humanity
When it is said that the ego works on the human principles, on the physical, etheric, and astral bodies, and transforms them in reverse order into Spirit-Self, Life-Spirit, and Spirit-Man, this statement relates to the work of the ego on the human being by means of the highest faculties, the development of which was begun only under earthly conditions. But this transformation is preceded at a lower level by [pg 413] another change, giving rise to the sentient-, the intellectual- or rational-, and the consciousness-soul. For while, in the course of human evolution, the sentient-soul is being formed, changes are taking place in the astral body; the growth of the intellectual-soul expresses itself in transformations in the etheric body; and that of the consciousness-soul in similar transformations in the physical body. Fuller information on this subject has been given in this book in the accounts of the evolution of the earth. Thus in a certain sense we may say that the sentient-soul itself is the result of a transformed astral body, the intellectual- or rational-soul of a transformed etheric body, and the consciousness-soul of a transformed physical body. But we may also say that these three divisions of the soul are parts of the astral body; for example, the consciousness-soul is only possible because it is an astral entity existing in a physical body suited to it. It lives an astral life within a physical body fashioned to be its dwelling place.
When we say that the ego operates on human principles through the physical, etheric, and astral bodies, transforming them in reverse order into Spirit-Self, Life-Spirit, and Spirit-Man, we're referring to how the ego works on the human being using the highest faculties, which only started developing under earthly conditions. However, this transformation is preceded at a lower level by another change that gives rise to the sentient soul, the intellectual or rational soul, and the consciousness soul. As the sentient soul develops during human evolution, changes occur in the astral body; the growth of the intellectual soul reflects transformations in the etheric body, and the development of the consciousness soul shows similar transformations in the physical body. More information on this topic has been provided in this book regarding the evolution of the earth. Thus, in a way, we can say that the sentient soul is a result of a transformed astral body, the intellectual or rational soul comes from a transformed etheric body, and the consciousness soul arises from a transformed physical body. At the same time, we can also say that these three aspects of the soul are parts of the astral body; for example, the consciousness soul exists because it is an astral entity living in a physical body that supports it. It experiences an astral life within a physical body designed to be its home.
The Dream State
The Dream Zone
A description of the dream state has been given in another chapter of this book. On the one hand it is to be regarded as a relic of the old picture-consciousness peculiar to man during the Moon evolution, and also during a great part of the evolution of the Earth. Evolution goes forward in such a way that earlier conditions resolve themselves into later ones. And so, in the dream state, there now appears [pg 414] in man a relic of what was once his normal condition. But at the same time this condition from another aspect is different from the old picture-consciousness. For since its development, the ego also has taken part in those activities of the astral body which are carried on during sleep in the dream life. Thus through the presence of the ego there arises in dreams a transformed picture-consciousness. But since the ego does not consciously exercise its authority over the astral body during dream life, nothing belonging to the sphere of that life can be regarded as being really able to lead to a knowledge of higher worlds in an occult sense. Something similar holds good with regard to what is often called vision, premonition, or “second sight.” These arise through silencing the ego and the consequent appearance of remnants of the old condition of consciousness. In spiritual science these are of no value. What may be observed in them cannot in any real sense be regarded as a result of it.
A description of the dream state has been provided in another chapter of this book. On one hand, it should be seen as a leftover from the old picture-consciousness that was typical for humans during the Moon evolution and for a significant part of Earth's evolution. Evolution unfolds in such a way that earlier states transform into later ones. Therefore, in the dream state, there remains in humans a trace of what was once their normal state. However, this state is also different from the old picture-consciousness in another way. Since its development, the ego has participated in the activities of the astral body that take place during sleep in the dream life. Consequently, the presence of the ego gives rise to a transformed picture-consciousness in dreams. Yet, because the ego does not consciously exert its influence over the astral body during dream life, nothing from that realm can truly lead to knowledge of higher worlds in an occult sense. A similar principle applies to what is often referred to as vision, premonition, or “second sight.” These phenomena emerge when the ego is silenced, resulting in the reappearance of remnants of the old state of consciousness. In spiritual science, these are considered meaningless. What can be observed in them should not be regarded as a genuine outcome of it.
The Attainment Of Supersensible Knowledge
The Pursuit of Higher Knowledge
The path to the attainment of knowledge of the higher worlds, which has been more fully described in this book, may also be called the “direct path of knowledge.” In addition to this path there is another, which we may designate as the “path of feeling.” It would be quite a mistake, however, to believe that the former had nothing to do with the development of feeling. On the contrary, it leads to the greatest possible deepening of the life of feeling. But [pg 415] the “path of feeling” addresses itself directly and solely to the feelings, and seeks from this point to rise to knowledge. It rests on the fact that when the soul entirely surrenders itself to a feeling for a certain length of time, the latter is transformed into knowledge, into imaginative perception. When, for example, the soul is filled for weeks or months, or even longer, with the feeling of humility, the content of the feeling becomes transformed into a perception. Now a path leading to supersensible regions may be found by devoting oneself to such feelings one by one; but for the man of today, bound by the ordinary circumstances of life, this is not easily carried out. Solitude, retirement from the life of the present day, is almost indispensable. For the impressions of everyday life disturb the soul especially at the beginning of development, through absorption in certain feelings. On the other hand, the path of knowledge described in this book can be pursued in every situation of present-day life.
The journey to gaining knowledge of higher worlds, which is explained in this book, can also be referred to as the "straight path to knowledge." Alongside this path, there's another one that we can call the "emotional journey." However, it would be a mistake to think that the first path has nothing to do with developing feelings. On the contrary, it leads to a deepening of emotional life. But the [pg 415] “emotional journey” focuses directly and solely on emotions and aims to elevate them to knowledge. It’s based on the idea that when the soul completely surrenders to a feeling for a certain period, that feeling transforms into knowledge, or imaginative insight. For instance, when the soul is filled with humility for weeks or months, or even longer, the essence of that feeling evolves into perception. A path to higher realms can be found by immersing oneself in these feelings, one at a time; however, for people today, caught up in the usual demands of life, this isn't easy to achieve. Solitude and stepping back from contemporary life are often essential because daily life’s distractions can disturb the soul, especially in the early stages of development when one's focus is on certain feelings. On the other hand, the path of knowledge described in this book can be followed in any situation in modern life.
Observation Of Special Events And Beings In The Spiritual World
Observation of Special Events and Beings in the Spiritual World
The question may be asked whether inner concentration and the other means described for the attainment of supersensible cognition permit us to observe only in a general way what happens between death and a new birth or other spiritual events; or whether they furnish the possibility of observing quite definite events and beings, as, for example, any given deceased person. To this we must answer that one who has acquired the ability to see in the spiritual [pg 416] world by the methods explained, can also perceive particular events which occur there; he acquires the power of putting himself in communication with individuals living in the spiritual world between death and a new birth. It must be observed, however, that in an occult sense this ought to take place only after the proper training required for supersensible cognition has been undergone. For not until then is it possible to distinguish between illusion and reality, in regard to certain events and beings. A man who tries to observe particular cases without due instruction, may fall a victim to innumerable deceptions. The training which leads to the observation in higher worlds of what has been described in this book, also leads to the ability to trace the post-mortem life of any special individual, and no less does it lead to the observation and comprehension of all psycho-spiritual beings who, from the hidden worlds, work upon the visible ones. Correct observation of individual cases is only possible, however, on the basis of a knowledge of the universal great facts of the spiritual world,—facts regarding the world and humanity which concern every human being. The desire for the one without the other, leads one into error.
The question can be raised about whether inner concentration and other methods for achieving higher awareness allow us to see only in a general way what occurs between death and rebirth, or any other spiritual events; or if they enable us to observe specific events and individuals, like a particular deceased person. We must say that someone who has developed the ability to see in the spiritual world using the methods described can also perceive specific events occurring there; they gain the ability to connect with individuals living in the spiritual realm between death and rebirth. However, it is important to note that this should only happen after proper training for higher perception has been completed. Only then can one distinguish between illusion and reality concerning certain events and beings. A person who attempts to observe specific cases without proper guidance may fall prey to countless deceptions. The training that enables observation in higher realms of what has been discussed in this book also allows one to trace the afterlife of any specific individual and to observe and understand all psycho-spiritual beings that influence the physical world from hidden realms. However, accurate observation of individual cases is only possible with a solid understanding of the universal truths of the spiritual world—truths about the world and humanity that concern everyone. The desire for one without the other leads one into mistakes.
Footnotes
- 1.
- We may also say, it could only live the life of a plant in the physical body.
- 2.
- Explanations such as those given in this book regarding the faculty of memory may very easily be misunderstood. For one who observes external events only would not at first sight notice the difference between what happens in the animal, or even in the plant, when something appears in them resembling memory, and what is here characterized as actual recollection in man. Of course, when an animal has performed an action for a third or fourth time it may perform it in such a way that the outer process gives the impression that memory and the training associated with it are present. Nay, we may even extend our conception of memory or of recollection as far as some naturalists and their disciples, when they point out that the chicken begins to pick up grain as soon as it comes out of the shell; that it even knows the proper movements of head and body for gaining its end. It could not have learned this in the eggshell; hence it must have done so through the thousands and thousands of creatures from which it is descended (so says Hering, for example). We may call the phenomenon before us something resembling memory, but we shall never arrive at a real comprehension of human nature if we do not take into account that every distinctive element which shows itself in the human being as an inner process, as an actual perception of earlier experiences at a later date, is not merely the working of earlier conditions in later ones. In this book it is this perception of what is past that is called memory, not alone the reappearance (even though transformed) of what once existed, in a later form. Were we to use the word memory for the corresponding processes in the vegetable and animal kingdoms, we should be required to use a different word in speaking of man. In the description given here the important thing is not the particular word used, but rather that in attempting to understand human beings this distinction should be recognized. Just as little do the apparently very intelligent actions of animals have any relation to what is here called memory.
- 3.
- The term "Understanding Soul" is sometimes translated by "rational mind." From a certain point of view one might prefer the term "intellectual spirit," because it expresses better the activity of the soul than does "rational mind." In the latter one thinks of the knowledge about a perception; in intellectuality, one thinks of the actual possibility of forming this knowledge through inward activity. In German the expression “emotional soul” only coincides as it should with the second member of the soul when the inward activity is kept in view.
- 4.
- No hard and fast line can be drawn between the changes which are accomplished in the astral body through the activity of the ego and those taking place in the etheric body. The one merges into the other. When a man learns something, and thereby gains a certain capacity for judgment, a change takes place in his astral body; but when this judgment changes his natural disposition, so that he habituates himself to feel differently, in consequence of his learning, from what he did before, this means a change in his etheric body. Everything that becomes so much a man's own that he can always recall it, is based on the transformation of the etheric body. That which little by little becomes an abiding possession of the memory has its foundation in the transmission to the etheric body of the work of the astral body.
- 5.
- As a matter of fact, it is always very profitable for any one who is taking up the study of occult science to acquaint himself with the statements of those who regard this science as merely fanciful. Such statements cannot be so easily branded as due to partiality on the part of the observer. Let occultists learn as much as possible from those who regard their efforts as nonsense. They need not be disturbed if in this respect their love is not reciprocated. Occult observation assuredly does not require such things for the verification of its results, nor are these allusions intended as proofs but as illustrations.
- 6.
- In current theosophical literature, the condition of the ego from death to the end of purification is called “Kamaloca.”
- 7.
- The assertion that a man's personal talents, if governed purely by the law of “genetics,” must show themselves at the beginning of a line of descent, not at its end, might of course easily be misunderstood. It might be said, indeed, that they could not show themselves then, for they must first be developed. But this is no objection; for if we wish to prove that something has been inherited from an ancestor, we must show how that which was there formerly is repeated in a descendant. Now if it were demonstrated that something existed at the beginning of a genealogical line which reappeared in its further course, we might speak of heredity. We cannot do so when something appears at the end of it which was not there before. The reversal of the above proposition is only to show that the belief in heredity is impossible.
- 8.
In different chapters of this book it has been shown how the world of humanity, and man himself, pass, in their progressive evolution, through conditions which have been named Saturn, Sun, Moon, Earth, Jupiter, Venus, and Vulcan. The relationship has also been indicated in which human evolution stands with regard to the celestial bodies which exist besides the earth and which are called saturn, jupiter, mars, and so on. These latter planets are also passing through their evolution in the natural way. At the present period they have reached such a stage that their physical portions are seen as those bodies which physical astronomy calls saturn, jupiter, mars, and so forth. Now when the saturn of the present day is observed by occultism it is seen to be, in a certain sense, a reincarnation of the old Saturn. It has come into existence because of the presence of certain beings, who before the separation of the sun from the earth were unable, like the others, to leave with the sun. The reason of this was that they had gained so many qualities which are suitable for a saturn existence, that their place could not be where the qualities of the sun were specially unfolded. The present jupiter, however, arose in consequence of the presence of beings possessed of qualities which can only be matured on the future jupiter of the whole evolution. A dwelling place appeared for them on which they can already begin in anticipation of this later evolution.
In different chapters of this book, it has been explained how humanity, and individuals, progress through various stages of evolution known as Saturn, Sun, Moon, Earth, Jupiter, Venus, and Vulcan. The connection between human development and the celestial bodies beyond Earth—like Saturn, Jupiter, Mars, and others—has also been highlighted. These planets are evolving naturally as well. At this point in time, they have reached a stage where their physical forms are recognized as the bodies that physical astronomy names Saturn, Jupiter, Mars, and so on. When occultism examines the present-day Saturn, it perceives it, in a certain way, as a reincarnation of the old Saturn. It has come into being due to the presence of specific beings who, before the separation of the sun from the Earth, were unable to leave with the others. This was because they had developed so many qualities suited for a Saturn existence that they couldn’t be where the qualities of the sun were primarily expressed. The current Jupiter, however, emerged from the presence of beings with characteristics that can only be fully developed on the future Jupiter of the overall evolution. A space has been provided for them where they can start to engage in anticipation of this later evolution.
In the same way mars is a planetary body on which dwell beings whose lunar evolution was such that further progress on the earth could bring them nothing. Mars is a reincarnation of the old Moon at a higher stage. The present mercury is the dwelling place of beings who are beyond the evolution of the earth; but this is just because they have developed certain qualities in a higher way than is possible on the earth itself. The present venus is a prophetic anticipation of the future Venus condition of a similar kind. It is consequently justifiable to give to the conditions preceding and following the Earth the names of their corresponding representatives in the universe.
In the same way, Mars is a planet where beings live whose lunar evolution was such that any further progress on Earth would mean nothing to them. Mars is a reincarnation of the old Moon but at a higher stage. The current Mercury is home to beings who are beyond Earth's evolution; this is because they have developed certain qualities in a way that's not possible on Earth itself. Today's Venus is a prophetic glimpse of the future Venus condition of a similar kind. Therefore, it makes sense to name the conditions before and after Earth after their corresponding representations in the universe.
- 9.
- Therefore it is perhaps scarcely necessary to remark that what has been described above could never actually happen. A contemporary man, as he is, could not have approached ancient Saturn as a spectator. The account was given merely for the sake of illustration.
- 10.
- In Christian spiritual science they bear the name of "Kyriotetes," that is, "Territories."
- 11.
- In Christian esoteric science they are called "Game of Thrones."
- 12.
- The Christian “Dynamis,” or "Abilities."
- 13.
- The Christian “Exusiai,” or "Authorities."
- 14.
- The Christian "Archaic," or "Principalities."
- 15.
- The Christian "Archangels," or "Archangels."
- 16.
- The Christian "Seraphim."
- 17.
- The Christian “Angels,” or "Angels."
- 18.
- The Christian “Cherubs.”
- 19.
- The gas appears to clairvoyant consciousness through the effect of light which emanates from it. We might therefore speak also of light forms, which are apparent to spiritual vision.
- 20.
- In current theosophical literature they are called "rounds." Yet, if we bear in mind the more graphic description already given, we shall guard against a too schematic concept of such matters.
- 21.
- In the next few pages, Sun and Moon are printed with capital letters when the outdated evolutions are referred to, but are printed “sun” and “moon” when the Earth period is indicated.—Translator.
- 22.
- Further particulars on this subject will be found in my book, Atlantis and Lemuria, which deals with man's ancestors.
- 23.
- More detailed information about these Mysteries of antiquity is to be found in my book, “Christianity as a Mystical Fact.” More particulars will be given in the last chapter of the present work.
- 24.
- What is to be said further on this subject will be given in a later chapter dealing with supersensible knowledge.
- 25.
- All sagas concerning the twilight of the gods, and similar traditions, had their origin in this knowledge of the Mysteries in Europe.
- 26.
- It is a matter of no moment whatever whether the above thoughts are warranted or not by any of the views held by natural science. For the object is to develop such thoughts about the plant and man as may—irrespective of all theories—be gained by means of simple and direct contemplation. Such thoughts are of importance side by side with no less significant theoretical presentments of things in the external world; and here the thoughts are not adduced in order to prove a fact scientifically, but to construct a symbol that shall prove effective, irrespective of whatever objections may be raised by this or that person against its construction.
- 27.
- In my explanations of "How to Gain Knowledge of the Higher Worlds," translated under the title of *The Path of Initiation* and beginning at Chapter II, several other examples of methods of meditation are given, and especially efficacious will be found one which deals with the coming into being and fading away of a plant; also another may be particularly recommended, based on the dormant formative power dwelling in the seed of a plant, and others on the form and structure of crystals, and other substances. But the purpose in this book was only to show in one instance, the nature of meditation.
- 28.
- Special exercises going into greater detail on this subject may be found in my book entitled *The Path of Initiation*.
- 29.
- It must of course be clearly understood that such an appellation as "lotus flower" has no more bearing on the matter than has the expression "wing," if applied to the lobe of a lung.
- 30.
- In my books, entitled “The Path of Initiation” and “Initiation and Its Outcomes,” some of these methods of meditation and exercises for acting upon these different organs are set forth.
- 31.
- The appellation “two-petal” or "16-petaled," and so on, is used because the organs in question may be likened to flowers having a corresponding number of petals.
- 32.
- Intuition is in everyday life a much-abused word, which is made to stand for a vague and uncertain view of a matter; for some sort of "idea," which, while it may possibly "hit" the truth, can nevertheless give no immediate proof of it. It is needless to say that this kind of intuition is not meant here. Intuition, in this case, stands for knowledge of the highest and most luminous clearness, of the justification of which the possessor is, in the fullest sense, conscious.
- 33.
- The suggestive points of view for the conduct of education resulting from a knowledge of these supersensible facts are presented in my little book, The Education of Children from the Perspective of Spiritual Science, in which will be found fuller details of what can here only be hinted at.
Download ePUB
If you like this ebook, consider a donation!